Pa1x 252um Eng

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 424

E

Users Manual

ENGLISH
OS Ver. 2.52
MAN0001093

Important safety instructions

Read these instructions.

Keep these instructions.

Heed all warnings.

Follow all instructions.

Do not use this apparatus near water.

Mains powered apparatus shall not be exposed to dripping or


splashing and that no objects filled with liquids, such as vases, shall
be placed on the apparatus.

Clean only with dry cloth.

Do not block any ventilation openings, install in accordance with


the manufacturers instructions.

Do not install near any heat sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other apparatus (including amplifiers) that produce
heat.

Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized or groundingtype plug. A polarized plug has two blades with one wider than
the other. A grounding type plug has two blades and a third
grounding prong. The wide blade or the third prong are provided
for your safety. If the provided plug does not fit into your outlet,
consult an electrician for replacement of the obsolete outlet. (for
U.S.A. and Canada)

Protect the power cord from being walked on or pinched particularly at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the point where they
exit from the apparatus.

Only use attachments/accessories specified by the manufacturer.

Unplug this apparatus during lightning storms or when unused for


long periods of time.

Turning off the power switch does not completely isolate this
product from the power line so remove the plug from the socket if
not using it for extended periods of time.

Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel. Servicing is


required when the apparatus has been damaged in any way, such
as power-supply cord or plug is damaged, liquid has been spilled
or objects have fallen into the apparatus, the apparatus has been
exposed to rain or moisture, does not operate normally, or has
been dropped.

Do not install this equipment on the far position from wall outlet
and/or convenience receptacle.

Do not install this equipment in a confined space such as a box for


the conveyance or similar unit.

Use only with the cart, stand, tripod, bracket, or table specified by
the manufacturer, or sold with the apparatus. When a cart is used,
use caution when moving the cart/apparatus combination to avoid
injury from tip-over.

The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol


within an equilateral triangle, is intended to
alert the user to the presence of uninsulated
dangerous voltage within the products enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to persons.
The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert the user to the presence of important operating and maintenance
(servicing) instructions in the literature accompanying the product.

CAUTION
Danger of explosion if battery is incorrectly replaced.
Replace only with the same or equivalent type.

THE FCC REGULATION WARNING (for U.S.A.)


This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for
a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits
are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful
interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses,
and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in
accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to
radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference
will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause
harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be
determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is
encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the
following measures:
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that
to which the receiver is connected.
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
Unauthorized changes or modification to this system can void the users
authority to operate this equipment.

CE mark for European Harmonized Standards


CE mark which is attached to our companys products of AC mains
operated apparatus until December 31, 1996 means it conforms to EMC
Directive (89/336/EEC) and CE mark Directive (93/68/EEC).
And, CE mark which is attached after January 1, 1997 means it conforms
to EMC Directive (89/336/EEC), CE mark Directive (93/68/EEC) and Low
Voltage Directive (73/23/EEC).
Also, CE mark which is attached to our companys products of Battery
operated apparatus means it conforms to EMC Directive (89/336/EEC)
and CE mark Directive (93/68/EEC).

IMPORTANT NOTICE TO CONSUMERS


This product has been manufactured according to strict specifications
and voltage requirements that are applicable in the country in which it is
intended that this product should be used. If you have purchased this
product via the internet, through mail order, and/or via a telephone sale,
you must verify that this product is intended to be used in the country in
which you reside.
WARNING: Use of this product in any country other than that for which
it is intended could be dangerous and could invalidate the
manufacturer's or distributor's warranty.
Please also retain your receipt as proof of purchase otherwise your
product may be disqualified from the manufacturer's or distributor's
warranty.

Data Handling

Disclaimer

Data in memory may sometimes be lost due to incorrect user


action. Be sure to save important data to floppy disk or hard disk.
Korg will not be responsible for damages caused by data loss.

The information contained in this manual have been carefully


revised and checked through. Due to our constant efforts to
improve our products, the specifications might differ to those in
the manual. Korg is not responsible for any eventual differences
found between the specifications and the contents of the instruction manual the specifications being subject to change without
prior notice

Example screens
Some pages of the manuals show LCD screens along with an
explanation of functions and operations. All sound names,
parameter names, and values are merely examples and may not
always match the actual display you are working on.

Liability

Use a soft cotton cloth to clean the screen. Some materials, such
as paper towels, could cause scratches and damage it. Computer
wipes are also suggested, provided they are specifically designed
for LCD screens.

Korg products are manufactured under strict specifications and


voltages required by each country. These products are warranted
by the Korg distributor only in each country. Any Korg product
not sold with a warranty card or carrying a serial number disqualifies the product sold from the manufacturer's/distributor's
warranty and liability. This requirement is for your own protection and safety.

Do not spray any liquids on the LCD screen directly. Always


apply the solution to your cloth first, then clean the screen.

Service and Users Assistance

Cleaning the display

Trademarks
Akai is a registered trademark of Akai Professional Corporation.
Macintosh is a registered trademark of Apple Computer, Inc.
MS-DOS and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft
Corporation. TC-Helicon is a registered trademark of TC Electronic, Inc. All other trademarks or registered trademarks are the
property of their respective holders.

For service, please contact your nearest Authorized Korg Service


Center. For more information on Korg products, and to find
software and accessories for your keyboard, please contact your
local Authorized Korg distributor. For up-to-date information,
please point your web browser to www.korgpa.com.

Copyright 2003-2005 KORG Italy Spa. Printed in Italy.

The BALANCE slider


When turning the instrument on, please be assured the BALANCE slider is set to the center. This sets both Sequencer 1 and Sequencer 2 to their maximum level. This will avoid
you start a Song without hearing anything.

Table of Contents

Table of Contents
Introduction
Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Rear panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Welcome! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Live Performing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Useful links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Whats in the box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
About this manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Making a backup copy of system files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Loading the operating system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Reloading the Factory Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Start up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Connecting the AC power cord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Turning the instrument on and off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Controlling the Volume (Master&Acc/Seq) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
The BALANCE slider . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Headphones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Audio Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Audio Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
MIDI connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Damper Pedal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Demo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
The music stand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Glossary of Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Keyboard tracks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Performance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Sequencer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
The LOGO decoder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Interface basics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
The Color TouchView graphical user interface . . . . . . . . . . 22
Operative modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Selected, highlighted items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Non-available, grayed-out parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23

Single Touch Settings (STS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43


The Pads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Adjusting volume balance between the Style and the
keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Adjusting volume of each single track . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Turning Style tracks on/off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Adding chords to your right-hand melody (ENSEMBLE
function) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Song Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Selecting a Song to play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Playing back a Song . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Changing tracks volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Turning Song tracks on/off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Mixing two Songs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Listening to a CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
The SongBook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Selecting the desired entry from the Main List . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Displaying Artist or Genre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Sorting entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Searching entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Adding entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Creating a Custom List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Selecting and using a Custom List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Selecting a SongBook STS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Singing with a connected microphone . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Connecting a microphone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Applying harmony to your voice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Soloing your voice (TalkBack) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Locking Voice Processor settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Recording a new Song . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Entering Backing Sequence (Quick Record) mode . . . . . . . . . 68
Preparing to record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Second-take recording (Overdubbing) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Saving a Song to disk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71

Reference
Quick Guide
Turning the instrument on and listening to the
demos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Turning the instrument on, and viewing the main screen . . . 26
Playing the demos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Playing Sounds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Selecting a Sound and playing it on the keyboard . . . . . . . . . . 27
Playing two or three Sounds at the same time . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Playing different Sounds with your left and your right hand . 31
Changing the split point . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Raising or lowering the Upper octave . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Digital Drawbars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Selecting and saving Performances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Selecting a Performance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Saving your settings to a Performance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Selecting and playing Styles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Selecting and playing a Style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Tempo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Intro, Fill, Variation, Ending . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42

Selecting elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Sound Select window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Performance Select window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Style Select window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Pad Select window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
STS Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Song Select window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Style Play operating mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Start-up settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
How Styles, Performances and STSs are linked together . . . . . 78
Main page (Normal view) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Style Tracks view page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Volume panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
STS Name panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Mic panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Sub-Scale panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Pad panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Split panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Edit menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Edit page structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84

Table of Contents

Mixer/Tuning: Volume/Pan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Mixer/Tuning: FX Send . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Mixer/Tuning: Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Mixer/Tuning: Sub Scale . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Effects: FX Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Effects: FX AD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Track Controls: Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Track Controls: Drum Volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Track Controls: Easy Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Keyboard/Ensemble: Keyboard Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Keyboard/Ensemble: Key/Velocity Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Keyboard/Ensemble: Ensemble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Style Controls: Drum/Fill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Style Controls: Keyboard Range On/Off / Wrap Around . . . . 93
Pad/Switch: Pad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Pad/Switch: Assignable Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Preferences: Style Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Preferences: Global Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Page menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Write Performance dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Write Single Touch Setting dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Write Style Performance dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Write Global-Style Play Setup dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
The DIRECT HD bank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
The DIRECT FD bank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Style Record mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
The Style structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Style Import/Export . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Entering the Style Record mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Exit by saving or deleting changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Listening to the Style while in Edit mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
List of recorded events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Main page - Record 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Main page - Record 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Style Record procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Edit menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Edit page structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Event Edit: Event Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Event Edit: Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Style Edit: Quantize . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Style Edit: Transpose . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Style Edit: Velocity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Style Edit: Cut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Style Edit: Delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Style Edit: Delete All . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Style Edit: Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Style Element Track Controls: Sound/Expression . . . . . . . . . 119
Style Element Track Controls: Keyboard Range . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Style Element Chord Table: Chord Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Style Track Controls: Type/Trigger/Tension . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Import: Import Groove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Import: Import SMF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Export SMF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Page menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Write Style dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Copy Sounds dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Copy Expression dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Copy Key Range dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Copy Chord Table dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Overdub Step Recording window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Pad Record mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
The Pad structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Entering the Pad Record mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126

Exit by saving or deleting changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127


Listening to the Pad while in Record/Edit mode . . . . . . . . . .127
Main page - Pad Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
Pad Record procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129
Edit menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129
Edit page structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129
Event Edit: Event Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
Pad Edit: Quantize . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
Pad Edit: Transpose . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
Pad Edit: Velocity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131
Pad Edit: Cut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131
Pad Edit: Delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
Pad Edit: Delete All . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
Pad Edit: Copy from Style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
Pad Edit: Copy from Pad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133
Pad Track Controls: Sound/Expression . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133
Pad Chord Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134
Import: Import Groove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134
Import: Import SMF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Export: SMF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Page menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Write Pad dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136
Song Play operating mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Transport controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
MIDI Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Master Volume, Sequencer Volume, Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Track parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Standard MIDI Files and Sounds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
NRPN Sound parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138
Keyboard, Pad and Sequencer tracks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138
Main page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139
Song Tracks 1-8 and 9-16 pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
Volume panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Jukebox panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Lyrics & Markers panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144
STS Name panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146
Mic panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146
Sub-Scale panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146
Pad panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146
Split panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146
Edit menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Edit page structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Switching between sequencers during editing . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Mixer/Tuning: Volume/Pan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Mixer/Tuning: FX Send . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
Mixer/Tuning: Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149
Effects: FX Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149
Effects: FX AD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Track Controls: Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Track Controls: Drum Volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Track Controls: Easy Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Keyboard/Ensemble: Keyboard Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Keyboard/Ensemble: Key/Velocity Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
Keyboard/Ensemble: Ensemble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
Pad/Switch: Pad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
Pad/Switch: Assignable Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
Jukebox Editor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
Groove Quantize . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Preferences: Track Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153
Preferences: General Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153
Page menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Write Global-Song Play Setup dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156
Playing back MP3 files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156

Table of Contents

Playing back Audio CD tracks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156


SongBook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Book Edit 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Book Edit 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Custom List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
List Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Lyrics/STS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Info . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Page menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Sequencer operating mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Transport controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
The Songs and the Standard MIDI File format . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Songs and Voice Processor Presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Sequencer Play - Main page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Entering Record mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Record mode: Multitrack Sequencer page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Record mode: Step Record page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Record mode: Backing Sequence (Quick Record) page . . . . 173
Record mode: Step Backing Sequence page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Edit menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
Edit page structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
Mixer/Tuning: Volume/Pan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Mixer/Tuning: FX Send . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Mixer/Tuning: Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Mixer/Tuning: Sub Scale . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Effects: FX Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Effects: FX AD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Track Controls: Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Track Controls: Drum Volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Track Controls: Easy Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Event Edit: Event Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Event Edit: Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Song Edit: Quantize . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Song Edit: Transpose . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Song Edit: Velocity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Song Edit: Cut/Insert Measures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Song Edit: Delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Song Edit: Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Song Edit: Move . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Preferences: Global Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Page menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Write Global-Sequencer Setup dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Song Select window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Save Song window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Sound operating mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
The MIDI channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
How to select oscillators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Sounds, Drum Kits, Digital Drawbars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Main page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Digital Drawbars page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Edit menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Edit page structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Basic: Sound Basic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Basic: OSC Basic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Basic: Vel/Key Zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
DrumKit: Sample Setup (Drum Kits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
DrumKit: Voice Mixer (Drum Kits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Pitch: Pitch Mod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
Pitch: Pitch EG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Filter: Filter Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Filter: Filter Mod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Filter: Filter LFO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203

Filter: Filter EG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203


Amp: Amp Level/Pan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
Amp: Amp Mod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Amp: Amp EG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
LFO: LFO1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
LFO: LFO2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
Effects: FX Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
Effects: FX1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
Effects: FX2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
Page menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
Write Sound dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
Copy Oscillator dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Copy FX dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Copy Drum Kit dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
AMS (Alternate Modulation Source) list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Sampling operating mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
Entering and exiting the Sampling mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
The Record (Sampling) procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
Edit menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
Sampling: Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
Sampling: Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Sampling: Loop Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Sampling: Sampling Info . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Time Slice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
The Time Slice procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
The Extend procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Multisample: Edit MS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Multisample: Key Assign . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
Page menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Write Sample dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Write MultiSample dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Write Slice dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Delete Sample dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Delete Multisample dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Export Sample dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
Export Multisample dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
Global edit mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
What is it, and how the Global is structured . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Main page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Edit menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Edit page structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
General Controls: Basic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
General Controls: Transpose Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
General Controls: Scale . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
General Controls: Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
General Controls: Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Controllers: Pedal/Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
Controllers: Assignable Sliders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
Controllers: EC5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
MIDI: MIDI Setup / General Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
MIDI: MIDI In Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
MIDI: MIDI In Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
MIDI: MIDI Out Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
MIDI: Filters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Audio Output: Sty/Kbd . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Audio Output: Seq1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Audio Output: Seq2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Audio Output: Drums . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Audio Output: Audio In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Audio Output: Metro / S/PDIF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Audio Output: MP3/CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Voice Processor Setup: Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Voice Processor Setup: Lead Voice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243

Table of Contents

Voice Processor Setup: Dynamics / EQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243


Voice Processor Setup: Talk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Voice Processor Preset: Preset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Voice Processor Preset: Thicken / Pitch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Voice Processor Preset: Voice Modeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Voice Processor Preset: Harmony . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
Voice Processor Preset: Harmony Voices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Voice Processor Preset: Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
Voice Processor Preset: Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
Voice Processor: The optional Pitch Correction and
Voice Modeling modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
Harmony and Tuning with the Voice Processor . . . . . . . . . . 253
Video Interface: Video Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Touch Panel Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Page menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Write Global - Global Setup dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Write Global - Midi Setup dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Write Global - Talk Configuration dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
Write Global - Voice Processor Setup dialog box . . . . . . . . . . 258
Write Global - Voice Processor Preset dialog box . . . . . . . . . 258
Disk edit mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
Storage devices and internal memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
Selecting and deselecting files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
File types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
Disk structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Main page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Page structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Navigation tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Save . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265
Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
Erase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Utility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
USB/CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
USB/CD: USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
USB/CD: CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
Page menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Disk handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Bonus software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
MIDI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
What is MIDI? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
Standard MIDI Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
The General MIDI standard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
The Global channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
The Chord 1 and Chord 2 channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
The Control channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
MIDI Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
Connecting Pa1X to a Master keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
Connecting the Pa1X to a MIDI accordion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Connecting the Pa1X to an external sequencer . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Playing another instrument with the Pa1X . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284

Appendix
Factory data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
Styles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
Style Elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
Single Touch Settings (STS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
Sounds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291

Drum Kits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299


Drum Kit maps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .300
Multisamples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
Drum Samples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
Performances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .322
Pads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .324
List of sounds assignable to the Pads in OS versions
previous to 2.0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .327
MIDI Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .328
Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329
Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
Dynamic Modulation sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
Filter/Dynamic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
Pitch/Phase Mod. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .340
Mod./P.Shift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
ER/Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Reverb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .360
Mono Mono Chain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .362
Assignable parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378
List of Footswitch and EC5 functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .378
List of Assignable Pedal and Assignable Sliders functions . . .379
List of Assignable Switches functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .380
List of functions assignable to Voice Processors
Continuous Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .381
List of functions assignable to Voice Processors Switch
Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .381
Scales . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .382
MIDI Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383
MIDI Controllers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
Program Change messages used as remote commands . . . . .384
MIDI Implementation Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .385
Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386
Control panel and operating mode parameters . . . . . . . . . . .386
Style, Pad and Song parameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .392
Recognized chords . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393
Installing the hard disk (Pa1X only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
Installing the Korg CDRW-1 Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397
Installing additional RAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399
Installing ROM expansions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
Installing the Video Interface (VIF3) . . . . . . . . . . . . 403
NTSC, PAL, SECAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .403
Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .403
Part listing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .403
Installation on the Pa1X Pro . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .404
Installation on the Pa1X . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .405
Connections and setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .406
Installing the MP3 Board (EXBP-MP3) . . . . . . . . . . . 407
Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .407
Part listing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .407
Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .408
Recording an MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .410
Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .410
Shortcuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412
Technical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416

Introduction

Front panel

Front panel

23

78
I

90AB
D
E

C
G

L
R

78

2
3
D

E
1

90AB
C
F

J
K

Introduction

Front panel

a b

WX
L M

YZ

[ \

Q
U
L M

O P

WX

a b

c
g

YZ
R

[ \

Front panel

1 JOYSTICK
This joystick triggers different functions, depending on the
direction it is moved towards.
X (+/)

DRAWBARS Each slider controls the corresponding drawbar


of the selected Digital Drawbars Sound.
ASSIGN. A

First set of freely assignable controls.

ASSIGN. B

Second set of freely assignable controls.

Move the joystick towards the left () to lower the


pitch, or towards the right (+) to raise it. This is
also called Pitch Bend.

6 MODE section

Y+

Move the joystick forward to trigger Modulation.

Each of these buttons recalls one of the instruments operating


modes. When selected, each mode excludes the others.

Move the joystick backward, to trigger the function assigned in Sound mode.

2 MASTER VOLUME

STYLE PLAY Style Play mode, where you can play Styles (automatic accompaniments) and/or play up to four
Keyboard tracks.
In the main page, Keyboard tracks are shown in
the right half of the display. You can reach the
main page by pressing EXIT from any of the Style
Play edit pages. If you are in a different operating
mode, press STYLE PLAY to recall the Style Play
mode. If Keyboard tracks are not shown in the
display, press the TRK. SEL. button to see them.

This slider controls the overall volume of the instrument, both


of the internal speakers (only Pa1X), the LEFT/MONO and
RIGHT outputs, and the HEADPHONES output. It does not
control the volume of the 1 and 2 sub-outputs.
This slider also controls the volume of the signal entering the
MIC input. It does not control the signal entering the line inputs
(1 and 2).
Warning: At the maximum level, with rich-sounding Songs, Styles
or Sounds, the internal speakers of Pa1X could distort during signal
peaks. Should this happen, lower the Master Volume a little.

3 ACC/SEQ VOLUME
This slider controls the accompaniment tracks volume (Style
Play mode) or the Song tracks volume, excluding the Keyboard
tracks (Song Play and Sequencer modes). This is a relative control, whose effective maximum value is determined by the MASTER VOLUME slider position.

4 ASSIGNABLE SLIDERS

This operating mode is automatically selected


when turning the instrument on.
SONG PLAY Song Play mode, where you can play back,
directly from disk, Songs in Standard MIDI File
(SMF) or (optionally) MP3 and Audio CD format. Since the Pa1X is equipped with two
sequencers, you can even play two Songs at the
same time, and mix them with the BALANCE
slider.
In addition to the Song tracks, you can play one
to four Keyboard tracks, along with the Song(s).
In the main page, Keyboard tracks are shown in
the right half of the display. You can reach the
main page by pressing EXIT from any of the Song
Play edit pages. If you are in a different operating
mode, press SONG PLAY to recall the Song Play
mode. Use the TRK. SEL. button to cycle between
Keyboard and Song tracks.

Gbl

These are freely assignable sliders (see Controllers: Assignable


Sliders on page 235 for infomation on how to assign functions
to them). Four operating modes are available, and can be
selected by pressing the SLIDER MODE button (see below).
If you keep the SHIFT button pressed, while the Upper,
Style or Song tracks are shown in the display, you can move just
one of the sliders to proportionally change the volume of all similar tracks. Slider Mode must be Volume.

Keep SHIFT pressed and move one of the sliders controlling the volume of one of the Upper tracks, to proportionally change the volume of all Upper tracks at the same time.
This works in Style Play and Song Play mode.

SEQUENCER Sequencer mode, where you can play, record or


edit a Song. The Backing Sequence mode lets you
record a new Song based on the Keyboard and
Style tracks, and save it as a new Standard MIDI
File.
SOUND

Keep SHIFT pressed and move one of the sliders controlling the volume of one of the Style tracks, to proportionally
change the volume of all Style tracks at the same time. This
works in Style Play mode.

Sound mode, to play single Sounds on the keyboard, or edit them. By pressing RECORD you
can enter the Sampling mode, Pa1X full-featured
sampler.

DEMO

Keep SHIFT pressed and move one of the sliders controlling the volume of one of the Song tracks, to proportionally
change the volume of all Song tracks at the same time. This
works in Sequencer mode.

Press the STYLE PLAY and SONG PLAY buttons


together to select the Demo mode. This mode lets
you listen to some Demo Songs, to let you understand the sonic power of the Pa1X.

7 GLOBAL

Use this button to select one of the four available operating


modes for the sliders.

This button recalls the Global edit environment, where you can
adjust various global settings. This edit environment overlaps
any operating mode, that still remains active in the background.
Press EXIT to go back to the underlying operating mode.

VOLUME

8 DISK

5 SLIDER MODE

SB

Each slider controls the volume of the corresponding track in the display.

This button recalls the Disk edit environment, where you can
execute various operations on files and disks (Load, Save, For-

matically selected. The Keyboard tracks and


effects will change, along with the Style tracks
and effects. Pad tracks will change too.

mat, etc). This edit environment overlaps any operating


mode, that still remains active in the background. Press EXIT to
go back to the underlying operating mode.

9 MEMORY

SB

This button turns the Lower and Chord Memory functions on


or off. Go to the Preferences: Style Preferences edit page (Style
Play mode, see page 95) to decide if this button should be a
Chord Memory only, or a Lower/Chord Memory button. When
it works as a Lower/Chord Memory:

Off

When you select a different Style (or the same


again), the Style tracks and effects are changed,
while the Keyboard tracks, and effects are not
changed. Pad tracks will not change as well.

Flashing

Variation/STS Link function activated. This function makes each Variation recall the corresponding STS when selected. For example, select
Variation 2, and STS 2 will be automatically
recalled; select Variation 3, and STS 3 will be
automatically recalled.

Note: This function can be automatically activated by playing


harder the keyboard. See Velocity Control on page 95.
On

Off

The sound on the left of the split point, and the


chord for the automatic accompaniment, are kept
in memory even when you raise your hand from
the keyboard.
The sound and chords are released as soon as you
raise your hand from the keyboard.

0 BASS INVERSION

SB

This button turns the Bass Inversion function on or off.


Note: This function can be automatically activated by playing
harder the keyboard. See Velocity Control on page 95.
On

Off

The lowest note of a chord played in inverted


form will always be detected as the root note of
the chord. Thus, you can specify to the arranger
composite chords such as Am7/G or F/C.
The lowest note is scanned together with the
other chord notes, and is not always considered
as the root note.

A MANUAL BASS

SB

This button turns the Manual Bass function on or off.


Note: When you press the MANUAL BASS button, the Bass track
volume is automatically set to its maximum value. The volume is
automatically set back to the original value when the MANUAL
BASS button is deactivated.
On

Off

D STYLE SELECT section


Use these buttons to open the Style Select window and select a
Style. See Style Select window on page 75.
The leftmost button lets you select the upper or lower row of
Style banks, or the DIRECT HD Style banks (only if the hard
disk is installed). Press it repeatedly to select one of the rows.
(After both LEDs have turned on, press the button again to turn
them off).

Upper LED On

Upper-row Styles selected.

Lower LED On

Lower-row Styles selected.

Both LEDs On

DIRECT HD Styles selected (if any). Direct HD Styles are


accessed by pressing buttons [1-9].

A word about Style banks and names. Styles from 8BEAT/16


BEAT to WORLD 3, and from LATIN1 to TRADITIONAL
are standard Styles, the user cant normally overwrite with a
Load operation (unless you remove the protection; see Factory
Style and Pad Protect on page 272).
DIRECT FD Styles are Styles directly accessed from floppy
disk (no need to load from disk). See The DIRECT FD bank
on page 100.
DIRECT HD Styles are directly accessed from the hard disk, if
installed (again, no need to load from disk). See The DIRECT
HD bank on page 99.

The automatic accompaniment stops playing


(apart for the Drum and Percussion tracks), and
you can manually play the Bass track on the
Lower part of the keyboard. You can start the
automatic accompaniment again by pressing one
of the CHORD SCANNING buttons.

Styles from USER1 to USER3 are location where you can


load new Styles from disk.

The bass track is automatically played by the


Style.

E INTRO 1-3/COUNT IN buttons

B FADE IN/OUT
When the Style is not playing, press this button to start it with a
volume fade-in (the volume goes from zero to the maximum).
When the Style is playing back, press this button to stop it with a
volume fade-out (the volume gradually decreases).
You dont need to press START/STOP to start or stop the Style.

C SINGLE TOUCH
This button turns the Single Touch and Variation/STS Link
functions on or off.
On

When a different Style (or the same again) is


selected, a Single Touch Setting (STS1) is auto-

Each button (Style bank) contains four pages, each with up to


eight Styles. Repeatedly press a bank button to cycle between the
available pages.
Sty

SB

These buttons set the arranger in Intro mode. After pressing one
of these buttons, start the Style, and it will begin with the
selected intro. The INTRO LED automatically goes off at the end
of the intro.
Press them twice (LED blinking) to let them play in loop, and
select any other Style element (Fill, Intro, Variation) to exit the
loop.
Note: Intro 1 plays a short sequence with different chords, while
Intro 2 plays on the last recognized chord. Intro 3 is usually a onebar Count In.

Introduction

Front panel

10

Front panel

F ENDING 1-2 buttons

Sty

SB

While the Style is running, these two buttons trigger an Ending,


and stop the Style. Press one of them, and the Style will stop running with an Ending. If pressed while the Style is stopped, they
act as an additional couple of Intros.
Press them twice (LED blinking) to let them play in loop, and
select any other Style element (Fill, Intro, Variation) to exit the
loop.
Note: Ending 1 plays a short sequence with different chords, while
Ending 2 plays on the last recognized chord.

G VARIATION 1-4 buttons

Sty

Sty

L RECORD
This button sets the instrument to Record or Sampling mode
(depending on the current operating mode).

M TRK.SEL. (TRACK SELECT)


Depending on the operating mode, this button switches between
the various tracks view.
STYLE PLAY MODE
Toggles between Keyboard and Style tracks.

SB

Each of these buttons select one of the four variations of the current Style. Each variation can vary in patterns and sounds.

H FILL 1-3/BREAK buttons

the Panic key combination. Just press SHIFT + START/STOP


to stop all notes and reset all controllers.

SB

SONG PLAY MODE


Toggles between Keyboard tracks, Song tracks 18, and Song tracks 9-16.
SEQUENCER MODE

These buttons trigger a fill-in. Press them twice (LED blinking)


to let them play in loop, and select any other Style element (Fill,
Intro, Variation) to exit the loop.

N SINGLE TOUCH SETTING buttons

Note: Fill 3 is usually a Break.


Note: This function can be automatically activated by playing
harder the keyboard. See Velocity Control on page 95.

I TAP TEMPO/RESET
This is a double-function button, acting in a different way
depending on the Style status (stop/play).
Tap Tempo: When the Style is not playing, you can beat the
tempo on this button. At the end, the accompaniment starts
playing, using the tapped in tempo.
Reset: When you press this button while the Style is playing
back, the Style pattern goes back to the previous strong beat.

J SYNCHRO START / STOP buttons

Toggles between Song tracks 1-8 and Song tracks


9-16.

These buttons allow to select up to four Single Touch Settings.


Each of the Styles and SongBook entries includes a maximum of
four Single Touch Settings (STS), to automatically configure
Keyboard tracks and effects, and the Voice Processor, at the
touch of a finger. When the SINGLE TOUCH LED is lit, an STS
is automatically selected when selecting a Style.

O SHIFT
With this button held down, pressing certain other buttons
accesses to a second function.

P HELP
Press this button to open the context-sensitive Help.

SB

These buttons turn the Synchro Start and Synchro Stop functions on or off.
Start On, Stop Off
In this situation, just play a chord in the chord
recognition area (usually under the split point,
see CHORD SCANNING section on page 11)
to automatically start the Style. If you like, turn
one of the INTROs on before starting the Style.

Q COLOR TOUCHVIEW GRAPHICAL DISPLAY


Use this display to interact with the instrument.

R SEQUENCER 1 TRANSPORT CONTROLS


Pa1X is equipped with two sequencers (Sequencer 1 and
Sequencer 2), each with its own set of transport controls. The
Sequencer 1 group is also used for the Sequencer mode.
<< and >>

Start On, Stop On


When both LEDs are lit, raising your hand from
the keyboard momentarily stops the Style running. If you play a chord again, the Style starts
again.

When pressed once, these buttons move the Song


to the previous or following measure. When kept
pressed, they make the Song scrolling continuously, until you release them.

Start Off, Stop Off

In Jukebox mode (Sequencer 1), keep the


SHIFT button pressed, and press these buttons to
scroll to the previous or next Song in the Jukebox
list (see Jukebox Editor on page 151).

All Synchro functions are turned off.

K START/STOP
Starts or stops the Style running.

When playing back CD tracks, keep the SHIFT


button pressed, and press these buttons to scroll
to the previous or next track.

Note: This function can be automatically activated by playing


harder the keyboard. See Velocity Control on page 95.
You can reset all frozen notes and controllers on the
Pa1X and any instrument connected to its MIDI OUT, by using

Rewind and Fast Forward commands. If you use


them while the Song is in play, they make it scroll
back or forward.

PAUSE

Pauses the Song at the current position. Press


PAUSE or PLAY/STOP to start the Song playing
again.

PLAY/STOP Starts or stops the current Song. When you stop


the Song, the Song Position goes back to measure
1 (i.e., the beginning of the Song).
In Song Play mode, pressed while keeping SHIFT pressed, starts both sequencers at the
same time.

11

make the page menu disappear, without selecting any


item
return to the main page of the current operating mode
exit the Global or Disk edit environment, and return to
the current page of the current operating mode
exit from a Style, Performance or Sound Select window

S BALANCE slider

X MENU

In Song Play mode, this slider balances the volume of the two
on-board sequencers. When fully on the left, only the Sequencer
1 can be heard. When fully on the right, only the Sequencer 2
can be heard. When in the middle, both sequencers play at full
volume.

This button opens the edit menu page for the current operating
mode or edit mode. After opening an edit menu, you can jump
to one of the edit sections by touching the corresponding button
in the display.

T SEQUENCER 2 TRANSPORT CONTROLS


Transport controls for Sequencer 2. See instructions for
Sequencer 1 above.

U TEMPO/VALUE section

Sty

SB

The DIAL and the DOWN/- and UP/+ buttons can be used to
control the Tempo, assign a different value to the selected
parameter in the display, or scroll a list of files in the Song Select
and Disk pages.
DIAL

Turn the dial clockwise to increase the value or


tempo. Turn it counter-clockwise to decrease the
value or tempo.
When used while pressing the SHIFT
button, this control always acts as a Tempo control.

DOWN/- and UP/+


DOWN/- decreases the value or tempo; UP/+
increases the value or tempo.
Press both buttons together to reset the Tempo to
the value memorized in the selected Style.

Otherwise, press EXIT to return to the main page of the current


operating mode, or the current page of the underlying operating
mode.
See the relevant chapter devoted to each operating mode or edit
environment, to see their maps in detail.

Y TEMPO LOCK
This button turns the Tempo Lock function on or off.
On

When you select a different Style or Performance,


the tempo does not change. You can still manually change it, by using the DIAL.

Off

When you select a different Style or Performance,


the memorized tempo is automatically selected.

Z DISPLAY HOLD
This button turns the Display Hold function on or off.
On

When you open a temporary windows (like the


Sound Select window), it remains in the display
until you press EXIT or an operating mode button.

Off

Any temporary window closes after a certain


time, or after selecting an item in the window.

V AUDIO IN LED

[ SONGBOOK

This LED shows the level of the audio signal entering the INPUT
connectors. Three different colors show the level.

Press this button to recall the SongBook mode. While in this


mode, you can browse through the music database.

Off

No signal entering.

Green

Low- to mid-level signal entering. If the LED


turns off too often, the input gain is too low. Use
the GAIN controls and/or the source devices volume to raise the input level.

Orange

Optimum level. Try to keep the gain at this level.

Red

Clipping is occurring at the input stage. This is


fine if the LED goes to red only occasionally during a signal peak. If it turns red too often, the
input level is too high, and you should reduce it
by using the GAIN controls and/or the source
devices volume control.

See page 15 for more information on the INPUTs and volume


control.

You can jump to the SongBook > Custom List page by


keeping SHIFT pressed, and pressing the SONGBOOK button.

\ ENSEMBLE

This button turns the Ensemble function on or off. When on,


the right-hand melody is harmonized with the left-hand chords.
Note: The Ensemble function works only when the keyboard is in
SPLIT mode, and the LOWER Chord Scanning mode selected.

] CHORD SCANNING section

exit the edit menu page, without selecting any item

SB

In Style Play and Sequencer-Backing Sequence mode, use these


buttons to define the way chords are recognized by the arranger.
LOWER

Chords are detected below the split point. The


number of notes you should play to form a chord
is defined by the Chord Scanning Mode parameter (see Chord Recognition Mode on page 95).

UPPER

Chords are detected above the split point. You


must always play three or more notes to let the
arranger recognize a chord.

W EXIT
Use this button to perform various actions, leaving from the current status:

SB

Introduction

Front panel

12

Front panel

FULL (both LEDs On)


Chords are detected on the full keyboard range.
You must always play three or more notes to let
the arranger recognize a chord. (You can use this
mode even when the Split Keyboard Mode is
selected).
OFF

No chords detected. After pressing START/STOP,


only the Drum and Percussion accompaniment
tracks can play.

` KEYBOARD MODE section

SB

These buttons define how the four Keyboard tracks are positioned on the keyboard.
SPLIT

The Lower track plays below the split point, while


the Upper 1, Upper 2 and Upper 3 tracks play
above it. By default, selecting this keyboard mode
automatically selects the Lower chord scanning
mode (see Chord Recognition Mode on
page 95).

FULL UPPER
The Upper 1, Upper 2 and/or Upper 3 tracks play
on the whole keyboard range. The Lower track
does not play. By default, selecting this keyboard
mode automatically selects the Full chord scanning mode (see Chord Recognition Mode on
page 95).

a STYLE CHANGE
This button turns the Style Change function on or off.
On

Off

When you select a Performance, the Style could


change, according to which Style number is
memorized onto the Performance.
When you select a Performance, the Style and
Style track settings remain unchanged. Only Keyboard track settings are changed.

b PERFORMANCE SELECT
Press this button to use the SOUND/PERFORMANCE SELECT
section to select a Performance.

c SOUND SELECT
Press this button to use the SOUND/PERFORMANCE SELECT
section to select a Sound, and assign it to the selected track.

d SOUND/PERFORMANCE SELECT section


Sty

SB

SB

Use these buttons to open the Sound Select or Performance


Select window, and select a Sound or a Performance. See Sound
Select window on page 74, or Performance Select window on
page 74. For a list of available Sounds, see Sounds on page 291.
The leftmost button selects the upper or lower row of Sound or
Performance banks. Press it repeatedly to select one of the rows.

Upper LED On

Upper row of Sounds or Performances selected.

Lower LED On

Lower row of Sounds or Performances selected.

Both LEDs On

Additional EXB cards Sounds or Performances


selected.

On the front panel, Sound banks are identified by the instrument names, while Performance banks are identified by numbers (1-10; 0=bank 10).
A note about Sound banks and names. Sounds from PIANO
to SFX are standard Sounds, the user cant directly modify.
Sounds USER1 and USER2 are locations where you can load
new Sounds from disk.
USER DK is where you can load new Drum Kits.
Each Sound bank contains various pages, each with up to eight
Sounds. Repeatedly press a bank button to cycle between the
available pages.

e ASSIGNABLE SWITCH (1-4)

SB

You can assign any function to these switches. See Pad/Switch:


Assignable Switch on page 94 for more information.

f PAD (1-4, STOP)

SB

Each Pad corresponds to a dedicated Pad track. Use these buttons to trigger up to four sounds or sequences at the same time.

Press a single PAD button to trigger a single sound or


sequence.

Press more PAD buttons to trigger several sounds or


sequences.

The sequences will play up to the end. Then, they will stop or
continue repeating, depending on their One Shot/Loop status
(see Pad Type on page 133).
You can stop all sequences, or just some of them, by pressing the
STOP button of the PAD section:

Press STOP to stop all sequences at once.

Keep STOP pressed and press one (or more) of the PAD
buttons to stop the corresponding sequence(s).

Note: Pads share polyphony voices with the other tracks, so avoid
using too many of them together with a dense Style or Song
arrangement.
About Pad synchronization. In Style Play mode, Pads are syncd
to the Styles tempo. In Song Play mode, they are syncd to the
last Sequencer you set to play. For example, assume you pressed
SEQ2-PLAY; when pressing one of the PAD buttons, it will play
in sync with Sequencer 2.
Note: There is no synchronization with MP3 files and Audio CD
Tracks. Pads can only be synchronized to Standard MIDI Files.
Therefore, when an MP3 file or Audio CD Track is assigned to the
last select Sequencer, Pads will synchronize to the last Standard
MIDI File that has been played back.
About Pads and the Sequencers Play command. When you
press one of the PLAY buttons to start the corresponding
Sequencer, all Pads will stop playing.

g TRANSPOSE

Sty

SB

These buttons transpose the whole instrument in semitone steps


(Master Transpose). The transposition value is usually shown on
the page header in the display.

Press both buttons together, to reset the Master Transpose to


zero.

Note: The Master Transpose has no effect on tracks set to Drum


mode (and, even if set in a different status, on the Drum and Percussion tracks). See Track Controls: Mode on page 88, and
Track Controls: Mode on page 150.

Lowers the Master Transpose a semitone.

Raises the Master Transpose a semitone.

h OCTAVE

SB

These buttons transpose the selected track in steps of a whole


octave (12 semitones; max 2 octaves). The octave transposition
value is always shown (in octaves) next to a tracks name.

Press both buttons together, to reset the Octave Transpose to


zero.
Note: The Octave Transpose has no effect on tracks set to Drum
mode (and, even if set in a different status, on the Drum and Percussion tracks).

Lowers the selected track an octave.

Raises the selected track an octave.

13

Introduction

Front panel

14

Rear panel

Rear panel

12

3 4 5 6

9 0

12

3 4 5 6

9 0

Rear panel

AC CABLE CONNECTOR

Plug the supplied AC cable into this connector.

POWER switch

Use this switch to turn the instrument on or off.

VIDEO OUT (optional)

If an optional VIF3 video interface is fitted, you can connect the


Pa1X to a TV or video monitor. The RCA connector is already
included with the instrument, even if the video interface is not
installed. See Installing the Video Interface (VIF3) on page 403
for more information.

LCD CONTRAST

Use this knob to adjust the display contrast.

DIGITAL OUTPUT

Use this 48 kHz S/PDIF output to connect the Pa1X to the S/


PDIF input connector of another digital device, like a digital
mixer, audio card, DAT or stand-alone CD recorder. The same
signal output from the LEFT/MONO & RIGHT connectors is
sent by this connector. See S/PDIF On/Off on page 241 for
more information.

ASSIGN. PEDAL

Use this port to connect a continuous- or footswitch-type pedal,


like the Korg EXP2 or XVP10. To program it, see Pedal/Footswitch on page 235.

DAMPER PEDAL

Use this to connect a Damper pedal, like the Korg PS1, PS or


DS1H. To change its polarity, see Damper Polarity on
page 235.

OUTPUT

Use these unbalanced connectors to send the audio signal


(sound) to a mixer, a PA system, a set of powered monitors, or
your hi-fi system.
To set the output for each track, or the routing for the audio
inputs, see the Audio Output section, starting from page 239.
LEFT/MONO, RIGHT
These are the main stereo outputs. Use them to
send the final stereo mix to an external device. Set
the output level with the MASTER VOLUME
slider.
1, 2

These are the sub outputs. Use them to create a


stereo sub-mix of just some tracks, or to output
just a single instrument to be mixed alone, or to
be processed or amplified externally.

USB

This is a USB Type B (slave) connector. Use it to connect the


Pa1X to a personal computer, and transfer data to/from its hard
disk. See Hard Disk USB Connection on page 273 for more
information.

MIDI INTERFACE

The MIDI interface allows your Pa1X to be connected to external


controllers (master keyboard, MIDI guitar, wind controller,
MIDI accordion), to a series of expanders, or to a computer
running a sequencer or an editor. Two sets of IN and OUT connectors are provided. For more information on how to use the
MIDI interface, see the MIDI chapter.
IN A/B

OUT A/B

These connectors receive MIDI data from a computer or a controller. Connect them to an external controllers or computers MIDI OUT.
These connectors usually work as MIDI OUTs,
but can be configured as MIDI THRU connectors. See MIDI A Out/Thru Mode and MIDI B
Out/Thru Mode on page 237 for information on
how to change their settings.
When set to OUT, these connectors send MIDI
data generated by Pa1Xs keyboard, controllers,
and/or the internal sequencer. Connect them to
an expanders or computers MIDI IN.
When set to THRU, these connectors send an
exact copy of the data received on the IN connector of the same group (A or B). Use them to cascade the Pa1X with other MIDI instruments.

EC5 MULTISWITCH

This connects to a Korg EC5 multiswitch, to control many functions in realtime. To program the EC5, see EC5-AE on
page 236.

Note: The MASTER VOLUME slider has no effect


on these outputs. Signal is sent dry, with no effects
applied.

INPUT

Use these connectors to input a dynamic microphone, another


keyboard/synthesizer or a CD player.
1, 2

Only active when the 1/MIC switch is set to 1. Use


these unbalanced connectors to connect a linelevel input source, such as a CD player or a synthesizer. The signal goes directly to the final mix.

1/MIC

Use this switch to select the input. When 1 is


selected, both line inputs 1 & 2 are active. When
MIC is selected, only the microphone input is
active, and sent to the Voice Processor. See Audio
Output: Audio In on page 240 for more information.

GAIN

Use this controls to adjust the input sensitivity of


the MIC connector (from 20 to 55dB).

MIC

Only active when the 1/MIC switch is set to MIC.


Use this balanced connector to input a dynamic
microphone, and send the signal to the Voice
Processor. To connect a condenser microphone,
you need an external phantom power supply
(refer to your microphone users manual). The
input signal is sent to the Voice Processor.
Use the GAIN knob to adjust the input gain, and
see the input level by watching at the AUDIO IN
LED on the control panel.

Introduction

15

16

Welcome!
Live Performing

Welcome!
Welcome to the world of Korg Pa1X and Korg Pa1X Pro Professional Arranger! Pa1X is the most powerful arranger available
today, both for professional and home entertainment use.

Pa1X Pro only: Included hard disk, with preloaded Real


Drums and Turkish/Arabic World sets.

Here are some of the features of your new instrument:

RX Technology, the cutting edge engine that drives every


aspect of the Pa1X from the synthesis to the display and
how it all works together.

Powerful HI (Hyper Integrated) Korg sound generation


system, as seen in our best professional synthesizers.

OPOS (Objective Portable Operating System) multitasking


operating system, to let you load data while playing your
instrument.

Operating System updates, to load new features from disk.


Dont let your instrument get old!

Optional hardware expansions, to add a video out, more


RAM, a CD Player/Writer, up to two sound ROMs, an
hardware MP3 encoder/decoder, an internal hard disk
(standard on the Pa1X Pro). Get more and more for the
money!

Solid State Disk (SSD), for any system update a smart way
to replace the usual ROM memory.

Direct Style access from floppy disk and hard disk.

General MIDI Level 2 Sound-compatible.

More than 870 Sounds, including more than 47 Drum Kits.

Four multieffect processor for internal tracks, each with 89


effect types plus a Vocoder available for FX D).

320 Performance locations, and more than 1,800 preloaded


Single Touch Settings (STS), for fast setting of keyboard
sounds and effects.

More than 450 preloaded Styles.

Style Record and Edit

XDS Double Sequencer with Crossfader.

Full-featured 16-track sequencer

Fully editable music database, for fast song retrieving, supplied by the SongBook

Onboard sampling to create and edit new sounds and


audio grooves

Sophisticated Voice Processor, with effects and a 4-voice


harmonizer, featuring voice technologies by TC-Helicon.

High-quality microphone preamplifier, with 20 ~ 55dB of


gain.

High-quality input (ADC) and output (DAC) audio converters.

Color TouchView Graphical User Interface.

Eight fully-programmable sliders, to be used also as organ


drawbars

Pa1X only: Digital bi-amplification with Auto Loudness


and 4-way Bass Reflex system, for realistic sound reproduction.

Live Performing
Pa1X has been carefully designed to be used live. The realtime
word has its full meaning in this instrument. Performances
allow the instant selection of all the tracks on the keyboard and a
suitable Style; STSs allow an instant selection of the keyboard
tracks; Styles are the realtime backing companions for your realtime playing; the SongBook is the quick way to select a song
from a sophisticated music database.

Useful links
Your preferred Korg dealer not only carries this keyboard, but
also a whole bunch of hardware and software accessories. You
should ask him for more Sounds, Styles, and other useful music
materials.
Each Korg distributor can give you useful information. Just give
them a call for additional services. In the English-speaking
world, here are the relevant addresses:
USA

KORG USA, 316 South Service Road, Melville,


New York, 11747, USA
Tel:1-516-333-9100, Fax:1-516-333-9108

Canada

Jam Industries, 620 McCaffrey, St-Laurent, QC,


Canada, H4T 1N1
Tel. (514) 738-3000, Fax (514) 737-5069

UK

KORG UK Ltd, 9 Newmarket Court, Kingston,


Milton Keynes, Buckinghamshire, MK10, 0AU
Tel.: 01908 857100
UK Technical Support Tel: 01908 857122, Fax:
01908 857199
E-mail: [email protected]

Many Korg distributors also have their own web page on the
internet, where you can find infos and software. Useful web
pages in English are the following:
www.korg.com
www.korg.co.uk
www.jam-industries.com
A place to find operating system updates and various system files (for
example, a full backup of the factory data) is at the following link:
www.korgpa.com
Other useful information can be found worldwide by accessing
to other Korg web sites, like the following:
www.korg.co.jp
www.korgfr.net

Welcome!
Whats in the box

17

www.korg.it

Making a backup copy of system files

www.letusa.es

Whats in the box

A backup of all data is already supplied with the hard disk


installed on the Pa1X Pro. In case you modify some data, you
can make a new backup, to preserve your data from being accidentally lost.

After you buy your Pa1X, please check all the following items are
included in the package. if some of them are missing, immediately contact your Korg dealer.

If you own a standard Pa1X, not fitted with a hard disk right at
the factory, we suggest you make a backup copy of all data,
including Sounds, Performances and Styles, to a set of floppy
disks, in case the internal data is changed.

Pa1X or Pa1X Pro

Music stand

Power cable

Owners Manual

CD assembling kit, including screws

Pa1X only: HD mounting kit, including two mounting


brackets and eight M3x6 screws.

About this manual


This manual is divided in four sections:

To backup the Operating System, please see Save OS to Floppy


Disk on page 271.
To backup the Factory Data (Styles, Programs), see Backup
Resources on page 271.

Loading the operating system


Your Pa1X can be constantly updated as new versions of the
operating system are released by Korg. You can download the
operating system from www.korgpa.com. Please, read the
instructions supplied with the operating system on the site.
You can see which version of the operating systems is installed in
your Pa1X by going to the Utility page of the Disk mode (see
OS Version Number on page 272).

An Introduction, containing an overview of the instrument and of basic operations.

A Quick Guide, containing a series of practical guides.

A Reference Guide, with each page and parameter


described in detail.

Reloading the Factory Data

An Appendix, with a list of data and useful information for


the advanced user.

Should you need the original Factory Data, a copy of them is


already supplied with the hard disk (on the Pa1X Pro). On the
Pa1X, you can create a set of backup disks (see Backup
Resources on page 271).

Within the manual, you will find the following abbreviations:


The parameter can be saved to a Performance by
selecting the Write Performance command from
the page menu.
Sty

The parameter can be saved to the current Style


Performance by selecting the Write Style Performance command from the page menu.
The parameter can be saved to one of the Single
Touch Settings of the current Style, by selecting
the Write STS command from the page menu.

SB

The parameter can be saved to one of the Single


Touch Settings of a SongBook entry, by checking
the Write STS option in the Book Edit page of the
SongBook mode.
The parameter can be saved to the Global, by
selecting one of the available Write Global commands from the page menu. Several Global areas
are available, and a smaller symbol after the GBL
abbreviation will appear for each relevant parameter. More information is given in each Reference
chapter.

To restore data, see Restore Resources on page 271.

Introduction

www.korg.de

18

Start up
Connecting the AC power cord

Start up
Connecting the AC power cord
Connect the supplied power cord
to the dedicated socket on the
rear of the instrument. Then,
plug it into a wall socket. You
dont need to worry about the
local voltage, since the Pa1X uses
a universal power adapter.

Turning the instrument on and off

Press the POWER switch on the rear panel to turn the


instrument on. The display will light up, showing the boot
procedure.
Note: When turning the instrument on, RAM PCM Samples
used by some User Sounds may be automatically loaded,
depending on the status of the PCM Autoload parameter
(see page 273). This may take some time for loading.

Press again the POWER switch on the rear panel to turn the
instrument off.
Warning: When turning the instrument off, all data contained in RAM (Song recorded or edited in Sequencer mode,
Samples in edit and not yet saved) will be lost. MIDI Grooves
generated by the Time Slice function will be lost, too.
On the contrary, data contained in the SSD memory (Factory
data, User Sounds, Performances, Styles and Multisamples)
will be preserved. Samples will be preserved, too.

Controlling the Volume (Master&Acc/Seq)

Use the MASTER VOLUME slider to


control the overall volume of the
instrument. This slider controls the
volume of the sound going to the
internal speakers (Pa1X only), the
main (LEFT/MONO & RIGHT )
OUTPUTs, and the HEADPHONES
connector.
The 1 & 2 OUTPUT connectors are
not affected by this slider. So, use the mixers or speakers
level controls to adjust the volume.
Note: Begin with a moderate level, then raise the MASTER
VOLUME up. Dont keep the volume at an uncomfortable
level for too long.

Use the ACC/SEQ VOLUME slider to control the volume of


Style tracks (drums, percussions, bass). This slider also
controls both Sequencers tracks, leaving Keyboard tracks
untouched.

The BALANCE slider


The BALANCE slider sets the relative volume of the two
onboard sequencers (Sequencer1 and Sequencer 2).

Move it fully left to set Sequencer 1 to the maximum level


and Sequencer 2 to zero.

Move it fully right to set Sequencer 1 to zero and Sequencer


2 to the maximum level.

Move it to the center to set both Sequencer at the same


level.

Note: When turning the instrument on, move this slider to the center, to avoid starting a Song at the minimum level.

Headphones
Connect a pair of headphones to the HEADPHONES output,
under the left part of the keyboard (just under the joystick). You
can use headphones with an impedance of 16-200 (50 suggested). Use a headphone amplification distributor to connect
more than one pair of headphones.

Audio Outputs
Audio outputs allows you to connect the Pa1X to an external
amplification system. Apart for headphones, this is the only way
to listen to the sound of the Pa1X Pro, since it is not fitted with
internal speakers.
Stereo. Connect two mono cables to the main (LEFT/MONO,
RIGHT) OUTPUTs. Connect the other end of the cables to a stereo channel of your mixer, two mono channels, two powered
monitors, or the TAPE/AUX input of your audio system. Dont
use the PHONO inputs of your audio system!
Mono. Connect a mono cable to the LEFT/MONO OUTPUT.
Connect the other end of the cable to a mono channel of your
mixer, a powered monitor, or a channel of your TAPE/AUX
input of a hi-fi system (you will hear that channel only, unless
you can set the amplifier to Mono mode).
Separate outputs. You can connect your Pa1X to four channels
of a mixer. This is very useful when recording, or if you want to
send a sequencers or backing track to a separate channel. For
example, by using the separate outputs, you may send the Drum
or Bass track to an external compressor or reverb unit, or mix
the separate tracks on an external mixer.
Connect four mono cables to each of the main (LEFT/MONO,
RIGHT) and 1, 2 OUTPUTs. To feed the sub-outputs (1, 2) you
must program the track(s) you wish to send them (see the
Audio Output section in the Global, starting from page 239).

Note: When a track is sent to the OUTPUT 1 or 2, it is removed


from the main mix going to the internal speakers and the LEFT/
MONO & RIGHT OUTPUTS.
Note: OUTPUTs 1 & 2 are not effected.

19

Damper Pedal

Adjust the volume of the LEFT/MONO & RIGHT OUTPUTs


with the MASTER VOLUME slider. Adjust the volume of the 1 &
2 OUTPUTs with the mixers or external speakers level controls.

Connect a Damper (Sustain) pedal to the DAMPER connector


on the back panel. Use a Korg PS1, PS2 or DS1H footswitch
pedal, or a compatible one. To switch the Damper polarity, see
Damper Polarity on page 235

Audio Inputs

Demo

Connect your microphone, guitar, or any other musical instrument, to the INPUTs on the back of the instrument. The microphone signal may also be sent to the Voice Processor for
sophisticate processing.

Listen to the built-in Demo Songs to appreciate the power of the


Pa1X. There are several Demo Songs to choose from.

Depending on the connected device(s), you must choose a suitable signal routing, by using the 1/MIC switch in the INPUT section. Select the MIC position to connect a microphone to the
MIC input, or the 1 position to connect a mono or stereo linelevel source (like a synthesizer or an external CD player) to the 1
& 2 INPUTs.

At this point, if you dont press any other button, all the Demo
Songs will be played back.

See the Singing with a connected microphone chapter on


page 64, and the Audio Output: Audio In section on page 240,
for more information on connecting and setting the inputs and
the audio source.

1.

Press the STYLE PLAY and SONG PLAY buttons together.


Their LEDs start blinking.

2.

Select one of the available options, to listen to a specified


Demo Song.

3.

Stop the Demo by pressing the STOP button on the display,


or by exiting the Demo mode by pressing any MODE button.

The music stand


MIDI connections
You can play the internal sounds of your Pa1X with an external
controller, i.e. a master keyboard, a MIDI guitar, a wind controller, a MIDI accordion, or a digital piano.
You can also control other MIDI devices with the Pa1X, or connect it to a computer for use with an external sequencer.
See the MIDI chapter for more information on MIDI connections.

A music stand comes standard with your Pa1X. Insert its legs
into the two dedicated holes on the rear panel.

Introduction

Start up
Audio Inputs

20

Glossary of Terms
Sound

Glossary of Terms
Before you begin, take a few moments to familiarize yourself
with the names and terms we will be using to talk about the various elements of the Pa1X.
In this section, you will find a brief description of various key
elements of the Pa1X. A professional arranger (Pa) keyboard
uses different terminology than a traditional synthesizer or
workstation. By familiarizing yourself with the names and functions in this section, you will get a better understanding of how
all the different parts of the Pa1X work together to create a realistic musical performance. This will also help you to get the most
out of the rest of the Users Manual.

Sound
A Sound is the most basic unit of an Arranger Keyboard performance. A Sound is basically a playable instrument timbre
(piano, bass, sax, guitar) that can be edited, saved, recalled
and assigned to any track. An individual Sound can be played on
the keyboard in the Sound mode. In the Style Play mode or
Sequencer mode, Sounds may be freely assigned to Sequencer
tracks, Style tracks, or Keyboard tracks.

Style
The Style is the heart of a professional arranger keyboard. At its
basic level, a Style will consist of up to eight parts, or Tracks.

Drums
The Drum track will provide a repeating rhythmic phrase,
played by the standard instruments of a Drum Kit.

Percussion

Variation
For each Style, there are four Variations. In general, each Variation is a slightly different version of the others. As you progress
from Variation one to Variation four, the arrangements will
become more complex, and more parts (Tracks) may be added.
This allows your performance to have a more dynamic arrangement, without losing the original feel of the Style.

Fill-in
During a performance, a drummer may often perform a fill such as when transitioning from a verse to a chorus adding
extra dynamics and keeping the beat from getting too repetitive.
The Pa1X offers three Fill-ins specifically programmed for each
Style. A Fill-in may be drums alone, drums with instrumentation, of even a silent break.

Intro & Ending


Each Style also allows you to embellish your performance with a
set of musical introductions and endings. A long and short version of the Intro and Ending are usually provided, with the
former more harmonically elaborated, and the latter with a fixed
chord. A count-in style Intro is also provided.

Keyboard tracks
In addition to the Style tracks, up to four additional parts can be
played on the keyboard in real-time. Each of these Keyboard
tracks can be limited to a particular range of keys or velocities,
but in general three can be assigned to play above the split point
(Upper), and one below (Lower). This allows the Upper Sounds
to be layered together. The split point can be set to any note on
the keyboard. In addition to performing along with a Style, these
same Keyboard tracks will allow you to play along with the
Sequencer.

An additional rhythmic phrase played by various percussion


instruments (conga, shaker, cowbell, etc.) is provided by the Percussion track.

STS (Single Touch Settings)

The Drum and Percussion tracks will play the same phrase
repeatedly, regardless of the notes and chords being played on
the keyboard, although it is possible to assign a different Drum
Kit to either part, or to edit the Kit itself.

Single Touch Settings allow you to instantly change the sounds


assigned to each of the Keyboard tracks with a single button
press, allowing for wide variation in sounds during a performance. Four STS (Single Touch Settings) can be saved with each
Style or SongBook entry.

Bass & Accompaniment


The Bass track and the (up to) five additional Style tracks will
each play musical phrases that are musically related to and in
sync with the Drum and Percussion tracks. However, the notes
being played by these tracks will change to follow the chord progression that you play on the keyboard.
Again, any Sound you choose may be assigned to any track in a
Style.

Ensemble
By turning the Ensemble feature on, a single note played on one
of the Keyboard tracks will be embellished by additional notes to
create a complete chord voicing. The Ensemble knows which
notes to add by looking at the chord that the Style is playing. In
addition, the Ensemble parameters allow you to select the type
of voicing that will be added from a simple one-note harmony
to a full Brass section even a marimba-style trill!

Performance

21

mances, etc...) intact when the power is off. The SSD also allows
for easy updating of the operating system via the floppy drive.

Performance
The Performance is the most encompassing setting on the Pa1X
a single setting that can remember a Style (with all the appropriate sounds), the Keyboard tracks (with all the appropriate
sounds) and all their Single Touch Settings, Tempo, transposition, etc A Performance can be stored in one of the Performance Banks, or it can be saved in a database format using the
SongBook function.

Sequencer
The Sequencer acts as a recorder, so you can capture and playback your performances. The Pa1X sequencer can function in
different modes. In the Backing Sequence mode, each Style element and each Real-Time (Keyboard and Pads) element can be
recorded on a separate track in a single pass. This can be a big
help in getting a song recorded quickly. The sequencer can also
behave as a traditional 16-track linear sequencer, where each
track is recorded individually one at a time.

The LOGO decoder


On the front panel of your Pa1X you have probably noticed
seven logos, and may have even wondered what they stand for.
Well, here is a quick explanation of each one.

The SongBook provides a database that


allows you to instantly recall all the settings
(Style, Performance, Sounds, Tempo, etc)
required to perform a particular song. The
SongBook comes with a number of entries,
but you are free to edit and remove any entry, as well as add any
of your own. The main advantage of the SongBook is that it
allows you to search for a song using title, composer, musical
genre, etc

RX Technology is the cutting edge engine


that drives every aspect of the Pa1X from
the synthesis to the display and how it all
works together.

A variety of professional
vocal effects are provided by
the Pa1X including reverb,
delay, compression, and even four-part vocal harmonies! Pitch
correction and vocal modeling are available as optional
upgrades. All of the vocal effects are provided by TC Helicon, the
leader in vocal processing technology.

The Solid State Disk (SSD) is protected digital


memory that keeps the operating system and
all the Pa1X resources (Sounds, Styles, Perfor-

X-fade Dual Sequencer. Thats right! The


Pa1X actually features TWO sequencers. A
DJ-style Cross-fader (X-fader) allows you
to perform seamless transitions from one song to another, or to
pause one song, switch to another, and then come back and finish the original. Mighty nice for live performances!

Object Portable Operating System allows the


Pa1X to perform multi-tasking capabilities, such
as loading a file from floppy into one of the
sequencers as the other sequencer continues to
play.

General MIDI (GM) is a standard that ensures


the compatibility of sounds and messages
between GM compatible instruments available
from different manufacturers. For example,
sequenced songs created on any GM equipped product and
saved in the GM format will playback correctly on the Pa1X.

Introduction

Glossary of Terms

22

Interface basics
The Color TouchView graphical user interface

Interface basics
The Color TouchView graphical user
interface

Dialog boxes
Similar to selecting windows, dialog boxes overlap the underlaying page. Press one of the button on the display to give Pa1X an
answer, and the dialog box will close.

Pa1X features an easy-to-use graphical user interface, based on


Korgs patented Color TouchView interface. Here are the basic
elements of the users interface.

Pages
Parameters are grouped into separate pages, to be selected by
touching the corresponding tabs on the lower part of the display.

Page menus
Press the icon on the upper right corner of each page, and a
menu with suitable commands for the current page will appear.
Touch one of the available commands to select it. (Or, press anywhere else on the screen to make it disappear, with no command
selected).

Menus and sections


Pages are grouped in sections, to be selected by touching the corresponding buttons in the Edit menu that opens up when you
press the MENU button.

Pop-up menus
When an arrow appears next to a parameter name, press it to
open a pop-up menu. Select any of the available options (or anywhere else on the screen to make the menu disappear).

Overlapping windows
When you press a Sound, Style, or Song name, a selecting window overlaps the current page. After you select an item in the
window, or press the EXIT button, the window closes, and the
underlying page is shown again.

Checkboxes
This kind of parameters are on/off switches. Press them to
change their status.

Operative modes

Numeric fields
When a numeric value is underlined, press it a second time to
open the Numeric Keypad.

23

Operative modes
Pa1X pages are divided into various operating modes. Each
mode is accessed by pressing the corresponding button in the
MODE section on the control panel.
Each operating mode is marked with a different color code, that
helps you understand at first sight where you are.
Three special modes (Global, Disk, and SongBook) overlap the
current operating mode, that remains active in the background.
The SongBook mode can recall the Style Play or Song Play
modes.

Selected, highlighted items

Alphabetic fields
When a textual option is underlined, press it a second time to
open a list of options.

Editable names

Any operation carried on on parameters, data or list entries, is


executed on highlighted items. First select the parameter or item,
then execute the operation.

When the
(Text Edit) button appears next to a name, press
it to open the Text Edit window and edit the name.

Non-available, grayed-out parameters


When a parameter or command is not currently available, it is
shown in grey on the display. This means it cannot be selected,
but may become available when a different option is selected, or
you switch to a different page.

Lists and scrollbars


Files on disk, as well as other kinds of data, are shown as lists.
Use the scrollbar to scroll the list content.

Scrollbar

List

Icons
Various icons help identifying the type of a file, a Song, a folder.

Introduction

Interface basics

24

Interface basics
Non-available, grayed-out parameters

Quick Guide

26

Turning the instrument on and listening to the demos


Turning the instrument on, and viewing the main screen

Turning the instrument on and listening to the demos


First of all, turn the instrument on and familiarize yourself with the main screen. You can also listen
to the demos.
Demo buttons

Display

Power switch

Turning the instrument on, and viewing the main screen


Turn the Pa1X on by pressing the POWER button, located on the back panel.
After you turn the POWER on, a welcome screen is shown for a few seconds, and then the main display appears.
Recognized chord
Tempo and beat counter

Style name

Style Element
measure number

Page menu
Sounds assigned to the
Upper Keyboard tracks
Upper Keyboard tracks status

Style bank

Sound name

Style meter

Sound bank

Selected Performance or STS

Sound assigned to the Lower


Keyboard track

Songs assigned to Sequencer 1


and Sequencer 2

Lower Keyboard track status

Volume sliders. They can be controlled using the Assignable Sliders on the control panel
(provided the VOLUME LED is
turned on)

Play/Mute status

Tabs

Playing the demos


A variety of demo songs have been included to demonstrate the sonic power of the Pa1X.

To open the Demo page, press the STYLE PLAY and SONG PLAY buttons at
the same time.

Follow the instructions in the display. Thats it!

Playing Sounds
Selecting a Sound and playing it on the keyboard

27

Playing Sounds
You can play up to three sounds at the same time on the keyboard. You can also split the keyboard
into two parts, to play up to three sounds with your right hand (Upper), and one with your left hand
(Lower).
Keyboard mode (split/full) select
buttons

Selecting a Sound and playing it on the keyboard


1

Be sure the Upper 1 track is selected and set to play.

A selected track is shown with a


white background. In this example,
the Upper 1 track is selected. If it is
not selected, press it once to select
it.

The status icon shows


that the Upper 1 track
is set to play. If it is
muted, press the status icon to set it to play.

If you want to play the Sound on the whole keyboard, be sure the keyboard is in Full Upper mode. If it is split in two par ts, press the FULL
UPPER button in the KEYBOARD MODE section on the control panel.

(Full) Upper

i Note: Be sure tracks


Upper 2 and Upper 3 are
muted, and are not playing. If you hear more
than one sound, see
page 29 for how to mute
tracks.

Quick Guide

Sound Select section

28
3

Playing Sounds
Selecting a Sound and playing it on the keyboard

Press the Upper 1 tracks area in the display, to open the Sound Select
window.

The triangle means


you can touch this
name to open a
Select window

Sound bank

Sounds name

The currently selected Sound


also appears on the page
header.

Target track for the


selected Sound

i Note: You can also


open the Sound Select
window by pressing one
of the buttons in the
PERFORMANCE/SOUND
SELECT section provided the LED on the
SOUND SELECT button is
on. This will let you jump
directly to the desired
Sound bank.

The selected Sound is highlighted. Press a Sounds name to


select it.

Press one of the side tabs to


select a different Sound bank.

Press one of the lower tabs to


select a different Sound page.

A Previous and Next Page pair of


button may appear in this area,
when more than four pages are
available.

Select a Sound from the Sound Select window.

The Sound Select window closes,


and the main screen appears
again, with the selected Sound
assigned to the Upper 1 track.

Play the Sound on the keyboard.

i Note: You
can leave the
Sound Select
window open
in the display, even after
selecting a Sound. Just
press the DISPLAY HOLD
button to turn its LED
on.

Playing Sounds
Playing two or three Sounds at the same time

29

Playing two or three Sounds at the same time


You can layer all three Upper tracks and play them on the keyboard.
Please note how the M
(Mute) icon appears in the
Upper 2 and Upper 3 status
boxes. These tracks will not
be heard.

Press the
(Mute) icon in the Upper 2 status box, to set the Upper 2
track to play.

Play the keyboard.

Quick Guide

Note how the Dark Pad sound (assigned to the Upper 2 track) has been
layered with the Grand Piano (assigned to the Upper 1 track).

Press the
(Mute) icon in the Upper 3 status box, to set the Upper 3
track to play.

Play the keyboard.


Note how the StringEns2 sound (assigned to the Upper 3 track) has
been added to the Dark Pad (assigned to the Upper 2 track) and the
Grand Piano (assigned to the Upper 1 track).

30

Playing Sounds
Playing two or three Sounds at the same time

Press the
track again.

Play the keyboard.

(Play) icon in the Upper 3 status box, to mute the Upper 3

Note how the StringEns2 sound (assigned to the Upper 3 track) has
been muted again. Only tracks Upper 1 and Upper 2 can be heard at this
time.

Press the
track again.

Play the keyboard.

(Play) icon in the Upper 2 status box, to mute the Upper 2

Note how the Dark Pad sound (assigned to the Upper 2 track) has been
muted again. Only track Upper 1 can be heard at this time.

Playing Sounds
Playing different Sounds with your left and your right hand

31

Playing different Sounds with your left and your right hand
You can play a single Sound with your left hand, in addition to playing up to three Sounds with your
right hand.
Press the SPLIT button in the KEYBOARD MODE section on the contr ol
panel, to split the keyboard into Lower (left hand) and Upper (right hand)
parts.

Upper

Lower

Quick Guide

Be sure the Lower track is set to play.


If the Lower track is muted, press
its icon status, and the play status
icon will appear.

Play the keyboard.


Note how the keyboard is split into two parts, each playing different sounds.

Lower

Upper

Return to the full keyboard playing mode by pressing the FULL UPPER
button in the KEYBOARD MODE section on the control panel.

(Full) Upper

i Hint: You can select a


different Sound for the
Lower part, by following the same procedure
used for the Upper 1
track. See page 27.

32
5

Playing Sounds
Changing the split point

Play the keyboard.


Note how the keyboard once again plays the Upper tracks for
the entire length of the keyboard.

Upper

Changing the split point


If you are not comfortable with the selected split point, you may set the split point to any key.

Press the Split tab to see the Split Point panel.

Touch the keyboard in the display, then play a note on the keyboard. Or,
press the Split Point parameter to select it, and use the DIAL to select the
new split point.

Press the Volume tab to go back to the Volume panel.

Playing Sounds
Raising or lowering the Upper octave

33

Raising or lowering the Upper octave


If all Upper tracks sound too high or too low, you can quickly change which octave they are playing
in.

Use the UPPER OCTAVE buttons on the control panel, to transpose all
Upper tracks at the same time.

i Note: the Octave


Transpose value for each
Upper track is shown in
the
corresponding
tracks status box.
Each press of this button
will lower the pitch by one
octave.

Press both UPPER OCTAVE buttons together to reset the octave.

Quick Guide

Each press of this button


will raise the pitch by one
octave.

Digital Drawbars
A special sound in the Pa1X is the Digital Drawbars. This sound simulates the classic tonewheel
organs of the past. You can use the Assignable Sliders of the Pa1X to adjust each drawbar, and then
save these settings to a Performance (see Saving your settings to a Performance on page 37).

Mute all Upper tracks, apart for the Upper 1 track. Select the Upper 1
track.
The Upper 1 track is set to
play and selected.

Upper 2 and 3 tracks are


muted (they cannot be
heard).

Press the Sound name to open the Sound Select window.

i Note: You
can select a
Digital Drawbar
Sound
also by pressing the DIGITAL DRAWBAR button
in the PERFORMANCE/
SOUND SELECT section.

34
3

Playing Sounds
Digital Drawbars

Select the Digi Organ bank, then choose the DigDrawbars Sound.
Due to the nature of these Sounds, there is only one Digital Drawbar Organ Sound. Different
drawbar settings may be stored with each Performance. So, selecting a different Performance will
select different settings for the Digital Drawbar Organ.

After you select the Digital


Drawbar Organ Sound, the
Drawbar Setting page appears.

As soon as the Drawbar Setting page appears in the display, the Assignable Sliders will function as organ drawbars (the sliders DRAWBAR LED
will be lit). Move the Assignable Sliders to change the various drawbar
settings.

i Note: You dont need


to be in the Digital
Drawbars page to use
the Assignable Sliders to
change the sound. When
a Drawbar Organ is
assigned to a Keyboard
track, the sound can be
changed also while in
the main page, provided that the DRAWBARS LED is turned on.

To change the Digital


Drawbar Organ settings
by using the Assignable
Sliders, the DRAWBARS
LED must be turned on.
Use the SLIDER MODE button to turn it on.

Select different parameters in this page, and change their settings to see
how each setting affects the sound.

When you have found some settings that you like, you can save them to
a Performance, as described later in this section.

i Hint: As an alternative to using Assignable


Sliders to change drawbar values, you can
touch a drawbar in the
display, and use the
TEMPO/VALUE controls
to change it.

Playing Sounds
Digital Drawbars

Press the EXIT button to go back to the main page.

Quick Guide

35

36

Selecting and saving Performances


Selecting a Performance

Selecting and saving Performances


The Performance is the musical heart of the Pa1X. Unlike selecting single Sounds, selecting a Performance will recall several Sounds at the same time, the needed effects and transpositions, a suitable
Voice Processor preset, plus many more parameters useful for playing in a musical situation.
You can save all control panel settings in a Performance (including your Digital Drawbar Organ settings). While many Performances are already supplied with the instrument, you can customize each
of them to your own taste, and then save them in their customized form.
Similar to Performances, you can also save your settings to a Single Touch Setting (STS), which will
store all the settings for the Keyboard tracks. Four STSs are supplied with each Style and SongBook
entry, and can be selected with the four dedicated buttons under the display.
As far as Style tracks are concerned, you can save settings in a third object called the Style Performance.
Please note that settings saved in Performance 1 are automatically selected when the instrument is
turned on. This means you can save your preferred startup settings to Performance 1.
Single Touch Settings (STS) section

Performance/Sound Select section

Selecting a Performance
1

Press the Performance area in the display, to open the Performance


Select window.

i Note: You can open


the Performance Select
window also by pressing
one of the buttons in the
PERFORMANCE/SOUND
SELECT section provided the LED on the
PERFORMANCE SELECT
button is on. This will let
you jump directly to the
desired
Performance
bank.

The selected Performance is


highlighted. Press a Performance name to select it.

Press one of the side tabs to


select a different Performance
bank.
Press one of the lower tabs to select
a different Performance page.

Selecting and saving Performances


Saving your settings to a Performance

37

Select one of the Performances in the Performance Select window.

The Performance Select window closes, and the main screen


appears again (provided the
DISPLAY HOLD LED is turned
off). Sounds, effects, and other
settings, change according to
the setting memorized in the
selected Performance.

Play the keyboard.


Settings memorized in the selected Performance have
been selected. Sounds, effects and other settings have
been recalled.

Saving your settings to a Performance


All the control panel settings, plus the Keyboard track settings, selected effects and Voice Processor
Preset, can be saved to a single Performance, to be quickly recalled at a later time.

Press the page menu icon to open the page menu.


Page menu icon

Page menu

i Note: If
the LED of
the
STYLE
CHANGE
button
is
turned on, selecting a
Performance may automatically select a different Style and its settings
(Sounds, effects, Drawbar settings for the Style
tracks)

Quick Guide

38
2

Selecting and saving Performances


Saving your settings to a Performance

Select the Write Performance command to open the Write Performance


dialog box.

After choosing the Write Performance


menu item, the Write Performance dialog box appears.

If you like, you may assign a new name to the Performance.


Press Symbol to
enter special charachters.
Use alphabetical
characters to
enter text.

Use the SHIFT button to switch


between capitals
and small characters.

Press the T symbol to open the Text Edit


dialog box.

Use the < and >


buttons to move the
cursor.

Press Clear to delete the


whole string, Delete to
delete just a single character.

When done, press OK


to confirm the new
name, or Cancel to
abandon all changes.

Selecting and saving Performances


Saving your settings to a Performance

39

Select a Bank and Performance location in memory, where you would


like to save the Performance.

To select the target Bank and


Performance location, select
the Bank and Performance
parameters, and use the
TEMPO/VALUE section.

or
The selected Performance location is
highlighted. Press a
Performances name
to select it.

B)

Note: A Performance
can be saved to an
Empty location. An
Empty locations
currently contains
no data.

Press one of the side tabs to


select a different Performance
bank.

Press one of the lower tabs to


select a different Performance
page.

When you have changed the name to the Performance, and selected the
target location, press OK to save the Performance to memory (or cancel
to stop the operation).

! Warning: Saving a
Performance
to
an
already used location
overwrites any existing
data at that location.

Quick Guide

A)

40

Selecting and playing Styles


Selecting and playing a Style

Selecting and playing Styles


Pa1X is an arranger, i.e. a musical instrument providing automatic accompaniments, or arrangements.
Each arrangement style is called, as a consequence, Style.
A Style is made of several Style Elements (Intro, Variation, Fill, Ending), corresponding to the various
sections of a song. By selecting Style Elements, you can make your playing more varied and musical.
When selecting a Style, a Style Performance, with settings for the Style tracks, is also selected. If the
SINGLE TOUCH LED is turned on, the first of the four Single Touch Settings (STS) associated with
the Style is selected, too, and Keyboard tracks, pads, effects and some other useful parameters are
automatically configured.
Use the Style controls to start or stop the Style.
Style Select section

Style Elements

Style Controls

Selecting and playing a Style


1

Press the Style area in the display. The Style Select window appears.

i Note: You can open


the Style Select window
also by pressing one of
the buttons in the STYLE
SELECT section. This will
let you jump directly to
the desired Style bank.
The selected Style is highlighted.
Press a Styles name to select it.

Press one of the side tabs to


select a different Style bank.
Press one of the lower tabs to
select a different Style page.

i Note: You
can leave the
Style
Select
window open
in the display, even after
selecting a Style. Just
press the DISPLAY HOLD
button to turn its LED
on.

Selecting and playing Styles


Selecting and playing a Style

41

Select a Style from the Style Select window.

The Style Select window closes,


and the main screen appears
again, with the selected Style
ready to go.

Be sure one of the Chord Scanning modes is selected.


For chord scanning to work, either of both LEDs must be
turned on. Lower: chords are recognized on the left of the
split point; Upper: chords are recognized on the right of
the split point; Full: chords are recognized on the whole
keyboard. Off: only the Drum track can be heard.

Press the SYNCHRO-START button to turn its LED on.

Play the keyboard.


When the Syncho-Start function is turned on, the Style
starts playing as soon as you play a note or chord in the
chord recognition area. Play chords with your left hand,
and the melody with your right hand. The arranger will
follow your playing.

Press START/STOP to stop the Style.

i Note: You could simply press START/STOP to


start the Style, but the
Synchro-Start function
allows you to make the
Style start in sync with
your playing on the keyboard. Therefore, it may
be considered a more
musical way of starting
a Style.

Quick Guide

42

Selecting and playing Styles


Tempo

Tempo
While a Tempo setting is saved with each Style or Performance, you can change it to be whatever you
like. You can use either of the following two methods.

While the Tempo parameter is selected, use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to


change its value.

When the Tempo parameter is not selected, keep the SHIFT button
pressed, and use the DIAL to change the Tempo. The selected tempo will
be shown in a small window.

Press the UP and DOWN buttons at the same time to recall the saved
Tempo.

Intro, Fill, Variation, Ending


When playing Styles, you can select various Style Elements to make your playing richer. A Style is
made of up to four basic patterns (Variations), three Intros (or two Intros and a Count-In), three Fills
(or two Fills and a Break), and two Endings.

Make sure the SYNCHRO-START LED is turned on (otherwise, press the


button to turn it on).

Press one of the INTRO buttons to set the corresponding Intro to play.

Play the keyboard.


The Style starts with the selected Intro. When the Intro is
completed, the basic pattern (selected Variation) starts to
play.

Selecting and playing Styles


Single Touch Settings (STS)

43

While playing, press one of the FILL buttons to select a Fill.

i Note: You do not


need to select a Fill
before selecting a different Variation, but selecting a Fill makes the
transition
smoother
and more musical.
Before the Fill ends, press one of the VARIATION buttons, to select a different variation of the basic pattern.

When the Fill ends, the selected Variation will start playing.

i Note: You do not


need to select a Variation during a Fill, since a
Variation may already be
automatically recalled at
the end of the Fill. See
Fill Mode (13) on
page 93.

Quick Guide

When you like to stop playing, press one of the ENDING buttons to stop
the Style with an Ending.
When the Ending is finished, the Style automatically stops.

Single Touch Settings (STS)


Each Style or SongBook entry may come with up to four Keyboard track settings, called STS (short
for Single Touch Settings). STS #1 is automatically selected when choosing a Style, provided the
SINGLE TOUCH LED is turned on. STS#1 is also recalled when a SongBook entry is selected.
STSs are still available when switching to Song Play mode from Style play mode, to let you select a different configuration of Keyboard tracks and a different Voice Processor Preset, while listening to the
Songs.

Press one of the four STS buttons under the display.

Play the keyboard.

i Note: STSs are very


similar to Performances,
but they are fine-tuned
to the Style they are
associated to.

Settings memorized in the selected STS have been


selected. Sounds, effects and other settings have been
recalled.

Try all the other STSs, and see how settings change with each of them.

i Hint: You may see


the name of the four
available STSs for the
current Style, by pressing
the STS Name tab.

44

Selecting and playing Styles


The Pads

The Pads
Each Performance and STS can assign different sounds or patterns to the four PADS. These sounds or
patterns can be played along with the Keyboard and Style tracks.

Press one of the four PADS.

If the selected PAD triggers an endless sound or pattern (i.e. the


Applause), pressing STOP will cancel that sound.

Select a different Performance, and see how the sounds or patterns


assigned to the PADS change.
You can even press more Pads at once, and play two or more sounds or patterns at the same
time. Pressing STOP stops them all at the same time. Keeping STOP pressed and pressing one of
the PAD buttons only stops that sound or pattern.

Adjusting volume balance between the Style and the keyboard


Adjusting the volume of the Style tracks may be useful, to gently fade them while Keyboard tracks can
still be played at the normal volume.

While the Style is playing, use the ACC/SEQ VOLUME slider to adjust the
Style volume. Keyboard tracks volume does not change when moving
the slider.

i Hint: You can see


which sounds or patterns
are associated to the
four Pads for the current
Performance or STS, by
pressing the Pad tab.

Selecting and playing Styles


Adjusting volume of each single track

45

Adjusting volume of each single track


You can adjust the volume of each of the Style and Keyboard tracks, for example to soften the bass a
little, or to make the keyboard solo louder.
Use the Assignable Sliders (be sure the VOLUME LED is turned on) to
adjust each Keyboard tracks volume, as well as grouped Style tracks.

In Normal view, all


Style tracks are seen
as three grouped
tracks.

To control the volume, the


VOLUME LED must be turned
on. If it is off, repeatedly press
the SLIDER MODE button to
change it. Please note that the
SLIDER MODE status is saved
with each Performance.

The LED indicator


of grouped Style
tracks and Keyboard tracks turns
on.

To separately adjust each Style track, press the TRK. SEL. (TRACK SELECT)
button to change tracks view.

i Hint: As an alternative, you can change


each tracks volume, by
touching a tracks area
to select it, then using
the TEMPO/VALUE controls to change the volume.
In Style view, all separate Style tracks are
shown, and can be
controlled using the
corresponding Assignable Sliders.

The LED indicator


of single Style
tracks turns on.

To return to Normal view, press the TRK. SEL. button again.


The LED on the TRK. SEL. button will turn off.

Quick Guide

46

Selecting and playing Styles


Turning Style tracks on/off

Turning Style tracks on/off


You may easily turn on or off any Style track while you are playing. For example, try muting all
accompaniment tracks, while drum and bass continue to play.

While the Style is playing, touch anywhere in the ACCOMP tracks channel strip to select the track (volume value highlighted), then touch it again
to set the track to Mute.

Mute the ACCOMP


track. All accompaniment tracks will go
silent (apart from
Drum, Percussion and
Bass).

To set tracks back to the Play status, press the Mute icon on the ACCOMP
track.

Set the ACCOMP


track to Play. All
accompaniment
tracks will return to
their original volumes.

To mute/unmute each single Style track, press TRK. SEL. to switch to the
Style Tracks view.

Press the TRK. SEL. button again to go back to the Normal view.
The LED on the TRK. SEL. button will turn off.

Adding chords to your right-hand melody (ENSEMBLE function)


Chords played with your left hand may be applied to the right-hand melody.

Press the SPLIT button in the KEYBOARD MODE section to split the keybord.
The Ensemble function only works in Split mode.

i Note: While in the


Normal view of the Style
Play mode, you can see
Style tracks grouped in
just three complex
tracks. To see each Style
track as individual tracks,
just press the TRK. SEL.
button.

Selecting and playing Styles


Adding chords to your right-hand melody (ENSEMBLE function)

Press the ENSEMBLE button to turn its LED on.

Play chords with the left hand and single notes in the right hand.

47

Notice how the right hand is automatically harmonized,


according to the chords composed with your left hand.

To select a different harmonization style, keep the SHIFT button pressed,


and press the ENSEMBLE button to open the Ensemble page.
This is a fast shortcut to recall this page. The longer would have been entering the Edit mode by
pressing the MENU button, then going to the Ensemble page.
While the Ensemble parameter is
selected, use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to select one of the available
harmonization types.

When the right harmonization type has been selected, press the EXIT button to go back to the main page.

While in an edit page, press


EXIT to go back to the main
page of the current operating
mode.

Press the ENSEMBLE button again to turn its LED off. The automatic harmonization will be turned off.

Quick Guide

48

Song Play
Selecting a Song to play

Song Play
Pa1X is equipped with two onboard sequencers that can be run at the same time to mix between different Songs. Songs are read directly from disk, so there is no need to load them to memory before
playing them back.
Pa1X can read Songs of various kinds: Standard MIDI Files (SMF), KAR, MP3 and Audio CD (MP3
and Audio CD playback only available as options). Please remember that the Double Sequencer
(XDS) function is not available with two MP3s or two CD tracks at the same time. You can, however,
run a CD track on one sequencer, and an MP3 on the other one.
It may be of great interest to singers and guitar players to know that if a midifile contains lyrics and
chords, they can be seen in the display. Lyrics can also be seen on an external video monitor, provided
you have the (optional) Video Interface installed.
The SONG PLAY button

Sequencers controls

Selecting a Song to play


1

Press the SONG PLAY button to switch to the Song Play mode.

After pressing the SONG PLAY


button, the main page of the
Song Play mode appears.

i Hint: In Style Play


mode, you can pre-select
the Songs to be assigned
to both sequencers. This
way, you will be ready to
start them, as soon as
you switch to Song Play
mode.

The Songs area of the


Style Play main page.

Song Play
Selecting a Song to play

49

Press the Sequencer 1 area to open the Song Select window (or press the
SELECT button of the Sequencer 1 section on the control panel).

i Hint: As an alternative, you can open the


Song Select window by
pressing the SELECT button in the SEQUENCER 1
section on the control
panel.

Scroll through the list and select the Song to play.

Use the scroll bar to see all Songs


in the list. As an alternative,
select an item and use the DIAL.

The selected Song is highlighted.


Press a Songs name to select it.

Press the Select button to select the


highlighted Song, and assign it to
Sequencer 1.

Use the Device pop-up menu to select


one of the available mass-storage
devices (floppy disk, hard drive).

Use the Open and Close buttons


to browse through the folders.

Use the Sync P. (Synchronized Path)


button to see the selected Song again.

When the Song is selected, press the Select button to confirm your selection, and close the Song Select window.
Selected Song

After pressing the Select button in the display,


the main page of the Song Play mode appears
again.

Quick Guide

50

Song Play
Playing back a Song

Playing back a Song


Once a Song has been selected, it may be played back by the sequencer.

Be sure the BALANCE slider is completely moved to the left (toward


Sequencer 1).

Press the
playback.

(PLAY/STOP) button in the SEQUENCER 1 section to star t

After pressing the


(PLAY/STOP) button,
the buttons LED turns on, and the measure
counter begins to show the current measure
number.

Use the SEQUENCER 1 control section to control the Songs playback.


Press the PAUSE button to stop the Song at
the current position. Press it again (or press
PLAY/STOP) to resume playback.

Press the REWIND button once to go to the


beginning of the current measure. Keep it
pressed to go back several measures.

Press the FAST FORWARD button once to go


to the beginning of the next measure. Keep it
pressed to go forward several measures.

When you want to stop the song and go back to the first measure, press
the
(PLAY/STOP) button again.
When the Song is
stopped, the LED on the
PLAY/STOP button goes
dark.

i Note: In any case, the


sequencer will automatically stop when the end
of the Song is reached.

Song Play
Changing tracks volume

51

Changing tracks volume


During playback, you may wish to change each tracks volume, to create a mix on the fly.

In Normal view, use the Assignable Sliders to adjust each Keyboard


tracks volume (provided the VOLUME LED is turned on).

Keyboard tracks

VOLUME LED. Its status depends on the


last selected Performance. If needed,
repeatedly press the
SLIDER MODE button
to turn it on.

Quick Guide

In Normal view
(Keyboard
tracks shown)
this LED is
turned on.
In Normal view
(Keyboard
tracks shown)
both LEDs are
turned off.

Press the TRK. SEL. (TRACK SELECT) button once to see tracks 1-8 (Track 18 view).

i Note: Changes to
Song tracks will not be
saved, and will be reset
each time you press the
(PLAY/STOP) button.
To save changes, you
must edit the Song in
Sequencer mode.
In Track 1-8 view, the
first 8 tracks of the
selected Song are
shown, and can be
controlled using the
corresponding Assignable Sliders.

The LED indicator


of tracks 1-8 turns
on.

VOLUME LED
turned on.

52
3

Song Play
Changing tracks volume

Press TRK. SEL. once again to see tracks 9-16 (Track 9-16 view).

i Hint: As an alternative, you can change


each tracks volume, by
touching a tracks area
to select it, then using
the TEMPO/VALUE controls to change the volume.
In Track 9-16 view, the
second group of 8
tracks of the selected
Song are shown, and
can be controlled
using the corresponding Assignable Sliders.

VOLUME LED
turned on.

The LED indicator


of tracks 9-16 turns
on.

Press TRK. SEL. again, to return to the Normal view (Keyboard tracks).

Keyboard tracks

Press the

While listening to the Song, switch from Normal view to Track 1-8 and
Track 9-16 view, to see which tracks are playing.

(PLAY/STOP) button to start the Song.

Each track has a sound assigned to it, so look for the name of the Sounds you are listening to.

Song Play
Turning Song tracks on/off

Touch each tracks channel strip, to see each tracks detail in the Track
Info line.

Selected track

Assigned Sound. Press it to


open the Sound Select window.

Sound bank

Program Change (if activated see Show Program Change


number on page 234)

Alternatively, you can see the Sound assigned to each track in the Sound
area of the Track 1-8 and Track 9-16 views.

Octave Transpose
Sounds. Names are abbreviated,
to fit the limited space. Press to
open the Sound Select window.

Turning Song tracks on/off


During playback, you may wish to mute one or more tracks, for example to sing along with the Song,
or play an instrumental part live on the keyboard.
Muting/unmuting Song tracks works exactly as with Style tracks. See Turning Style tracks on/off on
page 46 for more information.

i Note: These changes


will not be saved to the
Song. To save changes,
edit
the
Song
in
Sequencer mode.

Quick Guide

53

54

Song Play
Mixing two Songs

Mixing two Songs


You can select two Songs at the same time, and mix between them using the BALANCE slider.

Press the Sequencer 1 area to open the Song Select window and select
the Song to be played by Sequencer 1. Press Select to confirm.

Once a song is assigned to Sequencer 1, press the Sequencer 2 area once


to select it, and a second time to open the Song Select window. Select a
Song to be assigned to Sequencer 2, and press Select to confirm.

Keep the SHIFT button pressed, and press any of the two
buttons, to start both Sequencers at the same time.

(PLAY/STOP)

During playback, move the BALANCE slider, to mix between the two Songs.

During playback, you may control each Sequencer separately, by using


the dedicated Sequencer controls.

Press the relevant


Sequencer.

(PLAY/STOP) button to stop the corresponding

i Hint: You dont need


to start both sequencers
at the same time. You
can start the first Song
then start the second
one when the first one is
near to the end. This
way, you can use the
BALANCE slider to gently
crossfade between the
end of one Song and the
beginning of the following one.

Song Play
Listening to a CD

55

Listening to a CD

Insert the CD into the CD Player.

Press a Sequencer area to open the Song Select window.

Device popup menu

Use the Device pop-up menu to select the CD Player.

Select any of the tracks contained in the CD, and press Select to assign it
to the selected Sequencer.

Check the All


option to listen to
all the tracks on
the CD, starting
from the selected
one. Press
(PLAY/STOP) to
start listening.

Use the Sequencers transport controls to play/stop the selected CD track.


You can jump to the following CD track by keeping the SHIFT button pressed, while pressing
the >> button. Keep SHIFT pressed and press << to jump to the previous CD track.

Quick Guide

If your Pa1X is fitted with the (optional) CDRW-1 CD Player, you can listen to songs from any Audio
CD. Please note that, while you can assign a single CD track to either sequencers, you can mix it with
a midifile assigned to the other sequencer.

56

The SongBook
Selecting the desired entry from the Main List

The SongBook
One of the most powerful features of the Pa1X is the onboard music database, that allows you to organize your Styles and Songs (in SMF, KAR and optionally MP3 format) for easy retrieving. Each
entry of this database may include the artist, title, genre, number, key, tempo, and meter of a specified
song. When selecting one of the entries, the associated Style, MP3 or Standard MIDI File is automatically recalled.
In addition to helping you organizing your shows, the SongBook allows you to associate up to four
STSs to each Standard MIDI File or MP3. This way, it is easy to recall a complete setup for Keyboard
tracks, effects, and the Voice Processor, for realtime playing over a Standard MIDI File or MP3.
You can add your own entries to the SongBook, as well as edit the existing ones. Korg has already supplied some hundred entries as standard. Furthermore, the SongBook allows you to create various custom lists, that may suit your different shows.

The SONGBOOK button

Selecting the desired entry from the Main List


A large database is already included with the instrument, and you can later customize it. You may
browse through this database in a variety of ways.

While you are in Style Play or Song Play mode, press the SONGBOOK
button to open the SongBook window.
Style or Standard MIDI Files(s) currently
assigned to the arranger or sequencer(s)

Use the scroll


bar to see all
entries in the
list. As an alternative, select an
item and use the
DIAL.

SongBook Main
List
Press this checkbox to turn the
view filter on.

Press this button


to edit the view
filter.

Adds the selected entry


to the Custom List (if
activated see page 61).

Press this button to


select the current entry
to play.

Browse through the entries.


Icons in the Type column will help you identify the type of the entry. The Genre column is
shown by default, but you can switch to the Artist column (see Displaying Artist or Genre
below).

The SongBook
Displaying Artist or Genre

57

When the entry is visible in the display, select it and press the Select button in the display.
After selecting an entry, the corresponding Style, SMF, KAR file, or MP3 (optional) will be
recalled, together with the relevant operating mode (Style Play or Song Play). Up to four STSs
will also be recalled.
The selected Style, SMF, KAR file, or MP3 is shown in the higher part of the screen.

Displaying Artist or Genre


For space matter, either the Genre or Artist column can be seen in the display. You cannot see both at
the same time.
Press the page menu icon to open the page menu.

i Note: The Artist and


Key fields of all supplied
entries have been intentionally left empty.

Choose Show Artist (now Genre) to switch from Genre to Artist in the List
view. The Artist column will be shown.

Open the page menu again, and choose the Show Genre (now Ar tist)
item. The Genre column will be shown again.

Quick Guide

58

The SongBook
Sorting entries

Sorting entries
You can change the order entries are shown in the display.

Press the page menu icon to open the page menu.

Choose whether the list


must be seen in ascending
or descending order

Choose one of the sorting


options to change the list
view order. The selected
option will be shown in
red over the list of file.

Select one of the available sorting options.


The order of entries in the display changes, reflecting the selected sorting option.

Searching entries
The SongBook database may be really huge. You can, however, look for (say) specific artists or song
titles, using the filtering functions.

Press the Filter button in the display, to open the Filter dialog box.

Available
search criteria.
Genre and
Artist are
both considered, even
though only
one of them
may be shown
in the List

Press the
(Text Edit) button next to the search criteria (even more
than one) you want to enter.
For example, you may want to find all songs containing the word love in the title. If so, select
the Name criterion, and enter the word love. Capitals are not relevant for the search.

Adding entries

Press OK in the display, and close the Text Edit dialog box. The entered
text is now the search criteria.

Press OK to close the Filter dialog box and return to the SongBook page.
Once the Filter dialog box has been closed by pressing OK, the Filtered check box is automatically checked, and the filter is activated. Only entries matching the entered criterion are seen in
the Main List.

To see the whole SongBook database again, press the Filtered check box
again, to make the check mark disappear.

Adding entries
You can add your own entries to the SongBook database.

Go to the Style Play or Song Play mode, depending on the type of entry
you want to add to the SongBook database.

Select the Style, Standard MIDI File or MP3 file (optional) to be added to
the SongBook.
Assign the selected Song to Sequencer 1. Songs assigned to Sequencer 2 will not be saved in the
SongBook entry.

Edit Keyboard and Style tracks as you prefer, by selecting different


Sounds and Effects, or editing any other parameter.
Please note that changes to a Standard MIDI Files tracks will not be saved as SongBook data.
Data included in the Standard MIDI File will always be considered.

Select a different Voice Processor Preset, if you like.

59

Quick Guide

The SongBook

60
5

The SongBook
Adding entries

When your entry is ready, press the SONGBOOK button, then the Book
Edit 1 tab to see the Book Edit 1 page.
Name of the Style, SMF, KAR or MP3 file, memorized with the entry (provided Write Current
Entrys parameters
Resource is selected when saving it).
Entrys name
Currently selected resource. If a
different Style, SMF, KAR or
MP3 file has been selected, it
may differ from the saved
resource (shown on top of the
page).

When checked, current settings for Style


tracks, or the path for the SMF, KAR or
MP3 file, are saved with the entry. If
unchecked, original Style track settings are
saved with the entry.
This parameter is mandatory when creating a new entry by pressing the New Song
button.
When checked, current Keyboard track
and Voice Processor settings are saved to
one of the four STSs available for each
entry. You can also exit the SongBook, edit
Keyboard tracks, then return to the SongBook and save the new settings to a different STS. Press the Text Edit icon to edit the
STS name.

One of the four STS available


for each entry, where you can
save the current settings for
Keyboard tracks and the Voice
Processor.

Press New Song to create a


new entry.

Press the New Song button in the display to add a new item to the SongBook list.

Press the
(Text Edit) button next to the field(s) you want to edit, and
write the name. Set all other parameters.
You can write the genre, artist name, and name of the associated STS. Select a Tempo matching
the songs tempo, and select the Meter and Key of the song. You can also specify a Master Transpose value, to be automatically selected when selecting the entry.

After having filled up all the desired fields (be as comprehensive as you
can), press the Write button in the display to open the Write dialog box.

The SongBook
Creating a Custom List

61

Press the
(Text Edit) button to assign a name to the new entry, then
press OK to save the entry to the SongBook database.
Entrys name. A good idea may be to assign the entry the same
name of the associated Standard MIDI File or MP3 file, or a
name suitable for the use of the associated Style.
Select Rename/Overwrite to overwrite an existing entry. Warning: the
older entry will be deleted!

Creating a Custom List


You can create several Custom Lists in the SongBook, to make a set of entries suitable for your various
shows. Before starting a new Custom List, be sure you have added all needed entries to the SongBook
main database (see Adding entries above).

While in SongBook mode, open the page menu and check the Enable List
Edit item.

After you check the


Enable List Edit item, the
List Edit page becomes
available.

Select a Custom List to be edited.


To edit an existing list, press the Custom List tab to open the Custom List page, and select one of
the available Custom Lists. To create a new list, press the List Edit tab to open the List Edit page,
and press the New List button to create a new, blank list.

Press the Book tab to open the Book page and see the full database. Use
the various sorting, searching and filtering options (seen above) to find

Quick Guide

Select New Song to add a new entry


to the SongBook database. This
option is automatically selected
when a new entry has been created
(by pressing the New Song button).

62

The SongBook
Creating a Custom List

the entries you are looking for. Press the Add to List button when the
desired entry has been selected.

Use the scroll


bar to see all
entries in the
list. As an alternative, select an
item and use the
DIAL.

SongBook list

Press this checkbox to turn the


view filter on (if
any).
Press this button to edit
the view filter.

Adds the highlighted entry to the


Custom List.

When finished adding entries to the Custom List, press the List Edit tab to
go to the List Edit page, and use the various commands to edit the list.
List name

Scrollbar

Select an entry on the


list to edit

Press Write to save the


current Custom List.

Use the vertical arrows


to move the selected
entry up or down in
the list.

Press Del Song to


delete the selected
entry.

Press New List to create a new Custom List.


Press Del List to delete the current Custom
List. Warning: Del List will delete the current Custom List.

When the Custom List is ready, press the Write button in the display to
save it to memory. If you like, assign a new name to the Custom List.
Press Symbol to
enter special charachters.
Use alphabetic
characters to
enter text.

Use the SHIFT button to switch


between capitals
and small characters.

Press the T symbol to open the Text Edit


dialog box.

Use the < and >


buttons to move the
cursor.

Press Clear to delete the


whole string, Delete to
delete just a single character.

When done, press OK


to confirm the new
name, or Cancel to
abandon all changes.

The SongBook
Selecting and using a Custom List

63

Selecting and using a Custom List


After creating one or more Custom Lists, you can select one and use it for your show.

Press the Custom List tab to select the Custom List page.

Use the List pop-up menu to select one of the available Custom Lists.

Press Select to set the


highlighted entry to play
(if different than the
one automatically
selected).
Use the List pop-up menu to
select one of the available Custom Lists.

Press Next to select the next entry in the list.


(This command can also be assigned to an
Assignable Switch).

Select one of the entries in the list (it turns blue), then press the Select button in the display (the selected entry turns green) to start playing back
from there.

Selecting a SongBook STS


Up to four STSs can be associated to an entry based on a Standard MIDI File or an MP3 file.

Press the Lyrics/STS tab to open the Lyrics/STS page and see the four
STSs associated to the current SongBook entry.

STSs associated with


the current entry.

Select the desired STS by touching its name in the display. As an alternative, press the SINGLE TOUCH BUTTON corresponding to the desired STS.
The STS is selected. Keyboard tracks and Voice Processor settings may change.

Quick Guide

Entry in play. To select a


different one, highlight
it and press the Select
button in the display.

64

Singing with a connected microphone


Connecting a microphone

Singing with a connected microphone


Pa1X is fitted with a powerful digital voice processor, based on technologies developed by TC Helicon,
including effects, four-part harmonization, and (optional) pitch correction and voice modeling.
Microphone input

Microphone input volume control

Access Voice Processor editing from the main page (tab Mic)
and the GLOBAL button (items Voice Processor Setup and
Voice.Processor Preset)

Connecting a microphone
To sing along with the Pa1X, you must first connect a suitable microphone to its MIC input. Any
dynamic microphone is directly supported. To connect a phantom-powered condenser microphone,
you need an external phantom power supply. You can also connect the microphone though an external mixer, and connect one of the mixers line outputs to the line input IN1 of the Pa1X.

Lower the Audio In track volume by using the corresponding slider.

To control the volume, the


VOLUME LED must be turned
on. If it is off, repeatedly press
the SLIDER MODE button to
change it. Please note that the
SLIDER MODE status is saved
with each Performance.

Connect a microphone.
If you connect a microphone to the MIC input, move the MIC/IN1 switch to the MIC position.
This allows the microphone signal to pass through the built-in high-quality preamp of the Pa1X.
If you connect a microphone to the IN1 input, passing through a mixer or a preamp, move the
MIC/IN1 switch to the IN1 position. This will allow you to use the Pa1X as a powerful outboard
effect processor.

i Note: Lowering the


Audio In track volume
helps avoiding feedback.
Feedback is caused by
audio generated by the
Pa1X, returning to the
audio circuitry via the
microphone.

Singing with a connected microphone


Connecting a microphone

65

Go to the main page of the Style Play or Song Play mode, and select the
Mic tab. Uncheck all the master switches.

Sing into the microphone, and adjust the input gain and the Audio In
tracks volume, until you achieve the correct settings.
Adjust the input level by using the MIC
GAIN knob. Sing into the microphone, and
watch at the AUDIO IN LED on the control
panel. If it goes red too often, turn down
the input gain; if it turns on green too
often, increase the input gain. No hint of
distortion should be heard in the audio system when you sing.

i Note: You have a correct microphone volume


setting when the AUDIO
IN LED turns red very
often, and just during
the signal peaks. The
AUDIO IN slider must be
set accordingly, to compensate a too loud or
weak incoming signal.

While you adjust


the gain, gradually
increase the Audio
In track volume, by
using the corresponding slider.

Turn on again all desired master switches.

Try the Play/Mute button of the Microphone panel, to mute/unmute the


whole microphone section.

Microphone muted

Microphone set to
play

i Note: This is the


same play/mute control
you can find in the Mic/
In channel strip of the
Volume panel.

Quick Guide

Voice Processor master switches. To test


the microphone level,
uncheck Harm/
Model, Pitch,
Thicken, Effects, Talk,
Mic Mute.

66

Singing with a connected microphone


Applying harmony to your voice

Press the Volume tab to select the Volume panel.

If you like, start a Style or Song. Adjust the microphone final volume
using the AUDIO IN Assignable Slider.

Adjust the other settings, balancing the Style/Song and microphone with
the ACC/SEQ VOLUME slider and the AUDIO IN Assignable Slider.
The settings for the ACC/SEQ VOLUME and AUDIO IN sliders are not saved in memory, so
they stay consistent when selecting different Styles, Performances, Songs or Voice Processor settings.

Applying harmony to your voice


1

Be sure you are in Style Play mode, and select a Style you especially like.

Press the Mic tab to show the Microphone panel, and select one of the
available Voice Processor Presets.
Voice Processor Presets are settings for the various Voice Processor modules (Effects, Harmony,
Voice Modeling, Pitch Correction, Thickening). By selecting a Preset, all processing parameters
may change.

i Note: Pitch Correction and Voice Modeling are available as


options.

A Voice Processor Preset is assigned to each Performance or STS. When selecting a different Performance or STS, the Voice Processor Preset may change (depending on the Mic panel lock status), changing the type of processing applied to your voice.
Mic panel lock

Use this pop-up menu


to select a Voice Processor Preset.

If you like, start the Style.

Check the Harm/Model checkbox, to turn Harmony on.

Play the keyboard, to send chords to the Voice Processor.

Sing along with the chords and melody you play on the keyboard.

If it is playing, stop the Style.

i Note: By default, the


first Performance and
STS does not include any
harmony effect, to avoid
any unwanted processing from being applied
to
the
microphone.
When you select a Preset
you like, you can save it
to a Performance or STS
(see Saving your settings to a Performance
on page 37)

i Note: By default, you


can turn the Harmony
section on/off by pressing the ASSIGNABLE
SWITCH 2, whichever the
shown page is.

Singing with a connected microphone


Soloing your voice (TalkBack)

67

Soloing your voice (TalkBack)

While in the main page of the Style Play or Song Play mode, press the
Mic tab to see Voice Processors master switches.

During playback, press the Talk checkbox, making the check mark
appear.

Sing or talk into the microphone.


Youll hear background music has been made softer, while your voice will be heard loud and
proud.

To turn the TalkBack function off, press the Talk checkbox again, making
the check mark disappear.
The background music returns to the original volume.

Locking Voice Processor settings


If you like the selected Voice Processor Preset, and other settings you have made in the Microphone
panel, you can lock them, to prevent them from changing each time you select a Performance, Style
or STS that may be saved using different settings.

While the Microphone panel is shown in the display, press the lock icon
to freeze it.

Lock on. Voice Processor settings will


not change when
selecting a different
Performance or STS.

To unlock the settings, press the lock icon again.

Lock off. Voice Processor settings will


change when selecting a new Performance or STS.

i Note: By default, you


can turn the TalkBack
function on/off by pressing the ASSIGNABLE
SWITCH 4, whichever the
shown page is.

Quick Guide

Sometimes, during a live show, you might like to talk to your audience. Use the TalkBack function to
attenuate the music, and let your voice pass through clean and clear.

68

Recording a new Song


Entering Backing Sequence (Quick Record) mode

Recording a new Song


There are several ways to create a Song on the Pa1X. The easiest and fastest is to use the Styles to
record what you are playing in realtime on the keyboard, while the arranger gives you the accompaniment tracks.
The SEQUENCER button

Style Select section

Style Elements

Style Controls

Sequencer 1 controls

Entering Backing Sequence (Quick Record) mode


1

Press the SEQUENCER button to switch to the Sequencer mode.

After pressing the SEQUENCER


button, the main page of the
Sequencer mode appears.

Press the RECORD button to open the Song Record Mode Select dialog
box.

Press the RECORD button, to


open the Song Record Mode
Select dialog box

Recording a new Song


Preparing to record

69

Select the Backing Sequence (Quick Record) option and press OK to enter
the Backing Sequence Record mode.

Quick Guide

After choosing the Backing Sequence


(Quick Record) option, the Backing
Sequence Record page appears.

Preparing to record
When you enter Backing Sequence Record, the most recently used Style is already selected, and all
tracks are ready to record. You could simply start recording as if you were playing in realtime with the
Styles. However, there are some settings that you may wish to edit.

If you like, adjust any editable parameter in the display.

Press the Style parameter (or one the STYLE


buttons) to open the
Style Select window,
and select a different
Style (as seen on
page 40).

Track(s) status. Rec means they are ready


to record. Play means they are recorded
and you can hear them. Mute means they
cannot be heard.

Measure counter. Negative numbers (-2, -1)


are the precount,
after which you can
start recording.
Styles Tempo. Change
it, if you like.
Styles Meter. You cannot change it.

Grouped tracks. During Quick Record, you cannot


access each separate Song track. For ease of use,
just two master tracks are provided: Kbd/Pad (Keyboard/Pads) and Ch/Acc (Chord/Accompaniment).

Press the Perf/STS


parameter to open
the Performance
Select window, and
select a different Performance (as seen on
page 36). As an alternative, you use the
PERFORMANCE/
SOUND or STS buttons.

70

Recording a new Song


Recording

Recording
1

Select the Style Element you wish to use before starting to play.
Select one of the Intros to start with an introduction. Select any of the Variations before starting
to record.

Start recording, by pressing the START/STOP button.

Play as if you were performing live with the Styles.


During recording, select any Style Element (Intro, Variation, Fill, Ending) you like. You can
also press START/STOP to stop the Style, and press it again to start the Style up again!
Please remember that, while recording in Backing Sequence Record mode, you cannot use the
SYNCHRO, TAP TEMPO/RESET, ACC/SEQ VOLUME controls.

When finished recording your Song, press the


(PLAY/STOP) button in
the SEQUENCER 1 section to exit recording, and return to the main page
of the Sequencer mode.

After pressing the PLAY/STOP button, the


main page of the Sequencer mode appears
again.

While in the main page of the Sequencer mode, press the


(PLAY/STOP)
button in the SEQUENCER 1 section to listen to the recorded Song.
The Backing Sequence Song has been converted to an ordinary Song. If you like it, you can save
it to disk, and read it in Song Play mode, or with any external sequencer.

To edit the Song, press MENU to enter the Edit mode (see instructions
starting from page 178).

i Note: If you do not


wish to start the Song
with the Style playing,
you can simply start
recording by pressing
the
PLAY/STOP button in the SEQUENCER 1
section, and start the
Style only later. The Style
will start at the next
strong beat

Recording a new Song


Second-take recording (Overdubbing)

71

Second-take recording (Overdubbing)

Press the REC button to enter Record again. When the Song Record Mode
Select dialog box appears, select Backing Sequence (Quick Record)
again.

If you are recording just one of the grouped tracks, set the track to be
preserved to the Play mode.

Repeat the recording process, and press the


(PLAY/STOP) button in the
SEQUENCER 1 section to stop recording and to return to the main page of
the Sequencer mode.

While in the main page of the Sequencer mode, press the


(PLAY/STOP)
button in the SEQUENCER 1 section to listen to the recorded Song.
Again, the Backing Sequence Song has been converted to an ordinary Song.

Saving a Song to disk


After recording a Song that you like, it is a good idea to save it to disk, to avoid losing it when the
instrument is turned off.

While in the main page of the Sequencer mode, press the page menu
icon to open the page menu.

Quick Guide

You may wish to re-record, and add one of the two grouped tracks, or overwrite a bad recording
with a new one. Usually, you will record all chord and Style Element changes during the first take, and
record Keyboard tracks and Pads during the second take.

72
2

Recording a new Song


Saving a Song to disk

Select the Save song command to open the Save Song window.

After you select the Save


song command, the Save
Song page appears.

Select a device and folder where you want to save your Song.

If a Song is selected (highlighted) it will be overwritten. If


no Song is selected, a new Song
file will be created on disk.
To deselect a selected Song,
press anywhere else in the Song
list, or select the same storage
device again.

Use the Device pop-up menu to select


one of the available storage devices
(floppy disk, hard drive).

Use the scroll bar to see all Songs


in the list. As an alternative,
select an item and use the DIAL.

Press the Save button to save the Song


to the current folder.

Use the Open and Close buttons


to browse through the folders.

Press the Save button in the display to open the Save Song dialog box.
Press the Text Edit
icon to edit the
Songs name.

Press OK in the display to save the Song to disk, or Cancel to stop the
Save operation.

In case you prefer to exit


this page without saving
the Song, press the EXIT
button.

Reference

74

Selecting elements
Sound Select window

Selecting elements
The following windows are shown in the various operating
modes, whenever you try to select a Sound, Performance, Style
or Song.

Sounds
Press one of these buttons in the display to select a Sound. Unless
the DISPLAY HOLD LED is turned on, the window automatically closes short after you select a Sound.

Sound Select window


Performance Select window
Press the Sound area whereas it appears in the display, or one of
the SOUND SELECT buttons on the control panel (provided the
SOUND SELECT LED is lit), to open the Sound Select window.
Use the SOUND SELECT buttons to go directly to the selected
bank.
Press EXIT to exit from this page and go back to the previous
page without selecting any Sound.
Bank groups

Side tabs (banks)

Press the Performance area whereas it appears in the display, or


one of the PERFORMANCE SELECT buttons on the control
panel (provided the PERFORMANCE SELECT LED is lit), to
open the Performance Select window. Use the PERFORMANCE
SELECT buttons to go directly to the selected bank.
Press EXIT to exit from this page and go back to the previous
page without selecting any Performance.
Bank groups

Side tabs (banks)

Sounds
Lower tabs (pages)

If more than four pages are


available, the Previous/Next tabs
are shown

Note: Depending on the status of the Auto Performance/Sound


Select parameter (see page 234), a Sound may be immediately
selected when pressing one of the SOUND SELECT buttons. The
latest selected Sound for that bank will be selected.
Bank groups
Selected group of banks.
Side tabs (banks)
Use these tabs to select a bank of Sounds. Each tab corresponds
to one of the SOUND SELECT buttons on the control panel.
Lower tabs (pages)
Use these tabs to select one of the available pages in the selected
bank.
If you press again the same SOUND/PERFORMANCE SELECT
button on the control panel, the next page in the same bank is
selected. This way, you do not need to press one of the corresponding tabs in the display in order to select a different page.
Previous/Next tabs
Scroll the lower tabs to the left or the right, when additional tabs
are available but cannot be seen in the display.

Performances
Lower tabs (pages)

Note: Depending on the status of the Auto Performance/Sound


Select parameter (see page 234), a Performance may be immediately selected when pressing one of the PERFORMANCE SELECT
buttons. The latest selected Performance for that bank will be
selected.
Bank groups
Selected group of banks.
Side tabs (banks)
Use these tabs to select a bank of Performance. Each tab corresponds to one of the PERFORMANCE SELECT buttons on the
control panel.
Lower tabs (pages)
Use these tabs to select one of the available pages in the selected
bank.
If you press again the same SOUND/PERFORMANCE SELECT
button on the control panel, the next page in the same bank is
selected. This way, you do not need to press one of the corresponding tabs in the display in order to select a different page.

Selecting elements
Style Select window

Previous/Next tabs
Scroll the lower tabs to the left or the right, when additional tabs
are available but cannot be seen in the display.

75

After selecting a Style from this window, its name begins to flash,
meaning it is ready to start playing at the beginning of the next
measure.

Performances
Press one of these buttons in the display to select a Performance.
Unless the DISPLAY HOLD LED is turned on, the window automatically closes short after you select a Performance.

Pad Select window

Style Select window

Press EXIT to exit from this page and go back to the previous
page without selecting any Pad.

Press the Pad area whereas it appears in the display, to open the
Pad Select window.

Bank groups

Side tabs (banks)

Press the Style area whereas it appears in the display, or one of


the STYLE buttons on the control panel, to open the Style Select
window. Use the STYLE buttons to go directly to the selected
bank.
Press EXIT to exit from this page and go back to the previous
page without selecting any Style.
Bank groups

Side tabs (banks)

Lower tabs (pages)

Pads

Bank groups

Styles

Note: Depending on the status of the Auto Style Select parameter


(see page 234), a Style may be immediately selected when pressing
one of the STYLE SELECT buttons. The latest selected Style for that
bank will be selected.

Side tabs (banks)

Bank groups

Use these tabs to select one of the available pages in the selected
bank.

Selected group of banks.


Side tabs (banks)
Use these tabs to select a bank of Styles. Each tab corresponds to
one of the STYLE buttons on the control panel.

Use these tabs to select a bank of Pads.


Lower tabs (pages)

Pad
Press one of these buttons in the display to select a Pad. Unless
the DISPLAY HOLD LED is turned on, the window automatically closes short after you select a Pad.

Lower tabs (pages)


Use these tabs to select one of the available pages in the selected
bank.

STS Select

If you press again the same STYLE SELECT button on the control panel, the next page in the same bank is selected. This way,
you do not need to press one of the corresponding tabs in the
display in order to select a different page.

Use the four SINGLE TOUCH SETTING button on the control


panel, to select one of the four STS associated with the current
Style or the selected SongBook entry.

Styles
Press one of these buttons in the display to select a Style. Unless
the DISPLAY HOLD LED is turned on, the window automatically closes short after you select a Style.

Press the STS tab on the main page of the Style Play and Song
Play mode, or the Info tab on the SongBook mode, to see the
name of the available STSs.

Reference

Lower tabs (pages)

Selected group of banks, corresponding to different types of


Pads. Hit are single-note, pre-programmed factory Pads.
Sequence are sequence-based, pre-programmed factory Pads.
User can be either single-note or sequence-based Pads, and can
be user-recorded or modified.

76

Selecting elements
Song Select window

Directory

In Style Play and Song Play mode:

This is the list of the selected devices content.


File status

File size

Scrollbar

In SongBook mode:

Type of the
file or folder

Song Select window


This page appears when you press one of the Song areas in the
display, or one of the SELECT buttons in one of the
SEQUENCER sections on the control panel.
Press EXIT to exit from this page and go back to the main page
of the Song Play operating mode without selecting a Song.
Song path

Directory

Page menu
icon

File or folder
name

Modification
date

Use the scrollbar to scroll the list items.


As an alternative, you can select one of the items, and use the
TEMPO/VALUE controls to scroll.

Keep the SHIFT button pressed, and press DOWN or UP, to


jump to the previous or next alphabetical section.
A list can contain several different types of files or folders.
Type icon

File/folder type
Standard MIDI File (SMF)

Karaoke file (KAR)

MPEG Layer 3 (MP3)

Audio CD track
Storage device
Jukebox file (JBX)

While in this page, select a Standard MIDI File, Karaoke, or MP3


file (optional) for the selected Sequencer. A Jukebox file may
only be assigned to Sequencer 1.

Folder

Note: There is a separate working directory for each onboard


sequencer.
Song path
This line shows the current device path.

A file or folder may be in one of the following status. (See Protect and Unprotect on page 277 for information on how to
change the file status).
Status icon

File/folder status
Protected

Unprotected

Page menu icon


Press the page menu icon to open the menu. See Song Select
page menu on page 77 for more information.

Selecting elements
Song Select window

Storage device
Use this pop-up menu to select one of the available storage
devices.
Device

Type

FD

Floppy disk

HD

Hard disk (optional of the Pa1X)

CD

CD (optional)

Open

77

Note: If no Song corresponds to the dialed number, the Song not


available message will appear.
Warning: While the directory may contain more than 9999 files,
you cant select Songs outside the 0001-9999 range when using the
numeric keypad.

Song Select page menu


Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.

Opens the selected folder (item whose icon looks like this one:
).
Close
Closes the current folder, returning to the parent (upper)
folder.
Sync P. (Synchronized Path)

Export Song List


Select this command to save the current list as a text file to a
floppy disk. This way, you will be able to print a list of Songs, to
see which number matches each Song.

Press this button to see the Song assigned to the selected


Sequencer. This is useful to quickly return to it, after you have
browsed through long directories and dug into different folders.

1.

While in the Song Select window, select the folder whose


Song list you wish to save as a text file.

2.

Select the Export Song List command from the page menu.

Select

3.

A dialog box will appear, asking you to select either a floppy


disk or the hard disk.

4.

Select an option.

Selects the highlighted item in the display. If a Song is already


playing, it stops, and the new Song is ready to play. You are
returned to the main page.

When this button is pressed, all midifiles and MP3 files contained in the current directory are added to a new Jukebox list,
that is automatically assigned to Sequencer 1. The order in
which they are played depends on the current sorting method,
i.e., how the files are shown in the display.
You can use this Jukebox list as any other list of this type (i.e.,
start the playback with SEQ1 PLAY/STOP, jump to the next Song
in the list with SHIFT + >>, edit it in the Jukebox page).
Note: A Jukebox list can include up to 127 Songs. If your folder contains more items, only the first 127 will be considered.
Hint: If you dont want to lose the list when turning the instrument
off, go to the Jukebox page and save it to disk as a .JBX file.

Selecting a Song by its ID number


Each Song in a folder on disk (up to 9,999) has a progressive ID
number assigned. You can see this number before the Songs
name in the Song Select window. You can use this number to
select the Song by composing the corresponding number, speeding up the Song retrieval when you are using an hard disk filled
with midifiles.

While in the Song Select window, press the SELECT button to


open the keypad, and enter the number corresponding to the
Song to be selected.
While in any page of the Song Play mode, press the SELECT button twice to open the keypad.

If you select the floppy disk, insert a floppy disk in the


disk drive, and press OK to confirm.
If you select the hard disk, just press OK to confirm.
Note: The text file will contain a list of *.mid, *.kar, .mp3 and
*.jbx files only. Folders and different kinds of files will not be
included.
When saved, the text file will be named after the selected folder. For
example, a folder named Dummy will generate a Dummy.txt
file. If a file with the same name already exists on the floppy disk, it
will be overwritten without waiting for any confirmation. A file
containing the list of all valid files contained into the root of the disk
will generate a Root.txt file.
The list will include the progressive number assigned to each Song,
file names in MS-DOS format (8.3), the total number of files in the
list.
For the correct display and printing of the list on a personal computer, use a fixed size (i.e., non-proportional) character in your text
editor.

Reference

Play All

78

Style Play operating mode


Start-up settings

Style Play operating mode


The Style Play mode is the boot-up operating mode. When in
this mode, you can play with Styles (i.e. automatic accompaniments), while playing with one to four tracks (Upper 1-3 and
Lower) on the keyboard. You can select different Sounds and
Effects by selecting Performances and STSs. A different Voice
Processor Preset may be selected by a Performance or STS. You
can also use the SongBook to automatically select Styles for a
desired music genre.

Start-up settings
Since Performance 1 of Bank 1 (Performance 1-1) is automatically selected when turning the instrument on, you can save to it
your preferred start-up settings.
Just select the Sounds, Effects, MIDI channels, Voice Processor
Preset, and other settings you would like to have automatically
selected when turning the instrument on, and select the Write
Performance from the page menu. When the Write Performance window appears, save the settings to Performance 1 of
Bank 1. (See Write Performance dialog box on page 98).
Note: If you like some settings are preserved even when selecting
different Performances, STSs and Styles, turn on the desired locks
to avoid changes to the selected parameters (see General Controls:
Lock on page 232). Save these locks to the Global (see Write Global - Global Setup dialog box on page 257).

How Styles, Performances and STSs are


linked together
Styles, Performances and STSs are linked in many ways.
When the SINGLE TOUCH LED is on, selecting a Style also
changes Keyboard tracks (STS 1 is automatically selected). Performance settings are overridden.
When the STYLE CHANGE LED is on, selecting a Performance
also selects a Style (the one whose number is memorized with
the Performance).
Current track settings can be saved either in a Performance, an
STS, or a Style Performance, depending on the page menu command you select.

Main page (Normal view)


This is the page you see after you turn the instrument on.
To access this page from another operating mode, press the
STYLE PLAY button.
To return to this page from one of the Style Play edit pages, press
the EXIT button.
Style area

Page header

Performance/
STS
area

Page menu icon

Keyboard
tracks
area

Sequen
cer 1/2
area
Panels

To switch between Normal view (Keyboard tracks, grouped


Style tracks and Mic/In controls) and Style view (individual
Style tracks), use the TRK. SEL. (TRACK SELECT) button.
(See Style Tracks view page and Volume panel starting
from page 80).

Page header
This line shows the current operating mode, transposition and
recognized chord.

Operating mode
name

Master Transpose
(in semitones)

Recognized
chord

Operating mode name


Name of the current operating mode.
Master transpose

Sty

Master transpose value in semitones. This value can be changed


using the TRANSPOSE buttons on the control panel.
Note: Transpose may be automatically changed when selecting a
different Performance or Style. It may also be changed when loading a Standard MIDI File generated with an instrument of the Korg
Pa series.
To avoid transposing, lock the Master Transpose parameter in the
Global (see General Controls: Lock on page 232), then write the
Global to memory (see Write Global - Global Setup dialog box
on page 257).

Style Play operating mode


Main page (Normal view)

79

Recognized chord

Performance/STS area

Displays the recognized chord, when you play a chord on the


keyboard. If no chord abbreviation is shown, no chord recognition mode has been selected by using the CHORD SCANNING
buttons (see page 11).

This is where the latest selected Performance or STS name is


shown.

Page menu icon

Selected Performance
or STS

Press the page menu icon to open the menu. See Page menu on
page 97 for more information.

Selected Performance or STS


This is the last selected Performance (PERF) or Single Touch Setting (STS).

Style area
This is where the Style name is shown, together with its tempo
and meter parameters.
Style name

To select a different STS, use the four SINGLE TOUCH SETTING buttons under the display.

Current
beat

Sequencer 1/2 area

Style bank

Current
tempo

This is where Songs assigned to the two onboard sequencers are


shown.

Current Style Element


measure

Song name

Style name
Currently selected Style. Press the Style name to open the Style
Select window. As an alternative, use the STYLE SELECT section
on the control panel.

Song name

Style bank

Name of Songs assigned to Sequencer 1 (S1) and Sequencer 2


(S2). You can select Songs while playing Styles, to have them
ready when switching to Song Play mode.

Bank the current Style belongs to.

The icon shows the type of the selected Song.

Style Element meter

Standard MIDI File, often abbreviated as SMF


(file extension: *.MID or *.KAR).

Meter of the current Style Element.

MP3 available with the EXBP-MP3 option


installed (file extension: *.MP3).

Current measure
Measure number of the current Style Element, that is currently
playing.
Current beat
Beat number of the current measure, that is currently playing.
Current tempo

Sty

Metronome tempo (from 30 to 250). Select this parameter and


use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to change the tempo.
As an alternative, you dont need to select this parameter; just
keep the SHIFT button pressed and use the DIAL to change the
tempo.
To recall the Tempo stored in the current Style, press the
DOWN/- and UP/+ buttons at the same time.
Note: Tempo may change while a Style Element is playing. Each
Style Element may contain Tempo Change data.

Audio CD Track available with the CDRW-1


option installed.
Only assignable to Sequencer 1. A Jukebox file (file
extension: *.JBX) can be assigned to Sequencer 1,
but its name is not shown in this area. The JBX
icon appears, together with the name of the currently selected Song in the Jukebox list.

Reference

Style Element meter

Press the name to open the Performance Select window. As an


alternative, use the PERFORMANCE/SOUND SELECT section
to select a different Performance.

80

Style Play operating mode


Style Tracks view page

Keyboard tracks area

Panels

This is where Keyboard tracks are shown.

The lower half of the main page contains the various panels, you
can select by pressing the corresponding tabs. See more information in the relevant sections, starting from page 81.

Tracks octave
transpose

Sound
name

Volume panel

Track name

Sound
bank

Track status

Sound name

Tabs

Name of the Sound assigned to the corresponding Keyboard


track.
If the track is already selected (white background), press the
Sound name to open the Sound Select window.
If the track is not selected (dark background), first select it,
then press the Sound name to open the Sound Select window.
Sound bank
Bank the current Sound belongs to.

Style Tracks view page


Press the TRK. SEL. button to switch from the Normal view to
the Style Tracks view. In this view, individual Style tracks are
shown in the lower half of the display, while the upper half of the
main page changes, to show parameters for the Style tracks.

Program Change
Program Change number. Shown only when the Show Program
Change number parameter is turned on in Global mode. (See
page 234).

Selected track
info area

Keyboard track name

Sounds area

Non editable. Name of the corresponding track:


UP1

Upper 1

UP2

Upper 2

UP3

Upper 3

LOW

Lower

Press TRK. SEL. again to return to the Normal view (Keyboard


tracks, grouped Style tracks, Mic/In controls).

Keyboard track octave transpose

Original Style Sounds

Non editable. Octave transpose of the corresponding track. To


individually edit the octave transpose for each track, go to the
Mixer/Tuning: Tuning edit page (see page 86).

This parameter lets you select different Sounds for the Style
tracks, other than those recorded in each Style Element pattern.
Sounds assigned when this parameter is checked are shown in
the Sounds area of this page.

You can also transpose all Upper tracks by using the UPPER
OCTAVE buttons on the control panel.
Keyboard track status
Play/mute status of the current track. Select the track, then press
this area to change the track status.

Note: This parameter can be saved with the Performance or Style


Performance, and is automatically set to On or Off when you select
a different Performance or Style, depending on its saved status.
On

Style tracks always use the original Sounds


recorded in each Style Element. If you assign a
different Sound to a Style track, this parameter is
automatically set to Off.

Off

You can assign different Sounds to each Style


track, and save them in a Performance or Style
Performance. This becomes the only tracks
Sound for all Style Elements.

Play status. The track can be heard.


Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
/

When the icon of the Lower track is framed in


yellow, the Bass & Lower Backing function is
active (see page 96).

Sty

81

Style Play operating mode


Volume panel

Selected Track Info area


This line lets you see the Sound assigned to the selected track.
Not only it is shown on the main page, but also in several edit
pages.

Track name

Press the Volume tab to select this panel. This is where you can
set the volume of each track, and mute/unmute tracks.
Use the TRK. SEL. (TRACK SELECT) button to switch from
Normal view (Keyboard and grouped Style tracks, Mic/In controls) to Style Tracks view (Style tracks).

Sound bank
Sound name

Volume panel

Program Change

If the VOLUME LED over the SLIDER MODE button is turned


on, the Assignable Sliders LEDs show which view is currently
selected.

Track name
Name of the selected track.
Sty

Sound name

Sound assigned to the selected track. Press anywhere in this area


to open the Sound Select window, and select a different Sound.

The Normal view shows grouped Style tracks, Mic/In controls,


Keyboard tracks (upper sliders LED turned on):

Sty

Sound bank
Bank the selected Sound belongs to.

Sty

Program Change

Program Change number. Shown only when the Show Program


Change number parameter is turned on. (See page 234).

The Style Tracks view shows individual Style tracks (lower sliders LED turned on):

Sounds area
This area lets you see Sounds and octave transposition for the
eight Style tracks.

Track status icon

Virtual slider

Sound name

Virtual sliders (track volume)


Style tracks octave transpose

Sty

Non editable. Octave transpose of the corresponding track. To


edit the octave transpose, go to the Mixer/Tuning: Tuning edit
page (see page 86).
Sound name
Name of the Sound assigned to the track. Touch a name a first
time to select the corresponding track (detailed information are
shown on the Selected Track Info area, see above). Touch it a second time to open the Sound Select window.

Sty

Virtual sliders are a graphical display of each tracks volume. Use


the Assignable Sliders to change this value (provided the VOLUME LED is turned on above the SLIDER MODE button, see
below).
As an alternative, press the tracks area to select a track, and use
TEMPO/VALUE controls to change the value.
Assignable Sliders function
Use the SLIDER MODE button to select the function assigned to
the Assignable Sliders. When the VOLUME LED is turned on,
each Assignable Slider controls the volume of the corresponding
track.

Reference

Octave icon

82

Style Play operating mode


STS Name panel

The assigned function may be saved to a Performance or STS.


Therefore, when selecting a Performance or STS, the assigned
function may change.
Track status icons

Sty

Mic panel
Press the Mic tab to select this panel. This is where you can turn
on/off the various Voice Processor sections.

Play/mute status of the current track. Select the track, then press
the track area again to change its status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
Track names
Under the sliders, a label for each track is shown. Use the TRK.
SEL button to switch between the various track views.
MIC/IN

Audio inputs. [*]

UPPER13 Upper tracks.

Harm/Mod (Harmony/Modeling)

VPp

Turns the Harmony or Modeling module on/off. (The Modeling


module is optional).
Lead

LOWER

Lower track.

ACCOMP

Grouped Accompaniment tracks. [*]

DR/PERC

Grouped Drum and Percussion tracks. [*]

BASS

Bass Style track.

DRUM

Drum Style track.

V1V4

PERC

Percussion Style track.

Turns each of the four Harmony voices on/off.

ACC15

Accompaniment Style tracks.

VPp

Turns the Lead (singers) voice on/off. This switch only works
when the Harmony module is turned on. if it is turned off, the
Lead voice will be always heard, whichever the status of this
switch.

Pitch

VPp

VPp

[*] Volume for these tracks is not memorized.

Turns the Pitch Correct module on/off. (The Pitch Correction


module is optional).

STS Name panel

Thicken

VPp

Turns the Thicken module on/off.


Press the STS Name tab to select this panel. While in this panel,
you can see the name of the four Single Touch Settings (STS)
belonging to the latest selected Style or SongBook entry. Touch
one of the names to select the corresponding STS.

Effects

VPp

Turns the Effects module on/off.


Talk

Tlk

Check this switch to soften all music generated by the Pa1X, and
speak on the microphone at normal level. This is useful to speak
with your audience, while automatically lowering the background music volume.
Note: You cannot edit STS names with this panel. To edit a name,
select the STS to be renamed, then select the Write Single Touch
Setting command from the page menu (see Write Single Touch
Setting dialog box on page 98).

While this switch is checked, all Voice Processor modules are


momentarily turned off, except for Thicken and Reverb, whose
level is simply reduced to avoid losing clarity on the voice. Setting for the Talk function can be programmed on the Talk page
(see Voice Processor Setup: Talk on page 244).
Uncheck this switch to return to the original settings.
Mic Mute
Check this switch to completely mute the microphone input.
This is the same as the MIC/IN Play/Mute icon in the Main page
(see Track status icons on page 82).
VP Preset
Use this pop-up menu to select one of the available Voice processor Presets. Selecting a Preset may change all the above parameters, as well as other Voice Processor parameters. Presets can be
freely edited (see Voice Processor Preset: Preset on page 245).

Style Play operating mode


Sub-Scale panel

VP lock icon

Gbl

This lock avoids changing the Voice Processor Preset when


selecting a different Performance, STS or SongBook entry. This
is useful if you want to use the same Preset while selecting different Performances, STSs or SongBook entries.
This lock is reset when turning the instrument off, unless you
write Global settings to memory (see Write Global - Global
Setup dialog box on page 257).
For more information on parameter locks, see General Controls: Lock on page 232.

83

This lock is reset when turning the instrument off, unless you
write Global settings to memory (see Write Global - Global
Setup dialog box on page 257).
For more information on parameter locks, see General Controls: Lock on page 232.

Split panel
Press the Split tab to select this panel. This is where you can set
the split point and Chord Recognition mode.

Sub-Scale panel
Press the Sub-Scale tab to select this panel. This panel replicates
the Mixer/Tuning: Sub Scale edit page (see page 86).
Split Point
Use this parameter to select a different split point. A full-range
piano keyboard is shown in the display, divided at the selected
split point. Upper tracks play on the right of this point, while the
Lower track plays on the left.
Keyboard diagram

Press the Pad tab to select this panel. This is where you can
assign a different Hit or Sequence Pad to each of the four pads,
and see at a glance how pads are programmed. For more
options, go to the Pad/Switch: Pad page (see page 94).

Chord Recognition Mode


This parameter allows you do decide how chords are recognized
by the auto-accompaniment engine. Please note that when in
Full or Upper Chord Scanning mode, the Fingered 3 mode is
always selected, and you must always play at least three notes, to
let a chord be recognized.

Pad
assignment
Older
sounds

Pad assignment

Touch anywhere on the keyboard diagram. A message will


appear, asking you to press the new split point on the keyboard
of your Pa1X (or to press the EXIT button to close the message
with no changes).

For more information on the various options, see Chord Recognition Mode on page 95.

SB

Name of the Hit or Sequence assigned to each Pad. Press the box
to make the Pad Select window appear (see Pad Select window
on page 75).

Note: This parameter is the same you can find in the Preferences:
Style Preferences page (see page 95).
Split Point and Chord Recognition lock icons

Older sounds

SB

To warrant compatibility with data generated prior to OS version 2.0, the name of the older sounds assigned to the Pads is
shown under each Pad assignment box. As soon as you select a
new Hit or Sequence, the name of the older sound disappears.
Volume D Send

When locked, Split Point and Chord Recognition mode remain


unchanged when selecting a different Performance or STS.
These locks are reset when turning the instrument off, unless
you write Global settings to memory (see Write Global - Global
Setup dialog box on page 257).
For more information on parameter locks, see General Controls: Lock on page 232.

SB

Volume, Pan, Send to the FX C and D values for each of the four
Pads.
Pads lock icon

Gbl

Gbl

When locked, assignements to the pads remain unchanged when


selecting a different Performance or STS.

Reference

Pad panel

84

Style Play operating mode


Edit menu

Parameters area

Edit menu
From any page, press the MENU button to open the Style Play
edit menu. This menu gives access to the various Style Play edit
sections.
When in the menu, select an edit section, or press EXIT or
STYLE PLAY to exit the menu and return to the main page. To
return to the main page, you can also select the Main Page menu
item.
When in an edit page, press EXIT or the STYLE PLAY button to
return to the main page of the Style Play operating mode.

Each page contains various parameters. Use the tabs to select


one of the available pages. For detailed information on the various types of parameters, see sections starting from page 84.
Tabs
Use tabs to select one of the edit pages of the current edit section.

Mixer/Tuning: Volume/Pan
This page lets you set the volume and pan for each of the Keyboard or Style tracks. Volume settings are the same as in the Volume panel of the main page.
Use the TRK. SEL. button to switch from the Keyboard to the
Style tracks, and vice versa.

Each item in this menu corresponds to an edit section. Each edit


section groups various edit pages, that may be selected by pressing the corresponding tab on the lower part of the display.

Grouped Style tracks

Edit page structure

Keyboard tracks

All edit pages share some basic elements.


Operating mode

Edit section

Page menu
icon
Selected
track info
Individual
Style tracks

Parameters
area

Upper Volume Link

Tabs

Operating mode
This indicates that the instrument is in Style Play mode.

This parameter allows you to define if changing the volume for


one of the Upper tracks, proportionally changes also the other
Upper tracks.
Note: This parameter is the same you can find in the Preferences:
Global Setup page (see page 96).
On

When changing volume to one of the Upper


tracks, volume for the other Upper tracks
changes in proportion.

Off

When changing volume to one of the Upper


tracks, only that tracks volume is changed. Other
Upper tracks are left unchanged.

Edit section
This identifies the current edit section, corresponding to one of
the items of the edit menu (see Edit menu on page 84).
Page menu icon
Press this icon to open the page menu (see Page menu on
page 97).

Sty

Sty

Pan
Track position in the stereo field.
L-64L-1

Left stereo channel.

85

Style Play operating mode


Mixer/Tuning: FX Send

Use the TRK. SEL. button to switch from Keyboard to Style


tracks, and vice-versa.

C0

Center.

R+1R+63

Right stereo channel.

Off

If the tracks output status is Left&Right (normal


setting), the direct (uneffected) signal is not sent
to the outputs; only the FX signal is heard for this
track.
If the track is sent to a separate output, no FX is
sent to any output.
To program the output status for each track, see
Audio Output: Sty/Kbd on page 239.
Sty

Volume
Tracks volume.
0127

MIDI value of the tracks volume.


Sty

Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

Send level (AD)

Mixer/Tuning: FX Send

0127

This page lets you set the level of the tracks direct (uneffected)
signal going to the Internal FX processors. The effect processors
included in Pa1X are connected in parallel, so you can decide
which percentage of the direct signal can be effected:

Track

Out L/R

Sty

Level of the track (direct) signal sent to the effect


processor.

Play/Mute icon

Sty

Tracks play/mute status.


Play status. The track can be heard.

In case you do not want to send a tracks direct signal to the output, but only the effected signal (as when using insert effects,
like Rotary, Distortion, EQ), just set the Pan to Off (see Pan
above):

Track

Out L/R

FX Processor
There are four Internal FX processors in Style Play mode (two
for Keyboard and Pad tracks, two for Style tracks). You can
assign them any kind of available effects, but we found it convenient to arrange them in the following way, for most of the
Styles, STS and Performances included with the Pa1X:
FX A

Reverb processor for the Style tracks.

FX B

Modulating FX processor for the Style tracks.

FX C

Reverb processor for the Realtime (Keyboard)


tracks.

FX D

Modulating FX processor for the Realtime (Keyboard) tracks.

Reference

Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

FX Processor

86

Style Play operating mode


Mixer/Tuning: Tuning

Mixer/Tuning: Tuning

Mixer/Tuning: Sub Scale

This page is where you can set the octave transpose and fine tuning for each track. Plus, you can program the Pitch Bend range
for each track.

This page lets you program an alternative scale for the tracks
selected with the Scale Mode parameter (see page 95). The

Use the TRK. SEL. button to switch from the Keyboard to the
Style tracks, and vice-versa.

remaining tracks (if any) use the basic scale set in Global
mode (see Main Scale on page 231).

Note: A different Scale can be associated to each Performance or


STS.
Note: Quarter Tone selection can be received by MIDI (i.e., by an
external sequencer or controller). Conversely, selection of Quarter
Tone settings can be sent by the Pa1X to an external MIDI recorder
as System Exclusive data.
Scale
Selected scale. See Scales on page 382 for a list of the available
scales. When selecting the User scale, the keyboard diagram on
the right becomes active (see How to fine tune each note of the
User scale below).
PB Sensitivity

Sty

These parameters show the Pitch Bend range for each track, in
semitones.
112

Maximum up/down pitch bend range (in semitones). 12 = 1 octave.

No pitch bend allowed.

Octave Transpose

Sty

This is the octave transpose value.


-3

Lowest octave.

Standard tuning.

+3

Highest octave.
Sty

Detune
This is the fine tuning value.
-64

Lowest pitch.

00

Standard tuning.

+63

Highest pitch.

Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

Key

This parameter is needed by some scales to set the preferred


key (see Scales on page 382).
Quarter Tone
Check the Quarter Tone parameter to make the keyboard diagram active. in the display, touch any note you want to lower a
quarter tone, making a big dot appear on the note diagram.
Touch the note again to make the dot disappear.

This control is momentary and not saved to memory, to allow


for fast scale alteration while playing. You can assign the Quarter
Tone function also to a footswitch, an EC5 switch or an Assignable Switch.
See below How to use the Quarter Tone function with a footswitch, EC5 switch or Assignable Switch for information on the
use of this function.

Sty

Keyboard diagram
When Quarter Tone is checked, or a User scale is selected, this
diagram allows you to modify each notes pitch.

87

Style Play operating mode


Effects: FX Select

Scale lock icon

Notes you pressed on step 2 are now lowered of a quarter


tone.

Gbl

When locked, Scale parameters remain unchanged when selecting a different Performance or STS.

4.

Press and release the Quarter Tone pedal again, without


playing any note. All pitches will be reset, and the scale
selected by the Performance, STS will be recalled.

This lock is reset when turning the instrument off, unless you
write Global settings to memory (see Write Global - Global
Setup dialog box on page 257).
For more information on parameter locks, see General Controls: Lock on page 232.

How to fine tune each note of the User


scale
When the User scale is selected, the keyboard diagram becomes
active. You can then change each note tuning in cents of a semitone (within a range of 99 cents, referred to Equal tuning). This
way, you can create a custom scale, you can save to a Performance or STS.

Reset the original scale.

Effects: FX Select
This page allows you to select the A/B (Style) and C/D (Keyboard and Pads) effects.

Fine tuning values

How to use the Quarter Tone function with


a footswitch, EC5 switch or Assignable
Switch
The Quarter Tone function allows you to program a custom
scale in realtime, for example those sudden scale change typical
of Arabic music. Changes are not saved anywhere, so the scale is
easily wiped-out when selecting a different Performance or
STS, or when pressing the Quarter Tone pedal again.
Note: You can create a custom scale, to be assigned to a Performance or STS, simply by selecting and editing a User scale, and
saving any change to a Performance or STS. See Scale above.

Sty

FX AD

Effects assigned to the corresponding effect processors. Usually,


A and C are reverbs, while B and D are modulating effects (chorus, flanger, delay). For a list of the available effects, see
Effects on page 329.
Effects from A to D can be saved to a Performance. Effect A/B
(Style tracks) can be saved to a Style Performance. Effects C/D
(Keyboard and Pad tracks) can be saved to an STS.
Sty

Wet/Dry

Mix between the effected (Wet) and direct (uneffected, Dry) signal.
Dry

Direct signal only.

Wet

Effected signal only.

You can assign the Quarter Tone function to a footswitch, a


Korg EC5 switch, or an Assignable Switch.

nn:nn

Percentage of Wet/Dry signal.

1.

B to A, D to C

Program a footswitch, one of the EC5 pedals, or an Assignable Switch, to be the Quarter Tone switch.
Simply go to the Global mode, and reach the Controllers:
Pedal/Switch or Controllers: EC5 page. There, you will
find the Pedal/Footswitch and EC5-AE parameters,
to which you can assign the Quarter Tone function.
While still in Global mode, select the Write Global-Global
Setup command from the page menu, to save these settings
to the Global (see Write Global - Global Setup dialog box
on page 257).

2.

Lower some note pitches.


Keep the Quarter Tone pedal pressed. The keyboard will
not play at this time. Press the notes you want to lower a
quarter tone. Release the pedal.

3.

Play with your new scale.

Sty

Amount of the B effect going back to the input of the A effect, or


of the D effect going back to the input of the C effect.
Mod.Track (Modulating Track)

Sty

Source track for modulating MIDI messages. You can modulate


an effect parameter with a MIDI message generated by a physical
controller.

Reference

After selecting the User scale, touch a note in the keyboard diagram, and use TEMPO/VALUE controls to adjust the selected
note tuning in cents.

88

Style Play operating mode


Effects: FX AD

Effects: FX AD

Track Controls: Mode

These pages contain the editing parameters for the four effect
processors. Here is an example of the FX A page, with the Reverb
Smooth Hall effect assigned.

This page lets you connect each track to the internal sound generator and to external MIDI devices. This is very useful to let a
Style track drive an external expander, or play a digital piano
with one of Pa1Xs Keyboard tracks. In addition, here you can set
the polyphony mode for each track.

Selected effect

FX parameters

Selected effect

Sty

SB

Select one of the available effects from this pop-up menu. This is
equivalent to the FX AD parameters found in the Effects:
FX Select page (see above).
Note: Effects can be different for each of the four editing pages.
FX parameters

Sty

SB

Parameters may be different, depending on the selected effect.


See Effects on page 329 for a list of available parameters for
each effect type.
Int./Ext. (Internal/External)
Wet/Dry

Sty

SB

Mix between the effected (Wet) and direct (uneffected, Dry) signal. This is the same as the Wet/Dry parameters found in the
Effects: FX Select page (see above).
Src (Source)

Sty

SB

Modulation source. To select the track generating this message,


see the Mod.Track (Modulating Track) parameters found in
the Effects: FX Select page (see above). For a list of modulation
source, see the Effects chapter.

Sty

Internal

The track plays the sounds generated by the


internal sound engine. It does not play an external instrument connected to the MIDI OUT.

External

The track plays an external instrument connected


to the MIDI OUT. The connected device must
receive on the MIDI channel associated with this
track on the Pa1X (see MIDI: MIDI Out Channels on page 238).
A track set to this status does not play the internal
sounds, therefore saving polyphony.
Instead of the assigned Sound name, the <external> remark is shown on a tracks area in the
Main page:

Control Change/Program Change area

If the Show Program Change name is checked


(see page 234), a strings of transmitted Control
Change and Program Change data is shown next
to the <external> remark. This will let you know
what the track is transmitting to the MIDI OUT.
In the following example, CC#0 is the Control
Change 0 (Bank Select MSB), CC#32 is the Con-

89

Style Play operating mode


Track Controls: Drum Volume

trol Change 32 (Bank Select LSB), PC is the Program Change:

CC#0

CC#32

In this page you can adjust the volume for each family of Drum
and Percussion instrument for the selected track. A list of families is shown below.

PC

When touching the Sound area, the numeric keypad appears, instead of the Sound Select window.
You can enter the Control Change/Program
Change bundle shown above, separating the three
parts with a dot (.). If entering just one of the
three numbers, a Program Change message is
sent.
Both

These parameters can be accessed only on tracks set in Drum


mode (see above). Use them on tracks with a Drum Kit assigned,
or you will not be able to hear any change.
Note: All values are referred to the value of the original Sounds.

The track plays both the internal sounds and an


external instrument connected to the MIDI OUT.
Sty

Type
Drum

Track Controls: Drum Volume

Drum/Percussion track. Set a track to Drum


mode if you wish to separately adjust the volume
and set a different output for each percussive
family of the assigned Drum Kit Sound. (See
Track Controls: Drum Volume on page 89, and
Audio Output: Sty/Kbd on page 239).
Note: Tracks set to Drum or Percussion mode, while
in Style Record (see Track Type on page 120),
cannot be edited here. This option appears in grey.
Other Style tracks cannot be set to Drum mode
here.
Tracks of this kind are polyphonic, i.e. they can
play more than one note at the same time.

Mono

Tracks of this kind are monophonic, i.e. each new


note stops the previous note.

Mono Right

A Mono track, but with priority assigned to the


rightmost (highest) note.

Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

Sty

Drum families
Kick

Kick drums volume.

Snare

Snare drums volume.

Tom

Toms volume.

HiHat

Hi-Hat volume.

Cymbal

Ride, Crash and other cymbals volume.

Perc.1

Low-pitched percussions volume.

Perc.2

High-pitched percussions volume.

EFX

Special effects volume.

Sty

Select
Use these buttons to select the track to edit. The button corresponding to the selected track turns green.
Reset Track
Press this button to reset all changes to percussive instrument
volumes in the selected track.
Reset All Tracks
Press this button to reset all changes to percussive instrument
volumes in all tracks.

Reference

Poly

90

Style Play operating mode


Track Controls: Easy Edit

Play/Mute icon

Sty

Tracks play/mute status.

Decay

Decay time. Time to go from the final Attack level


to the beginning of the Sustain.

Release

Release time. This is the time during which the


sound goes from the sustaining phase, to zero.
The Release is triggered by releasing a key.

Cutoff

Filter cutoff. This sets the sound brightness.

Resonance

Use the Filter Resonance to boost the cutoff frequency.

LFO Depth

Intensity of the Vibrato (LFO).

LFO Speed

Speed of the Vibrato (LFO).

LFO Delay

Delay time before the Vibrato (LFO) begins, after


the sound starts.

Play status. The track can be heard.


Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

How to adjust volume for a single Drum


Family
Here is a quick example of the use of the Drum Volume function.
1.

While in this page, press TRK. SEL. to see individual Style


tracks.

2.

Press the Select button, in the display, above the Drum


track.

3.

Press START/STOP to let the Style go.

4.

While listening to the Style, select the Cymb. knob, and use
TEMPO/VALUE controls to turn the volume completely
off.
Youll notice how all cymbals stops sounding.

5.

Press the Reset Track button in the display to recall the


original cymbals volume.

Select
Use these buttons to select the track to edit. The button corresponding to the selected track turns green.
Reset Track
Press this button to reset all changes to Sound parameters in the
selected track.
Reset All Tracks
Press this button to reset all changes to Sound parameters in all
tracks.
Play/Mute icon

Track Controls: Easy Edit

Sty

Tracks play/mute status.


In this page you can edit the main parameters of the Sounds
assigned to each track.

Play status. The track can be heard.


Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

Note: All values refer to the value of the original Sound.

How to adjust sound parameters for a single Sound


Here is a quick example of the use of the Easy Sound Edit function.
1.

If needed, while in this page press TRK. SEL. to see Keyboard tracks.

2.

Press the Select button, in the display, above the Upper 1


track.

3.

While playing on the keyboard to hear the Sound, select the


Cutoff knob, and use TEMPO/VALUE controls to turn its
value completely off.
Youll notice how the filter progressively cuts out high frequencies, making the sound darker and mellower.

4.

Parameters
Attack

Sty

Attack time. This is the time during which the


sound goes from zero (at the moment when you
strike a key) to its maximum level.

Press the Reset Track button in the display to recall the


original Cutoff value.

Style Play operating mode


Keyboard/Ensemble: Keyboard Control

91

Keyboard/Ensemble: Keyboard Control

Keyboard/Ensemble: Key/Velocity Range

This page lets you enable/disable the Damper and Expression


pedals, plus the Joystick, for each of the Keyboard tracks.

This page lets you program a key and dynamic (velocity) range
for each of the Keyboard tracks.
Key range is useful to create a set of Keyboard tracks playing in
different zones of the keyboard. For example, you may have
french horns and woodwinds playing in the center range of the
keyboard, while only woodwinds play on the higher range.
Velocity range is useful to create a sound made of up to three
dynamic layers, assigning each of the Upper tracks to a different
dynamic range.
As an example, you may assign the El.Piano 1 Program to the
Upper 1, and the El.Piano 2 Program to the Upper 2 track. Then,
set Upper 1 to [Bottom=0, Top=80], and Upper 2 to [Bottom=81, Top=127]. The El.Piano 1 will play when playing softer,
the El.Piano 2 when playing louder.

Damper
On

When you press the Damper pedal and release


the keys, the tracks sound is kept sustained.

Off

The Damper pedal is not active on any track set


to this status.

Joystick X
This enables/disables the left/right movement of the Joystick
(Pitch Bend, and sometimes a Sound parameters control; for
Pitch Bend settings, see Mixer/Tuning: Tuning on page 86).
Joystick Y
Top/Bottom Key (Key Range)
This parameter pair sets the Top and Bottom key range for the
track.
C-1G9

Expression
This parameters allows you to switch the Expression control on/
off on each individual Keyboard track. The Expression control is
a relative level control, always subtracted from the Volume value
of the track.
As an example, imagine you have a Piano sound assigned to
Upper 1, and a Strings sound assigned to Upper 2. If you turn
the Expression switch on on Upper 2, and off on Upper 1, you
can use a continuous pedal to control only the Strings volume,
while the Piano remains unchanged.
To program a pedal or Assignable Slider to act as an Expression
control, see Controllers: Pedal/Switch on page 235 or Controllers: Assignable Sliders on page 235. You can only assign this
function to a volume-type pedal, not to a switch-type one.
Assign the KB Expression option to the pedal or Assignable
Slider, then select Write Global-Global Setup from the page
menu to save the setting to the Global.
Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

Selected key.

Top/Bottom Vel. (Velocity Range)


This parameter pair sets the Top and Bottom dynamic range for
the track.
0

Lowest velocity value.

127

Highest velocity value.

Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

Reference

This enables/disables the front/rear movement of the Joystick


(Y+: Modulation, and sometimes a different Sound parameters
control; Y-: Various controls, or non-active).

92

Style Play operating mode


Keyboard/Ensemble: Ensemble

Echo

Keyboard/Ensemble: Ensemble
This page lets you program the Ensemble function. This function harmonizes the right-hand melody (played in realtime)
using the recognized chords of the left-hand.
Note: The Ensemble function only works in Style Play mode, with
the Split Keyboard Mode.

As the Repeat option, but with the repeated notes


fading away after the time set with the Feedback
parameter (see below).

Note Velocity
This parameter sets the velocity difference between the righthand melody and the added harmonization notes.
-100

Subtracted velocity value.

Tempo
Note: This parameter only appears when the Trill, Repeat or Echo
options are selected.
Note value for the Trill, Repeat or Echo Ensemble options. This
is in sync with the Metronome Tempo.
Feedback
Note: This parameter only appears when the Echo option is
selected.
This parameter sets how many times the original note/chord is
repeated by the Echo option.

Ensemble
Harmonization type.

Ensemble Track Assign

Duet

Adds a single note to the melody.

Close

Adds a closed-position chord to the melody.

Use these parameters to separately set Upper tracks for the


Ensemble function.

Open 1

Adds an open-position chord to the melody.

Off

There is no harmonization on this track.

Open 2

As the above, but with a different algorithm.

Normal

This track is included in the harmonization.

Block

Block harmonization very typical of jazz music.

Mute

This track only plays the Ensemble notes, but not


the original note.

Power Ensemble
Adds a fifth and an octave to the melody, as heard
in hard rock.
Fourths LO

Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.

Typical of jazz, this option adds a perfect fourth


and a minor seventh under the melody.

Play status. The track can be heard.

Fourths UP

As the above, but with notes added over the melody.

Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

Fifths

This adds a series of Fifths below the original


note.

Octave

Adds one or more octaves to the melody.

Dual

This option adds to the melody line a second


note, at a fixed interval set with the Note
parameter. When selecting this option, a transposition value appears (-24+24 semitones to the
original note).

Brass

Typical Brass section harmonization.

Reed

Typical Reed section harmonization.

Trill

When two notes are played on the keyboard, this


option trills them. If three or more notes are
played, only the last two are trilled. You can set
the trill speed by using the Tempo parameter (see
below).

Repeat

The played note is repeated in sync with the


Tempo parameter (see below). When playing a
chord, only the last note is repeated.

Style Play operating mode


Style Controls: Drum/Fill

93

selected. When Variation 4 is reached, an Inc


command will select Variation 4 again. When
Variation 1 is reached, a Dec command will select
Variation 1 again.

Style Controls: Drum/Fill


In this page you can select various general parameters for the
Style.

To Var.1To Var.4
Fill to Variation (->1, ->2, ->3, ->4) automatically selects one of the four available Style Variations at the end of the fill.
Fill Mode lock icon

Gbl

This lock prevents the Fill Mode being changed when selecting a
different Performance or Style.
This lock is reset when turning the instrument off, unless you
write Global settings to memory (see Write Global - Global
Setup dialog box on page 257).

Sty

Drum Mapping (Var.1Var.4)

The Drum Mapping lets you select an alternative arrangement of


percussive instruments for the selected Drum Kit, without any
additional programming. Just select a Drum Map, and some
percussive instruments will be replaced with different instruments.
Off

For more information on parameter locks, see General Controls: Lock on page 232.
Sty

Track status
Track play/mute status. Press these icons to change it.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

Standard mapping.

Drum Mapping 17
Drum Map number. Mapping 1 is soft-sounding, while mapping 7 is loud-sounding.
Sty

Kick and Snare Designation

The Kick Designation replaces the original Kick (Bass Drum)


sound with a different Kick of the same Drum Kit, while the
Snare Designation replaces the original Snare Drum sound with
a different Snare of the same Drum Kit.

Style Controls: Keyboard Range On/Off /


Wrap Around
In this page you can program the Wrap Around point, and turn
on/off the Keyboard Range included in each Style tracks.

Off

Original Kick or Snare.

Type 13

Kick or Snare replacing the original one.

Fill Mode (13)

Reference

Hint: Select different Designations while listening to the Style, and


see how they affect the Style. When you like the result, save your
setting to a Performance or Style Performance.

Sty

These parameters set a Variation to be automatically selected at


the end of each of the three available Fills (13).
Off

The same Variation, playing before selecting a


Fill, will be selected again.

V1&V2 V3&V4
The specified Variations will be alternatively
selected. For example, with the V1&V2 option,
Variation 1 and Variation 2 will be alternatively
selected after the end of the Fill.
Var.Up/Var.Down
The next higher/lower numbered Variation is
selected, in cycle. After Variation 4, an Up command will select Variation 1. After Variation 1, a
Down command will select Variation 4.
Var.Inc/Var.Dec
The next higher/lower numbered Variation is

Keyboard Range On/Off

Sty

This parameter is an on/off switch for the Key Range parameter


memorized into each Style Element track.
On

The Keyboard Range is considered provided it


has been programmed (see Style Element Track
Controls: Keyboard Range on page 119 in Style
Record mode). When a track goes over the lower
or higher Keyboard Range point, it is automatically transposed, to stay in the programmed
range.

Off

No Keyboard Range used.

94

Style Play operating mode


Pad/Switch: Pad

Sty

Wrap Around

Pan

The wrap-around point is the highest register limit for the backing track. The accompaniment patterns will be transposed
according to the detected chord. If the chord is too high, the
Style tracks might play in a register that is too high, and therefore unnatural. If, however, it reaches the wrap-around point, it
will be automatically transposed an octave lower.

Pan for each of the four Pad tracks.

The wrap-around point can be individually set for each track in


semitone steps up to a maximum of 12 semitones, relative to the
chord root set in Style Record mode (see Key/Chord on
page 107).

C Send

-64-1

Left stereo channel.

Center.

+1+63

Right stereo channel.

Send level to the C Internal FX processor (usually reverb) for


each of the four Pad tracks.

It is advisable to set different Wrap Around points for each track,


to avoid all tracks jump to a different octave at the same time.

D Send

112

Send level to the D Internal FX processor (usually modulating


effect) for each of the four Pad tracks.

Maximum transposition (in semitones) of the


track, referred to the original key of the Style pattern.
Sty

Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.

Pad lock icon

Gbl

This lock avoids selecting a different Performance or STS


changes also the Hit or Sequence Pads assigned to the Pads.
This lock is reset when turning the instrument off, unless you
write Global settings to memory (see Write Global - Global
Setup dialog box on page 257).

Play status. The track can be heard.


Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

For more information on parameter locks, see General Controls: Lock on page 232.

Pad/Switch: Pad
Pad/Switch: Assignable Switch
This page lets you select a different sound for each of the four
PAD buttons.

This page lets you select a different function for each of the four
ASSIGN. SWITCH buttons.

Pad
assignment
Older
sounds

Note: You can also assign different Sounds from the Pad panel of
the main page.
Pad assignment

SB

Name of the Hit or Sequence assigned to each Pad. Press the box
to make the Pad Select window appear (see Pad Select window
on page 75).
Older sounds

SB

To warrant compatibility with data generated prior to OS version 2.0, the name of the older sounds assigned to the Pads is
shown under each Pad assignment box. As soon as you select a
new Hit or Sequence, the name of the older sound disappears.
Volume
Volume for each of the four Pad tracks.

Switch 14
Each of the four ASSIGN. SWITCH buttons. Use these pop-up
menus to assign a function to each switch. See List of Assignable Switches functions on page 380.
Assignable Switch lock icon

Gbl

This lock avoids selecting a different Performance or STS


changes also the functions assigned to the switches.
This lock is reset when turning the instrument off, unless you
write Global settings to memory (see Write Global - Global
Setup dialog box on page 257).
For more information on parameter locks, see General Controls: Lock on page 232.

Style Play operating mode


Preferences: Style Preferences

Preferences: Style Preferences


In this page you can set various general parameters for the Style
play mode. Settings can be saved to a Performance, or STS.

Velocity Control

95

SB

Set this parameter to trigger one of the following functions simply by playing louder with your left hand. When playing with a
velocity value higher than the value set by the Velocity Control
Value parameter (see page 96), the selected function will be
activated.
This function only works in SPLIT Keyboard Mode, with the
LOWER or no Chord Scanning mode selected.
It does not work in FULL Chord Scanning mode, or in SPLIT
Keyboard Mode, with the UPPER Chord Scanning mode
selected.
Off

The function is turned off.

Break, Fill In 1, Fill In 2


When playing with a velocity higher than the
trigger value on the Lower track, the selected element is automatically triggered.
This parameter defines how chords are recognized by the autoaccompaniment engine. Please note that when in Full or Upper
Chord Scanning mode, the Fingered 3 mode is always selected,
and you must always play at least three notes, to let a chord be
recognized.
Note: This parameter is the same you can find in the main page
(see Split panel on page 83).
Fingered 1

Play one or more notes, according to the selected


Chord Scanning Mode. A full Major chord will be
recognized even if only a single note is played.

Fingered 2

You must always play three or more notes for a


full chord to be recognized. If you play just one
note, a unison will be played. If you play a suspended chord (a root+5th), a suspended chord
will be played. The full chord will be recognized
when you play three or more notes.

Fingered 3

One Finger

You must always play three or more notes for a


chord to be recognized. This option is automatically selected when selecting the FULL Chord
Scanning mode.
You can also compose a chord using a simplified
chord playing technique:
If you play only one note, a Major chord is recognized.
Play the root note, plus a white key on the left,
for a 7th. For example, play C3 + B2 for a C7.
Play the root note, plus a black key on the left,
for a Minor chord. For example, play C3 + Bb2
for a C minor.
Play the root note, plus a white and a black key
on the left, for a Minor 7th. For example, play C3
+ B2 + Bb2 for a C min 7.

Expert

This mode is an extension of the Fingered 2, adding rootless and slashed chord recognition, often
used in jazz, fusion, modern pop and light music.
This type of chord recognition is very useful to
play piano chords typical of jazz piano players.
You dont need to play the root note, doubling the
note already played by the bass track.

Start/Stop

You can start or stop the Style by playing harder


on the keyboard.

Bass Inversion
When playing with a velocity higher than the
trigger value, the Bass Inversion function will be
activated.
Memory

When playing with a velocity higher than the


trigger value, the Memory function will be activated.

Scale Mode
This parameter defines which tracks are affected by the selected
alternative scale (see Scale on page 86).
Keyboard tracks
The scale will only affect Keyboard tracks.
Upper tracks The scale will only affect Upper 1-3 Keyboard
tracks.
All Tracks

The scale will affect all tracks (Keyboard, Style,


Pads).

Memory Mode
This parameter sets the way the MEMORY button works.
Chord

When its LED is on, the MEMORY button keeps


the recognized chord in memory. When its LED
is off, the chord is reset when raising the hand
from the keyboard.

Chord + Lower
When its LED is on, the MEMORY button keeps
the recognized chord in memory, and keeps the
Lower track held until the next note or chord is
played. When its LED is off, the chord is reset
when raising the hand from the keyboard, and
the Lower track is not sustained.
Fixed Arr. + Lower
When its LED is on, the MEMORY button keeps
the Lower track held until the next note or chord
is played. When off, the Lower track is not sustained when raising the hand from the keyboard.
The chord is always kept in memory.

Reference

Chord Recognition Mode

96

Style Play operating mode


Preferences: Global Setup

Lock icon

Gbl

Style Change On By Default

Sty

All parameters in this page may be protected from selecting a


different Performance or STS.

This parameter allows you to define the status of the STYLE


CHANGE button at startup.

This lock is reset when turning the instrument off, unless you
write Global settings to memory (see Write Global - Global
Setup dialog box on page 257).

On

At startup, the LED of the STYLE CHANGE button will automatically turn on.

Off

At startup, the LED of the STYLE CHANGE button will stay off.

For more information on parameter locks, see General Controls: Lock on page 232.

Velocity Control Value

Sty

Preferences: Global Setup

Use this parameter to set a velocity value over which to automatically trigger the Style Start/Stop or select a Style Element (see
Velocity Control above).

In this page you can set various general parameters for the Style
Play mode.

Upper Volume Link

This parameter allows you to define if changing the volume for


one of the Upper tracks, proportionally changes also the other
Upper tracks.
On

When changing volume to one of the Upper


tracks, volume for the other Upper tracks
changes in proportion.

Off

When changing volume to one of the Upper


tracks, only that tracks volume is changed. Other
Upper tracks are left unchanged.

Bass & Lower Backing


Note: These settings are stored in the Style Play Setup area of the
Global file (together with all the other parameters marked with the
abbreviation through the manual). After changing these
settings, select the Write Global-Song Play Setup command from
the page menu to save them to the Global.
Sty

Midi Setup

On

MIDI channels for the Style Play mode can be automatically


configured by selecting a MIDI Setup with this parameter. See
MIDI on page 280 for more information on using MIDI Setups.

For detailed information on MIDI Setup settings, see MIDI


Setup on page 328.
Note: After selecting a MIDI Setup, you can go to the Global mode
and apply any change to each channel setting. To store these
changes to a MIDI Setup, while still in Global mode select the Write
Global-Midi Setup command from the page menu. All MIDI Setup
can be freely customized and overwritten.
Hint: To restore the original MIDI Setups, load the original Factory data again (downloadable from www.korgpa.com).
Performance/Sound Default

Sty

Performance banks and Sound banks share the same buttons on


the control panel. Use this parameter to define whether the PERFORMANCE SELECT or the SOUND SELECT LED must be on
when you turn the instrument on.

Sty

When the SPLIT Keyboard Mode is selected, and the Style is not
running, this function lets you play a simple accompaniment
with your left hand.

Sty

Note: To automatically select a MIDI Setup when entering the


Style Play mode, select the Write Global-Style Setup command
from the page menu.

Sty

If the Style is not playing, and you play chords


with your left hand, the Sound assigned to the
Lower track plays chord notes (even if the Lower
track is muted), and a Bass sound plays the chord
root. When you start the Style, the normal behavior is restored.
When the Bass&Lower Backing function is active,
the Play/Mute status icon of the Lower track is
framed in yellow (see Keyboard track status on
page 80).

Off

If the Style is not playing, and the Lower track is


muted, no sound can be heard when you play
with your left hand. If the Lower track is set to
play, you can hear the sound assigned to the
Lower track.

Style Play operating mode


Page menu

Page menu

97

See Write Global-Style Play Setup dialog box on page 99 for


more information.
Solo Track

Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.

Select the track to be soloed, and check this item. You will hear
only the selected track, and the Solo warning will flash on the
page header.
Uncheck this item to exit the Solo function.
The Solo functions works in a slightly different way, depending
on the selected track:
Keyboard track: The selected Keyboard track is the only track
you can hear when playing on the keyboard. All other Keyboard
tracks are muted. The status of the Style tracks is unaffected.
Style track: The selected track is the only Style track you can
hear. All other Style tracks are muted. The status of the Keyboard
tracks is unaffected.
Copy/Paste FX

Select this command to open the Write Performance dialog box,


and save most of the current control panel settings to a Performance.

You can copy a single, or all four effects, between Styles, Performances, STSs and Songs. To do this, choose the Copy FX and
Paste FX commands from the page menu of the Style Play,
Song Play or Sequencer modes.

See Write Performance dialog box on page 98 for more information.

To copy a single effect:


1.

Write Single Touch Setting

go to the page of the single effect you want to copy (FX A,


FX B, FX C, or FX D), or

Select this command to open the Write Single Touch Setting


(STS) dialog box, and save Keyboard track settings to one of the
Single Touch Settings (STS) of the current Style.
See Write Single Touch Setting dialog box on page 98 for more
information.

Select the source Song, Performance, Style or STS, then

go to the Effects > FX Select page, to copy all four effects.


This may be useful if you want to copy each of the four
effects into different Performances, Styles or STSs.
2.

Choose the Copy FX command from the page menu.

Write Current Style Performance

3.

Select this command to open the Write Current Style Performance dialog box, and save Style track settings to the Style Performance of the current Style.

Select the target Performance, Style or STS, then go to the


page of the single effect you want to paste (FX A, FX B, FX
C, or FX D).

4.

Choose the Paste FX command from the page menu.

See Write Single Touch Setting dialog box on page 98 for more
information.

To copy all four effects:


1.

Select the source Performance, Style or STS, then go to the


Effects > FX Select page, to copy all four effects.

2.

Choose the Copy FX command from the page menu.

3.

Select the target Performance, Style or STS, then go to the


page of the Effects > FX Select page.

4.

Choose the Paste FX command from the page menu.

Write Global-Style Setup


Select this command to open the Write Global-Style Setup dialog box, and save global settings that are unique to the Style Play
mode. These settings are programmed on the Preferences: Global Setup page (see page 96).

Reference

Write Performance

98

Style Play operating mode


Write Performance dialog box

Write Performance dialog box

Write Single Touch Setting dialog box

Open this window by selecting the Write Performance item from


the page menu. Here, you can save all track settings, the selected
Style number, various Style settings, and the selected Voice Processor Preset, to a Performance.

Open this window by selecting the Write Single Touch Setting


item from the page menu. Here, you can save Keyboard track
settings, and the selected Voice Processor Preset, to one of the
four single Touch Settings (STS) belonging to the current Style.

Parameters saved in the Performance are marked with the


symbol through the users manual.

Parameters saved in the STS are marked with the


through the users manual.

Name

Name

Name of the Performance to be saved. Press the


(Text Edit)
button next to the name to open the Text Edit window.

Name of the STS to be saved. Press the


(Text Edit) button
next to the name to open the Text Edit window.

Perf Bank

Current Style

Target bank of Performances. Each bank corresponds to one of


the PERFORMANCE/SOUND buttons. Use TEMPO/VALUE
controls to select a different bank.

Non editable. Settings are saved in one of the four STSs belonging to the current Style. This parameter displays the name of the
parent Style.

Performance

STS

Target Performance location in the selected bank. Use TEMPO/


VALUE controls to select a different location.

Target STS location. The name of the STS currently saved at the
target location is shown. Use TEMPO/VALUE controls to select
a different location.

Select button
Press this button to open the Performance Select window, and
select a target location.

symbol

Style Play operating mode


Write Style Performance dialog box

99

Write Style Performance dialog box

The DIRECT HD bank

Open this window by selecting the Write Style Performance item


from the page menu. Here, you can save Style track settings to
the Style Performance of the current Style.

You can expand the internal memory User Styles with nine additional banks residing on the hard disk (optional on the Pa1X
with speakers). When both LEDs of the leftmost STYLE button
are lit, the DIRECT HD banks are selected. No loading is
required.
Use the first nine STYLE bank buttons to select these banks.
Each bank can include up to 32 Styles; browse them using the
PAGE buttons.
The DIRECT HD Styles are contained in three folders, inside the
DIRECTHD folder you can find in the hard disks root. These
folders, automatically created by the Pa1X, have fixed names:

Parameters saved in the Style Performance are marked with the


symbol through the users manual.

Style Bank
Non editable. Bank of Styles the current Style belongs to. Each
bank corresponds to one of the STYLE buttons.

Folder name

DIRECT HD bank buttons

BANK123.SET

1, 2, 3

BANK456.SET

4, 5, 6

BANK789.SET

7, 8, 9

Creating the DIRECT HD banks

Current Style
Non editable. Name of the current Style.

There are two ways to create the DIRECT HD banks:

While in Style Record mode, you can write the new or


edited Style in the Direct HD banks, as an alternative to the
User Style banks. See the Style Record chapter for more
information.

While in Disk mode, you can save any Style into the
DIRECT HD folders. See below the relevant procedure.
More information on the disk procedures are in the Disk
chapter.

Write Global-Style Play Setup dialog box


Open this window by selecting the Write Global-Style play Setup
item from the page menu. Here, you can save various Style Preference settings (see Preferences: Global Setup on page 96), that
are saved to the Global file.

Note: The following procedure requires you overwrite the


User Style banks. Save these banks before proceeding, to avoid
losing important data.
1.

Press DISK and go to the Load page.

2.

Load three banks of Styles, to be transformed in DIRECT


HD banks 1, 2 and 3, into the USER01, USER 02 and
USER03 banks.

Parameters saved in the Style Play Setup area of the Global are
marked with the

Sty

symbol through the users manual.

Reference

Sty

100
3.

Style Play operating mode


The DIRECT FD bank

Go to the Save page.

The DIRECT FD bank


In addition to the internal memory and DIRECT HD Styles, you
can have DIRECT FD Styles, directly accessed from the floppy
disk.
Just insert a disk, with Styles contained in the DIRECTFD.SET
folder, and press the DIRECT FD Style bank button. The disk
drive will read the DIRECTFD.SET folders content, and will
give you direct access to the Styles (no loading required).
4.

While the All item is selected, press Open to open it. The
internal memory content appears.

Note: Reading from floppy disk may take some seconds, before the
Styles are shown.
When the Style Select window opens, browse through the
DIRECT FD Styles. There are up to 12 pages, and up to 96
DIRECT FD Style locations in a disk.
Note: Reading from floppy disk is a little slower than reading from
the internal memory or the hard disk. So, there is a chance that you
will have to wait some beats, before the selected DIRECT FD Style
is ready to play. The Style will start at the next beginning of measure.

Creating the DIRECT FD bank


5.

Select the Style folder, and press Save To, to make the target device directory appear.

To configure the DIRECT FD bank, create a DIRECTFD.SET


folder in the floppy disk, and save your Styles to this folder.
Note: The following procedures requires you overwrite the User
Style banks. Save these banks before proceeding, to avoid loosing
important data.
1.

Press DISK and go to the Load page.

Device popup menu

6.

If it is not yet selected, select the hard disk (HD), by using


the Device pop-up menu.

7.

The hard disk directory appears. Select the DIRECTHD


folder and press Open to open it.

8.

The DIRECTHD folder directory appears. Select the


BANK123.SET folder, and press Save to save the banks.

9.

Load other Styles into the USER01-USER03 banks. Save


them onto the BANK456.SET folder.

10. Load other Styles into the USER01-USER03 banks. Save

them onto the BANK789.SET folder.

Device popup menu

2.

Select a device where to load the Styles from, by pressing


the Device pop-up menu. Load three banks of Styles, to be
transformed to the DIRECT FD bank.

3.

Go to the Save page.

Style Play operating mode


The DIRECT FD bank

4.

While the All item is selected, press Open to open it. The
internal memory content appears.

5.

Select the Style folder, and press Save To, to make the target device directory appear.

101

Device popup menu

Insert the floppy disk in the disk drive.

7.

If it is not yet selected, select the floppy disk (FD), by using


the Device pop-up menu.

8.

Press New SET to create a new .SET folder.

9.

Press the
(Text Edit) button. When the Text Edit dialog box opens, name the new folder DIRECTFD. Press
OK to confirm.

Reference

6.

10. Press OK to close the Create New SET Folder, and return to

the floppy disk directory.


11. With the DIRECTFD folder selected, press Save To to

save the banks.


12. Press the DIRECT FD button in the STYLE SELECT sec-

tion, to gain direct access to the saved Styles.

102

Style Record mode


The Style structure

Style Record mode


By entering the Style Record mode, you can create your own
Styles, or edit an existing Style.

Each Style Element is made up of smaller units, called Chord


Variations (CV), but not all of them have the same number of
CVs. Variations 1-4 have up to 6 CVs each, while the other Style
Elements have only up to 2 CVs.

The Style structure

When you play on the chord recognition area (Lower, Upper or


Full, depending on the Chord Scanning section on the control
panel), the arranger scans the keyboard and determines which
chord you are playing. Then, depending on the selected Style
Element, it determines which Chord Variation (CV) should be
played for the scanned chord. Which Chord Variation corresponds to each scanned chord is a setting of the Style: the Chord
Variation Table. Each Style Element contains a Chord Variation
Table, whose prototype is the following:

The term Style relates with music sequences automatically


played by the arranger of the Pa1X. A Style consists of a predefined number of Style Elements (E) (Pa1X features twelve different Style Elements: Variation 1-4, Intro 1-3, Fill 1-3, Ending
1-2). When playing, these Style Elements can be selected directly
from the control panel, using the corresponding buttons.
To explain the Style structure, we can use a tree-structure, as
shown in the following diagram:

Chord

Pop Ballad

Chord Variations (CVs)


Variation 1-4

Intro 1-3, Fill 1-3, Ending 1-2

CV1 CV6

CV1 CV2

Maj
6

Variation 1
Variation 2

M7b5

um
rc
ss

Variation 3

Sus4

Variation 4

Sus2
M7sus4

Intro1

min
m6

c3
c4
c5
CV2

M7

CV1

m7

CV2

m7b5
mM7

Intro 2

CV3
Intro 3/C.In

7
7b5
7sus4

CV4
Fill 1

dim

Fill 2

dimM7

CV5
CV6

aug

Fill 3/Break
Ending 1

aug7
augM7
no 3rd

Ending 2

no 3rd, no 5th

After deciding what CV to play, the arranger triggers the right


sequence for each track. Since each sequence is written in a particular key (for example, CMajor, GMajor or Emin), the
arranger transposes it according to the scanned chord. Notes in
the sequence are carefully transposed according to the Note
Transposition Tables (NTT), to make them work fine with all
recognized chords. The NTT allows you to record just some
Chord Variations, and have all the notes play in the right place,
avoiding dissonances and transposing the pattern notes to the
notes of the recognized chord.
Going deeper into the Style structure, we can see that each
Chord Variation is made up of Track Sequences, and the Pa1X
supports 8 different tracks. DRUM and PERC are used for drum
and percussion sequences, BASS for bass and ACC1-5 are for

Style Record mode


Style Import/Export

accompaniment sequences (string, guitar, piano or other accompaniment instruments).


Just to summarize, when you play a chord on the chord recognition area, the arranger determines which Style Element is used,
then determines which Chord Variation should be used for the
played chord, then Style sequences for every track of that Chord
Variation are transposed from the original chord to the recognized chord using the NTT, and so on every time you play a
chord.

103

Entering the Style Record mode


While in the Style Play operating mode, press the REC button.
The following page will appear in the display:

What to record
Recording a Style is a matter of recording tracks, inside a series
of Chord Variations, inside a series of Style Elements, inside the
Style itself.

Pattern data vs. track data

When editing an existing Style, the original Style Performance is recalled, but the following parameters are reset to
their default values: Drum Mapping (Off), Kick & Snare
Designation (Off), Original Style Sound (On), Keyboard
Range (On). This means that you can hear some differences
between the Style in play and the same Style being edited;
for example, resetting the Drum Mapping may lead to
some instruments being replaced.

While the Style Record mode is where you can create or edit
music patterns for the Style, track parameters (like Sounds, Volume, Pan, Octave Transpose, FX settings) have to be edited in
Style Play mode.

After creating or editing music patterns in Style Record


mode, save them by selecting the Write Style command
from the page menu of the Style Record mode (see Write
Style dialog box on page 123).
After editing track parameters in Style Play mode, save
them to the Style Performance by selecting the Write Style
Performance command from the page menu of the Style
Play mode (see Write Style Performance dialog box on
page 99).

Style Import/Export
As an alternative to creating Styles on the Pa1X, you can use
Korgs Style To Midi application to import a Standard MIDI
Files (SMF) from your computer to a Pa1Xs Style. The application is freely downloadable from www.korgpa.com. Please read
the included instructions.

Select Record/Edit Current Style to edit the current Style.


If it is a Factory Style, you may not be able to save it at the
original location (depending on the status of the Factory
Style and Pad Protect parameter, see page 272); you will
select a User Style instead.

Select Record New Style to start from a new, empty Style. A


default Style Performance will be recalled. When finished
recording, you will save the new Style onto a User Style
location. (Styles can be saved onto Factory Style locations
only when the Factory Style and Pad Protect parameter is
set to On see page 272).

After editing the Style, please save it (see Exit by saving or deleting changes below) and exit the Style Record mode. Then, while
in Style Play mode, edit the Style Performance to adjust track
settings (Tempo, Volume, Pan, FX Send see page 84 and following in the Style Play operating mode chapter) and save it by
selecting the Write Current Style Performance from the page
menu (see Write Style Performance dialog box on page 99).
Note: After a record or edit operation, the memory is automatically reorganized. Therefore, when you press START/STOP
there is a delay before you can actually listen to the Style. This
delay is higher with a Style containing more MIDI events.
Note: While in Record mode, the footswitch and EC5 pedals are
disabled. On the contrary, volume/expression-type pedals can
be used.

Reference

You dont need to record all Chord Variations for all Style Elements. It is often only needed to record just a Chord Variation
for each Style Element. Exceptions are the Intro 1 and Ending 1,
where we suggest to record both a Major and minor Chord Variations.

104

Style Record mode


Exit by saving or deleting changes

Exit by saving or deleting changes

List of recorded events

When finished editing, you can save your Style in memory, or


abort any change.

The Style Record mode filters out some events that may cause
wrong operation of the Style. Here are the recorded events, and
the most important filtered-out events.

To save changes, select the Write Style command from the


page menu (see Write Style dialog box on page 123).
To abort all changes, select the Exit from Record command
from the page menu, or press the REC button, to exit from
record and return to the main page of the Style Record mode.
Hint: Save often while recording, to avoid accidentally losing your
Style.

Control function

CC# (Control Change Number)


Allowed

Note On
Note Off (a)
Pitch Bend
Modulation 1

Modulation 2

Pan

10

Expression

11

While you are in Style Record mode, you can listen to the
selected Chord Variation or to the whole Style, depending on
the page you are in.

CC#12

12

CC#13

13

Damper

64

To select a Chord Variation, go to the Main page of the Record/


Edit mode (see Element (Style Element) and Chord Var
(Chord Variation) on page 105).

Filter Resonance

71

Low Pass Filter Cutoff

74

CC#80

80

CC#81

81

CC#82

82

Listening to the Style while in Edit mode

When you are in the Main, Event Edit, Quantize, Transpose, Velocity, or Delete pages, you can listen to the
selected Chord Variation. Press START/STOP to check
how it works. Press START/STOP again to stop the playback.

Not allowed
Program Change
After Touch

When you are in the Sounds/Expression, Keyboard


Range, Chord Table, Trigger/Tension, Delete All, Copy,
Style Element Controls or Style Control pages, you can
listen to the whole Style. Press START/STOP and play
some chords to do your tests. Select any Style Element
using the control panel buttons (VARIATION 1-4,
INTRO 1-2, FILL 1-2, ENDING 1-2). Press START/STOP
again to stop the playback.

(a). A Note Off will always be inserted at the end of the Chord Variation.

Note: While in Style mode, the Fingered 3 Chord Scanning


mode is automatically selected.

All allowed controllers can be assigned to an Assignable Pedal/


Slider/Switch.

Volume

All other Control Change messages

Note: Some Control Change messages cannot be recorded directly


by using Pa1X integrated controls.

MIDI Control Change messaged inserted by using a software on an


external computer are imported when using the Style to Midi
application, available from www.korgpa.com.
Some controllers are reset at the end of the pattern.

Style Record mode


Main page - Record 1

105

Measure number

Main page - Record 1

Current measure you are recording.

After pressing the REC button, and having chosen whether you
want to edit an existing Style or create a new one, the main page
of the Style Record mode appears, with the tab Record 1
selected.
Page sub-header

Page header

Page menu icon

Recording
parameters area

Recording parameters area


Element (Style Element)
This parameter lets you select a Style Element for editing. Each
Style Element corresponds to a button on the control panel carrying the same name. After selecting a Style Element, select a
Chord Variation for actual editing (see below).
Var1CountIn
This is the selected Style Element

Selected
track info
area

Chord Var (Chord Variation)


This parameter lets you select a Chord Variation for editing,
after selecting the Style Element this Chord Variation belongs to.

Key/
Chord
area

Note: When this parameter and the assigned value is in small letters (cv1cv6), the Chord Variation is empty; when it is in capitals
(CV1CV6), it is already recorded.
Track volume/status area

Page header
This line shows the current operating mode, transposition and
recognized chord.

If Style Element is Var1, Var2, Var 3 or Var4, you can select one
of 6 Chord Variations to edit.
If Style Element is Intro1, Intro2, Intro3, Fill1, Fill2, Fill3,
Ending1 or Ending2, you can select one of 2 Chord Variations to
edit.
Resolution

Use this parameter to set the quantization during recording. Quantization is a way of correcting timing errors;
notes played too soon or too later are moved to the nearest
axis of a rhythmic grid, set with this parameter, thus
playing perfectly in time.

Master Transpose
(in semitones)

Operating mode name


Name of the current operating mode.

Note: To quantize after recording, use the Quantize function in the


Edit section (see Style Edit: Quantize on page 114).

Master transpose
Master transpose value in semitones. This value can be changed
using the TRANSPOSE buttons on the control panel.

High

No quantization applied.

 (1/32) (1/8)
Grid resolution, in musical values. For
example, when you select 1/16, all notes are
moved to the nearest 1/16 division. When
you select 1/8, all notes are moved to the
nearest 1/8 division. A 3 after the quantization

Page menu icon


Press this icon to open the page menu. See Page menu on
page 123.

value means triplet.

Page sub-header
This area shows some performing info on the Style.

Style in record/edit

Beat counter

Measure number

Style in record/edit

No quantization

1/16

1/8

Name of the Style currently in edit or record.


Beat counter

Rec Length (Recording Length)

This indicator shows the current beat inside the current measure.

This parameter sets the recording length (in measures) of the


selected track. Its value is always equal to, or a divider of, the
Chord Variation Length (see next parameter).

Reference

Operating mode
name

106

Style Record mode


Main page - Record 1

This is not the total length of the Chord Variation, but just of the
current track. For example, you may have a Chord Variation
eight measures long, with a drum pattern repeating each two
measures. If so, set the CV Length parameter to 8, and the Rec
Length parameter to 2 before starting recording the Drum
track. When playing back the Style, saving it or executing any
edit operation on the Style, the 2-measures pattern will be
extended to the full 8-measures length of the Chord Variation.
Warning: If you assign CV Length a value lower than Rec
Length, the value of Rec Length is not immediately updated in
the display. Therefore, you are still free of changing the value of
CV Length, before the measures exceeding its value are deleted
(see warning in CV Length (Chord Variation Length) below).
However, if you press START/STOP to begin recording, the real
Rec Length value is changed to the new one, even if the display
still shows the old value.
For example, you may have CV Length = 4 and Rec Length = 4.
If you set CV Length to 2, and press START/STOP to begin
recording, Rec Length is still shown as 4, but it is in reality set to
2, and recording will cycle for just 2 measures. After you press
START/STOP to stop recording, Rec Length is updated to 2, and
all measures after the second measure are deleted.

Meter
This is the meter (time signature) of the Style Element. You can
edit this parameter only when the Style Element is empty, i.e.
before you begin recording anything.
NTT (Note Transposition Table)
The Note Transposition Table (NTT) determines how the
arranger will transpose pattern notes, when a chord is recognized that does not exactly match the original chord of a Chord
Variation. For example, if you only recorded a Chord Variation
for the CMaj chord, when a CMaj7 is recognized on the keyboard the arranger must transpose some notes to create the
missing 7th.
Note: To conform to Korg specifications, it is advisable to set the
NTT to No Transpose on the Intro 1 and Ending 1.
Root

The root note (in CMaj = C) is transposed to the


missing notes.

Fifth

The 5th note (in CMaj = G) is transposed to the


missing notes.

i-Series

All original patterns must be programmed on the


Maj7 or min7 chords. When loading old
Korg i-Series Styles, this option is automatically
selected.

NoTrnsp

No transposition applied. The pattern will always


play as recorded. This is the standard setting of
Intro 1 and Ending 1 in Korgs original Styles.

CV Length (Chord Variation Length)


This parameter sets the total length (up to 32 measures) for the
selected Chord Variation. When playing a Style, this will be the
length of the accompaniment pattern, when the chord corresponding to the Chord Variation is recognized on the keyboard.
Warning: If you reduce the Chord Variation Length after
recording, any measure after the selected length will be deleted.
Be very careful when setting the CV Length to a lower value
after recording! If it happens, we suggest to exit from record
without saving (see Exit from Record on page 123).

As recorded with
NTT = Root or 5th
(Key/Chord = CMaj)

When you play a CM7


with NTT = Root

When you play a CM7


with NTT = 5th

Metro (Metronome)

As recorded with
NTT = i-Series
(Key/Chord = CM7)

When you play a CMaj


with NTT = i-Series

When you play a C7


with NTT = i-Series

This is where you can set the metronome.


Off

No metronome click will be heard during recording. In any case, a one-bar precount will be
played before starting recording.

On1

Metronome on, with a one-bar precount before


starting recording.

Selected track info area

On2

Metronome on, with a two-bar precount before


starting recording.

This line lets you see the Sound assigned to the selected track.

Tempo

Track name

Select this parameter to use TEMPO/VALUE controls to set the


tempo.

Sound bank
Sound name

Hint: You can always change the Tempo, when other parameters
are selected, by keeping the SHIFT button pressed, and rotating the
DIAL.

Track name

Note: When recording tempo, old data is always replaced by the


new data.

DrumAcc5 Style track.

Note: The actual tempo of the Style will be the one shown when
saving the Style Performance in Style Play mode (see Current
tempo on page 79).

Sound name

Program Change

Name of the selected track.

Sound assigned to the selected track. The triangle means you can
press the name to open the Sound Select window, and select a
different Sound.

Style Record mode


Main page - Record 1

107

Sound bank

Delete Note button

Bank the selected Sound belongs to.

When a track is selected, you can use this command to delete a


single note or a single percussive instrument.

Program Change
Program Change number. Shown only when the Show Program
Change number parameter is turned on in Global mode. (See
page 234).

Key/Chord area

If the Style is playing, this shortcut deletes the instrument only


while the key is kept pressed, leaving all other notes untouched
within the track.

Tracks volume/status area


Virtual sliders

Key/Chord
This parameter pair allows you to define the tracks original key
and chord type, for the current Chord Variation. When in Style
Play mode, this chord will be played back exactly as it was
recorded, without any NTT processing (see above).
To record just one Chord Variation for a Style Element, the suggested original key/chord is maj7 (with NTT = i-Series). Be
very careful to play the 7th+ note (i.e., with a Cmaj7th key/
chord, the B), to avoid the lack of notes, or a bad NTT conversion when playing different chords.

Each virtual slider in the display corresponds to an Assignable


Slider on the control panel. Use the Assignable Sliders to change
each value, provided the VOLUME LED (over the SLIDER
MODE button) is turned on. This LED status depends on the
last selected Performance, but can be changed anytime by using
the SLIDER MODE button.

Note: To conform to Korg specifications, it is advisable to record


both the Major and minor Chord Variations for the Intro 1
and Ending 1 Style Elements.

In the example above, you will record the Acc1 track in the AMajor key, with notes pertaining to the A7th scale. This exact pattern will be recalled, when an A7th chord will be recognized.

As an alternative, press the tracks area to select a track, and use


TEMPO/VALUE controls to change the value.
Track status icons
Status of tracks. Press this icon to change the status.
Play status. The track can be heard.

Copy Key/Ch (Copy Key/Chord) button

Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

Press this button in the display to copy Key/Chord settings of the


currently selected track to all other tracks of the same Chord
Variation, or to the whole Style. This function is useful to speedup pattern programming, and to avoid having different tracks in
different keys within the same Chord Variation.

Record status. After starting recording, the track


will receive notes from the keyboard and the
MIDI IN connector.
Track names
Under the sliders, a label for each track is shown.
DrumAcc5 Shown Style tracks.

Current Chord Variation Tracks


The Key/Chord of the current track will be copied to all tracks of the current Chord Variation.
All Style Tracks
The Key/Chord of the current track will be copied to all tracks of the Style (i.e., all Chord Variations).

Reference

When you select a track, the original key/chord assigned to the


selected track will be shown. All recorded tracks will play back
on that key/chord. For example, if the original key/chord for the
Acc1 track is A7th, when selecting the Acc1 track all the remaining tracks will play on the A7th key/chord.

108

Style Record mode


Main page - Record 2

Main page - Record 2

Style Record procedure

While in the main page, press the Record 2 tab to see this page.
Most parameters in this page are the same as in Main page Record 1. In addition, here you can see and select Sounds for
each Style track.

There are two different methods for recording a Style: Realtime


and Step.

Realtime Recording allows you to record Style patterns in


realtime.

Step Recording allows you to create a new Style by entering


single notes or chords in each track. This is very useful
when transcribing an existing score, or needing a higher
grade of detail, and is particularly suitable to create drum
and percussion tracks.

Sounds
area

Preparing to record
1.

If you like to edit an existing Style, select that Style.

2.

Press the REC button to enter the Style Record mode. You
are prompted to select either the Current Style, or a New
Style.

Sounds area

Select record/edit Current Style if you want to edit the


current Style, or make a new Style starting from an existing
one. Select Record New Style if you want to start from
scratch with an empty Style.

This area lets you see Sounds and octave transposition for the
eight Style tracks.

Octave icon

Sound name

3.

After you select your preferred option, the main page of the
Style Record mode will appear.

4.

Select the Element (Style Element) and Chord Var (Chord


Variation) parameters, to select the Chord Variation to be
recorded/edited.

Octave icon
Non editable. This indicator shows the tracks octave transposition. To change this value, go to the Mixer/Tuning: Tuning edit
page in the Style Play mode (see page 86). Save this value to the
Style Performance.
Sound name
Name of the Sound assigned to the track. Touch a name a first
time to select the corresponding track (detailed information are
shown on the Selected Track Info area, see above). Touch it a second time to open the Sound Select window.
Note: These Sounds can be replaced by Sounds selected by a Performance, provided the Original Style Sounds parameter is left
unchecked in Style Play mode (see page 80).

Note: For more information on the Style Elements and Chord


Variations, and the Style structure in general, see The Style
structure on page 102.
5.

Use the Rec Length (Recording Length) parameter to set


the length (in measures) of the pattern to record.

6.

Use the Meter parameter to set the Style Elements meter.


Note: You can edit this parameter only if you selected the
Record New Style option when entering the Record mode,
or when editing an empty Chord Variation.

7.

Select the Tempo parameter and set the tempo.

8.

Press the Record 2 tab to see the Sounds area. Here you can
assign the right Sound to each Style track. You cannot select
Digital Drawbars Sounds. (For more details, see Sounds
area on page 108).

9.

If needed, set the Octave Transpose for each track. Note:


The Octave Transpose will affect only the notes coming from
the keyboard, and not from the arranger.

10. At this point, if you want to do a Realtime Recording go on

reading Realtime Record procedure below. Otherwise, if


you prefer to do a Step Record, jump to Step Record procedure on page 109.

Style Record mode


Style Record procedure

109

Realtime Record procedure

Step Record procedure

1.

Select the track to record. Its status icon will turn to


Record. (For more details, see Tracks volume/status area
on page 107).

1.

While in the main page of the Style Record mode, select the
Overdub Step Recording command from the page menu,
to enter the Overdub Step Record mode.

Note: When entering the Record mode, the last selected


track is already in Record status. When you press START/
STOP after entering the Record mode, you can immediately start recording.

2.

The Pos parameter shows the current position.


If you do not want to insert a note or chord at the current
position, insert a rest instead, as shown in step 4.
To jump to the next measure, filling the remaining beats
with rests, press the Next M. button in the display.

If you like, you can try your part before recording:


the

3.

To change the step value, use the Step Time values area in
the display.

4.

Insert a note, rest or chord at the current position.

(Mute) status icon appears.

Press START/STOP to let any recorded track play back,


and practice on the keyboard.

To insert a single note, just play it on the keyboard. The


inserted note length will match the step length. You may
change the velocity and relative duration of the note, by
editing the Duration and Velocity parameters (see
page 125).

When you have finished practicing, press START/STOP to


stop the arranger, and unmute the track by repeatedly
pressing its icon status, until the
appears again.
2.

(Record) status icon

While the shown status icon is Record, press START/STOP


to begin recording. Depending on the Metro (metronome) option you selected, a 1- or 2-bars precount may
play before the recording actually begins. When it begins,
play freely. The pattern will last for some measures, according to the Rec Length value, then restart.

To insert a rest, just press the Rest button in the display. Its
length will match the step value.

Since the recording will happen in overdub, you can add


notes on any following passage. This is very useful to record
different percussive instruments at any cycle on a Drum or
Percussion track.

To insert a chord or a second voice, see Chords and second voices in Step Record mode below.

Note: While recording, tracks Keyboard Range (see


page 119) is ignored, and the track can play over the whole
keyboard range. The Local parameter (see Local Control
On on page 237) is also automatically set to On, to allow
playing on the keyboard.
3.

To tie the note to be inserted to the previous one, press the


Tie button in the display. A note will be inserted, tied to the
previous one, with exactly the same name. You dont need
to play it on the keyboard again.

5.

After inserting a new event, you may go back by pressing


the Back button in the display. This will delete the previously inserted event, and set the step in edit again.

6.

When the end of the pattern is reached, the End of Loop


event is shown, and the recording restarts from the
001.01.000 position. Any note exceeding the pattern
length, inserted at its end, will be reduced to fit the total
length of the pattern.

When finished recording, press START/STOP to stop the


arranger. Select a different track, and go on recording the
full Chord Variation.

At this point, you may go on, inserting new events in overdub mode (the previously inserted events will not be
deleted). This is very useful when recording a drum or percussion track, where you may want to record the bass drum
on a first cycle, the snare drum on the second cycle, and the
hi-hat and cymbals during the following cycles.

Note: You can select a different track only when the arranger
is not running.
4.

When finished recording the Chord Variation, select a different Chord Variation or Style Element to go on recording
the full Style.

5.

When finished recording the new Style, select the Write


Style command from the page menu, to open the Write
Style dialog box (see Write Style dialog box on page 123)
and save it to memory.
To exit the Style Record mode without saving any change,
select the Exit from Record command from the page
menu.

7.

When finished recording, press the Done button in the display to exit the Step Record mode.
When back to the main page of the Style Record mode, you
may turn all tracks to the play status, then press START/
STOP to listen to the Style. Press START/STOP again to
stop the playback.

8.

From the main page of the Style Record mode, select either
the Write Style or the Exit from Record command to
exit from the Style record mode, respectively by saving the
Style to memory, or by canceling any change (see Write
Style dialog box on page 123).

Reference

Mute the track, by repeatedly pressing its icon status, until

Style Record mode


Style Record procedure

Chords and second voices in Step Record


mode

Ex.2:

You are not obliged to insert single notes in a track. There are
several ways to insert chords and double voices. Lets look at
some.

Step Time =

1.

Edit the first notes Velocity value.

2.

Press the first note and keep it pressed.

3.

Edit the second notes Velocity value.

4.

Press the second note and keep it pressed.

5.

Edit the third notes Velocity value.

6.

Press the third note, then release all notes.

On
Press C

Ex. 1:

Off
Release E (continue holding C)

Step Time =

On
Press G


Off
Release G and C

Off
Release G and C

On
Press F and C

Step Time =

Step Time =

Step Time =

Off
Release F
(continue holding C)

Step Time =

On
Press E and C

Step Time =

Off
Release G
(continue holding C)

Step Time =

On
Press G (continue holding C)

Ex.3:

Step Time =

Entering a second voice. You can insert passages where one note
is kept pressed, while another voice moves freely.

Step Time =
Tie

Entering a chord. Simply play a chord instead of a single note.


The event name will be the first note of the chord you pressed,
followed by the abbreviation.
Entering a chord made of notes with different velocity values.
You can make the upper or lower note of a chord, for example,
louder than the remaining ones, to let the most important stand
out from the chord. Here is how to insert a three-note chord:

110

On
Press E
(continue holding C)

On
Press G
(continue holding C)

On
Press D
(continue holding C)

Step Time =

Off
Release E and C

Step Time =

Off
Release D
(continue holding C)

Style Record mode


Edit menu

111

Other pages have a slightly different structure.

Edit menu

Operating mode

Edit section

Page menu
icon

From any page (apart for Step Record), press the MENU button
to open the Style Record edit menu. This menu gives access to
the various Style Record edit sections.
When in the menu, select an edit section, or press EXIT to exit
the menu and return to the main page. To return to the main
page, you can also select the Main Page menu item.

Parameters
area

When in an edit page, press the EXIT button to return to the


main page of the Style Record mode.

Track status
Tabs

Operating mode
This indicates that the instrument is in Style Record mode.
Edit section
This identifies the current edit section, corresponding to one of
the items of the edit menu (see Edit menu on page 111).
Selected Style Element
Note: While the Style is in play, you cannot access the Edit section
pages from the main page (see page 105). Stop the playback before
pressing MENU.
Note: When switching from the Edit section pages (Quantize,
Transpose, Velocity, Delete) to the other pages, or vice-versa, the
Style (if in play) is automatically stopped.

In Style Record mode, edits always happen on the selected Style


Element.
Page menu icon
Press this icon to open the page menu (see Page menu on
page 123).
Parameters area

Most edit pages share some basic elements.


Operating mode

Edit section

Track status

Selected Style
Element
Page menu
icon
Selected
track info

Parameters
area

Tabs

Use these buttons to mute/unmute tracks while editing.


Tabs
Use tabs to select one of the edit pages of the current edit section.

Reference

Each page contains various parameters. Use the tabs to select


one of the available pages. For detailed information on the various types of parameters, see sections starting from page 112.

Edit page structure

112

Style Record mode


Event Edit: Event Edit

Position

Event Edit: Event Edit

Position of the event, expressed in the form aaa.bb.ccc:

The Event Edit is the page where you can edit each single MIDI
event of the selected Chord Variation. You can, for example,
replace a note with a different one, or change its playing strength
(i.e., velocity value). See Event Edit procedure on page 113 for
more information on the event editing procedure.
Page sub-header

Page header

Page menu icon

aaa is the measure


bb is the beat
ccc is the tick (each quarter beat = 384 ticks)

You can edit this parameter to move the event to a different position. You can edit a position in either of the following ways:
(a) select the parameter, and use the TEMPO/VALUE controls
to change the value, or
(b) select the parameter, then touch it again; the numeric keypad will appear. Enter the new position by dialing in the
three parts of the number, separated by a dot. Zeroes at the
beginning can be omitted, as well as the least important
parts of the number. For example, to enter position
002.02.193, dial 2.2.193; to enter position 002.04.000 dial
2.4; to enter position 002.01.000, simply dial 2.

Event list

Track popup menu

Type, Value 1, Value 2

Tabs

Scrollbar

Type and values of the event shown in the display. Depending on


the selected event, the value may change. This parameter also
shows the (greyed-out, so non-editable) CC#11 (Expression)
event at the beginning of the pattern, and the End Of Loop
marking, when the end of a track is reached.

Page header
See Page header on page 105.

Page menu icon


Press this icon to open the page menu. See Page menu on
page 123.

Page sub-header
This area shows some performing info on the Song.

Event type

Value 1

Value 2

Note

Note name

Velocity

Ctrl

Control Change number

Control Change value

Bend

Bending value

To change the event type, select the Type parameter, then use the
TEMPO/VALUE controls to select a different event type. A set of
default values will be automatically assigned to the event.
To select and edit the events value, select the corresponding
parameter, and use TEMPO/VALUE controls.
Length

Selected track

Selected Style
Element

Selected Chord
Variation

Selected track
Name of the track in edit. Use the Track pop-up menu to select
one of the Style tracks.
SE/CV (Style Element/Chord Variation)
Selected Style Element and Chord Variation. This parameter
cannot be edited. To select a different Style Element and Chord
Variation, press EXIT to go back to the main page of the Style
Record mode (see Main page - Record 1 on page 105).

Length of the selected Note event. The value format is the same
as the Position value. This is only available for Note events.
Note: If you change a length of 000.00.000 to a different value,
you cant go back to the original value. This rather uncommon
zero-length value may be found in some drum or percussion tracks.
Scrollbar
Use the scrollbar to browse the event through the list.

Other elements
Track pop-up menu

Event list
Use the Event list to see all events contained in the selected track
in the selected Style Element.
Use the scrollbar to browse through the events. You can also
scroll by using the SHIFT + DIAL combination.
Touch the event to be selected. Selected events are highlighted
and can be heard.

Use this pop-up menu to select the track to edit, inside the current Chord Variation.
DrumAcc5 Style track.
Go Meas./Catch
This is a dual-function command.

Style Record mode


Event Edit: Event Edit

While the sequencer is not running, it works as a Go to Measure command. Press it to open the Go to Measure dialog box:

9.

113

Scroll though the various events by using the scrollbar.

10. Select an event to be edited by touching it in the display.

This is usually a note, that you can edit.

For more information on the event types and their values, see Event Edit: Event Edit on page 112.

While the sequencer is running, it works as a Catch Locator


command. Press it to show the event that is currently playing.
Insert
Press the Insert button in the display to insert a new event at the
current shown Position. The default values are Type = Note,
Pitch = C4, Velocity = 100, Length = 192.
Delete
Press the Delete button in the display to delete the event selected
in the display.

Event Edit procedure


Here is the general procedure to follow for the event editing.
1.

Select the Style to edit, and press the REC button. Select the
Current Style option to enter recording. The main page
of the Style Record mode will appear.

2.

Select the Element (Style Element) and Chord Var


(Chord Variation) parameters.

3.

4.

5.

11. Edit the event.

Select the M parameter. Use TEMPO/VALUE controls


to change the events position.
Select the Type parameter. You may use TEMPO/VALUE
controls to change the event type, as well as its Value 1 and
Value 2.
If a Note event is selected, select the Length parameter,
and use TEMPO/VALUE controls to change the events
length.
12. You may use the Go Meas. command to go to a different

measure (see Go Meas./Catch on page 112)


13. As described in step 4, you may press START/STOP to lis-

ten how the pattern sounds after your changes. Press


START/STOP again to stop the pattern running.
14. Press the Insert button in the display to insert an event at

the Position shown in the display (a Note event with default


values will be inserted). Press the Delete button in the display to delete the selected event.
15. When editing is complete, you may select a different track

to edit (go to step 7).


16. When finished editing the selected Chord Variation, press

Note: For more information on the Style Elements and Chord


Variations, and the Style structure in general, see The Style
structure on page 102.

EXIT to go back to the main page of the Style Record


mode, then go to step 2 to select and edit a different Chord
Variation.

Press MENU, and select the Event Edit section. The Event
Edit page appears (see Event Edit: Event Edit on page 112
for more information).

17. When finished editing the whole Style, select the Write

Press START/STOP to listen to the selected Chord Variation. Press START/STOP to stop it. Chord Scanning does
not work, so you will listen the pattern at the original Key/
Chord.
Press the Filter tab to select the Filter page, and uncheck the
filters for the event types you wish to see in the display (see
Event Edit: Filter on page 114 for more information).

6.

Press the Event Edit tab to go back to the Event Edit page.

7.

Use the Track pop-up menu to select the track to edit (see
Track pop-up menu on page 112).

8.

The list of events contained in the selected track (inside the


Chord Variation selected on step 2) will appear in the display. Some events on the beginning of the Chord Variations, as well as the EndOfTrk event (marking its ending
point) cannot be edited, therefore appearing in grey.

Style command from the page menu to open the Write


Style dialog box (see Write Style dialog box on page 123),
or select the Exit from Record command to cancel all
changes.
Press the
(Text Edit) button to enter the Text Edit
dialog box. Enter a name and confirm by selecting OK.
Select a target memory location where to save the Style.
The name of the Style already existing at the selected location is shown after the Style Bank-Location number.
Warning: If you select an existing Style and confirm writing,
the older Style is deleted and replaced by the new one. Save
the Styles you dont want to loose on disk, before overwriting
them.
18. Press OK to save the Style to the internal memory, or Can-

cel to delete any changes made in Style Record mode. When


the Are you sure? message appears, press OK to confirm,
or Cancel to go back to the Write Style dialog box.

Reference

When in this dialog box, select a target measure, and press OK.
The first event available in the target measure will be selected.

114

Style Record mode


Event Edit: Filter

Event Edit: Filter

Style Edit: Quantize

This page is where you can select the event types to be shown in
the Event Edit page.

The quantize function may be used to correct any timing mistake after recording, or to give the pattern a groovy feeling.

Turn On the filter for all event types you do not wish to see in
the Event Edit page.

After setting the various parameters, press Execute.

Note: Some of the events are ghosted, and non editable, since the
corresponding events are not editable in a Style.

Use this parameter to select a track.


All

Note/RX Noise

Control

Track

All tracks selected.

Notes and RX Noises.

DrumAcc5 Selected track.

Control Change events. Only the following Control Change numbers are allowed with Styles.

E / CV (Style Element/Chord Variation)

Control function

CC# (Control Change Number)

Use these parameters to select the Style Element and Chord Variation for editing.

Modulation 1

Resolution

Modulation 2

Pan

10

Expression(a)

11

CC#12

12

This parameter sets the quantization after recording. For example, when you select 1/8, all notes are moved to the nearest 1/8
division. When you select 1/4, all notes are moved to the nearest
1/4 division.

CC#13

13

Damper

64

Filter Resonance

71

Low Pass Filter Cutoff

74

CC#80

80

CC#81

81

CC#82

82

(a). Expression events cannot be inserted at the starting Position


(001.01.000). An Expression value is already among the default
header parameters of the Style Element.

Tempo/Meter Tempo and Meter changes (Master Track only).


Pitch Bend

Pitch Bend events.

No quantization

1/8

1/4

 (1/32) (1/4)
Grid resolution, in musical values. A bf character added after the value means swing-quantization. A 3 means triplet.
Start / End Tick
Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to quantize.
If a Chord Variation is four measures long, and you want to
select it all, the Start will be positioned at 1.01.000, and the End
at 5.01.000.
Bottom / Top Note
Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to quantize. If you select the same note as the Bottom and
Top parameters, you can select a single percussive instrument in
a Drum or Percussion track.

Style Record mode


Style Edit: Transpose

Note: These parameters are available only when a Drum or Percussion track is selected.
Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.
Track status icon
Status of tracks. Press this icon to change the status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

115

Bottom / Top Note


Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to be transposed. If you select the same note as the Bottom
and Top parameters, you can select a single percussive instrument in a Drum or Percussion track. Since in a Drum Kit each
instrument is assigned to a different note of the scale, transposing a percussive instrument means assigning the part to a different instrument.
Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.
Track status icon

Track names
Under the buttons, a label for each track is shown.

Status of tracks. Press this icon to change the status.


Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

Style Edit: Transpose


Track names
In this page you can transpose the selected track(s).
Note: After transposing, please dont forget to readjust the Key/
Chord parameter in the main page of the Style Record mode (see
page 107).

Under the buttons, a label for each track is shown.

Style Edit: Velocity


In this page you can change the velocity (dynamics) value of
notes in the selected track. An Advanced mode is available,
allowing you to select a velocity curve for the selected range.
This is useful to create fade-ins or fade-outs.

Reference

After setting the various parameters, press Execute.


E / CV (Style Element/Chord Variation)
Use these parameters to select the Style Element and Chord Variation for editing.
Track

After setting the various parameters, press Execute.

Use this parameter to select a track.

Note: When an RX Sound is assigned to the track being edited, the


resulting sound may change, since this kind of Sounds is made of
several different layers triggered by different velocity values.

All

All tracks selected, apart for tracks set in Drum


mode (like the Drum and Percussion tracks). The
whole selected Chord Variation will be transposed.

DrumAcc5 Single selected track.


Value

Also, a fade-out may result in the level jumping up next to the


zero, since a higher-level layer may be selected by low velocity values.
Track
Use this parameter to select a track.

Transpose value (127 semitones).


Start / End Tick
Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to be transposed.
If a Chord Variation is four measures long, and you want to
select it all, the Start will be positioned at 1.01.000, and the End
at 5.01.000.

All

All tracks selected. The velocity for all notes of


the whole selected Chord Variation will be
changed.

DrumAcc5 Selected track.


E / CV (Style Element/Chord Variation)
Use these parameters to select the Style Element and Chord Variation for editing.

116

Style Record mode


Style Edit: Cut

Track status icon

Value

Status of tracks. Press this icon to change the status.

Velocity change value (127).

Play status. The track can be heard.

Start / End Tick


Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to be modified.
If a Chord Variation is four measures long, and you want to
select it all, the Start will be positioned at 1.01.000, and the End
at 5.01.000.
Bottom / Top Note
Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to be modified. If you select the same note as the Bottom
and Top parameters, you can select a single percussive instrument in a Drum or Percussion track.

Mute status. The track cannot be heard.


Track names
Under the buttons, a label for each track is shown.

Style Edit: Cut


This function lets you quickly delete a selected measure (or a
series of measures) from the selected Chord Variation. All following events are moved back, to replace the cut measure(s).

Advanced
When this checkbox is checked, the Intensity, Curve, Start
Velocity Value and End Velocity Value parameters can be
edited.
Intensity
(Only available in Advanced mode). Use this parameter to specify
the degree to which the velocity data will be adjusted toward the
curve you specify in Curve.
0100%

Intensity value. With a setting of 0 [%], the velocity will not change. With a setting of 100 [%], the
velocity will be changed the most.

After setting the various parameters, press Execute.

Curve

E / CV (Style Element/Chord Variation)

(Only available in Advanced mode). Use this parameter to select


one of the six curves, and to specify how the velocity will change
over time.

Use these parameters to select the Style Element and Chord Variation for editing.

Start Value = 0%, End Value = 100%


Curve 1

Curve 2
127

127

Velocity

Velocity

Velocity

Start
Value

End
Value

Start
Value

First measure to be cut.

Curve 3

127

End
Value

Start

Length
Number of measures to be cut.
Start
Value

End
Value

Execute
Curve 5

Curve 4

Curve 6

127

127

127

Velocity

Velocity

Velocity

Start
Value

End
Value

Start
Value

End
Value

Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.

RANDOM

Start
Value

Track status icon


End
Value

Status of tracks. Press this icon to change the status.


Play status. The track can be heard.

Start / End Vel. Value

Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

(Only available in Advanced mode). Velocity change at the starting and ending ticks of the selected range.

Track names

0100

Under the buttons, a label for each track is shown.

Velocity change in percentage.

Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.

Style Record mode


Style Edit: Delete

Note: Some CC data are automatically removed


during recording. See the table on page 104 for
more information on the allowed data.

Style Edit: Delete


This page is where you can delete MIDI events out of the Style.
This function does not remove measures from the pattern. To
remove whole measure, use the Cut function (see Style Edit:
Cut on page 116)

117

Start / End Tick


Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to delete.
If a Chord Variation is four measures long, and you want to
select it all, the Start will be positioned at 1.01.000, and the End
at 5.01.000.
Bottom / Top Note
Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to delete. If you select the same note as the Bottom and
Top parameters, you can select a single percussive instrument in
a Drum or Percussion track.
Note: These parameters are available only when the All or Note
option is selected.

After setting the various parameters, press Execute.

Execute

E / CV (Style Element/Chord Variation)

Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.

Use these parameters to select the Style Element and Chord Variation for editing.

Track status icon


Status of tracks. Press this icon to change the status.

Track
Play status. The track can be heard.

Use this parameter to select a track.


All

All tracks selected. After deletion, the selected


Chord Variation will remain empty.

DrumAcc5 Selected track.

Mute status. The track cannot be heard.


Track names
Under the buttons, a label for each track is shown.

Event
Type of MIDI event to delete.
All events. The measures are not removed from
the Chord Variation.

Note

All notes in the selected range.

Dup.Note

All duplicate notes. When two notes with the


same pitch are encountered on the same tick, the
one with the lowest velocity is deleted.

After Touch

After Touch events.

Style Edit: Delete All


This function lets you quickly delete a selected Style Element or
Chord Variation, or the whole Style.

Note: This kind of data is automatically removed


during recording.
Pitch Bend

Pitch Bend events.

Prog.Change Program Change events, excluding the bundled


Control Change #00 (Bank Select MSB) and #32
(Bank Select LSB).

Ctl.Change

Note: This kind of data is automatically removed


during recording.

After setting the various parameters, press Execute.

All Control Change events, for example Bank


Select, Modulation, Damper, Soft Pedal

Track

CC00/32CC127
Single Control Change events. Double Control
Change numbers (like 00/32) are MSB/LSB bundles.

All

All tracks of the selected Style, Style Element or


Chord Variation.

Drum-Acc5

Single track of the selected Style, Style Element or


Chord Variation.

Reference

All

118

Style Record mode


Style Edit: Copy

E / CV (Style Element/Chord Variation)

From To E/CV (Style Element/Chord Variation)

Use these parameters to select the Style Element and Chord Variation for editing.

Use these parameters to select the source and target Style Elements or Chord Variations.

All

Note: You cant copy from a Variation to a different Style Element


(or vice-versa), because of their different structure.

All Style Elements, i.e. the whole Style. When E/


Track=All and CV=All, the whole Style is deleted,
and all parameters are set to the default status.

All

All Style Elements, i.e. the whole Style. You cant


change the target, that is automatically set to All.

Var1End2

Single Style Element.

Var1CountIn
Single Style Element.
V1-CV1CI-CV2

V1-CV1E2-CV2
Single Chord Variation.

Single Chord Variation.


Execute

From To Track

Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.

Use this parameter to select the source and target track to copy.
You can double a track, to strengthen a pattern.

Track status icon

All

All tracks of the selected Style, Style Element or


Chord Variation.

Drum-Acc5

Single track of the selected Style, Style Element or


Chord Variation.

Status of tracks. Press this icon to change the status.


Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
Execute
Track names

Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.

Under the buttons, a label for each track is shown.


Track status icon
Status of tracks. Press this icon to change the status.

Style Edit: Copy


Here you can copy a track, Chord Variation or Style Element
inside the same Style, or from a different one. Furthermore, you
can copy a whole Style.
Warning: The Copy operation deletes all data at the target location
(overwrite).

Play status. The track can be heard.


Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
Track names
Under the buttons, a label for each track is shown.

Copying to a Chord Variation of a different


length
You can copy a Chord Variation to a different one of a different
length. Just keep in mind the following:

If the source length is a divider of the target length, the


source Chord Variation will be multiplied to fit the target
Chord Variation. For example, if the source is 4-measures
long, and the target 8-measures, the source will be copied
two times.

1 2 3 4
After setting the various parameters, press Execute.
Note: If you copy too many events on the same tick, the Too
many events! message appears, and the copy operation is aborted.
Note: When you copy over an existing Chord Variation, Program
Change data is not copied, to leave the original Sounds unchanged
for that Chord Variation.
From Style
Choose this option to select the source Style to copy the track,
Chord Variation or Style Element from. Press the Select button
to open the Style Select window and select the source Style.

1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4

If the source length is not a divider of the target length, the


source Chord Variation will be copied for as many measures as can fit the target Chord Variation. For example, if
the source is 6-measures long, and the target 8-measures,

Style Record mode


Style Element Track Controls: Sound/Expression

the source will be copied once, then the fist 2 measures will
be copied to fit the remaining 2 measures.

1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2
Note: Avoid copying to a Chord Variation with a different meter,
for example a 4/4 Chord Variation onto a 3/4 one.

119

Expression area
Use these knobs to set the Expression (CC#11) value for the corresponding track. This value can be seen at the beginning of the
Event Edit list (see Event Edit: Event Edit on page 112).
Different Expression values can be defined for each Style Element. This way, you can set a different volume in each Style Element, relative to the general Volume value set in the Style
Header.

Volume area

Style Element Track Controls: Sound/


Expression
In this page you can assign a different Sound to each track of the
selected Style Element. Each Style Element can have different
Sound; after saving the new Style, please dont forget to check
the Original Style Sounds parameter in the Style Play mode
(see page 80), to let the Style select the Sound bypassing the Style
Performance settings.
In this page you can also modify the Expression (CC#11) value
for each of the Style Element tracks. This lets you reduce the relative level of a track in a single Style Element, without reducing
the overall Volume of the Style. This is a very useful control,
when you have different Sounds assigned to the same track in
different Style Elements, and the internal level of these Sounds
must be different.

Use these controls to set the volume and status of each track. See
page 107 for more information.
The Volume value is the same for the whole Style. Use the
Expression controls to adjust the relative balance between tracks
in each Style Element.

Style Element Track Controls: Keyboard


Range
The Keyboard Range automatically transposes any pattern note
that would otherwise play too high or too low in pitch, compared to the original acoustic instrument, when transposed by
the arranger. This will result in a more natural sound for each
accompaniment instrument.
For example, the lower limit for a guitar is E2. If you play a chord
under the E2, the transposed pattern could exceed this limit, and
sound unnatural. A Bottom limit set to E2 for the guitar track
will solve the problem.

Reference

Different Keyboard Range values can be set for each Style Element.

When in this page, press the corresponding button on the control panel to select a Style Element (VARIATION1
ENDING2).
To copy the settings of this page to another Style Element, use
the Copy Sound and Copy Expression commands from the
page menu (see Copy Sounds dialog box and Copy Expression dialog box starting from page 124).

Selected Track Info area


See Selected track info area on page 106 for detailed information.

Sounds area
See Sounds area on page 108 for detailed information.

Note: The Keyboard Range is ignored while recording. The selected


track can play on the full range of the keyboard.
When in this page, press the corresponding button on the control panel to select a Style Element (VARIATION1
ENDING2).
To copy the settings of this page to another Style Element, use
the Copy Keyboard Range command from the page menu (see
Copy Key Range dialog box on page 124).
Top/Bottom
Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range for the corresponding track of the current Style Element.

120

Style Record mode


Style Element Chord Table: Chord Table

Volume area

Mapping of the Style Play mode (see Drum


Mapping (Var.1Var.4) on page 93).

Use these controls to set the volume and status of each track. See
page 107 for more information.

Perc

Style Element Chord Table: Chord Table

Percussion track. This type of track cannot be


transposed, and is used for Drum Kit made of
Percussion sounds. It is NOT affected by the
Drum Mapping.

Bass

Bass track. This type of track always plays the


root when changing chord.

Acc

Accompaniment track. This type of track can be


used freely, for melodic or harmonic accompaniment patterns.

This is the page where you can assign a Chord Variation to each
of the most important recognized chord. When a chord is recognized, the assigned Chord Variation will be automatically
selected by the arranger to play the accompaniment.

Trigger Mode
This setting lets you define how Bass and Acc-type tracks are
retriggered when the chord is changed.
Off

Each time you play a new chord, current notes


will be stopped. The track will remain silent until
a new note will be encountered in the pattern.

Rt

(Retrigger) The sound will be stopped, and new


notes matching the recognized chord will be
played back.

Rp

(Repitch) New notes matching the recognized


chord will be played back, by repitching notes
already playing. There will be no break in the
sound. This is very useful on Guitar and Bass
tracks.

When in this page, press the corresponding button on the control panel to select a Style Element (VARIATION1
ENDING2).
Chord / Chord Variation
Use these parameters to assign a Chord Variation to each of the
most important chords.

Style Track Controls: Type/Trigger/Tension


In this page you can set the Mode, Retrigger mode for the Style
tracks, and activate/deactivate the Tension for the Accompaniment tracks.

When in this page, press the corresponding button on the control panel to select a Style Element (VARIATION1
ENDING2).
Track Type
Use this parameter to set the type of the corresponding track.
Drum

Drum track. This type of track is not transposed


by the arranger, and is used for Drum Kits made
of Drum sounds. It can be affected by the Drum

Tension
Tension adds notes (a 9th, 11th and/or 13th) that have actually
been played to the accompaniment, even if they haven't been
written in the Style pattern. This parameter specifies whether or
not the Tension included in the recognized chord will be added
to the Acc-type tracks.
On

The Tension will be added.

Off

No Tension will be added.

Style Record mode


Import: Import Groove

121

Import: Import Groove

Import: Import SMF

The Import Groove function allows the loading of MIDI


Grooves (.GRV files) generated by the Slice function (see
Time Slice on page 220 in the Sampling mode). By importing
these data to a track, and assigning the Sound based on the sliced
samples to the same track, you can play the original audio
groove, and freely change its tempo.

The Import SMF function allows you to import MIDI data from
a Standard MIDI File (SMF) created on your preferred external
sequencer, and transform them in a Chord Variation.

Note: Please execute the Import Groove operation before turning


the instrument off. All .GRV files generated by a Time Slice operation are deleted when turning the instrument off.
From
Use this parameter to select one of the MIDI Groove patterns
(.GRV files) generated when saving data after a Time Slice
operation.
To E/CV (Style Element/Chord Variation)
Use this parameter to select the target Style Element and Chord
Variation.
To Track
Use this parameter to select the target track inside the selected
Chord Variation. The Percussion track is usually suggested,
since the Drum track is still suitable for standard Drum Kit
sounds (count-in, break etc.). After importing the MIDI Groove
pattern, assign the Sound, to which the sliced samples are
assigned, to the track playing the MIDI Groove pattern.

When importing an SMF, parameters like CV Length, Meter,


Tempo Changes, Program Changes and Expression are recognized. These parameters will be imported as the header of the
Style Element containing the Chord Variation, provided the
Initialize parameter is checked, or the Style Element is empty.
Hint: It is a good idea to check the Initialize parameter when
importing the first Chord Variation of a Style Element, and
uncheck it when importing the following Chord Variations.
Sounds assigned to each track can be imported, provided the
Program Change, Bank Select MSB and LSB events are on the
first tick of the SMF. These data are loaded in the Style Elements header, and not as Sounds assigned to the Style Performance.
Note: Sounds in the Style Element header can be overridden by
Sounds assigned to the Style Performance, by checking the Original Style Sound parameter in the main page of the Style Play
mode (Style Track view).
If the above data was not found on the first tick of the
imported SMF, Sounds must be manually assigned to each track.
You can do this in the Record 1 or Record 2, or the Sound/
Expression page of the Style Record mode,.
Key/Chord, Chord Table, Expression, and any other Style Variation parameter, must be manually programmed in the relevant
Style Record pages.
The starting Tempo, and each tracks Volume, must be programmed as Style Performance data, and then saved in the Style
Performance.
Meter Change is not allowed, therefore not recognized.
The Chord Variation length is the same as the imported SMF.
You can change length by changing the value of the CV Length
parameter, on the main page of the Style Record mode.
Hint: If a note extends beyond the last measure of the Chord Variation, an additional measure is appended (for example, if a note
extends after the end of the fourth measure in a 4-measure pattern,
a 5-measure Chord Variation will be generated). If so, change the
CV Length value to reset the Chord Variation length. The exceeding
note will be cut, to fit the new pattern length.

Reference

Note: After importing a groove generated by a melody line (not by


a percussive groove), the imported groove and samples will not be
transposed together with the other Style tracks. Audio data cannot
be transposed by the arranger.

Note: You cannot use this function to import data from any generic
Song. The Standard MIDI File to be imported must be programmed as if it was one of Pa1Xs Chord Variations.

122

Style Record mode


Export SMF

When programming a Chord Variation on an external


sequencer, please assign each Style track to the correct MIDI
channel, according to the following table.
MIDI Channel(s)

Pa1X Track

Bass

10

Drum

11

Percussion

12-16

Accompaniment 1-5

Export SMF
The Export SMF function allows you to export a Chord Variation as a Standard MIDI File (SMF), and edit it on your preferred external sequencer.

Note: Only SMF in format 0 can be loaded.


From Song
This is the name of the Standard MIDI File to be loaded. Press
the Select button to open the file selector, and select an .SMF
file.
Select
Press this button to open the file selector and load the SMF.

To Song

Initialize

This (non-editable) parameter shows the name of the Standard


MIDI File to be generated. The (automatically assigned) name
will be the same of the exported Chord Variation.

Check this parameter if you want all settings of the target Style
Element (i.e., Key/Chord, Chord Table, Sounds) are reset
when loading the SMF.
Hint: It is a good idea to check the Initialize parameter when
importing the first Chord Variation of a Style Element, and
uncheck it when importing the following Chord Variations.

From E/CV
Use this pop-up menu to select one of the available Chord Variations from the current Style.
Execute

To E/CV
Use this parameter to select a target Chord Variation.
Execute
After setting all parameters in this page, press this button to
import the Standard MIDI File into the target Chord Variation.

After selecting a Chord Variation, press this button to export it as


a Standard MIDI File. A standard file selector will appear. Select
the target device and directory, then press Save.

Style Record mode


Page menu

123

Copy Chord Table

Page menu
Press the page menu icon to open the page menu. Press a command to select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the
menu without selecting a command.

Only available while in the Style Element Chord Table page. Select
this command to open the Cpy Chord Table dialog box (see
Copy Chord Table dialog box on page 124).
Delete Current Track
Select this command to delete the selected track.
Overdub Step Recording
Select this command to open the Overdub Step recording window (see Overdub Step Recording window on page 125).
Solo Track
Select the track to be soloed, then check this item. You will hear
only the selected track, and the Solo warning will flash on the
page header.
Uncheck this item to exit the Solo function.
Exit from Record
Select this command to exit from Record without saving changes
to the Style.

Write Style
Select this command to open the Write Style dialog box, and save
the Style to the internal memory.

Write Style dialog box

See Write Style dialog box on page 123 for more information.
Undo
Only available in Record mode. While in Record mode, cancels
the latest recorded data and restores the previous situation.
Selected a second time, it restores recorded data again (Redo
function).

Open this window by choosing the Write Style item from the
page menu. Here you can save the recorded or edited Style to
memory, by choosing either a User or Direct HD bank.

While the Style Element Track Control edit section is selected,


use this command to open the Copy Sound dialog box and copy
all Sounds assigned to the current Style Element tracks to a different Style Element.
See Copy Sounds dialog box on page 124 for more information.

Parameters saved in the Style are marked with the


through the users manual.

Copy Expression

Name

While the Style Element Track Control edit section is selected,


use this command to open the Copy Expression dialog box and
copy all Expression values assigned to the current Style Element
tracks to a different Style Element.

Name of the Style to be saved. Press the


(Text Edit) button
next to the name to open the Text Edit window.

See Copy Expression dialog box on page 124 for more information.
Copy Keyboard Range

symbol

Style Bank
Target bank of Styles. Each bank corresponds to one of the
STYLE SELECT buttons. Use TEMPO/VALUE controls to select
a different bank.

While the Style Element Track Control edit section is selected,


use this command to open the Copy Keyboard Range dialog box
and copy all Keyboard Range values for the current Style Element tracks to a different Style Element.

Style

See Copy Key Range dialog box on page 124 for more information.

Note: A User Style is usually prompted when writing a Style. However, you can overwrite a Factory Style, when the Factory Style
and Pad Protect parameter is left unchecked (see page 272).

Target Style location in the selected bank. Use TEMPO/VALUE


controls to select a different location.

Reference

Copy Sound

124

Style Record mode


Copy Sounds dialog box

Select button

Var1CountIn
Single Style Element where to copy settings to.

Press this button to open the Style Select window, and select a
target location.
While in the Style Select window, use the buttons on top of the
window to select either the User or the Direct HD banks.

Copy Sounds dialog box


Open this window by choosing the Copy Sounds item from the
page menu. Here you can copy all Sounds assigned to the current Style Element tracks to a different Style Element.

Copy Key Range dialog box


Open this window by choosing the Copy Keyboard Range item
from the page menu. Here you can copy all Keyboard Range values for the current Style Element tracks to a different Style Variation.

From Style Element


Non editable. Currently selected Style Element.
From Style Element
Non editable. Currently selected Style Element.

To Style Element
Target Style Element.

To Style Element

All

Target Style Element.


All

Settings will be copied to all Style Variation of the


Style in edit.

Settings will be copied to all Style Variation of the


Style in edit.

Var1CountIn
Single Style Element where to copy settings to.

Var1CountIn
Single Style Element where to copy settings to.

Copy Chord Table dialog box


Copy Expression dialog box
Open this window by choosing the Copy Expression item from
the page menu. Here you can copy all Expression values assigned
to the current Style Element tracks to a different Style Variation.

Open this window by choosing the Copy Chord Table item from
the page menu. Here you can copy the Chord Table of the current Style Element to a different Style Element.

To Style Element
From Style Element

Target Style Element.

Non editable. Currently selected Style Element.

All

To Style Element

Var1CountIn

Target Style Element.


All

Settings will be copied to all Style Variation of the


Style in edit.

Settings will be copied to all Style Variation of the


Style in edit.

Single Style Element where to copy settings to.

Style Record mode


Overdub Step Recording window

125

Free Memory

Overdub Step Recording window


The Step Record allows you to create a new Style by entering single notes or chords to each track, by playing them on the keyboard one at a time, with no need to play on time. This is very
useful when transcribing an existing score, or needing a higher
grade of detail, and is particularly suitable to create drum and
percussion tracks.
To access this page, select the Overdub Step Recording command from the page menu.

Remaining memory for recording.


Duration
Relative duration of the inserted note. The percentage is always
referred to the step value.
25%

Staccatissimo.

50%

Staccato.

85%

Ordinary articulation.

100%

Legato.

Velocity
Set this parameter before entering a note or chord. This will be
the playing strength (i.e., velocity value) of the event to be
inserted.
Kbd

Keyboard. You can select this parameter, by turning all counter-clockwise the dial. When this
option is selected, the playing strength of the
played note is recognized and recorded.

1127

Velocity value. The event will be inserted with


this velocity value, and the actual playing
strength of the note played on the keyboard will
be ignored.

Track (Selected track)


Name of the selected track in record.

Style track.
SE (Selected Style Element)
See Element (Style Element) on page 105.

Rest
Press this button to insert a rest.
Tie

CV (Selected Chord Variation)

Press this button to tie the note to be inserted to the previous


note.

See Chord Var (Chord Variation) on page 105.

Back

Pos (Position)

Goes to the previous step, erasing the inserted event.

This is the position of the event (note, rest or chord) to be


inserted.

Next M. (Next Measure)

Event list
Previously inserted events. You may delete this event, and set it
in edit again, by pressing the Back button.
Step Time values
Length of the event to be inserted.

Note value.

Standard () Standard value of the selected note.


Dot (.)

Augments the selected note by one half of its


value.

Triplet (3)

Triplet value of the selected note.

Meter
Meter of the current measure. This parameter cannot be edited.
You can set the Meter in the main page of the Style Record mode,
before actually starting recording (see step 6 on page 108 for
more information).

Goes to the next measure, and fills the remaining space with
rests.
Done
Exits the Step Record mode.

Reference

DRUMACC5

126

Pad Record mode


The Pad structure

Pad Record mode


formance or Write STS command from the page menu of
the Style Play mode (see Write Performance dialog box
on page 98 or Write Single Touch Setting dialog box on
page 98).

By entering the Pad Record mode, you can create your own Pads,
or edit an existing Pad.

The Pad structure


A Pad is basically a single-track Style. Most of what applies to
Style recording also applies to Pad recording.

To enter Pad Record mode, go to the Style Play mode and press
REC. The Style/Pad Record Select window appears.

There are two different categories of Pads:

Hit Pads. While they are


mostly used as non-transposing events, they can also be
transposing notes or chords.
Basically, they are single-note
or single-chord Sequences
(see below).
Sequence Pads, i.e., complex single-track patterns,
that can be transposed by
playing different chords on
the keyboard exactly as a
Style track. They are roughly
equivalent to single-element,
single-track,
multi-chord
variation Styles (see illustration).

Entering the Pad Record mode

Pad
CV1
Pad Track
CV2
CV3
CV4
CV5

Select Record/Edit Pad to select an existing Pad to edit. If it


is a Factory Pad, you may not be able to save it at the original location (depending on the status of the Factory Style
and Pad Protect parameter in the ->Disk->Preferences
page); you will select a User Pad location instead.

Select Record New Pad to start from a new, empty Pad.


When finished recording, you will save the new Pad into a
User Pad location. (Pads can be saved into Factory Pad
locations only when the Factory Style and Pad Protect
parameter is set to Off).

CV6

Each Pad is made up of up to six smaller units, called Chord


Variations (CV). Each Chord Variation is made of a single track
(the Pad track).
Exactly as with the Styles, when playing a chord in the chord recognition area, the corresponding Chord Variation is recalled.
Recorgnized chords are associated to a Chord Variationby means
of the Chord Variation Table. Each Pad contains a Chord Variation Table.
As with the Styles, the Note Transposition Tables (NTT) applies
to the Pads.

What to record
Recording a Pad is a matter of recording a single track, inside a
series of Chord Variations, inside the Pad itself.
You dont need to record all Chord Variations. It is often only
needed to record just a Chord Variation.

Pattern data vs. track data


While the Pad Record mode is where you can create or edit
music patterns for the Pad, track parameters (like Sounds, Volume, Pan, Octave Transpose, FX settings) have to be edited in
Style Play mode.

After creating or editing music patterns in Pad Record


mode, save them by selecting the Write Pad command from
the page menu of the Pad Record mode (see Write Pad
dialog box on page 136).

After editing track parameters in Style Play mode, save


them to the Performance or STS by selecting the Write Per-

When you have finished recording or editing the Hit or


Sequence Pad, please save it (see Exit by saving or deleting
changes below) and exit the Pad Record mode.
Then, go to the Pad page of the Style Play or Song Play mode,
assign the new Hit or Sequence to a Pad button, and adjust the
various track settings (Volume, Pan, and C/D FX Send see
Pad/Switch: Pad on page 94). Finally, save the Performance or
STS by selecting the Write Performance or Write STS command from the page menu.
Note: While in Record mode, the footswitch and EC5 pedals are
disabled. On the contrary, volume/expression-type pedals can
be used.

Pad Record mode


Exit by saving or deleting changes

127

Exit by saving or deleting changes

Main page - Pad Record

When finished editing, you can save your Pad in memory, or


cancel any change.

The Main page of the Pad Record mode looks like a simplified
version of the Main page of the Style Record mode, with just a
single track to be recorded and no Style Elements to be chosen.
The only addition is the Pad Sync parameter.

To save changes, select the Write Pad command from the


page menu (see Write Pad dialog box on page 136).
To cancel all changes, select the Exit from Record command
from the page menu, or press the REC button, to exit from
record and return to the main page of the Style Record mode.
Hint: Save often while recording, to avoid accidentally losing your
Pad.

Listening to the Pad while in Record/Edit


mode

When you are in the Main, Event Edit, Quantize, Transpose, Velocity, or Delete pages, you can listen to the selected
Chord Variation. Press START/STOP to check how it
works. Press START/STOP again to stop the playback.
When you are in the Sounds/Expression, Keyboard Range,
Chord Table, Trigger/Tension, Delete All, Copy, Style Element Controls or Style Control pages, you can listen to the
whole Pad. Press START/STOP and play some chords to do
your tests.

Note: In this mode, the pattern is always played back in loop, even
if the Pad Type parameter is set to One Shot (see page 133).
Note: While in Pad Record mode, the Fingered 3 Chord Scanning
mode is automatically selected.

Please look at the Users Manual for more information on the


various parameters. Only general information and differences
with the Style Record mode are described here.

Recording parameters area


Chord Var (Chord Variation)
This parameter lets you select one of the six available Chord
Variations (CV1 CV6) for editing or recording.
Note: When this parameter and the assigned value is in small letters (cv1cv6), the Chord Variation is empty; when it is in capitals
(CV1CV6), it is already recorded.
Resolution

Use this parameter to set the quantization during recording.


Pad Sync

PAD

This parameter allows you to set a synchronization mode for the


Pads pattern.
Off

No synchronization. The sequence will start as


soon as you press the PAD button.

Continued

The pattern will start immediately, in sync with


the arrangers or active sequencers tempo.
Depending on the current position of the beat
counter, it might not start from its very beginning; instead, it will continue from the current
position.
For example, if the arrangers or sequencers beat
counter shows the third beat, and is playing tick
91, the Pad will start from its third beat, at tick
91.
The beat counter

This works exactly as if it was a Fill.

Reference

While you are in Pad Record or Pad Edit mode, you can listen to
the selected Chord Variation. To select a Chord Variation, go to
the Main page of the Record/Edit mode.

128
Beat

Pad Record mode


Main page - Pad Record

The sequence will start at the next beat, in sync


with the arrangers or sequencers tempo. It will
start from its very beginning (i.e., tick 1 or measure 1).

Rec Length (Recording Length)

Root

The root note (in CMaj = C) is transposed to the


missing notes.

Fifth

The 5th note (in CMaj = G) is transposed to the


missing notes.

i-Series

The original pattern must be programmed on the


Maj7 or min7 chords.

NoTrnsp

No transposition table is applied. The pattern will


always play as recorded, with no added notes.
However, it will be transposed to other keys,
depending on the played chord.

PAD

This parameter sets the recording length (in measures) of the


sequence. Its value is always equal to, or a divider of, the Chord
Variation Length (see next parameter).
Warning: If you assign CV Length a value lower than Rec
Length, the value of Rec Length is not immediately updated in
the display. Therefore, you are still free of changing the value of
CV Length, before the measures exceeding its value are deleted
(see warning in CV Length (Chord Variation Length) below).
However, if you press START/STOP to begin recording, the real
Rec Length value is changed to the new one, even if the display
still shows the old value.
CV Length (Chord Variation Length)

for the CMaj chord, when a CMaj7 is recognized on the keyboard the arranger must transpose some notes to create the
missing 7th.

As recorded with
NTT = Root or 5th
(Key/Chord = CMaj)

When you play a CM7


with NTT = Root

When you play a CM7


with NTT = 5th

As recorded with
NTT = i-Series
(Key/Chord = CM7)

When you play a CMaj


with NTT = i-Series

When you play a C7


with NTT = i-Series

PAD

This parameter sets the total length (up to 32 measures) for the
selected Chord Variation. When playing a Style, this will be the
length of the accompaniment pattern, when the chord corresponding to the Chord Variation is recognized on the keyboard.
Warning: If you reduce the Chord Variation Length after
recording, any measure after the selected length will be deleted.
Be very careful when setting the CV Length to a lower value
after recording! If it happens, we suggest to exit from record
without saving (see Exit from Record on page 136).

Note: The NTT does not work if the Track Type parameter is set
to Drum.

Metro (Metronome)

Pad Track info area

This is where you can set the metronome.

This line lets you see the Sound assigned to the selected track.

Off

No metronome click will be heard during recording. In any case, a one-bar precount will be
played before starting recording.

On1

Metronome on, with a one-bar precount before


starting recording.

On2

Metronome on, with a two-bar precount before


starting recording.

Tempo
Select this parameter to use TEMPO/VALUE controls to set the
tempo.
Note: This value will not be recorded, and will only be used for testing the pattern at various speeds while editing or recording.
Hint: You can always change the Tempo, when other parameters
are selected, by keeping the SHIFT button pressed, and rotating the
DIAL.
Meter

Sound name

Program Change

Sound name

PAD

Sound assigned to the Pad track. The triangle means you can
press the name to open the Sound Select window, and select a
different Sound.
Sound bank

PAD

Bank the selected Sound belongs to.


Program Change

PAD

Program Change number. Shown only when the Show Program


Change number parameter is turned on in Global mode.

PAD

This is the meter (time signature) of the sequence. You can edit
this parameter only when the sequence is empty, i.e. before you
begin recording anything.
NTT (Note Transposition Table)

Sound bank

PAD

The Note Transposition Table (NTT) determines how the


arranger will transpose pattern notes, when a chord is recognized that does not exactly match the original chord of a Chord
Variation. For example, if you only recorded a Chord Variation

Tracks volume/status area


Octave Transpose
This (non-editable) indicator shows the current octave
transposition. To change this value use the OCTAVE
TRANSPOSE buttons on the control panel.
While this value is not memorized with the Pad, the transposition is used during recording. For example, if you play a C4 and
a +1 octave transposition is selected, a C5 is recorded.

Pad Record mode


Pad Record procedure

129

Virtual slider

Edit menu

The virtual slider in the display shows the tracks volume.


To change the volume, touch the slider and use TEMPO/
VALUE controls to change the value.
This value is not saved with the Pad, and is only used to test the
Pads volume during editing or recording.

When pressing the MENU button while in Pad Record mode,


the Pad Record Edit Menu will appear.

Track status icons


Status of the track. Press this icon to change the status.
Record status. After starting recording, the track
will receive notes from the keyboard and the
MIDI IN connector.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

Key/Chord area
Key/Chord

PAD

This parameter pair allows you to define the tracks original key
and chord type, for the current Chord Variation. When playing
the pattern back, this chord will be played back exactly as it was
recorded, without any NTT processing (see above).

Delete Note button


When a track is selected, you can use this command to delete a
single note or a single percussive instrument.
If the Pad is playing, this shortcut deletes the instrument only
while the key is kept pressed, leaving all other notes untouched
within the track.

Note: The Pad Edit pages are a simplified version of the Style Edit
pages. See the Users manual for information on the various
parameters.
Note: While the Pad is in play, you cannot access the Edit section
pages from the main page (see page 127). Stop the playback before
pressing MENU.
Note: When switching from the Edit section pages (Quantize,
Transpose, Velocity, Delete) to the other pages, or vice-versa, the
Pad (if in play) is automatically stopped.

Edit page structure

Pad Record procedure


Recording a Pad is very similar to recording a Style. Please see
the relevant chapter in the Users manual.

Operating mode

Edit section

Page menu
icon
Pad track
info

Parameters
area

Tabs

Reference

Most edit pages share some basic elements.

130

Pad Record mode


Event Edit: Event Edit

Other pages exhibit a slightly different structure.


Operating mode

Edit section

Page menu
icon

Pad Edit: Quantize


The quantize function may be used to correct any timing mistake after recording, or to give the pattern a groovy feeling.

Parameters
area

Tabs

Operating mode
This indicates that the instrument is in Pad Record mode.
After setting the various parameters, press Execute.
Edit section
This identifies the current edit section, corresponding to one of
the items of the edit menu (see Edit menu on page 129).

CV (Chord Variation)
Use this parameters to select the Chord Variation for editing.

Page menu icon

Resolution

Press this icon to open the page menu (see Page menu on
page 135).

This parameter sets the quantization after recording.

Parameters area

Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to quantize.

Each page contains various parameters. Use the tabs to select


one of the available pages. For detailed information on the various types of parameters, see sections starting from page 130.

Start / End Tick

Bottom / Top Note


Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to quantize.

Tabs
Use tabs to select one of the edit pages of the current edit section.

Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.

Event Edit: Event Edit


The Event Edit is the page where you can edit each single MIDI
event of the selected Chord Variation. You can, for example,
replace a note with a different one, or change its playing strength
(i.e., velocity value).
Page sub-header

Page header

Page menu icon

Pad Edit: Transpose


In this page you can transpose the selected track(s).
Note: After transposing, please dont forget to readjust the Key/
Chord parameter in the main page of the Pad Record mode (see
page 129).

Event list

Tabs

Scrollbar

This is very similar to the Style Records Event Edit page. See the
Users Manual for more information on the event editing procedure.

After setting the various parameters, press Execute.


CV (Chord Variation)
Use this parameters to select the Chord Variation for editing.

Pad Record mode


Pad Edit: Velocity

131

Value

Bottom / Top Note

Transpose value (127 semitones).

Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to be modified.

Start / End Tick


Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to be transposed.
Bottom / Top Note
Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to be transposed.

Advanced
When this checkbox is checked, the Intensity, Curve, Start
Velocity Value and End Velocity Value parameters can be
edited.
Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.

Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.

Pad Edit: Velocity


In this page you can change the velocity (dynamics) value of
notes in the selected track.

Pad Edit: Cut


This function lets you quickly delete a selected measure (or a
series of measures) from the selected Chord Variation. All following events are moved back, to replace the cut measure(s).

After setting the various parameters, press Execute.

CV (Chord Variation)

CV (Chord Variation)

Use this parameters to select the Chord Variation for editing.

Use this parameters to select the Chord Variation for editing.

Start

Value

First measure to be cut.

Velocity change value (127).

Length
Number of measures to be cut.

Intensity
(Only available in Advanced mode). Use this parameter to specify
the degree to which the velocity data will be adjusted toward the
curve you specify in Curve.
Curve
(Only available in Advanced mode). Use this parameter to select
from six types of curve, and specify how the velocity will change
over time.
Start / End Vel. Value
(Only available in Advanced mode). Velocity change at the starting and ending ticks of the selected range.
Start / End Tick
Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to be modified.

Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.

Reference

After setting the various parameters, press Execute.

132

Pad Record mode


Pad Edit: Delete

Bottom / Top Note

Pad Edit: Delete


This page is where you can delete MIDI events out of the Pad.
This function does not remove measures from the pattern. To
remove whole measure, use the Cut function (see Pad Edit:
Cut on page 131)

Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to delete.
Note: These parameters are available only when the All or Note
option is selected.
Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.

Pad Edit: Delete All


This function lets you quickly delete a single Chord Variation, or
the whole Pad.

After setting the various parameters, press Execute.


CV (Chord Variation)
Use this parameters to select the Chord Variation for editing.
Event
Type of MIDI event to delete.
All

All events. The measures are not removed from


the Chord Variation.

After setting the various parameters, press Execute.

Note

All notes in the selected range.

CV (Chord Variation)

Dup.Note

All duplicate notes. When two notes with the


same pitch are encountered on the same tick, the
one with the lowest velocity is deleted.

Use this parameters to select the Chord Variation to be deleted.

After Touch

Pitch Bend

All

All Chord Variations, i.e. the whole Pad. After


deletion, all parameters are set to the default status.

Note: This kind of data is automatically removed


during recording.

CV1CV6

Single Chord Variation.

Pitch Bend events.

Execute

After Touch events.

Prog.Change Program Change events, excluding the bundled


Control Change #00 (Bank Select MSB) and #32
(Bank Select LSB).

Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.

Note: This kind of data is automatically removed


during recording.

Pad Edit: Copy from Style

All Control Change events, for example Bank


Select, Modulation, Damper, Soft Pedal

Here you can copy a track from a Style, and transform it into a
Pad pattern.

CC00/32CC127
Single Control Change events. Double Control
Change numbers (like 00/32) are MSB/LSB bundles.

Warning: The Copy operation deletes all data at the target location
(overwrite).

Ctl.Change

Note: Some CC data are automatically removed


during recording. See the table in the Users Manual for more information on the allowed data.
Start / End Tick
Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to delete.

After setting the various parameters, press Execute.

Pad Record mode


Pad Edit: Copy from Pad

Note: If you copy too many events on the same tick, the Too
many events! message appears, and the copy operation is aborted.
Note: When you copy over an existing Chord Variation, Program
Change data is not copied, to leave the original Sounds unchanged
for that Chord Variation.

133

From Pad
Choose this option to select the source Pad to copy the Chord
Variation from. Press the Select button to open the Pad Select
window and select the source Pad.
From CV (Chord Variation)

From Style

Use this parameter to select the source Chord Variation.

Choose this option to select the source Style to copy the track
from. Press the Select button to open the Style Select window
and select the source Style.

All

All Chord Variations, i.e. the whole Pad. You cant


change the target, that is automatically set to All.

CV1CV6

Single Chord Variation.

From E/CV (Style Element/Chord Variation)


Use this parameter to select the source Style Element and Chord
Variation.
Var1End2

A single Style Element, i.e., all Chord Variations.

V1-CV1E2-CV2

To CV (Chord Variation)
Use this parameter to select a target Chord Variation inside the
current Pad.
CV1CV6

Target Chord Variation. Automatically set to All it


the From CV parameter is also set to All.

A single Chord Variation.


Execute
From Track

Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.

Use this parameter to select the source track to copy.


Drum-Acc5

Single track of the selected Style Element or


Chord Variation.

Pad Track Controls: Sound/Expression

To CV (Chord Variation)
Use this parameter to select a target Chord Variation inside the
current Pad.
CV1CV6

Target Chord Variation.

In this page you can assign a Sound to the Pad track, adjust its
Volume (CC#07) and Expression (CC#11) values, and set various other parameters, like the Keyboard Range, Track Type,
Trigger Mode, Tension and Wrap Around.

Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.

Reference

Pad Edit: Copy from Pad


Here you can copy a Chord Variation from a different Pad. Furthermore, you can copy a whole Pad.
Warning: The Copy operation deletes all data at the target location
(overwrite).

Sound/Bank

PAD

Sound assigned to the Pad track.


Pad Type

PAD

Use this parameter to decide if the Pad will play once or if it will
loop.
Note: While in Pad Record mode, the pattern is always played back
in loop, even if this parameter is set to One Shot.
One Shot

When you press one of the PAD buttons, the corresponding Pad is only played once. This is useful
for playing Hits or Sequences than must only play
once.

Loop

When you press one of the PAD buttons, the corresponding Pad plays up to the end, then continues playing from the start. Press STOP in the PAD
section to stop it playing. This is useful for playing cyclic sequences.

After setting the various parameters, press Execute.


Note: If you copy too many events on the same tick, the Too
many events! message appears, and the copy operation is aborted.
Note: When you copy over an existing Chord Variation, Program
Change data is not copied, to leave the original Sounds unchanged
for that Chord Variation.

134

Pad Record mode


Pad Chord Table

Expression

PAD

Use this knob to set the Expression (CC#11) value for the Pad
track. This value can be seen at the beginning of the Event Edit
list.
The Expression is useful to balance the Pad with the other Pads.
For example, if you want the Pad you are recording is mellower
than the average, just lower the Expression value.
Volume
Use this slider to set the Volume (CC#07) value for the Pad track.
This value is not saved with the Pad, and is only used to test the
Pads volume during editing or recording.
Keyboard Range

PAD

The Keyboard Range automatically transposes any pattern note


that would otherwise play too high or too low in pitch, compared to the original acoustic instrument, when transposed by
the arranger. This will result in a more natural sound for the Pad
instrument.
Note: The Keyboard Range is ignored while recording. The Pad
track can play on the full range of the keyboard.
Trigger Mode

PAD

Wrap Around

PAD

The wrap-around point is the highest register limit for the Pad
track. The Pad pattern will be transposed according to the
detected chord. If the chord is too high, the Pad track might play
in a register that is too high, and therefore unnatural. If, however, it reaches the wrap-around point, it will be automatically
transposed an octave lower.
The wrap-around point can be individually set in semitone steps
up to a maximum of 12 semitones, relative to the chord root set
in the main page of the Pad Record mode (see Key/Chord on
page 129).
112

Maximum transposition (in semitones) of the


track, referred to the original key of the Pad pattern.

Pad Chord Table


This is the page where you can assign a Chord Variation to each
of the most important recognized chord. When a chord is recognized, the assigned Chord Variation will be automatically
selected by the arranger to play the Pad track.

(Not available if Track Type = Drum). This setting lets you define
how Bass and Acc-type tracks are retriggered when the chord is
changed.
Off

Each time you play a new chord, current notes


will be stopped. The track will remain silent until
a new note will be encountered in the pattern.

Rt

(Retrigger) The sound will be stopped, and new


notes matching the recognized chord will be
played back.

Rp

(Repitch) New notes matching the recognized


chord will be played back, by repitching notes
already playing. There will be no break in the
sound. This is very useful on Guitar and Bass
tracks.

Track Type

PAD

Use these parameters to assign a Chord Variation to each of the


most important chords.

PAD

Import: Import Groove

Use this parameter to set the type of the Pad track.


Drum

Chord / Chord Variation

Drum track. This type of track is not transposed


by the arranger, and is used for Drum Kits, or for
tracks that you dont want to be transposed when
playing a different chord.

Bass

Bass track. This type of track always plays the


root when changing chord.

Acc

Accompaniment track. This type of track can be


used freely, for melodic or harmonic accompaniment patterns.

Tension

PAD

Tension adds notes (a 9th, 11th and/or 13th) that have actually
been played, even if they haven't been written in the Pad pattern.
This parameter specifies whether or not the Tension included in
the recognized chord will be added to an Acc-type track.
On

The Tension will be added.

Off

No Tension will be added.

The Import Groove function allows the loading of MIDI


Grooves (.GRV files) generated by the Slice function (see
Time Slice in the Sampling mode). By importing these data to
the Pad track, and assigning the Sound based on the sliced samples to the same track, you can play the original audio groove,
and freely change its tempo.

Pad Record mode


Import: Import SMF

135

From
Use this parameter to select one of the MIDI Groove patterns
(.GRV files) generated when saving data after a Time Slice
operation.
To CV (Chord Variation)

Export: SMF
The Export SMF function allows you to export a Chord Variation as a Standard MIDI File (SMF), and edit it on your preferred external sequencer.

Use this parameter to select the target Chord Variation.

Import: Import SMF


The Import SMF function allows you to import MIDI data from
a Standard MIDI File (SMF) created on your preferred external
sequencer, and transform them in a Chord Variation.

To Song
This (non-editable) parameters shows the name of the Standard
MIDI File to be generated. The (automatically assigned) name
will be the same of the exported Chord Variation.
From CV
Use this pop-up menu to select one of the available Chord Variations from the current Pad.
When programming a Chord Variation on the external
sequencer, please assign the Pad track to the MIDI channel #10.
Note: Only SMF in format 0 can be loaded.

Execute
After selecting a Chord Variation, press this button to export it as
a Standard MIDI File. A standard file selector will appear. Select
the target device and directory, then press Save.

From Song

Select
Press this button to open the file selector and load the SMF.

Page menu
Press the page menu icon to open the page menu. Press a command to select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the
menu without selecting a command.

Initialize
Check this parameter if you want all Pad settings (i.e., Key/
Chord, Chord Table, Sound) are reset when loading the SMF.
Hint: It is a good idea to check this parameter when importing the
first Chord Variation of the Pad, and uncheck it when importing
the following Chord Variations.
To CV
Use this parameter to select a target Chord Variation.
Execute
After setting all parameters in this page, press this button to
import the Standard MIDI File into the target Chord Variation.

Write Pad
When done recording or editing a Pad, and you want to save the
changes, select this command to open the Write Pad dialog box,
and save the Pad to the internal memory.
See Write Pad dialog box on page 136 for more information.
Undo
Only available in the Main page of the Pad Record mode, and in
some Pad Edit pages. While in Record mode, cancels the latest
recorded data and restores the previous situation. Selected a second time, it restores recorded data again (Redo function).

Reference

This is the name of the Standard MIDI File to be loaded. Press


the Select button to open the file selector, and select an .SMF
file.

136

Pad Record mode


Write Pad dialog box

Delete Pad Track


Only available in the Main page of the Pad Record mode. Select
this command to delete the Pad track.
Overdub Step Recording
Only available in the Main page of the Pad Record mode. Select
this command to open the Overdub Step recording window (see
the Style Record chapter in the Users Manual for more information).
Exit from Record
Select this command to exit from Record without saving changes
to the Pad.

Write Pad dialog box


Open this window by selecting the Write Pad item from the page
menu. Here you can save the recorded or edited Pad to memory.

Parameters saved in the Pad are marked with the PAD symbol
through the users manual.
Name

PAD

Name of the Pad to be saved. Press the


(Text Edit) button
next to the name to open the Text Edit window.
Pad Bank
Target Pad bank. Only User banks can be selected.
Pad
Target Pad location in the selected bank. Use TEMPO/VALUE
controls to select a different location.
Note: A User Pad is usually prompted when writing a Pad. However, you can overwrite a Factory Pad, when the Factory Style and
Pad Protect parameter is left unchecked (see page Disk->Preferences).
Select button
Press this button to open the Pad Select window, and select a target location.

Song Play operating mode


Transport controls

137

Song Play operating mode


The Song Play operating mode is where you can listen to Songs.
Since the Pa1X is equipped with two onboard sequencers, you
can play two Songs at the same time. This is very useful to mix
between two Songs during a live performance. Songs can be in
Standard MIDI File, Karaoke, MP3 or Audio CD format (MP3
Player and Audio CD Player available as options).
You can play along with the Song with up to four Keyboard
tracks (Upper 1-3, Lower). You can select different Sounds and
Effects for Keyboard tracks by selecting Performances and STSs.
A different Voice Processor Preset may be selected by a Performance or STS.
While in Song Play, you can use the SongBook to automatically
select Songs for a desired music genre. With each Song entry in
the SongBook, up to four STSs are associated.

Sequencer 1

Sequencer 2

Track parameters
Keyboard track settings made in Song Play mode may be saved
to a Performance. You can recall different settings by just selecting a different Performance.
Settings for Song tracks, like pan, volume and FX sends, depend
on the midifile.
Changes to Song tracks made in Song Play mode cannot be
saved to the midifile, and are intended just for realtime editing.
To permanently save changes to the various Song parameters,
use Sequencer mode.

Transport controls
You can use the separate transport controls for each of the two
onboard sequencers. Use the SEQUENCER 1 controls for
Sequencer 1, and SEQUENCER 2 controls for Sequencer 2. See
SEQUENCER 1 TRANSPORT CONTROLS on page 10 for
more information).

Standard MIDI Files and Sounds

In Song Play mode the MIDI Clock is always generated by the


internal sequencer, even if the Clock parameter is set to MIDI
(see Clock Source on page 236). While in this mode, Pa1X
cannot receive MIDI Clock messages from the MIDI IN.
Pa1X transmits to the MIDI OUT only the MIDI Clock message
generated by Sequencer 1.

Master Volume, Sequencer Volume,


Balance
While the MASTER VOLUME slider controls the general volume
of the instrument, you can use the ACC/SEQ VOLUME slider to
control only Sequencers tracks volume. This lets you adjust the
Sequencers volume alone, while Keyboard tracks are not
affected by this slider.
Sequencers volume (Keyboard
tracks are unaffected

A difference could be in the sound played by each track. If you


recorded a Song with the Pa1X (Sequencer mode), using only
General MIDI sounds, you can play the same Song on virtually
any other musical instrument or computer. If you used Korg
native sounds, you cannot play back the same sounds on instruments from other brands.
When you read SMFs in Song Play mode, there is no problem
reading files made using only General MIDI sounds. Sounds
could be different when playing a Song made on a different
instrument: despite the wide compatibility of Pa1X with other,
non-standard formats, differences may arise.
If so, go to the Sequencer operating mode and load the SMF.
Then, manually reassign the non-matching Sounds, replacing
them with similar Sounds on the Pa1X. Then, save the SMF
again, and you will be able to play it in Song Play mode with the
correct Sounds.

Reference

The native Song file format of the Pa1X is the Standard MIDI
File (SMF), an universal standard set by all manufacturers. You
can read these files with any musical instrument or computer.

MIDI Clock

Overall instruments volume

Use the BALANCE slider to mix between Sequencer 1 and


Sequencer 2. Move it to the center for the maximum volume of
both sequencers.

138

Song Play operating mode


NRPN Sound parameters

NRPN Sound parameters

Keyboard, Pad and Sequencer tracks

GM-compliant Standard MIDI Files can contain NRPN (#99,


98) Control Change messages. These messages are used to modify some Sound parameters before starting a Song. The following
NRPN messages are recognized by the Pa1X:

The Pa1X is equipped with a double sequencer. Each Song can


play a maximum of 16 tracks, for a total of 32 sequencer tracks.

CC#99
(MSB)

CC#98
(LSB)

CC#06
(Data Entry)

Vibrato Rate

0127(a)

Vibrato Depth

0127(a)

Vibrato Decay

10

0127(a)

Filter Cutoff

32

0127(a)

Resonance

33

0127(a)

EG Attack Time

99

0127(a)

EG Decay Time

100

0127(a)

EG Release Time

102

0127(a)

Drum Filter Cutoff

20

dd(b)

0127(a)

Drum Filter Resonance

21

dd(b)

0127(a)

Drum EG Attack Time

22

dd(b)

0127(a)

Drum EG Decay Time

23

dd(b)

0127(a)

Drum Coarse Tune

24

dd(b)

0127(a)

Drum Fine Tune

25

dd(b)

0127(a)

Drum Volume

26

dd(b)

0127

Drum Panpot

28

dd(b)

0127(a)

Drum Rev Send (FX 1)

29

dd(b)

0127(a)

Drum Mod Send (FX 2)

30

dd(b)

0127(a)

NRPN

(a). 64 = No change to the original parameters value


(b). dd = Drum Instrument No. 0127 (C0C8)

Note: These control s are reset when stopping the Song, or selecting
a new Song.

In addition, you can play on the keyboard with four additional


Keyboard tracks (Upper 1-3 and Lower). You can edit the Volume and Play/Mute status for these tracks on the main page of
the Song Play mode (see illustration below).
While in Song Play mode, you can still select Performances or
STSs from the latest selected Style. To select a different set of
STSs, you can first select a different Style.

Press here to
select a Performance
Press here to
select a Style
Keyboard
tracks volume and Play/
Mute status

In addition to Keyboard tracks, selecting a different Performance


or STS may change sounds assigned to the PADs.
When you enter Song Play mode from the Style Play mode, Keyboard and Pad tracks are the same as in Style Play mode.

Song Play operating mode


Main page

139

Recognized chord

Main page
Press SONG PLAY to access this page from another operating
mode.

Displays the recognized chord, when you play a chord on the


keyboard. If no chord abbreviation is shown, no chord recognition mode has been selected by using the CHORD SCANNING
buttons (see page 11).

To access this page from another operating mode, press the


SONG PLAY button.

Page menu icon

Note: When switching from Style Play to Song Play, the Song Setup
is automatically selected, and various track parameters may
change.
To return to this page from one of the Song Play edit pages, press
the EXIT or SONG PLAY button.

To switch between Keyboard tracks (Normal view) and Song


tracks (Song Tracks views), use the TRK. SEL. (TRACK
SELECT) button. Pressed a first time, you will see tracks 1-8; a
second press will show tracks 9-16; pressed again, you will go
back to Keyboard tracks. (See Song Tracks 1-8 and 9-16 pages
and Volume panel starting from page 142).
Songs area

Page header

Press the page menu icon to open the menu. See Page menu on
page 155 for more information.

Songs area
This is where Song names are shown, together with parameters
depending on the selected type of Song.
The following illustration shows parameters appearing when a
Standard MIDI Files has been selected.
Song type icon

Song name

Page menu icon

Current measure

Meter
Tempo

Keyboard
tracks
area

Style
area

Song name

Total
time

Elapsed time

All Songs

Seq.1
Seq.2

Page header
This line shows the current operating mode, transposition and
recognized chord.

Master Transpose
(in semitones)

The following illustration shows parameters appearing when


an MP3 file has been selected.
Song type icon

Recognized
chord

Song name

Elapsed time

Total
time

Operating mode name

Seq.1
Seq.2

Name of the current operating mode.


Master transpose

The following illustration shows parameters appearing when


an Audio CD Track has been selected.
Song type icon

Panels

Operating mode
name

Seq.1
Seq.2

SB

Master transpose value in semitones. This value can be changed


using the TRANSPOSE buttons on the control panel.
Note: Transpose may be automatically changed when selecting a
different Performance. It may also be changed when loading a
Standard MIDI File generated with an instrument of the Korg Pa
series.
To avoid transposing, lock the Master Transpose parameter in the
Global (see General Controls: Lock on page 232), then write the
Global to memory (see Write Global - Global Setup dialog box
on page 257).

Seq. 1/2
A different Song may be assigned to each of the two onboard
sequencers (Seq.1 and Seq.2). Each sequencer has its own
parameters.

Reference

Perf./
STS
area

140

Song Play operating mode


Main page

Song type icon

Meter

Songs of different types can be assigned to the sequencers. This


icon shows the file type.

This parameter appears when a Standard MIDI File (or a Karaoke


file) has been selected.

Standard MIDI File, often abbreviated as SMF


(file extension: *.MID or *.KAR). The SMF
(*.MID) is the industry standard song format,
used by Pa1X as its basic Song format when
recording a new Song. A MIDI Karaoke File
(*.KAR) is an extension of the SMF format.
MPEG Layer-3 format, or MP3 (file extension:
*.MP3) available with the EXBP-MP3 option
installed. Only assignable to one of the sequencers
at a time. This is a compressed audio file, that
may be generated on any personal computer, or
on the Pa1X itself.
Note: If starting an MP3 files playback on a
Sequencer, another MP3 file running on the other
Sequencer will be stopped. You cannot play two
MP3 files at the same time.
Note: If running an MP3 from a Data CD, and the
CD is not spinning, it may take some time before
the playback begins, since the CD needs a few seconds to start spinning again.
Audio CD Track available with the CDRW-1
option installed. Only assignable to one of the
sequencers at a time
Only assignable to Sequencer 1. A Jukebox file (file
extension: *.JBX) can be assigned to Sequencer 1,
but its name is not shown in this area. The JBX
icon appears, together with the name of the currently selected Song in the Jukebox list.
Note: To create or edit a Jukebox file, go to the Jukebox Edit page (see page 151).
Song name
Displays the name of the Song assigned to the corresponding
sequencer.

Current Song meter.


Measure number
This parameter appears when a Standard MIDI File (or a Karaoke
file) has been selected.
Current measure number.
Total time
This parameter appears when an Audio CD Track or an MP3 file
has been selected.
Total length (in minutes:seconds) of the selected Audio CD
Track or MP3 file.
Elapsed time
This parameter appears when an Audio CD Track or an MP3 file
has been selected.
Elapsed time (in minutes:seconds) of the Audio CD Track or
MP3 file currently in play.
Tempo
This parameter appears when a Standard MIDI File (or a Karaoke
file) has been selected.
Metronome tempo. Select this parameter and use the TEMPO/
VALUE controls to change the tempo. As an alternative, you
dont need to select this parameter; just keep the SHIFT button
pressed and use the DIAL to change the tempo of the selected
sequencer.
Note: While in the main page, you can have the Tempo parameter
of Sequencer 2 selected, while Sequencer 1 is selected. Use the DIAL
to change Tempo for Sequencer 2, and SHIFT + DIAL to change
Tempo for Sequencer 1.
All Songs
This checkbox appears when an Audio CD Track has been selected.

If the sequencer is already selected (white background), press


the Song name to open the Song Select window.

Check this parameter to play all CD tracks, starting from the


selected one.

If the sequencer is not selected (dark background), first select


it, then press the Song name to open the Song Select window.

Performance/STS area

When the Song Select window appears, you can select a single
Song or a Jukebox file (see Song Select window on page 76).
If you select another Song while a Song is in play within the same
Sequencer, the old Song stops, and the new Song will be selected,
ready to play.
To select a Song, you can also press the SELECT button (on the
control panel) corresponding to the desired sequencer. Press
SELECT a second time to select a Song by dialing in its ID number (see Selecting a Song by its ID number on page 77).

This is where the Performance or STS name is shown.

Selected Performance
or STS

Selected Performance or STS


This is the last selected Performance (PERF) or Single Touch Setting (STS).
Press the name to open the Performance Select window. As an
alternative, use the PERFORMANCE/SOUND SELECT section
to select a different Performance.
To select a different STS, use the four SINGLE TOUCH SETTING buttons under the display.

Song Play operating mode


Main page

Style area

Keyboard track name

Currently selected Style. You can select a Style while playing


Songs, to have it ready when switching to Style Play mode.

Non editable. Name of the corresponding track:


UP1

Upper 1

Press the Style name to open the Style Select window. As an


alternative, use the STYLE SELECT section on the control panel.
By selecting a different Style, you can also select a different set of
STSs.

UP2

Upper 2

UP3

Upper 3

LOW

Lower

Keyboard track octave transpose

Keyboard tracks area

You can also transpose all Upper tracks by using the UPPER
OCTAVE buttons on the control panel.

This is where Keyboard tracks are shown.


Upper octave
transpose

Keyboard track status

Play/mute status of the current track. Press this icon to change


the status.

Track name
Track status

Sound name

SB

Note: You can save this setting into the Global-Song Play Setup (by
choosing the Write Global-Song Play Setup command from the
page menu), to leave the track status unchanged when selecting a
different Standard MIDI File. This way, you can leave, for example,
the bass track in mute, and let you bassist play it live.
SB

Name of the Sound assigned to the corresponding Keyboard


track.

However, the above is not true when reading a Standard MIDI File
created with a Pa-Series instrument. These files do include special
commands to force the Play/Mute status of each track.
Play status. The track can be heard.

If the track is already selected (white background), press the


Sound name to open the Sound Select window.

Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

If the track is not selected (dark background), first select it,


then press the Sound name to open the Sound Select window.

Panels

Sound bank

The lower half of the main page contains the various panels, you
can select by pressing the corresponding tabs. See more information in the relevant sections, starting from page 143.

SB

Bank the current Sound belongs to.

Volume panel

Program Change

SB

Program Change number. Shown only when the Show Program


Change number parameter is turned on in Global mode. (See
page 234).

Tabs

Reference

Sound
bank

SB

Non editable. Octave transpose of the corresponding track. To


individually edit the octave transpose for each track, go to the
Mixer/Tuning: Tuning edit page of the Song Play mode (see
Mixer/Tuning: Tuning on page 86 for more details).

Selected Style

Sound
name

141

142

Song Play operating mode


Song Tracks 1-8 and 9-16 pages

Program Change

Song Tracks 1-8 and 9-16 pages


Repeatedly press the TRK. SEL. button to cycle between the Normal, Song Tracks 1-8 and Song Tracks 9-16 view. In Song Track
views, the upper half of the main page changes, to show parameters for the Song tracks.
Songs area

Program Change number. Shown only when the Show Program


Change number parameter is turned on. in Global mode (see
page 234).

Sounds area
This area lets you see Sounds and octave transposition for the
eight tracks currently displayed.

Selected track
info area
Song track octave
transpose

Sounds area

Sound name

Song track octave transpose


Non editable. Octave transpose of the corresponding track. To
edit the octave transpose, go to the Mixer/Tuning: Tuning edit
page of the Song Play mode (see Mixer/Tuning: Tuning on
page 86 for more details).
Track name

Sound name
Name of the Sound assigned to the track. Touch a name a first
time to select the corresponding track (detailed information are
shown on the Selected Track Info area, see above). Touch it a second time to open the Sound Select window.

Press TRK. SEL. again to return to Normal view (Keyboard


tracks). (See Main page on page 139).

Songs area
Despite a different layout, it works as the Song area in the Normal view.

Selected Track Info area


This line lets you see the Sound assigned to the selected track.
Not only it is shown on the main page, but also in several edit
pages.

Track name

Sound bank
Sound name

Program Change

Track name
Name of the selected track.
Sound name
Sound assigned to the selected track. Press anywhere in this area
to open the Sound Select window, and select a different Sound.
Sound bank
Bank the selected Sound belongs to.

Song Play operating mode


Volume panel

143

each Assignable Slider controls the volume of the corresponding


track.

Volume panel
Press the Volume tab to select this panel. This is where you can
set the volume of each track, and mute/unmute tracks.
Use the TRK. SEL. (TRACK SELECT) button to switch from
Normal (Keyboard and Mic/In tracks) to Song Tracks 1-8 and
Song Tracks 9-16 views.
If the VOLUME LED above the SLIDER MODE button is turned
on, the Assignable Sliders LEDs show which view is currently
selected.

The assigned function may be saved to a Performance. Therefore, when selecting a Performance, the assigned function may
change.
Track status icons
The Normal view shows grouped Style tracks, Mic/In controls,
Keyboard tracks (upper sliders LED turned on):

SB

Play/mute status of the current track. Select the track, then press
this area to change the track status. The status of Keyboard
tracks may be saved to a Performance or STS.
See Keyboard track status on page 141 for more information.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

The Song Tracks 1-8 view shows individual Song tracks 1-8
(third sliders LED turned on):

Track names
Under the sliders, a label for each track is shown. Use the TRK.
SEL button to switch between the various track views.
MIC/IN

Audio inputs. [*]

The Song Tracks 9-16 view shows individual Song tracks 9-16
(last sliders LED turned on):

LOWER

Lower track.

T01T16

Song tracks. [*]

[*] Volume for these tracks is not memorized.

Jukebox panel
Track status icon

Virtual slider

Virtual sliders (track volume)

SB

Virtual sliders are a graphical display of each tracks volume. Use


the Assignable Sliders to change this value (provided the VOLUME LED is turned on above the SLIDER MODE button, see
below).
As an alternative, press the tracks area to select a track, and use
TEMPO/VALUE controls to change the value.
The volume of Keyboard tracks may be saved to a Performance.
Assignable Sliders function

SB

Use the SLIDER MODE button to select the function assigned to


the Assignable Sliders. When the VOLUME LED is turned on,

When a Jukebox (JBX) file is assigned to Sequencer 1, you can


use the list shown in this panel to browse the Jukebox list, and
press the Select button in the display to select a Song to play. This
way, you can select any Song in the list as your starting Song, and
manually change the order of the Songs to play.
Note: A Jukebox file can be assigned to Sequencer 1 only.
Note: This panel is only available after loading a Jukebox file.
Hint: To create or edit a Jukebox file, go to the Jukebox Edit page
(see page 151).
Warning: Should you delete a Song included in the Jukebox list
currently in play, the sequencer will stop, and the No Song message will appear. At this point, you can select the JukeBox tab to
open the Jukebox panel, and select a different Song.
As an alternative, you can select the next Song by pressing SHIFT +
>> (FAST FORWARD) in the SEQUENCER 1 section of the con-

Reference

UPPER13 Upper tracks.

144

Song Play operating mode


Lyrics & Markers panel

trol panel, then press


tion again.
Song list

(PLAY/STOP) in the SEQUENCER 1 sec-

Lyrics & Markers panel


Selected Song

Jukebox file

Lyrics side tabs


These panels show the lyrics and chord abbreviations included
in a Song, or loaded as a .TXT file with the Song. You can see
the following types of Lyrics:

Lyrics included in Standard MIDI Files

Song list

Lyrics included in Karaoke files

Use this list to browse through the Songs in the Jukebox list. Use
the scrollbar to scroll the list.

Lyrics included in MP3 files (in ID3 format see


www.id3.org)

Selected Song

Lyrics loaded as a .TXT file with a Standard MIDI File,


Karaoke or MP3 file (see Text files loaded with Standard
MIDI Files and MP3 files below)

Name of the Song currently in play. You can select a different


Song from the list, and press the Select button in the display to
selected it for playback.
Select button

Lyrics will be shown only if they are compatible with a standard


format that Pa1X can understand.
Song chords

Current measure

Press this button to select the Song highlighted in the list, and
assign it to Sequencer 1. If a Song is already playing, it will be
stopped, and the selected Song will start playing back.

Recorgnized chord

Selected
sequencer

Jukebox file
Song
name

Name of the selected Jukebox file. To edit this file, see Jukebox
Editor on page 151.

Display
options

Transport controls for the Jukebox


When you select a Jukebox file, Sequencer 1 transport controls
work in a slightly different way than with single Songs.
<< and >>

Pressed alone, these buttons are the Rewind and


Fast Forward commands.
Keep the SHIFT button pressed, and press
these buttons to scroll to the previous or next
Song in the Jukebox list.

PAUSE

Pauses the Song at the current position. Press


PAUSE or
(PLAY/STOP) to start the Song
playing again.

While the Song is playing, the text flows in the display. Chord
abbreviations (if any) will appear above the lyrics, in time with
the music (depending on the Show Chords parameter status,
under the Options side tab). Lyrics at the current position are
highlighted.
Song chords
Chords contained in the midifile (if any). This indicator may be
easier to read than chords shown within the lyrics.

(PLAY/STOP)
Starts or stops the current Song. When you stop
the Song, the sequencer goes back to measure 1 of
the current Song.
If the Jukebox panel is open, you can select the
Song from which to start. See Jukebox panel
above.

Current measure
Current measure number.
Recognized chord
Chords played on the keyboard, and recognized by the chord
scanning engine.
Selected sequencer (SEQ 1/SEQ 2)
Use these side tabs to select a sequencer whose Song to show.
Note: You can have Sequencer 2 selected in the Main page of the
Song Play mode, and Sequencer 1 selected in the Lyrics page, or
vice-versa. This way, you can select a Song whose lyrics to display
on the external video monitor, while selecting a different sequencer
for editing operations.

Song Play operating mode


Lyrics & Markers panel

145

Song name

How to delete a marker:

Song assigned to the selected sequencer. Use the side tabs SEQ 1
and SEQ 2 to select a sequencer whose Song to show.

1.

Touch the marker to be deleted in the display.

2.

Press the Delete button in the display to delete the selected


marker.

Markers side tabs


Standard Song Markers contained in a midifile can be read with
the Pa1X, to quickly jump to a given position in the Song. Additionally, you can set your own marker points on-the-fly.
Press one of these side tabs to access the Marker panel corresponding to one of the two sequencers.

How to save the markers:


From the page menu, choose the Save Song Marker Seq.1 or
Save Song Marker Seq.2 (depending on the sequencer where
you created the markers). The markers will be saved into the
midifile.
Auto Scroll
Check this parameter if you want the current marker to be
always visible in the display during playback, by making the list
of markers scroll automatically.
Dont check this parameter, if you prefer to prevent the list from
scrolling. This is useful if you want a marker to remain in the
display, ready to be selected as soon as you want to jump to its
position, with no need to scroll the list to catch it out.

Options side tab


Note: Markers do not work when the Groove Quantize is activated.

Press this side tab to access the Options panel, and adjust the
various video settings (see details below).

Note: It is not advisable to use them with a Jukebox file assigned to


Sequencer 1, since pressing PLAY/STOP would delete the markers.

1.

Go to the Song Play > Mark Seq.1 (Seq.2) page.

2.

Start the Song by pressing the SEQ.1 (SEQ.2) PLAY/STOP


button.

3.

When you reach the position you want to save as a marker,


press the Add button in the display.

Display Controls

If you press Add within the first beats of the measure, the
beginning of the current measure is saved as a marker.

Use these parameters to define how lyrics are shown in the display.

If you press Add within the last beat of the measure, the
beginning of the followng measure is saved as a marker.

Characters

4.

Do the same for any following marker.

5.

Stop the Song by pressing the SEQ.1 (SEQ.2) PLAY/STOP


button.

Size of fonts. You can choose between a smaller and a bigger


font.
Link int and ext video

How to jump to a saved marker:


1.

Start the Song again.

2.

When you want to jump to a saved marker, touch it in the


display. The Song will jump to the saved position at the
beginning of the next measure.

How to edit a marker:

Sng

Sng

When checked, settings for the internal display are automatically


mirrored to the external video monitor.
Show chords

Sng

If this parameter is checked, chords are shown above lyrics in the


display provided the midifile contains them.

1.

Touch the marker to be edited in the display.

TXT File Text Follow

2.

Press the Edit button in the display to set the marker to


edit. The Edit Marker window will appear.

3.

While in Edit Marker window, you can edit the name and
position of the marker being edited.

When linking a .TXT file to a Song, you scroll the text by using
the Text Down and Text Up assignable commands. Unlike the
reading of Lyrics events contained in a Standard MIDI File, there
is no automatic scrolling, that make the current verse start on
top of the internal and the external display at the same time.

Sng

Therefore, text shown in the internal display and in the external


video might begin with a different verse. This parameter lets you

Reference

How to add a marker:

146

Song Play operating mode


STS Name panel

choose the internal or the external display as the one that must
be perfectly lined.
Int. Video

Ext. Video

When pressing the control corresponding to the


Text Down command, the first line of the current
page of text is shown on top of the internal video.
The external video might not be perfectly lined.
Choose this option if you are reading verses from
the internal display.
When pressing the control corresponding to the
Text Down command, the first line of the current
page of text is shown on top of the external video.
The internal video might not be perfectly lined.
Choose this option is your audience is reading
verses from an external video.
Note: When this option is selected, the text scrollbar
disappears from the internal display.

STS Name panel


Select this panel to see the name of the four available STSs. See
STS Name panel on page 82 for details.

Mic panel
Select this panel to set parameters for the microphone input. See
Mic panel on page 82 for details.

Sub-Scale panel

Text files loaded with Standard MIDI Files


and MP3 files

Select this panel to select a secondary scale for the Keyboard


tracks. See Mixer/Tuning: Sub Scale on page 86 for details.

When a .TXT file exists in the same directory as a Standard


MIDI File or MP3 file, and shares exactly the same name, it will
be loaded with the .MID or MP3 file, and can be seen in the
Lyrics page.

Pad panel

As an example, if the file MYSONG.TXT exists in the same


directory as the MYSONG.MID or MYSONG.MP3 file, it is
loaded together with the matching .MID or .MP3 file.

Select this panel to see which Hit or Sequence Pads are assigned
to the four Pads. See Pad panel on page 83 for details.

However, unlike ordinary Lyrics, the text will not scroll automatically while the Song is playing back. You must scroll it with the
DIAL. As an alternative, you can use an assignable switch or
footswitch, with the Text Page Up or Text Page Down functions
assigned, to scroll (respectively) to the previous or next text
page.
Note: When a .TXT file is loaded with the Song, it overrides any
included Lyrics data.

Split panel
Select this panel to adjust the split point for the Keyboard tracks.
See Split panel on page 83 for details.

Song Play operating mode


Edit menu

147

Parameters area

Edit menu
From any page, press the MENU button to open the Song Play
edit menu. This menu gives access to the various Song Play edit
sections for the currently selected sequencer (see Songs area
on page 142).

Each page contains various parameters. Use the tabs to select


one of the pages. For detailed information on the various types
of parameters, see sections starting from page 147.
Tabs
Use tabs to select one of the edit pages of the current edit section.

When in the menu, select an edit section, or press EXIT or


SONG PLAY to exit the menu.
When in an edit page, press the EXIT or SONG PLAY button to
go back to the main page of the Song Play operating mode.

Switching between sequencers during


editing
When you enter Edit mode, you can edit the selected sequencers
parameters. The selected sequencer is always shown on the page
header.

Each item in this menu corresponds to an edit section. Each edit


section groups various edit pages, that may be selected by pressing the corresponding tab on the lower part of the display.

To select a sequencer, go to the main page of the Song Play


mode, and select the sequencers you wish to edit. The selected
sequencer is shown with a white background.

Edit page structure


All edit pages share some basic elements.
Edit section

Page menu
icon
Selected
track info

Parameters
area

Mixer/Tuning: Volume/Pan
This page lets you set the volume and pan for each of the Keyboard or Song tracks.
Note: Song parameters cannot be saved when saving to a Performance or STS.
Note: A muted track may be reset when selecting a different Song.

Tabs

Operating mode
This indicates that the instrument is in Song Play mode.
Selected sequencer
Before entering edit, select one of the two sequencers, by using
the Song area of the main page (see Switching between
sequencers during editing below).
Edit section
This identifies the current edit section, corresponding to one of
the items of the edit menu (see Edit menu on page 147).
Page menu icon
Press this icon to open the page menu (see Page menu on
page 155).

Reference

Selected
Operating mode sequencer

148

Song Play operating mode


Mixer/Tuning: FX Send

Use the TRK. SEL. button to switch from the Keyboard to the
Song tracks, and vice versa.

Off

If the tracks output status is Left&Right (normal


setting), the direct (uneffected) signal is not sent
to the outputs; only the FX signal is heard for this
track.
If the track is sent to a separate output, no FX is
sent to any output.
To program the output status for each track, see
Audio Output: Seq1 and Audio Output: Seq2
on page 239.

Volume

SB

Tracks volume.
0127

MIDI value of the tracks volume.

Play/Mute icon

SB

Sng

Tracks play/mute status. See Keyboard track status on


page 141 for more information.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

Mixer/Tuning: FX Send
This page lets you set the level of the tracks direct (uneffected)
signal going to the Internal FX processors.
Note: Song parameters cannot be saved when saving to a Performance or STS.
The effect processors included in Pa1X are connected in parallel,
so you can decide which percentage of the direct signal can be
effected:
Upper Volume Link

Track

Sty

This parameter allows you to define if changing the volume for


one of the Upper tracks, proportionally changes also the volume
for the other Upper tracks.
To save this parameter status, go to the Style Play mode, then
select the Write Global-Style Play Setup from the page menu (see
Write Global-Song Play Setup dialog box on page 156).
Note: This parameter is the same you can find in the Preferences:
Global Setup page of the Style Play mode (see page 96).
On

Off

FX Processor
In case you do not want to send a tracks direct signal to the output, but only the effected signal (as when using insert effects,
like Rotary, Distortion, EQ), just set the Pan to Off (see Pan
above):

Track

When changing volume to one of the Upper


tracks, volume for the other Upper tracks
changes in proportion.
When changing volume to one of the Upper
tracks, only that tracks volume is changed. Other
Upper tracks are left unchanged.

Pan

SB

Track position in the stereo field.


-64-1

Left stereo channel.

Center.

+1+63

Right stereo channel.

Out L/R

Out L/R

FX Processor
There are four Internal FX processors in Song Play mode. Usually, they are arranged as follows:
FX A

Reverb processor for Sequencer 1 and 2.

FX B

Modulating FX processor for Sequencer 1 and 2.

FX C

Reverb processor for Keyboard tracks.

FX D

Modulating FX processor for Keyboard tracks.

Depending on the status of the Seq.2 FX Mode parameter,


Sequencer 2 might use the C/D effect pair (see page 154).
Furthermore, in Sequencer mode you can create Songs using all
four effects (see Effects: FX Select on page 180).

149

Song Play operating mode


Mixer/Tuning: Tuning

Use the TRK. SEL. button to switch from Keyboard to Song


tracks, and vice-versa.

Mixer/Tuning: Tuning
Parameters in this page let you set various tuning settings. See
Mixer/Tuning: Tuning on page 86 for details.
Parameters

SB

Note: Song track values edited in this page are not saved, and are
only intended for realtime use.

Effects: FX Select
This page allows you to select effects to be assigned to the four
Internal FX processors (A-D).

Note: When you stop the Song, or select a different Song, the
default effects are selected again. You can, however, stop the Song,
change the effects, then start the Song again. Edit the Song in
Sequencer mode to permanently change the effects.

Note: When you stop, then start the Song again, or select a different
Song, the default Song track settings are selected again. You can,
however, pause the Song, change the effects, then exit fro pause and
start the Song again. Edit the Song in Sequencer mode to permanently change the effects.

SB

Effects assigned to the corresponding effect processors. Usually,


A and C are reverbs, while B and D are modulating effects (chorus, flanger, delay). For a list of the available effects, see
Effects on page 329.
Wet/Dry

Send level (AD)


0127

SB

Level of the track (direct) signal sent to the effect


processor.

Play/Mute icon

SB

Sng

Tracks play/mute status. See Keyboard track status on


page 141 for more information.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

Sng

SB

Sng

Mix between the effected (Wet) and direct (uneffected, Dry) signal.
Dry

Direct signal only.

Wet

Effected signal only.

nn:nn

Percentage of Wet/Dry signal.

B to A, D to C

SB

Sng

Amount of the B effect going back to the input of the A effect, or


of the D effect going back to the input of the C effect.
Mod.Track (Modulating Track)

Sng

Source track for modulating MIDI messages. You can modulate


an effect parameter with a MIDI message generated by a physical
controller or a Song track.

Reference

FX AD

150

Song Play operating mode


Effects: FX AD

Effects in Song Play mode

Wet/Dry

Pa1X is equipped with four effect processors, or DSPs (Digital


Signal Processors), to process MIDI tracks. In Song Play mode
you can have two or four effects at the same time, depending on
the midifile you are reading.

Mix between the effected (Wet) and direct (uneffected, Dry) signal. This is the same as the Wet/Dry parameters found in the
Effects: FX Select page (see above).

Effects A and B are usually reserved to both sequencers, while


effects C and D are usually reserved to Keyboard tracks and
Pads.

Src (Source)

Depending on the status of the Seq.2 FX Mode parameter,


each effect pair could be reserved to a different Sequencer (see
page 154).
You can also create Songs that make use all four effects in
Sequencer mode.

A Song created on the Pa1X (in Sequencer mode) can use


up to 4 effects (usually 2 reverbs + 2 modulating effects);
each track may use the A/B or C/D pair.

SB

SB

Sng

Sng

Modulation source. To select the track generating this message,


see the Mod.Track (Modulating Track) parameters found in
the Effects: FX Select page (see above). For a list of modulation
source, see the Effects chapter.

Track Controls: Mode


These parameters let you set the Internal/External, and the Poly/
Mono status of Song tracks. See Track Controls: Mode on
page 88.

A Standard MIDI File or Karaoke file will only use 2


effects (usually 1 reverb + 1 modulating effect). This lets
you use the remaining 2 effects for the Realtime tracks.

When using both sequencers at the same time, and the


Seq.2 FX Mode is set to AB mode (see page 154), they
only use the A/B pair, while the C/D pair is reserved to the
Keyboard tracks.

Note: These parameters can be saved to the Global-Song Play


Setup, by selecting the Write Global-Song Play Setup command
from the page menu.

When using both sequencers at the same time, and the


Seq.2 FX Mode is set to CD mode (see page 154),
Sequencer 1 uses the A/B pair, while Sequencer 2 uses the
C/D pair, sharing it with Keyboard tracks.

Track Controls: Drum Volume

Parameters

SB

Sng

These parameters let you adjust the volume for each percussive
instrument family. See Track Controls: Drum Volume on
page 150.

Effects: FX AD

Parameters
These pages contain the editing parameters for the four effect
processors. Here is an example of the FX A page, with the Reverb
Smooth Hall effect assigned.

SB

Note: Song track values edited in this page are not saved, and are
only intended for realtime use.

Selected effect

Track Controls: Easy Edit


FX parameters

These parameters let you fine-tune edit parameters for Sounds


assigned to the tracks. See Track Controls: Easy Edit on
page 90.
Parameters

SB

Note: Song track values edited in this page are not saved, and are
only intended for realtime use.

Selected effect

SB

Sng

Select one of the available effects from this pop-up menu. This is
the same as the FX AD parameters found in the Effects: FX
Select page (see above).
FX parameters

SB

Keyboard/Ensemble: Keyboard Control


These parameters let you set parameters for the Keyboard tracks.
See Keyboard/Ensemble: Keyboard Control on page 91.

Sng

Parameters may differ, depending on the selected effect. See


Effects on page 329 for a list of available parameters for each
effect type.

Parameters

SB

Song Play operating mode


Keyboard/Ensemble: Key/Velocity Range

151

Keyboard/Ensemble: Key/Velocity Range

If a Jukebox file is already selected into a Sequencer, you will


enter this page with that file ready to be edited. Otherwise, you
will enter this page with an empty list.

These parameters let you select a note and velocity range for the
Keyboard tracks. See Keyboard/Ensemble: Key/Velocity Range
on page 91.

To create a new Jukebox file, press Del All to remove all Songs or
the current list. Add new Songs, then press Save and enter a different name before confirming. A new Jukebox file will be saved
to disk.

Parameters

Move Up/Down

SB

Use these button to move the selected item up or down in the


list.

Keyboard/Ensemble: Ensemble

Add
Adds a Song at the end of the current list. You can add up to 127
Songs in a list.

See Keyboard/Ensemble: Ensemble on page 92.


Parameters

SB

Note: A Jukebox list can include only Songs contained in the same
folder.
Hint: Instead of a single Song, you can select a Jukebox file, and
add its whole content to the current Jukebox list.

Pad/Switch: Pad

Insert
See Pad/Switch: Pad on page 94.
Parameters

SB

Inserts a Song at the current position (i.e., between the selected


item and the preceding one). All subsequent Songs are moved to
the next higher-numbered slot. You can add up to 127 Songs in a
list.
Note: A Jukebox list can include only Songs contained in the same
folder.

Pad/Switch: Assignable Switch

Hint: Instead of a single Song, you can select a Jukebox file, and
insert its whole content to the current Jukebox list.

See Pad/Switch: Assignable Switch on page 94.


Delete
Parameters

SB

This command lets you delete the selected Song from the list.

Jukebox Editor

Select this command to delete the whole Jukebox list.


Save

The Jukebox function lets you play a list of Songs (127 max), at
the simple touch of a button. You can play a Jukebox file by
assigning it to Sequencer 1, after having selected it in the Song
Select page, just as if it was an ordinary Song (see Jukebox
panel on page 143).

Press this button to save the Jukebox file to disk. The Save Jukebox File dialog box appears, allowing you to edit the name and
save your file to disk.

Press the
(Text Edit) button to open the Text Edit window,
and edit the name.

In this page, you can create, edit and save a Jukebox file. A Jukebox list can contain Standard MIDI Files, Karaoke files, and
MP3 files. (Note: MP3 files are only supported with the EXBPMP3 option installed).

If you are editing an existing list, and do not change its name, the
old file is overwritten. If you change it, a new file will be created
on disk.
If you are saving a new list, the NEWNAME.JBX name is automatically assigned, and you can edit it.
Note: You can save your .JBX file only in the same folder as the
Song files included in the list.

Reference

Del All

152

Song Play operating mode


Groove Quantize

division. When you select 1/4, all notes are moved


to the nearest 1/4 division.

Groove Quantize
No quantization

You can apply a realtime groove-quantization to Sequencer 1.


Groove-quantization is a way of changing the music groove during the playback, moving notes to the nearest axis of a rhythmic
grid. Please feel free to experiment: this function is a great
source of musical inspiration.

1/8

1/4

To enable groove quantize, you can either use the command in


this page, or check the Groove Quantize Enable command in the
page menu.
Accuracy

Accuracy percentage of quantize. For example, if Acc=50, and


the note is 20 tics away from the coarse grid, it is moved to the
grid of only 10 tics.
0

No accuracy. The quantize is not executed.

100

Maximum accuracy. The note is moved exactly at


the grid position.

Swing
Note: Groove Quantize parameters are not saved, as they are only
intended for realtime use.

Asymmetry of quantization. Grid axis are moved to the nearest


grid axis.
0

Even-numbered axis are totally moved over the


previous odd-numbered axis.

50

Axis are perfectly equidistant.

100

Even-numbered axis are totally moved over the


following odd-numbered axis.

Enable
Enables/disables quantization. It is automatically set to Off each
time the instrument is turned on, or when selecting a different
Song.
Hint: You can enable/disable the Groove Quantize also by selecting
the Seq.1-Groove Quantize Enable command from the page
menu.

Swng=50

Swng=25

Note Start
Enables/disables quantization of the Note On event (i.e. beginning of the note).

Swng=75

Note Duration
Enables/disables quantization of the Note Off event (i.e. the
length of the note).

Window

Resolution

Coarse quantize grid resolution. This parameter is the main


quantization value, to be varied with the Acc, Swing and Window values.

The quantize window corresponds to the axis. No


quantization happens.

100

The quantize window extends to the nearest window; all events are quantized.

 (1/32) (1/4)
Grid resolution, in musical values (a 3 after the
value means triplet). For example, when you
select 1/8, all notes are moved to the nearest 1/8

Area of quantize intervention, bordering the grid axis.

Win=0

Win=50

Win=100

Song Play operating mode


Preferences: Track Settings

153

is totally moved away from a generating sequencer,


and may interfere with the Song you are listening
to.

Preferences: Track Settings


In this page, you can set various general parameters referred to
Song tracks.

Global

Chords are sent from the Chord Scanning area of


the keyboard.

Preferences: General Control


In this page, you can set various general parameters.

Note: These settings are stored in the Song Play Setup area of the
Global file (together with all the other parameters marked with the
abbreviation in the manual). After changing these settings,
select the Write Global-Song Play Setup command from the page
menu to save them to the Global.
Sng

Melody

Sng

This parameter selects the Songs Melody track. This track can be
muted using the Melody Mute function, assignable to an
Assignable Switch, Footswitch or EC5 pedal.
Drum

Sng abbreviation through the manual). After changing these


settings, select the Write Global-Song Play Setup command from
the page menu to save them to the Global.

Sng

Midi Setup

Bass

Sng

This parameter selects the Songs Bass track. This track is left set
to play (together with the Drum track) when selecting the
Drum&Bass function, assignable to an Assignable Switch,
Footswitch or EC5 pedal.
Harmony Track

Sng

The Voice Processor gets the chord notes (as well as Program
Change messages) from the track selected with this parameter.
No track sends notes to the Harmony module of
the Voice processor. Chords can still be received
from the MIDI IN.

Seq.1-Track 116
Chords are sent from one of Sequencer 1 tracks.
Seq.2-Track 116
Chords are sent from one of Sequencer 2 tracks.
Seq.1+2 Track 116
Notes are sent by a track with the same name
from both Sequencer 1 and Sequencer 2.
Warning: If both sequencers are generating notes at
the same time, the harmonizer will receive notes
from both sequencers. Be warned that notes are sent
to the harmonizer even when the BALANCE slider

Sng

MIDI channels for the Song Play mode can be automatically


configured by selecting a MIDI Setup with this parameter. See
MIDI on page 280 for more information on using MIDI Setups.
Note: To automatically select a MIDI Setup when entering the
Song Play mode, select the Write Global-Song Play Setup command
from the page menu.
For detailed information on MIDI Setup settings, see MIDI
Setup on page 328.
Note: After selecting a MIDI Setup, you can go to the Global mode
and apply any change to each channel setting. To store these
changes to a MIDI Setup, while still in Global mode select the Write
Global-Midi Setup command from the page menu. All MIDI Setups can be freely customized and overwritten.
Hint: To restore the original MIDI Setups, load the original Factory data again (downloadable from www.korgpa.com).
Performance recalls FX CD

Sng

This parameter selects the effects mode for the Performance.


Off

When selecting a Performance, no effect is


selected.

On

The Performance selects the C/D effect pair.


Note: When both this parameter and the Seq.2 FX
Mode parameter are set to select the C/D effect
pair, Sequencer 2 shares its effects with Keyboard
tracks. Therefore, these effects can be changed either
selecting a Song for Sequencer 2, or selecting a Performance.

Reference

This parameter selects the Songs Drum track. This track is left
set to play (together with the Bass track) when selecting the
Drum&Bass function, assignable to an Assignable Switch,
Footswitch or EC5 pedal.

Off

Note: These settings are stored in the Song Play Setup area of the
Global file (together with all the other parameters marked with the

154

Song Play operating mode


Preferences: General Control

Lyrics/Markers Balance Link

Start one of the sequencers, by pressing its own


(PLAY/STOP) control. Then, start the other
sequencer, by pressing the other
(PLAY/
STOP) control; the second sequencer starts at the
next beat (quarter or octave, depending on the
Songs Time Signature).

Sng

This parameter allows you to use the BALANCE slider to select


the Sequencer whose lyrics or markers will be shown in the
built-in display, and whose lyrics will be shown on the external
monitor (provided the optional VIF-3 video interface card is
installed).
Off

When moving the BALANCE cross-fader, only


the Song will be selected. The shown lyrics or
markers will remain unchanged.

On

When moving the BALANCE slider fully to the


left or the right, the corresponding Song will
fade-in, and its lyrics and markers will be selected
and shown in the display or external monitor.

Seq.2 FX Mode

This parameter selects the effects mode for Sequencer 2. When a


4-effects Song is loaded, all four effects are used, independently
from this setting.
AB

The A and B effect pair is used. Sequencer 2


shares its effects with Sequencer 1.

CD

The C and D effect pair is used.

Lyrics
Markers
Seq.1

Note: When this parameter is set to CD, Sequencer


2 shares its effects with Keyboard tracks, so these
effects can be changed either selecting a Song for
Sequencer 2, or selecting a Performance (unless the
Performance recalls FX CD parameter is left
unchecked see above).

Lyrics
Markers
Seq.2

Fast Play
SEQ 1 Best GM Sound
SEQ 2 Best GM Sound

Sng

Sng
Sng

When one of these options is checked, any GM-compliant sound


in the corresponding sequencer is replaced by the best Pa1X
sounds, according to a factory-set table.

Sng

When checked, this function allows to skip the empty setup


beats at the beginning of a song, and immediately start from the
first note. However, any setup data are read and considered.
Get HD Path

Sng

Note: This function does not work on songs created or edited with
the Korg Pa1X, or any other a Pa-Series instrument. This is to prevent changing the original users sound assignment.

Press this button to see the current path of each sequencer. This
lets you know where currently selected Songs are located in the
disks.

Hint: General MIDI (GM) sounds ensure compatibility between


different brands and models of musical instruments, but are hardly
the best-sounding presets. This option can substantially improve
your midifiles playback, even if this is not always true. A little
experimentation is recommended.

If you save these paths to the Global, by selecting the Write Global-Song Play Setup command from the page menu, the first
time you will open the Song Select window, after turning the
instrument on, the selected path will be selected by default.

Link Mode

Sng

The two onboard Sequencers can work each with a different


Tempo (Off), or use the same Tempo (Link modes).
Note: You can always start both sequencers simultaneously. Start
both sequencers simultaneously by keeping SHIFT held down while
pressing one of the
(PLAY/STOP) controls.
Off

The sequencers Tempo are not linked. Each


sequencer uses its own Tempo.

Measure

The two sequencers Tempo are linked together.


The Tempo data written into the Songs are
ignored. Adjust the Tempo using the TEMPO/
VALUE controls.
Start one of the sequencers, by pressing its own
(PLAY/STOP) control. Then, start the other
sequencer, by pressing the other
(PLAY/
STOP) control; the second sequencer starts at the
next measure.

Beat

The two sequencers Tempo are linked together.


The Tempo data written into the Songs are
ignored. Adjust the Tempo using the TEMPO/
VALUE controls.

Song Play operating mode


Page menu

155

If you select the hard disk, just press OK to confirm.

Page menu
Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.

Note: When saved, the text file will be named after the selected
Jukebox file. For example, a Jukebox file named Dummy.jbx will
generate a Dummy.txt file. A new, unnamed Jukebox file will
generate a New_name.txt file. If a file with the same name
already exists on the floppy disk, it will be overwritten without
waiting for any confirmation.
The list will include the progressive number assigned to each Song,
file names in MS-DOS format (8.3), the total number of files in the
list.
For the correct display and printing of the list on a personal computer, use a fixed size (i.e., non-proportional) character in your text
editor.
Seq.1-Groove Quantize Enable
Enables/disables the groove quantize (see Groove Quantize on
page 152). It is automatically unchecked each time the instrument is turned on, or when selecting a different Song.
Note: Groove Quantize only works on Sequencer 1.

Write Performance

Solo Track

Select this command to open the Write Performance dialog box,


and save most of the current control panel settings to a Performance.

Select the track to be soloed, and check this item. You will hear
only the selected track, and the Solo warning will flash on the
page header.

See Write Performance dialog box on page 98 for more information.

Uncheck this item to exit the Solo function.

Select this command to open the Write Global-Song Play Setup


dialog box, and save global settings that are unique to the Song
Play mode.
See Write Global-Song Play Setup dialog box on page 156 for
more information.
Save Song Marker Seq.1/2
Select this command to save the markers created in the corresponding sequencer (see Markers side tabs on page 145).
Export Jukebox List

Keyboard track: The selected Keyboard track is the only track


you can hear when playing on the keyboard. All other Keyboard
tracks are muted. Sequencer tracks are left in play status.
Song track: The selected track is the only Song track you can
hear. All other Song tracks are muted. Keyboard tracks are left in
play status.
Copy/Paste FX
You can copy a single, or all four effects, between Styles, Performances, STSs and Songs. To do this, choose the Copy FX and
Paste FX commands from the page menu of the Style Play,
Song Play or Sequencer modes.

Select this command to save the current Jukebox list as a text file
to a disk. Here is how it works.

To copy a single effect:

1.

1.

2.

While a Jukebox file is assigned to the sequencer, select the


Export Jukebox List command from the page menu.

Select the source Song, Performance, Style or STS, then


go to the page of the single effect you want to copy (FX A,
FX B, FX C, or FX D), or

A dialog box will appear, asking you to select either a floppy


disk or the hard disk.

go to the Effects > FX Select page, to copy all four effects.


This may be useful if you want to copy each of the four
effects into different Performances, Styles or STSs.
2.

Choose the Copy FX command from the page menu.

3.

Select the target Performance, Style or STS, then go to the


page of the single effect you want to paste (FX A, FX B, FX
C, or FX D).

4.

Choose the Paste FX command from the page menu.

To copy all four effects:


3.

Select an option.
If you select the floppy disk, insert a floppy disk in the
disk drive, and press OK to confirm.

1.

Select the source Performance, Style or STS, then go to the


Effects > FX Select page, to copy all four effects.

2.

Choose the Copy FX command from the page menu.

Reference

Write Global-Song Play Setup

The Solo functions works in a slightly different way, depending


on the selected track:

156

Song Play operating mode


Write Global-Song Play Setup dialog box

3.

Select the target Performance, Style or STS, then go to the


page of the Effects > FX Select page.

4.

Choose the Paste FX command from the page menu.

Write Global-Song Play Setup dialog box


Open this dialog box by selecting the Write Global-Song Play
Setup item from the page menu. Here, you can save various Song
Preference settings (see Preferences: Track Settings on
page 153), that are saved to the Global file.

Parameters saved in the Song Play Setup area of the Global are
marked with the

Sng

symbol through the users manual.

Playing back MP3 files


Playing back an MP3 is the same as playing a Standard MIDI
File, with the following exceptions:

You can play only one MP3 file at once.

Tempo cannot be modified.

Lyrics cannot be displayed.

You need the EXBP-MP3 option to read MP3 files.

Playing back Audio CD tracks


Playing back an Audio CD Track is the same as playing a Standard MIDI File, with the following exceptions:

You can play only one Audio CD Track at once.

Tempo cannot be modified.

Lyrics cannot be displayed.

You need the CDRW-1 option to read Audio CD Tracks.

You can play a whole CD by selecting the All option while


in the main page of the Song Play mode (see All Songs on
page 140).

SongBook
Book

157

SongBook
The SongBook is an onboard database that allows you to organize various musical resources (Style, Standard MIDI Files,
KAR files, and optionally MP3 files) for easy retrieving.
The SongBook mode overlaps the Style Play and Song Play operating modes. When you select an entry from the database, the
Style Play or Song Play mode is automatically selected, depending on the type of file associated with the entry.
In addition to helping you organize your shows, the SongBook
allows you to associate up to four STSs to each Standard MIDI
File or MP3, played back in Song Play mode. This way, it is easy
to recall a complete setup for Keyboard tracks, effects, and the
Voice Processor, for realtime playing over a midifile or MP3.
For more information on using the SongBook, see the Quick
Guide (starting from page 56).
Note: SongBook entries do not include actual data, but only a
pointer to a Style in memory, a Standard MIDI File, or an MP3
file. When you copy a SongBook file, referenced files are not copied
with it.
Warning: If you load a SongBook list from disk (.SBD file), the
existing one in memory is deleted. Save your old SongBook list
before loading a new one.

List Header
The List Header may change, depending on the type of data
associated with the selected entry.

When a Style is associated to the entry, the currently


selected entrys name is shown on the left (N:), and the
associated Style is shown on the right (Style:):

When a Standard MIDI File or MP3 is associated to the


entry, the list header is split into two parts, with the left half
referring to Sequencer 1, and the right one referring to
Sequencer 2.
Information for the selected entrys name (N:) and associated Standard MIDI File or MP3 (S1: or S2:) is given
for each sequencer:

Note: If you select a different Style, Standard MIDI File or


MP3, the entrys name field (N:) returns blank (---),
meaning the entry has been modified.

Book

Full list of the SongBook database. Use the scrollbar to browse


through the list.

The Book page contains the full database of song entries (i.e., an
.SBD file). While in this page, you can select an entry, and press
the Select button in the display to start playback.

You can touch one of the heading labels above the list to change
the order in which entries are shown. For example, by touching
the Name label, the list is alphabetically re-ordered according
to the file names. The selected label turns red, showing the currently selected ordering.

If the Enable List Edit command is selected in the page menu


(see above), the Add to list button becomes available, to let you
add entries to the selected Custom List.
List Header

Main list
Scrollbar

The corresponding items in the page menu are automatically


updated to reflect these changes (see Sort by Type/Name/
Genre/Artist/Key/Tempo/Meter on page 164).

Scrollbar
Use the scrollbar to scroll the entries.
Commands

Commands
Each entry of this database may include the songs author, name,
genre, original key, tempo and meter. When selecting one of the
entries, the associated Style, MP3 or Standard MIDI File is automatically recalled.

Filtered
When this box is checked, only entries matching the selected filter criteria are shown in the Main list. The box is automatically
checked when you exit from the Filter dialog box by pressing OK
(see below).

Reference

Main list

158

SongBook
Book

Filter

After you select this command, the Num column appears:

Press this button to open the Filter dialog box, and select one or
more filter criteria, to show a restricted set of entries in the main
list.

Press the
(Text Edit) button next to the search criteria you
want to edit (Name, Genre, or Artist). You can also select a
Meter, or a range of Tempo values.
Press the Clear button next to the search criterion you want to
delete or set to a default value.

To see the Key column again, select the Show Key (now Song
Numbers) command from the page menu.
To select a SongBook entry by entering its number, press the
SONGBOOK button again while you are in any page of the
SongBook mode. The numeric keypad will appear, allowing you
to enter the number corresponding to the desired entry.

Press Clear All to reset all search criteria, excluding Tempo.

Selecting SongBook entries via MIDI

Add to list

SongBook entries can be selected via MIDI (through the special


Control channel), by using the NRPN dedicated Control Change
messages #99 (MSB, with value 2) and #98 (LSB, with value 64).

Select an entry, then press this button to add the selected entry
to the current Custom List (see Custom List on page 162).
Select
Press this button to confirm selection of the highlighted entry in
the main list. After pressing this button, the name of the selected
entry appears in the left upper corner of the display (N:).

Setting the special Control MIDI channel


First of all, go to the Global > MIDI > Setup/General Control
page and select a MIDI Setup to be used when you will remotely
select SongBook entries.

When you select a song in any of the SongBook lists, its name
appears in reversed text, over a dark-blue background. While in
this situation, the song is selected, but not yet in play.

Then go to the Global > MIDI > Midi In Channel page, to assign
a MIDI channel to the special Control channel. Assign the Control option to one of the sixteen available MIDI channels (usually one of the higher-numbered ones).

When you press the Select button in the display, the song starts
to play. The blue background turns to green, to show the Song is
selected and currently in play.

When done, save this setting to the current MIDI Setup by


choosing the Write Global-Midi Setup command from the
page menu.

Numeric selection of entries

If you plan to use a different MIDI channel for the Style Play and
Song Play modes, repeat the above to create a second MIDI
Setup.

When in SongBook mode, you can select a SongBook entry by


means of an unique number. Numbers associated with each
entry are added in the Book Edit 2 page (see Book Edit 2 on
page 161).
To see the numbers while in the Book page, select the Show
Song Numbers (now Key) command from the page menu:

Assigning a MIDI Setup to the Style Play and Song Play


modes
Since SongBook entries dynamically recall the Style Play or the
Song Play modes, it is advisable to assign them the same MIDI
Setup, or two different MIDI Setups with the Control channel
assigned to the same MIDI channel. This way, the same MIDI
channel will be used to select a SongBook entry in either the
Style Play or Song Play mode.
When one of the operating modes is recalled, the MIDI Setup
memorized in the Style Play Setup or in the Song Play Setup will
be automatically selected, and MIDI channels will be automatically configured.
To assign a MIDI Setup to each of the two operating modes:
In Style Play mode, go to the Style Play > Preferences > Style
Setup page, and select a MIDI Setup. Select the Write GlobalStyle Setup command from the page menu.
In Song Play mode, go to the Song Play > Preferences > General Control page, and select the same MIDI Setup assigned to

SongBook
Book Edit 1

the Style Play mode. Select the Write Global-Song Play Setup
command from the page menu.

159

Book Edit 1

Selecting SongBook entries via MIDI


When you are ready to remotely select SongBook entries, switch
to the Style Play or Song Play mode.
At this point, Pa1X must receive on the special Control channel
the NRPN Control Change messages #99 (MSB, with value 2)
and #98 (LSB, with value 64) in fast succession, as an initialization string. This string must be sent only once, unless another
NRPN control is sent on the same MIDI channel before selecting
a different SongBook entry.

The Book Edit 1 page is where you to add or modify SongBook


entries.
Hint: Use the Filter in the Book page, to quickly find an entry to be
edited.
The Book Edit 1 page with a Style-based entry:

After the initialization string has been sent, you must send the
selection string, made of two Control Change messages: CC#06
(Data Entry MSB) for the thousands and hundreds, and CC#38
(Data Entry LSB) for the tens and units. The range of the Data
Entry controls, in this case, is 0~99 (instead of the typical
0~127).
The following examples show some typical situations.

Send the following string to select SongBook entry #77:


The Book Edit 1 page with a Song-based entry:
Initialization string (CC#99, 98)
Thousands and hundreds (00xx)
Tens and units (xx77)

Send the following string to select SongBook entry #100:

Initialization string (CC#99, 98)

Tens and units (xx00)

Send the following string to select SongBook entry #8563:

Initialization string (CC#99, 98)


Thousands and hundreds (85xx)
Tens and units (xx63)

Header
Name
Name of the selected song entry. The name is assigned after you
press the Write button to save the entry to the SongBook list.
Resource
Style, Standard MIDI File or MP3 associated with the saved
entry.
Warning: If you replace this resource with a different one, carrying
the same disk path and name (in case of a Standard MIDI File or
MP3) or memory location number (in case of a Style), the SongBook entry will no longer point to the right data. Be careful not to
delete or move a Style or a file associated with a SongBook entry
from the original location.

Database Area
Genre
Music genre associated with the entry.
Artist
Name of the artist of the song associated with the entry.

Reference

Thousands and hundreds (01xx)

160

SongBook
Book Edit 1

Key Info

Write STS

Original key of the entry. The first field is the key name, the second one is the mode (major or minor).

When saving a SongBook entry, and this parameter is checked,


you can save a single STS or all four Styles STSs.

Tempo

<STS Name> A single STS is saved to the chosen SongBook


STS. The source are the Keyboard and Pad tracks,
as they have been configured by selecting a Performance, Style STS, SongBook STS, or after
manual editing.

Basic tempo of the Style, or starting tempo of the Standard MIDI


File associated with the entry. This may change, if a Tempo
Change event is included with the associated resource.
Note: Even if you can edit this value, the starting value of a Standard MIDI Files is always considered, and overrides this value.
Note: You can edit this value even if an MP3 is associated to the
SongBook entry. However, this is just an indicative value, since you
cannot change the MIDI Tempo of an MP3 file.

When you press Write and choose the Rename/


Overwrite option, only the new STS is overwritten, while the others are left untouched.
All Current Style STS
All four STSs are saved to the current SongBook
entry. The source STSs are those contained in the
Style currently selected in Style Play mode.

Meter Info
Basic meter of the Style, or starting meter of the Standard MIDI
File associated with the entry. This may change, if a Meter
Change event is included with the associated resource.
M.Transp. (Master Transpose)
Master Transpose. When the entry is selected, the Master Transpose for the whole instrument is automatically changed (unless
the Master Transpose is locked).
Note: The Master Transpose value saved with the SongBook entry
overrides any Master Transpose setting contained in the referenced
Song.

When you press Write and choose the Rename/


Overwrite option, all STSs are overwritten.
Note: If the Write STS parameter is not checked, and you choose
the New Song option after having pressed Write, the four STSs of
the last selected SongBook entry are saved in the new entry.
STS Name
Name of the current STS. Press the
(Text Edit) button to
open the Text Edit window, and modify the name.
To STS Location

Resource Area

One of the four STS available for each entry, where you can save
the current settings for Keyboard tracks and the Voice Processor.

Write Current Resource


When checked, a reference to the selected resource (the Style,
SMF, KAR or MP3 file shown on the right of this parameter) is
saved with the entry when pressing Write.

Buttons

When unchecked, no new resource will be saved with the entry.


The original resource associated with the entry will be preserved
when pressing Write.

Press this button to create a new entry. Settings are copied from
the currently selected Style, Standard MIDI File or MP3. The
selected resource will be shown in the Resource Name field
(see above).

When pressing New Song to create a new, blank entry, this


parameter is automatically checked, and cannot be modified. A
reference to the associated resource will be saved with the new
entry.

New Song

Del Song
Press this button to delete the current entry.

Resource Name

Write

Name of the currently selected Style, Standard MIDI File or MP3


file. It may differ from the name of the saved resource, shown on
top of the page (see Resource above).

Press this button to open the Write Song dialog box, and save the
current entry to the main list of the SongBook.

You can select a different resource, by just using the STYLE


SELECT section, or the two SELECT buttons on the control
panel, to select a different Style, Standard MIDI File or MP3 file.
As an alternative, you can exit to the Style Play or Song Play
mode, and select resources from there. Then, press the SONGBOOK button to return to the Book Edit page.
When you press Write, a link to the selected resource(s) is saved
with the entry (provided Write Current Resource is selected
when saving). The resource(s) will be recalled when you selected
the entry it is associated to.

To assign a different name to the entry, press the


button to open the Text Edit window.

(Text Edit)

Select an option to add the new entry to the SongBook:

SongBook
Book Edit 2

Select Rename/Overwrite to overwrite an existing entry,


optionally changing its name. Warning: The older entry will
be deleted!

Select New Song to save a new entry to the SongBook database.

161

When a .TXT file is selected, a special vertical scrollbar


appears in the Lyrics/STS page of the SongBook mode.
Touch it to scroll through the text during the performance.
See Lyrics/STS on page 163.

Scrolling is also possible by means of the Text Page Down/


Up command, that can be assigned to a Footswitch, EC
Switch or Assignable Switch.

This section of the Book Edit 2 page contains two buttons:

Book Edit 2
The Book Edit 2 page is where you select Style options to be
memorized, link a .TXT file, and assign a unique number to
the current entry.

Reset

Press this buttons to unlink the text file from the


entry.

Browse

Press this button to open a standard File Selector,


and select a .TXT file to be linked to the current
SongBook entry.

Song Selection Number

SB

Here you can select a unique number (up to 9,999) to be associated to the current SongBook entry. By typing this number after
pressing the SONGBOOK button again, you will be able to
quickly recall an entry from the Book page (see Numeric selection of entries on page 158).
Assigning a number is not mandatory, but may help you to organize your entries. For example, you can use the different 100s to
create a different way of categorizing your entries by genre or
age.
SB

The status of these functions can be memorized in a SongBook


entry.
Note: If the SongBook entry is based on a Song, Synchro Start and
Synchro Stop appear in grey and cannot be modified, since they
have no effect on a Song.
Unchanged

When selecting this SongBook entry, the status of


the corresponding function is left unchanged.

Off

When selecting this SongBook entry, the status of


the corresponding function is turned off.

On

When selecting this SongBook entry, the status of


the corresponding function is turned on.

Linked .TXT

SB

You can select a text (.TXT) file, and link it to the Style or Song
associated with the current SongBook entry. When you select
this entry, the text file is automatically loaded.
Text files can be seen in the display and in an external monitor
(provided the VIF-3 Video Interface has been installed). Since
there is no automatic synchronization between this kind of lyrics
and the associated songs, you must scroll them manually. This
can be accomplished in either of two ways:

Each number can correspond only to a single entry. You cannot


assign the same number to two or more different entries. Therefore, if you try to save a modified entry without first selecting a
different Song Selection Number, and select the New Song
option in the Write Song dialog box, the following error message
will appear:
This entrys Song Selection Number has already been assigned.
Please assign a different number.
Should this happen, you will automatically be kept in the Book
Edit 2 page. While there, assign a different number (while turning the Dial or pressing the UP/DOWN buttons, you are only
allowed to select numbers that are still free) and try to save the
entry again.
Harmony Track
When selecting a SongBook entry (pointing to a Standard MIDI
File), the Harmony Track can be automatically selected.
Note: If the entry is based on a Style, this parameter is greyed out
(non-selectable).
Unchanged

The previously selected track is left unchanged.

Track Number

The chosen track is selected when choosing the (SMFbased) SongBook entry.

Reference

Synchro Start / Synchro Stop / Memory

162

SongBook
Custom List

Custom List

List Edit

Use this page to select and use one of the available Custom Lists
(i.e., one of the .SBL files saved in the same folder as the .SBD
SongBook file). Custom Lists are lists made of entries extracted
from the main SongBook list (as seen in the Book page). They
allow the use of smaller, customized SongBook lists, suitable for
a single gig or your own music tastes.

This page is only available after checking the Enable List Edit
command in the page menu (see page 164).
Use this page to edit the available Custom Lists. A Custom List is
a set of SongBook entries, created by selecting items from the
Main List.
To add entries to a Custom List, first create or select the list to be
edited in this page. Then, go to the Book page, select the entry to
be added, and press the Add to list button. When finished adding entries, return to this page and edit the selected list.

List Header

Custom list

List Name

Scrollbar

Custom list
Scrollbar

Commands

Hint: You can jump to this page by keeping SHIFT pressed, and
pressing the SONGBOOK button.

Commands

List header
See List Header on page 157.

List Name

Custom list

Name of the selected list. To select a Custom List, go to the Custom List page and use the List pop-up menu.

List of files contained in the selected Custom List. Use the scrollbar to browse through the list.

Scrollbar

Custom list
List of songs contained in the selected Custom List. Use the
scrollbar to browse through the list.

Use the scrollbar to scroll the entries.

Scrollbar
Commands
List pop-up menu
Use this pop-up menu to select one of the available lists.

Use the scrollbar to scroll the entries.

Commands

Next

Move

Press this button to select the next entry in the list.

Use these buttons to move the selected song entry up or down in


the list.

Hint: You can assign this command to an Assignable Switch or


Assignable Footswitch.

Del Song

Select

Press this button to delete the selected song entry from the list.

Press this button to confirm selection of the highlighted entry in


the list. After pressing this button, the name of the selected entry
appears in the left upper corner of the display (N:).

New List

Hint: This command is useful to browse through the list, and select
an entry different than the following one in the list.

Del List

Press this button to create a new, empty Custom List.

Press this button to delete the current list.

SongBook
Lyrics/STS

163

Write
Press this button to save changes to the selected Custom List.

Lyrics/STS
The Lyrics/STS page is where you can see Lyrics and select STSs.

To assign a different name to the selected list, press the


(Text Edit) button to open the Text Edit window.
Select an option to save the edited Custom List:

Select Rename/Overwrite to overwrite an existing list,


optionally changing its name. Warning: The older list will
be deleted!

When a .TXT file is associated to the current song, a vertical


scrollbar appears, allowing you to scroll to the previous or
former text page during the performance.

Select New List to save a new Custom List in memory. This


list will be available in the Custom List page.

Note: You cannot scroll a single line of text at a time; you always
scroll by a whole page of text, either if you press on the scrollbar or
one of the small scrolling arrows.

Press here to scroll to


the next page

Lyrics as text files associated to a SongBook entry

As as consequence, there are four ways of seeing Lyrics on the Pa1X:

In Song Play mode, you can see lyrics contained in a Standard MIDI File as Lyrics events, or in an MP3 with Lyrics
file. To see this kind of lyrics you must press the Lyrics tab
in the Song Play mode.

In SongBook mode, you can see lyrics contained in a Standard MIDI File as Lyrics events, or in an MP3 with Lyrics
file. To see this kind of lyrics you must press the Lyrics/STS
tab in the SongBook mode.

In SongBook mode, you can see lyrics contained in a


.TXT file associated with a Style-based SongBook entry.
To see this kind of lyrics you must press the Lyrics/STS tab
in the SongBook mode.

In SongBook mode, you can see lyrics contained in a


.TXT file associated with a Song-based SongBook entry.
To see this kind of lyrics you must press the Lyrics/STS tab
in the SongBook mode.

In the case of Song-based entries, this is the priority of lyrics


data shown in the display:
i)
ii)

TXT file associated with the entry, overriding


TXT file contained in the same folder as the Standard MIDI
File or MP3 file, recalled by the entry, overriding
iii) Lyrics events contained in the Standard MIDI File or MP3 file.

Reference

Lyrics can be associated to each SongBook entry (either Style or


Song-based) as a .TXT file. See Linked .TXT on page 161 for
more information on this issue.

164

SongBook
Info

Info

Page menu

Use the Info page to see the name of the selected entry, the associated resource(s), the total number of Songs in the SongBook,
the number of filtered entries, the number of available Custom
Lists, and the number of Songs in the current list.

Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.

In case of an entry based on a Style:


Selected entry
Associated
resource

Artist/Genre
Select this command to toggle between the Artist and Genre column on the SongBook list, appearing in the Book and Custom
List page.

In case of an entry based on Standard MIDI Files or MP3s:


Selected entry

Associated
resource(s)

Ascending/Descending
Select this command to toggle between the ascending and
descending view order of the SongBook list. The sorting order is
selected with one of the following commands.
Sort by Type/Name/Genre/Artist/Key/Tempo/Meter
Select one of these command to select the sorting order. The
selected option is shown in red above the entry list.
Enable List Edit
Select this command, and make the checkmark appear, to make
the List Edit page available.
Export as text file

Selected entry
This parameter shows the currently selected entry. If it is blank
(---), the latest selected entry has been modified, or no entry has
been selected yet.
Associated resource

Select this command to open the Export dialog box, and save the
SongBook or Custom List as a text file. The selected filtering will
be applied to the exported list, assuming the Filter button is
checked.
The dialog box is a little different, depending on the page where
you selected this command.

Selected from the Book page:

Selected from the Custom List page:

Style, Standard MIDI File or MP3 associated to the selected


entry.
Song number
Total number of entries in the SongBook list.
Filtered Song number
This parameter shows the number of entries shown in the Book
page, after applying the selected filter. If no filter is selected, this
matches the total number of entries in the SongBook list (see
previous parameter).
Custom List number
This parameter shows the number of available Custom Lists.
Songs in the Current List
Number of entries in the selected Custom List.

SongBook
Page menu

165

Press the
(Text Edit) button to open the Text Edit window
and assign a name to the text file to be saved to disk.

If you select the floppy disk, insert a floppy disk in the disk
drive, and press OK to confirm.

If you select the hard disk, just press OK to confirm.

Reference

Then, select either the floppy disk or the hard disk to save the
file.

166

Sequencer operating mode


Transport controls

Sequencer operating mode


The Sequencer operating mode is the full-featured onboard
sequencer, where you can create a Song from scratch, or edit it.
You can also use this mode to edit the initial parameters of a
Standard MIDI File, either made with an external sequencer or
with Pa1Xs own sequencer.
You can save the new or edited Song as a Standard MIDI File
(SMF, i.e., a file with the .MID extension), and play it back
either in Song Play or Sequencer mode or on any external
sequencer.

Transport controls
To play back a Song, use SEQUENCER 1 transport controls.
While in Sequencer mode, Sequencer 1 is used for all functions.
See SEQUENCER 1 TRANSPORT CONTROLS on page 10 for
more information.

Sequencer Play - Main page


Press SEQUENCER to access this page from another operating
mode. In this page you can load a Song, and play it back using
the transport controls for SEQUENCER 1 (see Transport controls above).
Note: When switching from Style Play to Sequencer mode, the
Sequencer Setup is automatically selected, and various track
parameters may change.
To return to this page from one of the Sequencer edit pages,
press the EXIT or SEQUENCER button.
To switch between Song tracks 1-8 and 9-16, use the TRK. SEL.
button.
Song area

Page header

Page menu icon

Note: When pressing the


(PLAY/STOP) button to stop the Song
during playback, Song parameters are not reset.

The Songs and the Standard MIDI File


format

Selected
track info
area

Sounds
area

The native Song format for Pa1X is the Standard MIDI File.
When saving a Song as a SMF, an empty measure in automatically inserted to the beginning of the Song. This measure contains various Song initialization parameters.
When an SMF is loaded, the empty measure is automatically
removed.

Songs and Voice Processor Presets


You can use the Voice Processor while in Sequencer mode. For
this, just two settings are needed:

Select the Song track where you are recording chords to be


sent to the Voice Processor (see Harmony Track on
page 186).

Go to the Voice Processor Preset section of the Global


mode, and select the desired Voice Processor Preset.

Track volume/status area

Page header
This line shows the current operating mode, transposition and
recognized chord.

Operating mode
name

Master Transpose
(in semitones)

Operating mode name


Name of the current operating mode.
Master transpose
Master transpose value in semitones. This value can be changed
using the TRANSPOSE buttons on the control panel.
Note: Transpose may be automatically changed when loading a
Standard MIDI File generated with an instrument of the Korg Pa
series.
To avoid transposing, lock the Master Transpose parameter in the
Global (see General Controls: Lock on page 232), then write the
Global to memory (see Write Global - Midi Setup dialog box on
page 257).

Sequencer operating mode


Sequencer Play - Main page

167

Page menu icon

Selected track info area

Press the page menu icon to open the menu. See Page menu on
page 187 for more information.

This line lets you see the Sound assigned to the selected track.
Not only it is shown on the main page, but also in several edit
pages.

Song area
Track name

This is where Song name is shown, together with its tempo and
meter parameters, and the current measure.
Song type icon

Song name

Current measure

Sound bank
Sound name

Program Change

Track name
Name of the selected track.

Meter
Tempo

Song type icon


In Sequencer mode, only Standard MIDI Files (files with the
.MID or .KAR extension) can be loaded.
Song name

Sound name
Sound assigned to the selected track. Press anywhere in this area
to open the Sound Select window, and select a different Sound.
Sound bank
Bank the selected Sound belongs to.
Program Change

Touch the Song name to make the Song Select window appear,
allowing for selection of a different Song (see Song Select window on page 76).
To select a Song, you can also press the SELECT button in the
SEQUENCER 1 section of the control panel. Press SELECT a
second time to select a Song by dialing in its ID number (see
Selecting a Song by its ID number on page 77).

Program Change number. Shown only when the Show Program


Change number parameter is turned on in Global mode (see
page 234).

Sounds area
This area lets you see Sounds and octave transposition for the
eight tracks currently displayed.

Octave icon

Sound name

Meter
Current Song meter.

Song track octave transpose

Measure number

Non editable. Octave transpose of the corresponding track. To


edit the octave transpose, go to the Mixer/Tuning: Tuning edit
page (see page 180).

Current measure number.


Tempo

Sound name

Metronome tempo. Select this parameter and use the TEMPO/


VALUE controls to change the tempo. As an alternative, when a
different parameter is selected, or you are in a different page,
keep the SHIFT button pressed and use the DIAL to change the
tempo of the sequencer.

Name of the Sound assigned to the track. Touch a name a first


time to select the corresponding track (detailed information are
shown on the Selected Track Info area, see above). Touch it a second time to open the Sound Select window.

Metro

Track volume/status area

Check this box to turn the metronome on during playback.

This area is where you can set the volume of each Song track,
and mute/unmute tracks.

Tempo (Tempo mode)


Use this menu to select the Tempo change mode.
Manual

In this mode, you can change the Tempo using


TEMPO/VALUE section controls. The Song will
be played back using the manually selected
tempo.

Auto

The Tempo recorded to the Song will be used.

Use the TRK. SEL. (TRACK SELECT) button to switch between


Song Tracks 1-8 and Song Tracks 9-16 views.

Reference

Displays the name of the selected Song. No Song means that a


new (blank) Song is selected, and you can record it.

168

Sequencer operating mode


Sequencer Play - Main page

If the VOLUME LED above the SLIDER MODE button is turned


on, the Assignable Sliders LEDs show which view is currently
selected.

Assignable Sliders function


Use the SLIDER MODE button to select the function assigned to
the Assignable Sliders. When the VOLUME LED is turned on,
each Assignable Slider controls the volume of the corresponding
track.

The Song Tracks 1-8 view shows individual Song tracks 1-8
(third sliders LED turned on):

The Song Tracks 9-16 view shows individual Song tracks 9-16
(last sliders LED turned on):

Note: While in Sequencer mode, you cannot save the SLIDER


MODE status to a Performance, since Performances are disabled
while in this mode.
Track status icons

Track status icon

Virtual slider

Seq

Play/mute status of the current track. Select the track, then press
this area to change the track status. The status of Song tracks is
saved when saving the Song.
Play status. The track can be heard.

Virtual sliders (track volume)


Virtual sliders are a graphical display of each tracks volume. Use
the Assignable Sliders to change this value (provided the VOLUME LED is turned on above the SLIDER MODE button, see
below).
As an alternative, press the tracks area to select a track, and use
TEMPO/VALUE controls to change the value.

Mute status. The track cannot be heard.


Track names
Under the sliders, a label for each track is shown. Use the TRK.
SEL button to switch between tracks 1-8 and 9-16.
T01T16

Song tracks.

Sequencer operating mode


Entering Record mode

Entering Record mode


To enter Record mode, press the REC button while you are in
Sequencer mode. The following dialog box will appear:

169

Record mode: Multitrack Sequencer


page
While in Sequencer mode, press the REC button and select the
Multitrack Sequencer option. The Multitrack Sequencer page
appears.
Page sub-header

Page header

Page menu icon

Recording
parameters area
Selected
track info
area

Multitrack Sequencer

Sounds
area

Full-featured sequencer. Select this option for


classic multitrack recording. (See Record mode:
Multitrack Sequencer page on page 169).
Backing Sequence (Quick Record)
Easy way of recording. Just play with Styles, and
record your realtime performance.
Step Backing Sequence
Step-record. Enter chords and notes one at a
time. Very useful if you are not a keyboard player.

Tracks volume/status area

See Multitrack recording procedure on page 171 for information on the record procedure.

Page header
See Page header on page 166.

Page menu icon


See Page menu icon on page 167.

Page sub-header
This area shows some performing info on the Song.

Song name

Beat counter

Measure number

Song name
Name of the Song in record.
Beat counter
This indicator shows the current beat inside the current measure.
Measure number
Current measure you are recording.

Recording parameters area


Rec mode (Recording mode)
Set this parameter before starting record, to select a recording
mode.
Overdub

The newly recorded events will be mixed to any


existing events.

Reference

Select one of the three available recording options and press OK


(or Cancel if you dont want to enter Record mode).

170

Sequencer operating mode


Record mode: Multitrack Sequencer page

Overwrite

The newly recorded events will replace any existing events.

Auto Punch

Recording will automatically begin at the Start


position, and stop at the End position.
Note: The Auto Punch function will not work on an
empty Song. At least one track must already be
recorded.

PedalPunch

Recording will begin when pressing a pedal set to


the Punch In/Out function, and will finish
when pressing the same pedal again.
Note: The Pedal Punch function will not work on
an empty Song. At least one track must already be
recorded.

Tempo
Select this parameter, and use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to
set the tempo.
Note: You can always change the Tempo, when other parameters
are selected, by keeping the SHIFT button pressed, and rotating the
DIAL.
Note: The tempo is always recorded in overwrite mode (old data is
replaced by the new data).
Meter
This is the basic meter (or time signature) of the Song. You can
edit this parameter only when the Song is empty, i.e., before you
begin recording anything. To insert a meter change in the middle
of the Song, use the Insert Measure function (see page 185).

Free memory
Remaining memory available for recording.

Tempo (Tempo mode)


This parameter sets the way tempo events are read or recorded.

Resolution

Use this parameter to set the quantization during recording. Quantization is a way of correcting timing errors;
notes played too soon or too later are moved to the nearest
axis of a rhythmic grid, set with this parameter, thus
playing perfectly in time.
High
No quantization applied.

Manual

Manual reading. The latest manual Tempo setting


(made using the TEMPO/VALUE controls) is
considered the current Tempo value. No Tempo
change events will be recorded. This is very useful
to record the Song much slower than its actual
Tempo.

Auto

Auto reading. The Sequencer plays back all


recorded Tempo events. No Tempo change events
are recorded.

Record

All Tempo changes made during recording will be


recorded to the Master Track.

 (1/32) (1/8)
Grid resolution, in musical values. For
example, when you select 1/16, all notes are
moved to the nearest 1/16 division. When
you select 1/8, all notes are moved to the
nearest 1/8 division.

Selected track info area


This line lets you see the Sound assigned to the selected track.
See Selected track info area on page 167 for more information.

No quantization

Sounds area

1/16

This area lets you see Sounds and octave transposition for the
eight tracks currently displayed. See Sounds area on page 167
for more information.

1/8

Track volume/status area


Start/End
Start and End locators. These parameters area available only
when the Auto Punch recording mode is selected. They set the
starting and ending points of the Punch recording.
Metro (Metronome)
This is the metronome heard during recording.
Off

No metronome click will be heard during recording. A one-bar precount will be played before
starting recording.

On1

Metronome on, with a one-bar precount before


starting recording.

On2

Metronome on, with a two-bar precount before


starting recording.

This area is where you can set the volume of each Song track,
and change track status. See Track volume/status area on
page 167.
Track status icons
Play/mute/record status of the current track. Select the track,
then press this area to change its status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
Record status. After pressing
(PLAY/STOP) to
start recording, the track will receive notes from
the keyboard and the MIDI IN connector.

Sequencer operating mode


Record mode: Step Record page

Multitrack recording procedure


Here is the general procedure to follow for the Multitrack
Recording.
1.

Press SEQUENCER to enter Sequence mode.

2.

Press the REC button, and select the Multitrack


Sequencer option to enter the Multitrack Record mode.
Now you can prepare your recording parameters. (For
more details, see Record mode: Multitrack Sequencer
page on page 169).

3.

Be sure the Overdub or Overwrite recording options is


selected (see Rec mode (Recording mode) on page 169).

4.

Set the tempo. There are two ways of changing tempo:

171

Record mode: Step Record page


The Step Record allows you to create a new Song by entering single notes or chords to each track. This is very useful when transcribing an existing score, or needing a higher grade of detail,
and is particularly suitable to create drum and percussion tracks.
To access this page, select the Overdub Step Recording or
Overwrite Step Recording command from the page menu.
In Overdub Step Recording mode you will add to existing events,
while in Overwrite Step Recording mode you will overwrite all
existing events.
Page sub-header

Page header

Note parameters

Keep the SHIFT button pressed, and use the TEMPO/


VALUE controls to change the tempo.
Move the cursor to the Tempo parameter, and use the
TEMPO/VALUE controls to change tempo.
Use the TRK. SEL. button to switch between Song Tracks 18 and Song Tracks 9-16, and assign the right Sound to each
track (see Sound name on page 167).

6.

Select the track to record. Its status icon will automatically


change to Record (see Track status icons on page 170).

7.

Press
(PLAY/STOP) to start recording. Depending on
the Metro option you selected, a 1- or 2-bars precount may
play before the recording actually begins. When it begins,
play freely.
If you selected the Auto Punch recording mode, the
recording will begin only when reaching the Start point.
If you selected the Pedal Punch recording mode, press the
pedal when you want to begin recording. Press it again to
finish recording.
Note: The Punch functions will not work on an empty Song.
At least one track must already be recorded.

8.

9.

When finished recording, press


(PLAY/STOP) to stop
the sequencer. Select a different track, and go on recording
the whole Song.
When finished recording the new Song, either press the
REC button, or select the Exit from Record command
from the page menu (see page 187).

Step
time

Buttons

Event list

See Step Record procedure below, for information on the


record procedure.

Page header
This line shows the current operating mode.

Page sub-header
Track
Name of the selected track in record.
S1Tr01Tr16
Sequencer 1 track. In Sequencer mode, you
always work with Sequencer 1.

Warning: Save the Song to disk, to avoid it is lost when turning the instrument off.

Pos (Position)

Note: When exiting the Record mode, the Octave Transpose is


automatically reset to 0.

This is the position of the event (note, rest or chord) to be


inserted.

10. If you wish, edit the new Song, by pressing the MENU but-

ton, and selecting the various edit pages.

Step Time area


Step Time
Length of the event to be inserted.

Note value.

Standard () Standard value of the selected note.


Dot (.)

Augments the selected note length by one half of


its value.

Triplet (3)

Triplet value of the selected note.

Reference

5.

172

Sequencer operating mode


Record mode: Step Record page

Note parameter area

Back
Goes to the previous step, erasing the inserted event.

Meter
Meter of the current measure. This parameter cannot be edited.
You can set a Meter change by using the Insert function of the
Edit menu, and inserting a new series of measures with a different Meter (see Song Edit: Cut/Insert Measures on page 185).

Next M. (Next Measure)


Goes to the next measure, and fills the remaining space with
rests.
Done

Free Memory

Exits the Step Record mode.

Available memory for recording.

Step Record procedure

Duration
Relative duration of the inserted note. The percentage is always
referred to the step value.

Here is the general procedure to follow for the Step Recording.


1.

Press SEQUENCER to enter Sequencer mode.

50%

Staccato.

2.

85%

Ordinary articulation.

100%

Legato.

Press the REC button, and select the Multitrack


Sequencer option to enter the Multitrack Record mode.
From the page menu, select the Overdub Step Recording
or Overwrite Step Recording mode. At this point, the
Step Record window will appear in the display.

3.

The next event will be entered at the position shown by the


Pos indicator in the upper right corner of the display.

Velocity
Set this parameter before entering a note or chord. This will be
the playing strength (i.e., velocity value) of the event to be
inserted.
Kbd

1127

Keyboard. You can select this parameter, by turning all counter-clockwise the dial. When this
option is selected, the playing strength of the
played note is recognized and recorded.
Velocity value. The event will be inserted with
this velocity value, and the actual playing
strength of the note played on the keyboard will
be ignored.

If you dont want to insert a note at this position, insert a


rest instead, as shown in step 5.
To jump to the next measure, filling the remaining beats
with rests, press the Next M. button in the display.
4.

To change the step value, use the Step Time parameters.

5.

Insert a note, rest or chord at the current position.


To insert a single note, just play it on the keyboard. The
inserted note length will match the step length. You may
change the velocity and relative duration of the note, by
editing the Velocity and Duration parameters. See Velocity and Duration on page 172.

Event list area

To insert a rest, just press the Rest button in the display. Its
length will match the step value.

List of inserted events


Previously inserted events. You may delete the last of these
events, and make it ready for a new event, by pressing the Back
button in the display.
Position

To tie the note to be inserted to the previous one, press the


Tie button in the display. A note will be inserted, tied to the
previous one, with exactly the same pitch. You dont need
to play it on the keyboard again.

Position where the event has been inserted. The


value is shown in the measure.beat.tick format.

To insert a chord or a second voice, see Chords and second voices in Step Record mode on page 110 of the Style
Record mode chapter.

Note/RX Noise
Name of the inserted Note or RX Noise. When
entering a chord, a series of dots is shown after
the name of the root note.
Vel.

Velocity of the inserted event.

Dur.%

Percentage duration of the inserted event.

6.

After inserting a new event, you may go back by pressing


the Back button in the display. This will delete the previously inserted event, and set the step in edit again.

7.

When finished recording, press the Done button in the display. The main page of the Multitrack Recording mode will
appear again.

8.

From the main page of the Multitrack Recording mode,


either select the Exit from Record command from the
page menu, or press the REC button to exit the Record
mode. While in the main page of the Sequencer mode, you
may press the
(PLAY/STOP) button in the
SEQUENCER 1 section to listen to the Song, or select the
Save Song command from the page menu to save the Song
to disk (see Save Song window on page 188).

Buttons
Rest
Press this button to insert a rest.
Tie
Press this button to tie the note to be inserted to the previous
one. A note with the same pitch, and the specified length, will be
created, and tied to the previous one.

Sequencer operating mode


Record mode: Backing Sequence (Quick Record) page

With Pa1X, you are not obliged to insert single notes in a track.
There are several ways to insert chords and double voices. For
more information, see Chords and second voices in Step
Record mode on page 110 of the Style Record mode chapter.

Record mode: Backing Sequence (Quick


Record) page
Backing Sequence (Quick Record) mode allows you to quickly
record your live performance with the Styles. To make things
easier, just two grouped tracks are provided: Kbd/Pad (Keyboard
and Pads) to record keyboard and pads, and Ch/Acc (Chords/
Accompaniment) to record Style commands and chords played
on the keyboard.
While in Sequencer mode, press the REC button and select the
Backing Sequence (Quick Record) option. The Backing
Sequence (Quick Record) page appears.
Page sub-header

Page header

Page menu icon

Recording
parameters area
Selected
track info
area

B.S.
grouped
tracks area

Track volume/status area

See Backing Sequence (Quick Record) recording procedure on


page 175 for information on the record procedure.

Page header
See Page header on page 166.

Page menu icon


See Page menu icon on page 167.

Page sub-header
See Page sub-header on page 169.

Recording parameters area


Style
This parameter shows the selected Style. Either press it, or press
one of the STYLE buttons, to open the Style Select window and
select a different Style (see Style Select window on page 75).
Free memory
Remaining memory for recording.
Resolution
Use this parameter to set the quantization during recording.
Quantization is a way of correcting timing errors; notes played
too soon or too later are moved to the nearest axis of a rhythmic
grid, set with this parameter, thus playing perfectly in time.
High

No quantization applied.

Reference

Chords and second voices

173

174

Sequencer operating mode


Record mode: Backing Sequence (Quick Record) page

 (1/32) (1/8)

On2

Grid resolution, in musical values. For example,


when you select 1/8, all notes are moved to the
nearest 1/8 division. When you select 1/4, all
notes are moved to the nearest 1/4 division.
High (no
quantization)
1/16

Metronome on, with a two-bar precount before


starting recording.

Tempo
Metronome tempo. Select this parameter and use the TEMPO/
VALUE controls to change the tempo. As an alternative, when a
different parameter is selected, or you are in a different page,
keep the SHIFT button pressed and use the DIAL to change the
tempo of the sequencer.
Meter
(Non-editable). This parameter shows the meter of the selected
Style for reference.

1/8

PERF or STS (Performance or STS)


Kbd/Pad, Ch/Acc
These parameters let you define grouped track status during
recording. This status is reflected by the big status indicator
above the track sliders.
RT/Pads: This Backing Sequence track includes the four Keyboard tracks and the four Pads. After finishing recording, they
will be saved as Song tracks 1-8, as in the following table:
RT/Pad track

Song track/Channel

Upper 1

Upper 2

Upper 3

Lower

Pad 1

Pad 2

Pad 3

Pad 4

Ch/Acc: This Backing Sequence track groups all Style tracks,


together with recognized chords and Style controls and Style
Elements selection. After finishing recording, they will be saved
as Song tracks 9-16.

This parameter shows the selected Performance or STS (depending on the last item selected).
To select a Performance, either press it, or press one of the PERFORMANCE/SOUND buttons (provided the PERFORMANCE
SELECT LED is turned on), to open the Style Select window and
select a different Performance (see Style Select window on
page 75).
To select an STS, use the four SINGLE TOUCH SETTING buttons under the display.

Backing Sequence grouped tracks area


Grouped tracks status indicators
These giant indicators show the status of the Backing Sequence
grouped tracks. They reflect the status of the Kbd/Pad and Ch/
Acc parameters (see Kbd/Pad, Ch/Acc above).

Selected track info area


This line lets you see the Sound assigned to the selected track.
See Selected track info area on page 167 for more information.

Track volume/status area

Play

The Backing Sequence track is set to play. If there


are recorded data, they will be heard while
recording the other Backing Sequence track.

Mute

The Backing Sequence track is muted. If this


tracks has already been recorded, it will not be
heard during recording of the other Backing
Sequence track.

Virtual sliders (track volume)

The Backing Sequence track is in record. All previously recorded data will be deleted. After pressing
(PLAY/STOP) to start recording, the track
will receive notes from the keyboard and the
MIDI IN connector.

Assignable Sliders function

Rec

Metro (Metronome)
This parameter sets the metronome mode during recording.
Off

On1

No metronome click will be heard during recording. A one-bar precount will be played before
starting recording.
Metronome on, with a one-bar precount before
starting recording.

This area is where you can set the volume of each single Keyboard track, and mute/unmute tracks.

Graphical display of each tracks volume. See Virtual sliders


(track volume) on page 168 for more information.

See Assignable Sliders function on page 168 for more information.


Individual track status icons
While you can change the status of all Keyboard tracks at once,
by using the Kbd/Pad Backing Sequence track, you can also
change the status of each single track. Press this icon to change
the status of the corresponding individual track.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

Sequencer operating mode


Record mode: Backing Sequence (Quick Record) page

7.

Play your music. You can even stop the Style by pressing
START/STOP. If you stop the Style while recording, start it
again with the START/STOP button.

8.

When finished recording your performance, press the


(PLAY/STOP) button in the SEQUENCER 1 section. The
REC LED will turn off, and you will go back to the
Sequencer Play Main page (see Sequencer Play - Main
page on page 166).

Under the sliders, a label for each track is shown. Use the TRK.
SEL button to switch between the various track views.
MIC/IN

Audio inputs.

UPPER13 Upper tracks.


LOWER

Lower track.

At this point, you may press the


(PLAY/STOP) button
in the SEQUENCER 1 section to listen to the new Song.

Backing Sequence (Quick Record) recording


procedure
Here is the general procedure to follow for the Backing Sequence
(Quick) Recording.

You may also edit the Song by pressing the MENU button
(see Edit menu on page 178).
9.

1.

Press SEQUENCER to enter the Song mode.

Save the song to disk (see Save Song window on


page 188).

2.

Press the REC button, and select the Backing Sequence


(Quick Record) option to enter the Backing Sequence
(Quick Record) mode. Now you can prepare your recording parameters. (For more details, see Record mode: Backing Sequence (Quick Record) page on page 173).

Warning: The recorded Song is in RAM (Random Access


Memory), and will be deleted when turning the instrument
off, switching to the Style Play or Song Play mode, or entering
Record again. If you wish to preserve it, save the Song to disk.

3.

The last selected Style is currently selected. Should it not be


the right one, select a different Style to start recording with.
(See Style Select window on page 75).

4.

The last selected Performance or STS is currently selected.


If you prefer, select a different Performance or STS. (See
Performance Select window on page 74, and STS Select
on page 75).

5.

Select the status of the Backing Sequence grouped tracks,


using the Kbd/Pad and Ch/Acc parameters. (Kbd/Pad stays
for Keyboard and Pads; Ch/Acc stays for Chord and
Accompaniment, i.e. the Style tracks). To record all you
play on the keyboard, plus the automatic accompaniment,
leave their status to REC (see Track status icons on
page 170).
Warning: Tracks set to REC are automatically overwritten
when starting recording. Set a track to the PLAY or MUTE
status, when you dont want to delete it. For example, if you
are recording a keyboard part on an existing Style track, set
the Ch/Acc parameter to PLAY, and the Kbd/Pad track to
REC.

6.

Start recording by pressing the left


ton or the START/STOP button.

(PLAY/STOP) but-

By pressing the left


(PLAY/STOP) button (or the
START/STOP button), you can record a keyboard intro
with no Style playing. After a count-in (see Metro (Metronome) on page 174), you can start recording.
Play a solo intro, then start the auto-accompaniment by
pressing the START/STOP button.
By pressing the START/STOP button you can start the
Style right at the beginning of the Song.
Since you can use any Style control, you could start with
the usual combinations (INTRO, ENDING, FILL see
Selecting and playing a Style on page 40 for more information).
Note: While in Backing Sequence mode, you cant record the
SYNCHRO, TAP TEMPO/RESET, MANUAL BASS,
ACCOMPANIMENT VOLUME controls.

Reference

Track names

175

176

Sequencer operating mode


Record mode: Step Backing Sequence page

The locator value is shown in the measure.beat.tick format.

Record mode: Step Backing Sequence


page

Measure

Measure or bar number.

Beat

Divider in the Time Signature ratio (e.g., a quarter in a 3/4 time).

The Step Backing Sequence mode allows you to enter single


chords, to create or edit the Style (Chord/Acc) part of a Song.
This mode lets you enter chords even if you are not a keyboard
player, or fix any error made playing chords or selecting Style
controls, during a Backing Sequence (Quick Record) recording.

Tick

Smallest position value. Both Pa1X internal


sequencers feature a resolution of 384 ticks per
quarter.

In this mode, you can only edit Songs created on the Pa1X.
When saving a Song created using the Backing Sequence (Quick
Record) recording mode, all Chord/Acc data is preserved, and
can be loaded later, to be edited again by using the Step Backing
Sequence mode.

This is the last selected Style. To insert a Style change at the current position, touch the Style name to open the Style Select window, or follow the standard selecting procedure using the
buttons of the STYLE SELECT section.

While in Sequencer mode, press the REC button and select the
Step Backing Sequence option. The Step Backing Sequence
window appears.
Page menu
icon

Parameters
area

Style

Note: Any Style Change inserted after the beginning of the measure
(i.e., to a position other than Mxxx.01.000) will be effective at the
following measure. For example, if a Style Change event has been
inserted at M004.03.000, the selected Style will be effectively
selected at M005.01.000. (This works exactly as in Style Play
mode).
Note: When inserting a Style Change, you may also insert a Tempo
Change at the same position. A Style Change will not automatically insert the Styles Tempo.
Performance

Soft transport buttons

See Step Backing Sequence procedure on page 178 for information on the record procedure.

Page menu icon


Press the page menu icon to open the menu. See Step Backing
Sequence page menu on page 177 for more information.

Parameters area
Side arrow ( )
The small arrow next to a parameter means that its value is effective at the current position. For example, if you are at the
003.01.000 position, and an arrow lights up next to the Chord
parameter, this means that a chord change happens at the
003.01.000 position.
Measure
This parameter shows the current position of the Step Editor. To
go to a different position within the Song, use one of the following systems:

Select this parameter, then use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to go to a different measure.
Use the Measure buttons in the display to move to a different measure. Use the Step buttons in the display to move in
steps of 1/8 (192 ticks). Use the Event buttons in the display
to jump to the next event.

This is the last selected Performance. Select a Performance to


recall the Style it links to. To insert a Performance change at the
current position, touch the Performance name to open the Performance Select window, or follow the standard selecting procedure using the PERFORMANCE/SOUND SELECT section.
Note: The STYLE CHANGE LED is automatically turned on when
entering the Chord/Acc Step Mode. This means that selecting a Performance automatically selects the Style memorized in the Performance.
The SINGLE TOUCH and STS buttons are automatically disabled, meaning that you cant change Keyboard tracks while in
Chord/Acc Step Mode.
Tempo
This is the Tempo Change parameter. To insert a Tempo Change
event at the current position, select this parameter and use the
TEMPO/VALUE controls to change its value.
Chord
The chord parameter is divided in four separate parts:

Name

Type

Tension

Extension

Select one of the parts, then use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to


modify it. As an alternative, you can play a chord, and it will be
automatically recognized. While recognizing a chord, the status
of the BASS INVERSION button will be considered.
The lack of a chord (--) means that the accompaniment will not
play at the current position (apart for the Drum and Percussion
tracks). To select the -- option, select the Name part of the
Chord parameter, then use TEMPO/VALUE controls to select
the very last value (CB, Off).

Sequencer operating mode


Record mode: Step Backing Sequence page

Note: If you replace a chord with a different one, please remember


that the Lower track (if recorded) will not be automatically
changed, and may cause a dissonance against the accompaniment.
Style Element
This is the Style Element (i.e., a Variation, Fill, Intro, or Ending).
The length of the selected Style Element is always shown by the
Length parameter (see below).
Off means that the accompaniment will not play at the
selected position only Keyboard and Pad tracks will play.

177

Hint: Save the Song to disk, by selection the Save Song command
from the page menu, to avoid losing it when turning the instrument
off.

Step Backing Sequence page menu


Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.

Hint: Insert a Style Element Off event exactly where the automatic
accompaniment must stop (at the end of the Song).
Length
This parameter will let you know where to place the following
Style Element Change. For example, if you inserted an Intro
event lasting for 4 measures, you can insert 4 empty measure
after this event, and a Variation event at the end of the Intro,
beginning at the 4th empty measure.

When a side arrow ( ) is shown next to a parameter, there is an


event at the current position. You can press the Del button next
to it, to delete the event at the current position.
Hint: To delete all events starting from the current position, select
the Delete from selected command from the page menu (see
below).

Soft transport buttons


Previous or Next Event
Use these buttons to move to the previous or next recorded
event.
Previous or Next Step
Use these buttons to go to the previous or next step (1/8, or 192
ticks). If an event is located before the previous or next step, the
locator stops on that event. For example, if you are positioned
on M001.01.000, and no event exists before M001.01.192, the >
button moves to the M001.01.192 location. If an event exists on
M001.01.010, the > button stops to the M001.01.010 location.
These commands are effective even if the Measure parameter is
not selected.
Previous or Next Measure
Use these buttons to move to the previous or following measure.
These commands are effective even if the Measure parameter is
not selected.

Done button
Done
Press this button to exit the Step Backing Sequence mode. All
changes will be saved to memory.

Insert Measure
Use this command to insert an empty measure starting from the
current measure. All Chord/Acc events contained in the current
measure will be moved to the following measure. The event at
the Mxxx.xx.000 position (i.e., exactly at the beginning of the
measure, like a Time Signature or Style change) will not be
moved.
Cut Measure
Use this command to delete the current measure. All Chord/Acc
event contained in the following measures will be moved one
measure back.
Delete All from Selected
Use this command to delete events of all types, starting from the
current position.
Note: All events on the very first tick (M001.01.000), like Perf,
Style, Tempo, Chord, Style Element selection, cannot be deleted.
Delete All Styles/Perfs from Selected
Delete All Styles Elements from Selected
Delete All Chords from Selected
Delete All Tempos from Selected
Select one of these commands to delete all events of the corresponding type, starting from the current position to the end of
the Song. To delete all events of the same type from the whole
Song, go back to the M001.01.000 position, and select one of
these commands.
Note: All events on the very first tick (M001.01.000), like Perf,
Style, Tempo, Chord, Style Element selection, cannot be deleted.

Reference

Del (Delete) button

178

Sequencer operating mode


Edit menu

Step Backing Sequence procedure


Here is the general Step Backing Sequencer recording procedure.
Hint: Before entering Step Backing Sequence mode to edit an existing Song, select the Save Song command from the page menu,
and save the Song to disk. This way, you will have a copy of the
Song, in case you dont like the results of your editing.
1.

While in Sequencer mode, press the REC button, and


choose the Step Backing Sequence recording option.

Edit menu
From any page, press the MENU button to open the Sequencer edit
menu. This menu gives access to the various Sequencer edit sections.
When in the menu, select an edit section, or press EXIT to exit
the menu.
When in an edit page, press EXIT or the SEQUENCER button to
go back to the main page of the Sequencer operating mode.

2.

Select the Measure parameter, and go to the desired position in the Song, by using the TEMPO/VALUE controls.
Alternatively, you can move the locator using the soft
transport buttons in the display. See Soft transport buttons on page 177.

3.

Select the parameter type (Style, Performance, Tempo)


to insert, edit or delete at the current position. If an arrow
( ) appears next to a parameter, the shown event has been
inserted at the current position.

4.

Use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to modify the selected


event. Delete it by pressing the Del button next to the event.
When editing a parameter without the arrow ( ) next to it,
a new event is inserted at the current position.

5.

Exit the Step Backing Sequence recording mode, by pressing the Done button in the display.

Edit page structure

6.

Press
(PLAY/STOP) in the SEQUENCER 1 section to
listen to the consequence of your editing. If they are fine,

All edit pages share some basic elements.

save the Song to disk.

Each item in this menu corresponds to an edit section. Each edit


section groups various edit pages, that may be selected by pressing the corresponding tab on the lower part of the display.

Operating mode

Edit section

Page menu
icon
Selected
track info

Parameters
area

Tabs

Operating mode
This indicates that the instrument is in Sequencer mode.
Edit section
This identifies the current edit section, corresponding to one of
the items of the edit menu (see Edit menu on page 178).
Page menu icon
Press this icon to open the page menu (see Page menu on
page 187).
Parameters area
Each page contains various parameters. Use the tabs to select
one of the pages. For detailed information on the various types
of parameters, see sections starting from page 179.
Tabs
Use tabs to select one of the edit pages of the current edit section.

Sequencer operating mode


Mixer/Tuning: Volume/Pan

179

Mixer/Tuning: Volume/Pan

Mixer/Tuning: FX Send

This page lets you set the volume and pan for each Song track.

This page lets you set the level of the tracks direct (uneffected)
signal going to the Internal FX processors. The effect processors
included in Pa1X are connected in parallel, so you can decide
which percentage of the direct signal can be effected:

Use the TRK. SEL. button to switch between Song tracks 1-8 and
9-16.

Track

Out L/R

FX Processor
In case you do not want to send a tracks direct signal to the output, but only the effected signal (as when using insert effects,
like Rotary, Distortion, EQ), just set the Pan to Off (see Pan
above):

Track

Out L/R

FX Processor
There are four Internal FX processors in Sequencer mode,
grouped in two pairs (AB and CD). Usually you will create Songs
with only a pair (preferably AB), but you can create Songs using
both FX pairs. We suggest to use A and C as reverb processors,
and B and D as modulating effect processors.
Use the TRK. SEL. button to switch between Song tracks 1-8 and
9-16, and vice-versa.
Pan

L-64L-1

Left stereo channel.

C 00

Center.

R+1R+63

Right stereo channel.

Off

If the tracks output status is Left&Right (normal


setting), the direct (uneffected) signal is not sent
to the outputs; only the FX signal is heard for this
track.

Reference

Track position in the stereo field.

If the track is sent to a separate output, no FX is


sent to any output.
To program the output status for each track, see
Audio Output: Sty/Kbd on page 239.
Volume
Tracks volume.
0127

MIDI value of the tracks volume.

Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

FX Groups
Use this pop-up menu to select one of the two FX groups (AB or
CD).
Send level
0127

Level of the track (direct) signal sent to the effect


processor.

180

Sequencer operating mode


Mixer/Tuning: Tuning

Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.

Effects: FX Select
This page allows you to select effects to be assigned to the four
Internal FX processors (A-D).

Mixer/Tuning: Tuning
Parameters
See Mixer/Tuning: Tuning on page 86.

Mixer/Tuning: Sub Scale


This page lets you program an alternative scale for the selected
tracks (via the Track Assign parameter). The remaining

tracks (if any) use the basic scale set in Global mode (see
Main Scale on page 231).

Note: When you stop the Song, or select a different Song, the
default effects are selected again. You can, however, stop the Song,
change the effects, then start the Song again. Save the Song to permanently change the effects.
FX AD
Effects assigned to the corresponding effect processors. Usually,
A and C are reverbs, while B and D are modulating effects (chorus, flanger, delay). For a list of the available effects, see
Effects on page 329.
Wet/Dry
Mix between the effected (Wet) and direct (uneffected, Dry) signal.

Note: Quarter Tone selection and activation of the Sub-Scale on


each track of a Song, can be received by MIDI (i.e., by an external
sequencer or controller). Conversely, selection of Quarter Tone settings, or activation of the Sub-Scale on each track of the Song, can
be sent by the Pa1X to an external MIDI recorder as System Exclusive data.
Parameters
See Mixer/Tuning: Sub Scale on page 86.
Track Assign
Check the parameter corresponding to each track where the
Sub-Scale must be used.

Dry

Direct signal only.

Wet

Effected signal only.

nn:nn

Percentage of Wet/Dry signal.

B to A, D to C
Amount of the B effect going back to the input of the A effect, or
of the D effect going back to the input of the C effect.
Mod.Track (Modulating Track)
Source track for modulating MIDI messages. You can modulate
an effect parameter with a MIDI message generated by a physical
controller.

Sequencer operating mode


Effects: FX AD

181

Effects: FX AD

Event Edit: Event Edit

These pages contain the editing parameters for the four effect
processors. Here is an example of the FX A page, with the Reverb
Smooth Hall effect assigned.

The Event Edit is the page where you can edit each single MIDI
event of the selected track. You can, for example, replace a note
with a different one, or change its playing strength. See also
Event Edit procedure on page 182 for more information on
the event editing procedure.

Scrollbar

Selected effect

Parameters
Parameters may differ, depending on the selected effect. See
Effects on page 329 for a list of available parameters for each
effect type.

Track Controls: Mode


Parameter
See Track Controls: Mode on page 88.

Position
Position of the event, expressed in the form aaa.bb.ccc:

aaa is the measure


bb is the beat
ccc is the tick (each quarter beat = 384 ticks)

You can edit this parameter to move the event to a different position. You can edit a position in either of the following ways:
(a) select the parameter, and use the TEMPO/VALUE controls
to change the value, or
(b) select the parameter, then touch it again; the numeric keypad will appear. Enter the new position by dialing in the
three parts of the number, separated by a dot. Zeroes at the
beginning can be omitted, as well as the least important
parts of the number. For example, to enter position
002.02.193, dial 2.2.193; to enter position 002.04.000 dial
2.4; to enter position 002.01.000, simply dial 2.

Track Controls: Drum Volume

Type

Parameter

Type of the event shown in the display. To edit it, select the
parameter and use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to change its
value.

See Track Controls: Drum Volume on page 181.

Track Controls: Easy Edit


Parameter
See Track Controls: Easy Edit on page 90.

Value 1 and 2
Values of the event shown in the display. Depending on the
selected event, the value may change. This parameter also shows
the (non-editable) End Of Track marking, when the end of the
track is reached.
Here are the events contained in ordinary tracks (1-16).
Type

First value

Second value

Note

Note name

Velocity

RX Noise

Note name

Velocity

Prog

Program Change number

Ctrl

Control Change number

Control Change value

Bend

Bending value

Aftt

Mono (Channel) Aftertouch value

Reference

Select one of the available effects from this pop-up menu. This is
equivalent to the FX AD parameters found in the Effects:
FX Select page (see above).

182

Sequencer operating mode


Event Edit: Event Edit

While the sequencer is not running, it works as a Go to Measure command. Press it to open the Go to Measure dialog box:

Type

First value

Second value

PAft

Note to which the Aftertouch is applied

Poly Aftertouch value

And here are the events contained in the Master track.


Type

First value

Second value

Tempo

Tempo change

Volume

Master Volume value

When in this dialog box, select a target measure, and press OK.
The first event available in the target measure will be selected.

Meter

Meter

Scale

One of the available preset Scales

Root note for the


selected Scale

UScale (User Scale)

Altered note

Note alteration(b)

QT (Quarter Tone)

Altered note

Note alteration

change(a)

(b)

(0, 50)
QT Clear (Quarter
Tone Clearing)

Reset of all Quarter Tone


(QT) changes

FXType

One of the four available


FX processors

Effect number(c)

FXSend

Feedback Send (B>A or


D>C)

Feedback send
level

(a). Meter changes cant be edited or inserted separately from a measure. To insert a Meter change, use the Insert function in the Edit section and insert a series of measures with the new meter. Existing data
can then be copied or entered to these measures
(b). To edit User Scale and Quarter Tone settings, select the first value,
then select the scales degree to edit. Edit the second value to change
the tuning of the selected note of the scale.
(c). When selecting a different effect number during this edit, default
settings will be assigned to this event.

While the sequencer is running, it works as a Catch Locator


command. Press it to show the event that is currently playing.
Insert
Press the Insert button in the display to insert a new event at the
current shown Position. The default values are Type = Note,
Pitch = C4, Velocity = 100, Length = 192.
Note: You cant insert new events in an empty, non-recorded Song.
To insert an event, you must first insert some empty measures by
using the Insert Measure function (see Song Edit: Cut/Insert Measures on page 185).
Delete
Press the Delete button in the display to delete the event selected
in the display.
Note: The End of Track event cannot be deleted.

Event Edit procedure


Here is the general event editing procedure.

To edit the event Type and Values, select the parameter and use
the TEMPO/VALUE controls to change their value. In case of
numeric values, you can also press them twice to open the
numeric keypad.

1.

While in the Event Edit page, press


(PLAY/STOP) in the
SEQUENCER 1 section to listen to the Song. Press it again
to stop the Song.

2.

Select the Filter page, and turn Off the filter for the event
types you wish to see in the display (see Event Edit: Filter
on page 183 for more information).

3.

Return to the Event Edit page.

4.

Use the Track pop-up menu to select the track to edit.


The list of events contained in the selected track will appear
in the display.

Length
Length of the selected Note event. The value format is the same
as the Position value. Edit it in the same way.
Note: If you change a length of 000.00.000 to a different value,
you cant go back to the original value. This rather uncommon
zero-length value may be found in the drum and percussion tracks
of Songs made in Backing Sequence mode.
Track

For more information on the event types and their values, see above.
5.

Select the Position parameter. Use the TEMPO/VALUE


controls (or press the parameter again to open the numeric
keypad) to change the events position.

6.

Select the Type parameter and use the TEMPO/VALUE


controls to change the event type. Select the Value 1 and
2 parameters and use the TEMPO/VALUE controls (or
press the parameter again to open the numeric keypad) to
modify the selected value.

7.

In the case of a Note event, select the Length parameter,


and use the TEMPO/VALUE controls (or press the parameter again to open the numeric keypad) to change the events
length.

Use this pop-up menu to select the track to edit.


Track 116

Master

One of the ordinary tracks of the Song. These


tracks contains musical data, like notes and controllers.
This is a special track, containing Tempo changes,
Meter changes, Scale and Transpose data, and the
effect parameters.

Scrollbar
Use the scrollbar to browse the event through the list. You can
also scroll by using the SHIFT + DIAL combination.
Go/Catch
This is a dual-function command.

While the sequencer is not running, you may press the


Go/Catch button in the display to go to a different measure
(see Go/Catch above)

Sequencer operating mode


Event Edit: Filter

183

While the sequencer is running, you may use the Go/


Catch button in the display to see the currently playing
event in the display (see Go/Catch above).

Song Edit: Quantize

Use SEQUENCER 1 transport controls to listen to the


Song.

The quantize function corrects any rhythm error after recording.

8.

Press the insert button in the display to insert an event at


the Position shown in the display (a Note event with default
values will be inserted). Press the Delete button in the display to delete the selected event.

9.

When the editing is complete, you may select a different


track (go to step 4).

10. When finished editing the whole Song, select the Save Song

command from the page menu to save the Song to disk. See
Save Song window on page 188 for more information on
saving a Song.
After setting the various parameters, press Execute to start the
operation.

Event Edit: Filter

Track
Use this parameter to select a track.

This page is where you can select the event types to be shown in
the Event Edit page.

All

Quantize will apply to all tracks.

Track 116

Quantize will apply only to the selected track.

Resolution
This parameter sets the quantization value. For example, when
you select  (1/8), all notes are moved to the nearest 1/8 division.
When you select 1/4, all notes are moved to the nearest 1/4 division.
No quantization

Note/RX Noise

1/4

Notes and RX Noises.


Program

Program Change events.

Control

Control Change events.

Tempo/Meter Tempo and Meter changes (Master Track only).


After Touch

Grid resolution, in musical values. A bf character added after the value means swing-quantization. A 3 means triplet.

Mono (Channel) Aftertouch events.

Poly After Touch


Poly Aftertouch events.
Pitch Bend

 (1/32) (1/4)

Pitch Bend events.

Pa1X Controls
Controls exclusive of the Pa1X, like the FX and
Scale settings. These controls are recorded to the
Master Track, and saved as System Exclusive data.

Start / End Tick


Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to be quantized.
If you wish to select a four-measure sequence starting at the
beginning of the Song, the Start will be positioned at 1.01.000,
and the End at 5.01.000.
Bottom / Top Note
Use these parameters to set the bottom and top note of the keyboard range to quantize. If you select the same note as the Bottom and Top parameters, you can select a single percussive
instrument in a Drum track.
Note: These parameters are available only when a Drum track is
selected.

Reference

1/8

Turn On the filter for all event types you do not wish to see in
the Event Edit page.

184

Sequencer operating mode


Song Edit: Transpose

Song Edit: Transpose

After setting the various parameters, press Execute to start the


operation.
Track

Here you can transpose the Song, a track or a part of a track.

Use this parameter to select a track.


All

All tracks selected.

Track 116

Selected track.

Value
Velocity change value.
Start / End Tick
Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to edit.
After setting the various parameters, press Execute to start the
operation.
Track

If you wish to select a four-measure sequence starting at the


beginning of the Song, the Start will be positioned at 1.01.000,
and the End at 5.01.000.
Bottom / Top Note

Use this parameter to select a track.


All

All tracks selected (apart for Drum tracks).

Track 116

Selected track.

Value
Transpose value (127 semitones).
Start / End Tick
Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to transpose.

Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to edit. If you select the same note as the Bottom and Top
parameters, you can select a single percussive instrument in a
Drum track.
Advanced
When this checkbox is checked, the Intensity, Curve, Start
Velocity Value and End Velocity Value parameters can be
edited.
Intensity

If you wish to select a four-measure sequence starting at the


beginning of the Song, the Start will be positioned at 1.01.000,
and the End at 5.01.000.

(Only available in Advanced mode). Use this parameter to specify


the degree to which the velocity data will be adjusted toward the
curve you specify in Curve.

Bottom / Top Note

0100%

Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to transpose. If you select the same note as the Bottom and
Top parameters, you can select a single note, or a single percussive instrument in a Drum track.

Song Edit: Velocity

Intensity value. With a setting of 0 [%], the velocity will not change. With a setting of 100 [%], the
velocity will be changed the most.

Curve
(Only available in Advanced mode). Use this parameter to select
one of the six curves, and to specify how the velocity will change
over time.
Start Value = 0%, End Value = 100%
Curve 1

Here you can change the Velocity value for the notes. An
Advanced mode is available, allowing you to select a velocity
curve for the selected range. This is useful to create fade-ins or
fade-outs.

Curve 2

Curve 3

127

127

127

Velocity

Velocity

Velocity

Start
Value

End
Value

Start
Value

End
Value

Curve 5

Curve 4
127

127

Velocity

Velocity

Velocity

Start
Value

End
Value

Start
Value

End
Value

Curve 6

127

Start
Value

End
Value

RANDOM

Start
Value

End
Value

Start / End Vel. Value


(Only available in Advanced mode). Velocity change at the starting and ending ticks of the selected range.
0100

Velocity change in percentage.

Sequencer operating mode


Song Edit: Cut/Insert Measures

185

Event

Song Edit: Cut/Insert Measures

Type of MIDI event to delete.


All

All events. Measures will not be removed from


the Song, and will remain empty.

Note

All notes in the selected range.

Dup.Note

All duplicate notes. When two notes with the


same pitch are encountered on the same tick, the
one with the lowest velocity is deleted.

After Touch

After Touch events.

Pitch Bend

Pitch Bend events.

In this page you can cut or insert measures from the Song.

Prog.Change Program Change events, excluding the bundled


Control Change #00 (Bank Select MSB) and #32
(Bank Select LSB).
After selecting the Start and Length parameters, press Execute to
start the operation.

Ctl.Change

After the Cut, the following measures are moved back, to fill the
cut measures.

CC00/32CC127
Single Control Change events. Double Control
Change numbers (like 00/32) are MSB/LSB bundles.

After the Insert, the following measures are pushed forward to


accommodate the inserted measures.

All Control Change events, for example Bank


Select, Modulation, Damper, Soft Pedal

Start / End Tick

Start
First measure where to begin cutting/inserting.
Length
Number of measures to be cut/inserted.
Meter

Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to edit.
If you wish to select a four-measure sequence starting at the
beginning of the Song, the Start will be positioned at 1.01.000,
and the End at 5.01.000.
Bottom / Top Note

Song Edit: Delete


This page is where you can delete MIDI events from the Song.

Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to delete. If you select the same note as the Bottom and
Top parameters, you can select a single note, or a single percussive instrument in a Drum track.
Note: These parameters are available only when the All or Note
options are selected.

Song Edit: Copy


Here you can copy tracks or phrases.

After setting the various parameters, press Execute to start the


operation.
Track
Use this parameter to select a track.
All

All tracks selected.

Track 116

Selected track.

After setting the various parameters, press Execute to start the


operation.

Master

Master track. This is where the Tempo, Scale and


Effect events are recorded.

Note: If you copy too many events on the same tick, the Too
many events! message appears, and the copy operation is aborted.

Reference

Meter of the measures to be inserted.

186

Sequencer operating mode


Song Edit: Move

Mode
Use this parameter to select the Copy mode.
Merge
Overwrite

Copied data are merged with the data at the target position.
Copied data replace all data at the target position.

Preferences: Global Setup


In this page, you can select a MIDI Setup and the Harmony track
for the Sequencer mode.

Warning: Deleted data cannot be recovered!


From Track To Track
Use these parameters to select the source and target track to
copy.
All

All tracks. The target track cannot be selected.

Track 116

Selected source and target tracks.

Start Measure End Measure


These parameters are the starting and ending measure to copy.
For example, if From Measure=1 and To Measure=4, the first
four measures are copied.
To Measure
This parameter is the first of the target measures.

Note: These settings are stored in the Sequencer Setup area of the
Seq
Global file. (Parameter of this kind are marked with the
abbreviation through the manual). After changing these settings,
select the Write Global-Sequencer Setup command from the page
menu to save them to the Global.

Repeat Times

Midi Setup

Number of times the copy must be executed. Copies will be consecutive.

MIDI channels for the Sequencer mode can be automatically


configured by selecting a MIDI Setup with this parameter. See
MIDI on page 280 for more information on using MIDI Setups.

Song Edit: Move

Note: To automatically select a MIDI Setup when entering the


Sequencer mode, select the Write Global-Sequencer Setup command from the page menu.

Here you can shift a track forward or backward by just a few


ticks or whole measures.

Seq

For detailed information on MIDI Setup settings, see MIDI


Setup on page 328.
Note: After selecting a MIDI Setup, you can go to the Global mode
and apply any change to each channel setting. To store these
changes to a MIDI Setup, while still in Global mode select the Write
Global-Midi Setup command from the page menu. All MIDI Setups can be freely customized and overwritten.
Hint: To restore the original MIDI Setups, load the original Factory data again (downloadable from www.korgpa.com).
Harmony Track

After setting the various parameters, press Execute to complete


the operation.

Seq

The Voice Processor gets the chord notes from the track selected
with this parameter.

Track

Hint: Go to the Voice Processor Preset section of the Global mode to


try different Voice Processor Presets while creating or editing a
Song.

Use these parameters to select the track you want to move.

Off

Track 116

Selected track.

Start / End Tick


These parameters set the starting and ending point of the range
to move.
To Tick
This parameter allows you to set the target starting point of the
moved track.

No track sends notes to the Harmony module of


the Voice processor. Chords can still be received
from the MIDI IN.

Seq.1-Track 116
Chords are sent from one of Sequencer 1 tracks.

Sequencer operating mode


Page menu

187

Overwrite Step Recording

Page menu
Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.

Only available in Record mode. Select this command to enter


Overwrite Step Record mode. This recording mode lets you
enter events one at a time, overwriting all existing events. (See
Record mode: Step Record page on page 171).
Delete Song
Select this command to delete the Song and create a new, blank
Song.
Delete Current Track
Select this command to delete the track currently selected in the
Track area (see Track volume/status area on page 170).
Solo Track
Select the track to be soloed, and check this item. You will hear
only the selected track, and the Solo warning will flash on the
page header.
Uncheck this item to exit the Solo function.
Copy/Paste FX

Select this command to open the Write Global-Seq. Setup dialog


box, and save global settings that are unique to the Sequencer
mode. (See Write Global-Sequencer Setup dialog box on
page 188).

To copy a single effect:


1.

go to the page of the single effect you want to copy (FX A,


FX B, FX C, or FX D), or

Load Song

go to the Effects > FX Select page, to copy all four effects.


This may be useful if you want to copy each of the four
effects into different Performances, Styles or STSs.

Select this command to open the Song Select window, and load a
Song to the sequencer. (See Song Select window on page 188).
Please note that in Sequencer mode the file is loaded to memory
contrary to Song Play mode, where Songs are read directly
from disk.

2.

Choose the Copy FX command from the page menu.

3.

Select the target Performance, Style or STS, then go to the


page of the single effect you want to paste (FX A, FX B, FX
C, or FX D).

4.

Choose the Paste FX command from the page menu.

Save Song
Select this command to save the new or edited Song to disk as a
Standard MIDI File. The file is automatically added the .MID
extension. After selecting this command, the Save Song page
appears (see Save Song window on page 188).
Warning: Turning the instrument off will delete the Song from
memory. Save your Song to disk to avoid losing it.
Warning: The Song is also lost when switching from Sequencer to
Style Play or Song Play mode, without previously saving the Song
to disk.

Select the source Song, Performance, Style or STS, then

To copy all four effects:


1.

Select the source Performance, Style or STS, then go to the


Effects > FX Select page, to copy all four effects.

2.

Choose the Copy FX command from the page menu.

3.

Select the target Performance, Style or STS, then go to the


page of the Effects > FX Select page.

4.

Choose the Paste FX command from the page menu.

Undo

Exit from Record

When selecting this command, the latest operation is canceled,


and data are reverted to the previous situation.

Only available in Record mode. Select this command to exit the


Record mode, and go back to the Main page of the Sequencer
Play mode (see Sequencer Play - Main page on page 166).

Overdub Step Recording


Only available in Record mode. Select this command to enter
Overdub Step Record mode. This recording mode lets you enter
events one at a time, adding events to the existing events. (See
Record mode: Step Record page on page 171).

Reference

Write Global-Seq. Setup

You can copy a single, or all four effects, between Styles, Performances, STSs and Songs. To do this, choose the Copy FX and
Paste FX commands from the page menu of the Style Play,
Song Play or Sequencer modes.

188

Sequencer operating mode


Write Global-Sequencer Setup dialog box

Write Global-Sequencer Setup dialog box

Save Song window

Open this window by selecting the Write Global-Song Setup


item from the page menu. Here, you can save MIDI Setups (see
Midi Setup on page 186), that are saved to the Global file.

The recorded Song is contained in RAM, and is lost when turning the instrument off. The Song is also lost when you overwrite it in Record mode, or if you confirm the warning
message when switching to the Style Play or Song Play mode.
You must save to disk any Song you wish to preserve.
This window appears when you select the Save Song command
from the page menu.
Press EXIT to exit from this page and go back to the main page
of the Sequencer operating mode without saving the Song.
Song path

Directory

Parameters saved in the Sequencer Setup area of the Global are


marked with the

Seq

symbol through the users manual.

Song Select window


This window appears when you select the Load Song command from the page menu, or press the SELECT button in the
SEQUENCER 1 sections on the control panel. See Song Select
window on page 76 for details.
Storage device

Song path
This line shows the path of the location where you are saving the
Song.
Directory
This is the list of the selected devices content.
File status

Type of the
file or folder

File size

File or folder
name

Modification
date

Use the scrollbar to scroll the list items.


As an alternative, you can select one of the items, and use the
TEMPO/VALUE controls to scroll.

Keep the SHIFT button pressed, and press DOWN or UP, to


jump to the previous or next alphabetical section.

Sequencer operating mode


Save Song window

189

Storage device

Master Transpose saved with the Song

Use this pop-up menu to select one of the available storage


devices where to save the Song.

When saving a Song, the Master Transpose value is saved with


the Song. Since this value is saved as System Exclusive data, it is
preserved also when playing back the Song in Song Play mode.

Device

Type

FD

Floppy disk

HD

Hard disk (optional on the Pa1X with speakers)

Hint: Since the Master Transpose is a global parameter, loading a


Song with a non-standard transposition may result in unwanted
transposing when loading other Songs that do not contain their
own transposition data. To transpose a Song it is advisable to use
the Transpose function in the Edit section of the Sequencer mode
(see Song Edit: Transpose on page 184).

Open
Opens the selected folder (item whose icon looks like this:

).

Close
Closes the current folder, returning to the parent (upper)
folder.
Save
Press this button to open the Save Song dialog box, and save the
Song to the current directory.

You may also lock the Master Transpose, to avoid unwanted transposition. See General Controls: Lock on page 232 of the Global
chapter.
As a general rule, you should use the Master Transpose (TRANSPOSE buttons on the control panel) when you need to transpose
Keyboard tracks together with the Song. You should use the Edit
mode Transpose function (see Song Edit: Transpose on page 184)
when only the Song has to be transposed.
Note: The Master Transpose value is always shown on the page
header:

1.

If no file has been selected in the display, prior to pressing Save,


the NewSong default name will be automatically assigned to
the Song.

If you are in Record mode, stop the sequencer and exit


from the Record mode. Then go back to the main page of
the Sequencer Play mode (see Sequencer Play - Main
page on page 166).

2.

Note: If a file is selected, just touch the storage device name to deselect it.

Select the Save Song command from the page menu. The
Save Song page appears.

3.

If a file has been selected in the display, prior to pressing Save,


the name of the selected file will be automatically assigned to the
Song.

Select the folder where you want to save the Song into. Use
the Open and Close commands to browse open or close
folders. Use the scrollbar to browse through the files.

4.

When you are in the directory where you want to save your
Song to, press the Save button in the display.

In any of the above situations, press the


to edit the Song name.

(Text Edit) button

Warning: If a file with the same name is already in the current


directory, a message will warn you. If you confirm, the existing file
will be overwritten. Select a file before saving only if you want to
overwrite it (i.e., in case you are saving changes to an existing file).

To overwrite an existing file, select it before pressing Save.


To create a new file, do not select any file before pressing
Save. The NewSong (NEWSONG.MID on disk) name
will be automatically assigned to the Song.
5.

After pressing the Save button, the Save Song dialog box
will appear.

Empty measure at the beginning of the


Standard MIDI File

6.

If you like, press the


name.

When saving a Song as an SMF, an empty measure is automatically inserted to the beginning of the Song. This measure contains various Song initialization parameters.

7.

Press OK to confirm saving, or Cancel to stop the Save


operation.

Play/Mute status saved with the Song


When saving a Song, the Play/Mute status is saved with the Song.
This status is preserved also when playing back the same Song in
Song Play mode.

(Text Edit) button to edit the

Reference

Save Song procedure

190

Sound operating mode


The MIDI channel

Sound operating mode


The Sound operating mode is where you can listen to individual
Sounds, and edit them.

Note: Notes pointing to special Drum Kit features are marked by


the

icon.

To select a Sound, see the Basic operations chapter.


In this mode, the selected Sound can always be played across the
full keyboard range.
While in a different operating mode, you can easily select the
Sound to be edited when switching to the Sound mode. Just
select the track the Sound to be edited is assigned to, then keep
the SHIFT button pressed while pressing the SOUND button.
Hint: This is useful to see the Bank Select/Program Change numbers when programming a Song on an external sequencer.
Note: The Sound uses the same Scale of the latest selected Performance or STS.

The MIDI channel

Main page
Here is the main page of the Sound operating mode.
Page header

Page menu icon

Sound Info
area

Realtime
Controls
area

In Sound mode, Pa1X receives and transmits on the same channel of the Upper 1 track. If the Global channel is assigned, notes
can be received also on this channel. See MIDI: MIDI In Channels on page 238 and MIDI: MIDI Out Channels on page 238
for more information.

Voice Assign Mode area

FX area

Page header

How to select oscillators


While in an edit page requiring an oscillator to be selected
for editing, use the vertical row of buttons on the right
(15) to select one of the available oscillators. The number of available oscillators depends on the Oscillator
Mode parameter (see page 193).
When oscillators cannot be select, since the parameter
contained in the current page are global and valid for the
whole Sound, these buttons are greyed out, and cannot be
selected.

Sounds, Drum Kits, Digital Drawbars

This line shows the current operating mode and transposition.

Operating mode
name

Master Transpose
(in semitones)

Operating mode name


Name of the current operating mode.
Master transpose
Master transpose value in semitones. This value can be changed
using the TRANSPOSE buttons on the control panel.

Page menu icon


Press the page menu icon to open the menu. See Page menu on
page 211 for more information.

Pa1X features three different kinds of Sounds:

Ordinary Sounds. These are normal instrument Sounds,


like pianos, strings, basses.

Drum Kits. These are drum and percussion kits, where


each note of the keyboard is a different percussive instrument. You can find Drum Kits in the DRUM & PERC and
USER DK banks.

Digital Drawbars. These are Sounds with a very complex


structure, and a special usage. See Digital Drawbars page
on page 192 for more information.

Before pressing MENU to enter the edit environment, you


should select a Sound of the type you wish to edit or create.

Sound Info area


This is where basic details for the Sound are shown. Press anywhere in this area to open the Sound Select window.
Sound name
Name of the Sound assigned to the corresponding Keyboard
track.
Bank
Bank the current Sound belongs to.

Sound operating mode


Main page

Resonance

Bank Select MSB / Bank Select LSB / Program Change numbers,


in the form CC00.CC32.PC.
CC00

This section shows the value of the Control


Change (CC) 00 message (or Bank Select MSB)
for the selected Sound.

CC32

This section shows the value of the Control


Change (CC) 32 message (a.k.a. Bank Select LSB)
for the selected Sound.

PC

This section shows the value of the Program


Change (PC) message for the selected Sound.
Values are in the standard 0-127 MIDI numbering format.
Note: Some manufacturers could use the 1-128
numbering system; when connecting your Pa1X to
an instrument of this kind, increment the PC value
by 1 unit.

Use the Filter Resonance to boost the cutoff frequency.

Voice Assign Mode


Poly
The Sound will play polyphonically, allowing you play chords.
Mono
The Sound will play monophonically, producing only one note
at a time.
Hold
Use this parameter to keep the notes sustained even after releasing the keys.
Note: Please remember the Hold must be On before playing the
note to be held.

Octave Transpose icon

Legato

Non editable. Octave transpose value.

This parameter is available when the Mono option is selected.

Realtime Controls area

Note: If Legato is On, certain multisamples or keyboard locations


may produce an incorrect pitch.

Controls in this area allow you to edit the main parameters of


the Sounds assigned to each track.

On

While in this page, Assignable Sliders are linked to the corresponding Realtime Controls (a.k.a. Easy Sound Edit parameters).
Assignable
Slider

Realtime
Control

Assignable
Slider

Realtime
Control

1
2

Attack

LFO Depth

Decay

LFO Speed

Release

LFO Delay

Cutoff

Resonance

When legato is on, multiple note-ons will not


retrigger the voice. If one note is already on and
another note is turned on, the first voice will continue sounding. The oscillator sound, envelope,
and LFO will not be reset, and only the pitch of
the oscillator will be updated. This setting is
effective for wind instrument sounds and analog
synth-type sounds.
Off

Note: When selecting the Write Sound command from the page
menu, current parameter values, after editing the Realtime Controls, are saved with the Sound. After saving, Realtime Controls are
set back to the default position.

Attack

Attack time. This is the time during which the


sound goes from zero (at the moment when you
strike a key) to its maximum level.

Decay

Decay time. Time to go from the final Attack level


to the beginning of the Sustain.

Legato is off. Notes will always be retriggered


when note-on occurs.
When legato is off, multiple note-ons will retrigger the voice at each note-on. The oscillator
sound, envelope, and LFO will be reset (and
retriggered) according to the settings of the
Sound.

Note: All values refer to the original values of the Sound.

Note: After selecting a different Sound, Realtime Control values are


automatically set to zero.

Legato is on. When multiple note-ons occur, the


first note-on will retrigger the sound, and the second and subsequent note-ons will not retrigger.

FX Area
In Sound mode, the Sound uses its own effects instead of relying
on A-D effects. Two effect processors (FX1 and FX2) are available.
On/Off
Use this button to turn on or off the corresponding effect.
Note: When an effect parameter is edited, this parameter is automatically set to On.

Release

Release time. This is the time during which the


sound goes from the sustaining phase, to zero.
The Release is triggered by releasing a key.

Cutoff

Filter cutoff. This sets the sound brightness.

Note: If the FX1 and FX2 effects have been set to Off, FX Send values are set to zero when saving the Sound.

LFO Depth

Intensity of the Vibrato (LFO).

Selected Effect

LFO Speed

Speed of the Vibrato (LFO).

LFO Delay

Delay time before the Vibrato (LFO) begins, after


the sound starts.

Non editable. This shows the effect assigned to the corresponding


FX processor. To select a different effect, see FX1/2 on
page 210.

Reference

Bank Select / Program Change sequence

191

192

Sound operating mode


Digital Drawbars page

Send

Percussion

Use this knob to adjust the level of the corresponding effect.

The percussion adds a percussive sound to the attack segment of


the organ sound.

Wet/Dry
Use this knob to adjust the mix between the wet (effected) and
dry (uneffected) signal for the corresponding effect.

On/Off
Use this parameter to turn percussion on or off.
Foot

Digital Drawbars page


DIGITAL DRAWBARS are different from ordinary Sounds.
Their parameters are not saved as a new Sound, but can be saved
to a Performance. Therefore, when entering the Digital Drawbars page, the MENU button is disabled.
Note: In Style Play and Backing Sequence mode, only a Digital
Drawbar Sound is available for the Keyboard tracks, and one for
the Style tracks. Save them to a Performance (see Write Performance dialog box on page 98).
Note: In Song Play mode, there is a Digital Drawbars Sound for the
Keyboard tracks, one for Song tracks 1-8, another one for Song
tracks 9-16.
Note: In Sequencer mode there is a Digital Drawbars Sound for
Song tracks 1-8, one for Song tracks 9-16.
When you select the DIGITAL DRAWBARS bank, the Digital
Drawbar page appears, and the current setting is assigned to the
selected track.

Use this parameter to select a percussion register.


4

Percussion added to the 4 foot.

22/3

Percussion added to the 22/3 foot.

Mode (Percussion Mode)


This parameters lets you decide if the percussion sound has to be
triggered on the first note of a group of held notes, or to all
notes.
All

The percussive attack is played on all notes of a


chord.

1st

The percussive attack is played only on the first


note of a chord or a group of held notes. Release
all notes to trigger the percussion again.

Volume (Percussion Volume)


Level of the percussive sound.
099

Level.

Length (Percussion Length)


Decay speed of the percussive sound.
099

Decay time.

Atk Noise (Attack Noise)


On/Off
Turns the noise component of the percussive attack on of off.
Volume
When entering this page, the SLIDER MODE button is automatically set to DRAWBARS, so you can use the sliders to change
each foot volume. As an alternative, touch a foot and use
TEMPO/VALUE controls to change its value.
Each foot refers to the pipe length in a pipe organ, in which the
sound is produced by pipes of different length. Longer pipes
mean a lower sound; therefore, the 16 drawbar produces the
lowest pitched sound, while the 1 drawbar produces the highest
pitched sound.

Level of the attack noise (from 0 to 7).

Wave (Drawbar Wave)


Waveshape of the drawbars.
Mellow

A mellow-sounding synthetic wave.

Hard

A harder-sounding synthetic wave.

Sound operating mode


Edit menu

193

Operating mode

Edit menu

This indicates that the instrument is in Sound mode.

From any page, press the MENU button to open the Sound edit
menu. This menu gives access to the various Sound edit sections.
When in the menu, select an edit section, or press EXIT or
SOUND to exit the menu and return to the main page. To return
to the main page, you can also select the Main Page menu item.
When in an edit page, press EXIT or the SOUND button to
return to the main page of the Sound operating mode.

Edit section
This identifies the current edit section, corresponding to one of
the items of the edit menu (see Edit menu on page 193).
Page menu icon
Press this icon to open the page menu (see Page menu on
page 211).
Selected oscillator

When an ordinary Sound is selected:

Use these buttons to select the oscillator to edit.


Parameters area
Each page contains various parameters. Use the tabs to select
one of the available pages. For detailed information on the various types of parameters, see sections starting from page 193.
Tabs
Use tabs to select one of the edit pages of the current edit section.

When a Drum Kit is selected, the Basic section is replaced


by the DrumKit section:

Basic: Sound Basic

Reference

Here you can make basic settings for the Sound, such as basic
oscillator settings, the oscillator count, and the polyphonic
mode.

Each item in this menu corresponds to an edit section. Each edit


section groups various edit pages, that may be selected by pressing the corresponding tab on the lower part of the display.
Oscillator Mode

Edit page structure

Use these radio buttons to specify the basic Sound type; whether
it will use one or more oscillators (up to five).

All edit pages share some basic elements.


Operating mode

Edit section

Page menu
icon

The total amount of polyphony varies depending on the number


of oscillators used by the Sound (a maximum of 62 with only 1
oscillator, or a maximum of 12 with 5 oscillators).
Voice Assign Mode

Selected
oscillator

Parameters
area

This is the polyphonic mode of the Sound.


Poly

The Sound will play polyphonically, allowing you


play chords.

Mono

The Sound will play monophonically, producing


only one note at a time.

Single Trigger
Tabs

This parameter is available when the selected mode is Poly.

194

Sound operating mode


Basic: OSC Basic

On

When the same note is played repeatedly, the previous note will be silenced before the next note is
sounded, so that the notes do not overlap.

Off

When the same note is played repeatedly, the previous note will not be silenced before the next
note is sounded.

Legato
This parameter is only available when the selected mode is
Mono. It is the same found on the main page of the Sound
mode.

The High and Low pop-up menus is where you select the bank
(ROM, RAM or EXB), while the numeric field under it is for
selecting the multisample inside the selected bank. The Sound
name appears on its right.
The multisample you select for the High layer will be triggered
by velocities higher than the value of the Velocity Multisample
Switch Low-High parameter (see page 195). If you do not wish
to use velocity switching, set the switch to a value of 001, and
select only the High multisample.
ROM

The Flash-ROM bank. The internal Flash-ROM


contains 445 different multisamples (preset multisamples), supplied by Korg as standard.

RAM

RAM multisample, read from the RAM. These


are user-loaded or created multisamples.

See Legato on page 191 for information on this parameter.


Priority
This parameter is available when the selected mode is Mono. It
specifies which note will be given priority to play when two or
more notes are played simultaneously.
Low

Lowest note will take priority.

High

Highest note will take priority.

Last

Last note will take priority.

Hold
Use this parameter to keep the notes sustained even after releasing the keys.
Sound Transpose Range
Use these parameters to set a range for transposition. Inside this
range notes are transposed. Outside this range, they are not
transposed. This is useful to avoid RX Sounds being transposed
when transposing a Sound.

Note: If you create a new Sound based on a RAM


multisample, the RAM samples must be loaded
from disk. See PCM Autoload and Load PCM
button on page 273 (Disk mode) for information
on loading PCM samples, either at startup or with
a dedicated command.
EXB1, EXB2 EXB1 or EXB2 multisample, loaded from the corresponding optional EXB board (if installed).
Note: Each multisample has an upper note range limit, and cannot
produce sound when played above that limit.
2nd Offset
These parameters specify the point where the multisample(s)
will begin to play. For some multisamples this parameter will not
be available.
On

The sound will begin from the offset location


pre-determined for each multisample.

Off

The sound will start from the beginning of the


multisample waveform.

Basic: OSC Basic


Reverse
The multisample(s) on which the Sound will be based can be
selected here for each of the five oscillators. Each oscillator can
use 1 or 2 multisamples, each one assigned to the High or Low
layer.

The multisample will be played in reverse. In the case of FlashROM or optional (RAM or EXB) multisamples that were originally specified to loop, the multisample will be played back in
one-shot reverse mode. If the multisample was originally set to
reverse, it will playback without change.
On

The multisample will playback in reverse.

Off

The multisample will play back normally.

Level
These parameters specify the level of each multisample.
0127

Multisample level.

Note: Depending on the multisample, high settings of this parameter may cause the sound to distort when a chord is played. If this
occurs, lower the level.

OSC Multisample
High/Low Bank/Num
Use these parameters to select a different multisample for each of
the High and Low layers. You can use velocity to switch between
the two multisamples. Offset, Reverse and Level can be adjusted
independently for the High and Low multisamples.

Pitch/Delay/Velocity Switch
Octave
Use this parameter to adjust the pitch of the selected oscillator in
octave units. The normal octave of the multisample is 0.
-2+1

Octave transposition.

Sound operating mode


Basic: Vel/Key Zone

195

Transpose

Scaled Velocity

Use this parameter to adjust the pitch of the selected oscillator in


semitone steps over a range of 1 octave.

Use these parameters to scale velocity values received by the


oscillator. By using the Velocity Zone function (see above), an
oscillator may be limited to a restricted range (say, 10 to 20), that
may result in weak dynamics when the associated sample is triggered.

-12+12

Transposition in semitones.

Tune
Use this parameter to adjust the pitch of the sample in one-cent
steps (a semitone is 100 cents) over a range of 1 octave.
-1200+1200
Fine-tune value in cents.
Delay
This parameter sets a delay time from the note-on to the real
beginning of the sound. With a setting of KeyOff, the sound will
begin when note-off occurs. This is useful to create sounds such
as the click that is heard when a harpsichord note is released.
In this case, set the Sustain parameter to 0 (see page 204).
Key Off

The sound will begin when the note is released.

05000ms

Delay time in milliseconds.

By assigning a different value to these parameters, the restricted


range will be converted to a wider range (for example, the lowest
range value of 10 may be converted to a Scaled Velocity value of
0, and the highest range value of 20 may be converted to a Scaled
Velocity value of 127). All values included between the minimum and maximum value are scaled accordingly.
As a consequence, you can create an RX Sound of guitar, by
assigning the guitar fret noise to the 10~20 velocity range. When
a dynamics value between 10~20 is received, the real velocity
value is scaled to the Scaled Velocity values, and plays louder.
0127

Assigned velocity value.

DrumKit: Sample Setup (Drum Kits)

Velocity Multisample Switch Low-High


This is the velocity value dividing the High and Low layers for
the selected oscillator. Notes struck harder than this value will be
played by the High multisample.

This page appears when you edit a Drum Kit. Here you can
select a different percussive sample for each key and layer.

Drum Kits use only one oscillator.

Basic: Vel/Key Zone


Selected Layer

Reference

Velocity
Switches

Here you can set a note and velocity range window for the
selected oscillator.

Key
Key
Key in edit. You can press a key on the keyboard, while this
parameter is selected, to select a key.
Velocity Zone

Layers

Here you can specify the velocity range for the selected oscillator.

Number of layers assigned to the selected key. Depending on the


number of selected layers, you can have a different number of
velocity switches.

Note: You cannot set the Bottom Velocity higher than the Top
Velocity, nor the Top Velocity lower than the Bottom Velocity.
0127

Assigned velocity.

Keyboard Range
Here you can specify the note range for the selected oscillator.
Note: You cannot set the Bottom Key higher than the Top key, nor
the Top Key lower than the Bottom key.
C-1G9

Assigned note.

Assign
Use this parameter to turn the sample on/off.
On

The sample is assigned to the selected key.

Off

The sample is not assigned. The sample assigned


to the next highest assigned key is used instead.

196

Sound operating mode


DrumKit: Voice Mixer (Drum Kits)

Layer Selector & Velocity Sample Switch

Level

Selected Layer

This parameter specifies the level of the sample. For more information, see Level on page 194.

Use these radio buttons to select the layer to edit. The available
layers depends on the Layers parameter.

Mono/Stereo indicator

Velocity Switches

Non editable. This indicator tells if the selected sample is mono


(one voice per note) or stereo (two voices per note).

Each of these values separates the two adjacent layers for the
selected sample/key. Notes stricken harder than a velocity switch
will be played by the layer on the right, while notes stricken
softer are played by the layer on the left.

Transpose
This parameter transposes the selected sample. Use it to change
the pitch of the selected key.

The first and last values are not editable, and are always 001 and
127 (respectively).

No transposition applied.

-64+63

Transpose value in semitones.

Drum Sample

Tune
Use this parameter to fine-tune the assigned sample.

Bank/Num
Use these parameters to select a different Drum Sample for each
layer. You can use velocity to switch between the available samples. Offset, Reverse and Level can be adjusted independently for
the various multisamples.
The pop-up menu is where you select the bank (ROM, RAM or
EXB), while the numeric field under it is for selecting the sample
inside the selected bank. The sample name appears on its right.
The sample you select for the current layer will be triggered by
velocities higher than the value of the Velocity Switches
parameter (see page 196). If you do not wish to use velocity
switching, assign just one layer to the selected key, and assign a
sample only to Layer 1.
ROM

RAM

The Flash-ROM bank. The internal Flash-ROM


contains 445 different samples (preset samples),
supplied by Korg as standard.
RAM sample, read from the RAM. These are
user-loaded or created samples.
Note: If you create a new Drum Kit based on a
RAM sample, the RAM samples must be loaded
from disk. See PCM Autoload and Load PCM
button on page 273 (Disk mode) for information
on loading PCM samples, either at startup or with
a dedicated command.

No fine-tuning.

-99+99

Fine-tuning value in cents (1/100 of a semitone).

Cutoff
This parameter sets the cutoff frequency for the filter applied to
the selected sample.
Resonance
This parameter sets the resonance for the filter applied to the
selected sample.
Attack
This parameter is an offset to the selected samples EG Attack.
Decay
This parameter is an offset to the selected samples EG Decay.

DrumKit: Voice Mixer (Drum Kits)


This page appears when you edit a Drum Kit. Here you can set
various parameters for the different percussive sample assigned
to the selected key and layer.

EXB1, EXB2 EXB1 or EXB2 sample, loaded from the corresponding optional EXB board (if installed).
Note: Each sample has an upper note range limit, and may not
produce sound when played above that limit.
2nd Offset
These parameters specify the point where the sample will begin
to play. For some samples this parameter will not be available.
On

The sound will begin from the offset location


pre-determined for each sample.

Off

The sound will start from the beginning of the


sample.

Reverse
The sample will be played in reverse. For more information see
Reverse on page 194.

Key
See Key on page 195.

Sound operating mode


Pitch: Pitch Mod

Voice Assign Mode

197

Pitch: Pitch Mod

Single Trigger
Use this parameter to set the sample as a single-triggered one.
On

When the same key (note) is played repeatedly,


the previous note will be stopped before the new
note is triggered, so that they will not overlap.

Off

When the same key (note) is played repeatedly,


the previous note will not be stopped before the
new note is triggered.

Here you can make pitch settings for each oscillator. These settings specify how keyboard location will affect the pitch of each
oscillator, and select the controllers that will affect the oscillator
pitch and specify the depth of control. You can also specify the
amount of pitch change produced by the Pitch EG and by LFO1
and LFO2, switch portamento on/off and specify how it will
apply.

Exclusive Group
Exclusive Groups are sets of mutually exclusive keys, stopping
each other. For example, if the Open Hi-Hat and Closed Hi-Hat
are assigned the same Exclusive Group, playing an Open Hi-Hat
will stop the Closed Hi-Hat playing.
None

No Exclusive Group assigned. The selected key


will not be stopped by any other key.

1127

Exclusive Groups assigned to the selected key.


When you play this key, all other keys assigned to
the same Exclusive Group will be stopped, and
this key will be stopped by other keys assigned to
the same Exclusive Group.

Enable Note On Receive

Pitch
Pitch Slope

On

The Note On message is normally received.

Normally you will leave this parameter at +1.0. Positive (+) values will cause the pitch to rise as you play higher notes, and negative () values will cause the pitch to fall as you play higher
notes.

Off

The Note On message is not received. Therefore,


the corresponding key is muted.

With a value of 0, there will be no change in pitch, and the C4


pitch will sound regardless of the keyboard location you play.

Enable Note Off Receive

The diagram shows how the Pitch Slope and pitch are related:
Pitch
+2

Use this parameter to enable/disable the reception of the Note


Off (Key Off) message.
On

The sound will stop as soon as you release the


key.

Off

The sound will continue playing up to the end of


the sample. The Note Off message is ignored.

Mixer

+1
2oct

1oct
1oct

Reference

Use this parameter to enable/disable the reception of the Note


On (Key On) message.

1
C4 C5

-1.0+2.0

Key

Pitch slope value.

JS (+X)
Pan
This parameter sets the position in the stereo panorama of the
selected key.

This parameter specifies how the pitch will change when the joystick is moved all the way to the right. A setting of 12 produces 1
octave of change.

This parameter sets the FX1 send level for of the selected key.

For example if you set this to +12 and move the joystick all the
way to the right, the pitch will rise one octave above the original
pitch.

Send FX2

-60+12

This parameter sets the FX2 send level for of the selected key.

JS (X)

Send FX1

Maximum pitch change in semitones.

This parameter specifies how the pitch will change when the joystick is moved all the way to the left. A setting of 12 produces 1
octave of change.
For example, if you set this to -60 and move the joystick all the
way to the left, the pitch will fall five octaves below the original

198

Sound operating mode


Pitch: Pitch Mod

pitch. This can be used to simulate the downward swoops that a


guitarist produces using the tremolo arm.

Portamento

-60+12

Enabled

Maximum pitch change in semitones.

AMS (Alternate Modulation Source)


This parameter selects the source that will modulate the pitch of
the selected oscillator. See AMS (Alternate Modulation Source)
list on page 213.

This parameter turns the portamento effect (smooth change in


pitch from one note to the next) on/off, and specifies how it will
be applied.
Note: Portamento will also be switched when CC#65 (Portamento
SW) is received.

Intensity

On

Portamento will be applied.

This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect


produced by AMS. With a setting of 0, no modulation will be
applied. With a setting of 12.00, the pitch will change up to one
octave.

Off

Portamento will not be applied.

For example, if you set AMS to After Touch and apply pressure
to the keyboard, the pitch will rise if this parameter is set to a
positive (+) value, or fall if this parameter is set to a negative ()
value. The range is a maximum of one octave.
-12.00+12.00

Fingered
This parameter specifies whether the portamento effect restarts
or not with each note played.
On

Portamento will restart with each note.

Off

Portamento will not restart with each note.

Time

Parameter value.

This parameter sets the portamento time. Increasing the value


will produce a slower change in pitch.

Pitch EG

000127

The Pitch EG (Envelope Generator) is unique to all oscillators.

Velocity Intensity
This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the modulation that the pitch EG specified on Pitch: Pitch EG will apply
to the pitch. With a setting of 12.00, the pitch will change a maximum of 1 octave.
-12.00+12.00
Parameter value.
Pitch EG AMS (Alternate Modulation Source)
This parameter selects the source that will modulate the pitch
EG of the selected oscillator. See AMS (Alternate Modulation
Source) list on page 213).
Pitch EG Intensity
This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect
that AMS will have. For example, if you set AMS to Velocity
and set this value to +12.00, the velocity will control the range of
pitch change produced by the pitch EG in a range of 1 octave.
As you play more softly, the pitch change will draw closer to the
pitch EG levels.
Pitch change (level)
Note-on

Note-on
Note-off

Softly played
(Intensity (Pitch EG) setting)

Note-on
Note-off

Strongly played with


a positive (+) value

Note-off

Strongly played with a


negative () value

Note: Intensity (Pitch EG) and AMS will be added to determine


the depth and direction of the pitch modulation applied by the
pitch EG.

Portamento time in MIDI value.

Sound operating mode


Pitch: Pitch EG

199

See diagram above.

Pitch: Pitch EG

Attack Time

Here you can make settings for the pitch EG, which creates timevariant changes in the pitch of the oscillators. The depth of pitch
change produced by these EG settings on the oscillators is
adjusted by the Intensity (AMS1/2 Intensity) parameter (see
page 199).

Specifies the time over which the pitch will change from note-on
until it reaches the pitch specified as the attack level.
099

Parameter value.

Decay Time
Specifies the time over which the pitch will change after reaching
the attack level until it reaches the normal pitch.
099

Parameter value.

Release Time
Specifies the time over which the pitch will change from note-off
until it reaches the pitch specified as the release level.
099

Parameter value.

Level Modulation
Pitch EG change (level) (AMS=JS-Y/Velocity, Intensity= positive (+) value

Diagram

Note-on

Note-on

Note-on
Note-off

Note-off

Note-off

The diagram on top of the page shows the Pitch envelope line.

Level
These parameters specify the amount of pitch change. The actual
amount of pitch change will depend on the Intensity (AMS1/2
Intensity) parameter (see below). For example, with an Intensity setting of +12.00, a Level setting of +99 would raise the
pitch one octave, and a Level setting of 99 would lower the
pitch one octave.
Time-varying pitch settings (when Pitch EG Intensity = +12.00)
+99 = approximately 1 octave Attack Level
Note-off

Start Level

99 = approximately 1 octave

Decay
Time
Release Time

Start Level
Specifies the amount of pitch change at note-on.
-99+99

Parameter value.

Attack Level
Specifies the amount of pitch change when the attack time has
elapsed.
-99+99

A note played strongly with


Start Level Swing set to 0,
Attack Level Swing set to ,
the Joystick pulled on

AMS1/2 (Alternate Modulation Source 1/2)


These parameters select the source that will control the pitch EG
Level parameters (AMS (Alternate Modulation Source) list
on page 213).
Intensity (AMS1/2 Intensity)

Time
Release Level
Attack
Time

A note played strongly with


Start Level Swing set to 0,
Attack Level Swing set to +,
the Joystick pulled on

Parameter value.

Release Level

These parameters specify the depth and direction of the effect


applied by AMS1. With a setting of 0, the levels specified by
Level will be used.
For example if AMS1 is After Touch, pressing the keys to turn
it on will change the Level parameters of the Pitch EG. As the
absolute value of Intensity is increased, the pitch EG levels will
change more greatly when the key pressure is released. The
direction of the change is specified by St (Start Level Swing)
and At (Attack Level Swing). When the key pressure is
released, the pitch EG levels will return to their own settings.
If AMS1 is set to Velocity, increasing the absolute value of
Intensity will produce increasingly wider change in pitch EG
levels for strongly-played notes. The direction of the change is
specified by St (Start Level Swing) and At (Attack Level
Swing). As you play more softly, the pitch change will draw
closer to the pitch EG levels.

Specifies the amount of pitch change when the release time has
elapsed.

-99+99

-99+99

St (Start Level Swing)

Parameter value.

Time
These parameters specify the time over which the pitch change
will occur.

Parameter value.

This parameter specifies the direction of change in Start Level


caused by AMS1/2. If Intensity is a positive (+) value, a setting of + will raise the EG level, and a setting of will decrease it.
With a setting of 0 there will be no change.

Reference

Note-on
0 = pitch when
key is held
(sustained)

A note played softly with


Start Level Swing set at 0,
Attack Level Swing set to +,
the Joystick pulled on

200

Sound operating mode


Filter: Filter Type

At (Attack Level Swing)


This parameter specifies the direction of change in Attack
Level caused by AMS1/2. If Intensity is a positive (+) value,
a setting of + will raise the EG level, and a setting of will
decrease it. With a setting of 0 there will be no change.

Time Modulation

Filter: Filter Type


Here you can make settings for the filters that will be used by the
oscillators. You can select either a 24 dB/octave low pass filter
with resonance, or a series connection of a 12 dB/octave low pass
filter and a 12 dB/octave high pass filter.

Pitch EG changes (Time) (AMS = Velocity, Intensity = positive (+) value)


Note-on

Note-on
Note-off

Note-on
Note-off

Note-off

A note played softly with Attack A note played strongly with


A note played strongly with
Time Swing set to + and
Attack Time Swing set to + and Attack Time Swing set to and
Decay Time Swing set to +
Decay Time Swing set to +
Decay Time Swing set to

AMS (Alternate Modulation Source)


This parameter selects the source that will control the Time
parameters of the pitch EG (see AMS (Alternate Modulation
Source) list on page 213).
Intensity (AMS Intensity)
This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect
that AMS will have on the Time parameters. With a setting of
0, the pitch EG times will be just as specified by the Time settings.
The alternate modulation value at the moment that the EG
reaches each point will determine the actual value of the EG time
that comes next.

Filter Type
This parameter selects the type of filter (Low Pass Resonant, Low
Pass & High Pass) for the selected oscillator.
Low Pass Resonance
When the Low Pass filter type is selected, only filter A will be activated.

Low Pass & High Pass


When the Low Pass & High Pass filter type is
selected, the filter B will be activated.

For example, the decay time will be determined by the alternate


modulation value at the moment that the attack level is reached.
When this parameter is set to values of 16, 33, 49, 66, 82, or 99,
the specified EG times will speed up as much as 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, or
64 times respectively (or slowed down to 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32,
or 1/64 of the original time).
For example if AMS is set to Velocity, increasing the absolute
value of Intensity will allow strongly-played notes to increase
the changes in pitch EG Time values. The direction of the
change is specified by At (Attack Time Swing) and Dc (Decay
Time Swing). As you play more softly, the pitch EG times will
more closely approach the actual settings of the pitch EG.
-99+99

Parameter value.

Trim
Use this parameter to adjust the level at which the audio signal
output from the selected oscillator is input to filter A.
Note: If this value is raised, the sound may distort if Resonance is
set to a high value or when you play a chord.
0099

Trim level.

Filter A

At (Attack Time Swing)

Frequency (Cutoff Frequency A)

This parameter specifies the direction in which AMS will affect


the Attack Time parameter. With positive (+) values of Intensity, a setting of + will cause the time to be lengthened, and a
setting of will cause the time to be shortened. With a setting of
0 there will be no change.

This parameter specifies the cutoff frequency of filter A.


Low Pass
Level

Dc (Decay Time Swing)


Specify the direction in which AMS will affect the Decay
Time. With positive (+) values of Intensity, a setting of + will
cause the time to be lengthened, and a setting of will cause the
time to be shortened. With a setting of 0 there will be no change.

0099

This is a filter that cuts the highfrequency region above the cutoff
frequency.
This is the most common type of filter,
and is used to cut part of the overtone
12dB/oct
components, making an originally bright
24dB/oct
timbre sound more mellow (darker).
When the Filter Type is Low Pass
Frequency Resonance, the cutoff will have a
steeper slope.

Cutoff frequency value.

Sound operating mode


Filter: Filter Mod

201

Resonance (Resonance A)
The resonance emphasizes the overtone components that lie in
the region of the cutoff frequency specified by Frequency, producing a more distinctive sound. Increasing this value will produce a stronger effect.
0099

Resonance value.

Filter: Filter Mod


These settings let you apply modulation to the cutoff frequency
(Frequency) of the filter for the selected oscillator to modify
the tone.

Res. Mod. by AMS (Resonance modulated by AMS)


Selects the source that will control the Resonance level. See
AMS (Alternate Modulation Source) list on page 213.
The effect of resonance
Low Pass
Level

Low resonance value

High resonance value

When Filter Type is Low Pass Resonance, parameters for filter


B will not be editable (greyed out).

This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect


that Res. Mod. by AMS (Resonance modulated by AMS) will
have on the resonance level specified by Resonance (Resonance
A).
For example if Velocity has been selected, changes in keyboard
velocity will affect the resonance.
With positive (+) values, the resonance will increase as you play
more strongly, and as you play more softly the resonance will
approach the level specified by the Resonance setting.
With negative () values, the resonance will decrease as you play
more strongly, and as you play more softly the resonance will
approach the level specified by the Resonance setting.
The resonance level is determined by adding the Resonance
and Intensity (AMS Intensity) values.
-99+99

Parameter value.

Filter B
Frequency (Cutoff Frequency B)
This parameter specifies the cutoff frequency of filter B. This
parameter will be displayed when Filter Type is set to Low Pass
& High Pass.
High Pass
Level
This filter cuts the low-frequency range that
lies below the cutoff frequency. By cutting
the lower overtones, it lightens the tone.
12dB/oct
Frequency

0099

Cutoff frequency value.

Keyboard Tracking
Key Low/High
These settings specify keyboard tracking for the cutoff frequency
of the filter for the selected oscillator. The way in which the cutoff frequency is affected by the keyboard location you play can
be specified by the Key Low, Key High, Ramp Low and
Ramp High parameters.
Keyboard tracking will apply to the range below the specified
Low note number, and above the specified High note number.
C1G9

Lowest/Highest note in the range.

Ramp Low/High
These parameter specifies the angle of keyboard tracking.
If Intensity to A and Intensity to B are set to +50, Ramp
Low is set to 62 and Ramp High is set to +62, the angle of
the change in cutoff frequency will correspond to the keyboard
location (pitch). This means that the oscillation that occurs
when you increase the Resonance (Resonance A) will correspond to the keyboard location.
If you set Ramp Low to +43 and Ramp High to 43, the cutoff frequency will not be affected by keyboard location. Use this
setting when you do not want the cutoff frequency to change for
each note.
-99+99

Angle value.

Here is how cutoff frequency is affected by keyboard location


and the Ramp setting (Intensity to A and Intensity to B =
+50):
Cutoff frequency

High Ramp=+99
High Ramp=+62
High Ramp=0
High Ramp=43

Low Ramp=+99

High Ramp=99

Low Ramp=+43
Low Ramp=0
Low Ramp=62
Low Ramp=99

Low Key

High Key

Key

Reference

Intensity (AMS Intensity)

202

Sound operating mode


Filter: Filter Mod

Tracking to A/B

AMS (EG Alternate Modulation Source)

These parameters specify the note numbers at which keyboard


tracking will begin to apply, and set the Intensity to A and
Intensity to B parameters to specify the depth and direction of
the change applied to filters A and B.

Selects the source that will control the depth and direction of the
effect that the time-varying changes produced by the filter EG
will have on the cutoff frequency of filters A and B. See AMS
(Alternate Modulation Source) list on page 213.

For the range of notes between Key Low and Key High, the
cutoff frequency will change according to the keyboard location
(pitch).

Int to A (Intensity to A)

-99+99

Parameter value.

Filter EG

Specifies the depth and direction of the effect that AMS will
have on filter A. For details on how this will apply, refer to Int to
A (Intensity to A).
Int to B (Intensity to B)

Changes in cutoff frequency


Note-on

Note-on

Note-on
Note-off

Note-off

Note-off

Specifies the depth and direction of the effect that AMS will
have on filter B. For details on how this will apply, refer to Int to
A (Intensity to A).
Note: The sum of the settings for Velocity to A/B, Intensity to A/
B, and (AMS) Intensity to A/B will determine the depth and
direction of the effect produced by the filter EG.

Softly played

Strongly played
Setting to +

Strongly played
Setting to

Filter A/B Modulation


Velocity to A
This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect
that velocity will have on the time-varying changes created by
the filter EG (as set on Filter: Filter EG) to control the filter A
cutoff frequency.
With positive (+) values, playing more strongly will cause the filter EG to produce greater changes in cutoff frequency. With negative () values, playing more strongly will also cause the filter
EG to produce greater changes in cutoff frequency, but with the
polarity of the EG inverted.
99+99

Value of the Velocity to A parameter.

Velocity to B
This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect
that velocity will have on the time-varying changes created by
the filter EG to control the filter B cutoff frequency (see Velocity
to A).
99+99

Value of the Velocity to B parameter.

Int to A (Intensity to A)
Specifies the depth and direction of the effect that the time-varying changes created by the filter 1 EG will have on the filter A
cutoff frequency.
With positive (+) settings, the sound will become brighter when
the EG levels set by Filter EG Level and Time parameters are
in the + area, and darker when they are in the area.
With negative () settings, the sound will become darker when
the EG levels set by Filter EG Level and Time parameters are
in the + area, and brighter when they are in the area.
-99+99

Parameter value.

Int to B (Intensity to B)
Specifies the depth and direction of the effect that the time-varying changes created by the filter EG will have on the filter B cutoff frequency (see Int to A (Intensity to A)).
-99+99

Parameter value.

AMS1 (Alternate Modulation Source 1 for filter A/B)


Selects the source that will control modulation of the filter A
cutoff frequency. See AMS (Alternate Modulation Source) list
on page 213.
Note: The filter B parameters will be displayed when Filter Type
on page 200 is Low Pass & High Pass.
Intensity (Intensity to AMS1)
Specifies the depth and direction of the effect that AMS1 will
have.
When AMS1 is JS X, a positive (+) value for this parameter will
cause the cutoff frequency to rise when the joystick is moved
toward the right, and fall when the joystick is moved toward the
left. With a negative () value for this parameter, the opposite
will occur.
This value is added to the setting of the Filter A Frequency.
AMS2 (Alternate Modulation Source 2 for filter A/B)
Selects the source that will control modulation of the filter A
cutoff frequency (see AMS (Alternate Modulation Source) list
on page 213).
Intensity (Intensity to AMS2)
Specifies the depth and direction of the effect that the selected
source will have (see Intensity (Intensity to AMS1) on
page 202).

Sound operating mode


Filter: Filter LFO

203

Intensity to A

Filter: Filter LFO

Specifies the depth and direction of the effect that AMS will
have on filter A.

Here you can use the filter LFO to apply cyclic modulation to the
cutoff frequency of the filter (for the selected oscillator) to create
cyclical changes in tone.

For example if AMS is After Touch, higher settings of this


parameter will allow greater change to be applied to LFO1 when
you apply pressure to the keyboard.
-99+99

Parameter value.

Intensity to B
Specifies the depth and direction of the effect that AMS will
have on filter B (see Intensity to A).

LFO 2
Adjusts the depth of the cyclic modulation applied by LFO2 (set
on LFO: LFO2) to the cutoff frequency of filters A and B. For
more information on the parameters see LFO 1 above.

LFO 1

Filter: Filter EG

Intensity to A
Specifies the depth and direction of the modulation that LFO1
(set on LFO: LFO1) will have on the cutoff frequency of filter
A. Negative () settings will invert the phase.
Change in cutoff

Low setting

-99+99

Here you can make settings for the EG that will produce timevarying changes in the cutoff frequency of filters A and B for the
selected oscillator. The depth of the effect that these settings will
have on the filter cutoff frequency is determined by the Velocity and Intensity parameters.

High setting

Parameter value.

Intensity to B

-99+99

Reference

Specify the depth and direction of the modulation that LFO1


will have on the cutoff frequency of filter B (see Intensity to A).
Parameter value.

JS (Joystick) Y Intensity to A
By moving the joystick in the Y direction (toward yourself), you
can control the depth at which LFO1 modulates the cutoff frequency of filter A. This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the control.
Higher settings of this parameter will produce greater increases
in the effect of LFO1 on the filter when the joystick is moved
toward yourself.
-99+99

Diagram
The diagram on top of the page shows the Filter envelope line.

Filter envelope
Attack Level
Note-on

Parameter value.

JS (Joystick) Y Intensity to B
By moving the joystick in the Y direction (toward yourself), you
can control the depth at which LFO1 modulates the cutoff frequency of filter B. This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the control (see JS (Joystick) Y Intensity to A).
AMS (Filter LFO1 Alternate Modulation Source)
Select a source that will control the depth and direction of cutoff
frequency change for both filters A and B. See AMS (Alternate
Modulation Source) list.

Note-off
Sustain Level

The specified
cutoff
frequency

Release
Level

Break
Point
Level
Start
Level

Attack
Time

Decay
Time

Time

Slope
Time

Release
Time

Level
These are the envelope segment levels. The result will depend on
the filter that was selected in Filter Type. For example, with the
Low Pass Resonance filter, positive (+) values of EG Intensity
will cause the tone to be brightened by positive (+) levels, and
darkened by negative () levels.

204

Sound operating mode


Filter: Filter EG

Level Modulation

Start
This parameter specifies the change in cutoff frequency at the
time of note-on.

Filter 1 EG changes (level) (AMS = Velocity, Intensity = a positive (+) value)


Note-on

Note-on

-99+99

Note-on
Note-off

Note-off

Note-off

Level value.

Attack
This parameter specifies the change in cutoff frequency after the
attack time has elapsed.
-99+99

Softly played note with Start Level


Swing, Attack Level Swing, and
Break Level Swing set to +

Strongly played note with Start


Strongly played note with Start
Level Swing, Attack Level Swing, Level Swing, Attack Level Swing,
and Break Level Swing set to
and Break Level Swing set to +

Level value.
AMS (Alternate Modulation Source)

Break (Break Point)


This parameter specifies the change in cutoff frequency after the
decay time has elapsed.
-99+99

Level value.

Sustain
This parameter specifies the change in cutoff frequency that will
be maintained from after the slope time has elapsed until noteoff occurs.
-99+99

Level value.

Release
This parameter specifies the change in cutoff frequency that will
occur when the release time has elapsed.
-99+99

Level value.

Time
These parameters specify the time over which the filter change
will occur.
Attack

This parameter selects the source that will control the Level
parameters of the filter EG (AMS (Alternate Modulation
Source) list on page 213).
Intensity (AMS Intensity)
This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect
applied by AMS. With a setting of 0, the levels specified by
Frequency (Cutoff Frequency A) will be used.
For example, if AMS is Velocity, and you set St (Start Level
Swing), At (Attack Level Swing) and Br (Break Level Swing)
to + and set Intensity to a positive (+) value, the EG levels will
rise as you play more strongly. If Intensity is set to a negative
() values, the EG levels will fall as you play more strongly.
-99+99

Intensity value.

St (Start Level Swing)


This parameter specifies the direction in which AMS will affect
Start. When Intensity has a positive (+) value, a setting of +
for this parameter will allow AMS to raise the EG level, and a
setting of will allow AMS to lower the EG level. With a setting
of 0 there will be no change.
At (Attack Level Swing)

This parameter specifies the time over which the level will
change from note-on until the attack level is reached.

Decay

This parameter specifies the direction in which AMS will affect


Attack. When Intensity has a positive (+) value, a setting of +
for this parameter will allow AMS to raise the EG level, and a
setting of will allow AMS to lower the EG level. With a setting
of 0 there will be no change.

This parameter specifies the time over which the level will
change from the attack level to the break point level.

Br (Break Level Swing)

099

099

Time value.

Time value.

Slope
This parameter specifies the time over which the level will
change after the decay time has elapsed until the sustain level is
reached.
099

Time value.

Release
This parameter specifies the time over which the level will
change after note-on occurs until the release level is reached.
099

Time value.

This parameter specifies the direction in which AMS will affect


Break (Break Point). When Intensity has a positive (+)
value, a setting of + for this parameter will allow AMS to raise
the EG level, and a setting of will allow AMS to lower the EG
level. With a setting of 0 there will be no change.

Sound operating mode


Amp: Amp Level/Pan

Time Modulation

and setting this parameter to will allow AMS to shorten the


time. With a setting of 0 there will be no change.

Filter 1 EG changes (Time) (AMS = Velocity, Intensity = a positive (+) value)


Note-on

Note-on
Note-off

205

Note-on
Note-off

Note-off

Amp: Amp Level/Pan


Strongly played note with
Softly played note with Attack, Strongly played note with
Attack, Decay, Slope and
Attack, Decay, Slope and
Decay, Slope and Release
Release Level Swings set to + Release Level Swings set to
Level Swings set to +

These parameters control the volume and pan of the selected


oscillator.

AMS1/2
Use this parameter to select the source that will control the
Time parameters of the filter EG. See AMS (Alternate Modulation Source) list on page 213.
Int (AMS Intensity)
This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect
that AMS1/2 will have.

With a setting of 0, the times specified by Frequency (Cutoff


Frequency A) will be used.
If AMS1/2 is set to Velocity, positive (+) values of this parameter will cause EG times to lengthen as you play more strongly,
and negative () values will cause EG times to shorten as you
play more strongly.
-99+99

Amp Level
Volume of the selected oscillator.
Note: The volume of a Sound can be controlled by CC#7 (volume)
and #11 (expression). The resulting level is determined by multiplying the values of CC#7 and #11. The Global MIDI channel is
used for control.
0127
Pan
Pan (stereo position) of the selected oscillator.

This parameter is not available when editing a Drum Kit.


Use the individual Pan control for each key (see Pan on
page 197).

Intensity value.

At (Attack Time Swing)


This parameter specifies the direction in which AMS1/2 will
affect the attack time. With positive (+) values of Intensity, setting this parameter to + will allow AMS to lengthen the time,
and setting this parameter to will allow AMS to shorten the
time. With a setting of 0 there will be no change.
Dc (Decay Time Swing)
This parameter specifies the direction in which AMS1/2 will
affect the decay time. With positive (+) values of Intensity, setting this parameter to + will allow AMS to lengthen the time,
and setting this parameter to will allow AMS to shorten the
time. With a setting of 0 there will be no change.

Volume level.

Random

The sound will be heard from a different location


at each note-on.

L001

Places the sound at far left.

C064

Places the sound in the center.

R127

Places the sound to far right.

Note: This can be controlled by CC#10 (panpot). A CC#10 value of


0 or 1 will place the sound at the far left, a value of 64 will place the
sound at the location specified by the Pan setting for each oscillator, and a value of 127 will place the sound at the far right. This is
controlled on the global MIDI channel.

Pan modulation

Sl (Slope Time Swing)


This parameter specifies the direction in which AMS1/2 will
affect the slope time. With positive (+) values of Intensity, setting this parameter to + will allow AMS to lengthen the time,
and setting this parameter to will allow AMS to shorten the
time. With a setting of 0 there will be no change.
Rl (Release Time Swing)
This parameter specifies the direction in which AMS1/2 will
affect the release time. With positive (+) values of Intensity,
setting this parameter to + will allow AMS to lengthen the time,

AMS (Alternate Modulation Source)


Selects the source that will modify pan (see AMS (Alternate
Modulation Source) list on page 213). This change will be relative to the Pan setting.
Intensity
Specifies the depth of the effect produced by AMS. For example, if Pan is set to C064 and AMS is Note Number, positive
(+) values of this parameter will cause the sound to move toward
the right as the note numbers increase beyond the C4 note (i.e.,

Reference

For example, if AMS1/2 is set to FltKTr +/+, the EG Time


parameters will be controlled by the Keyboard Tracking settings.
With positive (+) values of this parameter, positive (+) values of
Ramp Low/High will lengthen the EG times, and negative ()
values of Ramp Low/High will shorten the EG times. The
direction of change is specified by At (Attack Time Swing),
Dc (Decay Time Swing), Sl (Slope Time Swing), and Rl
(Release Time Swing).

206

Sound operating mode


Amp: Amp Mod

as you play higher), and toward the left as the note numbers
decrease (i.e., as you play lower). Negative () values of this
parameter will have the opposite effect.
-99+99

Parameter value.

Amp Modulation
These parameters specify how the volume of the selected oscillator will be affected by velocity.
Velocity Intensity
With positive (+) values, the volume will increase as you play
more strongly. With negative () values, the volume will
decrease as you play more strongly.

Amp: Amp Mod

Volume change (with positive (+) values of this parameter)

These settings allow you to apply modulation to amp (for each


oscillator) to modulate the volume.

Note-on

Note-on
Note-off

Softly played

-99+99

Note-off

Strongly played

Intensity value.

AMS (Alternate Modulation Source)


Selects the source that will control the volume of the amp for the
selected oscillator (See AMS (Alternate Modulation Source)
list on page 213). Velocity cannot be selected.
Intensity

Keyboard Tracking
These parameters let you use keyboard tracking to adjust the
volume of the selected oscillator. Use the Key and Ramp
parameters to specify how the volume will be affected by the
keyboard location that you play.
Key Low/High
These settings specify the note number at which keyboard tracking will begin to apply. The volume will not change between
Key Low and Key High.
Keyboard tracking will apply to the range below the specified
Low note number, and above the specified Highy note number.
C1G9

Lowest/Highest note in the range.

This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect


that AMS will have. The actual volume will be determined by
multiplying the value of the changes produced by the amp EG
with the values of Alternate Modulation etc., and if the levels of
the amp EG are low, the modulation applied by Alternate Modulation will also be less.
For example, if AMS is set to After Touch, positive (+) values of
this parameter will cause the volume to increase when pressure is
applied to the keyboard. However if the EG settings etc. have
already raised the volume to its maximum level, the volume cannot be increased further.
With negative () values of this parameter, the volume will
decrease when pressure is applied to the keyboard.
-99+99

Intensity value.

Ramp Low/High
These parameters specify the angle of keyboard tracking.
With positive (+) values of the Ramp Low parameter, the volume will increase as you play notes below the Key Low note
number. With negative () values, the volume will decrease.
With positive (+) values of the Ramp High parameter, the volume will increase as you play notes above the Key High note
number. With negative () values, the volume will decrease.
-99+99

Angle value.

Here is an example of volume changes produced by keyboard


location and Ramp settings:
Volume

Ramp Low=+99

Ramp High=+99

Ramp Low=0

Ramp High=0

Ramp Low=99

Ramp High=99

Key Low

Key High

Key

Amp: Amp EG
These parameters let you create time-varying changes in the volume of the selected oscillator.

Sound operating mode


Amp: Amp EG

207

Diagram

Slope

The diagram on top of the page shows the Amplitude envelope


line.

This parameter specifies the time over which the volume will
change from when it reaches the break point level until it reaches
the sustain level.

Level

099

These parameters are the level of the envelope segment.

Note-on

Release
This parameter specifies the time over which the volume will
change after note-off until it reaches 0.

Amplifier EG
Note-off

Attack Level

Time value.

Break Point

Volume

099
Sustain
Level

Start
Level

Time

Time value.

Level Modulation
Amp 1 EG changes (Level) (AMS=Velocity, Intensity = a positive (+) value)

Attack
Time

Decay Slope
Time Time

Release Time

Note-on

Note-on
Note-off

Note-on
Note-off

Note-off

Start

099

Level value.

Attack

Softly played note when Start Level Strongly played note when Start Level Strongly played note when Start Level
Swing=0 and Attack Level Swing Swing=0 andAttack Level Swing and Swing=0 andAttack Level Swing and
Break Level Swing are set to +
and Break Level Swing are set to + Break Level Swing are set to +

AMS (Alternate Modulation Source)

This parameter specifies the volume level that will be reached


after the attack time has elapsed.

This parameter specifies the source that will control the Level
parameters of the amp EG. See AMS (Alternate Modulation
Source) list on page 213.

099

Intensity

Level value.

This parameter specifies the volume level that will be maintained


from after the slope time has elapsed until note-off occurs.

This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect


that AMS will have. For example, if AMS is Velocity, setting
St (Start Level Swing), At (Attack Level Swing) and Br
(Break Point Level Swing) to + and setting Intensity to a positive (+) value will cause the amp EG volume levels to increase as
you play more strongly. Setting Intensity to a negative () values will cause the amp EG volume levels to decrease as you play
more strongly. With a setting of 0, the levels will be as specified
on Amp: Amp EG.

099

-99+99

Break
This parameter specifies the volume level that will be reached
after the decay time has elapsed.
099

Level value.

Sustain

Level value.

Intensity value.

St (Start Level Swing)

Time
These parameters specify the time over which the volume change
will occur.
Attack
This parameter specifies the time over which the volume will
change after note-on until it reaches the attack level. If the start
level is 0, this will be the rise time of the sound.
099

Time value.

Decay
This parameter specifies the time over which the volume will
change from when it reaches the attack level until it reaches the
break point level.
099

Time value.

This parameter specifies the direction in which AMS will


change Start. If Intensity is set to a positive (+) value, setting
this parameter to + will allow AMS to increase the EG level, and
setting this parameter to will allow AMS to decrease the EG
level. With a setting of 0, no change will occur.
At (Attack Level Swing)
This parameter specifies the direction in which AMS will
change Attack. If Intensity is set to a positive (+) value, setting this parameter to + will allow AMS to increase the EG level,
and setting this parameter to will allow AMS to decrease the
EG level. With a setting of 0, no change will occur.
Br (Break Point Level Swing)
This parameter specifies the direction in which AMS will
change Break. If Intensity is set to a positive (+) value, setting this parameter to + will allow AMS to increase the EG level,
and setting this parameter to will allow AMS to decrease the
EG level. With a setting of 0, no change will occur.

Reference

This parameter specifies the volume level at note-on. If you want


the note to begin at a loud level, set this to a high value.

208

Sound operating mode


LFO: LFO1

Time Modulation
These parameters let you use an alternate modulation source to
modify the amp EG times that were specified in Time on
page 207.
Amp 1 EG changes (Time)
(AMS=Amp KTrk +/+, Intensity = a positive (+) value)
(When Amp Keyboard Track Low Ramp= a positive (+) value, and
High Ramp = a positive (+) value)
Note-on

Note-on
Note-off

Note-on
Note-off

Note-off

ting this parameter to + will allow AMS1 to lengthen the time,


and setting it to will allow AMS1 to shorten the time. With a
setting of 0 there will be no effect.
Rl (Release Time)
This parameter specifies the direction of the effect that AMS1
will have on Release. With positive (+) values of Intensity,
setting this parameter to + will allow AMS1 to lengthen the time,
and setting it to will allow AMS1 to shorten the time. With a
setting of 0 there will be no effect.
AMS2 (Alternate Modulation Source 2)

Low-pitched note played with High -pitched note played with


Attack, Decay, Slope, and
Attack, Decay, Slope, and
Release Time Swing at +
Release Time Swing at
Amp 1 EG changes (Time) (AMS=Velocity, Intensity= a positive (+) value)
Note-on

Note-on
Note-off

This is another alternate modulation source for the Amp EG. See
above AMS1 parameters.

Note-on
Note-off

Note-off

LFO: LFO1
Softly played note with
Attack, Decay, Slope and
Release Time Swing at +

Strongly played note with


Attack, Decay, Slope and
Release Time Swing at +

Strongly played note with


Attack, Decay, Slope and
Release Time Swing at

AMS1 (Alternate Modulation Source 1 - Time)


This parameter specifies the source that will control the Time
parameters of the amp EG (see AMS (Alternate Modulation
Source) list on page 213). With a setting of Off, there will be no
modulation.

In this and the next page you can make settings for the LFO that
can be used to cyclically modulate the Pitch, Filter, and Amp of
each oscillator. There are two LFO units for each oscillator. By
setting the LFO1 or LFO2 Intensity to a negative () value for
Pitch, Filter, or Amp, you can invert the LFO waveform.

Intensity
This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect
that AMS1 will have. For example, if AMS1(T) is Amp KTrk
+/+, the (Amp) Keyboard Track settings (see Keyboard Tracking on page 206) will control the EG Time parameters. With
positive (+) values of this parameter, positive (+) values of
Ramp (Ramp Setting) will cause EG times to be lengthened,
and negative () values of Ramp (Ramp Setting) will cause EG
times to be shortened. The direction of the change is specified by
At (Attack Time Swing), Dc (Decay Time Swing), Sl (Slope
Time Swing), and Rl (Release Time).
When AMS1(T) is Velocity, positive (+) values will cause EG
times to lengthen as you play more strongly, and negative ()
values will cause EG times to shorten as you play more strongly.
With a setting of 0, the EG times will be as specified by the
Level parameters (see page 207).

Waveform
This parameter selects the LFO waveform. The numbers that
appear at the right of some of the LFO waveforms indicate the
phase at which the waveform will begin.
Triangle

Triangle

90

Triangle
Random

At (Attack Time Swing)


This parameter specifies the direction of the effect that AMS1
will have on Attack. With positive (+) values of Intensity, setting this parameter to + will allow AMS1 to lengthen the time,
and setting it to will allow AMS1 to shorten the time. With a
setting of 0 there will be no effect.

Saw

Step Triangle 4

Triangle wave

Step Triangle 6

Phase will change


randomly at each key-in

Step Saw 4
Step Saw 6

Sawtooth down
Saw

180

Square

Square wave

Sine

Sine wave

Guitar

Guitar vibrato

Random1 (S/H):
Conventional sample & hold (S/H) in which the
level changes randomly at fixed intervals of
time
Random2 (S/H):
Both the levels and the time intervals will
change randomly.
Random3 (S/H):
The maximum level and minimum level will
alternate at random intervals of time (i.e., a
square wave with random period).

Dc (Decay Time Swing)

Exponential
Triangle

This parameter specifies the direction of the effect that AMS1


will have on Decay. With positive (+) values of Intensity, setting this parameter to + will allow AMS1 to lengthen the time,
and setting it to will allow AMS1 to shorten the time. With a
setting of 0 there will be no effect.

Exponential
Saw Down

Frequency

Sl (Slope Time Swing)

Set the LFO frequency. A setting of 99 is the fastest.

This parameter specifies the direction of the effect that AMS1


will have on Slope. With positive (+) values of Intensity, set-

0099

Random4 (Vector)
Random5 (Vector)
Random6 (Vector)
These types cause Random 13 to change
smoothly. They can be used to simulate the
instability of acoustic instruments etc.

Exponential
Saw Up

Frequency rate.

Sound operating mode


LFO: LFO1

209

Offset

Intensity (AMS1 Intensity)

This parameter specifies the central value of the LFO waveform.


For example, with a setting of 0 as shown in the following diagram, the vibrato that is applied will be centered on the note-on
pitch. With a setting of +99, the vibrato will only raise the pitch
above the note-on pitch, in the way in which vibrato is applied
on a guitar.

This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect


that AMS1(F) will have. When this parameter is set to a value
of 16, 33, 49, 66, 82, or 99, the LFO frequency being can be
increased by a maximum of 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, or 64 times respectively (or decreased by 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, or 1/64 respectively).

When Waveform is set to Guitar, the modulation will occur


only in the positive (+) direction even if you set Offset to 0.

For example, if AMS1(F) is Note Number, positive (+) values


of this parameter will cause the oscillator LFO to speed up as you
play higher notes. Negative () values will cause the oscillator
LFO to slow down as you play higher notes. This change will be
centered on the C4 note.

Here are offset settings and pitch change produced by vibrato:


Pitch

offset = 99

offset = 0

offset = +99

If AMS1(F) is set to JS +Y, raising the value of this parameter


will cause the oscillator LFO1 speed to increase as the joystick is
moved away from yourself. With a setting of +99, moving the
joystick all the way away from yourself will increase the LFO
speed by approximately 64 times.

Pitch at note-on

-99+99

Offset value.

Key Sync

-99+99

This parameter specifies if the LFO is synchronized to key


strokes.
On

The LFO will start each time you play a note, and
an independent LFO will operate for each note.

Off

The LFO effect that was started by the first-played


note will continue to be applied to each newlyplayed note. (In this case, Delay and Fade will be
applied only to the LFO when it is first started).

Intensity value.

AMS2 (Alternate Modulation Source2)


Intensity (AMS2 Intensity)
Make settings for a second alternate modulation source that will
adjust the frequency of the oscillator LFO1 (see above AMS1
(Alternate Modulation Source1) and Intensity (AMS1 Intensity)).

Frequency MIDI/Tempo Sync

Fade
MIDI/Tempo Sync
This parameter enables/disables the LFO synchronization with
Sequencer 1 Tempo.
On

The LFO frequency will synchronize to the tempo


(MIDI Clock) of Sequencer 1. In this case, the
values you specified for Frequency (see
page 208) and Frequency Modulation (see
page 209) will be ignored.

Here is how Fade affects the LFO (when Key Sync is On):
Note-on

Note-off
Fade

Delay

0099

Fade rate.

Delay
This parameter specifies the time from note-on until the LFO
effect begins to apply. When Key Sync is Off, the delay will
apply only when the LFO is first started.
099

Delay time.

Base Note
When MIDI/Tempo Sync is On, these parameters set a note
length relative to  (Tempo) and the multiple (Times) that
will be applied to it. These parameters will determine the frequency of the LFO1. For example if Base Note is  (quarter
note) and Times is 04, the LFO will perform one cycle every
four beats.
Even if you change the  (Tempo) setting of Sequencer 1, the
LFO will always perform one cycle every four beats.

This parameter is not available when editing a Drum Kit.

Frequency Modulation

 , 
,  , 
,  , 
,  ,

You can use two alternate modulation sources to adjust the


speed of the LFO1 for the selected oscillator.
AMS1 (Alternate Modulation Source1)
Selects the source that will adjust the frequency of the selected
oscillator LFO1 (see AMS (Alternate Modulation Source) list
on page 213). LFO1 can be modulated by LFO2.

Note value.
Times

This parameter is not available when editing a Drum Kit.


1...16

Beats before restarting the cycle.

Reference

This parameter specifies the time from when the LFO begins to
apply until it reaches the maximum amplitude. When Key
Sync. is Off, the fade will apply only when the LFO is first
started.

210

Sound operating mode


LFO: LFO2

Send to Master

LFO: LFO2

This parameters allows you to decide if the direct + effected signal must go to the Master, or just the effected signal.

Here you can make settings for the LFO2, which is the second
LFO that can be applied to the selected oscillator. See LFO:
LFO1 for more information on the parameters value.

On

Only the effected signal will be sent to the Audio


Outputs. The direct (non-effected) signal will not
be sent.

However in Frequency Modulation, the LFO cannot be


selected as a modulation source in AMS1 or AMS2.

Off

Both the effected signal and direct signals will be


sent to the Audio Outputs.

Effects: FX Select

Effects: FX1

Here you can select two effects for the whole Sound, switch them
on/off, and specify chaining.

In this page you can edit the effected assigned to the FX1 (A or
C) effect processor (usually reverb). See the Effects chapter for
more information.

Effects: FX2
In this page you can edit the effected assigned to the FX2 (B or
D) effect processor (usually modulating effect). See the Effects
chapter for more information.

Note: For details on the effects, refer to the Effects chapter.

FX 1/2 Group
Send
Send level for each effect.
Drum samples have their own send level settings (see Send
FX1 and Send FX2 on page 197). Use this parameter to
adjust the general offset of the Drum Kit.
000127

Effect level.

FX1/2
Use these parameters to select the effect type for effect 1/2. See
the Effects chapter for more information.
Note: If 000: No Effect is selected, the output from the master effect
will be muted.
Wet/Dry
Mix between the effected (Wet) and direct (uneffected, Dry) signal.
Dry

Direct signal only.

Wet

Effected signal only.

nn:nn

Percentage of Wet/Dry signal.

2>1
Use this parameter to send the output of effect 2 to the input of
effect 1.
000127

Level of the signal exiting the effect 2 going back


to the effect 1.

Sound operating mode


Page menu

Page menu
Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.

211

parameters. You cannot edit the Sound while you are in Compare mode.
While this function is on, the Compare indicator blinks on the
page header.

Write Sound dialog box


Open this window by selecting the Write Sound item from the
page menu. Here, you can save all Sound parameters to a Sound
location in memory.
Warning: If you write over an existing Sound, the Sound will be
deleted and replaced by the one you are saving (overwrite).
Please save on disk any User Sound you dont want to lose.
Note: DrumKits cannot be written over standard Sounds, nor vice
versa.
Write Sound
Select this command to open the Write Sound dialog box, and
save all editing parameters to a Sound.
See Write Sound dialog box on page 211 for more information.
Solo Oscillator
Select this command to solo the selected oscillator, and mute the
other oscillators. Select it again to unmute the other oscillators.

Note: To save over a Factory Sound location, unckeck the Factory


Sound Protect parameter in Disk mode (see Factory Sound Protect on page 272).
Warning: When replacing a Factory Sound, please be warned
that all Performance, STSs, Styles and Songs making use of it
will be modified as well. Use this feature with great care!
To restore the original data, please reload the original Musical
Resources (ver. 2.5 or higher), freely available from our web site
(www.korgpa.com).

When this function is activated, the Solo OSC [n] indicator (n


= oscillator number) blinks on the page header. While in this situation, you can select a different oscillator to be soloed.
Swap LFO

Copy Oscillator
Select this command to copy all settings between oscillators.
See Copy Oscillator dialog box on page 212 for more information.

Name
Name of the Sound to be saved. Press the
(Text Edit) button
next to the name to open the Text Edit window.

Copy FX
Select this command to copy all FX settings from another
Sound.
See Copy FX dialog box on page 212 for more information.
Copy Drum Kit
Select this command to copy the Drum Kit from a different
Drum Kit.

Sound Bank
Target bank of Sounds. Each bank corresponds to one of the
PERFORMANCE/SOUND buttons. Use TEMPO/VALUE controls to select a different bank.
Sound
Target Sound location in the selected bank. Use TEMPO/VALUE
controls to select a different location.

See Copy Drum Kit dialog box on page 212 for more information.

Select button

Init Sound

Press this button to open the Sound Select window, and select a
target location.

Select this command to delete all parameters, and set them to a


default value.
Compare
When this command is checked, original Sound parameter values are temporarily recalled, to compare them with edited

Reference

Select tis command to replace LFO1 with LFO2, and vice-versa.

212

Sound operating mode


Copy Oscillator dialog box

Copy Oscillator dialog box

Copy Drum Kit dialog box

Open this window by selecting the Copy Oscillator item from


the page menu. Here, you can copy all settings between oscillators.

Open this window by selecting the Copy Drum Kit item from
the page menu. Here, you can copy settings from a range of keys
of a Drum Kit.

From Sound

From Drum Kit

Press this button to open the Sound Select window, and select
the source Sound.

Press this button to open the Sound Select window, and select
the source Drum Kit.

From Oscillator

From Key

Select the source oscillator to copy from.

Select the source range of keys to copy from.

To Oscillator

To Key

Target oscillator where to copy the source settings to.

Target key. Settings are copied starting from this key, and
upwards.

Copy FX dialog box


Open this window by selecting the Copy FX item from the page
menu. Here, you can copy all FX settings between FX processors.

From Sound
Press this button to open the Sound Select window, and select
the source Sound.
From FX
Select the source effect to copy from.
To FX
Target effect where to copy the source settings to.

Sound operating mode


AMS (Alternate Modulation Source) list

213

AMS (Alternate Modulation Source) list


Off

Do not use Alternate Modulation

Pitch EG

Pitch EG

Filter EG

Filter EG within the same oscillator

Amp EG

Amp EG within the same oscillator

LFO1

LFO1 within the same oscillator

LFO2

LFO2 within the same oscillator

Flt KTrk +/+ (Filter Keyboard Track +/+)

Filter keyboard tracking within the same oscillator

Flt KTrk +/ (Filter Keyboard Track +/)

Filter keyboard tracking within the same oscillator

Flt KTrk 0/+ (Filter Keyboard Track 0/+)

Filter keyboard tracking within the same oscillator

Flt KTrk +/0 (Filter Keyboard Track +/0)

Filter keyboard tracking within the same oscillator

Amp KTrk +/+ (Amp Keyboard Track +/+)

Amp keyboard tracking within the same oscillator

Amp KTrk +/ (Amp Keyboard Track +/)

Amp keyboard tracking within the same oscillator

Amp KTrk 0/+ (Amp Keyboard Track 0/+)

Amp keyboard tracking within the same oscillator

Amp KTrk +/0 (Amp Keyboard Track +/0)

Amp keyboard tracking within the same oscillator

Note Number

Note number

Velocity

Velocity

Poly AT (Poly After Touch)

Polyphonic After Touch (transmitted from the Pa1X only as sequence data)

Channel AT (Channel After Touch)

After Touch (Channel After Touch)

Joystick X

Joystick X (horizontal) axis

Joystick +Y

Joystick +Y (vertical upward) direction (CC#01)

Joystick Y

Joystick Y (vertical downward) direction (CC#02)

JS+Y & AT/2 (Joy Stick +Y & After Touch/2)

Joystick +Y (vertical upward) direction and After Touch

JSY & AT/2 (Joy Stick Y & After Touch/2)

Joystick Y (vertical downward) direction and After Touch

Ass.Pedal

Assignable foot pedal (CC#04)

CC#18

CC#18

CC#17

CC#17

CC#19

CC#19

CC#20

CC#20

CC#21

CC#21

Damper

Damper pedal (CC#64)

CC#65

Portamento switch (CC#65)


Sostenuto pedal (CC#66)

CC#80

CC#80

CC#81

CC#81

CC#82

CC#82

CC#83

CC#83

Tempo

Tempo (tempo data from Sequencer 1 clock or external MIDI clock)

Flt KTrk +/+ (Filter Keyboard Track +/+)

Reference

Sostenuto

+/

The direction of the effect will be determined by


the sign of the Ramp Low setting, and by the
opposite sign of the Ramp High setting (50 for
a setting of +50, and +50 for a setting of 50).

0/+

Ramp Low will have no AMS effect. The sign of


the Ramp High setting will determine the
direction of its effect.

Flt KTrk +/ (Filter Keyboard Track +/)


Flt KTrk 0/+ (Filter Keyboard Track 0/+)
Flt KTrk +/0 (Filter Keyboard Track +/0)
Amp KTrk +/+ (Amp Keyboard Track +/+)
Amp KTrk +/ (Amp Keyboard Track +/)
Amp KTrk 0/+ (Amp Keyboard Track 0/+)
Amp KTrk +/0 (Amp Keyboard Track +/0)
+/+

The direction of the effect will be determined by


the sign (positive or negative) of the Ramp Low
or Ramp High setting.

214
+/0

Sound operating mode


AMS (Alternate Modulation Source) list

The sign of the Ramp Low setting will determine the direction of its effect. Ramp High will
have no AMS effect.

example of Amp
Keyboard Track settings

Amp
Ramp Low
= +50

Ramp High
= +50

Key Low Key High

Note Number

+ max
AMS = Amp KTrk +/+
AMS Intensity = positive (+) value

zero
Depth and direction of modulation
- max

+ max
AMS = Amp KTrk +/
AMS Intensity = positive (+) value

zero

Depth and direction of modulation


- max

+ max
AMS = Amp KTrk 0/+
AMS Intensity = positive (+) value

zero
Depth and direction of modulation
- max

+ max
AMS = Amp KTrk +/0
AMS Intensity = positive (+) value

zero
Depth and direction of modulation
- max

JS +Y & AT/2 (Joy Stick +Y & After Touch/2)


The effect will be controlled by the joystick +Y (vertically
upward) and by after touch. In this case, the effect of after touch
will be only half of the specified intensity.
JS Y & AT/2 (Joy Stick Y & After Touch/2)
The effect will be controlled by the joystick Y (vertically downward) and by after touch. In this case, the effect of after touch
will be only half of the specified intensity.

Sampling operating mode


Entering and exiting the Sampling mode

215

Sampling operating mode

New Sounds. Sampling allows you to create new sounds, by


recording from an external source connected to Pa1X Audio
Inputs, or by loading files from disk. Pa1X can read common
formats, like WAV and AIFF files, Korg Trinity and Triton Samples, Korg Trinity and Triton Multisamples, Korg Triton Programs, and Akai S1000 and S3000 Samples and Programs.
To be used, Samples must then be assigned to a Multisample or a
Drum Kit. A Multisample allows you to arrange samples into
separate zones of the keyboard. Drum Kits allows you to assign a
different sample to each note of the keyboard, with up to six
dynamic layers per note.
Multisamples can then be assigned to Sounds. Sounds created
with this function can be used as any ordinary Sound, and
assigned to any track.
The Load Sample function allows you to read samples (Korg
.KSF, Akai .S1 or .S3, .AIFF and .WAV) from disk. The
Import function allows to read multisamples (Korg .KMP and
Akai .P1 or .P3) from Korg Trinity and Triton, or Akai
S1000 or S3000 disks. Programs (.PCG files) can be imported
from Korg Triton disks, and converted to Sounds.

Entering and exiting the Sampling mode


While in Sound mode, press the RECORD button to enter in
Sampling mode.
While in Sampling mode, press the RECORD button to exit the
Sampling mode, and return to the Sound mode.

The Record (Sampling) procedure


Here is a short overview of a typical sampling procedure.
1.

With the MASTER VOLUME slider set to zero, connect the


source to be sampled to one or both the Audio Inputs on
the rear of the Pa1X. When the source has been connected,
raise the MASTER VOLUME slider to a position other than
zero.

2.

Adjust the source volume.


If recording from the MIC input, adjust the input level of
the Pa1X using the GAIN knob next to the Audio Input
connectors.

Note: Akai data can only be importeed from CD.

If recording from the line inputs, adjust the source output


level. If possible, set its output level to the maximum.

You can also use the Export function to export samples (.KSF)
and multisamples (.KMP) in Korg proprietary format.

Watch at the AUDIO IN LED to check the input level. Ideally, the LED should turn to red only on signal peaks, and
should usually stay orange (green means too low an input
signal).

Audio Grooves. Another powerful feature of the Sampling mode


is the Time Slice. This feature lets you add realism to MIDI
tracks, by using sampled patterns as the rhythm track of a Style.
Cycling rhythm samples, or audio grooves, can be sliced into
separate percussive instruments. Combined with MIDI tracks,
the sliced audio groove can be kept in sync with the Tempo,
and can play slower or faster than the original groove.

3.

Press the SOUND button to enter the Sound mode, then


press RECORD to enter the Record page.

4.

Use the Record Mode parameter to select the audio input


to be sampled.

Note: Sampling is only available on instruments with the hard


disk installed.

5.

If you can, first start the source to be recorded, then press


the Record button in the display to start recording.

Warning: When loading a .SET folder containing Sounds associated with PCM data, all existing PCM data in memory are deleted.
Save them before loading the folder, by selecting the PCM option
during a Save All operation (see Saving the full memory content
on page 265).
To see if a .SET folder contains PCM data, open it and look for a
PCM folder.
Note: When entering the Sampling mode, samples are automatically loaded from the (hidden) PCM folder on the hard disk. This
may take some time before this mode becomes operative.
Note: No sound will be heard when you first enter the Sampling
mode.
Note: Some demo audio grooves can be found on the Korg Pa1X
web site (www.korgpa.com).

As an alternative, press the Record button in the display,


and immediately start the source to be recorded.
6.

Press the Record button in the display again to stop recording. When the memory is full, the sampling automatically
stops. A maximum of 10.9 seconds is allowed for each sample.

7.

Play the keyboard to listen to the sampled sound.

8.

If you are not satisfied with the recorded sound, press the
Record button in the display again, to repeat recording.
Press Record again to stop recording. A new sample will be
automatically created.

9.

When finished sampling your sound, you can either save it,
or (if it is an audio groove) continue editing it with the
Time Slice function.
To save the sample, select the Write command from the
page menu. The Write Sample dialog box will appear (see
Write Sample dialog box on page 226). Assign a name to

Reference

Pa1X includes a full-featured sampler, with powerful tools for


creating (a) new sounds and (b) rhythm patterns, based on
audio grooves.

216

Sampling operating mode


Edit menu

the new Sample, and save it to the PCM folder on the hard
disk.
To create a series of separate percussive samples fro an
audio groove, and a MIDI Groove, go to the Time Slice
page. After creating a series of slices, use the Extend function to refine your groove. Select the Write command from
the page menu, to save the sliced samples and the MIDI
Groove to disk.
10. After saving, press the MENU button and go to the Multi-

sample section, to assign the sample(s) to a multisample.


Assign each sample to a different keyboard zone of the
multisample.

Edit menu
From any page of the Sampling mode, press the MENU button
to open the Sampling edit menu. This menu gives access to the
various Sampling edit sections.
When in the menu, select an edit section, or press EXIT to exit
the menu and return to the Sample Edit / Sample Record page.
To return to this page, you can also select the Sample Edit / Sample Record menu item.

11. When finished editing the multisample, select the Write

command from the page menu. The Write Multisample


dialog box will appear (see Write MultiSample dialog box
on page 226). Assign a name to the new multisample, and
save it to the internal memory (SSD).
12. Press RECORD to exit the Sampling mode and return to

the Sound mode.


To access the new multisample, first select an ordinary
Sound. Press MENU and go to the Basic: OSC Basic page
(see page 194). Select one of the available layers, then select
the RAM bank of multisamples. Finally, select the new
multisample.
To access the new sample(s), you must assign it to a Drum
Kit. First select a Drum Kit. Press MENU and go to the
DrumKit: Sample Setup (Drum Kits) page (see
page 195). Select a key and a layer, then select the RAM
bank of samples. Finally, select the new sample.
13. Select the Write Sound command from the page menu, and

save the Sound to an empty User location.

Each item in this menu corresponds to an edit section. Each edit


section groups various edit pages, that may be selected by pressing the corresponding tab on the lower part of the display.

Sampling: Record
This page allows you to record a 16-bit, 48kHz stereo or mono
sample.

14. Assign the new Sound to a Style track (preferably, the

Drum or Percussion track), then select the Save Current


Style Perf. command from the page menu, to save the Style
Performance.
15. If the new Sound is based on an audio groove, use the

Import: Import Groove function in the Style Record


mode (see page 121) to import the generated MIDI Groove
to the Style track you assigned the new Sound to.
Warning: Generated MIDI Grooves will be deleted when
turning the instrument off. Import them to a Style track
before turning the instrument off.

SM (Sample)
Press this area to open the Choose Sample window, and select
one of the available samples in the RAM memory for editing.

Select one of the available samples. The window will be automatically closed after selecting.

Sampling operating mode


Sampling: Edit

Level
Use these meters to see the level of the entering signal. When the
CLIP indicator turns red, the signal is too hot. Lower it by reducing the source output level, or by using the GAIN knob on the
rear panel of the Pa1X.
In case of mono sampling, only one of the indicators will work.

217

Sampling: Edit
This page allows you to cut, trim or normalize a sample, as well
as edit the loop points. The sample can played on the full keyboard.

REC Setup
Record Mode
Use this parameter to select the audio input on the back of the
instrument.
Channel 1 (L) Only the Input 1 is selected. A mono sample will
be produced.
Channel 2 (R) Only the Input 2 is selected. A mono sample will
be produced.

Both inputs will be selected. A stereo sample will


be produced.
Note: Whether you record or load a stereo or mono sample, the
sample in memory will be treated as if it was stereo (the editor is
always a stereo editor). Mono samples will be saved as mono files.
Stereo samples will be saved as two separate mono files, and will be
treated as mono files when reloaded.
Left to Sample
Non editable. Remaining memory (in samples/seconds) for sampling. The maximum space available for samples is 524,288
(mono or stereo) samples, or 10.9 seconds.
Sampled
Non editable. Used memory (in samples/seconds) for sampling.
Sampling Buffer
Non editable. Available memory (in samples/seconds) for sample
editing.

SM (Sample)
Selected sample. See SM (Sample) above.

Sample diagram
This is the graphical display of the selected sample waveform.
The area included between the Start and End points is highlighted (dark background).

Parameters
Start (Sample Start)
This is the sample start point (in samples). You may edit this
point, as well as the End point, to shorten the sample. Changing
the Sample Start cuts out the attack portion of the sound.
Note: When moving the Start point forward, the Loop Start
point is also moved forward.
Warning: When saving the edited sample (Write Sample operation), the segments exceeding the Start and End points are permanently removed.

Record button
Press this button to start recording. Press it again to stop recording. Recording will automatically stop when the maximum available space will end.
Note: Pa1X always samples at the maximum quality (16 bit,
48,000Hz). Samples of a different quality may be loaded (8 or 16
bit, 11,025Hz to 48,000Hz).

Loop Start
Note: Use the Loop On parameter on the Sampling: Loop Edit
page to turn the loop on (see page 219).
Use this parameter to adjust the Loop Start point. When you
adjust this parameter, an audible click may appear, due to a pitch
and/or level mismatch between the starting and ending points of
the loop. Move the Loop Start and Loop/Sample End point, so
that the click can no longer be heard.

Reference

Channel 1&2 (Stereo)

218

Sampling operating mode


Sampling: Loop Edit

When editing audio grooves, the Loop Start should match the
Sample Start point. This parameter usually differs from the Sample Start in ordinary sounds (i.e., a guitar, a piano, a voice).
Loop Start (L)

Loop End (E)

For example, you may have sampled an audio groove of an


exceeding length. Use the End parameter to cut the exceeding
portion at the end of the sample, and adjust the starting point of
the loop using the Start or Loop Start parameters.
Usually, checking the Snap to Zero parameter is a big help, to
avoid the loop clicks due to level mismatches.

Loop

Sampling: Loop Edit


Length
Sample Start (S)

Sample End (E)

End (Sample/Loop End)


This is the sample and loop end point (in samples). You may edit
this point, to shorten the sample.
Warning: When saving the edited sample (Write Sample operation), the segments exceeding the Start and End points are permanently removed.
Snap to Zero

The loop is a cycling portion of a sampled sound, that may


match with the whole sample. After the attack stage, most
sounds repeat the same waveform during their sustain stage. You
may adjust the Loop Start point with the Loop Start parameter, and the Loop End point (always matching the Sample End
point) using the End parameter.
This page lets you fine tune the loop points, by watching at the
Loop End and Loop Start points matching at the center of the
diagram. A good-sounding loop is shown as a continuous, nonbreaking line.

Turn this parameter on, to make all Sample and Loop Start and
End selections fall on zero-crossing points (i.e., points where the
waveform crosses the x-axis, and goes from negative to positive,
or from positive to negative values). This will make loops more
accurate, and will reduce the risk of clicks.
OrigNote (Original Note)
Original pitch of the sampled note. While this parameter means
nothing in this page, it will be useful when assigning a sample to
the multisample, to identify the original pitch of the sample.
For example, if you sample a C4, set this parameter to C4.
When the sample will be assigned to a keyboard zone of the multisample, it will be transposed (if needed) according to this
parameter, to avoid a change of the original pitch.

SM (Sample)

Zoom

Loop diagram

Use these buttons to change the size of the waveform shown in


the diagram. When a button is greyed-out, it means the maximum or minimum value has been reached.

This diagram shows the End (Loop End) point on the left half,
and the Loop Start point on the right half of the screen. Use
the End and Loop Start parameters to adjust the loop.

Selected sample. See SM (Sample) on page 216.

Increase the vertical size.

Parameters

Decrease the vertical size.

Start

Increase the horizontal size.

See Start (Sample Start) on page 217.

Decrease the horizontal size.

Loop Start
See Loop Start on page 217.

Full zoom in.


End
Full zoom out.

See End (Sample/Loop End) on page 218.

Changing the sample length and finding


good-sounding loop points

Use Zero

To adjust the sample length and loop points, check the Loop
On parameter, then use the Start, Loop Start and End
parameters to create a fine sounding cycling loop.

Loop Lock

See Snap to Zero on page 218.

This fixes the length of the loop being edited.

Sampling operating mode


Sampling: Sampling Info

Off

The Loop S. and End parameters can be


edited separately.

On

When the Loop S. or End parameter is edited,


the other one will be automatically adjusted so
that the distance between them (i.e., the loop
length) does not change. This is convenient when
you are creating a rhythm loop to match a specific tempo.

Loop On

The Crossfade Length cannot be greater than the smaller


length between the Sample Start Loop Start points, or the
Loop Start Sample End points.
Curve
Set Curve to specify how the volume will change in the crossfaded region.
Linear

The volume will change linearly.

Power

The volume will change non-linearly. Sometimes


a setting of Linear will produce the impression
that the volume has dropped in the middle of the
crossfade curve. In such cases, use Power.

Use this parameter to turn the loop on or off.


On

Off

The loop is turned on, and the portion of sound


included between the Loop Start and Loop End
points will cycle until a key is kept pressed. If the
Loop Start point matches the Start point, the
whole sample is cycled.
The loop is turned off. The sound will play from
the Sample Start to the Sample End point only
once, even if you keep a key pressed on the keyboard.

219

Sampling: Sampling Info


Use this page to see detailed info on the sample in edit. General
information for the RAM memory is also available.

Crossfade
When looping the pitched sample of a complex sound such as
strings or woodwinds to make the sound sustain, it is necessary
to create a long loop to preserve the rich character of the sound.
Crossfade Loop can be used to minimize the difference in pitch
and level between the beginning and ending of the loop region,
to create a natural-sounding loop. In order to solve such problems, Crossfade Loop causes the sound to change gradually from
the end to the beginning of the loop.

When the Loop On parameter is checked, and the Start and


Loop S. parameters have different values, the Crossfde button becomes available.
When you press the Crossfade button, the Crossfade Loop dialog
box appears:

SM (Sample)
Selected sample. See SM (Sample) on page 216.

Sampling Info
Samples
Number of samples in memory.
Drum Samples
Number of drum samples in memory.
Multisamples
Number of multisamples in memory.

Available Memory
RAM Bank 1/2

Crossfade Length
In Crossfade Length, specify the length of the sample that you
wish to crossfade. You can enter it either as the number of samples, or a percentage (%). If you set this as a percentage, the
number of samples will be calculated automatically.
If you set this to 50%, crossfade will be performed on the second
half of the region between loop start and loop end.

The Sample RAM memory is divided in two banks of 16 Megabytes (MB) each. Pa1X comes with 16MB of RAM already
installed, corresponding to Bank 1. You can install an additional
(optional) module of 16MB, corresponding to Bank 2, for a total
of 32MB.
Note: A sample cannot be split between the two banks. It must
reside on just one bank.

Reference

In practice, here is how it works. A specific length (the Crossfade Length value) of the waveform immediately before the
beginning of the loop is taken and mixed with the end portion.
At this time, the waveform level of the portion immediately
before the end (the length specified by Crossfade Length) will
gradually decrease, and the waveform level immediately before
the beginning of the loop will gradually increase as the two are
mixed.

220

Sampling operating mode


Time Slice

Mono Time
Remaining sample memory (in seconds). This value is given for
mono samples. With stereo samples, this time has to be halved.
Bytes
Remaining memory for sampling (in Bytes). This value is given
for mono samples. With stereo samples, this time has to be
halved.

Sample Info
Selected Samples
Size of the selected sample (in samples).
Samples
Total size of the samples in memory (in samples).
Sampling Frequency
Sampling frequency of the selected sample (in Hertz).

In addition to changing the grooves tempo without affecting its


pitch, this lets you do the following:

change the order in which notes are played

change the timing

edit the pattern notes to freely recreate a new rhythm loop.

Saving. After the slicing, you can select the Write command
from the page menu, to save the Sound based on sliced samples,
and the MIDI Groove containing the corresponding MIDI
sequence.
The Sound will be saved to the selected location in the User
area of the internal memory. You will be able to select it as an
ordinary Sound, and assign it to the Drum or Percussion track of
a Style.
The Multisample will be automatically saved to the next free
available location.
Samples will be permanently saved to the PCM folder on the
hard disk. They can be automatically loaded when turning the
instrument on, by checking the PCM Autoload option in Disk
mode (see page 273).

Time Slice

The MIDI Groove will be temporarily saved to the SSD memory, and will be available only when using the Import function of
the Style Record mode (see Import: Import Groove on
page 121).

The Time Slice function lets you transform a rhythm audio


groove in a series of single percussive samples, to be assigned to a
Style or Song Drum or Percussion track.

Warning: All MIDI Grooves will be delete each time the Pa1X is
turned off.

Ex.1 - Generating samples and MIDI Groove data:


Original rhythm sample
120BPM

Kick

Snare

Kick

Kick

Snare

Original pattern

Execute the Time Slice command

Some theory
Analyzing and processing. This function detects the attacks
(e.g., kick and snare) inside a rhythm audio groove (a sample
that loops a drum pattern), and automatically divides the audio
groove into individual percussive samples.

Sample1

Sample2

The divided percussive samples will be automatically assigned to


a multisample, and the multisample to a Sound.
Within the generated multisample, a separate sample is assigned
to a different note on the keyboard, starting from C#3. By playing an ascending chromatic scale with this multisample, you
could recreate the original audio groove.
A MIDI Groove will also be created, containing a sequence of
notes triggering the sliced percussive samples in the same order
as in the original audio groove (i.e., it plays an ascending chromatic scale starting from C#3).
When you will import this MIDI Groove to the percussive track
of a Style (see Import: Import Groove on page 121), this
sequence will let you adjust the grooves tempo without affecting
the pitch of the percussive samples.

Sample3

Sample4

Sample5

A multisample, a program and MIDI


Groove data will be created automatically

C3

Play in Style Play mode


120BPM

Generated MIDI Groove

Note: Sliced samples and MIDI data are saved with a Write
operation.

Sampling operating mode


Time Slice

221

Metronome Information

Ex.2 - Varying the grooves tempo


150BPM

Meter
Use this parameter to specify the Meter of the original sample.

90BPM

Played closer together,


but pitch is unchanged

Measures
Use this parameter to specify the number of measures of the
original sample. Usually, you will load a groove 1 or 2-measures
long.
BPM

Played further apart, but pitch is unchanged

Note: To vary the grooves tempo, you must first import the
generated MIDI data into the Percussion track (Import function of the Style Record mode), and assign the new generated
Sound to the Percussion track.
Gaps between sliced samples, when slowing down the tempo,
can be automatically filled by the Extend function, smoothing
each samples tail.

This parameter specifies the tempo (in Beats Per Minute) of the
original sample. Pa1X automatically calculates this value based
on the Start, End (see page 217), Meter and Measures parameters.
The BPM can be only adjusted to values lower than the one
automatically calculated. This can be useful, for example, when
the actual sample is shorter than the entered Meter and Measures values.
Meas.1

Ex.3 - Recombining MIDI notes and samples

Edit the MIDI data

Meas.2

In the above example, the actual groove lasts only up to the first
half of Measure 2. The recognized tempo is 130, while the real
tempo is 100. Set the BPM value to 100, and a rest will be added
to the end of the groove, to allow it to loop seamlessly.

Time Slice
See The Time Slice procedure on page 222 for more information.

Adjust the value of this parameter to change the number of recognized attacks, by varying the speed needed to the Slice engine
to start working again. For example, in the following example, if
the Release value is too high (i.e., too long), the second attack
may be lost:

Sample diagram
This diagram shows the sample waveform and the slices. Here is
how the sample diagram appears before the Slice:

Note: After changing the Release value, you must select the Slice
command again.
Threshold
and the same diagram after the Slice:

This parameter varies the threshold over which the attacks are
recognized (i.e., the Time Slice sensitivity). If it is too low,
weaker attacks may be ignored.
Note: After changing the Threshold value, you are not obliged to
select the Slice command again. The Slices value is immediately
changed.
Attacks
This (non-editable) parameter shows the number of attacks recognized. More than one attack may be recognized in a single
slice. Adjust the Release and Threshold parameters to change the
number of recognized attacks.

Reference

Release
Note: To recombine notes inside the generated MIDI sequence,
you must first import the MIDI data in Style Record mode, by
using the Import function. Then, use the Event Edit to
change the note order.

222

Sampling operating mode


The Time Slice procedure

Slices

Long

This option is most suitable for cymbals, whose


sound should be sustained up until the next note.
The tail envelope is sustained and falls slowly,
then falls suddenly next to the end.

This (non-editable) parameter shows the number of generated


slices, i.e. generated samples and notes in the midifile. To change
this value, edit the Release and Threshold parameters.
Note: You can have a maximum of 78 slices.
Slice button
Select this command to execute the Slice after entering the Time
Slice page, or changing the Release value. This command is
ghosted (i.e., non-selectable) if no sample has been recorded
of loaded yet.
The Time Slice operation is executed on the sample, from the
Start to the End point set in the Sample Edit / Sample
Record section.

Extend button
Press this button to execute the Extend command. After you
select it, it will return ghosted, meaning that you cant select it
again. If you change any of the parameters in this page, it will be
available again.

Extend
See The Extend procedure on page 223 for more information.

The Time Slice procedure

When using a sliced groove with a slow tempo, an annoying gap


may be heard between a sample and the following one. The
Extend function allows you to fix this problem by adding a tail
to all samples, making their decay smoother and more musical.

Before executing a Slice operation, you must record or load a


sample. Then, you may edit the sample on Sampling: Record,
then execute the Slice operation on this sample.

Before extending

1.

After recording or loading a sample, go to the Time Slice


page.

2.

Pa1X automatically calculates the BPM parameter, based


on the given Meter and Measures values. If you know these
data, set the Meter, Measures and BPM (Beats Per Minute)
parameters. This would make the slicing more accurate.

3.

Select the Slice command.

Added tail

The original sample will be sliced, and each generated sample assigned to a different key:
and after extending

Note: You can use the Extend function only after a Time Slice operation.
Note: The Extend function increases the original sample size.

C2B2: Full pattern at


a slower speed

Note: If there is not enough buffer memory, the Extend function


may not work. If this happens, please decrease the By value.
By
Use this parameter to set the length of the tail added to the
samples (in percentage). The higher this value, the greater the
size of the samples. A setting of 20-30% is usually suitable to
most grooves.
Mode
This parameter specifies if the added tail must decay in a linear
way, or sustain for a longer time and then fall suddenly.
Normal

This option is most suitable for percussive sound


with a short (but not immediate) decay. The
tail envelope is linear, and the level decays fast.

Separate sliced samples


C3: Full pattern at
the original speed

Key

Assigned sample/pattern

Speed %

C2

Full pattern cycling at half the speed

50%

C#2

53%

D2

56%

D#2

60%

E2

63%

F2

67%

F#2

Full pattern cycling at various speeds

71%

G2

75%

G#2

80%

A2

84%

A#2

89%

B2

94%

C3

Full pattern cycling at the original speed

C#3 and
above

Separate sliced samples

100%

Sampling operating mode


The Extend procedure

4.

To test the single sliced samples, play notes from C#3 and
above. If you play a full chromatic scale, the original pattern will be sounded.
Hint: If too many samples have been generated, and the keyboard cant fit them all, use the OCTAVE buttons to transpose
the keyboard, and listen to samples exceeding the upper limit.

6.

Set the By parameter, according to the tempo of the groove


you will use. If you will slow down the groove very much,
assign higher values to this parameter, otherwise you may
assign lower values.

2.

Select the Extend Mode. Long is more suitable for cymbals.

3.

Select the Extend command.

4.

After the Extend operation is complete, test the full pattern


at different speed, by playing notes from C2 (half speed) to
C3 (original speed). See table on page 222.

5.

If the Extend didnt produce satisfactory results, change the


settings. Any previously made change will be deleted.

6.

When the Extend is completed, you can save the sliced and
extended samples and the resulting MIDI Groove to the
internal memory.

If the Slice didnt produce satisfactory results, adjust the


Release parameter. If this does not produces good results,
try adjusting the Threshold parameter, too. After adjusting
the Release parameter, you must execute the Time Slice
again.

Select the Write command from the page menu. The Write
Slice dialog box will appear (see Write Slice dialog box on
page 227). Assign a name to the new Sound, and save it to
an User Sound location.

Since a tempo value rounding happens when making a


Time Slice operation, and the loop may not be accurate,
you may need to adjust both the Start and End parameters of the Sampling: Edit page, to make the groove loop
flawlessly. After editing these parameters, you must execute
the Time Slice again.
Go on experimenting different settings! Editing an audio
groove is a pure matter of experimentation.

7.

1.

Test the generated sliced drum kit on the keyboard.


To test the full pattern at different speed, play a note from
C2 (half speed) to C3 (original speed). See table above.

5.

The Extend procedure

When the Slice is completed, you can save the sliced samples and the MIDI Groove to disk, or use the Extend function to improve the quality of the slices.
Select the Write command from the page menu. The Write
Slice dialog box will appear (see Write Slice dialog box on
page 227). Assign a name to the new Sound, and save it to
an User Sound location.
A MIDI Groove with the same name will also be saved to a
reserved area of the internal memory. Be warned, that this
area will be deleted when turning the instrument off. Convert it to an internal Style pattern, by using the Import
function of the Style Record mode, before turning the
instrument off.
To improve the quality of the slices, use the Extend function (see Extend below).

8.

After saving, you may press RECORD to exit the Sampling


mode.

9.

After exiting the Sampling mode, you may load the generated MIDI Groove by using the Import function of the
Style Record mode (see Import: Import Groove on
page 121 for more information).

A MIDI Groove with the same name will also be saved to a


reserved area of the internal memory. Be warned, that this
area will be deleted when turning the instrument off. Convert it to an internal Style pattern, by using the Import
function of the Style Record mode, before turning the
instrument off.
7.

After saving, you may press RECORD to exit the Sampling


mode.

8.

After exiting the Sampling mode, you may load the generated MIDI Groove by using the Import function of the
Style Record mode (see Import: Import Groove on
page 121 for more information).

Multisample: Edit MS
The Multisample is a way of organizing several samples on the
keyboard. Each sample is assigned to a Keyboard Zone (or
Index), with a higher and a lower limit.
A Multisample is then assigned to a Sound (see Basic: OSC
Basic on page 194), where it is enriched with several performance parameters, like Amplitude Envelope, LFO, Filters, etc

Reference

A MIDI Groove with the original pattern will also be


generated. The screen will change, to show slices separated by vertical lines:

223

224

Sampling operating mode


Multisample: Key Assign

MS (MultiSample)
Press this area to open the Choose Multisample window, and
select one of the available multisamples in memory.

Keyboard diagram

Multisample: Key Assign


Use this page to see and edit the samples assigned to each Keyboard Range/Index in the multisample. This page gives a better
display of the assigned samples and their range on the keyboard.

This diagram shows the selected Index/Zone (highlighted), and


its Original Note (in red). Use the big and + button on its
side to scroll the diagram one octave lower or upper.

Multisample Setup

Sample list

Index
Index number of the selected Zone of the multisample / total
number of Zones in the multisample. A Zone always corresponds to a single sample.
Sample Number / Name
Number / name of the sample assigned to the selected zone of
the multisample.
Original Note
Use this parameter to automatically transpose the assigned sample, to make it sound at the right pitch. It should match to the
OrigNote (Original Note) value assigned when editing the
sample (see page 218).
Level

Keyboard ranges

MS (MultiSample)
See MS (MultiSample) on page 224.

Sample list
List of samples assigned to the selected multisample. Use the big
button with an arrow on top and to the bottom of the list to
scroll the list up or down.

Relative level of the selected zone.


Pitch
Fine tuning of the selected sample in cents (1 cent = 1/100 of a
semitone).
From To
Range of the selected Zone (or Index).

Buttons
Insert
Press this button to create a new zone (Index) after the selected
one.
Add
Press this button to add a new zone (Index) after the last one.
Delete
Press this button to delete the selected Zone/Index.

Keyboard ranges
Next to each sample name the low and high Zone limits appear.
Edit these values to change the Zone range. The Original Note is
shown in red.

Sampling operating mode


Page menu

225

Load Sample

Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.

Write
Select this command to open the Write Sample, Write Multisample or Write Slice dialog box (depending on the page you are in),
and save the sample(s) to the hard disk (PCM folder), and the
multisample(s) or the Sound generated by the Time Slice function to the internal memory (SSD).
See Write Sample dialog box on page 226, Write MultiSample
dialog box on page 226, or Write Slice dialog box on page 227
for more information.
Delete
Select this command to delete one or all samples and multisamples from memory.
See Delete Sample dialog box on page 227, or Delete Multisample dialog box on page 227 for more information.
Normalize

Use this command to load single samples (mono or stereo), in


KSF, AIFF or WAVE format.
Warning: By loading new samples, all samples in RAM are deleted.
Before loading, use the Write command to save older samples to
disk.

The samples are loaded to the RAM memory. Before leaving the
Sampling mode, use the Write command to save samples to the
hard disk (PCM folder) as New Samples.

KSF is Korgs native sample format, used by the Trinity


and Triton series of workstations, as well as the Pa-series
arrangers. The file name must have the .KSF extension.

S1 is Akai S1000, and S3 is S3000 native sample format.

AIFF is the Apple Macintosh preferred format for


audio. The file name must have the .AIF extension.

WAVE is the Microsoft Windows preferred format for


audio. The file name must have the .WAV extension.

Note: Akai data can only be imported from CD.


Note: You can only load samples in a 8 or 16-bit resolution, and a
sampling frequency rate from 11,025 to 48,000Hz. Loaded samples
always preserve their original resolution.

Select this command to automatically rescale the level of the


selected sample. Peaks will be raised to -0dB (i.e., maximum volume before clipping), while the remaining parts of the sample
will be proportionally raised.

Note: If the sample exceeds the maximum size allowed by the Pa1X
(524,288 samples, either mono or stereo), it will be truncated.

Normalization optimizes the samples level relative to other samples, making all samples sound more uniformly. It also helps
optimizing signal/noise ratio, by preventing further stages of
amplification from increasing any residual noise.

Use the Import command to import sounds, multisamples and


samples from non-native (i.e., non-Korg) formats.

Import

Cut
Select this command to cut the selected part of the sample
(inside the Start and End points).
Trim/Crop
Select this command to cut all parts of the sample out of the
selected range (i.e., out of the Start and End points).
Select All

With this command, you can import the following formats:

Use this command to select the whole sample.

PCG is Korgs native Program format, used by the Trinity


and Triton series of workstations. The file name must have
the .PCG extension

KMP is Korgs native multisample format, used by the


Trinity and Triton series of workstations. The file name
must have the .KMP extension.

Init Multisample
Only available in the Multisample page. Select this command to
create a new, blank multisample. Only one Zone will be available, with no sample assigned.

Reference

Page menu

226

Sampling operating mode


Write Sample dialog box

P is Akai S1000 and S3000 native Program format


(including the sample key assignation, or multisample).

Write Sample dialog box

Note: Akai data can only be imported from CD.


Imported Sounds and Multisamples are stored in the internal
SSD memory, that cannot be deleted when turning the instrument off.
Imported Samples are stored in RAM, and are deleted when
turning the instrument off. Before turning the instrument off,
save them to disk by selecting the Write command from the page
menu while in any page of the Sample Edit / Sample Record section.

Open this dialog box by selecting the Write command from the
page menu, while in the Sample Edit / Sample Record section. In
this dialog box you can save the sample to disk, inside the (hidden) PCM folder. Please always remember to save PCM samples
into a .SET folder, before turning the instrument off, or before
loading or recording new samples.

To automatically load samples when turning the instrument on,


check the PCM Autoload function in Disk mode (see
page 273). To load samples after turning the instrument on,
press the Load PCM button in the same page (see page 273).
Note: While Pa1X and Triton share most of their internal multisamples, some of them may differ. While reading a PCG file, Pa1X
tries to use exactly the same multisamples as in Triton. If this is not
possible, it looks for a similar multisample. If this too is not possible, an <empty> multisample will be selected. Enter the Sound Edit
mode, and select a multisample suitable for the imported Program.
Note: Not all Tritons PCG data are imported. Insert FX, EQ,
Arpeggio, Combi, Global and Drum Kit data are not loaded.
Note: You cannot import Drum Kits.

To assign a different name to the sample, press the


Edit) button to open the Text Edit window.

Select an option to select a memory location where to save the


sample:

Select Save as a new Sample to save to a new location.

Select Save to to overwrite an existing location. Warning:


The older sample at the same location will be deleted!

Note: Pa1X cannot read multisamples saved on more than a single


floppy disk.
Note: Multisample may contain many different samples. They are
assigned to the same keys as in the original file.
Hint: When importing a KMP file, take note of the selected multisample name; you will need it in Sound Edit mode, when assigning
the multisample to a new Sound.
Export
Depending on wheter you are in the Sample Edit / Sample
Record or Multiample section, this command allows you to
export a sample in one of two popular computer audio file formats, or a multisample in a Korg .KMP file.
See Export Sample dialog box on page 228, or Export Multisample dialog box on page 228 for more information.

(Text

Write MultiSample dialog box


Open this dialog box by selecting the Write command from the
page menu, while in the Multisample section. In this dialog box
you can save the multisample to the internal memory (SSD).
Multisamples are a way to organize samples on the keyboard,
and are used by Sounds as their basis.
Note: Multisamples are maintained in memory even when turning
the instrument off, but the associated samples are not. To automatically reload them to the RAM memory when turning the instrument on, check the PCM Autoload parameter in the Disk mode
(see page 273).

Exit from Record


Choose this command to exit from the Sampling mode.

To assign a different name to the multisample, press the


(Text Edit) button to open the Text Edit window.
Select an option to select a memory location where to save the
sample:

Select Save as a new MultiSample to save to a new location.

Select Save to to overwrite an existing location. Warning:


The older multisample at the same location will be deleted!

Sampling operating mode


Write Slice dialog box

227

Write Slice dialog box

Delete Sample dialog box

Open this dialog box by selecting the Write command from the
page menu, while in the Time Slice page. In this dialog box you
can save the Sound, sliced Samples and Multisample generated
by the Time Slice function, together with the generated MIDI
Groove.

Open this dialog box by selecting the Delete command from the
page menu, while you are in any page of the Sample Edit/Sample
Record section.

The Sound will be saved to the selected User bank location in the
internal, non-volatile memory (SSD). The Multisample will be
saved to a free location in the internal memory (SSD). Samples
will be saved in the PCM folder on the hard disk.
Note: The MIDI Groove is automatically saved in a reserved, temporary location on disk, and is automatically deleted when turning
the instrument off. So, import it (by using the Import: Import
Groove function in Style Record mode, see page 121), before turning the instrument off.

Select Selected, and select a sample number, to delete just


one of the samples from memory.

Select Not assigned to any Multisample/Drumkit to


delete only samples not yet assigned to a multisample or
drumkit (see paragraphs on the Multisample section,
starting from page 198).

Warning: The older Sound at the target location will be deleted!

Note: Use this option with care, since you may delete samples
you would like to preserve, that have not yet been assigned to
a multisample or drumkit. Use it only when you are sure all
desired samples have been assigned to a multisample or
drumkit.

Name
(Text

Sound Bank
Target bank of Sounds. Each bank corresponds to one of the
PERFORMANCE/SOUND buttons. Use TEMPO/VALUE controls to select a different bank.

Delete Multisample dialog box


Open this dialog box by selecting the Delete command from the
page menu, while you are in any page of the Multisample section.

Sound
Target Sound location in the selected bank. Use TEMPO/VALUE
controls to select a different location.
Select button
Press this button to open the Sound Select window, and select a
target location.

Select Selected, and select a multisample number, to


delete just one of the multisamples from memory.
Check the Delete Unassigned Samples option, to also
delete all samples not assigned to a multisample.
Note: Use this option with care, since you may delete samples
you would like to preserve, that have not yet been assigned to
a multisample or drumkit. Use it only when you are sure all
desired samples have been assigned to a multisample or
drumkit.

Select MultiSamples to delete all multisamples. No samples will be deleted, including those associated with the
deleted multisamples.

Reference

To assign a different name to the Sound, press the


Edit) button to open the Text Edit window.

Select All Samples, Multisamples, Drum Samples to


delete all samples, multisamples and drum samples from
memory. This operation completely resets the RAM, and
may be used to clean-up any trouble.

228

Sampling operating mode


Export Sample dialog box

Select All Samples, Multisamples, Drum Samples to


delete all samples, multisamples and drum samples from
memory. This operation completely resets the RAM, and
may be used to clean-up any trouble.

Export Sample dialog box

Export Multisample dialog box


Open this dialog box by selecting the Export command from the
page menu, while you are in any page of the Multisample section.

Open this dialog box by selecting the Export command from the
page menu, while you are in any page of the Sample Edit/Sample
Record section.

Original Name
Name of the sample being exported.
File Name
Name of the generated file on disk.
File Type
Either of the file types you can choose as the file format.
WAV

Microsoft Wave format, very common on Windows PCs.

AIFF

Apples Audio Interchange File Format, standard


on the Macintosh.

By using this function, you can export from the internal memory the multisample in edit in the Multisample section, and all
linked samples. The Export operation generates a .KMP file
(Korgs proprietary file format for multisamples), and a folder
containing a series of .KSF files (Korgs proprietary file format
for samples) inside the same directory.
Note: You cannot export a multisamples on more than a single
floppy disk. You can, however, export files of any size on the hard
disk.
Note: When exporting a stereo multisample, be careful to assign a
different name to the Left and Right channel files, to avoid overwriting. A -L and -R suffix is usually added after the name of
this kind of files.

Global edit mode


What is it, and how the Global is structured

229

Global edit mode


The Global edit environment is the place where you can set global functions, i.e. functions overriding the single Performance,
STS or Style. This edit environment overlaps the current operating mode (Style Play, Song Play, Sequencer, Sound Edit).

What is it, and how the Global is structured


The Global is a file that can be written to memory (and may subsequently be saved to disk), containing global parameters for the
whole instrument or each single operating mode.

Edit menu
From any page of the Global mode, press the MENU button to
open the Global edit menu. This menu gives access to the various Global edit sections.
When in the menu, select an edit section, or press EXIT to exit
the Global mode.
When in a page, press EXIT to go back to current operating
mode in the background (Style Play, Song Play, Sequencer,
Sound).

Global parameters can be written to memory by selecting the


various Write Global commands from the page menus
each dedicated to one of the areas of the Global file. They can be
saved to disk by using the ordinary Disk operations.
Note: Saving or loading a .SET folder also saves or loads the Global file. Parameter changing may be avoided by turning the Lock on
for any single parameter (or groups of parameters in the Lock page
of the Global mode, see General Controls: Lock on page 232).
There are separate areas in the Global file, that may be separately
written to memory, to avoid writing all global parameters at
once when not needed:

Global Setup, containing global parameters not linked to


any single operating mode.

Each item in this menu corresponds to an edit section. Each edit


section groups various edit pages, that may be selected by pressing the corresponding tab on the lower part of the display.

Style Play Setup, containing global parameters for the Style


Play mode, not linked to the single Performance, STS or
Style.

Note: The Global mode is not available while in Record mode


(Style Record, Song Record, Sampling).

Song Play Setup, containing global parameters for the Song


Play mode, not linked to the single Song.

Sequencer Setup, containing global parameters for the


Sequencer mode, not linked to the single Song.

Disk Preferences, containing preferences for the Disk


mode.

MIDI Setup, containing the available MIDI Setups, i.e., settings for MIDI communication.

Voice Processor Setup, containing lead voice setups for the


Voice Processor.

Voice Processor Presets, containing single presets for the


Voice Processor.

All edit pages share some basic elements.


Edit mode

Edit section

Page menu
icon

Parameters
area

Main page
Tabs

There is no main page in the Global edit mode. When pressing


EXIT, you exit the Global mode, and the underlying operating
mode in the background is recalled.

Edit mode
This indicates that the instrument is in Global mode.
Edit section
This identifies the current edit section, corresponding to one of
the items of the edit menu (see Edit menu on page 229).

Reference

Edit page structure

230

Global edit mode


General Controls: Basic

Page menu icon

+50

Press this icon to open the page menu (see Page menu on
page 257).

Reverb Offset

Parameters area
Each page contains various parameters. Use the tabs to select
one of the available pages. For detailed information on the various types of parameters, see sections starting from page 230.
Tabs
Use tabs to select one of the edit pages of the current edit section.

General Controls: Basic


This page contains various general parameters, setting the status
of the keyboard, the fade in/out, and the accelerando/ritardando.

Highest pitch.
Gbl

This is the master offset for all reverbs. Use it to adjust reverb
tails to the room where you are playing. Use negative values
when you are in a very reverberant room, positive values if the
room is too dry.
By using this global control, you are not obliged to change the
reverb time in each single Performance, STS, Style Performance,
or Song.
-50

Less reverb.

Standard reverb.

+50

More reverb.

Fade In/Out Time


These parameters allows you to set the speed for the Fade In/Out
function.
Fade In Time

Gbl

Time for a full fade in (from zero to maximum volume), after


you press the FADE IN/OUT button.
520

Fade time (in seconds).

Fade Out Time

Gbl

Time for a full fade out (from maximum volume to zero), after
you press the FADE IN/OUT button.
520

Keyboard Settings
Velocity Curve

Accelerando/Ritardando
Gbl

This parameter sets the sensitivity of the keyboard to your touch.


Fix

No dynamic control available. Dynamic values


are fixed, as in a classic organ.

Soft1 Hard3
Curves, from the lightest one to the hardest one.
A.Touch Curve

Fade time (in seconds).

Gbl

This parameter sets the sensitivity of the keyboard to the pressure you apply after first pressing a key.

These parameters lets you adjust the speed of the Accelerando


and Ritardando functions.
Step
Speed of the Tempo change (from 1 to 6). With higher values,
the step change is greater, and the speed will change faster. With
lower values, the step change is smaller, and the speed will
change more slowly.
Curve
Accelerando/ritardando curves (from 1 to 3). Experiment the
various options, to see the one that best fit your taste.

Soft1 Hard2

Glide

Curves, from the lightest to the hardest.


Off

Glide is a function you can assign to a footswitch. When the


pedal is pressed, affected notes on Upper tracks are bent down,
according to settings for the Pitch Bend on the same tracks.
When the pedal is released, notes return to the normal pitch, at
the speed defined by the Time parameter.

The aftertouch is turned off.

Global Tuning/Reverb
Master Tuning

Gbl

This is the master tuning of the instrument (in cents of a semitone). Use it to adapt your keyboard tuning to an acoustic
instrument, for example an acoustic piano.
-50

Lowest pitch.

Standard pitch (A4=440Hz).

To change Pitch Bend values for each Upper track, see the PB
Sensitivity parameter in the Style Play mode (see page 86)
Time
Time needed to notes affected by the Glide to return to the normal pitch.

Global edit mode


General Controls: Transpose Control

231

Post-KB/Pre-Scale

General Controls: Transpose Control

When this option is selected, notes will be transposed immediately after they leave the keyboard.
The Scale will be applied to the transposed notes.
For example, if you altered an E, and then set the
Master Transpose to +1, the E key will play F, and
the altered key will be E (that will play an altered
E).

This page is where you can select to which tracks the Master
Transpose is applied to, and adjust some related parameter.

Transpose

Scale

Tone
generator

Post-KB & Scale


When this option is selected, all notes are transposed immediately before they enter the internal
tone generator, or are sent to the MIDI OUT, but
after the Scale. For example, if you altered an E,
and set the Master Transpose to +1, the altered
key will still be E (that will play an altered F).

Transpose Control
Transpose applies to Style and Kbd tracks

Scale

Gbl

Transpose

Tone
generator

Use this parameter to turn the Master Transpose on or off, and


define the way it is applied, to Style and Keyboard tracks.
Off

No Master Transpose is applied to Style and Keyboard tracks.

In Sync

When you press either the TRANSPOSE [] or []


buttons, the new transpose setting will not take
effect until the first beat of the next measure is
reached. Keyboard tracks sounding at the time of
the transpose will be stopped.

This page lets you select the main (or basic) scale of the instrument.

When you press either the TRANSPOSE [] or []


buttons, the new transpose setting will occur
when the next note is played for both the Style
and Keyboard tracks individually. (Note that any
note playing from the Keyboard tracks will be
stopped when you press the TRANSPOSE button).
The next key or chord you press will sound with
the new transpose setting applied. (Note that if
you play a Keyboard track prior to a new chord,
the Keyboard track will play in the new key as the
Style will continue to play in the old key until a
new chord is entered).

Transpose applies to Sequencer 1/2

Gbl

Reference

In Realtime

General Controls: Scale

Main Scale

This parameter sets the main scale (or temperament) for the
whole instrument, apart for tracks where a different sub-scale
has been selected by a Performance or STS (see Scale Mode on
page 95, Style Play mode).

This flag lets you turn the Master Transpose on or off for the two
onboard Sequencers.

See Scales on page 382 for a list of available scales.

Transpose applies to Midi In notes

Key

Gbl

This flag lets you turn the Master Transpose on or off for Note
messages received from MIDI IN.

Position
Scale and Transpose position
The Scale and Transpose Position allows you to define the relation between the Scale and the Master Transpose.

Gbl

Note: You cannot select a User scale in Global mode.


Gbl

This parameter is needed by some scales to set the preferred key


(see Scales on page 382).

232

Global edit mode


General Controls: Lock

General Controls: Lock


This page, split in four panes that can be selected by means of
the correspodning side tabs, contains all the available locks,
sometimes grouped under just a single lock. Locks prevent
parameter values to be changed when loading data from disk, or
selecting a different Performance, Style or STS.

Locks

Gbl

All the available locks. Lock them to prevent changes due to


loading or selecting different elements. These locks are also
found in various other pages, next to the locked parameter.
Hint: To save the status of the various parameters as a fixed status
for the Pa1X, save all the parameters to Performance 1 of bank 1
(automatically selected when turning on the instrument), and save
these locks to the Global.
Master Transpose
When locked, master transpose is not automatically changed when selecting a different Performance or style.
(See Master transpose on page 78).
Style Performance Master Transpose Lock
When closed, this lock prevents a Style change to
modify the Master Transpose. When open,
changing a Style may also change the Master
Transpose.

LockTuning pane

(See Master transpose on page 78).


Hint: In order to avoid having the Master Transpose setting change when selecting a new Performance or STS, use the general Master Transpose
Lock (the first parameter in this page).
Note: When the Master Transpose Lock is closed,
this parameter has no effect. However, the Master
Transpose Lock also locks the Style Performance
Transpose.
Sub Scale/Quarter Tone
When locked, selecting a Performance or STS will
not change the Sub-Scale or Quarter Tone value.

LockControl pane

(See Sub-Scale panel on page 83).


Auto Octave

This lock lets you decide if the instrument will


automatically transpose the Upper tracks when
switching between the FULL UPPER and the
SPLIT Keyboard modes.
If On, when switching to the FULL UPPER or
SPLIT Keyboard Mode, the Upper tracks transposition is left unchanged.
If Off, when switching to the FULL UPPER Keyboard Mode, the Upper tracks Octave Transpose
is automatically set to 0. When switching to the
SPLIT Keyboard Mode, the Upper tracks Octave
Transpose is automatically set to -1.

LockFX & Voice Processor pane

Assignable Switches
When locked, selecting a Performance or STS will
not change the Assignable Switch assignment.
(See Pad/Switch:
page 94).
Slider Mode

Assignable

Switch

on

When locked, selecting a Performance or STS will


not change the selected status of the SLIDER
MODE button.
(See Assignable Sliders A 1-8, B 1-8 on
page 235).

LockStyle pane

Global edit mode


General Controls: Lock

Note: If effects associated to the selected Sound are


not compatible with effects already assigned to the
CD FX block, C and/or D Send values on the other
Keyboard tracks will be automatically set to zero.

When locked, selecting a Performance or STS will


not change the split point.
(See Split Point on page 83).

Pad

When locked, selecting a Performance or STS will


not change the Pad assignment.

For example, assume a chorus effect is assigned to


the D effect processor. If the new Sound assigns a
distortion effect to the D effect processor, the D Send
value on the Upper 2, Upper 3, and Lower tracks
will be set to zero, to avoid these tracks sound in the
wrong way. This way, the Upper 1 track (usually
the most important one for solo playing) will sound
with the needed effect, while the other Keyboard
tracks will just sound dry.

(See Pad/Switch: Pad on page 94).


Lower

When this lock is closed, the Lower track remains


unchanged when a different Style, Performance
or STS is selected.
This is useful if, for example, you prefer to always
play with the left hand muted and reserved only
to playing chords for the arranger.
Hint: If you want the same Lower settings to be
used during all your shows, save your preferred
Lower settings to Performance 1-1 (automatically
selected on startup), then close this lock and choose
the Write Global-Global Setup from the page
menu.

Keyboard Mode/Chord Scanning

Style Preferences
When locked, selecting a Performance or STS will
not change the value of parameters contained in
the Style Preferences pages.
(See Preferences: Style Preferences on page 95,
and Preferences: Global Setup on page 96).
Bass Inversion

When this lock is closed, the Keyboard Mode and


Chord Scanning remain unchanged when a different Performance or STS is selected.

When locked, selecting a Performance or STS will


not change the Bass Inversion status.

This is useful if, for example, you prefer to always


play in Full Keyboard, with chords recognized on
the whole keyboard range.

Manual Bass When locked, selecting a Performance or STS will


not change the Manual Bass status.

Note: The Keyboard Mode and Chord Scanning


settings are reset when switching to a different operating mode.
Hint: If you want the same Keyboard Mode and
Lower Scanning settings to be used during all your
shows, save your preferred settings to Performance
1-1 (automatically selected on startup), then close
this lock and choose the Write Global-Global
Setup from the page menu.
Voice Processor Preset
When locked, selecting a Performance or STS will
not change the Voice Processor Preset.
(See VP Preset on page 82).
Upper 1 FXs In Sound mode, you can assign a Sound two
effects (FX1 and FX2). When you assign a new
Sound to the Upper 1 track, the FX1 and FX2 settings saved with that Sound can be automatically
selected, overriding Performance/STS settings for
this track. Whether Sound or Performance/STS
effect parameters will be considered, depends on
the status of this lock.
If the Upper 1 FX Lock is turned on, when
assigning a new Sound to the Upper 1 track, Performance/STS parameters are left untouched;
selected effects, and FX Send values, are not
changed.
If the Upper 1 FX Lock is turned off, when
assigning a new Sound to the Upper 1 track,
Sound parameters are considered; selected
effects, and FX Send values, are changed according to the Sounds stored data.

(See BASS INVERSION on page 9).

(See MANUAL BASS on page 9).


Fill Mode

When locked, the selected Fill Mode will not


change when selecting a different Performance or
Style.
(See Fill Mode (13) on page 93).

Style Element When locked, selecting a different Style does not


cause selecting a different Style Element.
Style Tracks Play/Mute Lock
When closed, this lock prevents a Style or Performance change to modify the Play/Mute status of
the Style tracks. This way, you can, for example,
turn the bass track off during a whole show, to
allow your bassist to play it live. Also, you could
mute all Acc tracks, to only play with the Drum
and Bass tracks.
(See Track status icons on page 82).
Style Tracks Volume
When this lock is closed, the volume of the Style
tracks remains unchanged when a different Style
or Performance is selected.
This is useful if you create your own Styles, and
like to dynamically adjust the volume by using
the sliders as a mixer. It is not recommended with
Factory Styles, each one already mixed at its best
right at the factory.

Reference

Split Point

233

234

Global edit mode


General Controls: Interface

Track Activity

General Controls: Interface

Show Track Activity


This page contains parameters related to the way messages are
shown in the display.

Gbl

Use this parameter to turn on/off the Track Activity display.


When it is turned on, you can monitor events coming from the
tracks or the MIDI inputs. Incoming events are shown by the
changing color of each tracks label.

Here is the list of colors and their meaning:

Help/Message Language
Language

Gbl

Use this pop-up menu to select one of the available languages for
the online help system. Operating System version 2.0 supports
the English, French, German, Italian and Spanish languages.

Data coming from the MIDI IN ports.

Light Blue

Internal data, generated by the keyboard, pads,


the Arranger or one of the Sequencers.

Grey

Either internally or externally generated data (or


both at the same time).

Dark Blue

No data received.

Acc/Seq Slider
Acc/Seq Slider

Change button
Press this button to apply the selected language to the users
interface.
How to select the Help language
1.

Red

Since Pa1X must be reset at the end of this procedure, be


sure to first save all unsaved data.

2.

While in this page, select a language from the pop-up


menu.

3.

The Change button will start flashing in red. Press it.

4.

You will be asked if you want to save the Global, and select
the new language. Press Yes to confirm. The Global will be
automatically saved, and the language selected.

5.

A message will advice you to reboot the Pa1X. Press OK to


close the message window.

6.

Turn the Pa1X off, then on again.

Gbl

The ACC/SEQ VOLUME slider on the control panel can control


the volume of all Style or Song tracks, while leaving Keyboard
and Pad tracks unchanged, or act as a balance control, mixing
between the Keyboard and the Style or Song tracks.
Acc/Seq Volume
Choose this option to make the ACC/SEQ VOLUME slider control the volume of all Style or
Song tracks, while leaving Keyboard and Pad
tracks unchanged.
Acc/Seq-RealTime Balance
Choose this option to make the ACC/SEQ VOLUME slider act as a balance control, mixing
between the Keyboard and the Style or Song.
These functions are respectively called Style/RT
Track Balance and Song/RT Track Balance.

Auto Select
Program Change
Show Program Change number

Gbl

Program Change display next to Sound names can be turned on


or off, to make the interface less cluttered with data.
Check this parameter to show Program Change numbers next to
Sound names in the main page of the Style Play and Song Play
operating modes, and in the various Single Track Info areas.
Note: Program Change numbers are always shown in Sound Edit
mode.

Auto Style Select


Auto Performance/Sound Select

Gbl
Gbl

When one of these parameters is checked, the last selected Style,


Performance or Sound selected in a bank is immediately selected
when pressing the bank button.
This way, you can assign your preferred Style, Performance or
Sound to each control panels button, and select it just with a
single press.
However, the Style/Perf/Sound Select window still appears when
you press one of the bank buttons, so you can select a different
item if desired.
Note: Unless you save your settings by means of the Write GlobalAuto Select Setup page menu command, the memorized Style,

Global edit mode


Controllers: Pedal/Switch

Performance or Sound is reset to the first one in each bank, when


turning the instrument off and then on again.
Hint: You can save your preferred Performances into the first location of each bank. This way, by turning on this parameter, you will
select your preferred Performance at the touch of a single button.
Also note that, by turning the Factory Style and Pad Protect an
Factory Sound Protect2 parameters off, you can do the same with
the Styles and Sounds.

235

Controllers: Assignable Sliders


This page lets you program the Assignable Sliders. Two sets are
available (Assignable Sliders A and Assignable Sliders B). You
can assign the preferred set by using the SLIDER MODE button
on the control panel, respectively selecting the ASSIGNABLE A
or ASSIGNABLE B mode. The status of the SLIDER MODE button can be saved with the Performance or STS.

Controllers: Pedal/Switch

See page 378 for a list of the assignable functions. The first functions are switch-type functions, while the remaining (starting
from Master Volume) are continuous-like functions.

Continuous pedal, or footswitch, connected to the ASSIGNABLE PDL/SW connector.

See List of Assignable Pedal and Assignable Sliders functions


on page 379 for a list of the assignable functions. The first functions are switch-type functions, while the remaining (starting
from Master Volume) are continuous-like functions. Only continuous functions can be assigned to the sliders.

Damper Polarity

Assignable Sliders A 1-8, B 1-8

Pedal/Footswitch

Gbl

Gbl

Polarity of the Damper pedal.


Pedal/Switch Polarity
Polarity of the Assignable pedal or footswitch.

Gbl

Function assigned to the corresponding slider on the control


panel.
Gbl

Reference

This page lets you select a function to the Assignable Pedal/Footswitch, and select the polarity for the Damper and Assignable
Pedal/Footswitch.

236

Global edit mode


Controllers: EC5

For detailed information on MIDI Setup settings, see MIDI


Setup on page 328.

Controllers: EC5
This page lets you program each of the five switches of the
KORG EC5 multiswitch controller.

Note: After selecting a MIDI Setup, you can apply any changes to
each channels settings. To store the changes in memory, select the
Write Global-Midi Setup command in the page menu to save it to
memory (see Write Global - Midi Setup dialog box on page 257).
Hint: To restore the original MIDI Setups, load the original Factory data again (downloadable from www.korgpa.com).

Note to RX Noise
RX Noises are special sounds that make Sounds be more realistic. They are usually located above C7, depending on the Sound.
Enable

See List of Footswitch and EC5 functions on page 378 for a list
of the assignable functions. The first functions are switch-type
functions, while the remaining (starting from Master Volume)
are continuous-like functions. Only switch functions can be
assigned to the EC5 switches.

When this parameter is turned on, notes received from MIDI in


the RX Noises range are recognized. When off, notes are not
received.
Note: This parameter is automatically turned off when turning the
instrument on again.

General Controls

EC5-AE

Gbl

Use these parameters to set MIDI Clock, Local Off, and MIDI
OUT ports.

Each of the switches of a KORG EC5 multiswitch.

Mid

Clock Send

MIDI: MIDI Setup / General Controls

Use this parameter to turn the clock information on the MIDI


OUT on or off. This parameter is common to all MIDI Setups.

This page allows you to select a MIDI Setup, convert ordinary


notes to RX Noises, and set global parameters for the MIDI
communication.

Note: In Song Play mode, only the Sequencer 1 Tempo value will be
sent to the MIDI OUT.
Off

The Pa1X cannot send the MIDI Clock signal.


You cannot slave another instrument to the Pa1X,
even when connected to the MIDI OUT.

On

The Pa1X can send the MIDI Clock signal. You


can slave another instrument to the Pa1X Tempo,
Start/Stop and Play/Stop commands. Connect
the other instrument to the Pa1X MIDI OUT
port.

Clock Source
This parameter selects the MIDI Clock source for the Style Play
and Sequencer modes.
Note: In Song Play mode, the Internal clock is always used.

Current MIDI Setup


MIDI Setup

Sty

Sng

Seq

MIDI channels can be automatically configured by selecting a


MIDI Setup. Each of them lets you assign the best values to various MIDI parameters, to allow an easier connection with a particular MIDI controller. See MIDI on page 280 for more
information on using MIDI Setups.

Note: The Clock parameter is always set to Internal each time


you turn the instrument on.
Internal

Internal, i.e. the clock generated by the Pa1X


Sequencer 1 internal metronome.

MIDI A

External from MIDI IN A. In Style Play or


Sequencer mode, the Pa1X is slaved to an external
device, connected to its MIDI IN port. The Start/
Stop and Play/Stop commands, as well as the
metronome tempo, cannot be selected from the
control panel of the Pa1X. Use the external device
to set the tempo and start or stop the sequencer
or arranger.

MIDI B

As above, but referred to MIDI IN B.

A different MIDI Setup may be automatically selected when


entering the Style Play, Song Play or Sequencer modes. To select
a MIDI Setup for these modes, see Midi Setup on page 96 for
the Style Play mode, Midi Setup on page 153 for the Song Play
mode, and Midi Setup on page 186 for the Sequencer mode.

Global edit mode


MIDI: MIDI In Control

Local Control On

On

No data received via MIDI on a muted track can


be played by Pa1X.

Off

Data received via MIDI on a muted track can still


play on the Pa1X.

The Local parameter turns the keyboard on or off.


Note: The Local parameter is automatically reactivated each time
you turn the instrument on.

Off

When you play the keyboard, MIDI data is sent to


the internal sound generator. If tracks are
assigned to a MIDI OUT channel, data is also
sent to the MIDI OUT port.

Chord 1 Midi Channel

Mid

Chord 2 Midi Channel

Mid

The keyboard is connected to the MIDI OUT, but


cannot play the internal sound generator.

Notes entering these channels are sent to the Chord Recognition


engine.

This is very useful when working with an external


sequencer, to send notes and various MIDI messages from the integrated keyboard and controllers to the external sequencer, and then let the
sequencer send them back to the sound generator, without overlapping. See the MIDI chapter.

There are two separate Chord channels. This is very useful when
you must send chords to Pa1X on two different channels (like
with some MIDI accordions).

MIDI A Out/Thru Mode

Mid

MIDI B Out/Thru Mode

Mid

Use these radio buttons to define if the MIDI OUT connector


must work as OUT or THRU connectors. (OUT ports send data
generated by the Pa1X, while THRU connectors send the same
data received on the MIDI IN port).

Upper Octave Transp (Transpose)

Mid

Octave transposition of data received on the MIDI IN for the


Upper tracks. For example, if you select the +1 value, a received
C4 will play a C5 on the Pa1X.
This parameter may be useful to many MIDI accordion players,
whose MIDI interface may transmit on an unexpected octave.
Lower Octave Transp (Transpose)

Mid

Octave transposition of data received on the MIDI IN for the


Lower track. For example, if you select the +1 value, a received
C4 will play a C5 on the Pa1X.
This parameter may be useful to many MIDI accordion players,
whose MIDI interface may transmit on an unexpected octave.

MIDI: MIDI In Control


This page lets you program general parameters for the MIDI IN,
like the Chord Recognition channel and MIDI parameters for
the Voice Processor.

Midi In Velocity Value

Mid

Use this parameter to set a fixed velocity (dynamics) value for all
received MIDI notes. This is useful when playing the Pa1X with
an organ or a MIDI Accordion.
Normal

Normal velocity values are received.

40127

All received velocity values are converted to the


selected value.

Voice Processor Midi controls


Midi In Channel

Mid

Notes received on this channel are sent to the Harmony section


of the Voice Processor.

Midi In Controls
Midi In Octave Transpose

Octave Transpose In
Mid

Use this parameter to determine if the Octave Transpose is


applied also to notes received on the MIDI IN.
On

Off

Notes received on the MIDI IN are transposed


according to the Octave Transpose setting for
each track.
Data received on the MIDI IN are not transposed.

Midi In Mute/Unmute

Mid

Use this parameter to determine if a muted track can still play


data received via MIDI.

Mid

Octave transpose for all notes received via MIDI by the Harmony section of the Voice Processor.
In Note Range-High

Mid

In Note Range-Low

Mid

These parameters are the lowest and highest notes received by


the Harmony section of the Voice Processor. Notes received out
of this range are not recognized.

Reference

On

237

238

Global edit mode


MIDI: MIDI In Channels

MIDI: MIDI In Channels

MIDI: MIDI Out Channels

In this page, you can assign Pa1X tracks to any of the MIDI IN
channels.

In this page, you can assign Pa1X tracks to any of the MIDI OUT
channels.

Mid

Channels

Mid

Channels

You can assign to each channel one of the following tracks:

You can assign to each channel one of the following tracks:

Off

No track assigned.

Off

No track assigned.

Lower

Lower track.

Lower

Lower track.

Upper 13

One of the Upper tracks.

Upper 13

One of the Upper tracks.

Drum

Drum track.

Drum

Drum track.

Percussion

Percussion track.

Percussion

Percussion track.

Bass

Bass track.

Bass

Bass track.

Acc 15

One of the Auto-accompaniment tracks.

Acc15

One of the Auto-accompaniment tracks.

Seq.1 Tr 0116

Seq.1 Tr 0116

One of Sequencer 1 tracks.


Seq.2 Tr 0116

One of Sequencer 1 tracks.


Seq.2 Tr 0116

One of Sequencer 2 tracks.


Global

Control

Special channel to simulate the Pa1Xs integrated


controls (keyboard, pedals, joystick) with an
external keyboard or controller. MIDI messages
coming on this channel are seen as if they were
generated by Pa1Xs integrated controllers.
On this special channel, the Pa1X receives MIDI
messages to remotely select Styles, Performances,
STS and Style Elements. See tables on page 286
and following for more information on the
received data

One of Sequencer 2 tracks.


Seq.1/2 Tr 0116
Use these channels to send data generated by a
track with the same name on either or both
onboard sequencers at the same time.
Chord

Use this channel to send notes recognized by the


Chord Recognition engine to the MIDI OUT.
This is useful, for example, to control an external
Harmonizer from the Pa1X, using the Lower
track to play chords, even if the track is muted.

Global edit mode


MIDI: Filters

Left + Right

MIDI: Filters
Use this page to set up to 8 filters for the MIDI data received or
sent by the Pa1X.

239

The selected track is connected to the Left &


Right outs, in stereo. The track is also sent to the
Internal FX processors (A and B for the Style
tracks, C and D for the Keyboard and Pad tracks).
You can set the volume using the MASTER VOLUME slider.

Track

L/Mono & Right


Internal FX

Out 1 + 2

The track is connected to the 1 & 2 sub-outs, in


stereo. It is not sent to the Internal FX processors.
The MASTER VOLUME slider has no effect on it.

Track
Out 1
Selected MIDI IN filters.
Off

No filter.

Pitch Bend

Pitch Bend.

MonoTouch

Mono (or Channel) After Touch.

PolyTouch

Poly After Touch.

PrgChange

Program Change.

SysExcl

System Exclusive.

All CC

All Control Change messages.

0127

Control Change message #0127. See MIDI


Data on page 383 for a list of available Control
Change messages.

Midi Out Filters

The selected track is connected to the sub-out 1.


It is mixed to mono. It is not sent to the Internal
FX processors. The MASTER VOLUME slider has
no effect on it.

Track
Out 2

The selected track is connected to the sub-out 2.


It is mixed to mono. It is not sent to the Internal
FX processors. The MASTER VOLUME slider has
no effect on it.

Track

Audio Output: Seq1

Mid

Selected MIDI OUT filters. See above for information on each


filter type.

This page lets you connect Sequencer 1 tracks to the audio outputs. These setting are also applied to the Sequencer mode.

Audio Output: Sty/Kbd


This page lets you connect Style, Keyboard and Pad tracks to the
audio outputs.

Tracks

Gbl

Use these parameters to assign an audio output (OUTPUT section, on the back of the instrument) to each track.
See Audio Output: Sty/Kbd on page 239 for more information.

Tracks

Gbl

Use these parameters to assign an audio output (OUTPUT section, on the back of the instrument) to each track.

Reference

Midi In Filters

Mid

1&2

240

Global edit mode


Audio Output: Seq2

Drum Category

Audio Output: Seq2


This page lets you connect Sequencer 2 tracks to the audio outputs.

Kick

Bass Drum category.

Snare

Snare Drum category.

Tom

Tom category.

Hi-Hat

Hi-Hat category.

Cymbals

Cymbals category.

Perc.1

Low-pitched percussion category.

Perc.2

High-pitched percussion category.

Perc. FX

Sound FX category.

Gbl

Audio Output: Audio In


Tracks

Gbl

Use these parameters to assign an audio output (OUTPUT section, on the back of the instrument) to each track.

This page lets you connect the Audio Inputs and the Voice Processor to the audio outputs.

See Audio Output: Sty/Kbd on page 239 for more information.

Audio Output: Drums


This page lets you route Drum Kit Sounds to the audio outputs.

See Audio Output: Sty/Kbd on page 239 for more information


on the available audio outputs.
Rear SW (SELECT switch)
The status of this switch, located on the rear panel, is shown by
the Rear SW diagram. From its status depends the routing of the
Audio In signal.

See Audio Output: Sty/Kbd on page 239 for more information


about the available audio outputs.
Drum Output

When set to MIC, the MIC input goes to the Voice Processor, while line inputs 1 and 2 are directly connected to
the Left and Right outputs.

When set to 1, line input 1 goes to the Voice Processor,


while line input 2 and the MIC input are deactivated.

Gbl

This parameter lets you decide if Drum Kit Sounds will be sent
to the single output (or output pair) defined for the track they
are assigned to, or each drum category will be sent to a different
output.
Track

When this option is selected, Drum Kits will be


sent to the output selected in one of the previous
pages for the tracks they are assigned to.

Drum Category
When this option is selected, you can select a different output for each category of Drum Kit
sounds. Use the Drum Category box below, to
select an output for each category of percussive
sounds.

Mic
The microphone input is alternative to the line input In 1,
depending on the status of the SELECT switch on the rear panel.
When selected, the signal coming from a connected microphone
goes to the Voice Processor, then is output in stereo together
with any processing made inside the Voice Processor.
In 1
The line input In 1 may be routed to the Left output, or to the
Voice Processor, depending on the status of the SELECT switch
on the rear panel.

If the SELECT switch it is set to MIC, this input is sent to


the Left output.

If the SELECT switch is set to 1, it is sent to the Voice Processor.

Global edit mode


Audio Output: Metro / S/PDIF

In 2
The line input In 2 may be routed to the Right output, or deactivated, depending on the status of the SELECT switch on the rear
panel.

If the SELECT switch it is set to MIC, this input is sent to


the Right output.
If the SELECT switch is set to 1, it is deactivated.

Voice Processor Out

241

Note: The selected Metronome Mode must not be Off, in order for
the click to be sent to an audio output during playback.
See Tracks on page 239 for detailed information on the available outputs.

S/PDIF Out
S/PDIF On/Off

Gbl

Use this parameter to assign an audio output (OUTPUT section,


on the back of the instrument) to the Voice Processor.
In 1/2 Out

Use this parameter to turn the S/PDIF digital audio output on or


off.
Note: This parameter is automatically set to Off each time you turn
the instrument on.
On

Non editable. These output are fixed, and cannot be changed.

Audio Output: Metro / S/PDIF

All tracks set to be sent to the Left+Right audio


outputs (see from page 239) are sent to the S/
PDIF output. Together with the audio signal, the
Word Clock sync signal is also output, with a frequency of 48kHz.
When in this mode, the Pa1X becomes the Word
Clock master. No other master device can be connected to the same digital audio system. Please,
refer to the connected audio device (mixer, audio
card) for information on how to set it as a
Word Clock slave.

This page lets you define various parameters for the Metronome,
the S/PDIF output, and the Speakers (for the Pa1X with integrated speakers).
Off

No signal is sent to the S/PDIF output.

Speakers
Speakers On/Off

Gbl

Metronome
Mode

Gbl

Use this parameter to activate the metronome for the Style Play
and/or Song play operating modes.
Off

No metronome is heard.

Style

The metronome is always activated when playing


a Style.

Song

The metronome is always activated when playing


a Song.

Style+Song

The metronome is always activated when playing


a Style or Song.

Volume

Audio Output: MP3/CD


In this page you can program the MP3 (EXBP-MP3) and Audio
CD (CDRW-1) options.

Gbl

Use this parameter to set the volume of the metronome.


Click Out

Gbl

The metronomes click can be routed to any audio output.


Hint: When sending the click to your drum player, we suggest to
select one of the sub-outs Out 1 and 2, to avoid it is sent to the audience through the Left+Right outputs.

MP3 Board
This section only appears when the optional EXBP-MP3 board has
been installed.

Reference

Not available on the Pa1X Pro. On a Pa1X with integrated speakers, use this checkbox to turn speakers on or off. This option is
useful when the instrument is connected to an external amplification system, and you dont need the speakers.

242

Global edit mode


Voice Processor Setup: Setup

Max Volume

Gbl

Harmony Settings

Use this parameter to set the maximum volume of the MP3


Player.

These parameters are general settings for the Harmony section


voices, that are saved on the Voice Processor Setup.

Audio Out

Vibrato Mode

Gbl

This (non-editable) parameter shows the fixed output for the


MP3 Player (Left+Right).

CD Audio

This parameter sets whether the vibrato follows the onset and
attack of the model (Boost) or is instantaneous (Manual). The
joystick controls the vibrato in both modes.
Boost

The preset value for each voice (see Vibrato


Amount on page 250) is boosted when moving
the joystick.

Manual

Vibrato starts from a value of 0, and is fully controlled by the joystick.

This section only appears when the optional CDRW-1 CD drive


has been installed.
Max Volume

Gbl

Use this parameter to set the maximum volume of the Audio CD


Player.

VPs

Vibrato Rx Enable

VPs

This parameter lets you turn vibrato reception on or off.


Audio Out

Gbl

This (non-editable) parameter shows the fixed output for the


Audio CD (Left+Right).

Voice Processor Setup: Setup


In this page you can select a Voice Processor Setup, and set some
general parameters for the current Setup.

Octave Transpose

VPs

This transposes the harmony voices in Notes mode (see Harmony Mode on page 248). The value corresponds to octaves.
This is useful when used in conjunction with In Note RangeHigh and In Note Range-Low parameters (see page 237).
When receiving notes from MIDI, this value is summed to the
value of the Octave Transpose In parameter, found in the
MIDI: MIDI In Control page (see page 237).
Pitch Bend Range

VPs

Only available in Notes mode. Sets in semitones the range that


MIDI pitch bend information will alter the pitch of the harmonies in Notes mode.
Damper Mode

VPs

Use this parameter to define the effect of the Damper pedal on


the Voice Processor. The Damper message can be received from
the Damper pedal connected to the DAMPER jack, or from the
MIDI IN (CC#64).

Setup
Voice Processor Setup
Use this parameter to select a Voice Processor Setup.
Setup parameters are global and do not change when a different
preset is recalled. Setup parameters are all the parameters found
in the Voice Processor Setup edit section, including Lead input
level and pan, Compression/Gate, and EQ parameters among
many others.
They are parameters that would typically be set for a given situation based on the singer, microphone or studio configuration
and then left that way as a basis for the presets within the Voice
Processor. If you change your microphone (or singer!) the EQ/
Compression settings need to only be adjusted once in the setup
section.
If you wish to save your setup settings, just select the Write Global-Voice Processor Setup command from the page menu (see
page 257).

Off

Damper disabled.

Sustain

Notes sent to the Voice Processor are sustained as


long as the pedal is kept pressed. Therefore,
chords sent to the Harmony section do not
change until the pedal is released or a different
chord is recognized.

Harmony Hold
Harmony voices are sustained while you continue
to sing through them. On activation (press and
hold the Damper pedal), you can freeze whatever
the harmony voices are doing, and they will hold
their notes (in a very natural way) until you let
go.
Note: The Harmony Hold function can also be
assigned to an Assignable Footswitch or Switch.

Global edit mode


Voice Processor Setup: Lead Voice

243

Voice Processor Setup: Lead Voice

Voice Processor Setup: Dynamics / EQ

This page lets you adjust parameters for the Lead voice (i.e., the
singers voice).

In this page you can adjust parameters for the Compressor/Gate


and Equalizer, applied to the Lead and Harmony voices.

Mic Input

Assign
VPs

Low cut filter. 12dB per octave. Cutoff frequency options include
60, 80 and 120 Hz.
Delay Compensation

VPs

Turning this on delays the lead vocal so that the humanized harmony voices will be randomly ahead and behind the lead voice.
Turning this off results in minimum lead voice processing delay.

Pan/Volume
Pan knob

Dyn

VPs

Compressor/Gate assignment. The options are Off, Lead + Harmony, Harmony or Lead. The compressor has auto-makeup
gain, so there are no output levels problems when selecting a different option.
EQ

VPs

EQ assignment. The options are: Off, Lead + Harmony, Harmony or Lead.

Dynamics
VPs

Adjusts panning for the lead voice. L64 (panned fully left) to R63
(panned fully right).

The Voice Processor has dynamics processing optimized for


vocals.
Thresh knob

Level knob

VPs

VPs

Compressor Threshold. Range: 0 to -60 dB.

This parameter sets the Lead Voice level.


DryOff

Off

This setting mutes the dry input vocal, but allows


the thickening voices to pass through the unit as
if the lead level was set to 0dB.
Lead Voice is turned off.

-30dB 0dB Lead Voice level.

Ratio knob

VPs

Compression ratio. Range: 1.1:1 to 64:1.


Gate knob

VPs

Gate Threshold. Range: Off, -70dB to 0dB

EQ
The Voice Processor has an extremely flexible 3-band EQ with
frequency and gain-adjustable high and low shelving bands, as
well as a fully parametric band with Q control.
Low Gain knob

VPs

Low Shelving Frequency cut/boost. Range: 12 dB.


Low Frequency knob
Low Shelving
80Hz16kHz.

Frequency

VPs

center

frequency.

Range:

Reference

Low Cut

244

Global edit mode


Voice Processor Setup: Talk

Mid Gain knob

VPs

FX Lev (FX Level) knob

Use this knob to attenuate the effects level. 0dB corresponds to


no attenuation.

Mid Band Frequency cut/boost. Range: 12 dB.


Mid Frequency knob

VPs

Master Volume Attenuation knob

Mid Band Frequency center frequency. Range: 80Hz16kHz.


Mid Q knob

VPs

Reverb

High Gain knob

Type

VPs

High Shelving Frequency cut/boost. Range: 12 dB.


High Frequency knob
Frequency

Tlk

Use this knob to reduce the master volume. 0dB corresponds to


no level reduction.

Resonance of the midband. Range is .1 (wide band) to 10 (very


narrow band).

High Shelving
80Hz16kHz.

Tlk

Tlk

Use this parameter to choose a reverb to be automatically


selected when turning the Talk function on.
VPs

center

frequency.

Range:

PreDly (Pre Delay)

Tlk

Use this parameter to delay the reverb, and separate it from the
lead voice. With higher values, reverb may be perceived as an
echo.

Voice Processor Setup: Talk

Decay

This page is where you can set the Talk function, to be used to
address the audience, speaking over the background music.
Parameter contained in this page are relative to programming
parameters, and are used to attenuate the music when speaking.

Tlk

Use this parameter to set the reverbs decay time (in seconds).
The higher this value, the more difficult is to understand separate words.
Low Color

Tlk

Reverb Low Color. Specifies the characteristics of the reverbs low


frequencies.
High Color

Tlk

Reverb High Color. Specifies the characteristics of the reverbs


high frequencies.

Thicken
On/Off

This checkbox allows enabling/disabling of lead voice thickening


parameters.

Talk
Talk

Tlk

On/off switch for the Talk function. This is the same you can
find in the Mic panel of the Style Play and Song Play modes.

Det. (Detune)

Tlk

Level

Mixer

Use this knob to set the level of the voice thickening effect.
Tlk

Use this knob to attenuate the reverb applied to the lead voice.
0dB corresponds to no attenuation.

Tlk

Sets the amount that the detuned voices are panned. A value of
100% results in the detuned voices being hard panned R and L.
A value of 0% results in the detuned voices panned to center.

When this parameter is checked, the Talk function automatically


engages when the Sequencer or Arranger is stopped. This way,
you can talk to the audience between two songs, without the
need to press the Talk On/Off button.

Ld to Rv (Lead to Reverb) knob

Tlk

Sets the amount of lead voice detuning.


Spread

Mode
Auto (AutoTalk)

Tlk

Level knob

Tlk

Global edit mode


Voice Processor Preset: Preset

245

Harmony/Modeling Select

Voice Processor Preset: Preset

Harmony/Voice Modeling
This page allows you to select a Voice Processor Preset, as well as
turning on or off the various Voice processor modules.

VPp

Use this radio-button to select either the Harmony or the Voice


Modeling modules. They cannot be used at the same time in the
same Preset.
Note: The Voice Modeling module is optional, and may not be
available in your instrument. Please contact your Korg distributor,
or check on our site (www.korgpa.com), for information on this
module.

Harmony On/Off
These are switches for the Lead voice and voices generated by
the Harmony section.
Note: These parameter are the same found in the Mic panel of the
main page of the Style Play and Song Play modes.

Two optional software


modules are available for
the Voice Processor: Pitch
Correction and Voice
Modeling. These modules
can be purchased separately. Please see Voice Processor: The optional Pitch Correction and Voice Modeling modules on page 252 for more
information on how to purchase them.

Using Pitch Correction and Voice Modeling


in demo mode
Even if you have not yet bought the optional
software modules, you can turn them on, and
try them (with some limitations) before you buy.
While in demo mode, the audio signal will be interrupted every
30 seconds, and the VP Demo indicator will flash on top of the
screen.
To turn Voice Modeling on, select the corresponding radiobutton.

Lead

VPp

This checkbox allows turning the lead voice On or Off, independent of the Lead Level knob in the Voice Processor Setup section
(see Level knob on page 243). This is useful in creating presets
where you want to hear harmony voices only.
Note: This parameter is only available when the Harmony section
is turned on. If it is turned off, the Lead parameter is automatically
set to On.
V1V4

VPp

These checkboxes allow turning each of the four Harmony


Voices On or Off, independent of the Level knob in the Harmony Voice page (see Level knob on page 250).
This is the same as the Voice On/Off checkbox (see page 249).

Master On/Off
These are switches for the various Voice Processor sections.
Note: These parameter are the same found in the Mic panel of the
main page of the Style Play and Song Play modes.

To turn Pitch Correction on, check the Pitch parameter.


Pitch

Preset
Voice Processor Preset

VPp

This checkbox allows the enabling/disabling of the Pitch Correction module (available as an option).
SB

Use this parameter to select a Voice Processor Preset. This Preset


is saved when writing a Performance or STS to memory.
Preset parameters can be recalled by selecting a Performance or
STS. They can be found in the Voice Processor Preset edit section, including Harmony Voice settings, Pitch Correction
parameters, and Effect settings among many others.
If you wish to save your Preset settings, just select the Write
Global-Voice Processor Preset command from the page menu
(see page 257).

Thicken

VPp

This checkbox allows the enabling/disabling of the Thicken


module.
Harmony/Modeling

VPp

This checkbox allows the enabling/disabling of the Harmony or


Voice Modeling module (available as an option).
Effects

VPp

This checkbox allows the enabling/disabling of the Voice Processor Effects module.

Reference

The Buy Info buttons

246

Global edit mode


Voice Processor Preset: Thicken / Pitch

Root

Voice Processor Preset: Thicken / Pitch

VPp

Pitch Correction scale root.

This page contains parameters for the Thicken and the Pitch
Correction module (Pitch Correction available as an option see
Voice Processor: The optional Pitch Correction and Voice Modeling modules on page 252).

Scale Type

VPp

Pitch Correction scale type: Major, Minor-Natural (natural


minor), Minor-Harmonic (harmonic minor), Minor-Ascending (ascending melodic minor), Chromatic and Custom. This
setting, in combination with Root, determines which notes your
input vocal will be corrected to.
Attack

VPp

Pitch Correction attack rate. Sets the responsiveness of the correction. 0% is slow, and 100% is fast. Settings of between 16%
and 40% give the most transparent pitch correction. High settings can give you a robotic sounding effect.
Amount

Thicken
Thickening makes the Lead voice thicker, by adding two ghost
voices to the singers voice.
On/Off

VPp

This checkbox allows enabling/disabling of lead voice thickening


parameters. It is the same control found on the Preset page.
Det. (Detune)

Spread

With the amount set to 100%, a 10 cent flat input will be


corrected by 10 cents and a 50 cent flat input will be corrected by 50 cents.

With the amount set to 80%, a 10 cent flat input will be


corrected by approximately 5 cents and a 50 cent flat input
will be corrected by approximately 40 cents.

With the amount set to 0%, a 10 cent flat input will not be
corrected and a 50 cent flat input will be corrected by
approximately 10 cents.

Window

Level
VPp

Sets the volume level of the lead voice thickening effect.

Pitch Correction
Available as an option see Voice Processor: The optional Pitch
Correction and Voice Modeling modules on page 252.
The Voice Processor will listen to the pitch of your voice, compare it to the selected correction scale, and then apply pitch correction in realtime. The amount of correction applied is
governed by the various amount and timing settings available.
Pitch correcting your lead voice not only makes for great sounding lead vocals, it can also benefit your harmonies in that the
pitch correction is applied prior to harmony voice generation.
Pitch Correction On/Off

VPp

Sets the amount that the detuned voices are panned. A value of
100% results in the detuned voices being hard panned R and L.
A value of 0% results in the detuned voices panned to center.

Level knob

Pitch Correction Amount. Scales the amount of automatic correction applied to the input voice. The range is 0% to 100%.
However, 0% does not mean that the correction is turned off.
The amount of applied correction depends on how far out of
tune the input note is. This allows for a very musical way of correcting pitch. It corrects the large pitch errors while preserving
the natural micro variations around the target pitch. For example:

VPp

Sets the amount of lead voice detuning.

VPp

Check this parameter to turn Pitch Correction on. This is the


same as the Pitch parameter in the Preset page (Voice Processor Preset section), and in the Mic panel of the Style Play and
Song Play modes (main page).

VPp

VPp

Correction Window. Specifies the maximum distance (above or


below) in cents an out-of-tune note can be from the closest correction note and still be corrected. A very small window setting
will cause correction to occur only when the singer is singing
very close to the correct pitch. The maximum window size is 200
cents or a whole tone above and below the target pitch.
Custom Scale

VPp

This diagram, available when the Custom Scale Type is selected,


provides a chromatic list of notes beginning with the scale root.
Checkmarks indicate which notes are in the pitch correct scale
and which are ignored. No checkmark means that the note is
ignored. Modified (custom) scales are stored with presets.

Global edit mode


Voice Processor Preset: Voice Modeling

Spectral

Voice Processor Preset: Voice Modeling


Available as an option see Voice Processor: The optional Pitch
Correction and Voice Modeling modules on page 252.
Note: The Voice Modeling module is alternative to the Harmony
module. They cannot be both active at the same time. Go to the
Preset page (Voice Processor Preset section) to select the Voice Modeling option and make parameters in this page editable.
This page allows you to enable/disable, and edit, the Voice Modeling parameters.

247

VPp

The Spectral control is a set of equalizer response curves


intended to complement the Resonance selections. This equalization is different than those controlled via EQ in the Voice Processor Setup section. The Spectral styles reflect the natural
equalization equivalent to the native control a singer has over his
or her own voice. These modeled EQ curves are applied to the
Voice Modeling (VM) voice. These styles may be used in conjunction with the resonances, or purely as additional tonal control over the VM voice.
The Amt (Amount) parameter allows you to dial in the relative
strength of this effect on your VM voice; 0% for no effect, 100%
for maximum effect.
Growl

VPp

Growl refers to the combination of complex sounds the human


voice can make to change non-pitched aspects of the vocal
sound. Consider these examples: the cool breathy sound of a Jazz
or Folk singer, the legendary warm grumble of Blues from the
Mississippi Delta, the brazen sizzle of Rock and Alternative Rock
or the growl of 60s Soul.

The Voice Modeling can enhance or transform a voice. For


example, a thin vocal into a throaty one, a male into a
female. Complete control is possible through various modeling
parameters of the voice: Resonance, Spectral, Growl and Vibrato.
Note: You can use the Voice Modeled (VM) Lead voice together
with the unprocessed Lead voice, by turning on the Lead parameter in the Preset page (Voice Processor Preset section).
Resonance

VPp

Resonance is how we model different vocal tract dimensions,


and apply them to incoming vocals. Your favorite vocalists all
have unique pitch and glottal characteristics. Resonance changes
the tonal makeup of the sound by moving vocal formants, so
that the Voice Modeled (VM) Lead voice sounds quite different
than the original. Formants are the harmonic combinations that
help make our voices unique.
The styles have been given names that are easily identified when
assembling presets. The names may be associated with a particular genre of music or sound. This way, you can associate a certain
modification with a name, similar to how we describe colors in a
picture with names.
Some of the Resonance styles contain a built-in octave shift,
either up or down. This is to accommodate a male singing in the
female register, with a feminine timbre, or for a female to simulate a male singing voice. These Resonance styles enable you to
sing in a natural range and still hit the notes of your opposite
gender comfortably; they are Style settings Transmute.
The Amt (Amount) parameter allows you to dial in the relative
strength of this effect on your VM voice; 0% for no effect, 100%
for pure Resonance.

Breathiness factors in virtual air that gives the effect of being


close to a sensitive condenser microphone. This intimate sound
may be used in some Jazz styles or for pop ballads, although its
application is not limited to these. Breathiness may also be used
to give a tired or strained sound, where the singer may be
pushing a lot of air. You can also dial in whisper or like textures
to simulate a specific singers style.
Rasp is an effect where the breath pushed through the throat
cavity goes beyond mere breathiness, into a harsh sizzle or grind.
These sounds are a combination of hard breath and friction in
the larynx, which are difficult for many singers to reproduce and
are very damaging on the vocal cords. You can use Rasp on your
normal voice and achieve a grittier, rough delivery, sending a
clean voice into an overdriven frenzy. In many forms of heavy
rock music, this is an expressive and elusive performance component.
Growl describes another way that we can achieve Blues, Rock, or
Rhythm & Blues sounds with our normal voice. Growl refers to a
type of grind or friction of the larynx and epiglottis, usually
heard in Soul, R&B, and Blues music. Some of the styles are sensitive to the dynamics of the lead voice, meaning that when you
raise the volume of a syllable, the Voice Processor growls on that
syllable.
As with the other Voice Modeling effects, the Amt (Amount)
parameter controls the level of effect incorporated into the signal.

Reference

Voice Modeling is essentially realtime resynthesis and reshaping


of the human voice. It offers a variety of ways in which to process
the vocal input, including the ability to add breath, growl, rasp,
head and chest resonance, inflection or vibrato.

The Growl settings contain three types of effects: Breathiness,


Rasp, and Growl, arranged in various combinations in the style
library. All of these are set to create percussive and expressive
textures in addition to the sung note. Experimentation is the key
to finding styles that work in your scenario, or are difficult to
create in your scenario. The last few entries contain extreme and
unreal Growl styles no longer need you burn out your throat
night after night. Growl styles are created using the following
parameters:

248

Global edit mode


Voice Processor Preset: Harmony

Inflection

VPp

The Inflection styles allow the singer to adjust the characteristics


of scooping to the sung note. This is a stylistic effect in singing
where a singer sweeps up a variable range of pitch to rest on the
intended note. The Inflection settings use the following nomenclature: Up/Down, Fast, Often.
Up/Down is the direction of Inflection Up to a note, or Down
to a note.
Fast is the speed at which the inflection scoops, either Slow,
Medium or Fast.
Often is how regularly the Inflection occurs. The Voice Processor
listens for an Onset period before applying Inflection to the
beginning of the next phrase.
Vibrato

VPp

Vibrato is a pitch effect that singers often use in their delivery of


a piece of music. This effect is achieved by repeatedly altering the
size of the mouth and vocal tract in a pattern that varies above
and below a central pitch in an oscillating fashion.
The Vibrato styles are based on real vocalists vibratos. We have
analyzed a large set of parameters from a voice database and created various vibrato models. The Vibrato setting names reflect
the style of the vocals from which they were extracted. However,
a vibrato modeled from a style or gender different from yours
can sound very good when applied to your voice. Experimentation is the key to finding a style setting that best suits your application. You might begin incorporating Vibrato into your sound
by setting the Amt (Amount) control to 50%. This setting
matches the depth level that we analyzed in our modeling subjects. You can then vary the effect from this middle range up or
down to suit your taste.
Level

VPp

Use this knob to set the level of the modelled voices.


Pan

Harmony
Harmony On/Off

This checkbox allows enabling/disabling of the Harmony module. It is the same control found on the Preset page.
Latch On/Off

Use this knob to set the position in the stereo field of the modelled voices.

VPp

When enabled in Chord mode, the last chord played remains


active after the notes have been released from the keyboard.
When enabled in Notes mode, the harmony voices will only
respond to note input when the number of notes being played
equals the harmony voices enabled. This ensures logical voice
assignment when voices change. When Latch is On, the envelope
parameters Attack and Release are not applicable.
Harmony Mode

VPp

Change the current harmony mode. Available parameters: Scalic


(Scalic presets), Chord (Chordal presets), Shift, and Notes (Shift
and Notes presets).
See Harmony and Tuning with the Voice Processor on
page 253 for a full description of each harmony mode.
Root

VPp

In Scalic presets this sets the scale root.


Type

VPp

In Scalic presets this sets the scale type.


Human. (Humanization) Style

VPp

This is a list of humanization style types, each made up of a


combination of Flextime based time randomization, pitch
randomization and pitch inflection (scoop).
Amount

VPp

VPp

VPp

The amount that the humanization style is applied to the harmony voices.
Tuning

VPp

Voice Processor Preset: Harmony

This gives the option of either Equal temperament, Just intonation, or Barbershop tuning modes. See Harmony and Tuning
with the Voice Processor on page 253 for a full description of
each tuning mode.

In this page you can define general parameters for the Harmony
module.

Portamento

VPp

This is defined in milliseconds as the time to reach a target note


when a harmony voice needs to change pitch.
PB Assign

VPp

Pitch Bend control assignment. Allows assignment of the pitch


bend to Pitch (applicable in Notes and Chord harmony modes)
or Gender.
Note: For this to work, a value different than zero must be assigned
to the Pitch Bend Range in the Voice Processor Setup: Setup
page (see page 242).

Global edit mode


Voice Processor Preset: Harmony Voices

Smooth

VPp

Sets how much of the input pitch nuance is applied to the output
voice. Not applicable to Shift presets.

Voice Processor Preset: Harmony Voices


The Voice Processor can add up to four Harmony Voices to the
Lead voice. Here you can adjust parameters for each individual
voice.

Harmony Note Input


In Style Play and Song Play mode, when the Harmony track is
set to Global, the Voice Processors Harmony module can receive
notes and chords from a source different than the Arrangers
Chord Scanning area. This way, you can continue sending
chords to the Arranger with your left hand, while, for example,
sending chords or notes to the Harmony module with your right
hand.
Source

249

Voice
Select
buttons

VPp

This parameters allows you to select a source of notes or chords


for the Harmony module of the Voice Processor.
Chord Scanning
With this option selected, notes or chords come
from the same chord scanning area dedicated to
the Arranger. (This works exactly as in the previous
versions of the operating system).

Voice Select buttons


V1V4

VPp

Use these buttons to select one of the four available voices for
editing.

Lower

Notes or chords come from the Lower area of the


keyboard.

Upper

Notes or chords come from the Upper area of the


keyboard.

Individual Voice Basic

Full Keyb.

Notes or chords come from the full range of the


keyboard.

Voice On/Off

VPp

This checkbox allows enabling/disabling of the selected Harmony Voice. It is the same control found on the Preset page.

Harmony Voices Envelope

Note: The envelope can only work when the Latch On/Off
parameter is turned off (see page 248).
Attack

Gender

VPp

This parameter sets the formant of the Harmony Voice. Use it to


alter the character of the voice ranging from -50 (a big person
with a deep voice) to 0 (no change) to +50 (mice/alien sound).
Voicing

VPp

VPp

Sets the envelope attack time for harmony voices. Available only
in Notes and Chord mode.

This parameter is used to set the voicing of the selected voice.


This parameter means different things depending on the harmony mode of the preset.

Release

Scale Mode Presets

VPp

Sets the envelope release time for harmony voices. Available only
in Notes and Chord mode.

Level
Level knob
Sets the overall harmony voices level.

VPp

In this mode the Voicing parameter specifies the interval of the


harmony note with respect to the input note in the scale. The
range of values goes from --8, which is 2 octaves below the input
note, to ++8 which is two octaves above the input note, or Custom Map, which means custom voicing (See Custom Voice
Mapping below). For example, a setting of +3 will result in a
harmony voice a third above the input voice, related to the current scale.
Chord Mode Presets
In this mode the Voicing parameter specifies the relation of the
harmony note to the input note with respect to the current
chord. In Chord mode presets, the harmony voices are always
notes in the chord. A setting of Up1 will result in the harmony
voice being the next note above the input voice in the chord. For
instance, if the chord was C Major and the input note was an E,
an Up1 setting would produce a G harmony voice, just above the
input E.

Reference

The envelope lets you set a different Attack and Release time for
the harmony voices.

250

Global edit mode


Voice Processor Preset: Harmony Voices

The range of values goes from Down 5 to Unison to Up6. Additional values are Root1 and Root2 which give the root of the recognized chord as the harmony voice, and Bass1 and Bass2 (bass
voicing) which give the lowest note received. Root2 and Bass2
are the higher pitch Root and Bass settings.

Note Out

24

Number of semitones above or under the


received note.

Shift Mode Presets

UNI

In this mode the voices are shifted relative to the input note. The
values range from -24 semitones to +24 semitones.

Unison. The same note received on the input is


sent to the output.

NC

No Change. The harmony voice will keep its previous pitch until the lead voice pitch changes to a
non NC note.

Notes Mode Presets


In this mode there is no selectable voicing, since harmony voices
exactly play received notes.
Vibrato Style

VPp

A list of Vibrato styles based on the analysis of real singers.


Vibrato Amount

VPp

Resulting note when applying the custom map.

Copy to button
Use this button to copy the current custom map to another
voice. When you press the button, the Copy Custom Voice Mapping dialog box appears:

VPp

The depth of vibrato applied to the voice.

Pan/Level
Level knob

VPp

Sets the output level of the selected voice. Please note that there
is also a master harmony voice level found in the Harmony
page.
Pan knob

VPp

Adjusts the pan for the selected voice. L64 (panned fully left) to
R63 (panned fully right).

Custom Voice Mapping


This area is only available in Scalic Mode.
Scale mode harmonies are basically pitch maps. For each input
note in a scale you can define a resulting harmony note. The
Voice Processor has pre-defined pitch maps for all the offered
scale roots, types, and intervals.
The Custom voicing feature allows you to create your own pitch
maps. For example, you could define a pitch map so that a C
input produces an E output and a D input produces an A output.
The best way to work with custom voicing is as follows:
For a given harmony voice, select the scale root, type, and
interval that most closely matches the desired voicing.
Go to the Note In parameter and select the input note that
requires a different harmony note.
Go to the Note Out parameter and change the harmony note
as desired.
Select various other input notes and remap as desired. Repeat
the above steps for each harmony voice. You can also copy a map
from a voice to other voices.
The custom map can be transposed under the Harmony page
by changing the Root parameter.
Note In
Incoming note.

VPp

Check all desired target voices, then press OK to confirm the


copy.

Global edit mode


Voice Processor Preset: Effects

251

Decay

Voice Processor Preset: Effects

VPp

Reverb Decay Time.

This page allows to adjust the various effect parameters for the
Voice Processor.

Low Color

VPp

Reverb Low Color. Specifies the characteristics of the reverbs low


frequencies.
High Color

VPp

Reverb High Color. Specifies the characteristics of the reverbs


high frequencies.

Delay
Type

VPp

Use this parameter to select a Delay type.

FX Mix
Ld to Rv (Lead to Reverb) knob

DualMono

Maintains the panning of the sends.

PingPong1

Sends the lead voice to the left effect end only.

VPp

PingPong2

Sends the lead voice to the sends depending on


the lead pan setting.

VPp

Delay

Lead to Reverb effects send.


Ha to Rv (Harmony to Reverb) knob

Only available when Src = Manual (see below). Use this parameter to fine adjust (in milliseconds) the current delay time.

Harmony to Reverb effects send.


Ld to Dl (Lead to Delay) knob

VPp

VPp

Feedback

Lead to Delay effects send.

VPp

Delay feedback amount.


Ha to Dl (Harmony to Delay) knob

VPp

Src (Source)

Harmony to Delay effects send.

VPp

Dl to Rv (Delay to Reverb) knob


Delay output to Reverb effects send.
Rev/Dl (Reverb/Delay Balance) knob

VPp

Reverb/Delay mix.
FX Lev (FX Level) knob

VPp

Reverb
VPp

The list of reverb types includes the following acoustic simulations: Living Room, Chamber, Club, Classic Hall, Concert Hall,
Large Cathedral, Vocal Studio, Vocal Room, Vocal Hall, Ambience, Live Reverb, Plate1, Plate2, and Spring.
Pre Delay

Tempo is received from MIDI.

Manual

The delay time is set using the Delay parameter.

R (Ratio)

VPp

Sets the ratio between the tempo and the resulting delay.

Sets the overall volume of the combined Reverb and Delay


effects.

Type

MIDI

VPp

Reverb Pre-delay time. Sets the delay time prior to the reverb
output. Large rooms typically have reverbs that start much later
than the initial signal.

Hi Freq Damp (High Frequency Damping)


High Frequency Damping.

VPp

Reference

Use this parameter to set the source of the tempo for the delay.
VPp

252

Global edit mode


Voice Processor Preset: Controls

Voice Processor Preset: Controls

Voice Processor: The optional Pitch


Correction and Voice Modeling modules

This page allows you to define four continuous and four switch
dedicated controllers for the Voice Processor, to be assigned to
any physical controller (pedal, footswitch, sliders).
For example, you can first assign the Lead Voice Level to the
Cnt. Ctl. A Voice Processor meta-controller, then assign the
Cnt. Ctl. A option to an Assignable Pedal or Slider.

Two optional software modules are available for the Voice Processor: Pitch Correction and Voice Modeling. These algorithms,
developed by TCHelicon, are the most sophisticated tools available today for voice shaping and correction.
You can purchase them as a single optional plug-in (SUG-TC1)
from our web site www.korgpa.com, or by contacting your Korg
Distributor.
To buy a licence for this software option, press the red Buy button next to each of the parameter names (pages Preset,
Thicken/Pitch Correction or Voice Modeling). The following dialog box will appear, showing you your Pa1X Purchase
Code:

Cnt. Ctl AD

VPp

Continuous controllers. See List of functions assignable to


Voice Processors Continuous Controls on page 381 for a list of
assignable parameters.
Sw. Ctl AD

VPp

Switch controllers. See List of functions assignable to Voice Processors Switch Controls on page 381 for a list of assignable
parameters.

Copy this code, and press Cancel to close the dialog box. Type
the code in the dedicated field of the purchase module (online or
on paper, depending on your purchase option).
After receiving the authorization code, open the above dialog
box again, then press the
(Text Edit) button in the display,
and type it in the Activation Key field.
Press OK to confirm. Your Pitch Correction and Voice Modeling
modules will become completely functional!

Global edit mode


Harmony and Tuning with the Voice Processor

253

Chord (Chordal) Mode

Harmony and Tuning with the Voice


Processor
Harmony
Here's where we can go into a little more depth about harmonies. We've tried to keep it practical, focusing on what Voice Processor can do for you.
Harmony Hold
Truly an innovation, the Harmony Hold feature lets you (on a
whim) sustain the backing harmony voices while you continue
to sing through them. On activation (press and hold the
assigned Damper, Assignable Footswitch, Assignable Switch or
EC5 switch), you can freeze whatever the harmony voices are
doing, and they will hold their notes (in a very natural way) until
you let the pedal go.

Chordal harmonies take your chord information to create intelligent, diatonic harmonies based on your voice. To make
Chordal harmonies, you need to input in real time the chords
of the song. This may be done either by playing on the keyboard,
via MIDI or through a programmed sequence of chords
included in the Harmony Track of a Song.
In Chordal mode the Voice Processor will only create harmony
voices that fall on the notes of the chord. Chordal harmonies are
intelligent because they decipher the chord youre playing and
the note youre singing to produce musically pleasing harmonies.
When one note above is defined as a harmony voice (Up1), the
next note from the chord above the input note is output for that
harmony voice.
The subsequent illustration shows the harmony notes for the C
major scale with a voicing selection of a C major chord and a
single one above.
Root: C, Chord Type: Maj, Voicing: Up1

See Pedal/Footswitch on page 235, EC5-AE on page 236,


and Damper Mode on page 242 for more information.
Harmony Modes

Notes Mode
In this mode, you provide the Voice Processor with specific note
information to determine the pitch of the harmony voices. This
is the most direct and flexible way of creating harmonies, allowing you to weave complex melodies and counter harmonies irrespective of your lead vocal.
Shift Mode
Also known as Fixed Interval, this takes the pitch of your lead
voice and creates harmonies a set number of semitones away,
based on that pitch. The method of creating harmonies, using a
fixed number of semitones relative to an input note or pitch, is
called chromatic harmony, the theory of which well go into
later. We consider this type of harmonizing to be non-intelligent
because Voice Processor is not set to any particular key or scale.
These are pure, parallel harmonies. The most common shift harmony voices are the 5th (7 semitones) and octave (12 semitones), ranging from two octaves below the input to two octaves
above the input pitch.
Below is the C Major scale, showing third above chromatic scale
harmony, as used in Voice Processor Shift Mode.

Black = Lead, Grey = Harmony

You might have noticed that each harmony note can cover more
than one input note, or that each input note doesnt necessarily
have a unique harmony note. For instance, C and D both have E
as the 3rd above, E and F share G, and so on. This gives a more
stepped sound to the harmony as the changes are both greater in
magnitude and less frequent than when using other harmony
methods (shift mode for example). The benefit of this method is
that it is very easy to integrate vocal harmonies into your songs if
you already know their chord progressions! The following lists
the chords available with respect to the root of C:
Major

Maj7

M7sus4

min

Eb

min6

Eb

min7

Eb

Bb

min7b5

Eb

Gb

Bb

dim

Eb

Gb

[Bbb (= A)]

Bb

7b5

Gb

Bb

aug

G#

aug7

G#

sus4

sus2

7sus4

Bb

Bb

Reference

The Voice Processor has five different harmony modes, which


give five unique methods of creating harmony. Once we get into
describing the more complex harmony modes, well be showing
you examples based on the C major scale. If you are unfamiliar
with this scale weve shown C major here.

Black = Lead & Grey = Harmony

254

Global edit mode


Harmony and Tuning with the Voice Processor

Scale (Scalic) mode

parameter description under Custom Voice Mapping on


page 250.

Harmonies use key and scale information to create musically


correct, diatonic harmonies. Most popular music uses a single
scale, so you usually only have to input the information at the
beginning of your song. Scalic harmonies are more dynamic
than the chordal harmonies because there are unique harmony
notes for each input note. The subsequent illustration shows the
harmony notes for the C major scale with a voicing selection of a
C major scale and a single third above harmony voice. You can
see from the next diagram that the Scalic harmonies are intelligent and closely follow your lead voice for a tighter sound.

It is also tricky to pick out the key in some songs. An example is


Sweet Home Alabama. Listening, you might think this song is
in the key of D, as thats the first chord, but the harmonies
actually work best in the key of G try running the song
through Voice Processor to hear for yourself.
Setting the scale can also take a bit of practice: for songs centered
around the third or root of the scale it might not sound like
theres any noticeable differences between the three major or
three minor scales. This is because your song doesnt hit any of
the scales altered notes. A melody centered around the fifth of
the scale, (such as B in the key of E), highlights the differences
between the scales. Try the Sha Lala Lala La Tee Daa chorus
of Van Morrisons Brown Eyed Girl (key: E, scale: major, 3rd
above voicing) with each major scale to hear the audible difference between them. For the minor scales, Santanas Evil Ways
(key: G, scale: minor, 3rd above voicing) highlights the differences between the three minor scales.

Black = Lead, Grey = Harmony

Under the Harmony page, is a parameter called Smooth.


When set to 100% the harmony voices follow your input pitch,
errors and all, but when set to 0% the harmonies will jump
directly to the scalic harmony notes, kind of like a hard pitch
correction on the harmony voice. Setting the Smooth parameter
between 0 and 100% is like having variable amounts of pitch
correction on the harmonies. Voice Processor has five preprogrammed harmony scales: three major, three minor and one
custom per preset. To create a custom scale or pitch map see the

MAJ1

MAJ2

MAJ3

MIN1

MIN2

MIN3

The following table illustrates the third and fifth above for a
given input note to illustrate the differences between the six different scales. nc means no change, in that the harmony voice
will simply keep its previous pitch until the lead voice pitch
changes to a non nc note.

Lead Voice

C#

Eb

F#

G#

Bb

3rd above

nc

nc

nc

nc

5th above

nc

nc

nc

nc

3rd above

nc

nc

nc

nc

5th above

nc

nc

nc

nc

3rd above

nc

nc

nc

Bb

nc

5th above

nc

nc

Bb

nc

nc

3rd above

Eb

nc

nc

Ab

nc

Bb

nc

nc

5th above

nc

Bb

Bb

nc

nc

Eb

nc

nc

3rd above

Eb

nc

nc

nc

Bb

nc

nc

5th above

nc

Bb

nc

nc

Eb

nc

nc

3rd above

Eb

nc

nc

Ab

nc

nc

nc

5th above

nc

Bb

nc

nc

Eb

nc

nc

Global edit mode


Harmony and Tuning with the Voice Processor

255

Diatonic and Chromatic

Just Tuning

We've described scalic and chordal harmonies as diatonic, and


shift harmonies as chromatic; but what do those words mean?
Look at a piano keyboard. Between middle C and the next C
there are twelve keys 7 white keys and 5 black keys. Each of
those keys are pitched one semitone apart for a total of, you
guessed it, 12 semitones. The chromatic scale uses all twelve
semitone notes opposed to the diatonic scales. Thus there is only
one chromatic scale, but 12 each of the major, minor, etc. diatonic scales (C major, C# major, D major, etc). Most of us have
grown up hearing the traditional doh ray me fah so la tee doh
diatonic scale, so that harmonies based on the diatonic scale
sound correct.

Why just tuning? Although probably no one has ever told you
this, your expensive grand piano and the last great keyboard synthesizer you bought are both out of tune! Well, to be fair we can
say instead that they are all tuned using Equal temperament.
Harmony is the result of the interaction between differing audible frequencies in ratios that sound musical to the human ear. A
more exact ratio leads to a nicer sounding harmony.

To recap: we have three different harmony modes that use chromatic or diatonic scales.

The bottom line is that the approximations of equal temperament tuning are practical, but imperfect. Using the Voice Processor with Just tuning will definitely expand your musical
horizons!

Shifting, which uses the chromatic, 12 semitone scale, changes


the input pitch by a fixed number of semitones:

Just tuning is practice of maintaining the relative (and perfect)


ratios between pitches, creating perfect harmonies.

Chordal, which uses the root, third, fifth and sometimes seventh
of the many diatonic scales, pitches the harmony voice to the
closest note contained within the chord:

Scalic, which uses one of many diatonic scales, pitches the harmony voice to the nearest note contained within the scale:

Theory aside, the best way to get great sound is to experiment


with all of Voice Processor' possible harmony modes. Not only
will you develop an intuitive sonic sense of what works best
where, but by investigating different permutations and combinations you could discover some delightful sounds you might otherwise have missed.

Singers, especially when performing multi-part a cappella


music, base their tuning on how it harmonically sounds with
other singers. The natural tendency, and what sounds best, is to
sing with just tuning so that beating is minimized. One of the
goals in barbershop quartet singing is to strive for just relative
intonation so that a sub-frequency is audible. Achieving this
goal results in what barbershop fans often describe as the coveted ring and lock sound. In barbershop music it is the lead
singer's responsibility to try to sing the melody as close to the
tuning of a piano (equal temperament) as possible. The other
singers must then tune their harmonies to the melody using just
relative intonation. The Voice Processor is able to do this in both
the Just and Barbershop tuning modes.
When the Just or Barbershop Modes are selected in the Voice
Processor, the harmony tunings are based on the following relationships:
Minor 3rd

3 cycles for every 4 cycles of the input

Major 3rd

5 cycles for every 4 cycles of the input

5th

3 cycles for every 2 cycles of the input.

Barbershop differs from Just tuning in Chordal mode. Just tuning will use the root of the chord for the tuning reference, while
Barbershop tuning uses the input notes as the tuning reference.
For this reason it is better to use Barbershop in an a-cappella situation and Just when playing with other instruments, because
Just tuning sounds more in-tune with the other instruments that
most likely have equal temperament tuning.
Our best advice is to experiment and use your ears!

Reference

What does this mean, harmony-wise? Diatonic scale harmonies


can only use notes within specified scale or chord, so a third
above harmony voice actually varies between three and four
semitones above the lead note where the chromatic harmony
would stay exactly four semitones (a major 3rd) above each note.

Most instruments (like the piano) are absolute by nature. Each


note on the keyboard has a specific pitch. Equal temperament
tuning uses approximations for the tuning of each note, allowing
us to easily alter the key of our music without re-tuning our
instruments. Unfortunately, with this method of tuning we lose
the ability to create perfect ratios when playing multiple notes.
As a result, much of the harmony youve heard in music has not
been perfectly in tune!

256

Global edit mode


Video Interface: Video Out

Video Interface: Video Out

Touch Panel Calibration

If your Pa1X is fitted with a Video Interface Board (VIF3), use


this page to adjust its parameters.

From time to time (for example, after loading a new operating


system), calibrating your Color TouchView display may be
necessary to make pointing more precise. If so, use this page.

System

1.

When in this page, first touch exactly inside the upper left
set of arrows.

2.

Then, touch exactly inside the lower right set of arrows.

3.

Press done to confirm the new calibration.

Gbl

Selects the video standard (PAL or NTSC).


Character

Gbl

Select the character size (Big or Small).


Colors

Gbl

Selects a color set for the lyrics and background.


16
Position X/Y

Color set.
Gbl

These parameters lets you adjust the image position on the


external video monitor.

Touch Panel Calibration reset


In case the touch screen has become so misaligned, that it is very
difficult to use the Touch Panel Calibration function, you can
completely reset it, then fine-tune the adjustment with the above
function.
To reset the touch panel, press GLOBAL to enter the Global
mode, then press it again, and keep it pressed, until the following
dialog box appears.

Press GLOBAL to execute the reset, or EXIT to close this dialog


box without any reset.

Global edit mode


Page menu

Page menu
Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.

257

This way, the next time you will turn the Pa1X on, the preferred
Styles, Sounds and Performances will be still assigned to the relevant buttons.

Write Global - Global Setup dialog box


Open this window by selecting the Write Global-Global Setup
item from the page menu. Here, you can save most settings, programmed in the Global edit mode, to the Global file in memory.

Write Global-Global Setup


Select this command to open the Write Global-Global Setup dialog box, and save global settings that are not tied to a single
operative mode. These settings are programmed in the Global
edit mode.

Parameters saved in the Global Setup area of the Global are


marked with the

Gbl

symbol through the users manual.

See Write Global - Global Setup dialog box on page 257 for
information on the dialog box.
Write Global-Midi Setup
Select this command to open the Write Global-Midi Setup dialog box, and save the current MIDI settings to a MIDI Setup.
See Write Global - Midi Setup dialog box on page 257 for
more information.

Write Global - Midi Setup dialog box


Open this window by selecting the Write Global-Midi Setup
item from the page menu. Here, you can save all MIDI settings
to a MIDI Setup, that is included in the Global file in memory.

Select this command to open the Write Global-Talk Configuration dialog box, and save the current Talk settings (see Voice
Processor Setup: Talk on page 244).
See Write Global - Talk Configuration dialog box on page 258
for more information.
Write Global-Voice Processor Setup

Parameters saved in the MIDI Setup area of the Global are

Select this command to open the Write Global-Voice Processor


Setup dialog box, and save the current Voice Processor Setup settings (see from page 242).

marked with the

See Write Global - Voice Processor Setup dialog box on


page 258 for more information.
Write Global-Voice Processor Preset
Select this command to open the Write Global-Voice Processor
Preset dialog box, and save the current Voice Processor Preset
settings (see from page 245).
See Write Global - Voice Processor Preset dialog box on
page 258 for more information.
Write Global-Auto Select Setup
Choose this command to save the preferred Styles, Sounds and
Performances assigned to the control panel STYLE and PERFORMANCE/SOUND buttons, via the Auto Select functions
(see page 234).

Mid

symbol through the users manual.

Name
Name of the MIDI Setup to be saved. Press the
(Text Edit)
button next to the name to open the Text Edit window and modify the name.
Midi Setup
One of the 8 available MIDI Setup locations, where to save current MIDI settings.

Reference

Write Global-Talk Configuration

258

Global edit mode


Write Global - Talk Configuration dialog box

Write Global - Talk Configuration dialog


box

Write Global - Voice Processor Preset


dialog box

Open this window by selecting the Write Global-Talk Configuration item from the page menu. Here, you can save Voice processors Talk settings (see Voice Processor Setup: Talk on
page 244).

Open this window by selecting the Write Global-Voice Processor


Preset item from the page menu. Here, you can save current settings for the Voice Processor Preset edit section (see starting
from page 245).

Parameters saved in the Talk Configuration area of the Global

Parameters saved in the Voice Processor Preset area of the Global

are marked with the

Tlk

symbol through the users manual.

are marked with the

VPp
VPs

symbol through the users manual.

Name

Write Global - Voice Processor Setup


dialog box

Name of the VP Preset to be saved. Press the


(Text Edit)
button next to the name to open the Text Edit window and modify the name.

Open this window by selecting the Write Global-Voice Processor


Setup item from the page menu. Here, you can save current settings for the Voice Processor Setup edit section (see starting from
page 242).

Voice Preset

Parameters saved in the Voice Processor Setup area of the Global


are marked with the

VPs

symbol through the users manual.

Name
Name of the VP Setup to be saved. Press the
(Text Edit) button next to the name to open the Text Edit window and modify
the name.
Voice Setup
One of the 16 available Voice Setup locations, where to save current VP Setup settings.
Save and use as default
Check this option when saving a VP Setup, you would like to be
automatically selected when turning the instrument on.

One of the 128 available Voice Preset locations, where to save


current VP Preset settings.

Disk edit mode


Storage devices and internal memory

259

Disk edit mode

Storage devices and internal memory


During a Disk operation, files are usually exchanged between a
storage device and the internal memory. The Pa1X can use three
different mass storage device types:

Floppy Disk

Hard Disk (optional on the Pa1X with speakers)

CD (optional; only available for reading on version 1.0)

A device can be selected by using the Device pop-up menu,


available on the lower left corner of most Disk pages:
Device popup menu

Two internal memory areas are available: the SSD and RAM.

The SSD (Solid State Disk) is the non-volatile memory,


where Styles, Sounds, Performance, STSs and User Multisamples are contained. This area is not deleted when turning the instrument off.
The RAM (Random Access Memory) is the volatile memory, where Songs and User PCM Sample are contained.
This area is deleted when the instrument is turned off.

Selecting and deselecting files

File types
The following tables describe all the file and folder types the
Pa1X can manage. Here are the files you can read or write on the
Pa1X.
Extension

File/folder type

SET

All the User data. (This is a folder containing


other folders).

BKP

Backup folder, created with the Full Resource


Backup function of the Disk > Utility page. (This
is a folder containing other folders).

GBL

Global

VOC

Voice Processor Presets

PRF

Performance

PCG

Sound

PCM

Sample

STY

Style

PAD

Pad

SBD

SongBook

SBL

SongBooks Custom List

JBX

Jukebox

MID

Midi file (Standard MIDI File, SMF)

MP3(a)

MP3 file

(a). To read and write MP3 files, the optional EXBP-MP3 board is
required.

The Pa1X can also read (but not write) the following types of
data.
Extension

File type

KAR

Karaoke file

CDA

Audio CD Track

PCG

Korg Triton Programs

KSF

Korg Trinity/Triton Sample

(a)

While a file list is shown in the display, you can select any item by
touching it. The selected item is highlighted.
You can deselect all items in any of the following ways:

KMP

Korg Trinity/Triton Multisample


Akai Sample

Touch an empty area in the file list (if available).

Press the Device pop-up icon, and select the current device
again.

Akai Program

AIF

AIFF audio files

WAV

WAVE audio files

(a). To read Audio CD Tracks, the optional CDRW-1 CD player/writer is


required.

Reference

The Disk edit mode is the place where you can manage files. This
edit environment overlaps the current operating mode (Style
Play, Song Play, Sequencer, Sound Edit).

260

Disk edit mode


Disk structure

Disk structure

Page structure

Each disk (and the internal memory) can contain files and folders. The data in Pa1X is slightly more rigorously structured than
in a computer, due to the pre-configured kind of data inside the
instruments memory. The diagram below shows the global
structure of a Pa1X disk.

All edit pages share some basic elements.


Edit mode

Page menu
icon
Disk path

Note: Style banks from 1 to 16 (Factory Styles) can be seen in Disk


mode only when the Factory Style and Pad Protect parameter is
set to Off (see page 272), and only when loading or saving a single
Style bank.

List of files

Scrollbar

MYDIR.SET
GLOBAL

Commands

SETUP.GBL
VPPRESET.VOC

Tabs

SOUND
PERFORM

USER01.PCG
1 Piano 1

128 SynBrass22

BANK01.PRF
1-1 Grand Piano

1-8 Full Strings

USER02.PCG
1 SopranoSax

128 Noise

BANK02.PRF
2-1 Jazz Brass

2-8 Jazz Strings

USERDK.PCG
1 Standard Kit

64 Orchestral Kit

BANK.PRF
BANK20.PRF
20-1 Rock Brass

20-8 Rock Strings


SONGBOOK

Device pop-up menu

Edit mode
This indicates that the instrument is in Disk mode.
Page menu icon
Press this icon to open the page menu (see Page menu on
page 276).

STYLE

Disk path
BANK01.STY
1-1 8 Beat 1

1-32 8 Beat 16

SONGDB.SBD
BANK.STY
BANK16.STY
16-1 Traditional 1

16-32 Traditional 16
USER01.STY
U1-1 User 1

U1-32 User 16

Full path of the directory currently shown in the display.


List of files
This area shows the files and folder contained in the selected
device.
You can touch one of the heading label above the list to change
the order in which files are shown. For example, by touching the
Name label, the list is alphabetically re-ordered according to
the file names. The selected label turns red, showing the currently selected ordering.

USER02.STY
U2-1 User 1

U2-32 User 16
USER03.STY
U3-1 User 1

U3-32 User 16

Main page
There is no main page in the disk edit mode. When pressing
EXIT, you exit the Disk mode, and the underlying operating
mode in the background is recalled.

The corresponding items in the page menu are automatically


updated to reflect these changes (see Ordered by Name and
Ordered by Type on page 277).
Scrollbar
Use the scrollbar to scroll the list. Touching the arrows will scroll
one step at a time, while touching the bar will scroll one page at a
time.
Pressing the arrows while SHIFT is kept pressed jumps to the
previous or next alphabetical section, or file/folder type
(depending on the selected display order).
Device pop-up menu
Use this menu to select one of the available storage devices.

Disk edit mode


Navigation tools

261

Commands
Commands may be different depending on the shown page.
They are detailed in each relevant section.
Tabs

Navigation tools
When in a Disk page, you can use any of the following commands to browse through the files and folders.

Use tabs to select one of the edit pages of the current edit section.
Scrollbar
See Scrollbar above.
TEMPO/VALUE controls
Use these controls scroll the list up or down.
Device pop-up menu
See Device pop-up menu above.
Load/Save/Copy/Erase button
Executes the disk operation.
Open button
Opens the selected folder or directory (whose name begins with
the

icon.

Close button

Reference

Closes the current folder or directory, returning to the parent


(upper) level.

262

Disk edit mode


Load

Load
In this page you can load User data files (Performances, User
Sounds, User Styles, the SongBook, User PCM, the Global) from
a disk to the internal memory (SSD and RAM).

Loading all data of a specified type


You can load all User data of a specified type with a single operation.
1.

If loading from floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk
drive.

2.

Select the source device, by using the Device pop-up menu.


When device is selected, its content will appear in the display.

3.

If the folder you are looking for is inside another folder,


select the latter and press the Open button to open it. Press
the Close button to go back to the parent folder.

4.

Select the .SET folder containing the data you wish to


load, and press Open to open the .SET folder. A list of
User data appears (Global, Performance, SongBook,
Sounds, Style).

5.

Select the folder containing the type of data you are looking
for, and press Load to confirm your selection.

Note: While in this page, only data allowed for loading are shown.
All other files are hidden.
Warning: When loading a .SET folder containing Sounds associated with PCM data, all existing PCM data in memory are deleted.
Save them before loading the folder.

Loading all the User data


You can load all the User data with a single operation.
1.

If loading from floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk
drive.

2.

Select the source device, by using the Device pop-up menu.


When the device is selected, its content will appear in the
display.

3.

If the folder you are looking for is inside another folder,


select this latter and press the Open button to open it. Press
the Close button to go back to the parent folder.

4.

Select the .SET folder containing the data you wish to


load, and press Load to confirm the selection.

Note: Most data loaded from disk is merged with data


already existing in memory. For example, if there is data
in all three USER Style banks in memory (USER01,
USER02, USER03), and there is only the USER01 Style
bank on disk, the USER01 bank is overwritten, while
USER02 and USER03 banks are left unchanged.
As a result, you will have a STYLE folder in memory containing the USER01 bank you just loaded, and the old
USER02 and USER03 banks.
Warning: When loading a .SET folder containing PCM
data, all existing PCM data in memory are deleted. Save
them before loading the folder, by selecting the PCM option
during a Save All operation (see Saving the full memory content on page 265).
To see if a .SET folder contains PCM data, open it and look
for a PCM folder.

Note: Data loaded from disk, and data already in memory


are merged. For example, if there is data in all three USER
Style banks in memory (USER01, USER02, USER03), and
there is only the USER01 Style bank on disk, the USER01
bank is overwritten, while USER02 and USER03 banks
are left unchanged.
As a result, you will have a STYLE folder in memory containing the USER01 bank you just loaded, and the old
USER02 and USER03 banks.

Disk edit mode


Load

Loading a single bank

7.

You can load a single bank of User data (User Sounds, User
Styles, Performances) with a single operation. A bank corresponds to a STYLE SELECT or PERFORMANCE/SOUND
SELECT button.
1.

If loading from floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk
drive.

2.

Select the source device, by using the Device pop-up menu.


When device is selected, its content will appear in the display.

3.

If the folder you are looking for is inside another folder,


select this latter and press the Open button to open it. Press
the Close button to go back to the parent folder.

4.

Select the .SET folder containing the data you wish to


load, and press Open to open the .SET folder. A list of
User data appears (Global, Performance, SongBook,
Sounds, Style).

Select the target bank, and press OK to load the source


bank.

Warning: After confirming, all User data contained in the


bank in memory is deleted.

Loading a single item


You can load a single User item with a single operation.
1.

If loading from floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk
drive.

2.

Select the source device, by using the Device pop-up menu.


When device is selected, its content will appear in the display.

3.

If the folder you are looking for is inside another folder,


select this latter and press the Open button to open it. Press
the Close button to go back to the parent folder.

4.

Select the .SET folder containing the data you wish to


load, and press Open to open the .SET folder. A list of
User data appears (Global, Performance, SongBook,
Sounds, Style).

5.

Select the folder containing the type of data you are looking
for, and press Open to open the selected folder. A list of
User banks appears.

6.

Select the bank you are looking for, and press Open to open
it. A list of User items appears.

Select the folder containing the type of data you are looking
for, and press Open to open the selected folder. A list of
User banks appears.

Reference

5.

263

6.

Select the bank you are looking for, and press Load to confirm the selection. A dialog box appears, asking you to
select one of the available User banks in memory.

In the page above, the previously selected Style bank will be


loaded into the bank 1 (USER1 button) in memory. The
existing Styles in memory will be deleted and overwritten.

264
7.

Disk edit mode


Load

Select the item you are looking for, and press Load to confirm the load. A dialog box appears, asking you to select
one of the available User locations in memory.

Style Performance to write changes to the Style Performance. Press OK twice to confirm.
8.

Due to difference in Sounds, you will probably make some


adjustment to the old Styles, once they are loaded in Pa1X
(changing the Sound, Volume, Pan, Tempo, Drum Mapping, Wrap Around).

9.

To make the Sound assignment to the Style tracks effective,


be sure the Original Style Sounds parameter is not
checked (see page 80).

10. Save the Style Performance again. Select the Write Current

In the dialog box above, the previously selected Style will be


loaded into location 01 of the bank U01 (USER1 button) in
memory. The existing Style at the same memory location
will be deleted and overwritten.
Empty locations are named <empty>.
8.

Select the target location, and press OK to load the source


file.
Warning: After confirming, the item you are overwriting in
memory will be deleted.

Style Performance to write changes to the Style Performance. Press OK to confirm.

Loading Pa80/60 data


You can load Pa80/60 data exactly as if they were Pa1X data. The
only difference is that the SOUND folder of Pa1X is called
PROGRAM in the Pa80/60. Therefore, to load Sounds from
Pa80/60 disks, you must accomplish one of the following operations:

Either rename the PROGRAM folder SOUND (by


using a personal computer) before loading a .SET folder;
or

First load the .SET folder, then separately load the .PCG
file from the PROGRAM folder.

Loading i-Series data


Pa1X is compatible with the Styles of the older i-Series instruments. You can load them as if they were ordinary Pa1X data.
1.

Insert an older i-Series floppy disk into the disk drive.

2.

Press DISK to go to the Disk mode. Select the Load page if


needed.

3.

While in the Load page, select the floppy disk (FD) from
the Device pop-up menu.

4.

If you are reading an i30 disk, select the .SET folder and
press the Open button in the display.

5.

Select the .STY folder.

6.

At this point, you can load the whole .STY folder, or open
it and select a single Style.

To load the whole folder, press the Load button in the


display. If it contains more than 16 Styles, they will be
loaded into the USER banks sequentially, otherwise you
will be prompted to select one of the three USER Style
banks in memory. Once the target bank is selected, press
Load to load the bank. The Are you sure? message will
appear. Press OK to confirm, or Cancel to abort.
To load a single Style, press Open in the display to open
the .STY folder. Since a conversion will be started at
this point, please wait some seconds for the operation to
be completed.
Select the Style to load, then press Load. You will be
prompted to select a target location in memory. Once
the target location is selected, press Load to load the
Style. The Are you sure? message will appear. Press OK
to confirm, or Cancel to abort.
Note: Loading a whole .SET folder from an i30 disk may
take very long. You are advised to load a single bank or a
single Style a time.
7.

Go to the Style Play mode, and select (one of) the loaded
Style. Adjust the Tempo, then select the Write Current

Disk edit mode


Save

Saving the full memory content

Save

You can save the full memory content with a single operation.

Note: While in this page, only data allowed for saving are shown.
All other files are hidden.
Here are the various types of files contained in the internal
memory:
contains

If saving to a floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk drive.

2.

The full content (All) of the internal memory is already


shown. Select it, and press Save to confirm the selection.
The list of files of the target device is shown.

3.

If needed, select a different target device, by using the


Device pop-up menu. When the target device is selected, its
content will appear in the display.

4.

At this point, you can:

and will create on


disk

Press the New SET button and create a new .SET folder
(see Creating a new .SET folder on page 268), or
Select an existing .SET folder.

All

All the User data in


memory

A .SET folder

Style

The USER 01-03 Styles

A STYLE folder inside


a .SET folder

Sound

The USER Sounds and


Drum Kits

A SOUNDS folder
inside a .SET folder

Perform (Performances)

The Performances

A PERFORM folder
inside a .SET folder

SongBook

The SongBook database

A SONGBOOK folder
inside a .SET folder

PCM

All the Multisamples


contained in the SSD,
and the Samples contained in RAM

A PCM folder inside a


.SET folder

Global

The Global. All parame-

A GLOBAL folder
inside a .SET folder. A
.VOC file will be created inside the GLOBAL folder, containing
Voice Processor presets

ters marked with


through the various
chapters are saved in the
Global. Voice Processor
presets are saved too.

1.

5.

Press Save to confirm. A dialog box appears, asking you to


select the type of data to save:

In the above dialog box, check all data type you wish to save
to disk.
6.

Press OK to confirm, or Cancel to abort.

Warning: After confirming, all data of the selected type in


the target folder is deleted.

Reference

In this page, you can save User data from the internal memory to
a disk. You can save single files, banks, or all the User files of the
internal memory (i.e., the SSD device).

The file/folder
type

265

266

Disk edit mode


Save

Saving all data of a specified type

1.

If saving to a floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk drive.

In addition to the above, you can save all data of a specified type
by selecting the corresponding folder.

2.

The full content (All) of the internal memory is already


shown. Select it, and press Open to open it. A list of User
data types appear (each type is a separate folder).

3.

Select the folder containing the type of data you wish to


save, and press Open to open it. The list of contained banks
is shown.

4.

Select the bank to be saved, and press Save To to confirm


the selection. The list of files of the target device is shown.

5.

If needed, select a different target device, by using the


Device pop-up menu. When the target device is selected, its
content will appear in the display.

6.

At this point, you can:

1.

If saving to a floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk drive.

2.

The full content (All) of the internal memory is already


shown. Select it, and press Open to open it. A list of User
data types appear (each type is a separate folder).

3.

Select the folder containing the type of data you wish to


save, and press Save To to confirm the selection. The list of
files of the target device is shown.

4.

If needed, select a different target device, by using the


Device pop-up menu. When the target device is selected, its
content will appear in the display.

5.

At this point, you can:


Press the New SET button and create a new .SET folder
(see Creating a new .SET folder on page 268), or
Select an existing .SET folder.

6.

Press Save to confirm.

Warning: After confirming, all data of the selected type in


the target folder is deleted.

Saving a single bank


You can save a single User bank with a single operation. A bank
corresponds to a button on the control panel of the instrument
(i.e. a button of the STYLE section).

Press the New SET button and create a new .SET folder
(see Creating a new .SET folder on page 268), or
Select an existing .SET folder.

Disk edit mode


Save

7.

Press Save to confirm. A dialog box appears, asking you to


select one of the available User locations inside the folder:

In the dialog box above, the previously selected bank of


Styles will be saved to the bank User 01 (corresponding to
the USER1 button) inside the selected folder. Three User
banks are available.
8.

267

4.

Select the desired bank, and press Open to gain access to


the single files.

5.

Once you have selected the file that you want to save, press
Save To to confirm the selection. The list of files of the target device is shown.

6.

If needed, select a different target device, by using the


Device pop-up menu. When the target device is selected, its
content will appear in the display.

7.

At this point, you can:

Press OK to confirm, or Cancel to abort.

Warning: After confirming, the same bank in the target


folder is deleted.

Saving a single item


You can save a single User item with a single operation.
1.

If saving on a floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk drive.

2.

The full content (All) of the internal memory is already


shown. Select it, and press Open to open it. A list of User
data types appear (each type is a separate folder).

Press the New SET button and create a new .SET folder
(see Creating a new .SET folder on page 268), or

8.

3.

Press Save to confirm. A dialog box appears, asking you to


select one of the available User locations inside the selected
folder

Select the folder containing the type of data you wish to


save, and press Open to open it. The list of contained banks
is shown.

In the dialog box above, the previously selected Style will be


saved to location 01 inside the bank U01 (corresponding to
the USER1 button) inside the selected folder.
9.

Press OK to confirm, or Cancel to abort.

Warning: After confirming, the same item in the target


folder is deleted.

Reference

Select an existing .SET folder.

268

Disk edit mode


Copy

Creating a new .SET folder


Pa1X proprietary data must be saved in special folder with the
.SET extension. These special folders can be saved inside ordinary folders.
When saving, you can save onto existing .SET folders, or you
can create a new folder of this type. Here is how to do it.
1.

When the directory of the target device is shown in the display, the New SET button appears among the buttons
below the file list.

2.

Press the New SET button. A dialog box appears, asking


you to enter a name for the new .SET folder.

Copy
In this page you can copy files and folders. Folders can be generic
or .SET folders. In addition, you can copy the content of the
generic folder you are in. You can copy inside the same device, or
from a device to a different one.
To preserve the data structure integrity, during Copy operations
you cant open .SET folders and copy only one of the files it
contains. You can only open generic folders.

Copying a folders content


If nothing is selected while a folder is open in the display, you
can copy the folders content, without copying the folder itself.
3.

Press the
(Text Edit) button to open the Text Edit window. Enter the name, then press OK to confirm and close
the Text Edit window.

4.

Press OK to create the new folder and exit the dialog box.

Note: During the Copy procedure, you cant open a .SET folder.
You can, however, open any generic folder.
1.

If copying from or to a floppy disk, insert the disk into the


disk drive.

2.

Select the source device, by using the Device pop-up menu.

3.

If the folder you are looking for is inside another folder,


select this latter and press the Open button to open it. Press
the Close button to go back to the parent folder.

4.

To copy the current folders content, without copying the


folder itself, do not select anything in the display.

5.

Press Copy To to confirm. The target device appears.


Note: If the selected device is not available, the Device not
found, or unknown format message will appear. A different
device will be automatically selected.

6.

If needed, select the target device, by using the Device popup menu.

7.

If you want to select a different folder, use the Open and


Close buttons to move through the directories.
To copy into an existing generic folder (not a .SET
folder), select that folder.
To copy into the current folder, do not select anything.

8.

Once the target is selected, press Copy.


If a file or folder with the same name of the source data
already exists at the target location, the Overwrite dialog
box will appear (see Overwriting existing files or folders
on page 269).

Disk edit mode


Copy

269

Copying a single file or folder

To select more files or folders discontinuously:

You can copy a single file or folder, from a generic folder to a different one. The file or folder must be located in the root (the
main/highest level in the disk hierarchy) or into a generic folder.
You cant copy single files or folders from inside a .SET folder.

1.

Press the Mode button to choose the


SHIFT button.

2.

Select the first file or folder to be selected.

3.

Press and keep the SHIFT button pressed.

4.

Select a second file or folder to be selected.

5.

While keeping the SHIFT button pressed, continue selecting the other files or folders to be selected.

6.

Release the SHIFT button.

1.

If copying from or to a floppy disk, insert the disk into the


disk drive.

2.

Select the source device, by using the Device pop-up menu.

3.

Select the folder containing the file or folder you wish to


copy. If it is contained in another folder, press the Open
button to open it. Press Close to go back to the previous
hierarchic level.

To deselect the files or folders:

Select the file or folder to be copied, then press Copy To to


confirm its selection. The target device appears.

To deselect one or more file or folder, without deselecting


everything, keep SHIFT pressed and touch the file or folder
to be deselected.

Note: If the selected device is not available, the Device not


found, or unknown format message will appear. A different
device will be automatically selected.

To deselect everything, select any other file or folder. All


selected files and folders will be deselected.

Overwriting existing files or folders

4.

Press Open to open the folder containing the file or folder


to be copied.

5.

6.

If needed, select the target device, by using the Device popup menu.

7.

When the target device content appears in the display,


select the target folder. Press Open to open a folder, or
Close to close it.

8.

option for the

When copying files, a file or folder with the same name of a


source element might be found in the target device. In this case,
Pa1X asks you if you want to overwrite it.
When a duplicate file or folder is met, the following dialog box
appears:

Once the target is selected, press Copy.

Cancel

The procedure is interrupted.

Multiple file selection

No

While in the Erase and Copy pages of the Disk mode, you can
select several files or folders at the same time before executing
the operation. Files or folders can be selected consecutively (i.e.,
in a row), or discontinuously (i.e., with other files or folders in
the middle).

The file or folder is not overwritten. The source


file or folder is not copied. The procedure will
continue with the other files and folders.

Yes

The file or folder is overwritten. The procedure


will continue with the other files and folders.

Yes (to) All

The file or folder is overwritten. Any following


duplicate file or folders will be overwritten as
well, without this dialog box appearing again.
The procedure will continue with the other files
and folders.

To choose either to select files in a consecutive or discontinue


way, use the Mode button on the right of the page command
buttons, to choose an option for the SHIFT button:
Choose this option to select files or folders consecutively (i.e., in a row).
Choose this option to select files or folders discontinuously (i.e., with other files or folders in
the middle).
To select more files or folders consecutively:
1.

Press the Mode button to choose the


SHIFT button.

2.

Select the first file or folder to be selected.

3.

Press and keep the SHIFT button pressed.

4.

Select the last file or folder to be selected.

5.

Release the SHIFT button.

option for the

Reference

If a file or folder with the same name of the source data


already exists at the target location, the Overwrite dialog
box will appear (see Overwriting existing files or folders
below).

270

Disk edit mode


Erase

Erase

Format

The Erase function lets you erase files and folders from the disks.

The Format function lets you initialize a device.

With the Erase function you will be able to select the internal
memory (SSD device), and erase files from there. You cannot,
however, delete folders from the internal memory, since they are
used by the operating system.

Warning: When formatting a device, all data it contains is lost forever!

Erase procedure
1.

If erasing from a floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk
drive.

2.

If needed, select a different device, by using the Device


pop-up menu.

3.

If the file or folder you are looking for is inside another


folder, select this latter and press the Open button to open
it. Press the Close button to go back to the parent folder.

4.

Select the file or folder to erase.

5.

Press Erase to delete the selected item.

Multiple file selection


See Multiple file selection on page 269 for information on how
to select more files or folders to be erased at the same time.

Volume Label
Use this parameter to assign a name to the device to be formatted.
Press the
(Text Edit) button to open the Text Edit window.
Enter the name, then press OK to confirm and close the Text
Edit window.
Quick Format
This is a very fast format command, that you can use on previously formatted disks. This command rewrites just the FAT (File
Allocation Table) of the disk, without actual reformatting of all
sectors.
If it cannot be executed, the Quick Format failed. Full Format?
message appears. Press Yes to proceed with the Full Format, or
No to cancel.
1.

If formatting a floppy disk, insert a 3.5 HD or DD/DS


floppy disk into the disk drive, and select this option to format it.
If formatting a CD-RW, insert it into the CD drive.

2.

Select the Quick Format option.

3.

Press the Execute button in the display to confirm formatting.

4.

The If you confirm, all data in the HD/FD will be lost. Are
you sure? message appears in the display. Press Yes to confirm, or No to cancel.
Note: When formatting the hard disk, an additional warning
appears, to avoid accidental data loss.

Full Format
This is the complete format command, where each sector of the
disk is formatted. It is slower than the Quick Format command,
but sometimes more reliable.
See above for the procedure.
Execute button
Press this button, after setting all the options in this page, to execute the Format command.

Disk edit mode


Utility

271

1.

If you are making a backup on floppy disks, prepare at least


six disks. Disks dont need to be formatted, because Pa1X
will format them for you during the Backup procedure.

2.

Select the Backup Resources command, then press Execute.


The target device appears.

Save OS to Floppy Disk

3.

If backing up to floppy disks, insert the first backup disk.

This command starts an Operating System backup, to save a


copy of the instruments Operating System on three floppy disks.

4.

If needed, select a different device, by using the Device


pop-up menu.

Note: Should you not do a back-up and your internal data becomes
damaged, you can download the data from www.korgpa.com, or
ask your local Korg dealer.

5.

If you wish to save data inside another folder, select this latter and press the Open button to open it. Press the Close
button to go back to the parent folder.

1.

6.

Select the folder where to save data, and press Backup to


save it. If nothing is selected, data will be saved to the current directory.

Utility

Prepare three formatted, empty disks (1.44MB, MS-DOS


formatted). You can prepare this kind of disk using a PC or
the Pa1X itself (see Format on page 270). Clearly write
the disk progressive number on each disk label.

After pressing Backup, a dialog box will appear, asking you


to select a name for the backup file, and whether compression must be turned on or off during the backup.

Note: You cant prepare a Pa1X OS disk on a Macintosh. After


formatting, the Mac includes some invisible files in the root,
that may interfere with the Pa1X OS loading procedure.
2.

Select the Save OS to Floppy Disk command, then press the


Execute button in the display.

3.

When asked, insert a disk and press OK.


If a disk is not formatted or empty, Pa1X asks if you want to
format it. Press Yes to format the disk. Pa1X first tries a
Quick Format, then makes a Full Format if the former is
not possible.

4.

When finished, save the disks in a safe place.

Backup Resources

Press the
(Text Edit) button to open the Text Edit window. Enter the name, and confirm by pressing OK.

This command starts a backup of all internal Factory and User


data (Styles, Sounds, Performances) excluding the Operating
System. A .BKP file is created on disk(s).

We suggest you check Compression, to save space on the


backup device. However, with compression turned on, the
operation will last longer.

Note: Should you not do a back-up and your internal data becomes
damaged, you can download the original data from
www.korgpa.com. On the Pa1X Pro, a backup file has been provided on the hard disk, under the name PA1X_100.

7.

Press OK to start the backup.

8.

If backing up to floppy disks, when the Pa1X asks for it


insert a new disk into the floppy disk drive. Write the disk
number on each disks label.
If a disk is not formatted or empty, Pa1X asks if you want to
format it. Press Yes to format the disk. Pa1X first tries a
Quick Format, then makes a Full Format if the former is
not possible.

9.

When finished, save the disks in a safe place.

Restore Resources
This command restores the backup of the internal Factory and
User data, created with the Backup Resources command.
Note: Should you not do a back-up and your internal data becomes
damaged, you can download the original data from

Reference

This page includes a set of backup utilities.

272

Disk edit mode


Preferences

www.korgpa.com. On the Pa1X Pro, a backup file has been provided on the hard disk, under the name PA1X_100.
Warning: Dont play the keyboard while restoring data, and stay in
the Disk mode. Wait until the Wait message disappears.

Preferences
This page includes various protect options, plus the PCM Autoload option and settings for the hard disk sleep time.

1.

If you are restoring from a set of floppy disks or from a CD,


prepare the disk(s) containing the backup file to be
restored.

2.

Select the Restore Resources command, then press Execute.


The source device appears.

3.

If restoring from floppy disks, insert the first backup disk. If


restoring from CD, insert it in the CD drive.

4.

If needed, select a different device, by using the Device


pop-up menu.

5.

Browse through the files to find the backup file.

6.

When the backup file (.BKP file) is in the display, select it


and press the Restore command.

Global Protect

7.

If restoring from floppy disks, wait until the first backup


disk has been loaded. A message will appear, asking you to
insert the following disk. Insert the second backup disk and
press OK.

When loading a .SET file (see Loading all the User data on
page 262), this parameter (if On) prevents Global parameters
from being reprogrammed when loading all data. All Global
parameters are therefore left unchanged.

8.

Repeat the same procedure with the following backup


disks. When the last backup disk has been loaded, the
backup data is restored into the internal memory.

When loading a single .GLB file, this parameter is ignored, and


the Global is overwritten by the loaded data.

9.

Turn the instrument off, then on again to allow rebooting.

Dsk

Note: This parameter is saved to memory, but not to disk.

OS Version Number

Hard Disk Protect

This line shows the installed Operating System version. A newer


version may be available on www.korgpa.com.

When on, this parameter protects the Hard Disk from writing.

Dsk

Note: This parameter is saved to memory, but not to disk.


Factory Style and Pad Protect
When On, this parameter protects the Factory Styles (from the
8/16 BEAT 1 to the TRADITIONAL bank) and Factory Pads
(named Hit and Sequence in the Pad Select window) from
being overwritten when loading data from disk. Furthermore,
you cant access these banks when saving data.
When Off, you can load or save User Styles or Pads even into the
Factory Style banks (from 8/16 BEAT 1 to TRADITIONAL)
and Factory Pad banks (named Hit and Sequence in the Pad
Select window). This way, you can personalize your Factory Style
and Pad banks.
Please note that the Save All procedure always saves only the
USER Style banks.
Note: This parameter is automatically set to On when turning the
instrument off.
Note: Should your accidentally delete some Factory Data, reload
the Backup data, contact your Korg dealer or service center, or
download the data from www.korgpa.com.
Factory Sound Protect
When On, this parameter prevents writing edited Sounds from
the Edit Sound mode. When Off, you can freely save edited
Sounds either in the Factory or User Sound area. (See Write
Sound dialog box on page 211 for more information).
Note: This parameter is automatically set to On when turning the
instrument off.

Disk edit mode


USB/CD

273

Note: Should your accidentally delete some Factory Data, reload


the Backup data, contact your Korg dealer or service center, or
download the data from www.korgpa.com.

USB/CD

PCM Autoload

Use this page to enable or disable the USB interface, and to write
a CD or a CD image file.

Dsk

While most Sounds use samples, or PCM data, contained in


ROM therefore always available , some other Sounds may use
external samples, that must be loaded to RAM to be used. These
Sounds may have been loaded from disk, or created in Sampling
mode.
Since loading may take time, you can choose whether to automatically load or not these samples when turning the instrument
on.
If samples have not been loaded when turning the instrument
on, you can press the Load PCM button in this page to load
them.

On

When turning the instrument on, external samples used by some Sounds are automatically
loaded to RAM.

Off

When turning the instrument on, external samples used by some Sounds are not automatically
loaded. Therefore, these Sound will be muted,
until you use the Load PCM button to load them
to RAM.

Load PCM button


Press this button to load to RAM all sample (or PCM data) used
by some Sounds loaded fro disk, or created in Sampling mode.
Not available if no User PCM Samples are used by any Sound.

For information on the use of the USB interface, see USB/


CD: USB below.

For information on CD writing, see USB/CD: CD on


page 274.

USB/CD: USB
The USB interface allows you to access the internal hard disk
from a personal computer (Windows or Macintosh), by just
connecting the Pa1X to its USB interface. This way, you can
quickly backup data from the internal hard disk of the Pa1X to
your personal computer, or exchange data between the Pa1X and
a personal computer.

Hide Unknown Files


When this option is checked, non-proprietary files are hidden
when using Disk operations, therefore making browsing directories easier.
HD Sleep Time
Use this parameter to set the number of seconds after which, if
inactive, the hard disk will stop. If Off, the hard disk will never
go to sleep.

Note: Windows 2000 and XP, as well as Mac OSX, can be directly
connected to the Pa1X. To connect a Windows 98 computer you
need a dedicated driver, available on www.korgpa.com.
Hint: While USB communication is enabled, you cannot access
other functions on the Pa1X. We suggest you use the USB just after
turning the instrument on, and turn the instrument off and on
again after using and disconnecting it, to be sure USB activities will
not interfere with other disk operations.
Hard Disk USB Connection
Normally, USB is not activated on the Pa1X. Press the Enable
button to turn it on, or the Disable button (with all caveats) to
turn it off.
Enable

After connecting Pa1X to a personal computer by


using a standard USB cable (Pa1X is the B or
slave device, while the personal computer is the
A or master device), press this button to
enable communication.
The DISK LED will start blinking, while the personal computer reads the internal hard disk of the
Pa1X. When finished (this may take some minutes, depending on the hard disk size), the icon of

Reference

Warning: When loading PCM data, all existing PCM data in


memory are deleted. Save them before loading the folder, by selecting the PCM option during a Save All operation (see Saving the
full memory content on page 265).

274

Disk edit mode


USB/CD: CD

the hard disk will appear among the other storage


devices connected to the computer:

with the Write from IMG command on the Pa1X, or by common CD-writing software applications on a personal computer.
After pressing this button, the Select Files page appears. See
Select Files page below.
Write from IMG

Pa1X in Windows

Pa1X in Macintosh

Caveat: Do not modify .SET folders, or you will


no longer be able to use them on the Pa1X. Only use
the USB connection for backup purpose, or to modify ordinary folders.
Note: After starting USB connection, accessing
Pa1X data from the computer may take some time,
depending on the size of the hard disk and contained data.
Disable

Press this button to disconnect the USB connection. Be careful to press it only when you are
totally sure data transfer has been completed.
Note: USB connection is also automatically disconnected when disconnecting the USB communication on the personal computer side.
To disconnect USB communication on a PC, you
usually select the dedicated command by clicking
on the USB device icon with the right mouse button. On the Mac, select the USB device icon, then
select the Eject command or drag it to the eject
icon in the Dock.
Hint: We suggest to disconnect USB connection
from the personal computer, instead of pressing this
button on the Pa1X.

Press this button to write a CD from an ISO image file (.ISO),


either generated by the Write CD command on the Pa1X, or by
a CD-burning software application on a personal computer.
Pa1X complies with the ISO9660 Mode 1/2048 format (or
CDROM format). It does not comply with Mode 2 (or
CDROM-XA format).
Note: While image files can be generated by most CD-burning
applications, such as Ahead Software Nero, Roxio Easy CD
Creator, or Roxio Toast, we cannot warrant full compatibility
with them, due to the fast-changing way their features are implemented.
If you create the .ISO image file on a computer, you must move
it to the internal hard disk of the Pa1X via the USB connection,
prior to selecting this command. The needed ISO image file
must reside in the internal hard disk of the Pa1X.
After pressing this button, a standard File Selector appears,
allowing you to select an image file. After the ISO image file has
been selected and the Select button has been pressed, the Write
CD dialog box will appear (see Write CD dialog box below).

Select Files page


After pressing the Write CD button in the Disk > USB/CD
page, this page appears.

Caveat: Do not disconnect USB communication


before the personal computer has really finished
transferring files. Sometimes, the on-screen indicator tells the procedure has been completed,
BEFORE it is actually finished.
Disconnecting USB communication (or disconnecting the USB cable) before data transfer has
been completed may cause loss of data.

USB/CD: CD
You can use the (optional) Korg CDRW-1 CD Player/Writer to
write data on CD and CD-RW disks.

Note: A hard disk must be installed for CD writing to work.


Note: Audio CDs cannot be written on the Pa1X/Pa1X Pro.
Write CD
Press this button to create a list of files, to be directly written to
CD or saved as an image file. The image file can later be read

While in this page, you can select files or folders, and press the
Select button in the display to add them to the list of files to be
written on a CD.
After having selected all the desired files and/or folders, press the
Next> button to go to the Edit List page. When in the Edit

Disk edit mode


USB/CD: CD

List page you will be able to return back to this page and continue adding files or folders.
Device pop-up menu
Use this menu to select one of the available storage devices. Note
you can also select removable devices, like a floppy disk or a CD,
but you cannot remove them until the Pa1X has finished creating the image file (see Save IMG below).
Open button
Opens the selected folder (whose name begins with the
icon.

275

CD Label
Press the
(Text Edit) button to open the Text Edit window,
and assign a name to the CD. Enter the name, then press OK to
confirm and close the Text Edit window.
Del All
Press this button to delete the whole list.
Delete

Close button
Closes the current folder, returning to the parent (upper) level.
Select
Selects the highlighted file or folder, and adds it to the list of files
to be written to CD. Greyed-out until a file or folder is selected.

Select an item in the list, then press this button to delete it.
Save IMG
Press this button to save an ISO image file to disk. The generated
image complies with the ISO9660 Mode 1/2048 format (common to most CD-burning applications, such as Ahead Software Nero, Roxio Easy CD Creator, or Roxio Toast).
After you press this button, listed data are collected, and the
Writing ISO image file message appears in the display.

Next>
Jumps to the Edit List page. Greyed-out until a file or folder has
been added to the list.

Exits from the CD Writing mode, and returns to the USB/CD


page. The mastering list will remain in memory.
Folders, Files, Total Size

Note: Please do not remove any removable media (such as floppy


disks or CDs) during this phase.
This procedure may last for several minutes, depending on the
amount of data to be written. It is split in three consecutive
steps:

These (non-editable) indicators show the total number of folders and files included in the list, and their overall size.

1)

Folders/files are scanned in the source devices.

When the total size of added data exceeds about 650 MB, the
Total Size parameter turns to red, showing that there are too
many data to fit in a normal CD.

2)

The ISO image file is prepared.

3)

The ISO image file is written to the hard disk.

Edit List page


While in this page, you can see and edit the list of files and/or
folders to be written to a CD or image file.

A progress bar will inform you of the steps status.


Write CD
Press this button to open the Write CD dialog box, and write a
CD. See Write CD dialog box below.
<Back
Press this button to return to the Select Files page and add
other files to the list.
Exit
Exits from the CD Writing mode, and returns to the USB/CD
page. The mastering list will remain in memory.
Folders, Files, Total Size
These (non-editable) indicators show the total number of folders and files included in the list, and their overall size.

While in this page, you can delete files or folders by pressing the
Delete or Del All button, or press the <Back button to go back to
the Select Files page and add other files.
When the list is done, you can either save it to disk as an image
file by pressing the Save IMG button, or write a CD by pressing
the Write CD button.

When the total size of added data exceeds about 650 MB, the
Total Size parameter turns to red, showing that there are too
many data to fit in a normal CD.

Reference

Exit

276

Disk edit mode


Page menu

Write CD dialog box


This dialog box allows you to set the parameters for CD writing.

Note: If the Write operation fails on a rewritable CD (CD-RW),


the CD is automatically erased. Please try again with a slower writing speed. If this doesnt work, go to the Disk > Format page, and
perform a Full Format of the CD.

Page menu
Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.
Speed
Use this pop-up menu to select the writing speed. Depending on
the blank CD quality, higher speeds may also mean less-reliable
data writing.
Simulation
When this parameter is checked, the CD will not be actually
written. Instead, a simulation procedure will start, to let you see
if the writing speed is too high, and should be lowered.
While in simulation mode, the Write CD dialog boxs title will
change to Write CD - Simulation Mode.
At the end of the simulation procedure, the CD is automatically
ejected.
Close CD
With operating system version 2.0, Pa1X can only write a single
session on a CD. However, the CD can be left open, to let you
add other sessions from a PC or Mac on the same CD.

Check this parameter if you want to close (finalize) the


CD. When the CD is closed, you cannot add further data to
it. This is useful when the CDs content is complete and the
disk must be delivered or archived.

Leave it unchecked if you want to add further data later.

Note: If this parameter is not checked, Pa1X needs an additional


13MB (approx.) of space on the CD. However, if this space is not
available, the disk is automatically closed (and this parameter is
automatically checked).
Note: While Pa1X-generated CDs, left open for further addition of
data, can be used by most CD-burning applications, we cannot
warrant full compatibility with them, due to the fast-changing way
their features are implemented.

Create New Folder


This command lets you create a new folder in the root of any
disk, or inside any generic folder. You cant create or open .SET
folders with this command, since these are reserved folders, to be
created during a Save operation by using the New SET button.

By pressing the
(Text Edit) button you can open the Text
Edit window. Enter the name, then press OK to confirm and
close the Text Edit window.
Rename

Cancel

Available only when an item is selected in a file list.

Exits from the dialog box, and returns to the previous page.

Use this function to change the name of a file or folder. To preserve consistency through the data structure, you cannot rename
single files inside a .SET folder. Also, you cannot change the 3-

CD Info
Select this command to see various info on the selected CD.
Write CD
Press this button to start writing the CD, or the Simulation procedure. You will be asked to insert a blank CD into the CD
Writer.
In case you insert a CD-RW (rewritable) containing data, you
are asked if you want to delete all its content. Warning: This will
delete all the data already contained on the CD-RW!

Disk edit mode


Page menu

character extension of files and .SET folders, identifying the


type of file or folder.

277

Ordered by Name
Select this display option to see the list of files and folders in
rough alphabetical order, with different file types mixed in the
list. The File label, above the file list, is shown in red.

Ordered by Type

Press the
(Text Edit) button to open the Text Edit window.
Enter the new name, then press OK to confirm and close the
Text Edit window.

Select this display option to see the list of files and folders
ordered by type. Inside any type group, files are still in alphabetical order. The Type label, above the file list, is shown in red.

Object info
Select this command to see the size of any selected file or folder
on disk. Also, the number of files and directories it contains are
shown.

Ascending/Descending
Use this command to switch between the ascending (Numbers,
AZ) and descending (ZA, Numbers) order.
Write Global-Disk Preference
Select this command to open the Write Global-Disk Preferences
dialog box, and save settings executed in the Preferences page
(see Preferences on page 272).

Note: The single file size is always shown on the right of the file
name in any file list:

Parameters saved in the Disk Preferences area of the Global are


Select this command to see various info on the selected device.
To select a different device, use the Device pop-up menu on the
lower left corner of most Disk pages.

Protect
Select this command to protect the selected file or folder from
writing/erasing. The lock icon will appear next to the file or
folder name.

Unprotect
Select this command to unprotect the selected file or folder if
protected.

marked with the

Dsk

symbol through the users manual.

Reference

Device Info

278

Disk edit mode


Disk handling

Disk handling

Opening for disk


insertion
Disk activity
indicator

The Pa1X can save most of the data contained in memory on the
internal hard disk (if fitted), or on a 3,5 DS-DD disk (720KB
capacity) or HD (1,44MB capacity), MS-DOS-formatted. Here
are some precautions when handling disks.

Eject button

Floppy disk write protection


You can protect a disk from the accidental overwriting of data,
by opening the write protect hole. To protect the disk from overwriting, slide the protection flap so that the hole becomes visible.
To write-protect the disk: move
the flap and open the hole

To write-enable the disk: move


the flap to close the hole

Cleaning the floppy disk heads


The disk drive read/write heads get dirty with use and become
less accurate. You can clean the heads with a special cleaning
disk, you can purchase from any computer or musical instrument store. Use a 3.5 DS wet type head cleaning disk; and carefully follow the instructions included with it.

Precautions
Hard disk write protection
You can protect your hard disk from writing, by using the software protection found in Disk mode (see Hard Disk Protect
on page 272).

Do not remove a floppy disk or move the instrument while


the disk drive or hard disk is operating.

Make a backup copy of the disks, in order not to lose data


forever in case of damage. You can backup your floppy
disks to the internal hard disk or on a personal computer.
The internal hard disk can be backed up on a personal
computers hard disk, by using the USB connection.

Do not open the metallic shutter on a floppy disk, and do


not touch the surface of the magnetic media inside it. If the
magnetic media becomes scratched or soiled, data can be
lost.

Do not leave a disk in the disk drive while carrying the


instrument: the read/write heads may scratch the disk and
damage saved data.

Keep the floppy disks or the instrument away from sources


of magnetic fields, for example televisions, refrigerators,
computers, monitors, speakers and transformers. Magnetic
fields can alter the contents of the disks.

Do not keep floppy disks in very hot or wet places, do not


expose them to direct sunlight and do not store them without use in dusty or dirty places.

Do not place heavy objects on top of the disks.

After use, replace the disks in a case.

Inserting a floppy disk


Insert the disk delicately into the disk drive, with the label facing
upwards and the metal part to the front. Press it in as far as it will
go.
Note: The Pa1X incorporates a new type of disk drive and you cannot hear click when the disk is inserted into place.
Opening for disk
insertion
Disk activity
indicator
Eject
button

Removing a floppy disk


Before removing a disk, make sure that the disk activity indicator is off. If the LED is off, remove the disk by pressing the eject
button.
Warning: Do not remove the disk if the disk activity indicator is lit
up.

Possible problems

In exceptional cases, a floppy disk can get stuck in the disk


drive. In order to avoid this happening, you should only
use high quality disks. If the disk does get stuck, do not try
to force it out using sharp objects. Contact your local dealer
or your nearest Korg Service Center.

Magnetic fields, dirt, humidity and usage can damage data


on disk. You can try to recover the data with disk repair
utilities for personal computers. It is, however, advisable to
make a backup copy of data.

Disk edit mode


Bonus software

279

Bonus software
With Pa1X Pro, three .SET folders have been saved in the internal hard disk, with the whole content of Korgs Real Drums
and Turkish/Arabic World collections, formerly available as
separate cards for the Pa80/Pa60 series.
These are high quality sound sets, based on additional RAM
PCM Samples. Go to www.korgpa.com for more information.
To load these sounds, select either the REALDRUM.SET or
TA_WORLD.SET folder from the hard disk. By loading the
BONUS_SW.SET folder, you can load both collections at the
same time.
Warning: When loading the above folders, all User data in memory is deleted. Save important data to disk, before loading the
bonus software.

Reference

Note: After turning the instrument off, all samples are deleted from
the RAM memory. You can either have them automatically
reloaded when turning the instrument on again (see PCM Autoload on page 273), or manually load them (see Load PCM button on page 273).

280

MIDI
What is MIDI?

MIDI

CC00, or Bank Select MSB, and CC32, or Bank Select LSB.


This message pair is used to select a Sound Bank. Together
with the Program Change message, they are used to select a
Sound.

CC01, or Modulation. This is the equivalent of pressing up


the joystick. A vibrato effect is usually triggered on.

CC07, or Master Volume. Use this controller to set the


channels volume.

CC10, or Pan. This one sets the channels position on the


stereo front.

CC11, or Expression. Use this controller to set the relative


volume of tracks, with the maximum value matching the
current setting of the CC07 control.

CC64, or Damper Pedal. Use this controller to simulate the


Damper pedal.

What is MIDI?
Here is a brief overview of MIDI, as related to the Pa1X. If interested, you may find more information on the general use of
MIDI in the various specialized magazines and dedicated books.

In general
MIDI stands for Musical Instruments Digital Interface. This
interface lets you connect two musical instruments, or a computer and various musical instruments.
Physically, MIDI is composed of three different connectors. The
MIDI IN receives data from another device; the MIDI OUT
sends data to another device; the MIDI THRU sends to another
device exactly what was received on the MIDI IN (this is useful
to daisy-chain more instruments).
On the Pa1X there are two separate sets of MIDI ports, labeled
IN A, OUT A, IN B, OUT B. Each OUT port may work as a
THRU port, depending on the status of the MIDI A Out/Thru
Mode and MIDI B Out/Thru Mode parameters in the Global
mode (see page 237).

Tempo

Channels and messages

Lyrics are non-standard MIDI events, made to display text


together with the music. Pa1X can read many of the available
Lyrics format on the market.

Basically, a MIDI cable transmits 16 channels of data. Think to


each MIDI channel as a TV channel: the receiver must be set on
the same channel of the transmitter. The same happens with
MIDI messages: when you send a Note On message on channel
1, it will be received on channel 1 only. This allows for multitimbricity: you can have more than one sound playing on the same
MIDI instrument.
There are various messages, but here are the most commonly
used:
Note On This message instructs an instrument to play a note
on a specific channel. Notes have both a name (C4 standing for
the center C) and a number (60 being the equivalent for C4). A
Note Off message is often used to say the note has been released.
In some case, a Note On with value 0 is used instead.
Together with the Note On message, a Velocity value is always
sent. This value tells the instrument how loud the note must
play.

Tempo is a global MIDI message, that is not tied to a particular


channel. Each Song includes Tempo data.

Lyrics

Standard MIDI Files


Midifiles, or Standard MIDI Files (a.k.a. SMF), are a practical
way of exchanging songs between different instruments and
computers. Pa1X uses the SMF format as its default song format,
so reading a song from a computer, or saving a song that a computer software can read, is not a problem at all.
The Pa1X sequencers are compatible with the SMF in format 0
(all data in one track; it is the most common format) and 1
(multitrack). It can read the SMF in Song Play mode and modify/save them in Sequencer mode. It can save a song in SMF 0
format in the Sequencer mode.

After Touch This message is generated by pressing on the keyboard, after the note has been struck. It usually activates vibrato,
or other sound parameters.

When in Song Play mode, the Pa1X can also display SMF lyrics
in Solton, M-Live (Midisoft), Tune1000, Edirol, GMX, HitBit,
and XF formats, and the chord abbreviations of SMF in Solton,
M-live (Midisoft), GMX, and XF format.

Pitch Bend (PB) You can generate this message acting on the
joystick (X direction). The pitch is translated up or down.

Note: The above trademarks are the property of their respective


holders. No endorsement is intended by inclusion in this list.

Program Change (PC) When you select a Sound, a Program


Change message is generated on the channel. Use this message,
together with Control Change 00 and 32, to remotely select Pa1X
data from a sequencer or a master keyboard.

Standard MIDI Files usually have the .MID or .KAR filename


extension.

Control Change (CC) This is a wide array of messages, controlling most of the instrument parameters. Some examples:

MIDI
The General MIDI standard

Some years ago, the musical instruments world felt a need for
some further standardization. Then, the General MIDI Standard
(GM) was born. This extension of the basic MIDI sets new rules
for compatibility between instruments:

A minimum of 16 MIDI channels was required.

A basic set of 128 Sounds, correctly ordered, was mandatory.

The Drum Kit had a standard order.

Channel 10 had to be devoted to the Drum Kit.

if you have selected UPPER or FULL, the chord recognition


mode will always be Fingered 2 (you need to play at least
three notes in order for the chord to be detected).

These two channels are especially useful for accordion players to


assign a different Chord channel to the chords and the bass
played with the left hand. In this way, chords and bass will participate to the creation of chords for the chord recognition of the
automatic accompaniment.

The Control channel

A most recent extension is the GM2, that further expands the


Sounds database. The Pa1X is soundwise-compatible with the
GM2 standard.

You can set a MIDI IN channel as the Control channel (see


page 238), to select Styles and Performance from an external
device. See the Appendix for a list of messages corresponding to
Pa1X internal data.

The Global channel

MIDI Setup

Any channels with the Global option assigned (see MIDI: MIDI
In Channels on page 238) can simulate the Pa1X integrated
keyboard. When the Pa1X is connected to a master keyboard,
transmission should take place over the Global channel of the
Pa1X.

You can play Pa1X with an external controller, and use it simply
as a powerful sound generator. To help you configure the MIDI
channels, we have provided a set of MIDI Setups (see Midi
Setup on page 96 for the Style Play mode, Midi Setup on
page 153 for the Song Play mode, and MIDI Setup on page 236
for the Global mode).

The MIDI messages received over a Global channel and not over
a standard channel are affected by the buttons of the KEYBOARD MODE section, as well from the split point. Therefore,
if the SPLIT button LED is lit up, the notes that arrive to the
Pa1X over this channel will be divided by the split point into the
Upper (above the split point) and Lower (below the split point)
parts.
The notes that arrive to a Global channel are used for the chord
recognition of the automatic accompaniment. If the KEYBOARD MODE is SPLIT, only the notes below the split point
will be used. These notes will be combined with the ones of the
special Chord 1 and Chord 2 channels.

The Chord 1 and Chord 2 channels

We recommend you to consider each MIDI Setup as a starting


point you can freely tweak. Once you have selected the most
appropriate MIDI Setup for the connection to be made, you can
modify the parameters as necessary and save them in a MIDI
Setup (see Write Global - Midi Setup dialog box on page 257).

Connecting Pa1X to a Master keyboard


You can control the Pa1X with a master keyboard or any other
MIDI keyboard. You only need to connect the MIDI OUT connector of the master keyboard to the MIDI IN connector of the
Pa1X. The master keyboard will become the integrated keyboard
of the Pa1X if it transmits over the same channel programmed as
Global in the Pa1X.

You can set two special Chord channels (see page 238) to send to
the Pa1X notes for the chord recognition. The notes will be combined with the notes that go through the channel set as Global
(Global notes are recognized only under the split point, if the
SPLIT LED is lit up).
The Chord channels are not affected by the split point and the
KEYBOARD MODE section of the control panel. All the notes
both above and below the split point will be sent to the chord
recognition.

MIDI IN

MIDI OUT

The buttons of the CHORD SCANNING section have a particular effect on the Chord channels:

if you have selected LOWER, the chord recognition mode


will be set by the Chord Recognition Mode parameter in
the Style Play mode (see page 95);

If the master keyboard transmits over the Global channel of the


Pa1X, the split point and the status of the KEYBOARD MODE

Reference

The General MIDI standard

281

282

MIDI
Connecting the Pa1X to a MIDI accordion

section in the control panel will affect the notes received from
the master keyboard.

Connections and settings


To connect the master keyboard to the Pa1X follow this procedure:
1.

2.

3.

Connect the MIDI OUT connector of the master keyboard


to one of the MIDI IN connectors of the Pa1X (IN A suggested).

6.

Connection and settings


To connect the accordion to the Pa1X follow this procedure:
1.

Connect the MIDI OUT connector of the accordion to one


of the MIDI IN connectors of the Pa1X (IN A suggested).

For information on the master keyboard programming, see


the master keyboard own users manual.

2.

Select the MIDI Setup parameter. You can do this by going


to the MIDI: MIDI Setup / General Controls page of the
Global mode, or in the dedicated page of the Style Play,
Song Play or Sequencer mode (see Midi Setup on page 96
and Midi Setup on page 153).

Select the MIDI Setup parameter. You can do this by going


to the MIDI: MIDI Setup / General Controls page of the
Global mode, or in the dedicated page of the Style Play,
Song Play or Sequencer mode (see Midi Setup on
page 96, Midi Setup on page 153, and Midi Setup on
page 186).

Note: A different MIDI Setup may be selected for the Style


Play, Song Play and Sequencer modes. The 1-Default MIDI
Setup is automatically selected when entering the Sound Edit
mode. MIDI settings are therefore modified when switching to
a different operating mode. The current MIDI Setup is also
shown in the Global mode.
3.

To save the assigned MIDI Setup for the selected operative


mode into the Global, select the Write Global-Style
Setup, the Write Global-Song Play Setup, the Write
Global-Seq. Setup, or the Write Global-Global Setup
command from the page menu.
If needed, press one of the buttons in the MODE section to
go to the desired operative mode.

Select one of the available Accordion MIDI Setups.


Note: Settings may change when new Global data is loaded
from disk. To protect settings from loading, use the Global
Protect function (see Global Protect on page 272).

Select the Master Keyboard MIDI Setup.


Note: Settings may change when new Global data is loaded
from disk. To protect settings from loading, use the Global
Protect function (see Global Protect on page 272).

5.

There are various types of MIDI accordions, each one requiring


different MIDI settings. Pa1X is provided with a series of Accordion MIDI Setups, each one suitable for a different MIDI accordion (see page 236).

Program the master keyboard to transmit over the Global


channel of the Pa1X (see MIDI: MIDI In Channels on
page 238).

Note: A different MIDI Setup may be selected for the Style


Play, Song Play and Sequencer modes. The 1-Default MIDI
Setup is automatically selected when entering the Sound Edit
mode. MIDI settings are therefore modified when switching to
a different operating mode. The current MIDI Setup is also
shown in the Global mode.
4.

Connecting the Pa1X to a MIDI accordion

4.

To save the assigned MIDI Setup for the selected operative


mode into the Global, select the Write Global-Style
Setup, the Write Global-Song Play Setup, the Write
Global-Seq. Setup, or the Write Global-Global Setup
command from the page menu.

5.

If needed, press one of the buttons in the MODE section to


go to the desired operative mode.

MIDI
Connecting the Pa1X to an external sequencer

Connecting the Pa1X to an external


sequencer
You can program a new song on an external sequencer, using
Pa1X as a multi-timbral expander.

Connections and settings


In order to connect the Pa1X to a computer, you need to have a
computer with the MIDI interface.
1.

Connect the Pa1X and the computer as in the following


diagram.

MIDI OUT
MIDI IN

283

The Local Off


When the Pa1X is connected to an external sequencer, we recommend you to set the Pa1X in Local Off mode (see Local
Control On on page 237) to avoid that the notes are simultaneously played by the keyboard and by the MIDI events sent by
the external sequencer.
When the Pa1X is in Local Off, the Pa1X keyboard transmits
data to the external sequencer, but not to the internal sound generation. The sequencer will receive the notes played on the Pa1X
keyboard and send them to the selected track of the song. The
track will transmit the data to the internal sound generation of
the Pa1X.
Note: In order to send data to the Pa1X sound generation, the
MIDI Thru function must be activated in the external sequencer
(normally active; the name may be different according to the type
of sequencer). For more information refer to the instructions manual of the sequencer.

The Sounds

MIDI IN

MIDI OUT

The song that is played back by the computer sequencer can


select Pa1X Sounds through the MIDI messages Bank Select
MSB, Bank Select LSB (bank selection, two messages), and Program Change (Sound selection). For a list of Sounds and MIDI
values, see Sounds on page 291.

2.

Activate the MIDI Thru function on the external


sequencer.

3.

Press GLOBAL, and go to the MIDI: MIDI Setup / General


Controls page. uncheck the Local Control On parameter
(see page 237). This is called the Local Off status.

4.

Press SEQUENCER to go to the Sequencer mode. Go to the


Preferences: Global Setup page (see page 186). Select the
Extern.Seq. MIDI Setup.
Note: Settings may change when new Global data is loaded
from disk. To protect settings from loading, use the Global
Protect function (see Global Protect on page 272).

5.

Select the Write Global-Seq. Setup command from the


page menu to save the assigned MIDI Setup to the Global.

6.

Play the keyboard. Notes played on the keyboard go from


the MIDI OUT of the Pa1X to the MIDI IN of the computer/MIDI interface.
Notes generated by the computer (i.e. a song played by its
sequencer) are sent through the MIDI OUT of the MIDI
interface to the MIDI IN connector of the Pa1X.

Reference

A suggestion for those who program songs on computer: Even


though it is not essential, you usually set the bass on channel 2,
melody on channel 4, drum kit on channel 10, control of the
Pa1X voice harmonizer on channel 5.

284

MIDI
Playing another instrument with the Pa1X

Playing another instrument with the


Pa1X
You can use the Pa1X as the master controller for your MIDI
setup.
1.

Connect one of Pa1X MIDI OUT connectors to the other


instruments MIDI IN.

2.

Set the other instrument to the same channels you want to


play from Pa1X. For example, if you wish to play the Upper
1 and Upper 2 tracks with sounds of the other instrument,
enable the other instrument to receive on the same channels Pa1X is transmitting from tracks Upper 1 and Upper 2
(by default, channels 1 and 2).

3.

Set the master volume of the other instrument with its own
volume controls.

4.

Mute/unmute any track right from the Pa1X. Adjust each


tracks volume by using Pa1X sliders.

5.

Play the keyboard of the Pa1X.

The Keyboard
Pa1Xs keyboard can drive up to four tracks via the MIDI OUT
(Upper 1-3 and Lower). MIDI output channels are set in Global
mode (see MIDI: MIDI Out Channels on page 238).
As a default situation (1-Default MIDI Setup), each of Pa1X
Keyboard tracks transmit on the following channels:
Track

Out Channel

Upper1

Upper2

Upper3

Lower

When a track is muted, it cannot transmit any MIDI data to an


external expander or sequencer connected Pa1Xs MIDI OUT.
To hear only the expanders sounds, you can lower the MASTER
VOLUME control on the Pa1X, or set the Keyboard tracks to the
External status (see Track Controls: Mode on page 181).

The Sequencer
Any Sequencers track can drive a channel on an external instrument. To set each tracks MIDI output channel, see MIDI:
MIDI Out Channels on page 238.
To hear only the expanders sounds, you can lower the MASTER
VOLUME control on the Pa1X, or set the Song tracks to the
External status (see Track Controls: Mode on page 181).
Select the Sequencer 1 or Sequencer 2 MIDI Setup (depending on the Sequencer you are using on the Pa1X) to set the channels as follows.
Track

Out Channel

Song 116

116

The Arranger
One of the most interesting aspect of MIDI, is that you can use
your Pa1X to play an external instrument with its onboard
arranger. Yes, its hard to beat the audio quality of Pa1X, but you
could wish to use that old faithful synth you are still accustomed
to
To assign some of Pa1X Style tracks to an external instrument,
set them to the External status (see Track Controls: Mode on
page 181).
Select the Default MIDI Setup to set the channels as follows
(this is the default status of Pa1X).
Track

Out Channel

Bass

Drums

10

Percussion

11

Acc15

1216

Appendix

286

Factory data
Styles

Factory data
Styles
Note: You can remotely select Styles on the Pa1X, by sending it Bank Select MSB (CC#0), Bank Select LSB (CC#32) and Program Change
messages on the Control channel (see MIDI: MIDI In Channels on page 238).
#

CC#0

CC#32

PC

Moonlight Ballad

Bank: 8/16 Beat 1

CC#0

CC#32

PC

Kool Beat

Bank: 8/16 Beat 2

CC#0

CC#32

PC

Funky Ballad

Easy Beat

Slow HipHop

Unplugged Gtr1

Ballad

Unplugged 16 Bt

Easy Ballad 3

Real 16 Beat

Analog Ballad

Guitar Beat

Groove Ballad

British Pop 1

Easy Pop

Unplugged Gtr 3

Pop Chart 1

Standard 16 Bt 1

Pop & Sea

Soft Ballad

Unplugged Rock

Meditando

Easy Ballad 1

Pop Hits

Unplugged Gtr 4

British Pop 2

Half Time Lite

Unplugged Gtr 5

10

Classic 8 Bt 1

Analog Beat 1

Serenade

11

10

Classic 8 Bt 2

10

Analog Beat 2

10

Unplugged Bld 1

12

11

Soft Beat 1

11

Guitar Ballad 1

11

Acoustic Ballad

13

12

Unplugged 8 Bt 1

12

Guitar Ballad 2

12

Unplugged Bld 2

14

13

Light Rock 1

13

8 Beat Analog 1

13

Pop Jazz

15

14

Light Rock 2

14

Analogyst

14

Diva

16

15

Easy Ballad 2

15

8 Beat Analog 2

15

Rock Ballad 1

17

16

Soft Beat 2

16

Trendy Beat

16

Folk Ballad

18

17

Pop Beat 2

17

Slow Ballad

17

Pop Ballad 2

19

18

Standard 8 Beat

18

6 Strings Beat

18

Half Time Ballad

20

19

Unplugged 8 Bt 2

19

Half Time Guitar

19

Country Ballad 1

21

20

Love 8 Beat

20

Standard 16 Bt 2

20

4/4 Ballad

22

21

Half Beat

21

Pop 16 Beat 1

21

Love Ballad

23

22

UK 8 Beat

22

Pop 16 Beat 2

22

Natural Beat

24

23

8 Beat Groove

23

Cinema Ballad

23

Celtic Ballad

25

24

UK R & B

24

Windy Beat

24

16 Beat Analog 1

26

25

Pop Ballad 1

25

Home Beat

25

Color Beat

27

26

HipHop Beat

26

26

Pop Ballad 3

28

27

Miami Beat

27

27

8 Beat Analog 3

29

28

Classic Beat 3

28

28

16 Beat Analog 2

30

29

Real 8 Beat

29

29

31

30

Easy Groove

30

30

32

31

31

31

Factory data
Styles

CC#0

CC#32

PC

Easy Listening

Bank: Ballroom

CC#0

CC#32

PC

Bank: Dance
Dance Fever

CC#0

CC#32

PC

Bank: Rock

Pop Shuffle

Groove It Up

English Rock

Slow Band

Club Latin

Open Rock 1

Foxtrot 1

Barry Dance

Open Rock 2

Organ Foxtrot

Sister & Girl

Pop Rock

Movie Ballad

Philly Disco

Fire Rock

Pop Chart 2

Oriental Dance 1

Hard Rock

Candy & Sweet

Twist

Heavy Rock
South Strait

Big Band Jump

Organ Waltz

House Garage

10

Slow Waltz 1

House

South Shuffle

11

10

Slow Waltz 2

10

Dream

10

Rock Shuffle

12

11

Slow Waltz 3

11

Techno

11

Rock Ballad 2

13

12

Slow Waltz 4

12

Underground

12

Half Time

14

13

Slow Waltz 5

13

Progressive

13

Rock 6/8

15

14

Slow 6/8

14

Jungle

14

Abbey Road

16

15

Slow Pop

15

Rap

15

Soft Rock

17

16

Slow Rock 1

16

HipHop

16

Surf Rock

18

17

Slow Rock 2

17

Disco 70

17

Pop Shuffle 1

19

18

Unpl. Slow Rock

18

80's Dance

18

Blues Shuffle

20

19

Big Band Fox 1

19

Love Disco

19

60's Rock

21

20

Big Band Fox 2

20

Disco Party

20

Rock & Roll

22

21

Big Band Fox 3

21

Disco Funky

21

23

22

Operetta

22

Disco Gully

22

24

23

Quick Step 1

23

Dance 80

25

24

Quick Step 2

24

26

25

New Jive

25

25

27

26

Charleston

26

26

28

27

Foxtrot 2

27

27

29

28

Slow Fox

28

28

30

29

Foxtrot 3

29

29

31

30

30

30

32

31

31

CC#0

CC#32

PC

Bank: Soul & Funk

Kool Funk

3
4

23
24

31

CC#0

CC#32

PC

Bank: World 1

CC#0

CC#32

PC

Oberkr. Waltz 1

Bank: World 2
Hawaiian

Swing HipHop

Oberkr. Waltz 2

Country Beat

Funky Sisters

Oberkr. Waltz 3

Folk Beat

Steely Feel

Oberkr. Polka 1

Kountry Pop

Al Funk

Oberkr. Polka 2

Bluegrass

Elektrik Funk

German Polka 1

Country 8 Beat

Classic Funk

German Polka 2

Country 16 Beat

Talkin' Jazz

Oberkr. Polka

Country Beat

Pop Shuffle

Bavarian Pop 1

Modern Country

10

Easy Funk

Bavarian Pop 2

Country Boogie

11

10

Dance Funk

10

Polka Pop 1

10

Country Shuffle 1

12

11

Club Funk

11

Polka Pop 2

11

Country Shuffle 2

13

12

Blues Ballad

12

Party Polka

12

Country Ballad 2

14

13

Modern Gospel 1

13

Classic Flipper

13

Country 3/4

15

14

Modern Gospel 2

14

Flipper 6/8

14

Orleans

16

15

Gospel Shuffle

15

Flipper 4/4

15

Celtic Waltz

17

16

Rubber Funk

16

Dance Schlager

16

Mexican Waltz

18

17

Groove Funk

17

Fox Schlager

17

Norteno 1

19

18

Acid Jazz 1

18

Medium Schlager

18

Banda 2/4

20

19

Double Beat

19

Disco Schlager

19

Norteno 2

21

20

Groove

20

Schlager 1

20

Quebradita

22

21

Jazz Funk

21

Schlager 2

21

Tejano

23

22

Al Swing

22

Schlager 3

22

Cajun

24

23

HipHop Funk

23

Schlager 4

23

Zydeco

25

24

HipHop Soul

24

Pop Schlager

24

Celtic Dream

26

25

Motown Shuffle

25

Petry Rock 1

25

27

26

Pop Ballad 4

26

Petry Rock 2

26

28

27

Rhythm & Blues

27

Trucker

27

29

28

Soul 1

28

Schlager 5

28

30

29

Memphis

29

Volkst.Schlager

29

31

30

Motown 1

30

Sambamedley

30

32

31

Gospel

31

Partymix

31

Appendix

287

288

Factory data
Styles

CC#0

CC#32

PC

Flamenco

Bank: World 3

CC#0

CC#32

PC

10

Guitar Bossa

Bank: Latin 1

CC#0

CC#32

PC

11

Oriental Dance 2

Oriental Ballad

5
6

Bank: Latin 2
Salsa 1

Unplugged Bossa

Salsa 2

Cool Bossa

Mambo 1

Hora

Orchestral Bossa

Mambo Party

Sevillana 1

Meditation Bossa

English Tango

Sevillana 2

Basic Bossa

Orchestral Tango

Jota

L.A. Bossa

Tango.it

Copla

Groove Bossa

Italian Tango

Classic 3/4

New Bossa

Habanera 1

10

Bolero

Lite Bossa

Habanera 2

11

10

Minuetto

10

Lite Beguine

10

Mambo 2

12

11

Baroque

11

Latin Pop

11

Mambo 3

13

12

New Age

12

Latin Rock 1

12

Mambo 2000

14

13

Tarantella

13

Latin Rock 2

13

Salsa 3

15

14

Raspa

14

Latin Funk

14

Salsa 4

16

15

Vahde

15

Unplugged Latin

15

Mariachi

17

16

Oriental

16

Cha Cha 1

16

Reggae 1

18

17

Roman

17

Pop Cha Cha

17

Happy Reggae

19

18

Ciftetelli

18

Disco Cha Cha 1

18

Reggae 2

20

19

19

Disco Cha Cha 2

19

Reggae 3

21

20

20

Cha Cha 2

20

Pasodoble 1

22

21

21

Funky Cha Cha

21

Pasodoble Banda

23

22

22

Beguine 1

22

Pasodoble 2

24

23

23

Pop Beguine

23

Argentina Tango

25

24

24

Tradit. Bolero

24

26

25

25

Slow Bolero

25

27

26

26

Sabor

26

28

27

27

27

29

28

28

28

30

29

29

29

31

30

30

30

32

31

31

CC#0

CC#32

PC

Bank: Latin Dance

12

Brazilian Samba

3
4

31

CC#0

CC#32

PC

Bank: Jazz 1

CC#0

CC#32

PC

13

Bigger Band

14

Bank: Jazz 2

Andean

Big Band 1

Fast Big Band 1

Dance Band

Gipsy Dance

Soft Jazz

Show Time

Latin Dance 1

BeBop 1

Movie Swing

Slow Latin Rock

Jazz Brush

Xmas Swing

Samba

Medium Swing

Django

Sambalegre

Slow Swing

Hollywood 1

Disco Samba

Swing Ballad 1

Hollywood 2

Samba Funk

50's Swing

Broadway

10

Rhumba 1

Swing Ballad 2

Dixieland

11

10

Merengue 1

10

Unplug. Swing 1

10

Big Band 4

12

11

Merengue 2

11

Swing Ballad 3

11

Swing Shuffle

13

12

Cumbia

12

BeBop 2

12

Fast Big Band 2

14

13

Latin Dance 2

13

Big Band Medium

13

Latin Big Band

15

14

Batucada

14

Big Band 40's

14

Big Band Fox 4

16

15

Rhumba 2

15

Big Band 2

15

Acid Jazz 2

17

16

Gipsy

16

Jazz Waltz 1

16

New Jazz

18

17

Pop Rhumba

17

Jazz Waltz 2

17

Latin Jazz

19

18

Calypso

18

Jazz Waltz 3

18

Fusion

20

19

Lambada

19

5/4 Swing

19

Ragtime Piano

21

20

Meneito

20

Vocal Swing

20

Shuffle Piano

22

21

Macarena

21

Big Band 3

21

Boogie Piano

23

22

22

Mood Swing

22

Bossa Piano

24

23

23

Unplug. Swing 2

23

25

24

24

Big Band Ballad

26

25

25

25

27

26

26

26

28

27

27

27

29

28

28

28

30

29

29

29

31

30

30

30

32

31

31

31

24

Factory data
Styles

CC#0

CC#32

PC

15

Italian Waltz 1

German Waltz 1

Walzer Musette

Vienna Waltz

Viennese

Tradit. Polka

French March

March

Italian Waltz 2

10

Italian Waltz 3

11

10

Italian Waltz 4

10

10

12

11

Valzer

11

11

13

12

Italian Waltz 5

12

12

14

13

German Waltz 2

13

13

15

14

German Waltz 3

14

14

16

15

Laendler

15

15

17

16

Mazurka 1

16

16

18

17

Mazurka 2

17

17

19

18

Mazurka 3

18

18

20

19

Italian Polka

19

19

21

20

Polka 1

20

20

22

21

Polka 2

21

21

23

22

German Polka

22

22

24

23

Mazurka 4

23

23

25

24

Polka 3

24

24

26

25

25

25

27

26

26

26

28

27

27

27

29

28

28

28

30

29

29

29

31

30

30

30

32

31

31

31

CC#0

CC#32

PC

23-31

CC#0

CC#32

PC

17-19

Bank: User 1-3

CC#0

CC#32

PC

20-22

Bank: Direct FD 1-3

Bank: Direct HD 1-9

10

11

10

10

10

12

11

11

11

13

12

12

12

14

13

13

13

15

14

14

14

16

15

15

15

17

16

16

16

18

17

17

17

19

18

18

18

20

19

19

19

21

20

20

20

22

21

21

21

23

22

22

22

24

23

23

23

25

24

24

24

26

25

25

25

27

26

26

26

28

27

27

27

29

28

28

28

30

29

29

29

31

30

30

30

32

31

31

31

Appendix

Bank: Traditional

289

290

Factory data
Style Elements

Style Elements
Note: You can remotely select the various Style Elements on the Pa1X, by sending it Program Change messages on the Control channel (see
MIDI: MIDI In Channels on page 238).
PC

Style Element

PC

Style Element

PC

Style Element

PC

Style Element

PC

Style Element

80

Variation 1

81

Variation 2

82

Variation 3

83

Variation 4

84

Intro 1

85

Intro 2

86

Fill 1

87

Fill 2

88

Ending 1

89

Ending 2

90

Fill 3/Break

Note: The above Program Change numbers are given according to the 0-127 numbering system.

Single Touch Settings (STS)


Note: You can remotely select Single Touch Settings (STS) on the Pa1X, by sending it Bank Select MSB (CC#0), Bank Select LSB (CC#32)
and Program Change messages on the Control channel (see MIDI: MIDI In Channels on page 238). If a Style is already selected, just send
the Program Change message.
CC#0

CC#32

The same as the Style to which the STS belongs

PC

STS

PC

STS

PC

STS

PC

STS

64

STS 1

65

STS 2

66

STS 3

67

STS 4

Factory data
Sounds

Sounds
The following table lists all Pa1X Factory Sounds in order of
Bank Select-Program Change number.
Legend: The table also includes MIDI data used to remotely select
the Sounds. CC00: Control Change 0, or Bank Select MSB. CC32:
Control Change 32, or Bank Select LSB. PC: Program Change.
Bank: Sound/Performance Select button.
CC00

CC32

PC

121

121

121

CC00

CC32

PC

121

11

121

12

121

291

Name

Bank

GM2

DW8000 EP

E. Piano

Sweeping EP

E. Piano

13

White Pad EP

E. Piano

121

Harpsichord

Piano

121

Harpsi Octave

Piano

121

Harpsi Wide

Piano

121

Harpsi Key Off

Piano

121

Harpsi Korg

Piano

121

Clav

Piano

121

Pulse Clav

Piano

Name

Bank

GM2

121

Clav Wah

Piano

Acoustic Piano

Piano

121

Clav Snap

Piano

Ac. Piano Wide

Piano

121

Sticky Clav

Piano

Ac. Piano Dark

Piano

121

Celesta

Mallet & Bell

121

Grand Piano

Piano

121

Glocken

Mallet & Bell

121

Classic Piano

Piano

121

Sistro

Mallet & Bell

121

L/R Piano

Piano

121

10

Music Box

Mallet & Bell

121

Piano & Vibes

Piano

121

10

Orgel

Mallet & Bell

121

Piano & Strings

Piano

121

11

Vibraphone 1

Mallet & Bell

Piano

121

11

Vibrap. Wide

Mallet & Bell

11

Vibraphone 2

Mallet & Bell

121

Grand Piano 2

121

Bright Piano

Piano

121

121

Bright PianoWide

Piano

121

12

Marimba

Mallet & Bell

121

Piano Pad 1

Piano

121

12

Marimba Wide

Mallet & Bell

121

Piano Pad 2

Piano

121

12

Marimba Key Off

Mallet & Bell

121

Piano StringPad

Piano

121

12

Monkey Skuls

Mallet & Bell

121

E. Gran Piano

Piano

121

12

Log Drum

Drum & Perc.

121

E. Grand Wide

Piano

121

12

Mallet Clock

Mallet & Bell

12

Balaphon

Mallet & Bell

121

M1 Piano

Piano

121

121

90's Piano

Piano

121

13

Xylophone

Mallet & Bell

121

2000's Piano

Piano

121

14

Tubular Bell

Mallet & Bell

121

Chorus Piano

Piano

121

14

Church Bell 1

Mallet & Bell

121

Piano Layers

Piano

121

14

Carillon

Mallet & Bell

121

Honky-Tonk

Piano

121

14

Church Bell 2

Mallet & Bell

121

Honky Wide

Piano

121

15

Dulcimer

Mallet & Bell

15

Santur

Mallet & Bell

121

Electric Piano 1

E. Piano

121

121

Detuned EP 1

E. Piano

121

16

Drawbars Organ1

Organ

16

Det.DrawbarsOrg.

Organ

121

EP1 Veloc.sw

E. Piano

121

121

60's E. Piano

E. Piano

121

16

It. 60's Organ

Organ

121

Vintage EP

E. Piano

121

16

Drawbars Organ2

Organ

121

Pro Dyno EP

E. Piano

121

16

Dark Jazz Organ

Organ

121

Pro Stage EP

E. Piano

121

16

Iper Dark Organ

Organ

121

Studio EP

E. Piano

121

16

Full Drawbars

Organ

121

R&B E. Piano

E. Piano

121

16

DWGS Organ

Organ

E. Piano

121

16

Jazz Organ

Organ

16

Gospel Organ

Organ

121

Thin E. Piano

121

10

Dyno Tine EP

E. Piano

121

121

11

Club E. Piano

E. Piano

121

10

16

Good Old B

Organ

121

12

Classic Wurly

E. Piano

121

11

16

VOX Legend

Organ

121

13

Soft Wurly

E. Piano

121

12

16

Arabian Organ

Organ

121

14

Hard Wurly

E. Piano

121

13

16

Gospel Organ Vel

Organ

121

15

Vel. Wurly

E. Piano

121

14

16

Drawbars Organ3

Organ

E. Piano

121

17

Perc. Organ 1

Organ

E. Piano

121

17

Det.Perc.Organ

Organ

17

Perc. Organ 2

Organ

Organ

121
121

16
0

4
5

Tremolo Wurly
Electric Piano 2

Detuned EP 2

E. Piano

121

EP2 Veloc.sw

E. Piano

121

17

Old Wheels

121

EP Legend

E. Piano

121

17

Percuss. BX3

Organ

121

EP Phase

E. Piano

121

17

M1 Organ

Organ

121

Syn Piano X

E. Piano

121

17

Techno Org.Bass

Organ

121

Stereo Dig. EP

E. Piano

121

17

BX3 Short Decay

Organ

121

Classic Dig. EP

E. Piano

121

17

Rotary Organ

Organ

E. Piano

121

17

Perc.StereoOrgan

Organ

10

17

Perc. Organ 3

Organ

18

Rock Organ

Organ

121

Hybrid EP

121

Classic Tines

E. Piano

121

121

10

Phantom Tine

E. Piano

121

Appendix

121

121

292

Factory data
Sounds

CC00

CC32

PC

Name

Bank

121

18

BX3 Vel. Sw

121

18

Killer B

121

18

121

121
121

GM2

CC00

CC32

PC

Name

Bank

Organ

121

23

Acc.Voice Change

Accordion

Organ

121

23

Accordion 16 4'

Accordion

Dirty B

Organ

121

23

Acc.16 8 4' Plus

Accordion

18

Classic Click

Organ

121

23

Acc. & Acc. Bass

Accordion

18

Distortion Organ

Organ

121

10

23

Tango Accordion2

Accord

18

Super BX Perc.

Organ

121

24

Nylon Guitar 1

Guitar

121

18

Dirty Jazz Organ

Organ

121

24

Ukulele

Guitar

121

18

Perc.Short Decay

Organ

121

24

Nylon Key Off

Guitar

121

18

Perc. Wheels

Organ

121

24

Nylon Guitar 3

Guitar

121

10

18

Jimmy Organ

Organ

121

24

Nylon Bossa

Guitar

121

11

18

Rock Organ 2

Organ

121

24

Ac.Guitar KeyOff

Guitar

121

19

Church Organ

Organ

121

24

Spanish Guitar

Guitar

121

19

Church Oct. Mix

Organ

121

24

Guitar Strings

Guitar

121

19

Detuned Church

Organ

121

24

Nylon Gtr Pro1

Guitar

121

19

Pipe Mixture

Organ

121

24

Brazilian Guitar

Guitar

121

19

Church Pipes

Organ

121

10

24

Nylon Vel. Harm.

Guitar

121

19

Full Pipes

Organ

121

11

24

Nylon Gtr Pro2

Guitar

121

19

Pipe Tutti 1

Organ

121

12

24

Nylon Gtr RX1

Guitar

121

19

Positive Organ

Organ

121

13

24

Nylon Gtr RX2

Guitar

121

19

Pipe Tutti 2

Organ

121

14

24

Nylon Slide Pro

Guitar

121

19

Pipe Tutti 3

Organ

121

15

24

Nylon Guitar 2

Guitar

121

20

Reed Organ

Organ

121

25

Steel Guitar 1

Guitar

121

20

Puff Organ

Organ

121

25

12 Strings Gtr

Guitar

121

20

Small Pipe

Organ

121

25

Mandolin

Guitar

121

20

Flauto Pipes

Organ

121

25

Steel & Body

Guitar

121

20

Pipe Flute

Organ

121

25

Steel Guitar 2

Guitar

121

21

Accordion 1

Accordion

121

25

Steel 12 Strings

Guitar

121

21

Accordion 2

Accordion

121

25

Hackbrett

Guitar

121

21

Akordeon

Accordion

121

25

Finger Key Off

Guitar

121

21

Musette 1

Accordion

121

25

Finger Tips

Guitar

121

21

Musette 2

Accordion

121

25

Steel Folk Gtr

Guitar

121

21

Musette Clar.

Accordion

121

10

25

Mandolin Key Off

Guitar

121

21

Fisa 16, 8

Accordion

121

11

25

Mandolin Trem.

Guitar

121

21

Fisa 16, 4

Accordion

121

12

25

Reso. Guitar

Guitar

121

21

Fisa Master

Accordion

121

13

25

Steel Slide Pro1

Guitar

121

21

Cassotto

Accordion

121

14

25

Steel Slide Pro2

Guitar

121

10

21

Arabic Accordion

Accordion

121

15

25

Steel Guitar RX1

Guitar

121

11

21

Sweet Musette

Accordion

121

16

25

Steel Guitar RX2

Guitar

121

12

21

Cassotto 16'

Accordion

121

17

25

12 Strings Pro

Guitar

121

13

21

Cassotto Or.Tune

Accordion

121

18

25

12 Strings RX

Guitar

121

14

21

Cassotto NorTune

Accordion

121

19

25

Steel Guitar Pro

Guitar

121

15

21

Detune Accordion

Accordion

121

20

25

Steel Guitar 3

Guitar

121

16

21

2 Voices Musette

Accordion

121

21

25

Steel Guitar 4

Guitar

121

17

21

3 Voices Musette

Accordion

121

26

Jazz Guitar

Guitar

121

18

21

France Musette

Accordion

121

26

Pedal Steel Gtr1

Guitar

121

19

21

Acc.Clarinet OT

Accordion

121

26

Club Jazz Gtr 1

Guitar

121

20

21

Acc. Clarinet NT

Accordion

121

26

Club Jazz Gtr 2

Guitar

121

21

21

Acc. Piccolo OT

Accordion

121

26

Pedal Steel Gtr2

Guitar

121

22

21

Acc. Piccolo NT

Accordion

121

26

Soft Jazz Guitar

Guitar

121

23

21

Master Accordion

Accordion

121

26

JazzGtr SlidePro

Guitar

121

24

21

Accordion 3

Accord

121

27

Clean Guitar 2

Guitar

121

22

Harmonica 1

Accordion

121

27

Det. Clean Gtr

Guitar

121

22

Sweet Harmonica

Accordion

121

27

Mid Tone Gtr

Guitar

121

22

Harmonica 2

Accordion

121

27

Chorus Guitar

Guitar

121

22

Harmonica AT

Accordion

121

27

Vintage S.2

Guitar

121

22

Harmonica 3

Accord

121

27

Proces.E.Guitar

Guitar

121

23

Tango Accordion

Accordion

121

27

Single Coil

Guitar

121

23

Fisa Tango!

Accordion

121

27

New Stra.Guitar

Guitar

121

23

Accordion 16 8'

Accordion

121

27

Guitarish

Guitar

121

23

Accordion16 8 4'

Accordion

121

27

L&R E.Guitar 1

Guitar

121

23

Acc.16 8' & Bass

Accordion

121

10

27

L&R E.Guitar 2

Guitar

121

23

Accordion Bass

Accordion

121

11

27

Country Nu

Guitar

GM2

Sounds

CC00

CC32

PC

Name

Bank

121

12

27

Funky Wah Sw.

121

13

27

Clean Gtr Pro1

121

14

27

121

15

121

16

121

GM2

293

CC00

CC32

PC

Name

Bank

Guitar

121

33

Finger E.Bass2

Bass

Guitar

121

33

Finger E.Bass3

Bass

Single Coil Pro

Guitar

121

33

Stick Bass

Bass

27

Clean Gtr Pro2

Guitar

121

33

Finger Bass 1

Bass

27

Stra. Vel. Pro

Guitar

121

33

Finger Bass 2

Bass

17

27

Stra. Gtr Slide

Guitar

121

33

Chorus Fing.Bass

Bass

121

18

27

Chorus Gtr Pro

Guitar

121

33

Bright Finger B.

Bass

121

19

27

Vintage S.1

Guitar

121

10

33

Finger Bass Vel.

Bass

121

20

27

Clean Guitar 1

Guitar

121

11

33

More mid! Bass

Bass

121

21

27

Solid Guitar

Guitar

121

12

33

Finger Slap 1

Bass

121

22

27

Stein Guitar 1

Guitar

121

13

33

Finger Bass RX

Bass

121

23

27

Stein Guitar 2

Guitar

121

14

33

FingerB.& Guitar

Bass

121

24

27

Stein Guitar 3

Guitar

121

15

33

Finger Bass 4

Bass

121

25

27

Clean Guitar 3

Guitar

121

34

Picked E.Bass 3

Bass

121

28

Muted Guitar

Guitar

121

34

Picked E.Bass 1

Bass

121

28

Funky Cut Gtr

Guitar

121

34

Picked E.Bass 2

Bass

121

28

Mute Vel. Gtr

Guitar

121

34

Stein Bass

Bass

121

28

Jazz Man

Guitar

121

34

Guitar Bass

Bass

121

28

R&R Guitar

Guitar

121

34

Bass Mute

Bass

121

28

Stra. Chime

Guitar

121

34

Bass&Gtr Double

Bass

121

28

Clean Mute Gtr

Guitar

121

34

Pick Bass Vel.1

Bass

121

28

Rhythm E.Guitar

Guitar

121

34

Pick Bass Vel.2

Bass

121

28

Clean Funk

Guitar

121

34

Ticktacing Bass

Bass

121

28

Disto Mute

Guitar

121

10

34

Picked Bass RX

Bass

121

10

28

Clean Funk RX1

Guitar

121

11

34

Picked E. Bass 4

Bass

121

11

28

Clean Funk RX2

Guitar

121

35

Fretless Bass 1

Bass

121

12

28

Funk Stein RX1

Guitar

121

35

Fretless Bass2

Bass

121

13

28

Funk Stein RX2

Guitar

121

35

Fretless Sw.

Bass

121

14

28

Clean Guitar RX1

Guitar

121

35

Sweet Fretless

Bass

121

15

28

Clean Guitar RX2

Guitar

121

35

Dark R&B Bass1

Bass

121

16

28

Clean Guitar RX3

Guitar

121

35

Dark R&B Bass2

Bass

121

17

28

Clean Guitar RX4

Guitar

121

35

Woofer Pusher B.

Bass

121

18

28

Clean Guitar RX5

Guitar

121

35

Fretless Bass3

Bass

121

19

28

Muted Guitar 2

Guitar

121

36

Slap Bass 2

Bass

121

29

Overdrive Guitar

Guitar

121

36

Super Sw.Bass1

Bass

121

29

Guitar Pinch

Guitar

121

36

Super Sw.Bass2

Bass

121

30

Distortion Gtr

Guitar

121

36

FunkSlap Bass RX

Bass

121

30

Feedback Guitar

Guitar

121

36

SlapFing Bass RX

Bass

121

30

Dist.Rhytmic Gtr

Guitar

121

36

SlapPick Bass RX

Bass

121

30

Joystick Gtr Y-

Guitar

121

36

Slap Bass 4

Bass

121

30

Power Chords

Guitar

121

37

Slap Bass 3

Bass

121

30

Mute Monster

Guitar

121

37

Thumb Bass

Bass

121

30

Wet Dist. Guitar

Guitar

121

37

Dyna Bass

Bass

121

30

Solo Dist. Guitar

Guitar

121

37

Slap Bass Vel.

Bass

121

30

Stereo Dist. Gtr

Guitar

121

37

Chorus Slap Bass

Bass

121

30

Dist. Guitar RX1

Guitar

121

37

The Other Slap

Bass

121

10

30

Dist. Guitar RX2

Guitar

121

37

Slap Bass 1

Bass

121

31

Guitar Harmonic

Guitar

121

37

Slap Bass 5

Bass

121

31

Guitar Feedback

Guitar

121

38

Synth Bass 1

Bass

121

31

E.Gtr Harmonics

Guitar

121

38

Syn Bass Warm

Bass

121

32

Acoustic Bass

Bass

121

38

Syn Bass Reso

Bass

121

32

Ac. Bass Buzz

Bass

121

38

Clav Bass

Bass

121

32

Bass & Ride 2

Bass

121

38

Hammer

Bass

121

32

Acous. Bass Pro1

Bass

121

38

30303 Bass

Bass

121

32

Acous. Bass Pro2

Bass

121

38

30303 Square

Bass

121

32

DarkWoody A.Bass

Bass

121

38

Bass Square

Bass

121

32

Bass & Ride 1

Bass

121

38

Syn Bass Res

Bass

121

32

Acous. Bass RX

Bass

121

38

Digi Bass 1

Bass

121

32

Acoustic Bass 2

Bass

121

10

38

Digi Bass 2

Bass

121

33

Finger Bass 3

Bass

121

11

38

Digi Bass 3

Bass

121

33

Finger Slap 2

Bass

121

12

38

Blind as a Bat

Bass

121

33

Finger E.Bass1

Bass

121

13

38

Jungle Bass

Bass

GM2

Appendix

Factory data

294

Factory data
Sounds

CC00

CC32

PC

Name

Bank

121

14

38

Auto Pilot 1

121

15

38

Hybrid Bass

121

16

38

Dr. Octave

Bass

GM2

CC00

CC32

PC

Name

Bank

GM2

Synth 2

121

50

Synth Strings 1

Strings & Vocal

Bass

121

50

Synth Strings 3

Strings & Vocal

121

50

Analog Strings 2

Strings & Vocal

121

17

38

Drive Bass

Bass

121

50

Analog Velve

Strings & Vocal

121

18

38

Synth Bass 3

Bass

121

50

Odissey

Strings & Vocal

121

39

Synth Bass 2

Bass

121

50

Analog Strings 1

Strings & Vocal

121

39

Attack Bass

Bass

121

50

Synth Strings 4

Strings & Vocal

121

39

Rubber Bass

Bass

121

51

Synth Strings 2

Strings & Vocal

121

39

Attack Pulse

Bass

121

51

Synth Strings 5

Strings & Vocal

121

39

Euro Bass

Bass

121

52

Choir Aahs 1

Strings & Vocal

121

39

Jungle Rez

Bass

121

52

Choir Aahs 2

Strings & Vocal

121

39

Nasty Bass

Bass

121

52

Oooh Voices

Strings & Vocal

121

39

Phat Bass

Bass

121

52

Oooh Slow Voice

Strings & Vocal

121

39

Poinker Bass

Bass

121

52

Take Voices 1

Strings & Vocal

121

39

Synth Bass 80ish

Bass

121

52

Take Voices 2

Strings & Vocal

121

10

39

Autofilter Bass

Bass

121

52

Oooh Choir

Strings & Vocal

121

11

39

Monofilter Bass

Bass

121

52

Aaah Choir

Strings & Vocal

121

12

39

Reso Bass

Bass

121

52

Mmmh Choir

Strings & Vocal

121

13

39

Auto Pilot 2

Bass

121

52

Oh-Ah Voices

Strings & Vocal

121

14

39

Bass4 Da Phunk

Bass

121

10

52

Slow Choir

Strings & Vocal

121

15

39

Synth Bass 4

Bass

121

11

52

Grand Choir

Strings & Vocal

121

40

Violin

Strings & Vocal

121

12

52

Choir Light

Strings & Vocal

121

40

Slow Att.Violin

Strings & Vocal

121

13

52

Strings Choir

Strings & Vocal

121

40

Solo Violin

Strings & Vocal

121

53

Voice Ooohs

Strings & Vocal

121

40

Slow Violin

Strings & Vocal

121

53

Humming

Strings & Vocal

121

41

Viola

Strings & Vocal

121

53

Doolally

Strings & Vocal

121

42

Cello

Strings & Vocal

121

53

Airways

Strings & Vocal

121

43

Contrabass

Strings & Vocal

121

54

Synth Voice

Strings & Vocal

121

44

Tremolo Strings

Strings & Vocal

121

54

Analog Voice

Strings & Vocal

121

45

Pizzicato Str.

Strings & Vocal

121

54

Vocalesque

Strings & Vocal

121

45

Pizz. Ensemble

Strings & Vocal

121

54

Vocalscape

Strings & Vocal

121

45

Pizz. Section

Strings & Vocal

121

54

Classic Vox

Strings & Vocal

121

45

Double Strings

Strings & Vocal

121

54

Dream Voice

Strings & Vocal

121

46

Orchestral Harp

Strings & Vocal

121

55

Orchestra Hit

Brass

121

46

Yang Chin

Strings & Vocal

121

55

Bass Hit Plus

Brass

121

47

Timpani

Drum & Perc.

121

55

6th Hit

Brass

121

48

Strings Ens. 1

Strings & Vocal

121

55

Euro Hit

Brass

121

48

Strings & Brass

Strings & Vocal

121

55

Brass Impact

Brass

121

48

60s Strings

Strings & Vocal

121

55

Hit in India

SFX

121

48

Stereo Strings

Strings & Vocal

121

55

Wild Arp

Synth 2

121

48

Legato Strings

Strings & Vocal

121

55

Flip Blip

Synth 2

121

48

i3 Strings

Strings & Vocal

121

55

Netherland Hit

Brass

121

48

N Strings

Strings & Vocal

121

56

Trumpet 1

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

48

Arco Strings

Strings & Vocal

121

56

Dark Trumpet

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

48

Octave Strings

Strings & Vocal

121

56

Trumpet 2

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

48

Strings Quartet

Strings & Vocal

121

56

Mono Trumpet

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

10

48

Symphonic Bows

Strings & Vocal

121

56

Trumpet Expr

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

11

48

Ensemble & Solo

Strings & Vocal

121

56

Trumpet Pitch

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

12

48

Camera Strings

Strings & Vocal

121

56

Dual Trumpets

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

13

48

Arabic Strings

Strings & Vocal

121

56

Flugel Horn

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

14

48

Orchestra Tutti1

Strings & Vocal

121

56

Warm Flugel

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

15

48

Strings & Horns

Strings & Vocal

121

56

BeBop Cornet

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

16

48

Orch. & Oboe 1

Strings & Vocal

121

10

56

Trumpet Pro 1

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

17

48

Orch. & Oboe 2

Strings & Vocal

121

11

56

Trumpet Pro 2

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

18

48

Strings & Glock.

Strings & Vocal

121

12

56

Sweet FlugelHorn

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

19

48

Orchestra Tutti2

Strings & Vocal

121

13

56

Flugel Horn Pro

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

20

48

Orchestra&Flute

Strings & Vocal

121

14

56

Trumpet 3

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

21

48

Strings Ens. 3

Strings & Vocal

121

57

Trombone 1

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

49

Strings Ens. 2

Strings & Vocal

121

57

Trombone 2

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

49

Sweeper Strings

Strings & Vocal

121

57

Bright Trombone

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

49

Full Strings

Strings & Vocal

121

57

Hard Trombone

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

49

Strings Ens. 4

Strings & Vocal

121

57

Soft Trombone

Trumpet & Trbn.

Factory data
Sounds

CC00

CC32

PC

Name

Bank

121

57

Pitch Trombone

121

57

Trombone Expr. 1

121

57

121

57

121

121

10

GM2

CC00

CC32

PC

Name

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

63

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

63

Trombone Expr. 2

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

Trombone Vel. 1

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

57

Trombone Vel. 2

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

57

Trombone Vel. 3

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

295

Bank

GM2

Analog Brass 2

Brass

Brass Pad

Brass

63

Big Panner

Synth 1

63

Synth Brass 6

Brass

64

Soprano Sax

Sax

64

Sweet Soprano 3

Sax

121

11

57

Trombone Pro Vel

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

64

Soprano Pro

Sax

121

12

57

Trombone 3

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

64

Sweet Soprano 1

Sax

121

58

Tuba

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

64

Sweet Soprano 2

Sax

121

58

Oberkr. Tuba

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

65

Alto Sax

Sax

121

58

Tuba Gold

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

65

Alto Breath

Sax

121

58

Dynabone

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

65

Sax Ensemble

Sax

121

59

Mute Trumpet 1

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

65

Breathy Alto Sax

Sax

121

59

Mute Trumpet 2

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

65

Alto Sax Growl

Sax

121

59

Wah Trumpet

Trumpet & Trbn.

121

65

Sweet Alto Sax 1

Sax

121

59

Mute Ensemble 1

Brass

121

65

Sweet Alto Sax 2

Sax

121

59

Mute Ensemble 2

Brass

121

65

Soft Alto Sax

Sax

121

60

French Horn 1

Brass

121

65

Alto Sax Pro

Sax

121

60

French Horn 2

Brass

121

66

Tenor Sax

Sax

121

60

French Section

Brass

121

66

Tenor Sax Noise1

Sax

121

60

Classic Horns

Brass

121

66

Soft Tenor

Sax

121

60

Horns & Ensemble

Brass

121

66

Tenor Breath

Sax

121

61

Brass Section 1

Brass

121

66

Tenor Growl

Sax

121

61

Brass Section 2

Brass

121

66

Folk Sax

Sax

121

61

Tight Brass 3

Brass

121

66

Tenor Sax Noise2

Sax

121

61

Glen & Friends

Brass

121

66

Tenor Sax Expr.1

Sax

121

61

Big Band Brass

Brass

121

66

Tenor Sax Expr.2

Sax

121

61

Sax & Brass

Brass

121

66

Jazz Tenor Vel.1

Sax

121

61

Glen & Boys

Brass

121

10

66

Jazz Tenor Vel.2

Sax

121

61

Trumpet & Brass

Brass

121

11

66

Reed of Power

Sax

121

61

Attack Brass

Brass

121

67

Baritone Sax

Sax

121

61

Trumpet Ens.

Brass

121

67

Baritone Growl

Sax

121

10

61

Trombone Ens.

Brass

121

67

Breathy Baritone

Sax

121

11

61

Trombones

Brass

121

67

Baritone Sax Pro

Sax

121

12

61

Tight Brass 4

Brass

121

67

Baritone Sax 2

Sax

121

13

61

Fat Brass

Brass

121

68

Oboe

Woodwind

121

14

61

Dyna Brass 1

Brass

121

68

Double Reed

Woodwind

121

15

61

Brass Expr.

Brass

121

69

English Horn 1

Woodwind

121

16

61

Brass Band

Brass

121

69

English Horn 2

Woodwind

121

17

61

Film Brass

Brass

121

70

Bassoon

Woodwind

121

18

61

Brass Slow

Brass

121

71

Clarinet

Woodwind

121

19

61

Fanfare

Brass

121

71

Jazz Clarinet

Woodwind

121

20

61

Movie Brass

Brass

121

71

Clarinet G

Woodwind

121

21

61

Power Brass

Brass

121

71

Section Winds 1

Woodwind

121

22

61

Dyna Brass 2

Brass

121

71

Section Winds 2

Woodwind

121

23

61

Sforzato Brass

Brass

121

71

Clarinet Ens.

Woodwind

121

24

61

Double Brass

Brass

121

71

Woodwinds

Woodwind

121

25

61

Brass Hit

Brass

121

71

Folk Clarinet

Woodwind

121

26

61

Brass Fall

Brass

121

72

Piccolo

Woodwind

121

27

61

Tight Brass 1

Brass

121

72

Small Orchestra

Woodwind

121

28

61

Tight Brass Pro

Brass

121

72

Nay

Woodwind

121

29

61

Tight Brass 2

Brass

121

73

Flute 1

Woodwind

121

30

61

Brass of Power

Brass

121

73

Jazz Flute

Woodwind

121

31

61

Brass Section 3

Brass

121

73

Flute Switch

Woodwind

121

62

Synth Brass 1

Brass

121

73

Flute Dyn. 5th

Woodwind

121

62

Synth Brass 3

Brass

121

73

Flute Frullato

Woodwind

121

62

Analog Brass 1

Brass

121

73

Orchestra Flute

Woodwind

121

62

Jump Brass

Brass

121

73

Flute Muted

Brass

121

62

Electrik Brass

Brass

121

73

Wooden Flute

Woodwind

121

62

Synth Brass 5

Brass

121

73

Bambu Flute

Woodwind

121

63

Synth Brass 2

Brass

121

73

Flute 2

Woodwind

121

63

Synth Brass 4

Brass

121

74

Recorder 1

Woodwind

Appendix

296

Factory data
Sounds

CC00

CC32

PC

Name

Bank

GM2

CC00

CC32

PC

Name

Bank

121

74

Recorder 2

Woodwind

121

75

Pan Flute

Woodwind

121

10

87

OB Lead

Synth 2

121

11

87

A Leadload

121

75

Kawala

Woodwind

Synth 2

121

88

New Age Pad

Synth 2

121

76

Blown Bottle

Woodwind

121

88

Virtual Traveler

Synth 1

121

77

Shakuhachi 1

Woodwind

121

77

Old Shakuhachi

Woodwind

121

88

Arp Angeles

Synth 2

121

89

Warm Pad

121

77

Shakuhachi 2

Woodwind

Synth 1

121

89

Sine Pad

Synth 1

121

78

Whistle 1

Woodwind

121

89

Master Pad

Strings & Vocal

121

78

Whistle 2

Woodwind

121

79

Ocarina

Woodwind

121

89

Power Synth

Synth 2

121

89

The Pad

121

80

Lead Square 1

Synth 2

Synth 1

121

89

Money Pad

121

80

Lead Square 2

Synth 1

Synth 2

121

89

Dark Pad

121

80

Synth 1

Lead Sine

Synth 2

121

89

Freedom Pad

121

Synth 1

80

Old Portamento

Synth 2

121

89

Analog Pad 1

121

Synth 1

80

Dance Lead

Synth 2

121

89

Analog Pad 2

Synth 1

121

80

Wave Lead

Synth 2

121

10

89

Analog Pad 3

Synth 1

121

80

Sine Wave

Synth 2

121

11

89

Vintage Pad

Synth 1

121

80

Analog Lead

Synth 2

121

12

89

OB Pad

Synth 1

121

80

Old & Analog

Synth 2

121

13

89

Dark Anna

Synth 1

121

80

Gliding Square

Synth 2

121

14

89

Symphonic Ens.

Synth 1

121

10

80

Sine Switch

Synth 2

121

90

Polysynth

Synth 2

121

11

80

Square Rez

Synth 2

121

90

Reso Sweep

Synth 2

121

12

80

Port Whine

Synth 2

121

90

Sky Watcher

Synth 1

121

13

80

2VCO Planet Lead

Synth 2

121

90

Synth Sweeper

Synth 2

121

81

Lead Saw 1

Synth 2

121

90

Super Sweep

Synth 1

121

81

Lead Saw 2

Synth 2

121

90

Wave Sweep

Synth 1

121

81

Lead Saw Pulse

Synth 2

121

90

Cross Sweep

Synth 1

121

81

Lead Double Saw

Synth 2

121

90

Digital PolySix

Synth 2

121

81

Seq. Analog

Synth 2

121

90

Noisy Stabb

Synth 2

121

81

Power Saw

Synth 2

121

90

Mega Synth

Synth 2

121

81

Octo Lead

Synth 2

121

10

90

Tecno Phonic

Synth 2

121

81

Seq Lead

Synth 2

121

11

90

Farluce

Synth 1

121

81

Phat Saw Lead

Synth 2

121

12

90

Big Sweep Stab

Synth 1

121

81

Glide Lead

Synth 2

121

13

90

Korgmatose

Synth 1

121

10

81

Fire Wave

Synth 2

121

91

Choir Pad

Strings & Vocal

121

11

81

Rezbo

Synth 2

121

91

Itopia Pad

Synth 1

121

12

81

Synth Pianoid

Synth 2

121

91

Fresh Air

Strings & Vocal

121

82

Calliope

Synth 2

121

91

Heaven

Strings & Vocal

121

83

Chiff

Synth 2

121

91

Pop Synth Pad

Synth 2

121

84

Charang

Synth 2

121

91

Future Pad

Synth 1

121

84

Wire Lead

Synth 2

121

91

Tsunami Wave

Synth 1

121

84

Synchro City

Synth 2

121

91

Fresh Breath

Strings & Vocal

121

84

Sync Kron

Synth 2

121

91

Ravelian Pad

Synth 1

121

84

Metallic Rez

Synth 2

121

91

Full Vox Pad

Strings & Vocal

121

84

Brian Sync

Synth 2

121

10

91

Dance ReMix

Synth 1

121

84

Arp Twins

Synth 2

121

92

Bowed Glass

Synth 2

121

84

LoFi Ethnic

Synth 2

121

93

Metallic Pad

Synth 2

121

85

Voice Lead

Strings & Vocal

121

93

Cosmic

Synth 2

121

85

Ether Voices

Strings & Vocal

121

94

Halo Pad

Strings & Vocal

121

85

Cyber Choir

Strings & Vocal

121

95

Sweep Pad

Synth 1

121

86

Fifths Lead

Synth 2

121

95

Astral Dream

Synth 1

121

86

Crimson 5ths

Synth 1

121

95

Meditate

Synth 1

121

87

Bass & Lead

Synth 2

121

95

Dark Element

Synth 2

121

87

Soft Wrl

Synth 2

121

95

Mellow Pad

Synth 1

121

87

Electro Lead

Synth 2

121

95

Cinema Pad

Synth 1

121

87

Rich Lead

Synth 2

121

95

Reoccuring Astra

Synth 1

121

87

Thin Analog Lead

Synth 2

121

95

Vintage Sweep

Synth 1

121

87

Express. Lead

Synth 2

121

95

You Decide

Synth 1

121

87

HipHop Lead

Synth 2

121

96

Ice Rain

SFX

121

87

Square Bass

Synth 2

121

96

Motion Ocean

Synth 1

121

87

Big & Raw

Synth 2

121

96

Caribbean

Synth 2

121

87

Cat Lead

Synth 2

121

97

Soundtrack

Synth 1

GM2

Sounds

CC00

CC32

PC

Name

Bank

121

97

Air Clouds

121

97

Reso Down

121

97

121

121

121

GM2

297

CC00

CC32

PC

Name

Bank

Synth 1

121

113

Agogo

Drum & Perc.

Synth 1

121

114

Steel Drums

Mallet & Bell

Tinklin Pad

Synth 1

121

114

Warm Steel

Mallet & Bell

97

Pods In Pad

Synth 1

121

115

Woodblock

Drum & Perc.

97

Noble Pad

Synth 1

121

115

Castanets

Drum & Perc.

97

Rave

Synth 1

121

116

Taiko Drum

Drum & Perc.

121

97

Elastick Pad

Synth 1

121

116

Concert BassDrum

Drum & Perc.

121

98

Crystal

Synth 2

121

117

Melodic Tom 1

Drum & Perc.

121

98

Synth Mallet

SFX

121

117

Melodic Tom 2

Drum & Perc.

121

98

Vs Bell Boy

Mallet & Bell

121

117

Reverse Tom

Drum & Perc.

121

98

Krystal Bell

Mallet & Bell

121

118

Synth Drum

Drum & Perc.

121

98

Digi Bell

Mallet & Bell

121

118

Rhythm Box Tom

Drum & Perc.

121

98

Moving Bell

Synth 1

121

118

Electric Drum

Drum & Perc.

121

98

Bell Pad

Synth 1

121

118

Reverse Snare

Drum & Perc.

121

98

Bell Choir

Synth 1

121

119

Reverse Cymbal

Drum & Perc.

121

99

Atmosphere

Synth 2

121

119

Dragon Gong

Drum & Perc.

121

100

Brightness

Synth 2

121

119

Reverse Cymbal 2

Drum & Perc.

121

100

Lonely Spin

Synth 1

121

120

Guitar FretNoise

SFX

121

100

Synth Ghostly

Synth 1

121

120

Guitar Cut Noise

SFX

121

101

Goblins

SFX

121

120

Ac. Bass String

SFX

121

101

Motion Raver

Synth 2

121

120

Vox Wah Chick

Guitar

121

101

Digi Ice Pad

Synth 1

121

121

Breath Noise

SFX

121

101

VCF Modulation

Synth 2

121

121

Flute Click

Woodwind

121

102

Echo Drops

SFX

121

122

Seashore

SFX

121

102

Echo Bell

SFX

121

122

Rain

SFX

121

102

Echo Pan

SFX

121

122

Thunder

SFX

121

102

Band Passed

Synth 2

121

122

Wind

SFX

121

102

Pan Reso

Synth 2

121

122

Stream

SFX

121

102

Moon Cycles

Synth 1

121

122

Bubble

SFX

121

103

Star Theme

SFX

121

123

Bird Tweet 1

SFX

121

104

Sitar 1

Guitar

121

123

Dog

SFX

121

104

Sitar 2

Guitar

121

123

Horse Gallop

SFX

121

104

Sitar Tambou

Guitar

121

123

Bird Tweet 2

SFX

121

104

Indian Stars

Guitar

121

124

Telephone 1

SFX

121

104

Indian Frets

Guitar

121

124

Telephone 2

SFX

121

104

Bouzouki

Guitar

121

124

Door Creak

SFX

121

104

Tambra

Guitar

121

124

Door

SFX

121

104

Sitar Sitar

Guitar

121

124

Scratch

SFX

121

105

Banjo

Guitar

121

124

Wind Chime

SFX

121

105

Banjo Key Off

Guitar

121

125

Helicopter

SFX

121

105

Oud

Guitar

121

125

Car Engine

SFX

121

105

Jaw Harp

SFX

121

125

Car Stop

SFX

121

106

Shamisen

Guitar

121

125

Car Pass

SFX

121

107

Koto

Guitar

121

125

Car Crash

SFX

121

107

Taisho Koto

Guitar

121

125

Siren

SFX

121

107

Kanun

Guitar

121

125

Train

SFX

121

107

Kanun Trem.

Guitar

121

125

Jet Plane

SFX

121

107

Kanun Mix

Guitar

121

125

Starship

SFX

121

108

Kalimba

Mallet & Bell

121

125

Burst Noise

SFX

121

108

Kalimba Vel.

Mallet & Bell

121

126

Applause

SFX

121

109

Bag Pipes

Woodwind

121

126

Laughing

SFX

121

109

War Pipes

Woodwind

121

126

Screaming

SFX

121

109

Uillean BagPipes

Woodwind

121

126

Punch

SFX

121

109

HighlandBagPipes

Woodwind

121

126

Heart Beat

SFX

121

110

Fiddle

Strings & Vocal

121

126

Footsteps

SFX

121

111

Shanai

Woodwind

121

126

Stadium

SFX

121

111

Zurna

Woodwind

121

127

Gun Shot

SFX

121

111

Hichiriki

Woodwind

121

127

Machine Gun

SFX

121

112

Tinkle Bell

Mallet & Bell

121

127

Laser Gun

SFX

121

112

Gamelan

Mallet & Bell

121

127

Explosion

SFX

121

112

Bali Gamelan

Mallet & Bell

121

127

16

Digital Drawbars

Digi Organ

121

112

Garbage Mall

Mallet & Bell

121

64

0-127

User 1

GM2

Appendix

Factory data

298

Factory data
Sounds

CC00

CC32

PC

Name

Bank

121

65

0-127

User 2

121

68

0-127

EXB1 Bank 1

121

69

0-127

EXB1 Bank 2

121

70

0-127

EXB2 Bank 1

121

71

0-127

EXB2 Bank 2

GM2

Factory data
Drum Kits

299

Drum Kits
The following table lists all Pa1X Factory Drum Kits in order of
Bank Select-Program Change number.

PC

Name

PC

Name

42

Brush Kit RX

120

120

120

120

120

50

Bdrum & Sdrum

120

51

Arabian Kit 1

120

GM2

120

120

Legend: The table also includes MIDI data used to remotely select
the Drum Kits. CC00: Control Change 0, or Bank Select MSB.
CC32: Control Change 32, or Bank Select LSB. PC: Program
Change.

GM2

43-47 (remap to 40)


48

Orchestra Kit

49 (remap to 48)

52-55 (remap to 48)


56

SFX Kit

57-63 (remap to 56)

120

Standard Kit RX1

120

Standard Kit RX2

120

64

Percussion Kit

120

Standard Kit RX3

120

65

Latin Perc. Kit

120

Acoustic Kit

120

66

Trinity Perc.Kit

120

Pop Std. Kit RX

120

67

i30 Perc. Kit

120

Standard Kit 1

120

120

Standard Kit 2

120

72

Hip Hop Kit RX

120

Standard Kit 3

120

73

Techno Kit RX

120

Room Kit 1

120

74

Dance Kit RX

120

HipHop Kit 1

120

120

10

Jungle Kit

120

88

Standard Kit 4

120

11

Techno Kit 1

120

89

Pop Std. Kit 1

120

12

Room Kit 2

120

90

Pop Std. Kit 2

120

13

HipHop Kit 2

120

120

14

Techno Kit 2

120

96

Elektro Kit 1

120

15

Techno Kit 3

120

97

Elektro Kit 2

120

16

Power Kit 1

120

98-115 (remap to 5)

120

17

Power Kit 2

120

116 (remap to 51)

120

18

Power Kit RX1

120

120

19

Power Kit RX2

120

120

120

119

Standard Kit 5

120

24

Electro Kit

120

120

Room Kit 3

120

25

Analog Kit

120

121

Power Kit 3

120

26

House Kit 1

120

122

Elektro Kit 2

120

27

House Kit 2

120

123

Analog Kit 2

120

28

House Kit 3

120

124

Jazz Kit 2

120

29

House Kit 4

120

125

Brush Kit 3

120

30

House Kit RX1

120

126

Orchestra Kit 2

120

31

House Kit RX2

120

120

32

Jazz Kit RX1

127

SFX Kit 2

120

33

Jazz Kit

120

64

0-63

User DrumKits (1-64)

120

34

Jazz Kit RX2

120

68

0-63

EXB1 DrumKits (1-64)

120

35

Jazz Kit RX3

120

70

0-63

EXB2 DrumKits (1-64)

120

120

40

Brush Kit 1

120

41

Brush Kit 2 VS

20-23 (remap to 16)

68-71 (remap to 64)

75-87 (remap to 5)

91-95 (remap to 5)

117

Arabian Kit 2

118 (remap to 5)

36-39 (remap to 32)

Appendix

CC00 CC32

CC00 CC32

300

Factory data
Drum Kit maps

Drum Kit maps


Legend: In the following Drum Kit tables, the number 120-x-x before each Drum Kits name represents the Bank Select MSB (CC00) - Bank
Select LSB (CC32) - Program Change (PC) combo. The Sample columns contain each samples number and name. Excl is the Exlcusive
parameter: when a note is struck, all other notes with the same Exclusive number assigned are stopped. A number between round parenteses
(n) means a velocity switch, and the number of used velocity layers.
Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71

C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4

120-0-0: Standard Kit RX1


Sample
Excl.
45
SD Wood 2 pp
Off
60
SD Solid2 p
Off
79
SD Brass2 mf
Off
75
SD Brass1 p
Off
69
SD Maple2 pp
Off
63
SD Maple1 pp
Off
57
SD Solid1 p
Off
53
SD Piccolo2 pp
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
25
BD House 4
Off
228 99 SD
Off
40
BD Deep 88
Off
227 88 SD
Off
53~56 SD Piccolo2 pp~f (4)
Off
49~52 SD Piccolo1 pp~f (4)
Off
10
BD Jazz (2)
Off
7
BD Dry 3
Off
57~59 SD Solid1 p~f (3)
Off
160~165 HH2 Closed pp~ff (6) Off
8
BD Normal
Off
129 Rim Shot f
Off
45~48 SD Wood 2 pp~f (4)
Off
42~44 SD Wood 1 p~f (3)
Off
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
78~80 SD Brass2 p~f (3)
Off
81
SD Roll
7
221 Finger Snaps
Off
270 Zap2
Off
410 Noise White
Off
272 DJ Scratch2
7
272 DJ Scratch2
7
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
269 Zap1
Off
376 Click
Off
340 Triangle Open
Off
3~4 BD Acoust.2 mf~f (3) Off
0~2 BD Acoust.1 P~f (4)
Off
128-129 Rim Shot p-f (2)
Off
69~74 SD Maple2 pp~ff (6)
Off
230 88 Claps
Off
63~68 SD Maple1 pp~ff (6)
Off
139-140 Tom1 Floor p-f (2)
Off
160~165 HH2 Closed pp~ff (6)
1
137-138 Tom1 Low p-F (2)
Off
166-167 HH2 Foot p-F (2)
1
135-136 Tom1 Mid p-F (2)
Off
168-169 HH2 Open p-f (2)
1
135-136 Tom1 Mid p-f (2)
Off
133-134 Tom1 Hi p-f (2)
Off
195 Crash 19'open2 (2)
Off
133-134 Tom1 Hi p-f (2)
Off
207-209 Ride 20' mp2-mf2 (2) Off
198 China
Off
215 Ride Cup
Off
339 Tambourine Acc2
Off
199 Splash 8'edge1
Off
352 Cowbell
Off
193 Crash 17'edge2 (2)
Off
325 Vibraslap
Off
206-208 Ride 20' mp1-mf1 (2) Off
298 Bongo Hi Open
Off
295 Bongo Lo Open
Off
292 Conga Hi Slap2
Off
288 Conga Hi Open
Off
285 Conga Lo Open
Off
334 Timbale Hi Rim2
Off
329 Timbale Lo Open
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
346 Cabasa Up
Off
309 Maracas Push
Off
361 Samba Whistle
2

120-0-1: Standard Kit RX2


Sample
Excl.
45
SD Wood 2 pp
Off
60
SD Solid2 p
Off
79
SD Brass2 mf
Off
75
SD Brass1 p
Off
69
SD Maple2 pp
Off
63
SD Maple1 pp
Off
57
SD Solid1 p
Off
53
SD Piccolo2 pp
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
25
BD House 4
Off
228 99 SD
Off
40
BD Deep 88
Off
227 88 SD
Off
69~74 SD Maple2 pp~ff (6)
Off
63~68 SD Maple1 pp~ff (6)
Off
10
BD Jazz (2)
Off
1
BD Acoust.1 mf
Off
49~52 SD Piccolo1 pp~f (4)
Off
152~155 HH1 Closed pp~f (4)
Off
4
BD Acoust.2 f
Off
129 Rim Shot f
Off
60~62 SD Solid2 p~f (3)
Off
57~59 SD Solid1 p~f (3)
Off
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
78~80 SD Brass2 p~f (3)
Off
81
SD Roll
7
221 Finger Snaps
Off
270 Zap2
Off
410 Noise White
Off
272 DJ Scratch2
7
272 DJ Scratch2
7
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
269 Zap1
Off
376 Click
Off
340 Triangle Open
Off
0~2 BD Acoust.1 p~f (4)
Off
3~4 BD Acoust.2 mf~f (3) Off
128-129 Rim Shot p-f (2)
Off
45~48 SD Wood 2 pp~f (4)
Off
230 88 Claps
Off
42~44 SD Wood 1 p~f (3)
Off
139-140 Tom1 Floor p-f (2)
Off
152~155 HH1 Closed pp~f (4)
1
137-138 Tom1 Low p-f (2)
Off
156-157 HH1 Foot mp-mf (2)
1
135-136 Tom1 Mid p-f (2)
Off
158-159 HH1 Open mp-mf (2)
1
135-136 Tom1 Mid p-f (2)
Off
133-134 Tom1 Hi p-f (2)
Off
193 Crash 17'edge2 (2)
Off
133-134 Tom1 Hi p-f (2)
Off
207-209 Ride 20' mp2-mf2 (2) Off
198 China
Off
215 Ride Cup
Off
339 Tambourine Acc2
Off
199 Splash 8'edge1
Off
352 Cowbell
Off
191 Crash 15'edge2 (2)
Off
325 Vibraslap
Off
206-208 Ride 20' mp1-mf1 (2) Off
298 Bongo Hi Open
Off
295 Bongo Lo Open
Off
286 Conga Lo Mt Slap
Off
288 Conga Hi Open
Off
285 Conga Lo Open
Off
334 Timbale Hi Rim2
Off
329 Timbale Lo Open
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
346 Cabasa Up
Off
309 Maracas Push
Off
361 Samba Whistle
2

120-0-2: Standard Kit RX3


Sample
Excl.
45
SD Wood 2 pp
Off
60
SD Solid2 p
Off
79
SD Brass2 mf
Off
75
SD Brass1 p
Off
69
SD Maple2 pp
Off
63
SD Maple1 pp
Off
57
SD Solid1 p
Off
53
SD Piccolo2 pp
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
25
BD House 4
Off
228 99 SD
Off
40
BD Deep 88
Off
227 88 SD
Off
45~48 SD Wood 2 pp~f (4)
Off
42~44 SD Wood 1 p~f (3)
Off
10
BD Jazz (2)
Off
1
BD Acoust.1 mf
Off
63~68 SD Maple1 pp~ff (6)
Off
152~155 HH1 Closed pp~f (4)
Off
4
BD Acoust.2 f
Off
129 Rim Shot f
Off
53~56 SD Piccolo2 pp~f (4)
Off
49~52 SD Piccolo1 pp~f (4)
Off
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
78~80 SD Brass2 p~f (3)
Off
81
SD Roll
7
221 Finger Snaps
Off
270 Zap2
Off
410 Noise White
Off
272 DJ Scratch2
7
272 DJ Scratch2
7
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
269 Zap1
Off
376 Click
Off
340 Triangle Open
Off
0~2 BD Acoust.1 p~f (4)
Off
3~4 BD Acoust.2 mf~f (3) Off
128 Rim Shot p-f (2)
Off
60~62 SD Solid2 p~f (3)
Off
230 88 Claps
Off
57~59 SD Solid1 p~f (3)
Off
139-140 Tom1 Floor p-f (2)
Off
152~155 HH1 Closed pp~f (4)
1
137-138 Tom1 Low p-f (2)
Off
156-157 HH1 Foot mp-mf (2)
1
135-136 Tom1 Mid p-f (2)
Off
158-159 HH1 Open mp-mf (2)
1
135-136 Tom1 Mid p-f (2)
Off
133-134 Tom1 Hi p-f (2)
Off
193 Crash 17'edge2 (2)
Off
133-134 Tom1 Hi p-f (2)
Off
207 Ride 20' mp2
Off
198 China
Off
215 Ride Cup
Off
339 Tambourine Acc2
Off
199 Splash 8'edge1
Off
352 Cowbell
Off
191 Crash 15'edge2 (2)
Off
325 Vibraslap
Off
208 Ride 20' mf1
Off
298 Bongo Hi Open
Off
295 Bongo Lo Open
Off
286 Conga Lo Mt Slap
Off
288 Conga Hi Open
Off
285 Conga Lo Open
Off
334 Timbale Hi Rim2
Off
329 Timbale Lo Open
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
346 Cabasa Up
Off
309 Maracas Push
Off
361 Samba Whistle
2

120-0-3: Acoustic Kit


Sample
45
SD Wood 2 pp
60
SD Solid2 p
79
SD Brass2 mf
75
SD Brass1 p
69
SD Maple2 pp
63
SD Maple1 pp
57
SD Solid1 p
53
SD Piccolo2 pp
5
BD Dry 1
25
BD House 4
228 99 SD
226 88 BD
227 88 SD
89
SD Off Center
100 SD Cracker Room
11
BD Pillow
38
BD Amb.Rocker
91
SD Amb.Piccolo
171 HH3 Closed2
10
BD Jazz
130 Side Stick Dry
220 SD Orchestra
219 SD Orch. Roll
132 Drum Stick Hit
220 SD Orchestra
219 SD Orch. Roll
221 Finger Snaps
270 Zap2
410 Noise White
272 DJ Scratch2
272 DJ Scratch2
132 Drum Stick Hit
269 Zap1
376 Click
340 Triangle Open
8
BD Normal
11-5 BD Pillow-Dry 1 (2)
131 Side Stick Amb
86-87 SD Ghost p-f (2)
225 Claps 4
86-87 SD Ghost p-f (2)
145 Tom3 Floor
174 HH3 Open 2
145 Tom3 Floor
178 HH4 Foot
144 Tom3 Low
173 HH3 Open 1
144 Tom3 Low
143 Tom3 Hi
196 Crash 1
143 Tom3 Hi
213 Ride Edge 2
198 China
215 Ride Cup
339 Tambourine Acc2
201 Splash
352 Cowbell
196 Crash 1
325 Vibraslap
214 Ride Jazz
298 Bongo Hi Open
295 Bongo Lo Open
290 Conga Hi Mt Slap
288 Conga Hi Open
285 Conga Lo Open
334 Timbale Hi Rim2
329 Timbale Lo Open
351 Agogo Bell
351 Agogo Bell
346 Cabasa Up
309 Maracas Push
361 Samba Whistle

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2

Drum Kit maps

Note
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88

C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6

Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60

C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4

120-0-0: Standard Kit RX1


Sample
Excl.
361 Samba Whistle
2
308 Guiro Short
3
307 Guiro Long
3
326 Claves
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
342 Cuica Hi
4
343 Cuica Lo
4
341 Triangle Mute
5
340 Triangle Open
5
347 Cabasa Down
Off
355 Sleigh Bell
Off
358 Marc Tree
Off
305 Castanet Single
Off
330 Timbale Lo Mute
6
329 Timbale Lo Open
6
370 Stadium
Off

120-0-4: Pop Std.Kit RX


Sample
45
SD Wood 2 pp
60
SD Solid2 p
79
SD Brass2 mf
75
SD Brass1 p
69
SD Maple2 pp
63
SD Maple1 pp
57
SD Solid1 p
53
SD Piccolo2 pp
5
BD Dry 1
18
BD Squash
115 SD Hip6
226 88 BD
52
SD Piccolo1 f
59
SD Solid1 f
52
SD Piccolo1 f
36
BD Ambient
16
BD Gated
59
SD Solid1 f
161-162 HH2 Closed p-mp (2)
38
BD Amb.Rocker
130 Side Stick Dry
67
SD Maple1 f
68
SD Maple1 ff
132 Drum Stick Hit
59
SD Solid1 f
219 SD Orch. Roll
221 Finger Snaps
270 Zap2
410 Noise White
272 DJ Scratch2
272 DJ Scratch2
132 Drum Stick Hit
269 Zap1
376 Click
340 Triangle Open
38
BD Amb.Rocker
38
BD Amb.Rocker
129 Rim Shot f
47~59 SD Wood 2-Solid1 p~f (6)
230 88 Claps
47~59 SD Wood 2-Solid1 p~f (6)
140 Tom1 Floor f
160~163 HH2 Closed pp~mf (4)
138 Tom1 Low f
157-156 HH1 Foot mf-mp (2)
138 Tom1 Low f
168-169 HH2 Open p-f (2)
136 Tom1 Mid f
134 Tom1 Hi f
196 Crash 1
134 Tom1 Hi f
207-209 Ride 20' mp2-mf2 (2)
198 China
206-208 Ride 20' mp1-mf1 (2)
339 Tambourine Acc2
201 Splash
352 Cowbell
196 Crash 1
325 Vibraslap
206 Ride 20' mp1
298 Bongo Hi Open

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

120-0-1: Standard Kit RX2


Sample
Excl.
361 Samba Whistle
2
308 Guiro Short
3
307 Guiro Long
3
326 Claves
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
342 Cuica Hi
4
343 Cuica Lo
4
341 Triangle Mute
5
340 Triangle Open
5
347 Cabasa Down
Off
355 Sleigh Bell
Off
358 Marc Tree
Off
305 Castanet Single
Off
330 Timbale Lo Mute
6
329 Timbale Lo Open
6
370 Stadium
Off

120-0-2: Standard Kit RX3


Sample
Excl.
361 Samba Whistle
2
308 Guiro Short
3
307 Guiro Long
3
326 Claves
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
342 Cuica Hi
4
343 Cuica Lo
4
341 Triangle Mute
5
340 Triangle Open
5
347 Cabasa Down
Off
355 Sleigh Bell
Off
358 Marc Tree
Off
305 Castanet Single
Off
330 Timbale Lo Mute
6
329 Timbale Lo Open
6
370 Stadium
Off

120-0-5 (75~87, 89~115, 118~127): Standard Kit 1


Sample
Excl.
45
SD Wood 2 pp
Off
60
SD Solid2 p
Off
79
SD Brass2 mf
Off
75
SD Brass1 p
Off
69
SD Maple2 pp
Off
63
SD Maple1 pp
Off
57
SD Solid1 p
Off
53
SD Piccolo2 pp
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
25
BD House 4
Off
228 99 SD
Off
226 88 BD
Off
227 88 SD
Off
88
SD Full Room
Off
99
SD Processed
1
5
BD Dry 1
Off
17
BD Tight
Off
82
SD Dry 1
Off
171 HH3 Closed2
1
7
BD Dry 3
Off
131 Side Stick Amb
Off
220 SD Orchestra
7
219 SD Orch. Roll
7
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
220 SD Orchestra
7
219 SD Orch. Roll
7
221 Finger Snaps
Off
270 Zap2
Off
410 Noise White
Off
272 DJ Scratch2
7
272 DJ Scratch2
7
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
269 Zap1
Off
376 Click
Off
340 Triangle Open
Off
7
BD Dry 3
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
131 Side Stick Amb
Off
83
SD Dry 2
Off
225 Claps 4
Off
88
SD Full Room
Off
145 Tom3 Floor
Off
174 HH3 Open 2
1
145 Tom3 Floor
Off
178 HH4 Foot
1
144 Tom3 Low
Off
173 HH3 Open 1
1
144 Tom3 Low
Off
143 Tom3 Hi
Off
196 Crash 1
Off
143 Tom3 Hi
Off
213 Ride Edge 2
Off
198 China
Off
214 Ride Jazz
Off
339 Tambourine Acc2
Off
201 Splash
Off
352 Cowbell
Off
196 Crash 1
Off
325 Vibraslap
Off
213 Ride Edge 2
Off
298 Bongo Hi Open
Off

120-0-6: Standard Kit 2


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD House 4
99 SD
88 BD
88 SD
SD Amb.Piccolo
SD Processed
BD Pillow
BD Amb.Rocker
SD Jazz Ring
HH3 Closed2
BD Dry 1
Side Stick Dry
SD Dry 2
SD Cracker Room
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
BD Tight
BD Tubby
Side Stick Amb
SD Off Center
88 Claps
SD Off Center
Tom3 Floor
HH3 Closed1
Tom3 Floor
HH3 Foot
Tom3 Low
HH3 Open 1
Tom3 Low
Tom3 Hi
Crash 1
Tom3 Hi
Ride Edge 2
China
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc2
Splash
Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 2
Bongo Hi Open

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
25
228
226
227
91
99
11
38
90
171
5
130
83
100
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
17
15
131
89
230
89
145
170
145
172
144
173
144
143
196
143
213
198
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

301

361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-3: Acoustic Kit


Sample
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Lo
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
25
228
226
227
89
99
11
38
93
171
10
130
125
83
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
5
15
131
90
230
91
145
176
145
178
144
173
144
143
196
143
213
198
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298

120-0-7: Standard Kit 3


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD House 4
99 SD
88 BD
88 SD
SD Off Center
SD Processed
BD Pillow
BD Amb.Rocker
SD Brush Hit
HH3 Closed2
BD Jazz
Side Stick Dry
SD Brasser
SD Dry 2
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
BD Dry 1
BD Tubby
Side Stick Amb
SD Jazz Ring
88 Claps
SD Amb.Piccolo
Tom3 Floor
HH4 Closed1
Tom3 Floor
HH4 Foot
Tom3 Low
HH3 Open 1
Tom3 Low
Tom3 Hi
Crash 1
Tom3 Hi
Ride Edge 2
China
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc2
Splash
Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 2
Bongo Hi Open

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

Appendix

Factory data

302

Factory data
Drum Kit maps

295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-4: Pop Std.Kit RX


Sample
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Maracas Push
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Lo
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

120-0-5 (75~87, 89~115, 118~127): Standard Kit 1


Sample
Excl.
295 Bongo Lo Open
Off
286 Conga Lo Mt Slap
Off
288 Conga Hi Open
Off
285 Conga Lo Open
Off
334 Timbale Hi Rim2
Off
329 Timbale Lo Open
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
346 Cabasa Up
Off
309 Maracas Push
Off
361 Samba Whistle
2
361 Samba Whistle
2
308 Guiro Short
3
307 Guiro Long
3
326 Claves
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
342 Cuica Hi
4
343 Cuica Lo
4
341 Triangle Mute
5
340 Triangle Open
5
347 Cabasa Down
Off
355 Sleigh Bell
Off
358 Marc Tree
Off
305 Castanet Single
Off
330 Timbale Lo Mute
6
329 Timbale Lo Open
6
370 Stadium
Off

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
18
115
226
227
112
114
36
16
91
174
11
130
98
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272

120-0-8: Room Kit 1


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD Squash
SD Hip6
88 BD
88 SD
SD Hip3
SD Hip5
BD Ambient
BD Gated
SD Amb.Piccolo
HH3 Open 2
BD Pillow
Side Stick Dry
SD Yowie
SD Hip6
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7

120-0-9: HipHop Kit 1


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD Squash
SD Hip6
88 BD
88 SD
SD Hip3
SD Hip5
BD Ambient
BD Gated
SD Amb.Piccolo
HH3 Open 2
BD Pillow
Side Stick Dry
SD Yowie
SD Hip6
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2

Note
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108

C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
F6
F#6
G6
G#6
A6
A#6
B6
C7
C#7
D7
D#7
E7
F7
F#7
G7
G#7
A7
A#7
B7
C8

Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29

C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
18
115
226
227
112
114
36
16
91
174
11
130
98
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7

295
286
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-6: Standard Kit 2


Sample
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Lo Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Maracas Push
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Lo
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
18
115
226
227
112
114
36
16
91
174
11
130
98
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272

120-0-10: Jungle Kit


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD Squash
SD Hip6
88 BD
88 SD
SD Hip3
SD Hip5
BD Ambient
BD Gated
SD Amb.Piccolo
HH3 Open 2
BD Pillow
Side Stick Dry
SD Yowie
SD Hip6
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7

295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
489
489
489
489
489
489
489
489
489
489
489
353
332
334
333
285
286
288
291
292

120-0-7: Standard Kit 3


Sample
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Maracas Push
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Lo
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium
Empty
Empty
Empty
Empty
Empty
Empty
Empty
Empty
Empty
Empty
Empty
Chacha Bell
Timbale Hi Edge
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Hi Rim1
Conga Lo Open (2)
Conga Lo Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open (2)
Conga Hi Slap1
Conga Hi Slap2

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
32
115
226
227
112
114
36
16
91
174
11
130
98
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272

120-0-11: Techno Kit 1


Sample
Excl.
SD Wood 2 pp
Off
SD Solid2 p
Off
SD Brass2 mf
Off
SD Brass1 p
Off
SD Maple2 pp
Off
SD Maple1 pp
Off
SD Solid1 p
Off
SD Piccolo2 pp
Off
BD Dry 1
Off
BD Hip 3
Off
SD Hip6
Off
88 BD
Off
88 SD
Off
SD Hip3
Off
SD Hip5
Off
BD Ambient
Off
BD Gated
Off
SD Amb.Piccolo
Off
HH3 Open 2
1
BD Pillow
Off
Side Stick Dry
Off
SD Yowie
Off
SD Hip6
Off
Drum Stick Hit
Off
SD Orchestra
7
SD Orch. Roll
7
Finger Snaps
Off
Zap2
Off
Noise White
Off
DJ Scratch2
7

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

Drum Kit maps

272
132
269
376
340
15
38
130
100
230
88
145
170
145
178
144
180
144
143
196
143
213
198
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-8: Room Kit 1


Sample
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
BD Tubby
BD Amb.Rocker
Side Stick Dry
SD Cracker Room
88 Claps
SD Full Room
Tom3 Floor
HH3 Closed1
Tom3 Floor
HH4 Foot
Tom3 Low
HH4 Open
Tom3 Low
Tom3 Hi
Crash 1
Tom3 Hi
Ride Edge 2
China
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc2
Splash
Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 2
Bongo Hi Open
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Maracas Push
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Lo
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
18
115
226
227
112
114
36
16
91
174

120-0-12: Room Kit 2


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD Squash
SD Hip6
88 BD
88 SD
SD Hip3
SD Hip5
BD Ambient
BD Gated
SD Amb.Piccolo
HH3 Open 2

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1

Note
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88

F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6

Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18

C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0

272
132
269
376
340
39
32
229
116
230
123
141
181
141
184
141
182
141
141
196
141
213
202
214
339
201
239
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
185
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-9: HipHop Kit 1


Sample
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
BD Pop 99
BD Hip 3
88 Rim Shot
SD Ringy
88 Claps
SD Vintage6
Tom2 Hi
HH Old Close1
Tom2 Hi
HH Old Close2
Tom2 Hi
HH Old Open1
Tom2 Hi
Tom2 Hi
Crash 1
Tom2 Hi
Ride Edge 2
Crash Reverse
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc2
Splash
88 Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 2
Bongo Hi Open
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
HH Old Open2
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Lo
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
18
115
226
227
112
114
36
16
91
174

120-0-13: HipHop Kit 2


Sample
Excl.
SD Wood 2 pp
Off
SD Solid2 p
Off
SD Brass2 mf
Off
SD Brass1 p
Off
SD Maple2 pp
Off
SD Maple1 pp
Off
SD Solid1 p
Off
SD Piccolo2 pp
Off
BD Dry 1
Off
BD Squash
Off
SD Hip6
Off
88 BD
Off
88 SD
Off
SD Hip3
Off
SD Hip5
Off
BD Ambient
Off
BD Gated
Off
SD Amb.Piccolo
Off
HH3 Open 2
1

Excl.
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

272
132
269
376
340
30
40
221
122
230
117
141
232
141
188
141
182
141
141
235
141
213
202
214
339
201
239
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
185
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
18
115
226
227
112
114
36
16
91
174

120-0-10: Jungle Kit


Sample
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
BD Hip 1
BD Deep 88
Finger Snaps
SD Vintage5
88 Claps
SD Tiny
Tom2 Hi
88 HH Open
Tom2 Hi
HH Hip
Tom2 Hi
HH Old Open1
Tom2 Hi
Tom2 Hi
88 Crash
Tom2 Hi
Ride Edge 2
Crash Reverse
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc2
Splash
88 Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 2
Bongo Hi Open
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
HH Old Open2
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Lo
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

120-0-14: Techno Kit 2


Sample
Excl.
SD Wood 2 pp
Off
SD Solid2 p
Off
SD Brass2 mf
Off
SD Brass1 p
Off
SD Maple2 pp
Off
SD Maple1 pp
Off
SD Solid1 p
Off
SD Piccolo2 pp
Off
BD Dry 1
Off
BD Squash
Off
SD Hip6
Off
88 BD
Off
88 SD
Off
SD Hip3
Off
SD Hip5
Off
BD Ambient
Off
BD Gated
Off
SD Amb.Piccolo
Off
HH3 Open 2
1

303

272
132
269
376
340
18
25
369
228
230
228
266
183
266
189
266
185
266
266
196
266
213
202
214
339
198
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-11: Techno Kit 1


Sample
Excl.
DJ Scratch2
7
Drum Stick Hit
Off
Zap1
Off
Click
Off
Triangle Open
Off
BD Squash
Off
BD House 4
Off
Comp Voice Noise
Off
99 SD
Off
88 Claps
Off
99 SD
Off
E.Tom Real
Off
HH Old TiteClose
1
E.Tom Real
Off
HH Alpo Close
Off
E.Tom Real
Off
HH Old Open2
1
E.Tom Real
Off
E.Tom Real
Off
Crash 1
Off
E.Tom Real
Off
Ride Edge 2
Off
Crash Reverse
Off
Ride Jazz
Off
Tambourine Acc2
Off
China
Off
Cowbell
Off
Crash 1
Off
Vibraslap
Off
Ride Edge 2
Off
Bongo Hi Open
Off
Bongo Lo Open
Off
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Off
Conga Hi Open
Off
Conga Lo Open
Off
Timbale Hi Rim2
Off
Timbale Lo Open
Off
Agogo Bell
Off
Agogo Bell
Off
Cabasa Up
Off
Maracas Push
Off
Samba Whistle
2
Samba Whistle
2
Guiro Short
3
Guiro Long
3
Claves
Off
Woodblock1
Off
Woodblock1
Off
Cuica Hi
4
Cuica Lo
4
Triangle Mute
5
Triangle Open
5
Cabasa Down
Off
Sleigh Bell
Off
Marc Tree
Off
Castanet Single
Off
Timbale Lo Mute
6
Timbale Lo Open
6
Stadium
Off

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
18
115
226
227
112
114
36
16
91
174

120-0-15: Techno Kit 3


Sample
Excl.
SD Wood 2 pp
Off
SD Solid2 p
Off
SD Brass2 mf
Off
SD Brass1 p
Off
SD Maple2 pp
Off
SD Maple1 pp
Off
SD Solid1 p
Off
SD Piccolo2 pp
Off
BD Dry 1
Off
BD Squash
Off
SD Hip6
Off
88 BD
Off
88 SD
Off
SD Hip3
Off
SD Hip5
Off
BD Ambient
Off
BD Gated
Off
SD Amb.Piccolo
Off
HH3 Open 2
1

Appendix

Factory data

304

Factory data
Drum Kit maps

Note
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6

11
130
97
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
17
38
130
99
230
98
142
177
142
178
141
175
141
141
196
141
213
198
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1

120-0-16 (20~23): Power Kit 1


Sample
Excl.
45
SD Wood 2 pp
Off
60
SD Solid2 p
Off
79
SD Brass2 mf
Off
75
SD Brass1 p
Off
69
SD Maple2 pp
Off
63
SD Maple1 pp
Off
57
SD Solid1 p
Off
53
SD Piccolo2 pp
Off

Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7

120-0-12: Room Kit 2


Sample
BD Pillow
Side Stick Dry
SD Big Rock
SD Hip6
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
BD Tight
BD Amb.Rocker
Side Stick Dry
SD Processed
88 Claps
SD Yowie
Tom2 Floor
HH4 Closed2
Tom2 Floor
HH4 Foot
Tom2 Hi
HH3 Sizzle
Tom2 Hi
Tom2 Hi
Crash 1
Tom2 Hi
Ride Edge 2
China
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc2
Splash
Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 2
Bongo Hi Open
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Maracas Push
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Lo
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

11
130
98
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
36
35
221
107
464
111
141
181
141
188
141
182
141
141
196
141
213
202
214
339
201
239
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
185
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-13: HipHop Kit 2


Sample
Excl.
BD Pillow
Off
Side Stick Dry
Off
SD Yowie
Off
SD Hip6
Off
Drum Stick Hit
Off
SD Orchestra
7
SD Orch. Roll
7
Finger Snaps
Off
Zap2
Off
Noise White
Off
DJ Scratch2
7
DJ Scratch2
7
Drum Stick Hit
Off
Zap1
Off
Click
Off
Triangle Open
Off
BD Ambient
Off
BD Dance 99
Off
Finger Snaps
Off
SD Rap
Off
Alkis
Off
SD Hip2
Off
Tom2 Hi
Off
HH Old Close1
1
Tom2 Hi
Off
HH Hip
Off
Tom2 Hi
Off
HH Old Open1
1
Tom2 Hi
Off
Tom2 Hi
Off
Crash 1
Off
Tom2 Hi
Off
Ride Edge 2
Off
Crash Reverse
Off
Ride Jazz
Off
Tambourine Acc2
Off
Splash
Off
88 Cowbell
Off
Crash 1
Off
Vibraslap
Off
Ride Edge 2
Off
Bongo Hi Open
Off
Bongo Lo Open
Off
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Off
Conga Hi Open
Off
Conga Lo Open
Off
Timbale Hi Rim2
Off
Timbale Lo Open
Off
Agogo Bell
Off
Agogo Bell
Off
Cabasa Up
Off
HH Old Open2
Off
Samba Whistle
2
Samba Whistle
2
Guiro Short
3
Guiro Long
3
Claves
Off
Woodblock1
Off
Woodblock1
Off
Cuica Hi
4
Cuica Lo
4
Triangle Mute
5
Triangle Open
5
Cabasa Down
Off
Sleigh Bell
Off
Marc Tree
Off
Castanet Single
Off
Timbale Lo Mute
6
Timbale Lo Open
6
Stadium
Off

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53

120-0-17: Power Kit 2


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

11
130
98
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
34
25
229
108
230
270
236
183
236
189
236
185
236
236
196
236
213
202
214
339
201
239
196
325
213
237
237
237
237
237
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
342
360
360
347
355
358
305
330
469
370

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53

120-0-14: Techno Kit 2


Sample
Excl.
BD Pillow
Off
Side Stick Dry
Off
SD Yowie
Off
SD Hip6
Off
Drum Stick Hit
Off
SD Orchestra
7
SD Orch. Roll
7
Finger Snaps
Off
Zap2
Off
Noise White
Off
DJ Scratch2
7
DJ Scratch2
7
Drum Stick Hit
Off
Zap1
Off
Click
Off
Triangle Open
Off
BD Pop Kick
Off
BD House 4
Off
88 Rim Shot
Off
SD Noise
Off
88 Claps
Off
Zap2
Off
88 Tom
Off
HH Old TiteClose
1
88 Tom
Off
HH Alpo Close
Off
88 Tom
Off
HH Old Open2
1
88 Tom
Off
88 Tom
Off
Crash 1
Off
88 Tom
Off
Ride Edge 2
Off
Crash Reverse
Off
Ride Jazz
Off
Tambourine Acc2
Off
Splash
Off
88 Cowbell
Off
Crash 1
Off
Vibraslap
Off
Ride Edge 2
Off
88 Conga
Off
88 Conga
Off
88 Conga
Off
88 Conga
Off
88 Conga
Off
Timbale Hi Rim2
Off
Timbale Lo Open
Off
Agogo Bell
Off
Agogo Bell
Off
Cabasa Up
Off
Maracas Push
Off
Samba Whistle
2
Samba Whistle
2
Guiro Short
3
Guiro Long
3
Claves
Off
Woodblock1
Off
Woodblock1
Off
Cuica Hi
4
Cuica Hi
4
Flexatone
5
Flexatone
5
Cabasa Down
Off
Sleigh Bell
Off
Marc Tree
Off
Castanet Single
Off
Timbale Lo Mute
6
Darbuka1 Tek2
6
Stadium
Off

120-0-18: Power Kit RX1


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

11
130
98
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
34
25
267
126
230
227
386
233
402
184
425
234
266
266
196
266
213
202
214
339
407
239
196
339
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
366
364
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53

120-0-15: Techno Kit 3


Sample
Excl.
BD Pillow
Off
Side Stick Dry
Off
SD Yowie
Off
SD Hip6
Off
Drum Stick Hit
Off
SD Orchestra
7
SD Orch. Roll
7
Finger Snaps
Off
Zap2
Off
Noise White
Off
DJ Scratch2
7
DJ Scratch2
7
Drum Stick Hit
Off
Zap1
Off
Click
Off
Triangle Open
Off
BD Pop Kick
Off
BD House 4
Off
Rim House1
Off
SD Chili
Off
88 Claps
Off
88 SD
Off
Tribe
Off
99 HH Close
1
Wind
Off
HH Old Close2
Off
Amp Noise
Off
99 HH Open
1
E.Tom Real
Off
E.Tom Real
Off
Crash 1
Off
E.Tom Real
Off
Ride Edge 2
Off
Crash Reverse
Off
Ride Jazz
Off
Tambourine Acc2
Off
Xylophone Spectr
Off
88 Cowbell
Off
Crash 1
Off
Tambourine Acc2
Off
Ride Edge 2
Off
Bongo Hi Open
Off
Bongo Lo Open
Off
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Off
Conga Hi Open
Off
Conga Lo Open
Off
Timbale Hi Rim2
Off
Timbale Lo Open
Off
Agogo Bell
Off
Agogo Bell
Off
Cabasa Up
Off
Maracas Push
Off
Samba Whistle
2
Samba Whistle
2
Guiro Short
3
Guiro Long
3
Claves
Off
Woodblock1
Off
Woodblock1
Off
Uhh
Off
Yeah!
Off
Triangle Mute
5
Triangle Open
5
Cabasa Down
Off
Sleigh Bell
Off
Marc Tree
Off
Castanet Single
Off
Timbale Lo Mute
6
Timbale Lo Open
6
Stadium
Off

120-0-19: Power Kit RX2


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

Drum Kit maps

8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88

Note
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6

120-0-16 (20~23): Power Kit 1


Sample
Excl.
5
BD Dry 1
Off
35
BD Dance 99
Off
228 99 SD
Off
226 88 BD
Off
227 88 SD
Off
121 SD Vintage4
Off
120 SD Vintage3
Off
38
BD Amb.Rocker
Off
30
BD Hip 1
Off
89
SD Off Center
Off
177 HH4 Closed2
1
18
BD Squash
Off
131 Side Stick Amb
Off
118 SD Vintage1
Off
125 SD Brasser
Off
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
220 SD Orchestra
7
219 SD Orch. Roll
7
221 Finger Snaps
Off
270 Zap2
Off
410 Noise White
Off
272 DJ Scratch2
7
272 DJ Scratch2
7
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
269 Zap1
Off
376 Click
Off
340 Triangle Open
Off
16
BD Gated
Off
14
BD Terminator
Off
131 Side Stick Amb
Off
101 SD Dance
Off
225 Claps 4
Off
100 SD Cracker Room
Off
148 Tom Processed
Off
176 HH4 Closed1
1
148 Tom Processed
Off
172 HH3 Foot
1
148 Tom Processed
Off
180 HH4 Open
1
148 Tom Processed
Off
148 Tom Processed
Off
196 Crash 1
Off
148 Tom Processed
Off
213 Ride Edge 2
Off
198 China
Off
214 Ride Jazz
Off
339 Tambourine Acc2
Off
201 Splash
Off
352 Cowbell
Off
196 Crash 1
Off
325 Vibraslap
Off
213 Ride Edge 2
Off
298 Bongo Hi Open
Off
295 Bongo Lo Open
Off
290 Conga Hi Mt Slap
Off
288 Conga Hi Open
Off
285 Conga Lo Open
Off
334 Timbale Hi Rim2
Off
329 Timbale Lo Open
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
346 Cabasa Up
Off
309 Maracas Push
Off
361 Samba Whistle
2
361 Samba Whistle
2
308 Guiro Short
3
307 Guiro Long
3
326 Claves
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
342 Cuica Hi
4
343 Cuica Lo
4
341 Triangle Mute
5
340 Triangle Open
5
347 Cabasa Down
Off
355 Sleigh Bell
Off
358 Marc Tree
Off
305 Castanet Single
Off
330 Timbale Lo Mute
6
329 Timbale Lo Open
6
370 Stadium
Off

5
35
228
226
227
121
120
38
30
89
177
18
131
118
125
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
34
16
130
99
225
116
148
177
148
178
148
180
148
148
196
148
213
198
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-17: Power Kit 2


Sample
BD Dry 1
BD Dance 99
99 SD
88 BD
88 SD
SD Vintage4
SD Vintage3
BD Amb.Rocker
BD Hip 1
SD Off Center
HH4 Closed2
BD Squash
Side Stick Amb
SD Vintage1
SD Brasser
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
BD Pop Kick
BD Gated
Side Stick Dry
SD Processed
Claps 4
SD Ringy
Tom Processed
HH4 Closed2
Tom Processed
HH4 Foot
Tom Processed
HH4 Open
Tom Processed
Tom Processed
Crash 1
Tom Processed
Ride Edge 2
China
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc2
Splash
Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 2
Bongo Hi Open
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Maracas Push
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Lo
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

120-0-18: Power Kit RX1


Sample
5
BD Dry 1
18
BD Squash
115 SD Hip6
226 88 BD
52
SD Piccolo1 f
59
SD Solid1 f
68
SD Maple1 ff
36
BD Ambient
16
BD Gated
52
SD Piccolo1 f
161-162 HH2 Closed p-mp (2)
38
BD Amb.Rocker
130 Side Stick Dry
67
SD Maple1 f
68
SD Maple1 ff
132 Drum Stick Hit
56
SD Piccolo2 f
219 SD Orch. Roll
221 Finger Snaps
270 Zap2
410 Noise White
272 DJ Scratch2
272 DJ Scratch2
132 Drum Stick Hit
269 Zap1
376 Click
340 Triangle Open
38
BD Amb.Rocker
38
BD Amb.Rocker
129 Rim Shot f
45~52 SD Wood 2 pp~f (6)
230 88 Claps
46~56 SD Wood 2~Piccolo2 p~f (6)
140 Tom1 Floor f
160~163 HH2 Closed pp~mf (4)
138 Tom1 Low f
157-156 HH1 Foot mf-mp (2)
138 Tom1 Low f
168-169 HH2 Open p-f (2)
136 Tom1 Mid f
134 Tom1 Hi f
196 Crash 1
134 Tom1 Hi f
207-209 Ride 20' mp2-mf2 (2)
198 China
206-208 Ride 20' mp1-mf1 (2)
339 Tambourine Acc2
201 Splash
352 Cowbell
196 Crash 1
325 Vibraslap
206 Ride 20' mp1
298 Bongo Hi Open
295 Bongo Lo Open
290 Conga Hi Mt Slap
288 Conga Hi Open
285 Conga Lo Open
334 Timbale Hi Rim2
329 Timbale Lo Open
351 Agogo Bell
351 Agogo Bell
346 Cabasa Up
309 Maracas Push
361 Samba Whistle
361 Samba Whistle
308 Guiro Short
307 Guiro Long
326 Claves
327 Woodblock1
327 Woodblock1
342 Cuica Hi
343 Cuica Lo
341 Triangle Mute
340 Triangle Open
347 Cabasa Down
355 Sleigh Bell
358 Marc Tree
305 Castanet Single
330 Timbale Lo Mute
329 Timbale Lo Open
370 Stadium

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

305

120-0-19: Power Kit RX2


Sample
5
BD Dry 1
18
BD Squash
115 SD Hip6
226 88 BD
52
SD Piccolo1 f
59
SD Solid1 f
68
SD Maple1 ff
36
BD Ambient
16
BD Gated
52
SD Piccolo1 f
161-162 HH2 Closed p-mp (2)
38
BD Amb.Rocker
130 Side Stick Dry
67
SD Maple1 f
68
SD Maple1 ff
132 Drum Stick Hit
56
SD Piccolo2 f
219 SD Orch. Roll
221 Finger Snaps
270 Zap2
410 Noise White
272 DJ Scratch2
272 DJ Scratch2
132 Drum Stick Hit
269 Zap1
376 Click
340 Triangle Open
7
BD Dry 3
38
BD Amb.Rocker
129 Rim Shot f
53
SD Piccolo2 pp (2)
230 88 Claps
46~56 SD Wood 2~Piccolo2 p~f (6)
140 Tom1 Floor f
160~163 HH2 Closed pp~mf (4)
138 Tom1 Low f
157-156 HH1 Foot mf-mp (2)
138 Tom1 Low f
168-169 HH2 Open p-f (2)
136 Tom1 Mid f
134 Tom1 Hi f
196 Crash 1
134 Tom1 Hi f
207-209 Ride 20' mp2-mf2 (2)
198 China
206-208 Ride 20' mp1-mf1 (2)
339 Tambourine Acc2
201 Splash
352 Cowbell
196 Crash 1
325 Vibraslap
206 Ride 20' mp1
298 Bongo Hi Open
295 Bongo Lo Open
290 Conga Hi Mt Slap
288 Conga Hi Open
285 Conga Lo Open
334 Timbale Hi Rim2
329 Timbale Lo Open
351 Agogo Bell
351 Agogo Bell
346 Cabasa Up
309 Maracas Push
361 Samba Whistle
361 Samba Whistle
308 Guiro Short
307 Guiro Long
326 Claves
327 Woodblock1
327 Woodblock1
342 Cuica Hi
343 Cuica Lo
341 Triangle Mute
340 Triangle Open
347 Cabasa Down
355 Sleigh Bell
358 Marc Tree
305 Castanet Single
330 Timbale Lo Mute
329 Timbale Lo Open
370 Stadium

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

Appendix

Factory data

306

Factory data
Drum Kit maps

Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81

C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
30
228
226
227
89
120
34
36
115
231
25
270
99
121
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
20
265
268
266
230
114
266
174
266
178
266
173
266
266
196
266
213
202
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340

120-0-24: Electro Kit


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD Hip 1
99 SD
88 BD
88 SD
SD Off Center
SD Vintage3
BD Pop Kick
BD Ambient
SD Hip6
88 HH Close
BD House 4
Zap2
SD Processed
SD Vintage4
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
BD Dance 2
E.Tom FM
Rim House2
E.Tom Real
88 Claps
SD Hip5
E.Tom Real
HH3 Open 2
E.Tom Real
HH4 Foot
E.Tom Real
HH3 Open 1
E.Tom Real
E.Tom Real
Crash 1
E.Tom Real
Ride Edge 2
Crash Reverse
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc2
Splash
Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 2
Bongo Hi Open
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Maracas Push
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Lo
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
400
115
8
98
90
127
34
35
125
170
30
269
115
117
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
40
40
229
227
230
227
236
231
236
232
236
232
236
236
235
236
213
198
214
411
201
239
196
325
213
237
237
237
236
236
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
238
327
327
342
342
357
357

120-0-25: Analog Kit


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
Explosion
SD Hip6
BD Normal
SD Yowie
SD Jazz Ring
SD Whopper
BD Pop Kick
BD Dance 99
SD Brasser
HH3 Closed1
BD Hip 1
Zap1
SD Hip6
SD Tiny
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
BD Deep 88
BD Deep 88
88 Rim Shot
88 SD
88 Claps
88 SD
88 Tom
88 HH Close
88 Tom
88 HH Open
88 Tom
88 HH Open
88 Tom
88 Tom
88 Crash
88 Tom
Ride Edge 2
China
Ride Jazz
Noise FM Mod
Splash
88 Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 2
88 Conga
88 Conga
88 Conga
88 Tom
88 Tom
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Maracas Push
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
88 Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Hi
Finger Cymbal
Finger Cymbal

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
34
123
40
227
101
91
36
14
121
270
33
269
122
429
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
32
36
268
117
230
228
386
233
148
180
226
234
266
266
196
266
213
202
214
339
198
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
188
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
366
364
341
340

120-0-26: House Kit 1


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD Pop Kick
SD Vintage6
BD Deep 88
88 SD
SD Dance
SD Amb.Piccolo
BD Ambient
BD Terminator
SD Vintage4
Zap2
BD Hip 4
Zap1
SD Vintage5
Mouth Harp
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
BD Hip 3
BD Ambient
Rim House2
SD Tiny
88 Claps
99 SD
Tribe
99 HH Close
Tom Processed
HH4 Open
88 BD
99 HH Open
E.Tom Real
E.Tom Real
Crash 1
E.Tom Real
Ride Edge 2
Crash Reverse
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc2
China
Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 2
Bongo Hi Open
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
HH Hip
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Uhh
Yeah!
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
5
5

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
34
228
40
227
101
91
36
14
121
270
33
269
122
429
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
32
18
446
121
230
107
145
183
145
189
144
181
144
143
196
143
213
202
214
339
198
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
336
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340

120-0-27: House Kit 2


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD Pop Kick
99 SD
BD Deep 88
88 SD
SD Dance
SD Amb.Piccolo
BD Ambient
BD Terminator
SD Vintage4
Zap2
BD Hip 4
Zap1
SD Vintage5
Mouth Harp
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
BD Hip 3
BD Squash
Rek Jingle
SD Vintage4
88 Claps
SD Rap
Tom3 Floor
HH Old TiteClose
Tom3 Floor
HH Alpo Close
Tom3 Low
HH Old Close1
Tom3 Low
Tom3 Hi
Crash 1
Tom3 Hi
Ride Edge 2
Crash Reverse
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc2
China
Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 2
Bongo Hi Open
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Tambourine Push
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Lo
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5

Drum Kit maps

347
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-24: Electro Kit


Sample
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
34
228
40
227
101
91
36
14
121
270
33
269
122
429
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
39
35
268
98
230
115
266
231
266
231
266
232
266
266
196
266
213
202
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
188

120-0-28: House Kit 3


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD Pop Kick
99 SD
BD Deep 88
88 SD
SD Dance
SD Amb.Piccolo
BD Ambient
BD Terminator
SD Vintage4
Zap2
BD Hip 4
Zap1
SD Vintage5
Mouth Harp
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
BD Pop 99
BD Dance 99
Rim House2
SD Yowie
88 Claps
SD Hip6
E.Tom Real
88 HH Close
E.Tom Real
88 HH Close
E.Tom Real
88 HH Open
E.Tom Real
E.Tom Real
Crash 1
E.Tom Real
Ride Edge 2
Crash Reverse
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc2
Splash
Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 2
Bongo Hi Open
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
HH Hip

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

Note
82
83
84
85
86
87
88

A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6

Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70

C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4

347
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-25: Analog Kit


Sample
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
34
228
40
227
101
91
36
14
121
270
33
269
122
429
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
32
16
131
82
230
108
266
231
266
232
266
232
266
266
235
266
205
202
214
338
201
239
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
336

120-0-29: House Kit 4


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD Pop Kick
99 SD
BD Deep 88
88 SD
SD Dance
SD Amb.Piccolo
BD Ambient
BD Terminator
SD Vintage4
Zap2
BD Hip 4
Zap1
SD Vintage5
Mouth Harp
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
BD Hip 3
BD Gated
Side Stick Amb
SD Dry 1
88 Claps
SD Noise
E.Tom Real
88 HH Close
E.Tom Real
88 HH Open
E.Tom Real
88 HH Open
E.Tom Real
E.Tom Real
88 Crash
E.Tom Real
Ride Dance 99
Crash Reverse
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc1
Splash
88 Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 2
Bongo Hi Open
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Tambourine Push

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

185
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-26: House Kit 1


Sample
HH Old Open2
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
39
111
264
227
105
104
24
29
106
176
20
131
111
92
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
23
22
268
103
230
87
145
233
141
181
141
186
141
141
196
141
210
202
214
336
201
352
196
386
263
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309

120-0-30: House Kit RX1


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD Pop 99
SD Hip2
Boom
88 SD
SD House4
SD House3
BD House 3
BD Techno 2
SD Small
HH4 Closed1
BD Dance 2
Side Stick Amb
SD Hip2
SD Paper
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
BD House 2
BD House 1
Rim House2
SD House2
88 Claps
SD Ghost f
Tom3 Floor
99 HH Close
Tom2 Hi
HH Old Close1
Tom2 Hi
HH House Open1
Tom2 Hi
Tom2 Hi
Crash 1
Tom2 Hi
Ride Brush
Crash Reverse
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Push
Splash
Cowbell
Crash 1
Tribe
Perc. Ahh
Bongo Hi Open
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Maracas Push

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

307

347
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-27: House Kit 2


Sample
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
40
112
264
228
122
104
24
29
106
180
20
131
116
90
267
220
219
221
270
108
272
272
132
269
376
340
39
24
229
102
223
105
145
183
141
187
141
168
141
141
196
141
210
202
214
339
201
352
196
386
263
296
295
290
297
285
334
329
351
351
346
309

120-0-31: House Kit RX2


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD Deep 88
SD Hip3
Boom
99 SD
SD Vintage5
SD House3
BD House 3
BD Techno 2
SD Small
HH4 Open
BD Dance 2
Side Stick Amb
SD Ringy
SD Jazz Ring
Rim House1
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
SD Noise
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
BD Pop 99
BD House 3
88 Rim Shot
SD House1
Claps 2
SD House4
Tom3 Floor
HH Old TiteClose
Tom2 Hi
HH House Open2
Tom2 Hi
HH2 Open p
Tom2 Hi
Tom2 Hi
Crash 1
Tom2 Hi
Ride Brush
Crash Reverse
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc2
Splash
Cowbell
Crash 1
Tribe
Perc. Ahh
Bongo Lo Slap
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Bongo Lo Stick
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Maracas Push

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

Appendix

Factory data

308

Factory data
Drum Kit maps

Note
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88

B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6

Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59

C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3

361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
342
360
360
185
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-28: House Kit 3


Sample
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Hi
Flexatone
Flexatone
HH Old Open2
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

120-0-32 (36~39): Jazz Kit RX1


Sample
Excl.
45
SD Wood 2 pp
Off
60
SD Solid2 p
Off
79
SD Brass2 mf
Off
75
SD Brass1 p
Off
69
SD Maple2 pp
Off
63
SD Maple1 pp
Off
57
SD Solid1 p
Off
53
SD Piccolo2 pp
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
25
BD House 4
Off
228 99 SD
Off
40
BD Deep 88
Off
227 88 SD
Off
60~62 SD Solid2 p~f (3)
Off
57~59 SD Solid1 p~f (3)
Off
10
BD Jazz (2)
Off
7
BD Dry 3
Off
42~44 SD Wood 1 p~f (3)
Off
160~165 HH2 Closed pp~ff (6) Off
8
BD Normal
Off
129 Rim Shot f
Off
69-74 SD Maple2 pp~ff (6)
Off
63~68 SD Maple1 pp~ff (6)
Off
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
78~80 SD Brass2 p~f (3)
Off
81
SD Roll
7
221 Finger Snaps
Off
270 Zap2
Off
410 Noise White
Off
272 DJ Scratch2
7
272 DJ Scratch2
7
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
269 Zap1
Off
376 Click
Off
340 Triangle Open
Off
3~4 BD Acoust.2 mf~f (3) Off
0~2 BD Acoust.1 p~f (4)
Off
128-129 Rim Shot p-f (2)
Off
53~56 SD Piccolo2 pp~f (4)
Off
230 88 Claps
Off
49~52 SD Piccolo1 pp~f (4)
Off
139-140 Tom1 Floor p-f (2)
Off
160~165 HH2 Closed pp~ff (6)
1
137-138 Tom1 Low p-f (2)
Off
166-167 HH2 Foot p-f (2)
1
135-136 Tom1 Mid p-f (2)
Off
168-169 HH2 Open p-f (2)
1
135-136 Tom1 Mid p-f (2)
Off
133-134 Tom1 Hi p-f (2)
Off
193 Crash 17'edge2 (2)
Off
133-134 Tom1 Hi p-f (2)
Off
207 Ride 20' mp2 (2)
Off
198 China
Off
215 Ride Cup
Off
339 Tambourine Acc2
Off
199 Splash 8'edge1
Off
352 Cowbell
Off
191 Crash 15'edge2 (2)
Off
325 Vibraslap
Off
206-208 Ride 20' mp1-mf1 (2) Off

361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
342
360
360
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-29: House Kit 4


Sample
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Hi
Flexatone
Flexatone
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
25
228
40
227
90
91
38
11
88
171
5
131
83
93
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
10
9
131
82
230
90
150
176
150
178
149
175
149
149
196
149
213
198
215
339
197
352
196
325
212

120-0-33: Jazz Kit


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD House 4
99 SD
BD Deep 88
88 SD
SD Jazz Ring
SD Amb.Piccolo
BD Amb.Rocker
BD Pillow
SD Full Room
HH3 Closed2
BD Dry 1
Side Stick Amb
SD Dry 2
SD Brush Hit
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
BD Jazz
BD SoftRoom
Side Stick Amb
SD Dry 1
88 Claps
SD Jazz Ring
Tom Jazz Floor
HH4 Closed1
Tom Jazz Floor
HH4 Foot
Tom Jazz Hi
HH3 Sizzle
Tom Jazz Hi
Tom Jazz Hi
Crash 1
Tom Jazz Hi
Ride Edge 2
China
Ride Cup
Tambourine Acc2
Crash 2
Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 1

120-0-34: Jazz Kit RX2


Excl.
Sample
Excl.
Off
45
SD Wood 2 pp
Off
Off
60
SD Solid2 p
Off
Off
79
SD Brass2 mf
Off
Off
75
SD Brass1 p
Off
Off
69
SD Maple2 pp
Off
Off
63
SD Maple1 pp
Off
Off
57
SD Solid1 p
Off
Off
53
SD Piccolo2 pp
Off
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
Off
25
BD House 4
Off
Off
228 99 SD
Off
Off
40
BD Deep 88
Off
Off
227 88 SD
Off
Off 60~62 SD Solid2 p~f (3)
Off
Off 57~59 SD Solid1 p~f (3)
Off
Off
10
BD Jazz (2)
Off
Off
7
BD Dry 3
Off
Off
5356 SD Piccolo2 pp~f (4)
Off
1
160~165 HH2 Closed pp~ff (6) Off
Off
8
BD Normal
Off
Off
129 Rim Shot f
Off
Off
69-74 SD Maple2 pp~ff (6)
Off
Off 63~68 SD Maple1 pp~ff (6)
Off
Off
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
7
78~80-59 SD Brass2 p~f - Solid1 f (4) Off
7
81
SD Roll
7
Off
221 Finger Snaps
Off
Off
270 Zap2
Off
Off
410 Noise White
Off
7
272 DJ Scratch2
7
7
272 DJ Scratch2
7
Off
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
Off
269 Zap1
Off
Off
376 Click
Off
Off
340 Triangle Open
Off
Off
3~4 BD Acoust.2 mf~f (3) Off
Off
0~2 BD Acoust.1 p~f (4)
Off
Off 128-129 Rim Shot p-f (2)
Off
Off 53~56 SD Piccolo2 pp~f (4)
Off
Off
230 88 Claps
Off
Off 49~52 SD Piccolo1 pp~f (4)
Off
Off 139-140 Tom1 Floor p-f (2)
Off
1
160~165 HH2 Closed pp~ff (6)
1
Off 137-138 Tom1 Low p-f (2)
Off
1
166-167 HH2 Foot p-f (2)
1
Off 135-136 Tom1 Mid p-f (2)
Off
1
168-169 HH2 Open p-f (2)
1
Off 135-136 Tom1 Mid p-f (2)
Off
Off 133-134 Tom1 Hi p-f (2)
Off
Off
193 Crash 17'edge2 (2)
Off
Off 133-134 Tom1 Hi p-f (2)
Off
Off 207-209 Ride 20' mp2-mf2 (2) Off
Off
198 China
Off
Off 214-215 Ride Jazz-Cup (2)
Off
Off
339 Tambourine Acc2
Off
Off
199 Splash 8'edge1
Off
Off
352 Cowbell
Off
Off
191 Crash 15'edge2 (2)
Off
Off
325 Vibraslap
Off
Off 206-208 Ride 20' mp1-mf1 (2) Off

361
361
308
307
326
327
327
261
262
341
340
211
355
358
255
330
329
370

120-0-30: House Kit RX1


Sample
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Syn. FX4
Syn. FX5
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Ride Rivet
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Syn. Castanet
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

361
361
308
307
326
327
327
261
262
341
340
349
355
358
255
330
329
370

120-0-31: House Kit RX2


Sample
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Syn. FX4
Syn. FX5
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Caxixi Hard
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Syn. Castanet
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

120-0-35: Jazz Kit RX3


Sample
Excl.
45
SD Wood 2 pp
Off
60
SD Solid2 p
Off
79
SD Brass2 mf
Off
75
SD Brass1 p
Off
69
SD Maple2 pp
Off
63
SD Maple1 pp
Off
57
SD Solid1 p
Off
53
SD Piccolo2 pp
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
25
BD House 4
Off
228 99 SD
Off
40
BD Deep 88
Off
227 88 SD
Off
67
SD Maple1 f
Off
66
SD Maple1 mf
Off
38
BD Amb.Rocker
Off
11
BD Pillow
Off
67
SD Maple1 f
Off
171 HH3 Closed2
1
5
BD Dry 1
Off
131 Side Stick Amb
Off
51
SD Piccolo1 mf
Off
93
SD Brush Hit
Off
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
76
SD Brass1 mf
7
81
SD Roll
7
221 Finger Snaps
Off
270 Zap2
Off
410 Noise White
Off
272 DJ Scratch2
7
272 DJ Scratch2
7
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
269 Zap1
Off
376 Click
Off
340 Triangle Open
Off
10
BD Jazz
Off
3~4 BD Acoust.2 mf~f (3) Off
131 Side Stick Amb
Off
74
SD Maple2 ff
Off
230 88 Claps
Off
64
SD Maple1 p
Off
150 Tom Jazz Floor
Off
160~165 HH2 Closed pp~ff (6)
1
150 Tom Jazz Floor
Off
166-167 HH2 Foot p-f (2)
1
149 Tom Jazz Hi
Off
168-169 HH2 Open p-f (2)
1
149 Tom Jazz Hi
Off
149 Tom Jazz Hi
Off
193 Crash 17'edge2 (2)
Off
149 Tom Jazz Hi
Off
207-209 Ride 20' mp2-mf2 (2) Off
198 China
Off
215 Ride Cup
Off
339 Tambourine Acc2
Off
197 Crash 2
Off
352 Cowbell
Off
191 Crash 15'edge2 (2)
Off
325 Vibraslap
Off
212 Ride Edge 1
Off

Factory data
Drum Kit maps

C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3

120-0-40 (43~47): Brush Kit 1


Sample
Excl.
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
145 Tom3 Floor
Off
145 Tom3 Floor
Off
145 Tom3 Floor
Off
144 Tom3 Low
Off
143 Tom3 Hi
Off
83
SD Dry 2
Off
10
BD Jazz
Off
11
BD Pillow
Off
221 Finger Snaps
Off
170 HH3 Closed1
1
7
BD Dry 3
Off
130 Side Stick Dry
Off
94
SD Brush Tap1
7
94
SD Brush Tap1
7
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
220 SD Orchestra
7
219 SD Orch. Roll
7
221 Finger Snaps
Off
270 Zap2
Off
410 Noise White
Off
272 DJ Scratch2
7
272 DJ Scratch2
7
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
269 Zap1
Off
376 Click
Off
340 Triangle Open
Off
11
BD Pillow
Off
10
BD Jazz
Off
131 Side Stick Amb
Off
94
SD Brush Tap1
Off
93
SD Brush Hit
Off
96
SD Brush Swirl
Off
151 Tom Brush Hi
Off
174 HH3 Open 2
1
151 Tom Brush Hi
Off
178 HH4 Foot
1
151 Tom Brush Hi
Off
179 HH4 FootOpen
1
151 Tom Brush Hi
Off
151 Tom Brush Hi
Off

60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88

Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48

298
295
292
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-33: Jazz Kit


Sample
Bongo Hi Open
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Slap2
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Maracas Push
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Lo
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

120-0-41: Brush Kit 2 VS


Sample
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
145 Tom3 Floor
145 Tom3 Floor
145 Tom3 Floor
144 Tom3 Low
143 Tom3 Hi
83
SD Dry 2
10
BD Jazz
11
BD Pillow
221 Finger Snaps
170 HH3 Closed1
7
BD Dry 3
130 Side Stick Dry
94
SD Brush Tap1
94
SD Brush Tap1
132 Drum Stick Hit
220 SD Orchestra
219 SD Orch. Roll
221 Finger Snaps
270 Zap2
410 Noise White
272 DJ Scratch2
272 DJ Scratch2
132 Drum Stick Hit
269 Zap1
376 Click
340 Triangle Open
10
BD Jazz
9-8 BD SoftRoom-Normal (2)
94
SD Brush Tap1
95-94 SD Brush Tap2-1 (2)
93-90 SD Brush Hit-Jazz Ring (2)
96
SD Brush Swirl (2)
151 Tom Brush Hi
174 HH3 Open 2
151 Tom Brush Hi
178 HH4 Foot
151 Tom Brush Hi
179 HH4 FootOpen
151 Tom Brush Hi
151 Tom Brush Hi

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off

298
295
292
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-34: Jazz Kit RX2


Sample
Excl.
Bongo Hi Open
Off
Bongo Lo Open
Off
Conga Hi Slap2
Off
Conga Hi Open
Off
Conga Lo Open
Off
Timbale Hi Rim2
Off
Timbale Lo Open
Off
Agogo Bell
Off
Agogo Bell
Off
Cabasa Up
Off
Maracas Push
Off
Samba Whistle
2
Samba Whistle
2
Guiro Short
3
Guiro Long
3
Claves
Off
Woodblock1
Off
Woodblock1
Off
Cuica Hi
4
Cuica Lo
4
Triangle Mute
5
Triangle Open
5
Cabasa Down
Off
Sleigh Bell
Off
Marc Tree
Off
Castanet Single
Off
Timbale Lo Mute
6
Timbale Lo Open
6
Stadium
Off

120-0-42: Brush Kit RX


Sample
Excl.
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
145 Tom3 Floor
Off
145 Tom3 Floor
Off
145 Tom3 Floor
Off
144 Tom3 Low
Off
143 Tom3 Hi
Off
83
SD Dry 2
Off
10
BD Jazz
Off
11
BD Pillow
Off
221 Finger Snaps
Off
170 HH3 Closed1
Off
7
BD Dry 3
Off
130 Side Stick Dry
Off
94
SD Brush Tap1
7
94
SD Brush Tap1
7
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
220 SD Orchestra
7
219 SD Orch. Roll
7
221 Finger Snaps
Off
270 Zap2
Off
410 Noise White
Off
272 DJ Scratch2
7
272 DJ Scratch2
7
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
269 Zap1
Off
376 Click
Off
340 Triangle Open
Off
10
BD Jazz
Off
9-8 BD SoftRoom-Normal (2)
Off
94
SD Brush Tap1
Off
94
SD Brush Tap1
Off
93-59 SD Brush Hit-Solid1 f (2)
Off
96
SD Brush Swirl (2)
Off
151 Tom Brush Hi
Off
160~165 HH2 Closed pp~ff (6)
1
151 Tom Brush Hi
Off
166-167 HH2 Foot p-f (2)
1
151 Tom Brush Hi
Off
168-169 HH2 Open p-f (2)
1
151 Tom Brush Hi
Off
151 Tom Brush Hi
Off

298
295
292
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-35: Jazz Kit RX3


Sample
Excl.
Bongo Hi Open
Off
Bongo Lo Open
Off
Conga Hi Slap2
Off
Conga Hi Open
Off
Conga Lo Open
Off
Timbale Hi Rim2
Off
Timbale Lo Open
Off
Agogo Bell
Off
Agogo Bell
Off
Cabasa Up
Off
Maracas Push
Off
Samba Whistle
2
Samba Whistle
2
Guiro Short
3
Guiro Long
3
Claves
Off
Woodblock1
Off
Woodblock1
Off
Cuica Hi
4
Cuica Lo
4
Triangle Mute
5
Triangle Open
5
Cabasa Down
Off
Sleigh Bell
Off
Marc Tree
Off
Castanet Single
Off
Timbale Lo Mute
6
Timbale Lo Open
6
Stadium
Off

120-0-48 (49, 52~55): Orchestra Kit


Sample
Excl.
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
220 SD Orchestra
7
219 SD Orch. Roll
7
221 Finger Snaps
Off
170 HH3 Closed1
Off
172 HH3 Foot
Off
173 HH3 Open 1
7
212 Ride Edge 1
Off
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
269 Zap1
Off
376 Click
Off
340 Triangle Open
Off
9
BD SoftRoom
Off
216 BD Orchestra
Off
131 Side Stick Amb
Off
220 SD Orchestra
Off
305 Castanet Single
Off
220 SD Orchestra
Off
218 Timpani
Off
218 Timpani
Off
218 Timpani
Off
218 Timpani
Off
218 Timpani
Off
218 Timpani
Off
218 Timpani
Off
218 Timpani
Off

Appendix

C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6

120-0-32 (36~39): Jazz Kit RX1


Sample
Excl.
298 Bongo Hi Open
Off
295 Bongo Lo Open
Off
292 Conga Hi Slap2
Off
288 Conga Hi Open
Off
285 Conga Lo Open
Off
334 Timbale Hi Rim2
Off
329 Timbale Lo Open
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
346 Cabasa Up
Off
309 Maracas Push
Off
361 Samba Whistle
2
361 Samba Whistle
2
308 Guiro Short
3
307 Guiro Long
3
326 Claves
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
342 Cuica Hi
4
343 Cuica Lo
4
341 Triangle Mute
5
340 Triangle Open
5
347 Cabasa Down
Off
355 Sleigh Bell
Off
358 Marc Tree
Off
305 Castanet Single
Off
330 Timbale Lo Mute
6
329 Timbale Lo Open
6
370 Stadium
Off

Note

309

310

Factory data
Drum Kit maps

C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6

120-0-40 (43~47): Brush Kit 1


Sample
Excl.
196 Crash 1
Off
151 Tom Brush Hi
Off
212 Ride Edge 1
Off
198 China
Off
214 Ride Jazz
Off
339 Tambourine Acc2
Off
201 Splash
Off
352 Cowbell
Off
196 Crash 1
Off
325 Vibraslap
Off
213 Ride Edge 2
Off
298 Bongo Hi Open
Off
295 Bongo Lo Open
Off
290 Conga Hi Mt Slap
Off
288 Conga Hi Open
Off
285 Conga Lo Open
Off
334 Timbale Hi Rim2
Off
329 Timbale Lo Open
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
346 Cabasa Up
Off
309 Maracas Push
Off
361 Samba Whistle
2
361 Samba Whistle
2
308 Guiro Short
3
307 Guiro Long
3
326 Claves
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
342 Cuica Hi
4
343 Cuica Lo
4
341 Triangle Mute
5
340 Triangle Open
5
347 Cabasa Down
Off
355 Sleigh Bell
Off
358 Marc Tree
Off
305 Castanet Single
Off
330 Timbale Lo Mute
6
329 Timbale Lo Open
6
370 Stadium
Off

196
151
212
198
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2

120-0-50: Bdrum & Sdrum


Sample
Excl.
386 Tribe
Off
269 Zap1
Off
236 88 Tom
Off
226 88 BD
Off
226 88 BD
Off
33
BD Hip 4
Off
34
BD Pop Kick
Off
30
BD Hip 1
Off
26
BD House 5
Off
39
BD Pop 99
Off
226 88 BD
Off
265 E.Tom FM
Off
39
BD Pop 99
Off
38
BD Amb.Rocker
Off
36
BD Ambient
Off
35
BD Dance 99
Off
34
BD Pop Kick
Off
33
BD Hip 4
Off
32
BD Hip 3
Off
30
BD Hip 1
Off
26
BD House 5
Off
21
BD Dance 3
Off
20
BD Dance 2
Off
18
BD Squash
Off
41
BD Klanger
Off
40
BD Deep 88
Off
40
BD Deep 88
Off
226 88 BD
Off
17
BD Tight
Off
40
BD Deep 88
Off
25
BD House 4
Off
19
BD Dance 1
Off
21
BD Dance 3
Off
31
BD Hip 2
Off
37
BD Amb.Crackle
Off
40
BD Deep 88
Off
25
BD House 4
Off
34
BD Pop Kick
Off

120-0-51 (116): Arabian Kit 1


Sample
Excl.
45
SD Wood 2 pp
Off
60
SD Solid2 p
Off
79
SD Brass2 mf
Off
75
SD Brass1 p
Off
69
SD Maple2 pp
Off
63
SD Maple1 pp
Off
57
SD Solid1 p
Off
53
SD Piccolo2 pp
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
25
BD House 4
Off
228 99 SD
Off
226 88 BD
Off
227 88 SD
Off
88
SD Full Room
Off
99
SD Processed
1
5
BD Dry 1
Off
17
BD Tight
Off
82
SD Dry 1
Off
171 HH3 Closed2
1
7
BD Dry 3
Off
131 Side Stick Amb
Off
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
412 Tubular
Off
352 Cowbell
Off
352 Cowbell
Off
219 SD Orch. Roll
Off
221 Finger Snaps
Off
270 Zap2
Off
171 HH3 Closed2
Off
272 DJ Scratch2
Off
272 DJ Scratch2
Off
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
292 Conga Hi Slap2
Off
376 Click
Off
376 Click
Off
7
BD Dry 3
Off
25
BD House 4
Off
130 Side Stick Dry
Off

Note
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88

Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37

120-0-41: Brush Kit 2 VS


Sample
Crash 1
Tom Brush Hi
Ride Edge 1
China
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc2
Splash
Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 2
Bongo Hi Open
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Maracas Push
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Lo
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

193
151
210
198
214
339
197
352
191
325
211
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

5
5
5
425
362
280
275
281
272
415
416
421
423
419

120-0-42: Brush Kit RX


Sample
Excl.
Crash 17'edge2 (2)
Off
Tom Brush Hi
Off
Ride Brush (2)
Off
China
Off
Ride Jazz
Off
Tambourine Acc2
Off
Crash 2
Off
Cowbell
Off
Crash 15'edge2 (2)
Off
Vibraslap
Off
Ride Rivet (2)
Off
Bongo Hi Open
Off
Bongo Lo Open
Off
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Off
Conga Hi Open
Off
Conga Lo Open
Off
Timbale Hi Rim2
Off
Timbale Lo Open
Off
Agogo Bell
Off
Agogo Bell
Off
Cabasa Up
Off
Maracas Push
Off
Samba Whistle
2
Samba Whistle
2
Guiro Short
3
Guiro Long
3
Claves
Off
Woodblock1
Off
Woodblock1
Off
Cuica Hi
4
Cuica Lo
4
Triangle Mute
5
Triangle Open
5
Cabasa Down
Off
Sleigh Bell
Off
Marc Tree
Off
Castanet Single
Off
Timbale Lo Mute
6
Timbale Lo Open
6
Stadium
Off

120-0-48 (49, 52~55): Orchestra Kit


Sample
Excl.
218 Timpani
Off
218 Timpani
Off
218 Timpani
Off
218 Timpani
Off
218 Timpani
Off
339 Tambourine Acc2
Off
201 Splash
Off
352 Cowbell
Off
196 Crash 1
Off
325 Vibraslap
Off
217 Orchestra Cymbal
Off
298 Bongo Hi Open
Off
295 Bongo Lo Open
Off
290 Conga Hi Mt Slap
Off
288 Conga Hi Open
Off
285 Conga Lo Open
Off
334 Timbale Hi Rim2
Off
329 Timbale Lo Open
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
346 Cabasa Up
Off
309 Maracas Push
Off
361 Samba Whistle
2
361 Samba Whistle
2
308 Guiro Short
3
307 Guiro Long
3
326 Claves
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
342 Cuica Hi
4
343 Cuica Lo
4
341 Triangle Mute
5
340 Triangle Open
5
347 Cabasa Down
Off
355 Sleigh Bell
Off
358 Marc Tree
Off
305 Castanet Single
Off
330 Timbale Lo Mute
6
329 Timbale Lo Open
6
370 Stadium
Off

120-0-56 (57~63): SFX Kit


Sample
Excl.

120-0-64 (68~71): Percussion Kit


Sample
Excl.
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
308 Guiro Short
Off
336 Tambourine Push
Off
337 Tambourine Pull
Off
338 Tambourine Acc1
Off
338 Tambourine Acc1
Off
339 Tambourine Acc2
Off
339 Tambourine Acc2 (2)
Off
336 Tambourine Push
Off
339 Tambourine Acc2 (2)
Off
446 Rek Jingle
Off
360 Flexatone
Off
357 Finger Cymbal
Off
324 Tsuzumi
Off
299 Bongo Hi Slap
Off
300 Bongo Hi Stick1
Off
297 Bongo Lo Stick
Off
338 Tambourine Acc1
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
402 Wind
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
301 Bongo Hi Stick2
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
326 Claves
Off
328 Woodblock2
Off

BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
Amp Noise
Chinese Gong
DJ BD Rub
DJ Scratch5
DJ SD Rub
DJ Scratch2
Gtr Cut Noise1
Gtr Cut Noise2
E.Gtr Pick1
Gtr Scratch1
Dist. Slide1

Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

Drum Kit maps

Note
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120

D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
F6
F#6
G6
G#6
A6
A#6
B6
C7
C#7
D7
D#7
E7
F7
F#7
G7
G#7
A7
A#7
B7
C8
C#8
D8
D#8
E8
F8
F#8
G8
G#8
A8
A#8
B8
C9

120-0-50: Bdrum & Sdrum


Sample
Excl.
17
BD Tight
Off
6
BD Dry 2
Off
7
BD Dry 3
Off
12
BD Woofer
Off
8
BD Normal
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
15
BD Tubby
Off
8
BD Normal
Off
5
BD Dry 1
Off
8
BD Normal
Off
11
BD Pillow
Off
216 BD Orchestra
Off
16
BD Gated
Off
15
BD Tubby
Off
13
BD MondoKill
Off
15
BD Tubby
Off
14
BD Terminator
Off
20
BD Dance 2
Off
265 E.Tom FM
Off
236 88 Tom
Off
40
BD Deep 88
Off
21
BD Dance 3
Off
84
SD Dry 3
Off
88
SD Full Room
Off
89
SD Off Center
Off
90
SD Jazz Ring
Off
82
SD Dry 1
Off
92
SD Paper
Off
121 SD Vintage4
Off
125 SD Brasser
Off
98
SD Yowie
Off
100 SD Cracker Room
Off
97
SD Big Rock
Off
115 SD Hip6
Off
99
SD Processed
Off
101 SD Dance
Off
108 SD Noise
Off
118 SD Vintage1
Off
98
SD Yowie
Off
126 SD Chili
Off
266 E.Tom Real
Off
228 99 SD
Off
227 88 SD
Off
227 88 SD
Off
228 99 SD
Off
111 SD Hip2
Off
95
SD Brush Tap2
Off
94
SD Brush Tap1
Off
93
SD Brush Hit
Off
93
SD Brush Hit
Off
93
SD Brush Hit
Off
96
SD Brush Swirl
Off
96
SD Brush Swirl
Off
96
SD Brush Swirl
Off
82
SD Dry 1
Off
84
SD Dry 3
Off
97
SD Big Rock
Off
124 SD AmbiHop
Off
110 SD Hip1
Off
118 SD Vintage1
Off
112 SD Hip3
Off
123 SD Vintage6
Off
270 Zap2
Off
114 SD Hip5
Off
127 SD Whopper
Off
125 SD Brasser
Off
118 SD Vintage1
Off
228 99 SD
Off
127 SD Whopper
Off
127 SD Whopper
Off
101 SD Dance
Off
101 SD Dance
Off
228 99 SD
Off
228 99 SD
Off
116 SD Ringy
Off

120-0-51 (116): Arabian Kit 1


Sample
Excl.
84
SD Dry 3
Off
464 Alkis
Off
124 SD AmbiHop
Off
145 Tom3 Floor
Off
172 HH3 Foot
1
145 Tom3 Floor
Off
178 HH4 Foot
1
144 Tom3 Low
Off
173 HH3 Open 1
1
144 Tom3 Low
Off
143 Tom3 Hi
Off
196 Crash 1
Off
143 Tom3 Hi
Off
213 Ride Edge 2
Off
479 Hollo1
Off
480 Hollo2
Off
338 Tambourine Acc1
Off
472 Darbuka2
Off
352 Cowbell
Off
477 Darbuka D3
Off
346 Cabasa Up
Off
466 Bandir Closed
Off
480 Hollo2
Off
295 Bongo Lo Open
Off
480 Hollo2
Off
298 Bongo Hi Open
Off
437 Douf Rim Ak
Off
471 Darbuka1 Closed
Off
475 Darbuka D1
4
473 Darbuka3
4
476 Darbuka D2
Off
468 Darbuka1 Tek1
Off
468 Darbuka1 Tek1
Off
470 Darbuka1 DumOp
Off
486 Tef1
Off
487 Tef2
Off
447 Rik1
Off
449 Rik3
Off
487 Tef2
Off
486 Tef1
Off
487 Tef2
Off
445 Rek Dom Ak
Off
486 Tef1
Off
448 Rik2
Off
488 Tef3
Off
487 Tef2
Off
431 Bells Open
2
450 Sagat Half Open
2
451 Sagat Close
2
478 Davul
Off
484 Ramazan DVL2
3
483 Ramazan DVL1
3
485 Ramazan DVL3
3
482 Kup2
5
149 Tom Jazz Hi
5
482 Kup2
5
481 Kup1
Off
7
BD Dry 3
Off
481 Kup1
Off

120-0-56 (57~63): SFX Kit


Sample
Excl.
420 Dist. Slide2
Off
270 Zap2
Off
396 Gun Shot1
Off
271 DJ Scratch1
7
272 DJ Scratch2
7
132 Drum Stick Hit
Off
270 Zap2
Off
376 Click
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
418 Fret Noise
Off
415 Gtr Cut Noise1
Off
416 Gtr Cut Noise2
Off
415 Gtr Cut Noise1
Off
221 Finger Snaps
Off
373 Laughing
Off
372 Scream
Off
385 Punch
Off
384 Heart Beat
Off
375 Footsteps2
Off
374 Footsteps1
Off
371 Applause
Off
388 Door Creak
Off
389 Door Slam
Off
272 DJ Scratch2
Off
358 Marc Tree
Off
390 Car Engine
Off
391 Car Stop
Off
392 Car Pass
Off
393 Car Crash
Off
381 Crickets
Off
394 Train
Off
410 Noise White
Off
395 Helicopter
Off
427 Swish Terra
Off
396 Gun Shot1
Off
398 Machine Gun
Off
399 Laser Gun
Off
400 Explosion
Off
379 Dog
Off
380 Gallop
Off
377 Bird1
Off
387 Rainstick
Off
401 Thunder
Off
402 Wind
Off
410 Noise White
Off
403 Stream
Off
404 Bubble
Off
382 Cat
Off
378 Bird2
Off
383 Growl
Off
370 Stadium
Off
406 Telephone Ring
Off
405 Church Bell
Off
371 Applause
Off
371 Applause
Off
370 Stadium
Off
410 Noise White
Off
396 Gun Shot1
Off
394 Train
Off

311

120-0-64 (68~71): Percussion Kit


Sample
Excl.
352 Cowbell
Off
327 Woodblock1
Off
306 Castanet Double
Off
311 Baya Open
Off
344 Shaker1
Off
313 Baya Mute1
Off
309 Maracas Push
Off
311 Baya Open
Off
346 Cabasa Up
Off
317 Tabla Open
Off
319 Tabla Mute1
Off
325 Vibraslap
Off
316 Tabla Na
Off
341 Triangle Mute
3
216 BD Orchestra
Off
340 Triangle Open
3
308 Guiro Short
Off
430 Jingle Bell
Off
307 Guiro Long
Off
359 Marc TreeLP
Off
358 Marc Tree
Off
309 Maracas Push
Off
225 Claps 4
Off
230 88 Claps
Off
271 DJ Scratch1
Off
272 DJ Scratch2
Off
277 DJ Hit Rub
Off
361 Samba Whistle
Off
361 Samba Whistle
Off
292 Conga Hi Slap2
Off
293 Conga Heel
Off
288 Conga Hi Open
Off
285 Conga Lo Open
Off
342 Cuica Hi
Off
343 Cuica Lo
Off
335 Timbale Paila
Off
334 Timbale Hi Rim2
Off
333 Timbale Hi Rim1
Off
329 Timbale Lo Open
Off
238 88 Claves
Off
239 88 Cowbell
Off
221 Finger Snaps
Off
323 Taiko Rim
Off
322 Taiko Open
Off
270 Zap2
Off
219 SD Orch. Roll
5
220 SD Orchestra
5
217 Orchestra Cymbal
6
217 Orchestra Cymbal
6
463 Udu f Open
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
282 Orchestra Hit
Off
419 Dist. Slide1
Off
420 Dist. Slide2
Off
415 Gtr Cut Noise1
Off
416 Gtr Cut Noise2
Off
421 E.Gtr Pick1
Off
422 E.Gtr Pick2
Off
423 Gtr Scratch1
Off
424 Gtr Scratch2
Off
418 Fret Noise
Off
417 Power Chord
Off
417 Power Chord
Off
425 Amp Noise
Off

Appendix

Factory data

312

Factory data
Drum Kit maps

Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81

C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5

5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
367
365
364
368
341
340
360
357
239
306
305
221
221
183
363
324
324
324
216
216
351
351
285
286
291
292
240
288
341
340
286
289
292
338
288
297
297
300
329
301
329
338
335
332
335
332
334
333
445
445
445
446
354
327
328
352
309
354
346
344
352
347
347
347

120-0-65: Latin Perc Kit


Sample
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
Hit It
Yeah! Solo
Yeah!
Uhhhh Solo
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Flexatone
Finger Cymbal
88 Cowbell
Castanet Double
Castanet Single
Finger Snaps
Finger Snaps
HH Old TiteClose
Metal Hit
Tsuzumi
Tsuzumi
Tsuzumi
BD Orchestra
BD Orchestra
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Conga Lo Open
Conga Lo Mt Slap
Conga Hi Slap1
Conga Hi Slap2
88 Maracas
Conga Hi Open
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Conga Lo Mt Slap
Conga Hi Mute
Conga Hi Slap2
Tambourine Acc1
Conga Hi Open
Bongo Lo Stick
Bongo Lo Stick
Bongo Hi Stick1
Timbale Lo Open
Bongo Hi Stick2
Timbale Lo Open
Tambourine Acc1
Timbale Paila
Timbale Hi Edge
Timbale Paila
Timbale Hi Edge
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Hi Rim1
Rek Dom Ak
Rek Dom Ak
Rek Dom Ak
Rek Jingle
Mambo Bell
Woodblock1
Woodblock2
Cowbell
Maracas Push
Mambo Bell
Cabasa Up
Shaker1
Cowbell
Cabasa Down
Cabasa Down
Cabasa Down

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

120-0-66: Trinity Perc Kit


Sample
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
449 Rik3
448 Rik2
447 Rik1
446 Rek Jingle
445 Rek Dom Ak
435 Djembe Bass
322 Taiko Open
444 Pand Pattern4
443 Pand Pattern3
442 Pand Pattern2
441 Pand Pattern1
440 Pand Open
322-323 Taiko Open-Rim (2)
324 Tsuzumi (2)
302 Djembe Open (2)
303-304 Djembe Mute-Slap (2)
311-312 Baya Open-Ghe (2)
314-313 Baya Mute2-Mute1 (2)
435-315 Djembe Bass-Baya Mute3 (2)
317 Tabla Open (2)
321-318 Tabla Mute3-Tin (2)
320-319 Tabla Mute2-Mute1 (2)
320-316 Tabla Mute2-Na (2)
319 Tabla Mute1
216 BD Orchestra
386 Tribe
221 Finger Snaps
225 Claps 4
341 Triangle Mute
340 Triangle Open
306 Castanet Double
305 Castanet Single
306 Castanet Double
307 Guiro Long
308 Guiro Short
307 Guiro Long
325 Vibraslap
326 Claves
238 88 Claves
343 Cuica Lo (2)
342 Cuica Hi (2)
329 Timbale Lo Open
327 Woodblock1
331 Timbale Lo Rim
327 Woodblock1
330 Timbale Lo Mute
327 Woodblock1
332 Timbale Hi Edge
334 Timbale Hi Rim2
353 Chacha Bell
333 Timbale Hi Rim1
354 Mambo Bell
335 Timbale Paila (2)
295 Bongo Lo Open
352 Cowbell
296 Bongo Lo Slap
352 Cowbell
298 Bongo Hi Open
301 Bongo Hi Stick2
299 Bongo Hi Slap (2)
285 Conga Lo Open (2)
287 Conga Lo Slap
286 Conga Lo Mt Slap
290 Conga Hi Mt Slap
288 Conga Hi Open (2)
289 Conga Hi Mute
293 Conga Heel
291 Conga Hi Slap1
294 Conga Toe
292 Conga Hi Slap2

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
1
Off
Off
Off
2
2
2
Off
Off
Off
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

120-0-67: i30 Perc Kit


Sample
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
5
BD Dry 1
337 Tambourine Pull
338 Tambourine Acc1
338 Tambourine Acc1
339 Tambourine Acc2
339-5 Tamb. Acc2-BD Dry 1 (2)
336 Tambourine Push
339 Tambourine Acc2
316 Tabla Na
360 Flexatone
357 Finger Cymbal
324 Tsuzumi
299 Bongo Hi Slap
300 Bongo Hi Stick1
297 Bongo Lo Stick
338 Tambourine Acc1
351 Agogo Bell
402 Wind
351 Agogo Bell
301 Bongo Hi Stick2
327 Woodblock1
326 Claves
328 Woodblock2
352 Cowbell
327 Woodblock1
306 Castanet Double
311 Baya Open
344 Shaker1
313 Baya Mute1
309 Maracas Push
311 Baya Open
346 Cabasa Up
317 Tabla Open
319 Tabla Mute1
325 Vibraslap
316 Tabla Na
341 Triangle Mute
216 BD Orchestra
340 Triangle Open
308 Guiro Short
430 Jingle Bell
307 Guiro Long
359 Marc TreeLP
358 Marc Tree
309 Maracas Push
225 Claps 4
230 88 Claps
271 DJ Scratch1
272 DJ Scratch2
277 DJ Hit Rub
361 Samba Whistle
361 Samba Whistle
292 Conga Hi Slap2
293 Conga Heel
288 Conga Hi Open
285 Conga Lo Open
342 Cuica Hi
343 Cuica Lo
335 Timbale Paila
334 Timbale Hi Rim2
333 Timbale Hi Rim1
329 Timbale Lo Open
238 88 Claves
239 88 Cowbell
221 Finger Snaps
323 Taiko Rim
322 Taiko Open

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
3
Off
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
18
115
226
227
112
246
36
245
246
174
244
130
248
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
242
241
250
247
230
249
141
251
141
184
141
252
141
141
196
141
210
202
214
339
201
259
196
325
211
253
254
290
288
285
334
329
258
259
346
256
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
261
262
341
340

120-0-72: HipHop Kit RX


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD Squash
SD Hip6
88 BD
88 SD
SD Hip3
Syn. SD1
BD Ambient
Syn. BD Buzz
Syn. SD1
HH3 Open 2
Syn. BD4
Side Stick Dry
Syn. SD3
SD Hip6
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
Syn. BD2
Syn. BD1
Syn. Rim Click
Syn. SD2
88 Claps
Syn. SD4
Tom2 Hi
Syn. HH Closed
Tom2 Hi
HH Old Close2
Tom2 Hi
Syn. HH Open
Tom2 Hi
Tom2 Hi
Crash 1
Tom2 Hi
Ride Brush
Crash Reverse
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc2
Splash
Syn. FX2
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Rivet
Syn. Bongo1
Syn. Bongo2
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Syn. FX1
Syn. FX2
Cabasa Up
Syn. Shaker
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Syn. FX4
Syn. FX5
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5

Drum Kit maps

461
460
459
459
460
463
302
310
310
342
307
308
308
343
326
361
361
450
450
451
430
358
358
355
467
267
267
25
228
40
227
90
99
5
38
91
170
11
131
5
5
5
5

120-0-65: Latin Perc Kit


Sample
Tambourin Open
Tambourin Mute2
Tambourin Mute1
Tambourin Mute1
Tambourin Mute2
Udu f Open
Djembe Open
Maracas Pull
Maracas Pull
Cuica Hi
Guiro Long
Guiro Short
Guiro Short
Cuica Lo
Claves
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Sagat Half Open
Sagat Half Open
Sagat Close
Jingle Bell
Marc Tree
Marc Tree
Sleigh Bell
Bongo Roll
Rim House1
Rim House1
BD House 4
99 SD
BD Deep 88
88 SD
SD Jazz Ring
SD Processed
BD Dry 1
BD Amb.Rocker
SD Amb.Piccolo
HH3 Closed1
BD Pillow
Side Stick Amb
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1

Excl.
Off
5
5
6
6
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
3
3
3
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
5
Off
Off
Off
2
6
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
39
228
265
227
105
104
24
27
106
181
20
131
111
227
268
220
219
270
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340

120-0-73: Techno Kit RX


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD Pop 99
99 SD
E.Tom FM
88 SD
SD House4
SD House3
BD House 3
BD Liquid
SD Small
HH Old Close1
BD Dance 2
Side Stick Amb
SD Hip2
88 SD
Rim House2
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Zap2
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off

Note
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124

A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
F6
F#6
G6
G#6
A6
A#6
B6
C7
C#7
D7
D#7
E7
F7
F#7
G7
G#7
A7
A#7
B7
C8
C#8
D8
D#8
E8
F8
F#8
G8
G#8
A8
A#8
B8
C9
C#9
D9
D#9
E9

Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34

C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1

120-0-66: Trinity Perc Kit


Sample
351 Agogo Bell
351 Agogo Bell
309-310 Maracas Push-Pull (2)
344 Shaker1 (2)
345 Shaker2 (2)
347-348 Cabasa Down-Tap (2)
348-346 Cabasa Tap-Up (2)
350-349 Caxixi Soft-Hard (2)
336 Tambourine Push
338 Tambourine Acc1 (2)
337 Tambourine Pull
339 Tambourine Acc2
355 Sleigh Bell (2)
361 Samba Whistle
361 Samba Whistle
356 Rap Sleigh Bell
361 Samba Whistle
358 Marc Tree
361 Samba Whistle
431 Bells Open
387 Rainstick
362 Chinese Gong
377 Bird1
377 Bird1
378 Bird2
408 Cricket Spectrum
358 Marc Tree

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
32
115
226
227
112
114
36
22
91
174
23
130
98
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340

120-0-74: Dance Kit RX


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD Hip 3
SD Hip6
88 BD
88 SD
SD Hip3
SD Hip5
BD Ambient
BD House 1
SD Amb.Piccolo
HH3 Open 2
BD House 2
Side Stick Dry
SD Yowie
SD Hip6
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
4
4
Off
4
5
4
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off

270
219
220
217
217
463
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
419
341
340
360
431
350
306
306
221
221
363
363

120-0-67: i30 Perc Kit


Sample
Zap2
SD Orch. Roll
SD Orchestra
Orchestra Cymbal
Orchestra Cymbal
Udu f Open
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Orchestra Hit
Dist. Slide1
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Flexatone
Bells Open
Caxixi Soft
Castanet Double
Castanet Double
Finger Snaps
Finger Snaps
Metal Hit
Metal Hit

Excl.
Off
5
5
6
6
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
3
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53

120-0-88: Standard Kit 4


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

25
228
226
227
89
99
38
17
90
171
7
130
83
82
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340

BD House 4
99 SD
88 BD
88 SD
SD Off Center
SD Processed
BD Amb.Rocker
BD Tight
SD Jazz Ring
HH3 Closed2
BD Dry 3
Side Stick Dry
SD Dry 2
SD Dry 1
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open

Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off

313

120-0-72: HipHop Kit RX


Sample
Ride Rivet
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Syn. Castanet
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

120-0-89: Pop Std. Kit 1


Sample
45
SD Wood 2 pp
60
SD Solid 2 p
79
SD Brass 2 mf
75
SD Brass 1 p
69
SD Maple 2 pp
63
SD Maple 1 pp
57
SD Solid 1 p
53
SD Piccolo 2 pp
5
BD Dry 1
18
BD Squash
115 SD Hip 6
226 88 BD
52
SD Piccolo 1 f
59
SD Solid 1 f
52
SD Piccolo 1 f
36
BD Ambient
16
BD Gated
59
SD Solid 1 f
161-162 HH2 Closed p-mp (2)
38
BD Amb.Rocker
130 Side Stick Dry
67
SD Maple 1 f
68
SD Maple 1 ff
132 DrumStick Hit
59
SD Solid 1 f
219 SD Orch. Roll
221 Finger Snaps
270 Zap 2
410 Noise White
272 DJ Scratch 2
272 DJ Scratch 2
132 DrumStick Hit
269 Zap 1
376 Click
340 Triangle Open

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off

211
355
358
255
330
329
370

Appendix

Factory data

314

Factory data
Drum Kit maps

120-0-73: Techno Kit RX


Sample
BD House 5
BD Techno 1
88 Rim Shot
SD House2
88 Claps
99 SD
Tom Processed
99 HH Close
Tom Processed
88 HH Open
Tom Processed
HH House Open1
Tom Processed
Tom Processed
Crash 1
Tom Processed
Ride Dance 99
Crash Reverse
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc1
Splash
Cowbell
Crash 1
Tribe
Perc. Ahh
88 Conga
88 Conga
88 Conga
88 Tom
88 Tom
Noise White
Explosion
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Maracas Push
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Syn. FX4
Syn. FX5
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Shaker2
Tambourine Acc1
Marc Tree
Syn. Castanet
E.Tom Real
Boom
Stadium

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

120-0-90: Pop Std. Kit 2


Sample
45
SD Wood 2 pp
60
SD Solid 2 p
79
SD Brass 2 mf
75
SD Brass 1 p
69
SD Maple 2 pp
63
SD Maple 1 pp
57
SD Solid 1 p
53
SD Piccolo 2 pp
5
BD Dry 1
18
BD Squash
115 SD Hip 6
226 88 BD
52
SD Piccolo 1 f
59
SD Solid 1 f
52
SD Piccolo 1 f
36
BD Ambient
16
BD Gated
59
SD Solid 1 f
161-162 HH2 Closed p-mp (2)
38
BD Amb.Rocker
130 Side Stick Dry
67
SD Maple 1 f
68
SD Maple 1 ff
132 DrumStick Hit

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off

Note
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88

B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6

Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23

C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0

26
28
229
103
230
228
148
233
148
232
148
186
148
148
196
148
205
202
214
338
201
352
196
386
263
237
237
237
236
236
410
400
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
261
262
341
340
345
338
358
255
266
264
370

22
23
369
228
230
228
266
183
266
189
266
185
266
266
196
266
213
202
214
339
198
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

120-0-74: Dance Kit RX


Sample
BD House 1
BD House 2
Comp Voice Noise
99 SD
88 Claps
99 SD
E.Tom Real
HH Old TiteClose
E.Tom Real
HH Alpo Close
E.Tom Real
HH Old Open2
E.Tom Real
E.Tom Real
Crash 1
E.Tom Real
Ride Edge 2
Crash Reverse
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc2
China
Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 2
Bongo Hi Open
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Maracas Push
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Lo
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

489
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
30
228
226
227
89
120
34
36
115
231
25
270
99
121
132

120-0-96: Elektro Kit 1


Sample
Excl.
Empty
Off
SD Solid 2 p
Off
SD Brass 2 mf
Off
SD Brass 1 p
Off
SD Maple 2 pp
Off
SD Maple 1 pp
Off
SD Solid 1 p
Off
SD Piccolo 2 pp
Off
BD Dry 1
Off
BD Hip 1
Off
99 SD
Off
88 BD
Off
88 SD
Off
SD Off Center
Off
SD Vintage3
Off
BD Pop Kick
Off
BD Ambient
Off
SD Hip 6
Off
88 HH Close
1
BD House 4
Off
Zap 2
Off
SD Processed
Off
SD Vintage4
Off
DrumStick Hit
Off

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

7
17
131
91
230
88
145
174
145
178
144
173
144
143
196
143
213
198
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370

489
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
30
228
226
227
89
120
34
36
115
231
25
270
99
121
132

120-0-88: Standard Kit 4


Sample
BD Dry 3
BD Tight
Side Stick Amb
SD Amb.Piccolo
88 Claps
SD Full Room
Tom3 Floor
HH3 Open 2
Tom3 Floor
HH4 Foot
Tom3 Low
HH3 Open 1
Tom3 Low
Tom3 Hi
Crash 1
Tom3 Hi
Ride Edge 2
China
Ride Jazz
Tambourine Acc2
Splash
Cowbell
Crash 1
Vibraslap
Ride Edge 2
Bongo Hi Open
Bongo Lo Open
Conga Hi Mt Slap
Conga Hi Open
Conga Lo Open
Timbale Hi Rim2
Timbale Lo Open
Agogo Bell
Agogo Bell
Cabasa Up
Maracas Push
Samba Whistle
Samba Whistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica Hi
Cuica Lo
Triangle Mute
Triangle Open
Cabasa Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
Castanet Single
Timbale Lo Mute
Timbale Lo Open
Stadium

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

120-0-89: Pop Std. Kit 1


Sample
17
BD Tight
17
BD Tight
129 Rim Shot f
490 SD Rock
230 88 Claps
490 SD Rock
140 Tom 1 Floor f
163-165 HH2 Closed mf-ff (2)
138 Tom 1 Low f
157-156 HH1 Foot mf-mp (2)
138 Tom 1 Low f
168 HH2 Open p
136 Tom 1 Mid f
134 Tom 1 Hi f
196 Crash 1
134 Tom 1 Hi f
207-209 Ride 20' mp-mf 2 (2)
198 China
215 Ride Cup
339 Tambourine Acc 2
201 Splash
352 Cowbell
196 Crash 1
325 Vibraslap
206 Ride 20' mp 1
298 Bongo Hi Open
295 Bongo Lo Open
290 Conga Hi MtSlap
288 Conga Hi Open
285 Conga Lo Open
334 Timbale Hi Rim 2
329 Timbale Lo Open
351 Agogo Bell
351 Agogo Bell
346 Cabasa Up
346 Cabasa Up
361 Samba Whistle
361 Samba Whistle
308 Guiro Short
307 Guiro Long
326 Claves
327 Woodblock 1
327 Woodblock 1
342 Cuica Hi
343 Cuica Lo
341 Triangle Mute
340 Triangle Open
347 Cabasa Down
355 Sleigh Bell
358 Marc Tree
305 Castanet Single
330 Timbale Lo Mute
329 Timbale Lo Open
370 Stadium

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

120-0-97: Elektro Kit 2


Sample
Excl.
Empty
Off
SD Solid 2 p
Off
SD Brass 2 mf
Off
SD Brass 1 p
Off
SD Maple 2 pp
Off
SD Maple 1 pp
Off
SD Solid 1 p
Off
SD Piccolo 2 pp
Off
BD Dry 1
Off
BD Hip 1
Off
99 SD
Off
88 BD
Off
88 SD
Off
SD Off Center
Off
SD Vintage3
Off
BD Pop Kick
Off
BD Ambient
Off
SD Hip 6
Off
88 HH Close
1
BD House 4
Off
Zap 2
Off
SD Processed
Off
SD Vintage4
Off
DrumStick Hit
Off

120-0-117: Arabian Kit 2


Sample
SD Wood 2 pp
SD Solid2 p
SD Brass2 mf
SD Brass1 p
SD Maple2 pp
SD Maple1 pp
SD Solid1 p
SD Piccolo2 pp
BD Dry 1
BD House 4
99 SD
88 BD
88 SD
SD Full Room
SD Processed
BD Dry 1
BD Tight
SD Dry 1
HH3 Closed2
BD Dry 3
Side Stick Amb
Drum Stick Hit
Tubular
Cowbell

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off

45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
25
228
226
227
88
99
5
17
82
171
7
131
132
412
352

Drum Kit maps

Note
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96

C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
F6
F#6
G6
G#6
A6
A#6
B6
C7

120-0-90: Pop Std. Kit 2


Sample
59
SD Solid 1 f
219 SD Orch. Roll
221 Finger Snaps
270 Zap 2
410 Noise White
272 DJ Scratch 2
272 DJ Scratch 2
132 DrumStick Hit
269 Zap 1
376 Click
340 Triangle Open
17
BD Tight
17
BD Tight
129 Rim Shot f
491 SD Normal
230 88 Claps
491 SD Normal
140 Tom 1 Floor f
163-165 HH2 Closed mf-ff (2)
138 Tom 1 Low f
157-156 HH1 Foot mf-mp (2)
138 Tom 1 Low f
168 HH2 Open p
136 Tom 1 Mid f
134 Tom 1 Hi f
196 Crash 1
134 Tom 1 Hi f
207-209 Ride 20' mp-mf 2 (2)
198 China
215 Ride Cup
339 Tambourine Acc 2
201 Splash
352 Cowbell
196 Crash 1
325 Vibraslap
206 Ride 20' mp 1
298 Bongo Hi Open
295 Bongo Lo Open
290 Conga Hi MtSlap
288 Conga Hi Open
285 Conga Lo Open
334 Timbale Hi Rim 2
329 Timbale Lo Open
351 Agogo Bell
351 Agogo Bell
346 Cabasa Up
346 Cabasa Up
361 Samba Whistle
361 Samba Whistle
308 Guiro Short
307 Guiro Long
326 Claves
327 Woodblock 1
327 Woodblock 1
342 Cuica Hi
343 Cuica Lo
341 Triangle Mute
340 Triangle Open
347 Cabasa Down
355 Sleigh Bell
358 Marc Tree
305 Castanet Single
330 Timbale Lo Mute
329 Timbale Lo Open
370 Stadium

Excl.
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off

120-0-96: Elektro Kit 1


Sample
Excl.
220 SD Orchestra
7
219 SD Orch. Roll
7
221 Finger Snaps
Off
270 Zap 2
Off
410 Noise White
Off
272 DJ Scratch 2
7
272 DJ Scratch 2
7
132 DrumStick Hit
Off
269 Zap 1
Off
376 Click
Off
340 Triangle Open
Off
20
BD Dance 2
Off
265 E.Tom FM
Off
129 Rim Shot f
Off
490 SD Rock
Off
230 88 Claps
Off
490 SD Rock
Off
266 E.Tom Real
Off
174-171 HH3 Open-Closed 2 (2)
1
266 E.Tom Real
Off
178 HH4 Foot
1
266 E.Tom Real
Off
173 HH3 Open 1
1
266 E.Tom Real
Off
266 E.Tom Real
Off
196 Crash 1
Off
266 E.Tom Real
Off
213 Ride Edge 2
Off
202 Crash Reverse
Off
214 Ride Jazz
Off
339 Tambourine Acc 2
Off
201 Splash
Off
352 Cowbell
Off
196 Crash 1
Off
325 Vibraslap
Off
213 Ride Edge 2
Off
298 Bongo Hi Open
Off
295 Bongo Lo Open
Off
290 Conga Hi MtSlap
Off
288 Conga Hi Open
Off
285 Conga Lo Open
Off
334 Timbale Hi Rim 2
Off
329 Timbale Lo Open
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
346 Cabasa Up
Off
309 Maracas Push
Off
361 Samba Whistle
2
361 Samba Whistle
2
308 Guiro Short
3
307 Guiro Long
3
326 Claves
Off
327 Woodblock 1
Off
327 Woodblock 1
Off
342 Cuica Hi
4
343 Cuica Lo
4
341 Triangle Mute
5
340 Triangle Open
5
347 Cabasa Down
Off
355 Sleigh Bell
Off
358 Marc Tree
Off
305 Castanet Single
Off
330 Timbale Lo Mute
6
329 Timbale Lo Open
6
370 Stadium
Off

120-0-97: Elektro Kit 2


Sample
Excl.
220 SD Orchestra
7
219 SD Orch. Roll
7
221 Finger Snaps
Off
270 Zap 2
Off
410 Noise White
Off
272 DJ Scratch 2
7
272 DJ Scratch 2
7
132 DrumStick Hit
Off
269 Zap 1
Off
376 Click
Off
340 Triangle Open
Off
20
BD Dance 2
Off
265 E.Tom FM
Off
129 Rim Shot f
Off
491 SD Normal
Off
230 88 Claps
Off
491 SD Normal
Off
266 E.Tom Real
Off
174-171 HH3 Open-Closed 2 (2)
1
266 E.Tom Real
Off
178 HH4 Foot
1
266 E.Tom Real
Off
173 HH3 Open 1
1
266 E.Tom Real
Off
266 E.Tom Real
Off
196 Crash 1
Off
266 E.Tom Real
Off
213 Ride Edge 2
Off
202 Crash Reverse
Off
214 Ride Jazz
Off
339 Tambourine Acc 2
Off
201 Splash
Off
352 Cowbell
Off
196 Crash 1
Off
325 Vibraslap
Off
213 Ride Edge 2
Off
298 Bongo Hi Open
Off
295 Bongo Lo Open
Off
290 Conga Hi MtSlap
Off
288 Conga Hi Open
Off
285 Conga Lo Open
Off
334 Timbale Hi Rim 2
Off
329 Timbale Lo Open
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
351 Agogo Bell
Off
346 Cabasa Up
Off
309 Maracas Push
Off
361 Samba Whistle
2
361 Samba Whistle
2
308 Guiro Short
3
307 Guiro Long
3
326 Claves
Off
327 Woodblock 1
Off
327 Woodblock 1
Off
342 Cuica Hi
4
343 Cuica Lo
4
341 Triangle Mute
5
340 Triangle Open
5
347 Cabasa Down
Off
355 Sleigh Bell
Off
358 Marc Tree
Off
305 Castanet Single
Off
330 Timbale Lo Mute
6
329 Timbale Lo Open
6
370 Stadium
Off

352
219
221
270
171
272
272
132
292
376
376
7
17
130
84
225
84
145
174
145
178
144
173
144
143
196
143
213
433
432
338
434
352
434
346
436
439
295
438
298
437
455
475
458
456
457
316
318
445
448
447
449
449
446
487
445
486
448
449
446
431
450
451
478
302
302
433
431
450
451
478
10
488

315

120-0-117: Arabian Kit 2


Sample
Cowbell
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
HH3 Closed2
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Conga Hi Slap2
Click
Click
BD Dry 3
BD Tight
Side Stick Dry
SD Dry 3
Claps 4
SD Dry 3
Tom3 Floor
HH3 Open 2
Tom3 Floor
HH4 Foot
Tom3 Low
HH3 Open 1
Tom3 Low
Tom3 Hi
Crash 1
Tom3 Hi
Ride Edge 2
Dbk Tky Open
Dbk Tky Mute
Tambourine Acc1
Dbk Tky Rim
Cowbell
Dbk Tky Rim
Cabasa Up
Douf Dom Ak
Douf Tek Ak2
Bongo Lo Open
Douf Tek Ak1
Bongo Hi Open
Douf Rim Ak
Tabla Dom
Darbuka D1
Tabla Tak
Tabla Flam
Tabla Rim
Tabla Na
Tabla Tin
Rek Dom Ak
Rik2
Rik1
Rik3
Rik3
Rek Jingle
Tef2
Rek Dom Ak
Tef1
Rik2
Rik3
Rek Jingle
Bells Open
Sagat Half Open
Sagat Close
Davul
Djembe Open
Djembe Open
Dbk Tky Open
Bells Open
Sagat Half Open
Sagat Close
Davul
BD Jazz
Tef3

Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
4
4
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
2
Off
3
3
3
5
5
5
Off
Off
Off

Appendix

Factory data

316

Factory data
Multisamples

Multisamples
The following table lists all Pa1X Factory Multisamples available in ROM.
0

AcousticPiano_L

41

Pipe Flute_L

82

Bariton Sax mf

123 Flugel Vibrato

AcousticPiano_R

42

Pipe Flute_R

83

Bariton Sax f

124 Flugel Horn M1

M1 Piano

43

Pipe Positive

84

Bariton Sax T1

125 Tuba

El.GrandPiano

44

Pipe Mixture

85

Tenor SaxVibrato

126 Trombone Vibrato

E.P. FM 1

45

Pipe Full 1_L

86

Tenor Sax

127 Trombone1 mf

E.P. FM 1LP

46

Pipe Full 1_R

87

Tenor Sax M1

128 Trombone1 ff

E.P. FM 2

47

Pipe Full 2

88

Tenor Sax Expr.

129 Trombone2 Soft

E.P. Dyno Soft

48

Kalimba

89

Alto Sax Vibrato

130 Trombone2 Bright

E.P. Dyno SoftLP

49

MusicBox

90

Alto Sax p

131 Trombone SlurUp

E.P. StageHard

50

MusicBoxLP

91

Alto Sax mf

132 Trombone Fall

10

E.P. StageHardLP

51

Marimba

92

Alto Sax Growl

133 Trumpet Medium

11

E.P. Wurly Soft

52

MarimbaLP

93

Alto Sax 01W

134 Trump. Overblown

12

E.P. Wurly Hard

53

Xylophone

94

Soprano SaxVibr.

135 Trumpet Expr.

13

E.P. Pad 1LP

54

Vibraphone

95

Soprano Sax

136 Trumpet Muted

14

E.P. Pad 2

55

VibraphoneLP

96

French Musette

137 Trumpet Wah Wah

15

Clav.

56

Celesta

97

Musette 1

138 Trumpet Doit

16

Harpsichord

57

CelestaLP

98

Musette 1LP

139 Trumpet Fall

17

GospelOrg.Slow_L

58

Glockenspiel

99

Musette 2

140 Brass Ens. 1

18

GospelOrg.Slow_R

59

GlockenspielLP

100 Accordion 16'

141 Brass Ens. 2

19

GospelOrg.Fast_L

60

Tubular Bell

101 Acc.16' OrigTune

142 Brass Ens. 2LP

20

GospelOrg.Fast_R

61

Log Drum

102 Accordion 8'

143 Voice Choir

21

E.Organ Perc 1

62

SteelDr Hard

103 Acc. 8' OrigTune

144 Voice ChoirREV

22

E.Organ Perc 2

63

SteelDr HardLP

104 Accordion 4'

145 Voice Pop Ooh

23

E.Organ Perc 3

64

Gamelan

105 Acc. 4' OrigTune

146 Voice Pop OohREV

24

E.Organ 2'Perc

65

FM Bell

106 Accordion 1

147 Voice Pop Ah

25

M1 Organ 1

66

Flute

107 Accordion 2

148 Voice Pop AhREV

26

M1 Organ 2

67

Flute Frull

108 Fisa Bassoon

149 Doo Voice

27

Organ 1

68

Voice Flute

109 Fisa Clarinet

150 Doo VoiceLP

28

Organ 2

69

Jazz Flute

110 Bandoneon

151 String Ens.

29

Organ 2LP

70

Piccolo

111 Accordion Bass

152 String Ens.REV

30

E.Organ Jazz

71

Pan Flute

112 Acc.Noise KeyOn

153 Pizzicato Ens.

31

Bx3&Perc 3rd

72

Shakuhachi

113 Acc.Noise KeyOff

154 Violin

32

E.Organ Vox

73

Shakuhachi Atk

114 Acc.Change Voic

155 Viola

33

E.Organ Soft

74

Bottle

115 Harmonica

156 Cello&Contrabass

34

E.Organ Full

75

Recorder

116 Harmonica Wah

157 Violin & Cello

35

E.Organ Dist

76

Ocarina

117 Highland B.Pipes

158 Pizzicato

36

Rotary Org1

77

Clarinet

118 Highland Drones

159 SteelGtr Pick p

37

Rotary Org1LP

78

M1 DoubleReed

119 Uilleann Pipes

160 SteelGtr Pick mf

38

Rotary Org2

79

Oboe

120 Bag Pipes

161 SteelGtr pick f

39

SuperBX3

80

English Horn

121 French Horn T1

162 SteelGtr Mute

40

SuperBX3LP

81

Bassoon

122 French Horn Ens.

163 SteelGtr Slide

Multisamples

317

164 A.Guitar Finger

209 Funky Gtr 1 Stra

254 Thumb Bass

299 An.Strings 1

165 A.Guitar Pick

210 Funky Gtr 2 Stra

255 SlapBassThumb

300 An.Strings 1 REV

166 A.Guitar Harmo.

211 Jazz Guitar1

256 SlapBassThumbLP

301 An.Strings 2

167 Folk Guitar

212 Jazz Guitar2

257 SlapBass Pull

302 An.Strings 2 REV

168 Folk 12 Strings

213 Jazz Guitar3 p

258 Fretless Bass

303 Analog Vintage

169 Nylon Guitar mp

214 Jazz Guitar3 mf

259 Bass Harmonics

304 White Pad

170 Nylon Guitar mf

215 Jazz Guitar3 f

260 Bass HarmoLP

305 White Pad REV

171 Nylon Guitar ff

216 Pedal Steel Gtr

261 Sitar

306 N1 Air Vox

172 Nylon GuitarAtk

217 Reso Guitar

262 Santur

307 N1 Air Vox REV

173 A.Gtr HiStrings

218 Overdrive Gtr

263 SanturLP

308 Ether Bell

174 A.Gtr 12Strings

219 Dist Guitar

264 Tambura

309 Ether BellLP

175 A.Gtr Harmonics

220 Dist Gtr1 Harmo.

265 TamburaLP

310 Lore

176 A.Gtr Noise

221 Dist Gtr1 Mute

266 Bouzouki

311 Lore NT

177 Clean Gtr1 Stra

222 Dist Gtr2 Harmo.

267 BouzoukiLP

312 Space Lore

178 Clean Gtr1 Mute

223 Dist Gtr2 Mute1

268 Ukulele

313 Space Lore REV

179 Clean Gtr2 Stra

224 Dist Gtr2 Mute2

269 Oud

314 Wave Sweep 1

180 Clean Gtr2 Mute

225 Power Chord

270 ClarinetLP

315 Wave Sweep 2

181 Clean Gtr3 Tele

226 A.Bass1

271 Kanun

316 Wave Sweep 3

182 Clean Gtr4 Str p

227 A.Bass2 mf

272 Kanun Tremolo

317 Syn Ghostly

183 Clean Gtr4 Str f

228 A.Bass2 f

273 Nay

318 Syn Ghostly REV

184 Clean Gtr4 Mute

229 E.Bass1 Finger

274 Mandolin

319 Syn Air Pad

185 Clean Gtr4 Dead

230 E.Bass2 P.B.1

275 MandolinLP

320 Syn Air Pad REV

186 Clean Gtr4 Slap

231 E.Bass2 P.B.2

276 Banjo

321 Dream Str

187 Clean Gtr4 Slide

232 E.Bass2 LH Stop

277 BanjoLP

322 Dream Str REV

188 E.Gtr Sberg p1

233 E.Bass2 RH Stop

278 Shamisen

323 Syn AirVortexREV

189 E.Gtr Sberg f1

234 E.Bass2 Harmo.

279 Koto

324 Syn Clicker

190 E.Gtr Sberg p2

235 E.Bass3 p

280 Harp

325 Syn Clicker REV

191 E.Gtr Sberg f2

236 E.Bass3 mf

281 Mouth Harp 1

326 Cricket Spectrum

192 E.Gtr Le Neck

237 E.Bass3 f Slap

282 Mouth Harp 2

327 Noise 1

193 E.Gtr Le Bridge

238 E.Bass4 Pick

283 Mouth Harp 3

328 Noise 2

194 E.Gtr Le Mute p

239 E.Bass4 Harmo.

284 Mouth Harp 4

329 Swish Terra

195 E.Gtr Le Mute mf

240 E.Bass4 Slap

285 Mouth Harp 5

330 Gamelan XEQ

196 E.Gtr Le Ghost1

241 E.Bass4 SlapHar

286 Syn Bass Reso 1

331 Saw 1

197 E.Gtr Le Ghost2

242 E.Bass4 LH Mute

287 Syn Bass FM 1

332 Saw 2

198 E.Gtr Vintage p

243 E.Bass4 RH Mute

288 Syn Bass FM 1LP

333 Saw 3

199 E.Gtr Vintage mf

244 E.Bass Gliss

289 Syn Bass FM 2

334 Pulse 02%

200 E.Gtr Solid p

245 E.Bass Noise1

290 Syn Bass FM 2LP

335 Pulse 05%

201 E.Gtr Solid mf

246 E.Bass Noise2

291 Syn Bass TB

336 Pulse 08%

202 E.Gtr Solid f

247 Finger Bass 1

292 RB Saw Bass

337 Pulse 16%

203 E.Gtr Harmonics

248 Finger Bass 1LP

293 RB Square Bass

338 Pulse 33%

204 E.Gtr Gliss Down

249 Finger Bass 2

294 Chrom Res

339 Pulse 40%

205 E.Gtr Gliss Up

250 Finger Bass 2LP

295 DetunedSuper

340 Square

206 E.Gtr Noise

251 Finger Bass 3

296 DetunedSuperREV

341 Square MG

207 E.Gtr ShortNoise

252 Pick Bass

297 Detuned PWM

342 Square JP

208 E.Gtr FretNoise

253 Pick Bass LP

298 Detuned PWM REV

343 Triangle MG

Appendix

Factory data

318

Factory data
Multisamples

344 Ramp

370 Zap 2

396 Door Slam

422 88 Tom

345 Ramp MG

371 Stadium

397 Car Engine

423 88 Conga

346 Sine

372 Applause

398 Car Engine LP

424 88 Crash

347 DWGS Syn Sine 1

373 Birds 1

399 Car Stop

425 Tom

348 DWGS Syn Sine 2

374 Birds 1 REV

400 Car Pass

426 Tom Brush

349 DWGS Organ 1

375 Birds 2

401 Car Crash

427 Tom Process

350 DWGS Organ 2

376 Crickets

402 Train

428 Electric Tom

351 DWGS Bell 1

377 Crickets REV

403 Train REV

429 Flexatone

352 DWGS Bell 2

378 Church Bell

404 Helicopter

430 Tambourine

353 DWGS Bell 3

379 Church Bell REV

405 Helicopter REV

431 Agogo Bell

354 DWGS Bell 4

380 Thunder

406 Gun Shot

432 Marc Tree

355 DWGS Clav.

381 Stream

407 Machine Gun

433 Marc TreeLP

356 DWGS Digi 1

382 Bubble

408 Machine Gun REV

434 Cowbell

357 DWGS Digi 2

383 Bubble REV

409 Laser Gun

435 Click

358 DWGS Wire 1

384 Dog

410 Explosion

436 Temple Blocks

359 DWGS Wire 2

385 Gallop

411 Wind

437 Orchestra BD

360 DWGS Sync 1

386 Gallop REV

412 Timpani

438 Castanet

361 DWGS Sync 2

387 Laughing

413 Crash

439 Taiko

362 DWGS Sync 3

388 Telephone Ring

414 Crash Reverse

440 Djembe Open

363 Orchestra Hit

389 Tele Ring REV

415 Orchestra Crash

441 Djembe Mute

364 Band Hit

390 Scream

416 Ride Jazz

442 Chinese Gong

365 Impact Hit

391 Punch

417 Ride Edge 1

443 Snare Ghost

366 Brass Fall

392 Heart Beat

418 Ride Edge 2

444 RainStick

367 Vox Wah Gtr

393 Footstep 1

419 HiHat Closed

445 Empty

368 Vibe Chord

394 Footstep 2

420 88 HiHat Open

369 Zap 1

395 Door Creak

421 88 Cowbell

Factory data
Drum Samples

319

Drum Samples
0

BD Acoustic 1 p

41

BD Klanger

82

SD Dry 1

123 SD Vintage6

BD Acoustic 1 mf

42

SD Wood 1 p

83

SD Dry 2

124 SD AmbiHop

BD Acoustic 1 f

43

SD Wood 1 mf

84

SD Dry 3

125 SD Brasser

BD Acoustic 2 mf

44

SD Wood 1 f

85

SD Ghost Roll

126 SD Chili

BD Acoustic 2 f

45

SD Wood 2 pp

86

SD Ghost p

127 SD Whopper

BD Dry 1

46

SD Wood 2 p

87

SD Ghost f

128 Rim Shot p

BD Dry 2

47

SD Wood 2 mf

88

SD Full Room

129 Rim Shot f

BD Dry 3

48

SD Wood 2 f

89

SD Off Center

130 Side Stick Dry

BD Normal

49

SD Piccolo 1 pp

90

SD Jazz Ring

131 Side Stick Amb

BD SoftRoom

50

SD Piccolo 1 p

91

SD Amb.Piccolo

132 DrumStick Hit

10

BD Jazz

51

SD Piccolo 1 mf

92

SD Paper

133 Tom 1 Hi p

11

BD Pillow

52

SD Piccolo 1 f

93

SD Brush Hit

134 Tom 1 Hi f

12

BD Woofer

53

SD Piccolo 2 pp

94

SD Brush Tap 1

135 Tom 1 Mid p

13

BD MondoKill

54

SD Piccolo 2 p

95

SD Brush Tap 2

136 Tom 1 Mid f

14

BD Terminator

55

SD Piccolo 2 mf

96

SD Brush Swirl

137 Tom 1 Low p

15

BD Tubby

56

SD Piccolo 2 f

97

SD Big Rock

138 Tom 1 Low f

16

BD Gated

57

SD Solid 1 p

98

SD Yowie

139 Tom 1 Floor p

17

BD Tight

58

SD Solid 1 mf

99

SD Processed

140 Tom 1 Floor f

18

BD Squash

59

SD Solid 1 f

100 SD Cracker Room

141 Tom 2 Hi

19

BD Dance 1

60

SD Solid 2 p

101 SD Dance

142 Tom 2 Floor

20

BD Dance 2

61

SD Solid 2 mf

102 SD House 1

143 Tom 3 Hi

21

BD Dance 3

62

SD Solid 2 f

103 SD House 2

144 Tom 3 Lo

22

BD House 1

63

SD Maple 1 pp

104 SD House 3

145 Tom 3 Floor

23

BD House 2

64

SD Maple 1 p

105 SD House 4

146 Tom 4 Hi

24

BD House 3

65

SD Maple 1 mp

106 SD Small

147 Tom 4 Lo

25

BD House 4

66

SD Maple 1 mf

107 SD Rap

148 Tom Processed

26

BD House 5

67

SD Maple 1 f

108 SD Noise

149 Tom Jazz Hi

27

BD Liquid

68

SD Maple 1 ff

109 SD Reverse

150 Tom Jazz Floor

28

BD Techno 1

69

SD Maple 2 pp

110 SD Hip 1

151 Tom Brush Hi

29

BD Techno 2

70

SD Maple 2 p

111 SD Hip 2

152 HH1 Closed pp

30

BD Hip 1

71

SD Maple 2 mp

112 SD Hip 3

153 HH1 Closed p

31

BD Hip 2

72

SD Maple 2 mf

113 SD Hip 4

154 HH1 Closed mf

32

BD Hip 3

73

SD Maple 2 f

114 SD Hip 5

155 HH1 Closed f

33

BD Hip 4

74

SD Maple 2 ff

115 SD Hip 6

156 HH1 Foot mp

34

BD Pop Kick

75

SD Brass 1 p

116 SD Ringy

157 HH1 Foot mf

35

BD Dance 99

76

SD Brass 1 mf

117 SD Tiny

158 HH1 Open mp

36

BD Ambient

77

SD Brass 1 f

118 SD Vintage1

159 HH1 Open mf

37

BD Amb.Crackle

78

SD Brass 2 p

119 SD Vintage2

160 HH2 Closed pp

38

BD Amb.Rocker

79

SD Brass 2 mf

120 SD Vintage3

161 HH2 Closed p

39

BD Pop 99

80

SD Brass 2 f

121 SD Vintage4

162 HH2 Closed mp

40

BD Deep 88

81

SD Roll

122 SD Vintage5

163 HH2 Closed mf

Appendix

The following table lists all Pa1X Factory Drum Samples available in ROM.

320

Factory data
Drum Samples

164 HH2 Closed f

209 Ride 20' mf 2

254 Syn. Bongo 2

299 Bongo Hi Slap

165 HH2 Closed ff

210 Ride Brush

255 Syn. Castanet

300 Bongo Hi Stick1

166 HH2 Foot p

211 Ride Rivet

256 Syn. Shaker

301 Bongo Hi Stick2

167 HH2 Foot f

212 Ride Edge 1

257 Syn. Noise

302 Djembe Open

168 HH2 Open p

213 Ride Edge 2

258 Syn. FX 1

303 Djembe Mute

169 HH2 Open f

214 Ride Jazz

259 Syn. FX 2

304 Djembe Slap

170 HH3 Closed 1

215 Ride Cup

260 Syn. FX 3

305 Castanet Single

171 HH3 Closed 2

216 BD Orchestra

261 Syn. FX 4

306 Castanet Double

172 HH3 Foot

217 Orchestra Cymbal

262 Syn. FX 5

307 Guiro Long

173 HH3 Open 1

218 Timpani

263 Perc. Ahh

308 Guiro Short

174 HH3 Open 2

219 SD Orch. Roll

264 Boom

309 Maracas Push

175 HH3 Sizzle

220 SD Orchestra

265 E.Tom FM

310 Maracas Pull

176 HH4 Closed 1

221 Finger Snaps

266 E.Tom Real

311 Baya Open

177 HH4 Closed 2

222 Claps 1

267 Rim House 1

312 Baya Ghe

178 HH4 Foot

223 Claps 2

268 Rim House 2

313 Baya Mute 1

179 HH4 FootOpen

224 Claps 3

269 Zap 1

314 Baya Mute 2

180 HH4 Open

225 Claps 4

270 Zap 2

315 Baya Mute 3

181 HH Old Close 1

226 88 BD

271 DJ Scratch 1

316 Tabla Na

182 HH Old Open 1

227 88 SD

272 DJ Scratch 2

317 Tabla Open

183 HH Old TiteClose

228 99 SD

273 DJ Scratch 3

318 Tabla Tin

184 HH Old Close 2

229 88 Rimshot

274 DJ Scratch 4

319 Tabla Mute 1

185 HH Old Open 2

230 88 Claps

275 DJ Scratch 5

320 Tabla Mute 2

186 HH House Open 1

231 88 HH Close

276 DJ Scratch 6

321 Tabla Mute 3

187 HH House Open 2

232 88 HH Open

277 DJ Hit Rub

322 Taiko Open

188 HH Hip

233 99 HH Close

278 DJ Vocal Rub 1

323 Taiko Rim

189 HH Alpo Close

234 99 HH Open

279 DJ Vocal Rub 2

324 Tsuzumi

190 Crash 15' Edge 1

235 88 Crash

280 DJ BD Rub

325 Vibraslap

191 Crash 15' Edge 2

236 88 Tom

281 DJ SD Rub

326 Claves

192 Crash 17' Edge 1

237 88 Conga

282 Orchestra Hit

327 Woodblock 1

193 Crash 17' Edge 2

238 88 Claves

283 Band Hit

328 Woodblock 2

194 Crash 19' Open 1

239 88 Cowbell

284 Impact Hit

329 Timbale Lo Open

195 Crash 19' Open 2

240 88 Maracas

285 Conga Lo Open

330 Timbale Lo Mute

196 Crash 1

241 Syn. BD 1

286 Conga Lo MtSlap

331 Timbale Lo Rim

197 Crash 2

242 Syn. BD 2

287 Conga Lo Slap

332 Timbale Hi Edge

198 China

243 Syn. BD 3

288 Conga Hi Open

333 Timbale Hi Rim 1

199 Splash 8' Edge 1

244 Syn. BD 4

289 Conga Hi Mute

334 Timbale Hi Rim 2

200 Splash 8' Edge 2

245 Syn. BD Buzz

290 Conga Hi MtSlap

335 Timbale Paila

201 Splash

246 Syn. SD 1

291 Conga Hi Slap 1

336 Tambourine Push

202 Crash Reverse

247 Syn. SD 2

292 Conga Hi Slap 2

337 Tambourine Pull

203 Crash Dance 99

248 Syn. SD 3

293 Conga Heel

338 Tambourine Acc 1

204 Crash DDD-1

249 Syn. SD 4

294 Conga Toe

339 Tambourine Acc 2

205 Ride Dance 99

250 Syn. Rim Click

295 Bongo Lo Open

340 Triangle Open

206 Ride 20' mp 1

251 Syn. HH Closed

296 Bongo Lo Slap

341 Triangle Mute

207 Ride 20' mp 2

252 Syn. HH Open

297 Bongo Lo Stick

342 Cuica Hi

208 Ride 20' mf 1

253 Syn. Bongo 1

298 Bongo Hi Open

343 Cuica Lo

Drum Samples

321

344 Shaker 1

382 Cat

420 Dist. Slide 2

458 Tabla Tak

345 Shaker 2

383 Growl

421 E.Gtr Pick 1

459 Tambourine Mute 1

346 Cabasa Up

384 Heart Beat

422 E.Gtr Pick 2

460 Tambourine Mute 2

347 Cabasa Down

385 Punch

423 Gtr Scratch 1

461 Tambourine Open

348 Cabasa Tap

386 Tribe

424 Gtr Scratch 2

462 Timbales

349 Caxixi Hard

387 Rainstick

425 Amp Noise

463 Udu f open

350 Caxixi Soft

388 Door Creak

426 Space Lore

464 Alkis

351 Agogo Bell

389 Door Slam

427 Swish Terra

465 Bandir

352 Cowbell

390 Car Engine

428 Hand Drill

466 Bandir Closed

353 Chacha Bell

391 Car Stop

429 Mouth Harp

467 Bongo Roll

354 Mambo Bell

392 Car Pass

430 Jingle Bell

468 Darbuka 1 Tek 1

355 Sleigh Bell

393 Car Crash

431 Bells Open

469 Darbuka 1 Tek 2

356 Rap Sleigh Bell

394 Train

432 Dbk Tky Mute

470 Darbuka 1 DumOp

357 Finger Cymbal

395 Helicopter

433 Dbk Tky Open

471 Darbuka 1 Closed

358 Marc Tree

396 Gun Shot 1

434 Dbk Tky Rim

472 Darbuka 2

359 Marc Tree LP

397 Gun Shot 2

435 Djembe Bass

473 Darbuka 3

360 Flexatone

398 Machine Gun

436 Douf Dom Ak

474 Darbuka 4

361 Samba Whistle

399 Laser Gun

437 Douf Rim Ak

475 Darbuka D 1

362 Chinese Gong

400 Explosion

438 Douf Tek Ak 1

476 Darbuka D 2

363 Metal Hit

401 Thunder

439 Douf Tek Ak 2

477 Darbuka D 3

364 Yeah!

402 Wind

440 Pand Open

478 Davul

365 Yeah! Solo

403 Stream

441 Pand Pattern 1

479 Hollo 1

366 Uhh

404 Bubble

442 Pand Pattern 2

480 Hollo 2

367 Hit It

405 Church Bell

443 Pand Pattern 3

481 Kup 1

368 Uhhhh Solo

406 Telephone Ring

444 Pand Pattern 4

482 Kup 2

369 Comp Voice Noise

407 Xylophone Spectr

445 Rek Dom Ak

483 Ramazan DVL 1

370 Stadium

408 Cricket Spectrum

446 Rek Jingle

484 Ramazan DVL 2

371 Applause

409 Air Vortex

447 Rik 1

485 Ramazan DVL 3

372 Scream

410 Noise White

448 Rik 2

486 Tef 1

373 Laughing

411 Noise FM Mod

449 Rik 3

487 Tef 2

374 Footsteps 1

412 Tubular

450 Sagat Half Open

488 Tef 3

375 Footsteps 2

413 Gamelan

451 Sagat Close

489 Empty

376 Click

414 Tambura

452 Surdo L Mute

490 SD Rock

377 Bird 1

415 Gtr CutNois 1

453 Surdo L Open

491 SD Normal

378 Bird 2

416 Gtr CutNois 2

454 Tabla Medium

379 Dog

417 Power Chord

455 Tabla Dom

380 Gallop

418 Fret Noise

456 Tabla Flam

381 Crickets

419 Dist. Slide 1

457 Tabla Rim

Appendix

Factory data

322

Factory data
Performances

Performances
All Performances are user-editable. Use the following table as a model for your own Perfomance lists.
Note: You can remotely select Performances on the Pa1X, by sending it Bank Select MSB (CC#0), Bank Select LSB (CC#32) and Program
Change messages on the Control channel (see MIDI: MIDI In Channels on page 238).
#
1

CC#0 CC#32
1

PC

Bank: 1

CC#0 CC#32
1

PC

Bank: 2

CC#0 CC#32
1

PC

Bank: 3

CC#0 CC#32
1

PC

10

11

10

10

10

10

12

11

11

11

11

13

12

12

12

12

14

13

13

13

13

15

14

14

14

14

16

15

15

15

15

CC#0 CC#32
1

PC
0

Bank: 5

CC#0 CC#32
1

PC
0

Bank: 6

CC#0 CC#32
1

PC
0

Bank: 7

CC#0 CC#32
1

Bank: 4

PC
0

10

11

10

10

10

10

12

11

11

11

11

13

12

12

12

12

14

13

13

13

13

15

14

14

14

14

16

15

15

15

15

Bank: 8

Factory data
Performances

PC

Bank: 9

CC#0 CC#32
1

PC

Bank: 10

CC#0 CC#32
1

10

PC

Bank: 11

CC#0 CC#32
1

11

PC

10

11

10

10

10

10

12

11

11

11

11

13

12

12

12

12

14

13

13

13

13

15

14

14

14

14

16

15

15

15

15

CC#0 CC#32
1

12

PC

Bank: 13

CC#0 CC#32
1

13

PC

Bank: 14

CC#0 CC#32
1

14

PC

Bank: 15

CC#0 CC#32
1

15

PC

10

11

10

10

10

10

12

11

11

11

11

13

12

12

12

12

14

13

13

13

13

15

14

14

14

14

16

15

15

15

15

CC#0 CC#32
1

16

PC
0

Bank: 17

CC#0 CC#32
1

17

PC
0

Bank: 18

CC#0 CC#32
1

18

PC
0

Bank: 19

CC#0 CC#32
1

19

Bank: 16

Bank: 12

PC

Bank: 20

10

11

10

10

10

10

12

11

11

11

11

13

12

12

12

12

14

13

13

13

13

15

14

14

14

14

16

15

15

15

15

Appendix

CC#0 CC#32
1

323

324

Factory data
Pads

Pads
You can assign the following Hits or Sequences to the four Pads. Older sounds might be still assigned to the Pads when loading musical
resources generated with an older operating system (see the following section).
#

HIT - Drum

HIT - Percussion

HIT - World 1

Hit - World 2

HIT - Orchestral

HIT - Synth&Pad

88 Cowbell

Agogo 1

Baja 1

Kup 1

Brass Fall

Cosmic

88 Crash

Agogo 2

Baja 2

Kup 2

Orch.Cymbal 1

VCF Modulation

China

Castanet 1

China Gong

Kup 3

Orch.Cymbal 2

Planet Lead

Crash 1

Castanet 2

Darbuka 1

Kup 4

Orch. Hit

Brightness

Crash 2

Conga Hi

Darbuka 2

Ramazan 1

Orch. Snare

Crystal

Rev. Cymbal

Conga Low

Darbuka 3

Ramazan 2

Orch. Sn. Roll

New Age Pad

Ride 1

Conga Mute

Darbuka 4

Ramazan 3

Timpani 1

Fifths Lead

Ride 2

Conga Slap

Darbuka 5

Rek Dom Ak

Timpani 2

Calliope

Ride Bell

Cowbell

Darbuka 6

Rik 1

Timpani 3

Caribbean

10 Splash

10 Cuica 1

10 Darbuka 7

10 Rik 2

10 Timpani 4

10 Rezbo

11 Sticks

11 Cuica 2

11 Darbuka 8

11 Rik 3

11 Orchestra Tutti

11 Digital Polisix

12 Rim-Shot

12 Jingle Bell

12 Davul

12 Sagat 1

12

12 Motion Raver

13 Hi Tom Flam

13 Long Guiro

13 Douf Rim Ak

13 Sagat 2

13

13 Moving Bell

14 Mid Tom Flam

14 Short Guiro

14 Dragon Gong

14 Tef 1

14

14 Elastick Pad

15 Low Tom Flam

15 Open Bells

15 Hollo 1

15 Tef 2

15

15 Rave

16 Tom Flam End

16 Rain Stick

16 Hollo 2

16 Tef 3

16

16 Dance Remix

17 Drum Single A

17 Tamb. Acc. 1

17

17 Tef 4

17

17 Vintage Sweep

18 Drum Single B

18 Tamb. Acc. 2

18

18 Tef 5

18

18 You Decide

19 Drum Single C

19 Tamb. Open

19

19 Tef 6

19

19

20 Drum Single D

20 Tamb. Push

20

20

20

20

21 Drum Sing.HouseA

21 Timbale Hi

21

21

21

21

22 Drum Sing.HouseB

22 Timbale Low

22

22

22

22

23 Drum Sing.HouseC

23 Timbale Rim 1

23

23

23

23

24 Drum Sing.HouseD

24 Timbale Rim 2

24

24

24

24

25 Drum Kit A

25 Triangle 1

25

25

25

25

26 Drum Kit B

26 Triangle 2

26

26

26

26

27 Drum Kit C

27 Vibra Slap

27

27

27

27

28 Drum Kit D

28 Whistle 1

28

28

28

28

29 Drum Kit E

29 Whistle 2

29

29

29

29

30 Drum Kit F

30 Windchimes 1

30

30

30

30

31

31 Windchimes 2

31

31

31

31

32

32 Windchimes 3

32

32

32

32

HIT - Voice

HIT - Blocks

HIT - Misc&SFX 1

HIT - Misc&SFX 2

SEQ - Drum

SEQ - Percussion

Aah !

Blk Funk 1 A

Applause

Bubble

Drum DrumBasSolo

Perc FingerSnap

Hit it !

Blk Funk 1 B

Bird 1

Car Crash

Drum Snare Solo

Perc Triang.+HH

Laughing

Blk Funk 1 C

Bird 2

Car Engine

Drum 8 Bt Easy

Perc Latin 1

Scream

Blk Funk 1 D

Cat

Car Pass

Drum 8 Bt Medium

Perc Latin 2

Uuh !

Blk Funk 2 A

Church Bell

Car Stop

Drum Rock 1

Perc Latin 3

Yeah ! 1

Blk Funk 2 B

Crickets

Explosion

Drum Rock 2

Perc Mix

Yeah ! 2

Perc Soft

Blk Funk 2 C

Dist. Slide 1

Gun Shot

Drum Brush 1

Blk Funk 2 D

Dist. Slide 2

Helicopter

Drum Brush 2

Perc Conga

Blk Organ A

Dog

Jet Plane

Drum Disco 1

Perc Conga+Ride

10

10 Blk Organ B

10 Door Creak

10 Laser Gun

10 Drum Disco 2

10 Perc Conga+Mix

11

11 Blk Organ C

11 Door Slam

11 Machine Gun

11 Drum Disco 3

11 Perc Conga+Bongo

12

12 Blk Organ D

12 Foosteps 1

12 Phone Ring

12 Drum Disco 4

12 Perc Conga+Tamb.

13

13 Blk Choir A

13 Foosteps 2

13 Punch

13 Drum Funk 1

13 Perc Shaker
14 Perc Shak+Tamb 1

14

14 Blk Choir B

14 Heart Beat

14 River

14 Drum Funk 2

15

15 Blk Choir C

15 Horse Gallop

15 Seashore

15 Drum Brush Shuff

15 Perc Shak+Tamb 2

16

16 Blk Choir D

16 Lion

16 Siren

16 Drum Latin

16 Perc Shak+Cong 1

17

17

17 Scratch 1

17 Starship

17 Drum Progressiv1

17 Perc Shak+Cong 2

18

18

18 Scratch 2

18 Thunder

18 Drum Progressiv2

18 Perc Tambourine1

19

19

19 Scratch 3

19 Train

19 Drum Fill 1

19 Perc Tambourine2

Factory data
Pads

325

20

20 Scratch 4

20 Wind

20 Drum Fill 2

21

21

21 Scratch 5

21

21 Drum Break

20 Perc Tamb+Conga1
21 Perc Tamb+Conga2

22

22

22 Scratch 6

22

22 Drum End

22 Perc Guiro+Bongo

23

23

23 Stadium

23

23

23 Perc Cowbel+Tamb

24

24

24

24

24

24 Perc

25

25

25

25

25

25 Perc 6/8

26

26

26

26

26

26

27

27

27

27

27

27

28

28

28

28

28

28

29

29

29

29

29

29

30

30

30

30

30

30

31

31

31

31

31

31

32

32

32

32

32

32

SEQ - Groove

SEQ - Bass

SEQ - Piano

SEQ - Guitar

SEQ - Orchestral

SEQ - Solo

Grv Drum 1

Bass Pick Easy

Piano Accomp 1

Gtr Steel Strum1

Timpani Roll 1

Solo Marimba

Grv Drum 2

Bass Pick Med.

Piano Accomp 2

Gtr Steel Strum2

Timpani Roll 2

Solo Kalimba 1

Grv Brush

Bass Pick Busy

Piano Accomp 3

Gtr Steel Strum3

Orch. Tutti 1

Solo Kalimba 2

Grv Jazzy

Bass Finger Easy

Piano Accomp 4

Gtr Steel Strum4

Orch. Tutti 2

Solo Steel Drums

Grv Latin

Bass Finger Med.

Piano Accomp 5

Gtr Steel Strum5

Orch. Tutti 3

Solo Vibes

Grv HipHop 1

Bass Finger Walk

Piano Accomp 6

Gtr Steel Strum6

Orch. Tutti 4

Solo Gtr Dist.

Grv HipHop 2

Bass Latin

Piano Accomp 7

GtSteelStrum

Orch. Harp 1

Solo Slide Steel

Grv HipHop 3

Bass Slap

Piano Accomp 8

Gtr Steel Arp 1

Orch. Harp 2

Solo Banjo

Grv HipHop 4

Bass Digital

Piano Accomp 9

Gtr Steel Arp 2

Orch. Harp 3

Solo Violin

10 Grv HipHop 5

10 Bass Synth

10 Piano Arpeg. 1

10 Gtr Steel Arp 3

10 Orch. Harp 4

10 Solo Harpsi

11 Grv HipHop 6

11 Bass DigiFilter1

11 Piano Arpeg. 2

12 Grv Funk 1

12 Bass DigiFilter2

12 Piano Arp 1

11 GtrSteel Arp 6/8

11 Orch. Harp 5

11 Solo Harpsi 4/4

12 Gtr Steel Mute 1

12 French Horns 1

13 Grv Funk 2

13 Bass DigiFilter3

13 Piano Arp 2

13 Gtr Steel Mute 2

13 French Horns 2

12 Solo Gtr Funk


13 Solo Piano 1

14 Grv Funk 3

14

14 Piano Arp Down

14 Guitar Country

14 Strings 1

14 Solo Piano 2

15 Grv House 1

15

15 Piano Arp Up

15 Gtr Nylon Strum1

15 Strings 2

15 Solo Piano 3

16 Grv House 2

16

16 Piano Rhythm 1/8

16 Gtr Nylon Strum2

16 Strings 3

16 Solo Piano 4

17 Grv Analog

17

17 Piano Rhythm1/8T

17 Gtr Nylon Strum3

17 Strings 4

17 Solo Synth 1

18 Grv Garage 1

18

18 Piano Latin Rock

18 Gtr Nylon Strum4

18 Strings 5

18 Solo Synth 2

19 Grv Garage 2

19

19 Piano Salsa 1

19 Gtr Nylon Strum5

19 Strings 6

19 Solo Synth 3

20 Grv Dance 1

20

20 Piano Salsa 2

20 Gtr Nylon Strum6

20 Strings 7

20 Solo Synth 4

21 Grv Dance 2

21

21 Pno GlissDwnWhit

21 Gtr Nylon Arp 1

21

21 Solo Synth 5

22 Grv Techno 1

22

22 Pno GlissUpWhite

22 Gtr Nylon Arp 2

22

22 Solo Synth 6

23 Grv Techno 2

23

23 Pno GlissDwnBlak

23 Gtr Nylon Arp 3

23

23 Solo Guitar 1

24

24

24 Pno GlissUpBlack

24 GtrNylon Arp

24

24 Solo Guitar 2

25

25

25 Honky End

25

25

25 Solo Guitar 3

26

26

26

26

26

26

27

27

27

27

27

27

28

28

28

28

28

28

29

29

29

29

29

29

30

30

30

30

30

30

31

31

31

31

31

31

32

32

32

32

32

32

SEQ - Synth&Pad

SEQ - Misc&SFX

Synth Seq 1

Military 1

Synth Seq 2

Military 2

Synth Seq 3

Military 3

Synth Seq 4

Military 4

Synth Seq 5

Horror 1

Synth Seq 6

Horror 2

Synth Seq 7

Horror 3

Synth Seq 8

Horror 4

Synth Seq 9

Lullaby 1

10 Lullaby 2

10

10

10

10

10 Synth Seq 10

Appendix

20

326

Factory data
Pads

11 Synth Seq 11

11 Nature - River

11

11

11

11

12 Synth Portam. 1

12 Nature - Storm

12

12

12

12

13 Synth Portam. 2

13 Metronome

13

13

13

13

14 Synth Portam. 3

14 PreCount

14

14

14

14

15 Synth Portam. 4

15 Metronome 4/4

15

15

15

15

16 Synth Filter 1

16 PreCount 4/4

16

16

16

16

17 Synth Filter 2

17 PreCount 4/4 Dbl

17

17

17

17

18 Synth Pad Panned

18 Toccata

18

18

18

18

19 Synth Master Pad

19 5th Intro

19

19

19

19

20 Synth Dark Pad

20 Primavera

20

20

20

20

21

21 Circus 1

21

21

21

21

22

22 Circus 2

22

22

22

22

23

23

23

23

23

23

24

24

24

24

24

24

25

25

25

25

25

25

26

26

26

26

26

26

27

27

27

27

27

27

28

28

28

28

28

28

29

29

29

29

29

29

30

30

30

30

30

30

31

31

31

31

31

31

32

32

32

32

32

32

Factory data
List of sounds assignable to the Pads in OS versions previous to 2.0

327

List of sounds assignable to the Pads in OS versions previous to 2.0


With OS versions prior to 2.0, you could assign the following sounds to the Pads. When loading older data, these sounds could still be
assigned to the Pads. You can replace them with any of the Hit or Sequence resources listed in the previous section.
SOUND NAME

ChinaGong

36

DistSlid2

Crash 1

37

Crash 2

38

88 Crash

Ride 1

SOUND NAME

SOUND NAME

71

Darbuka1

106

HeartBeat

Sticks

72

Darbuka2

107

Footstep1

Cowbell

73

Darbuka3

108

Footstep2

39

Agogo 1

74

Darbuka4

109

Stadium

40

Agogo 2

75

Darbuka5

110

DoorCreak

Ride 2

41

Whistle 1

76

Darbuka6

111

DoorSlam

China

42

Whistle 2

77

Darbuka7

112

CarEngine

Ride Bell

43

Sh. Guiro

78

Darbuka8

113

Car Stop

Splash

44

LongGuiro

79

DoufRimAk

114

Car Pass

10

RevCymbal

45

Cuica 1

80

Tef 1

115

Car Crash

11

DragonGng

46

Cuica 2

81

Tef 2

116

Crickets

12

OrchCymb1

47

Triangle1

82

Tef 3

117

Train

13

OrchCymb2

48

Triangle2

83

Tef 4

118

Helicopt

14

OrcSdRoll

49

88Cowbell

84

Tef 5

119

Gun Shot

15

OrchSnare

50

TimbLow

85

Tef 6

120

MachinGun

16

Timpani 1

51

TimbHi

86

Rik 1

121

Laser Gun

17

Timpani 2

52

TimbRim1

87

Rik 2

122

Explosion

18

Timpani 3

53

TimbRim2

88

Rik 3

123

Dog

19

Timpani 4

54

CongaLow

89

RekDomAk

124

H. Gallop

20

Orch. Hit

55

CongaHi

90

OpenBells

125

Birds 1

21

BrassFall

56

CongaSlap

91

Sagat 1

126

Birds 2

22

Ch. Bell

57

CongaMute

92

Sagat 2

127

Thunder

23

JingleBel

58

Tamb.Acc1

93

Davul

128

Sea Shore

24

WindChim1

59

Tamb.Acc2

94

Ramazan 1

129

River

25

WindChim2

60

Tamb.Push

95

Ramazan 2

130

Bubble

26

WindChim3

61

TambOpen

96

Ramazan 3

131

Cat

27

VibraSlap

62

Castanet1

97

Kup 1

132

Lion

28

RainStick

63

Castanet2

98

Kup 2

133

PhoneRing

29

Scratch 1

64

Aah !

99

Kup 3

134

Applause

30

Scratch 2

65

Uuh !

100

Kup 4

135

Wind

31

Scratch 3

66

Yeah ! 1

101

Baya 1

136

Starship

32

Scratch 4

67

Yeah ! 2

102

Baya 2

137

Jetplane

33

Scratch 5

68

Hit It !

103

Laughing

138

Siren

34

Scratch 6

69

Hollo 1

104

Scream

139

Cosmic

35

DistSlid1

70

Hollo 2

105

Punch

Appendix

SOUND NAME
1

328

Factory data
MIDI Setup

MIDI Setup
Default

Master Kbd

Sequencer1

Sequencer 2

Accordion 1

Accordion 2

Accordion 3

Ext. Seq
S1_Tr 1

S1_Tr 1

Global

S1_Tr 1

S2_Tr 1

Global

Upp1

Upp1

S1_Tr 2

Control

S1_Tr 2

S2_Tr 2

Lower

Lower

Lower

S1_Tr 2

S1_Tr 3

S1_Tr 3

S2_Tr 3

Bass

Bass

S1_Tr 3

S1_Tr 4

S1_Tr 4

S2_Tr 4

Upp2

Upp2

S1_Tr 4

S1_Tr 5

S1_Tr 5

S2_Tr 5

Upp3

Upp3

S1_Tr 5

S1_Tr 6

S1_Tr 6

S2_Tr 6

S1_Tr 6

S1_Tr 7

S1_Tr 7

S2_Tr 7

S1_Tr 7

S1_Tr 8

S1_Tr 8

S2_Tr 8

S1_Tr 8

S1_Tr 9

S1_Tr 9

S2_Tr 9

Bass

S1_Tr 9

10

S1_Tr 10

S1_Tr 10

S2_Tr 10

Drum

Drum

Drum

S1_Tr 10

11

S1_Tr 11

S1_Tr 11

S2_Tr 11

Perc

Perc

Perc

S1_Tr 11

12

S1_Tr 12

S1_Tr 12

S2_Tr 12

Acc1

Acc1

Acc1

S1_Tr 12

13

S1_Tr 13

S1_Tr 13

S2_Tr 13

Acc2

Acc2

Acc2

S1_Tr 13

14

S1_Tr 14

S1_Tr 14

S2_Tr 14

Acc3

Acc3

Acc3

S1_Tr 14

15

S1_Tr 15

S1_Tr 15

S2_Tr 15

Acc4

Acc4

Acc4

S1_Tr 15

16

S1_Tr 16

S1_Tr 16

S2_Tr 16

Acc5

Acc5

Acc5

S1_Tr 16

1 Upp1

Upp1

S1_Tr 1

S2_Tr 1

Upp1

S1_Tr 1

S2_Tr 1

Upp. 1

Upp2

Upp2

S1_Tr 2

S2_Tr 2

Upp2

S1_Tr 2

S2_Tr 2

Upp3

Upp3

S1_Tr 3

S2_Tr 3

Upp3

S1_Tr 3

S2_Tr 3

Lower

Lower

S1_Tr 4

S2_Tr 4

Lower

S1_Tr 4

S2_Tr 4

S1_Tr 5

S2_Tr 5

S1_Tr 5

S2_Tr 5

S1_Tr 6

S2_Tr 6

S1_Tr 6

S2_Tr 6

S1_Tr 7

S2_Tr 7

S1_Tr 7

S2_Tr 7

S1_Tr 8

S2_Tr 8

S1_Tr 8

S2_Tr 8

Bass

Bass

S1_Tr 9

S2_Tr 9

Bass

S1_Tr 9

S2_Tr 9

10

Drum

Drum

S1_Tr 10

S2_Tr 10

Drum

S1_Tr 10

S2_Tr 10

11

Perc

Perc

S1_Tr 11

S2_Tr 11

Perc

S1_Tr 11

S2_Tr 11

12

Acc1

Acc1

S1_Tr 12

S2_Tr 12

Acc1

S1_Tr 12

S2_Tr 12

13

Acc2

Acc2

S1_Tr 13

S2_Tr 13

Acc2

S1_Tr 13

S2_Tr 13

14

Acc3

Acc3

S1_Tr 14

S2_Tr 14

Acc3

S1_Tr 14

S2_Tr 14

15

Acc4

Acc4

S1_Tr 15

S2_Tr 15

Acc4

S1_Tr 15

S2_Tr 15

16

Acc5

Acc5

S1_Tr 16

S2_Tr 16

Acc5

S1_Tr 16

S2_Tr 16

Chord 1 Chann.

Off

Off

Off

Off

Chord 2 Chann.

Off

Off

Off

Off

Off

Off

Harm. Chann.

Off

Harm. Octave

-1

-1

-1

Harm. Range HI

G9

G9

G9

G9

G9

G9

G9

G9

Harm. Range LO

C -1

C -1

C -1

C -1

C -1

C -1

C -1

C -1

MIDI IN Velocity

Normal

Normal

Normal

Normal

110

110

Normal

Normal

MIDI IN Oct. Trp.

MIDI IN Mute/Un.

Upper Oct. Trp.

Lower Oct. Trp.

MIDI IN
Channel

MIDI OUT
Channel

Effects
Diagrams

329

Effects
Pa1X is equipped with four powerful Effect Processors. You can
send them the internal tracks, or any signal entering the Audio
Inputs.

Modulation source

Note

Sostenu: #66

Sostenuto Pedal

MIDI(CC#80)
MIDI(CC#81)

Diagrams

MIDI(CC#82)
MIDI(CC#83)

The following instructions show the signal path diagram for


each of the effect types. The signal coming from the tracks
(Send) is mono. Before entering an effect processor, it is split in
two wires (Left and Right), and processed in stereo. The signal
is then output in stereo from the effect processor, and sent to the
Mix output (Left&Right, the heaphones or the internal speakers).
Effect Block
Send

Diagram

Left

Tempo

Some notes on the Gate parameters follow.


Gate1, Gate1+Dmpr (Gate1+Damper)
The effect is at maximum during note-on, and will stop when all
keys are released. With Gate1 + Dmpr, the effect will remain at
maximum even after the keys are released, as long as the damper
(sustain) pedal is pressed.
Gate1,Gate1+Dmpr

Right

1
Note

Dmpr

Damper Pedal
On
Off

Gate1

Dynamic Modulation sources


When the
symbol is encoutered, a Dynamic Modulation
can be applied to the corresponding parameter. The following
table shows the available modulation sources.
Modulation source

Note

Off

No modulation

Gate1+Dmpr

Time

Gate2, Gate2+Dmpr (Gate2+Damper)


This is essentially the same as for Gate 1 or Gate 1 + Dmpr.
However when Gate 2 or Gate 2 + Dmpr are used as a dynamic
modulation source for the EG of 022: St. Envelope Flanger etc.
or the AUTOFADE of 027: Stereo Vibrato, a trigger will occur at
each note-on. (In the case of Gate 1 and Gate 1 + Dmpr, the trigger occurs only for the first note-on.)

Gate1

Gate2,Gate2+Dmpr
1
Note

Gate1+Dmpr

Dmpr

Damper Pedal

Gate2

Gate2

Gate2+Dmpr
Note Nr

On
Off

Gate2+Dmpr

Note Number

Velocity

Note Velocity

AfterTouch

After Touch

JS X

Joystick Left/Right

JS+Y: CC#01

Joystick Forward

JS-Y: CC#02

Joystick Backward

Time

MIDI(CC#04)
MIDI(CC#12)
MIDI(CC#13)
MIDI(CC#16)

Appendix

MIDI(CC#18)
MIDI(CC#17)
MIDI(CC#19)
MIDI(CC#20)
MIDI(CC#21)
Damper: #64
Prta.SW: #65

Portamento Switch

330

Effects
Filter/Dynamic

002: Compressor

Filter/Dynamic

This effect compresses the input signal to regulate the level and
give a punchy effect. It is useful for guitar, piano, and drum
sounds. This is a stereo compressor. You can link left and right
channels, or use each channel separately.

Filter and dynamics control effects

000: No Effect

Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Select this option when you do not use any effects. When this
option is selected, the effect is muted.

Wet / Dry
EQ Trim

LEQ

HEQ

Compressor

Output Level

Envelope - Control
Envelope Select
Envelope - Control

001: Amp. Simulation

Output Level

Compressor
EQ Trim

LEQ

HEQ

Right

This effect simulates the frequency response characteristics of


guitar amplifiers. It is also effective for organ and drum sounds.

Wet / Dry

Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left
Wet / Dry

Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity

1...100

Attack
Sets the attack level

1...100

EQ Trim
Sets the EQ input level

0...100

Wet / Dry

Amplier Type
Selects the type of guitar amplier

Solid State, British


(EL84), American
(6L6)

Src
Selects the modulation source of the effect balance
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance

Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Sets the gain of Low EQ

15.0...+15.0dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Sets the gain of High EQ

15.0...+15.0dB

Output Level
Sets the output level of the compressor

Off...Tempo
100...+100

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds
b

b
Amp Simulation Filter
Right

Envelope Select
L/R Mix, L/R Individually
Determines whether the left and right channels are linked or used separately

0...100

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the compressor output level
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the compressor output level
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

a: Envelope Select
This parameter selects whether the left and right channels are
linked to control both signals simultaneously, or whether each
channel is controlled independently.

b: Sensitivity, f: Output Level


The Sensitivity parameter sets the sensitivity of the compressor.
If this parameter is set to a higher value, lower level sounds will
be boosted. With a higher Sensitivity, the overall volume level is
higher. To adjust the final volume level, use the Output Level
parameter.
Compressor - Sensitivity
Level
Wet
Sensitivity=100

Louder

Amp Simulation Filter

Dry

Sensitivity=40

Time

Effects
Filter/Dynamic

c: Attack

331

a: Envelope Select

This parameter controls the attack level.

When L/R Mix is selected for this parameter, the left and right
channels are linked to control the Limiter using the mixed signal.
If L Only (or R Only) is selected, the left and right channels are
linked, and the Limiter is controlled via only the left (or right)
channel.
With L/R individually, the left and right channels control the Limiter individually.

Compressor - Attack

Level
Attack=80
Attack=20
Wet

Dry
Time

b: Ratio, c: Threshold [dB], e: Gain Adjust [dB]

003: Limiter

Limiter - Threshold / Ratio


Ratio=1.0 : 1
Output Level
Ratio=2.0 : 1
Threshold

Ratio=4.0 : 1
Ration=Inf : 1

Louder

The Limiter regulates the input signal level. It is similar to the


Compressor, except that the Limiter compresses only signals that
exceed the specified level to lower unnecessary peak signals. The
Limiter applies a peaking-type EQ to the trigger signal (which
controls the degree of the Limiter effect), allowing you to set any
band width to be covered. This effect is a stereo limiter. You can
link left and right channels, or use each channel individually.

This parameter sets the signal compression Ratio. Compression


is applied only when the signal level exceeds the Threshold
value.
Adjust the output level using the Gain Adjust parameter, since
compression causes the entire level to be reduced.

Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry

Louder

Gain Adjust

Input Level

Limiter
Side PEQ
Envelope - Control

Trigger Monitor

Level

Dry

Envelope - Control
Envelope Select

Ratio=1.0 : 1
Ratio=2.0 : 1
Ratio=4.0 : 1

Limiter

Threshold

Gain Adjust
Right

Ratio=Inf : 1

Wet / Dry

Time

Envelope Select
L/R Mix, L Only, R Only, L/R Individually
Selects from linking both channels, controlling only from left channel, only
from the right channel, or controlling each channel individually

Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio

Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied

d: Attack, d: Release
These parameters set the attack time and release time. A higher
attack time will cause the compression to be applied more slowly.

1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1

Limiter - Attack / Release

40...0dB

Threshold

Dry

Attack
Sets the attack time

1...100

Release
Sets the release time

1...100

Src
Selects the modulation source for the output gain
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the output gain
Side PEQ Insert
Toggles between on/off of the trigger signals EQ

Wet

Ratio=Inf : 1
Attack=100
Release=100

63...+63
Release

Off, On

Attack

Trigger Monitor
Off, On
Switches between effect output monitor and trigger signal monitor

f: Side PEQ Insert, g: Side PEQ Cutoff [Hz], g: Q, g: Gain


[dB]

Side PEQ Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the EQ center frequency for the trigger signal

These parameters are used to set the EQ applied to the trigger


signal.
The Limiter determines whether the compression is applied or
not, based on the post-EQ trigger signal. Setting the equalizer
allows you to set the Limiter to respond to any frequency band.

Q
Sets the EQ bandwidth for the trigger signal
Gain [dB]
Sets the EQ gain for the trigger signal

20...12.00kHz

0.5...10.0
18.0...+18.0dB

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Ratio=Inf : 1
Attack=1
Release=1

Off...Tempo

Wet

Inf, 38...+24dB
,

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

f: Trigger Monitor
Setting this parameter On will cause the trigger signal to be output, instead of the effect sound. Use this parameter to check the
trigger signal with EQ applied.
Usually, set this to Off.

Appendix

Gain Adjust [dB]


Sets the output gain

332

Effects
Filter/Dynamic

004: Multiband Limiter

005: Gate

This effect applies the Limiter to the low range, mid range, and
high range of the input signal. You can control dynamics for
each range to adjust the sound pressure of the low range, mid
range, and high range in a different way from the EQ.

This effect mutes the input signal if its level is lower than the
specified level. It also reverses the on and off operation of the
gate, and uses Note On and Off messages to turn the gate on and
off.

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Stereo In - Stereo Out

Left
Band-Pass Filters
Low

Mid

Left

Wet / Dry

Wet / Dry

Delay

Limiter

Envelope - Control
Low Offset

Envelope - Control

Gain Adjust
Envelope Select

Limiter

Right

Envelope - Control

Limiter

Envelope - Control
High Mid Offset
Envelope - Control
High Offset

Gate

Delay

Gate

Right

Wet / Dry

Wet / Dry
Gate+Sus

Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio

1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003

Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied

Attack
Sets the attack time

1...100
Fx:003

Release
Sets the release time

Fx:003

40...0dB

Fx:003

Envelope Select
D-mod, L/R Mix, L Only, R Only
Selects from Control via the modulation source, mixing the left and right signals, Only left, and Only right
,
Src
Off...Gate2+Dmpr
Selects the modulation source that controls the gate when Envelope Select =
D-mod

1...100

Polarity
Switches between non-reversed and reversed Gate on/off

Low Offset [dB]


Gain of the low-range trigger signal

40...0dB

Threshold
Sets the level to which the Gate is applied

0...100

Mid Offset [dB]


Gain of the mid-range trigger signal

40...0dB

Attack
Sets the attack time

1...100

High Offset [dB]


Gain of the high-range trigger signal

40...0dB

Release
Sets the release time

1...100

Gain Adjust [dB]


Sets the output gain
h

Inf, 38...+24dB

Src
Selects the modulation source for the output gain
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the output gain

100...+100

e: Low Offset [dB], f: Mid Offset [dB], g: High Offset [dB]


These parameters set the gain of the trigger signal.
For example, if you do not want to apply compression to the high
range, reduce the High Offset value down below the Threshold level. In this way, the high range limiter will not respond,
and compression will not be applied.

Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time of the gate input

0...100msec

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

63...+63

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

Off...Tempo

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Fx:003,

+,

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

a: Envelope Select, a: Src


The Envelope Select parameter selects whether the gate on/off
is triggered by the level of the input signal, or controlled directly
by the modulation source. The Src parameter specifies the modulation source, selected from Off to Gate2+Dpmr.
With Envelope Select = L/R Mix, the left and right channel signal mixture will trigger the gate on/off. When L Only or R Only is
selected, the gate is controlled by either of the channel signals.

b: Polarity
This parameter reverses the Gate on/off operation. With a negative value, the gate is closed when the input signal level exceeds
the Threshold. The gate operation controlled by the modulation
source is also reversed.

c: Threshold, d: Attack, d: Release


This parameter sets the signal level below which Gate is applied
when Envelope Select is set to L/R Mix, L Only, or R Only.

Effects
Filter/Dynamic

The Attack and Release parameters set the Gate attack time and
release time.

Low Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency for Low EQ (shelving type)

333

20...1.0kHz

Gate - Threshold

Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

Output Level

18...+18dB

Mid1 Cutoff [Hz]


300...10.00kHz
Sets the center frequency for Mid/High EQ 1 (peaking type)

Louder

Threshold

Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 1

g
Louder

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1

Input Level
Gate - Attack / Release

18...+18dB

Mid2 Cutoff [Hz]


500...20.00kHz
Sets the center frequency for Mid/High EQ 2 (peaking type)

Threshold
Dry

Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2

Wet

0.5...10.0

Attack=1
Release=1

0.5...10.0

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2

18...+18dB

Direct Mix
Sets the amount of the dry sound mixed to the distortion

0...50

i
Wet

Speaker Simulation
Switches the speaker simulation on/off

Attack=100
Release=100

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Release

Attack

Off, On

e: Delay Time

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330

This parameter sets the delay time of the Gate input. If the sound
has a very fast attack, increase the delay time so that the signal
will be input after the Gate is opened. This will preserve the
attack part of the sound.

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

a: Wah

006: OD - Hi Gain Wah

The Wah parameter switches the wah effect on/off.

(Overdrive/Hi.Gain Wah)

a: Sw

This distortion effect utilizes an Overdrive mode and a Hi-Gain


mode. Controlling the wah effect, the 3-band EQ, and the amp
simulation will allow you to create versatile distortion sounds.
This effect is suitable for guitar and organ sounds.

This parameter sets how the wah effect is switched on and off via
the modulation source.
When Sw = Moment, the wah effect is usually turned off. It is
turned on only when you press the pedal or operate the joystick.
When a value for the modulation source is less than 64, off
speed is selected, and when the value is 64 or higher, on is
selected.

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry

Mode: Overdrive / Hi-Gain


Drive
3 Band PEQ
Amp Simulation
Driver
Output Level

When Sw = Toggle, the wah effect is switched between on and


off each time you press the pedal or operate the joystick.
The switch will be turned on/off each time the value of the
modulation source exceeds 64.

Direct Mix
Right
Wet / Dry

D-mod

Wah
Switches Wah on/off
a

b: Wah Sweep Range, b: Wah Sweep Src

Off, On

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that switches the Wah on and off
Sw
Toggle, Moment
Selects the switching mode for the modulation source that switches the Wah
on and off

Wah Sweep Range


Sets the range of Wah

b
Wah Sweep Src
Selects the modulation source that controls the Wah
c

10...+10

Off...Tempo

Drive Mode
Overdrive, Hi-Gain
Switches between overdrive and hi-gain distortion
Drive
Sets the degree of distortion

Output Level
Sets the output level
e

Src
Selects the modulation source for the output level
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the output level

d: Drive, e: Output Level


The degree of distortion is determined by the level of input signal and the setting of Drive. Raising the Drive setting will
cause the entire volume level to increase. Use the Output Level
parameter to adjust the volume level. The Output Level parameter uses the signal level input to the 3-Band EQ. If clipping
occurs at the 3-Band EQ, adjust the Output Level parameter.

d: Pre Low-cut
1...100

d
Pre Low-cut
Sets the low range cut amount of the distortion input

This parameter sets the sweep range of the wah center frequency. A negative value will reverse the direction of sweep. The
wah center frequency can be controlled by the modulation
source specified in the Wah Sweep Src parameter.

0...10

0...50

Off...Tempo
50...+50

Cutting the signal in the low range before it is input to the Distortion will create a sharp distortion.

g: Q, h: Q
These parameters set the bandwidth of each equalizer. The
higher the value, the narrower the band becomes.

Appendix

Pre Low-cut
Wah

334

Effects
Filter/Dynamic

007: Parametric 4EQ

d: Band2 Dynamic Gain Src, d: Amt [dB], f: Gain [dB]

(Parametric 4-Band EQ)

You can control the gain of Band 2 using the modulation source.
Parametric 4EQ - Band2 Dynamic Gain Control

This is a stereo 4-band parametric equalizer. You can select peaking type or shelving type for Band 1 and 4. The gain of Band 2
can be controlled by dynamic modulation.

D-mod

+15dB

Band2 Cutoff
+6dB

+6dB

0dB

0dB
Band2 Cutoff

Stereo In - Stereo Out

9dB

Left

Band1 Band2 Band3 Band4


PEQ
Trim

PEQ

PEQ

LEQ

PEQ

Band2 Gain[dB]= +6.0


Band2 Dynamic Gain Amt[dB]= +9.0

HEQ
PEQ

PEQ

008: Graphic 7EQ

PEQ

Right

(Graphic 7 Band EQ)

Wet / Dry

-mod

Trim
Sets the input level

Band1 Type
Selects the type of Band 1

Peaking, Shelving-Low

Band4 Type
Selects the type of Band 4

Peaking, Shelving-High

0...100

Wet / Dry

Trim

Off...Tempo

Amt [dB]
Sets the modulation amount of Band 2 gain

18...+18dB

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1

0.5...10.0
a

Type1:Wide 1, 2:Wide 2, 3:Wide 3, 4:Half Wide 1, 5:Half Wide 2, 6:Half Wide


3, 7:Low, 8:Wide Low, 9:Mid, 10:Wide Mid, 11:High, 12:Wide High
Selects a combination of center frequencies for each band

50...10.00kHz

Trim
Sets the input level

0.5...10.0

Band1 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1

18.0...+18.0dB

18.0...+18.0dB
,

Band2 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2

18.0...+18.0dB

300...10.00kHz

Band3 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3

18.0...+18.0dB

0.5...10.0

Band4 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4

18.0...+18.0dB

18.0...+18.0dB

Band5 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 5

18.0...+18.0dB

500...20.00kHz

Band6 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 6

18.0...+18.0dB

0.5...10.0

Band7 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 7

18.0...+18.0dB

18.0...+18.0dB

Fx:006

Band3 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency of Band 3
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3

Fx:006

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
Band4 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency of Band 4
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4

Fx:006

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

Selects a filter type for Band 1 and 4.


Parametric 4EQ - Band1, Band4 Type

0dB
Band1 Type=Shelving Low
Band1 Type=Peaking
3dB
Band1 Cutoff

Band4 Cutoff

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

100...+100

b: Band1 Type, c: Band4 Type

3dB
Band4 Type=Shelving High
Band4 Type=Peaking

0...100

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

18.0...+18.0dB

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Gain

Wet / Dry

Fx:006

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2

+Gain

Band1 Band2 Band3 Band4 Band5 Band6 Band7


Right

20...1.00kHz

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2

Band1 Band2 Band3 Band4 Band5 Band6 Band7

Trim

Band2 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency of Band 2

Left

Band2 Dynamic Gain Src


Selects the modulation source of the Band 2 gain

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1

Stereo In - Stereo Out

Band1 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency of Band 1

This is a stereo 7-band graphic equalizer. The bar graph of the


gain setting for each band gives you a clear, visual idea of frequency responses. You can select a center frequency setting for
each band from twelve types, according to the sound.

D-mod

Band2 Gain[dB]= +6.0


Band2 Dynamic Gain Amt[dB]= 15.0

HEQ

LEQ

Trim

Wet / Dry

PEQ

a: Type
This parameter selects a combination of center frequencies for
each band. Each center frequency is shown on the right edge of
the LCD.
You can configure a 21-Band Graphic EQ ranging from 80Hz to
18kHz if you route three Graphic 7Band EQ effects in series, with
a setting of 7:Low, 9:Mid, and 11:High for each EQ.

Effects
Filter/Dynamic

335

009: Wah/AutoWah

a: Frequency Bottom, a: Frequency Top

This stereo wah effect allows you to create sounds from vintage
wah pedal simulation to auto-wah simulation, and much
broader range settings.

The sweep width and direction of the wah filter are determined
by the Frequency Top and Frequency Bottom settings.
Sweep Mode=D-mod
Frequency

Wet / Dry

Wah
Envelope Sens
Envelope Shape
Response

D-mod

Wah
Bottom=60

Higher

Left

Wah
Woo
Top=30

Woo

Bottom=25

Sweep Mode
Auto
D-mod

D-mod

Higher
Zero

LFO

Higher

Top=75

Stereo In - Stereo Out

Frequency

D-mod

Higher
Zero

Max

Max

LFO

Wah

Sweep Mode=Auto
Frequency

Frequency

Right

Wet / Dry

Wah

Bottom=75

Frequency Bottom
Sets the lower limit of the wah center frequency

0...100

Frequency Top
Sets the upper limit of the wah center frequency

0...100

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the wah when Sweep Mode=D-mod

Envelope Sens (Envelope Sensitivity)


Sets the sensitivity of auto-wah

0...100

c
Envelope Shape
Sets the sweep curve of auto-wah

100...+100

LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

0.02...20.00Hz
,

Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz

Woo

Bottom=25

Top=25
Woo

Envelope

Envelope

Time

Time

This parameter changes the wah control mode. Setting Sweep


Mode to Auto will select an auto-wah that sweeps according to
envelope changes in the input signal level. Auto-wah is frequently used for funk guitar parts and clav sounds.
When Sweep Mode is set to D-mod, you can control the filter
directly via the modulation source in the same way as a wah
pedal.
When Sweep Mode is set to LFO, the effect uses LFO to sweep
in cycle.

c: Envelope Sens (Envelope Sensitivity)


This parameter sets the sensitivity of auto-wah. Increase the value
if the input signal is too low to sweep. Reduce the value if the
input signal is so high that the filter is stopped temporarily.

This parameter determines the sweep curve for auto-wah.

MIDI, 40...240

Envelope Shape
Level

Base Note
 , 
,  , 
, , 
, ,
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed

Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed

Envelope

c: Envelope Shape

BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
,
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

Wah

b: Sweep Mode

Response
0...100
Sets the response speed when Sweep Mode = Auto or D-mod

Woo

Sweep Mode
Auto, D-mod, LFO
Selects the control from auto-wah, modulation source, and LFO
,

Wah

Higher

Higher

Top=75

Envelope

value = 0...+100

x1...x16

value = 0...100
Time

0...100

Low Pass Filter


Switches the Wah Low Pass Filter on and off

Off, On

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

d: LFO Frequency [Hz], e: BPM/MIDI Sync


When BPM/MIDI Sync=Off, the LFO speed uses the LFO Frequency parameter setting. When BPM/MIDI Sync=On, the LFO
speed follows the BPM, Base Note, and Times settings.

e: BPM, e: Base Note, e: Times


One cycle of LFO sweep is obtained by multiplying the length of a
note ( ) (selected for Base Note, in relation to the tempo
specified in (BPM, or the MIDI Clock tempo if BPM is set to
MIDI) by the number specified in the Times parameter.

Appendix

Resonance
Sets the resonance amount

336

Effects
Filter/Dynamic

010: Random Filter

a: LFO Waveform, c: LFO Frequency [Hz],


d: LFO Step Freq (Frequency) [Hz]

This stereo band pass filter uses a step-shape waveform and random LFO for modulation. You can create a special effect from
filter oscillation.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Wet / Dry

When LFO Waveform is set to Step-Tri, LFO is a step-shape, triangle waveform. The LFO Frequency parameter sets the original triangle waveform speed. Changing the LFO Step Freq
parameter enables you to adjust the width of the steps.
When LFO Waveform is set to Random, the LFO Step Freq
parameter uses a random LFO cycle.

Filter

Random Filter LFO


LFO Frequency

Filter
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO Step Freq

LFO Phase

LFO Step Freq

LFO: Step-Tri/Random
Step-Tri

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Step-Tri, Random

LFO Phase [degree]


180...+180
Sets the LFO phase difference between the left and right

Random

b: LFO Phase [degree]


Offsetting the left and right phases alters how modulation is
applied to the left and right channels, creating a swelling affect.
LFO Phase

LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed
c

20.00...+20.00Hz

180

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009,

Base Note
 
 
 

Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed

0...100
0...100

Src
Selects the modulation source of lter modulation

Off...Tempo

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of lter modulation

100...+100

Resonance
Sets the resonance amount

0...100

Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
,
j

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

e: BPM, f: Step Base Note, f: Times


The width of an LFO step, or a cycle of random LFO, is obtained
by multiplying the length of a note ( ) (selected for Step Base
Note, in relation to the tempo specified in BPM, or the MIDI
Clock tempo if BPM is set to MIDI) by the number specified in
the Times parameter.

The effect sounds phase will be reversed when you set this
parameter in the range of values from Wet to 1:99.

x1...x32

Manual
Sets the lter center frequency
Depth
Sets the modulation depth of lter center frequency

0 [degree]

j: Wet/Dry

x1...x16

Fx:009

Step Base Note


 
 
 
 

Selects the type of notes to specify the LFO step speed ,
Times
Sets the number of notes to specify the LFO step speed

90

50.00...+50.00Hz

BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,

+90 +180 [degree]

LFO Step Freq (Frequency) [Hz]


0.05...50.00Hz
Sets the LFO step speed (speed that changes in steps) ,
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO step speed

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source used for both LFO speed and step speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

0.02...20.00Hz
,

100...+100

Effects
Filter/Dynamic

337

011: Exciter/Enhancer

012: Sub Oscillator

This effect is a combination of the Exciter, which adds a punch


to the sound and the Enhancer, which adds spread and presence.

This effect adds very low frequencies to the input signal. It is


very useful when simulating a roaring drum sound or emphasizing powerful low range. This effect is different from the equalizer
in that you can add very low range harmonics. You can also
adjust the oscillator frequency to match a particular note number, for use as an octaver.

Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry
LEQ

HEQ

Exciter
EQ Trim

Delay

EQ Trim

Delay

Depth
Stereo In - Stereo Out

Exciter

Left

Enhancer

Wet / Dry
Envelope Shape

Wet / Dry

Envelope Sens Pre LPF

D-mod

D-mod
Note No.

Exciter Blend
Sets the intensity (depth) of the Exciter effect
a

Off...Tempo

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the Exciter intensity

100...+100

Emphatic Point
Sets the frequency to be emphasized
b

Note (Key Follow)

Envelope Shape

0...70

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the frequency to be emphasized

Sine Oscillator

OSC Mode Pitch

Right

Fixed

Envelope Sens Pre LPF

100...+100
,

Src
Selects the modulation source of the Exciter intensity

Fixed Frequency
Note Interval, Fine

Wet / Dry

OSC Mode
Note (Key Follow), Fixed
Determines whether the oscillator frequency follows the note number or
whether it is xed

Note Interval
48...0
Sets the pitch difference from the note number when OSC Mode=Note (Key
Follow)

Amt
70...+70
Sets the amount of modulation of the frequency to be emphasized

Note Fine
Fine adjustment of the oscillator frequency

Enhancer Dly L (Enhancer Delay L) [msec]


Sets the delay time for the Enhancer left channel

Fixed Frequency [Hz]


10.0...80.0Hz
Sets the oscillator frequency when OSC Mode=Fixed

Enhancer Dly R (Enhancer Delay R) [msec]


Sets the delay time for the Enhancer right channel

0.0...50.0msec

0.0...50.0msec

Enhancer Depth
0...100
Sets the determines to what degree the Enhancer effect is applied
e

Src
Selects the modulation source of the Enhancer width

Off...Tempo

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the Enhancer width

100...+100
0...100

Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

15.0...+15.0dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15.0...+15.0dB

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the oscillator frequency when OSC
Mode=Fixed

100...+100

Envelope Pre LPF


1...100
Sets the upper limit of the frequency range for which very low harmonics are
added

Envelope Sens (Envelope Sensitivity)


0...100
Sets the sensitivity with which very low harmonics are added

e
Envelope Shape
Sets the oscillators volume envelope curve

100...+100

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Amt
80...+80Hz
Sets the oscillator frequency modulation amount when OSC Mode=Fixed
d

EQ Trim
Sets the 2-band EQ input level

100...+100

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

a: OSC Mode, b: Note Interval, b: Note Fine

This parameter sets the depth (intensity) of the Exciter effect.


Positive values give a frequency pattern (to be emphasized) different from negative values.

The OSC Mode parameter selects the oscillator operation


mode. When Note (Key Follow) is selected, the oscillators frequency is determined based on the note number, allowing you to
use it as an octaver. The Note Interval parameter sets the pitch
offset from the original note number by semitone steps. The
Note Fine parameter allows you to fine-tune in steps of cents.

b: Emphatic Point

d: Envelope Pre LPF

This parameter sets the frequency to be emphasized. Higher values will emphasize lower frequencies.

This parameter sets the upper limit of the frequency range to


which very low harmonics are added. Adjust this parameter if you
do not want to add lower harmonics to the higher range.

a: Exciter Blend

c: Enhancer Dly L [msec], d: Enhancer Dly R [msec]


These parameters set the delay time for the Enhancer left and
right channel. Specifying a slightly different delay time for the
left and right channel will add a stereo image, depth, and width
to the sound.

Appendix

Right

338

Effects
Filter/Dynamic

013: Talking Modulator

c: Voice Top, d: Voice Center, e: Voice Bottom

This effect adds an unusual character, like a human voice, to the


input signal. Modulating the tone via dynamic modulation, you
can create an interesting effect that sounds as if the guitar or synthesizer is talking.

These parameters assign vowels to the top, center, and bottom


position of the controller.
E.g.: When Voice Top=A, Voice Center=I, and Voice Bottom=U:
If Sweep Mode is set to LFO, the sound will change cyclically from
a to i, u, i, then a.

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Talking Modulator Control

Left

Wet / Dry
Voice Bottom

Voice Center

A
+

Talking Modulator

Voice Top

A
I

A-I-U-E-O

U
E
Right

D-mod
LFO

Wet / Dry

D-mod

Voice Top: A
Voice Center: I
Voice Bottom: U

Sweep Mode
D-mod
LFO

JS +Y
JS Y
etc

b
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that controls the voice pattern
Voice Top
Selects a vowel sound at the top end of control

A, I, U, E, O

Voice Center
Selects a vowel sound in the center of control

A, I, U, E, O

Voice Bottom
Selects a vowel sound at the bottom end of control

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

A, I, U, E, O

0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,

Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed

Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz

BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
Fx:009,
tempo and notes
g

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009

 
 
 

Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
Formant Shift
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
h
Resonance
Sets the Level of resonance of the voice pattern

x1...x16

Fx:009

100...+100

0...100

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

+ Max
+ Max

Zero

h: Resonance

Zero

This parameter adjusts the frequency level to which the effect is


applied. If you wish to apply the effect to a higher-range sound,
set this parameter to a higher value; to apply the effect to a
lower-range sound, set this to a lower value.

Bottom, 1...49, Center, 51...99, Top

LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

Max

h: Formant Shift

Sweep Mode
D-mod, LFO
Switches between modulation source control and LFO control
Manual Voice Control
Voice pattern control

JS X
Ribbon

100...+100

This parameter sets the intensity of resonance for the voice pattern. A larger value will add more character to the sound.

Effects
Filter/Dynamic

339

014: Decimator

015: Analog Record

This effect creates a rough sound like a cheap sampler by lowering the sampling frequency and data bit length. You can also
simulate noise unique to a sampler (aliasing).

This effect simulates the noise caused by scratches and dust on


analog records. It also reproduces some of the modulation
caused by a warped turntable.
Stereo In - Stereo Out

Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Left

Wet / Dry

Wet / Dry

High Damp Output Level

Pre LPF Resolution

EQ Trim

Pre EQ

EQ Trim

Pre EQ

Decimator

D-mod

Analog Record
Simulation

Sampling Frequency

LFO

Decimator
Resolution

High Damp Output Level

Wet / Dry

Pre LPF
Off, On
Selects whether the harmonic noise caused by a decrease in sampling frequency is generated or not

High Damp [%]


Sets the ratio of cut of the high range

0...100%

Sampling Freq (Sampling Frequency) [Hz]


Sets the sampling frequency
b

Right

Wet / Dry

Speed [RPM]
Sets the r.p.m. of a record

33 1/3, 45, 78

Flutter
Sets the modulation depth

0...100

Noise Density
Sets the noise density

0...100

Noise Tone
Sets the noise tone

0...100

Noise Level
Sets the noise level

0...100

1.00k...48.00kHz
c

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the sampling frequency
Amt
48.00k...+48.00kHz
Sets the modulation amount of the sampling frequency
LFO Frequency [Hz]
Sets the LFO speed

0.02...20.00Hz

Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

0...100

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the LFO modulation source of the sampling frequency

Resolution
Sets the data bit length
Output Level
Sets the output level

0...100

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the noise level

100...+100

Src
Selects the modulation source for the click noise level

Off...Tempo

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the click noise level

100...+100

EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

Q
Sets the EQ band width

0...100

0...100
300...10.00kHz
0.5...10.0

Src
Selects the modulation source for the output level

Off...Tempo

Gain [dB]
Sets the EQ gain

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the output level

100...+100

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Off...Tempo

Pre EQ Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the EQ center frequency

4...24

Src
Selects the modulation source for the noise level

Click Level
Sets the click noise level

20.00...+20.00Hz

Amt
100...+100
Sets the LFO modulation amount of the sampling frequency
e

Off...Tempo

Depth
Sets the depth of the sampling frequency LFO modulation
d

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

18.0...+18.0dB

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

100...+100

a: Pre LPF
If a sampler with a very low sampling frequency receives very
high-pitched sound that could not be heard during playback, it
could generate pitch noise that is unrelated to the original
sound. Set Pre LPF to ON to prevent this noise from being generated.
If you set the Sampling Freq to about 3kHz and set Pre LPF to
OFF, you can create a sound like a ring modulator.

e: Resolution, f: Output Level


If you set a smaller value for the Resolution parameter, the
sound may be distorted. The volume level may also be changed.
Use Output Level to adjust the level.

b: Flutter
This parameter enables you to set the depth of the modulation
caused by a warped turntable.

e: Click Level
This parameter enables you to set the level of the click noise that
occurs once every rotation of the turntable. This simulation
reproduces record noise, and the noise generated after the music
on a vinyl record finishes.

Appendix

Pre LPF
Right

340

Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.

017: Harmonic Chorus

Pitch/Phase Mod.

This effect applies chorus only to higher frequencies. This can be


used to apply a chorus effect to a bass sound without making the
sound thinner. You can also use this chorus block with feedback
as a flanger.

Pitch/phase modulation effects

016: Chorus

Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

This effect adds thickness and warmth to the sound by modulating the delay time of the input signal. You can add spread to the
sound by offsetting the phase of the left and right LFOs from
each other.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Low Level

Chorus/Flanger
High Damp
Feedback
High Damp

High/Low Split Point

Wet / Dry

High Level

High Level

Chorus/Flanger

Low Level

Right

Wet / Dry

Wet / Dry
LEQ

HEQ

LFO Phase

Chorus

LFO: Tri / Sine

EQ Trim

LEQ

HEQ

Chorus
EQ Trim

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Sine

LFO Phase [degree]


180...+180
Sets the LFO phase difference between the left and right Fx:010

Right
Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
LFO: Tri / Sine

LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed

Off...Tempo

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

LFO Phase [degree]


180...+180
Sets the LFO phase difference between the left and right Fx:010

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,

Triangle, Sine

0.02...20.00Hz

Fx:009,

0.02...20.00Hz

Fx:009,

Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

Off...Tempo
d

20.00...+20.00Hz

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed

MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009

 
 
 

Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed

x1...x16

L Pre Delay [msec]


Sets the delay time for the left channel

0.0...50.0msec

R Pre Delay [msec]


Sets the delay time for the right channel

0.0...50.0msec

0.0...50.0msec
0...100

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the LFO modulation depth

High/Low Split Point


1...100
Sets the frequency split point between the low and high range

Feedback
Sets the feed back amount of the chorus block

0...100

100...+100

h
High Damp [%]
Sets the high range damping amount of the chorus block

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the LFO modulation depth

EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

Pre Delay [msec]


Sets the delay time from the original sound

x1...x16

Fx:009

Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the LFO modulation depth

Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the LFO modulation depth
h

MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

Fx:009

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

 
 
 

Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009

BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
d

20.00...+20.00Hz

0...100%

Low Level
Sets the low range output level

0...100

High Level
Sets the high range (chorus) output level

0...100

i
0...100

Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

15.0...+15.0dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15.0...+15.0dB

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

i
j

Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010,
j

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

g: High/Low Split Point


This parameter sets the frequency that splits the high and low
range. Only the high range will be sent to the chorus block.

e: L Pre Delay [msec], f: R Pre Delay [msec]

h: Feedback

Setting the left and right delay time individually allows you to
control the stereo image.

Sets the feedback amount of the chorus block. Increasing the


feedback will allow you to use the effect as a flanger.

Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.

341

018: Multitap Cho/Delay

019: Ensemble

This effect has four chorus blocks with a different LFO phase.
You can create a complex stereo image by setting each blocks
delay time, depth, output level, and pan individually. You can
also fix some of the chorus blocks to combine the chorus and
delay effects.

This Ensemble effect has three chorus blocks that use LFO to
create subtle shimmering, and gives three dimensional depth
and spread to the sound, because the signal is output from the
left, right, and center.
Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Wet / Dry

Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In -Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry

Feedback

Tap1 Delay

Tap2 Delay
Tap3 Delay
Tap4 Delay

Right

Level

Pan

Level

Pan

Level

Pan

Level

Pan

0 [degree]
180 [degree]
90 [degree]
270 [degree]

Ensemble

Right
Wet / Dry
Shimmer

Wet / Dry

LFO

LFO: Triangle

LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

Speed
Sets the LFO speed

0.02...13.00Hz
a

Tap1(000) [msec]
Sets the Tap1 (LFO phase=0 degrees) delay time

0...570msec

Depth
Sets the Tap1 chorus depth

0...30

Level
Sets the Tap1 output level

0...30
b
L6...L1, C, R1...R6

Tap2(180) [msec]
Sets the Tap2 (LFO phase=180 degrees) delay time

c
0...30

Level
Sets the Tap2 output level

0...30
d

L6...L1, C, R1...R6

Depth
Sets the Tap3 chorus depth

0...30

Level
Sets the Tap3 output level

0...30

0...100

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the LFO modulation depth

Shimmer
Sets the amount of shimmering of the LFO waveform

0...100

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100

c: Shimmer
This parameter sets the amount of shimmering of the LFO waveform. Increasing this value adds more shimmering, making the
chorus effect more complex and richer.

L6...L1, C, R1...R6

Tap4(270) [msec]
Sets the Tap4 (LFO phase=270 degrees) delay time

100...+100

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

0...570msec

Pan
Sets the Tap3 stereo image

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Tap3(090) [msec]
Sets the Tap3 (LFO phase=90 degrees) delay time

Off...Tempo

Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the LFO modulation depth

0...570msec

Depth
Sets the Tap2 chorus depth

Pan
Sets the Tap2 stereo image

Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

Pan
Sets the Tap1 stereo image

1...100

0...570msec

Ensemble LFO
Level

Depth
Sets the Tap4 chorus depth

0...30

Level
Sets the Tap4 output level

0...30

Shimmer

Pan
Sets the Tap4 stereo image

L6...L1, C, R1...R6

Tap1 Feedback
Sets the Tap1 feedback amount
f

Time

100...+100

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of Tap1 feedback amount and effect balance
Amt
100...+100
Sets the Tap1 feedback amount and modulation amount
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

g
100...+100

Appendix

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

342

Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.

020: Flanger

b: LFO Shape

This effect gives a significant swell and movement of pitch to the


sound. It is more effective when applied to a sound with a lot of
harmonics. This is a stereo flanger. You can add spread to the
sound by offsetting the phase of the left and right LFOs from
each other.

Changing the LFO waveform shape controls the peak sweep of


flanging effects.
LFO Shape

LFO Shape = 0...100

LFO Shape = 0...+100

LFO Waveform=Sine

Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry

g: Feedback, h: Wet/Dry

Flanger
Feedback

The peak shape of the positive and negative Feedback value is


different. The harmonics will be emphasized when the effect
sound is mixed with the dry sound if you set a positive value for
both Feedback and Wet/Dry, and if you set a negative value
for both Feedback and Wet/Dry.

High Damp

Flanger
Right

Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
LFO: Tri / Sine

LFO Shape

g: High Damp [%]


a

Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time from the original sound

0.0...50.0msec

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Sine

This parameter sets the amount of damping of the feedback in


the high range. Increasing the value will cut high-range harmonics.

b
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
c

100...+100

021: Random Flanger

LFO Phase [degree]


180...+180
Sets the LFO phase difference between the left and right Fx:010
LFO Frequency [Hz]
Sets the LFO speed

The stereo effect uses a step-shape waveform and random LFO


for modulation, creating a unique flanging effect.

0.02...20.00Hz

Fx:009,

Stereo In - Stereo Out

Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

Off...Tempo

Left

Wet / Dry

Flanger

20.00...+20.00Hz

Feedback

BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
e

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

High Damp

Flanger
Right

MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009

Wet / Dry

LFO Phase
LFO: Step-Tri/Random

 
 
 

Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
f

x1...x16

Fx:009

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

LFO Phase [degree]


180...+180
Sets the LFO phase difference between the left and right Fx:010

100...+100

0...100%

LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010,
h

Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time from the original sound

0...100

g
High Damp [%]
Sets the feedback damping amount in the high range

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100
e

Step-Tri, Random
Fx:010

0.02...20.00Hz

Fx:010,

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source used for both LFO speed and step speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330

0.0...50.0msec

20.00...+20.00Hz

LFO Step Freq (Frequency) [Hz]


0.05...50.00Hz
Sets the LFO step speed (speed that changes in steps)
Fx:010,
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO step speed

50.00...+50.00Hz

BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
f

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

MIDI, 40...240

Fx:009, 010

 
 
 

Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed

 
 
 
 

Step Base Note
Selects the type of notes to specify the LFO step speed
Fx:010,
Times
Sets the number of notes to specify the LFO step speed

x1...x16

Fx:009

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

x1...x32

Fx:010

0...100

Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.

Feedback
Sets the feedback amount

100...+100
Fx:020

i
High Damp [%]
Sets the feedback damping amount in the high range

0...100%

When Sweep Mode = D-mod, the modulation source can control the flanger directly. Select the modulation source using the
Src parameter.

Fx:020

The effect is off when a value for the modulation source specified for the Src parameter is smaller than 64, and the effect is
on when the value is 64 or higher. The Envelope Generator is
triggered when the value changes from 63 or smaller to 64 or
higher.

Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010, 020,
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

d: EG Attack, d: EG Decay
Attack and Decay speed are the only adjustable parameters on
this EG.

022: Envelope Flanger


This Flanger uses an envelope generator for modulation. You
will obtain the same pattern of flanging each time you play. You
can also control the Flanger directly using the modulation
source.

023: Phaser
This effect creates a swell by shifting the phase. It is very effective
on electric piano sounds. You can add spread to the sound by
offsetting the phase of the left and right LFOs from each other.

Stereo In - Stereo Out

Stereo In - Stereo Out

Left

Left

Wet / Dry

Wet / Dry

Flanger

Phaser

Feedback

Resonance
High Damp

High Damp

Flanger

Phaser

Right

D-mod

EG Attack/Decay

EG

Right

Wet / Dry

D-mod

LFO: Tri / Sine

L Dly Bottom [msec] (L Delay Bottom)0.0...50.0msec


Sets the lower limit of the delay time on the left channel Fx:009

R Dly Bottom [msec] (R Delay Bottom)0.0...50.0msec


Sets the lower limit of the delay time on the right channel Fx:009

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

EG Attack
Sets the EG attack speed

Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

1...100

1...100

Feedback
Sets the feedback amount

100...+100
Fx:020

High Damp [%]0...100%


Sets the feedback damping amount in the high range Fx:020

Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
e

SrcOff...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on
page 330

x1...x16

Fx:009

Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied

0...100

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

0...100

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the LFO modulation depth
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the LFO modulation depth

100...+100

Resonance
Sets the resonance amount

100...+100

g
High Damp [%]
Sets the resonance damping amount in the high range

c: Sweep Mode, c: Src


This parameter switches the flanger control mode. With Sweep
Mode = EG, the flanger will sweep using the envelope generator. This envelope generator is included in the envelope flanger,
and not related to the Pitch EG, Filter EG, or Amp EG.
The Src parameter selects the source that starts the envelope
generator. If you select, for example, Gate, the envelope generator will start when the note-on message is received.

MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009

 
 
 

Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009

Wet/DryWet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet


Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on
page 330
010, 020,

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the
effect balance, on page 330

0.02...20.00Hz

Fx:009,

BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,

EG Decay
Sets the EG decay speed

100...+100
Fx:020

LFO Phase [degree]


180...+180
Sets the LFO phase difference between the left and right Fx:010
LFO Frequency [Hz]
Sets the LFO speed

SrcOff...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that triggers the EG (when EG is
selected for Sweep Mode), or modulation source that causes the
anger to sweep (when D-mod is selected for Sweep Mode)

Triangle, Sine

LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed

R Dly Top [msec] (R Delay Top)0.0...50.0msec


Sets the upper limit of the delay time on the right channel Fx:009
Sweep ModeEG, D-mod
Determines whether the anger is controlled by the envelope generator or by the modulation source,

LFO Shape

L Dly Top [msec] (L Delay Top)0.0...50.0msec


Sets the upper limit of the delay time on the left channel Fx:009

Wet / Dry
LFO Phase

Sweep Mode

0...100%

Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010,
h

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Appendix

343

344

Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.

g: Resonance, h: Wet/Dry
The peak shape of the positive and negative Feedback value is
different. The harmonics will be emphasized when the effect
sound is mixed with the dry sound, if you set a positive value for
both Resonance and Wet/Dry, and if you set a negative value
for both Resonance and Wet/Dry.

Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010, 023,
j

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

g: High Damp [%]


This parameter sets the amount of damping of the resonance in
the high range. Increasing the value will cut high-range harmonics.

024: Random Phaser

025: Envelope Phaser


This stereo phaser uses an envelope generator for modulation.
You will obtain the same pattern of phasing each time you play.
You can also control the Phaser directly using the modulation
source.

This is a stereo phaser. The effect uses a step-shape waveform


and random LFO for modulation, creating a unique phasing
effect.

Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry

Phaser

Stereo In - Stereo Out

Resonance

Left

Wet / Dry

High Damp

Phaser

Phaser
Right
Resonance

D-mod

D-mod

EG Attack/Decay

High Damp

Phaser

Wet / Dry

Sweep Mode
EG

Right
Wet / Dry
LFO Phase

L Manu Bottom (L Manual Bottom)


0...100
Sets the lower limit of the frequency range for the effect on the left channel

LFO: Step-Tri/Random

a
a

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

LFO Phase [degree]


180...+180
Sets the LFO phase difference between the left and right Fx:010

L Manu Top (L Manual Top)


0...100
Sets the upper limit of the frequency range for the effect on the left channel

Step-Tri, Step-Sin, Random


Fx:010

LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

Fx:009

0.02...20.00Hz

Fx:010,

20.00...+20.00Hz

LFO Step Freq (Frequency) [Hz]


Sets the LFO step speed

0.05...50.00Hz
Fx:010,

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO step speed

50.00...+50.00Hz

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

MIDI, 40...240
009, 010

 
 
 

Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed

x1...x32

Fx:010

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

0...100
100...+100
Fx:023
0...100%

Fx:023

EG Decay
Sets the EG decay speed

Fx:022

Resonance
Sets the resonance amount

High Damp [%]


Sets the resonance damping amount in the high range

0...100

High Damp [%]


Sets the resonance damping amount in the high range

Fx:022

1...100

1...100

100...+100
Fx:023
0...100%

Fx:023

Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010, 023,

Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied

Resonance
Sets the resonance amount

EG Attack
Sets the EG attack speed

x1...x16

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that triggers the EG (when EG is selected for
Sweep Mode), or modulation source that causes the anger to sweep
(when D-mod is selected for Sweep Mode)

Fx:009

Step Base Note


 
 
 
 

Selects the type of notes to specify the LFO step speed
Fx:010,
Times
Sets the number of notes to specify the LFO step speed

Sweep Mode
EG, D-mod
Determines whether the anger is controlled by the envelope generator or
by the modulation source
Fx:022,
c

BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,

R Manu Bottom (R Manual Bottom)


0...100
Sets the lower limit of the frequency range for the effect on the right channel
Fx:009
R Manu Top (R Manual Top)
0...100
Sets the upper limit of the frequency range for the effect on the right channel
Fx:009

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source commonly used for LFO speed and step
speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

Fx:009

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.

026: Biphase Mod.

345

027: Vibrato

(Biphase Modulation)
This stereo chorus effect adds two different LFOs together. You
can set the Frequency and Depth parameters for each LFO individually. Depending on the setting of these LFOs, very complex
waveforms will create an analog-type, unstable modulated
sound.

This effect causes the pitch of the input signal to shimmer. Using
the AutoFade allows you to increase or decrease the shimmering
speed.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Wet / Dry

Vibrato

Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry

Vibrato

Chorus/Flanger
High Damp
Right

Feedback

Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri / Sine

High Damp

Chorus/Flanger

AutoFade

LFO Shape
Fade-In Delay

LFO Frequency

Right
Wet / Dry
180 [degree]
LFO1: Tri / Sine

AUTOFADE Src
Selects the modulation source that starts AutoFade

LFO2: Tri / Sine

Off...Tempo
,

Fade-In Rate
Sets the rate of fade-in
LFO1 Waveform
Selects LFO1 waveform

Triangle, Sine

LFO2 Waveform
Selects LFO2 waveform

Triangle, Sine

LFO2 Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO2 speed

Off...Tempo

30.00...+30.00

Depth1
Sets the depth of LFO1 modulation
e

L Pre Delay [msec]


Sets the delay time for the left channel

0.0...50.0msec
Fx:016

R Pre Delay [msec]


Sets the delay time for the right channel

0.0...50.0msec
Fx:016

Bi-Phase Modulation LFO

LFO1
Depth1
LFO2
Depth2

0...100

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the LFO modulation depth
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the LFO modulation depth
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

x1...x16

Fx:009

0...100%

Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010,
j

100...+100
Fx:017

High Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the high range

MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of LFO2 modulation depth

Feedback
Sets the feedback amount

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed

0...100

20.00...+20.00Hz

 
 
 

Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009

Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of LFO1 modulation depth
Depth2
Sets the depth of LFO2 modulation

Off...Tempo

BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,

0...100

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of LFO1&2 modulation depth

0.02...20.00Hz

Fx:009,

Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

100...+100
Fx:020

LFO Frequency Mod


D-mod, AUTOFADE
Switches between D-mod and AUTOFADE for the LFO frequency modulation

LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

30.00...+30.00
0.02...30.00Hz

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO2 speed

Triangle, Sine

LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
d

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO1 speed

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

0.02...30.00Hz

Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO1&2 speed

00...2000msec

LFO Phase Sw
0 degree, 180 degree
Switches the LFO phase difference between left and right
LFO1 Frequency [Hz]
Sets the LFO1 speed

Fade-In Delay [msec]


Sets the fade-in delay time

100...+100

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

d: LFO Frequency Mod, a: AUTOFADE Src, a: Fade-In Rate


b: Fade-In Delay [msec]
When LFO Frequency Mod is set to AUTOFADE, you can use the
modulation source selected in AUTO FADE Src as a trigger to
automatically fade in the modulation amount. When BPM/MIDI
Sync is set to On, you cannot use this.
The Fade-in Rate parameter specifies the rate of fade-in. The
Fade-in Delay parameter determines the time from AutoFade
modulation source ON until the fade-in starts.
The following is an example of fade-in where the LFO speed is
increased from 1.0Hz to 4.0Hz when a note-on message is
received.
AUTOFADE Src=Gate1, LFO Frequency [Hz]=1.0

Appendix

1...100

346

Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.

LFO Frequency Mod=AUTOFADE, Amt=3.0


The effect is off when a value for the dynamic modulation
source specified for the AUTOFADE Src parameter is smaller
than 64, and the effect is on when the value is 64 or higher. The
AutoFade function is triggered when the value changes from 63
or smaller to 64 or higher.
AUTOFADE

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

029: 2-Voice Resonator

All Note Off

Note On

AUTOFADE

AutoFade

AUTOFADE Src=Gate1
LFO Frequency[Hz]=1.0
LFO Freq. Mod=AUTOFADE
Amt=+3.0

Gate1 Signal

Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010, 020,

This effect resonates the input signal at a specified pitch. You can
set the pitch, output level, and pan settings for two resonators
individually. You can control the resonance intensity via an LFO.

LFO Frequency
=1.0+3.0=4.0Hz

Fade-In Rate
Fade-In Dealy

LFO Frequency
=1.0Hz

Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

028: Auto Fade Mod.

Wet / Dry

High Damp

(Auto Fade Modulation)

Resonator

Trim

This stereo chorus/flanger effect enables you to control the LFO


speed and effect balance using auto fade, and you can spread the
sound by offsetting the phase of the left and right LFOs from
each other.

Level

Pan

Level

Pan

Resonance

Resonator

Trim

High Damp

Right
Wet / Dry

D-mod

Invert: On/Off
Pitch, Fine [cent]

LFO

Stereo In - Stereo Out

Control Mode

Left

Manual

Wet / Dry

Delay

Control Mode
Switches the controls of resonance intensity

Feedback
High Damp

Delay

Right

Manual, LFO, D-mod


,

LFO/D-mod Invert
Off, On
Reverses the Voice 1 and 2 control when LFO/D-mod is selected

Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
LFO: Tri / Sine

LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

LFO Shape

AutoFade

LFO Frequency

Wet / Dry

D-mod Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that controls resonance intensity

AUTOFADE Src
Selects the modulation source that starts AutoFade
a

Rate
Sets the rate of fade-in

Mod. Depth
100...+100
Sets the amount of resonance intensity control via LFO/D-mod

Off...Tempo
c

Fx:027,
1...100

Fx:027

Fade-In Dly (Fade-In Delay) [msec]


Sets the fade-in delay time

00...2000msec
Fx:027

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed

LFO Frequency Mod


D-mod, AUTOFADE
Switches between D-mod and AUTOFADE for the LFO frequency modulation
Fx:027

Voice1: Resonance
100...+100
Sets the intensity of resonance when Control Mode = Manual

Voice1: Level
Sets the Voice1 output level

0...100

Pan
Sets the Voice1 stereo image

L6...R6

Voice2: Pitch
Sets the Voice2 Pitch for resonance

C0...B8

Fine [cent]
Fine-adjusts the voice 2 pitch for resonance

Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz
h

L Delay Time [msec]


Sets the left channel delay time

0.0...500.0msec

R Delay Time [msec]


Sets the right channel delay time

0.0...500.0msec

h
High Damp [%]
Sets the feedback damping amount in the high range

50...+50

Voice2: Resonance
100...+100
Sets the intensity of resonance when Control Mode = Manual

High Damp [%]


0...100%

Sets the damping amount of resonant sound in the high range


Voice2: Level
Sets the Voice2 output level

0...100

Pan
Sets the Voice2 stereo image

L6...R6

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount

50...+50

C0...B8

0.02...20.00Hz

Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

Voice1: Pitch
Sets the voice1 Pitch for resonance

High Damp [%]


0...100%
Sets the damping amount of resonant sound in the high range

LFO Phase [degree]


180...+180
Sets the LFO phase difference between the left and right Fx:010

LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

0...100

Fine [cent]
Fine-adjusts the voice 1 pitch for resonance

100...+100
Fx:020

Trim
Sets the input level at the resonator

Triangle, Sine

0.02...20.00Hz

0...200

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

100...+100
Fx:020
0...100%

Fx:020

Wet/Dry Mod
D-mod, AUTOFADE
Switches between D-mod and AUTOFADE for the effect balance modulation
Fx:027

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.

This parameter determines the resonance intensity.


When Control Mode = Manual, the Resonance parameter
sets the intensity of resonance. If the Resonance parameter has
a negative value, harmonics will be changed, and resonance will
occur at a pitch one octave lower.
When Control Mode = LFO, the intensity of resonance varies
according to the LFO. The LFO sways between positive and negative values, causing resonance to occur between specified pitches
an octave apart in turn.
When Control Mode = D-mod, the resonance is controlled by
the dynamic modulation source. If JS X is assigned as the modulation source, the pitch an octave higher and lower can be controlled, similar to when LFO is selected for Control Mode.

030: Doppler
This effect simulates the Doppler effect of a moving sound
with a changing pitch, similar to the siren of an passing ambulance. Mixing the effect sound with the dry sound will create a
unique chorus effect.
Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

d: Voice1: Pitch, d: Fine [cent], g: Voice2: Pitch, g: Fine


[cent]
The Pitch parameter specifies the pitch of resonance by note
name. The Fine parameter allows for fine adjustment in steps
of cents.

Pan Depth

Right

Wet / Dry
LFO

D-mod

a: LFO/D-mod Invert
When Control Mode = LFO or D-mod, the controlled phase of
either Voice 1 or 2 will be reversed. When the resonance pitch is
set for Voice 1 (Resonance has a positive value), Voice 2 will resonate at a pitch an octave below (Resonance has a negative value).

Doppler

Wet / Dry

Trigger

LFO Mode = 1-Shot

LFO Mode
Switches LFO operation mode
a

Loop, 1-Shot
,

Src
Off...Tempo
When LFO Mode is set to 1-Shot, this modulation source triggers the LFO

LFO Sync
Off, On
Switches between LFO reset on and off when LFO Mode is set to Loop
LFO Frequency [Hz]
Sets the LFO speed

e: High Damp [%], h: High Damp [%]

Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

This parameter sets the damping amount of resonant sound in


the high range. Lower values will make a metallic sound with a
higher range of harmonics.

0.02...20.00Hz

Fx:009,

Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz

BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
d

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009

 
 
 

Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
Pitch Depth
Sets the pitch variation of the moving sound
e

x1...x16

Fx:009
,

0...100

Src
Selects the modulation source of pitch variation

Off...Tempo

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of pitch variation

100...+100

Pan Depth
Sets the panning of the moving sound

100...+100
,

Src
Selects the modulation source of panning

Off...Tempo

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of panning

100...+100

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

a: LFO Mode, a: Src, b: LFO Sync


The LFO Mode parameter switches LFO operation mode. When
Loop is selected, the Doppler effect will be created repeatedly. If
LFO Sync is set to On, the LFO will be reset when the modulation source specified with the Src parameter is turned on.
When LFO Mode is set to 1-Shot, the Doppler effect is created
only once when the modulation source specified in the Src field
is turned on. At this time if you do not set the Src parameter,
the Doppler effect will not be created, and no effect sound will
be output.

Appendix

a: Control Mode, e: Voice1: Resonance, h: Voice2:


Resonance

347

348

Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.

The effect is off when a value for the modulation source specified for the Src parameter is smaller than 64, and the effect is
on when the value is 64 or higher. The Doppler effect is triggered when the value changes from 63 or smaller to 64 or
higher.

e: Pitch Depth
With the Doppler effect, the pitch is raised when the sound
approaches, and the pitch is lowered when the sound goes away.
This parameter sets this pitch variation.

a: Scratch Source, b: Response


The Scratch Source parameter enables you to select the modulation source that controls simulation. The value of the modulation
source corresponds to the playback position. The Response
parameter enables you to set the speed of the response to the
modulation source.
Scratch Source
Start

Playback Position

End

Recorded Sound

f: Pan Depth
This parameter sets the width of the stereo image of the effect
sound. With larger values, the sound seems to come and go from
much further away. With positive values, the sound moves from
left to right; with negative values, the sound moves from right to
left.
Doppler - Pitch / Pan Depth

Higher

Pitch
Pan Depth
= (+) value

Pitch Depth

Lower

Center

Left

Right

Pan Depth
<

<

<

< < <<<<<< >>>>>> > >

Louder

Volume

>

>

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry

Scratch

Direct
Mix

Scratch

Right
D-mod
Envelope Control
Input
Envelope Select

Wet / Dry

D-mod

D-mod

Scratch Source
Selects the modulation source for simulation control

Response
Sets the speed of the response to the Scratch Source

Off...Tempo
,
0...100

Envelope Select
D-mod, Input
Selects whether the start and end of recording is controlled via the modula,
tion source or the input signal level
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that controls recording when Envelope Select
is set to D-mod

Threshold
0...100
Sets the recording start level when Envelope Select is set to Input

Response
Sets the speed of the response to the end of recording

Direct Mix
Always On, Always Off, Cross Fade
Selects how a dry sound is mixed

0...100

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Zero

Zero

+ Max

+ Max

c: Envelope Select, c: Src, d: Threshold

e: Response

This effect is applied by recording the input signal and moving


the modulation source. It simulates the sound of scratches you
can make using a turntable.

Rec Control

JS+Y
JSY
etc

Scratch!
Max

>

Louder

031: Scratch

JS X
Ribbon

When Envelope Select is set to D-mod, the input signal will be


recorded only when the modulation source value is 64 or higher.
When Envelope Select is set to Input, the input signal will be
recorded only when its level is over the Threshold value.
The maximum recording time is 1365msec. If this is exceeded, the
recorded data will start being erased from the top.

Pan Depth
= () value

Original Pitch

Scratch Source

D-mod

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

This parameter enables you to set the speed of the response to


the end of recording. Set a smaller value when you are recording
a phrase or rhythm pattern, and set a higher value if you are
recording only one note.

f: Direct Mix
With Always On, a dry sound is usually output. With Always Off,
dry sounds are not output. With Cross Fade, a dry sound is usually
output, and it is muted only when scratching.
Set Wet/Dry to Wet to use this parameter effectively.

349

Effects
Mod./P.Shift

a:LFO Waveform

Mod./P.Shift

This parameter selects the LFO waveform. Vintage wave simulates the characteristics of the tremolo created on a guitar amplifier. Combining this effect with the Amp Simulation will make a
realistic, vintage tremolo amplifier sound.

Other modulation and pitch shift effects

Tremolo - LFO Waveform

032: Tremolo

Triangle

This effect modulates the volume level of the input signal. The
effect is stereo, and offsetting the LFO of the left and right phases
from each other produces a tremolo effect between left and
right.

Wet / Dry

LFO Shape

This effect uses the input signal level to modulate a stereo tremolo. You can simulate a tremolo effect that becomes deeper as it
fades out while the level gets lower.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Triangle, Sine, Vintage, Up, Down

LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed

Tremolo

100...+100
Fx:020

LFO Phase [degree]


180...+180
Sets the LFO phase difference between the left and right

LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

Tremolo
Right

0.02...20.00Hz

Fx:009,

Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

LFO Phase
LFO: Tri/Sin/Vintage

Wet / Dry

LFO Shape

Off...Tempo
+

Envelope

20.00...+20.00Hz

BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed

0...100

a
Envelope Shape
Sets the envelope curve shape of the input signal
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

100...+100

Triangle, Sine, Vintage

b
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed

x1...x16
Fx:009

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

Envelope Shape
Envelope Sens

Envelope Sens (Envelope Sensitivity)


Sets the envelope sensitivity of the input signal

MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009

 
 
 

Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009

0...100

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the depth of modulation

100...+100
Fx:020

LFO Phase [degree]


180...+180
Sets the LFO phase difference between the left and right Fx:032
LFO Frequency [Hz]
Sets the LFO speed

0.02...20.00Hz

Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the depth of modulation

Envelope Amount [Hz]


20.00...+20.00Hz
Sets the changes of the LFO speed according to the input signal level

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
e

Wet / Dry

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

0...100

Envelope Amount
100...+100
Sets the changes of the modulation depth according to the input signal level

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

100...+100

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Appendix

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

b: LFO Phase [degree]

033: Envelope Tremolo

LFO Phase

Down

Tremolo

Wet / Dry

Right

Up

Tremolo

Left

Vintage

This parameter determines the difference between the left and


right LFO phases. A higher value will simulate the auto-pan effect
in which the sound is panned between left and right.

Stereo In - Stereo Out

LFO: Tri/Sin/Vintage/Up/Down

Sine

350

Effects
Mod./P.Shift

d: LFO Frequency [Hz], d: Envelope Amount [Hz],


e: Depth, e: Envelope Amount

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

These parameters set the modulation via an envelope (input signal level).
The LFO speed is obtained by adding the LFO Frequency
value to the Envelope Amount value multiplied by the input
signal. The LFO modulation depth is obtained by adding the
Depth value to the Envelope Amount value multiplied by the
input signal level.

The following example indicates that the Depth is 0


with an LFO Frequency of 1.0Hz and the maximum
input, and that the Depth is 100 with a Frequency of
8.0Hz with zero input.

LFO Frequency [Hz]=8.0, Envelope Amount [Hz]=7.0


Depth=100, Envelope Amount=100

Louder

Dry Envelope

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

LFO Frequency[Hz]=8.0
Envelope Amount[Hz]= 7.0Hz
Depth=100
Envelope Amount= 100

a: LFO Shape
You can change the panning curve by modifying the LFO waveform.

b: LFO Phase

Stereo Auto Pan - LFO Phase

Time

LFO Phase = 90 degrees

LFO Phase = 0 degrees

L-In

L-In

034: Auto Pan

L-In

L-In

R-In

R-In

R-In

R-In

Pan
Depth

Pan
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
LFO: Tri / Sin

LFO Shape

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Sine

a
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
b

LFO Phase [degree]


180...+180
Sets the LFO phase difference between the left and right

LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

100...+100

0.02...20.00Hz

Fx:009,

Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz

BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
d

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009

 
 
 

Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed

x1...x16

Fx:009

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
e

0...100

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the depth of modulation
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the depth of modulation

100...+100

L-In

L-In

L-In

Left

R-In

R-In

R-In

L-In

L-In

Wet / Dry

R-In

R-In

R-In
L-In

Stereo In - Stereo Out

R-In
L-In

L-In

L-In

This Auto Pan effect pans sound between left and right. It is stereo, and shifting the left and right LFO phases from each other
will simulate the sound of the left and right channels crossing
over each other by turns, or chasing each other.

LFO Phase = 180 degrees


L-In

R-In

R-In

Left

100...+100

This parameter determines the difference in the left and right


LFO phases. When you change the value gradually from 0, the
sound from the left and right channels will chase each other
around. If you set the parameter to +180 or 180, the sound from
each channel will cross over each other.
You need to input different sounds to each channel in order for
this parameter to be effective.

Shimmer
Level

Right
Center
Output Stereo Image

R-In

L-In
R-In

Effects
Mod./P.Shift

351

035: Phaser - Tremolo

f: Phaser WetDry, i: Wet/Dry

This effect has a stereo phaser and tremolo LFOs linked together.
Swelling phaser modulation and tremolo effects synchronize
with each other, creating a soothing modulation effect. It is suitable for electric piano type sounds.

The Phaser Wet/Dry parameter sets the balance between the


phaser output and the dry sound. The Wet/Dry parameter sets
the balance between the final phaser and tremolo output level
and the dry sound.

036: Ring Modulator

Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry

Phaser

This effect creates a metallic sound by applying the oscillators to


the input signal. Use the LFO or Dynamic Modulation to modulate the oscillator to create a radical modulation. Matching the
oscillator frequency with a note number will produce a ring
modulation effect in specific key ranges.

Tremolo
Phaser Wet / Dry

Resonance
Phaser Wet / Dry

Tremolo

Phaser
Right

Wet / Dry
LFO Type
LFO

Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

LFO Shape
LFO Phase

Wet / Dry
Pre LPF

Ring Modulator

Type:
Phs - Trml...Phs LR - Trml LR
Selects the type of the tremolo and phaser LFOs

LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed
b

Pre LPF

LFO Phase [degree]


180...+180
Sets the phase difference between the tremolo and phaser LFOs

Note No.

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

Note Offset, Fine


Note (Key Follow)

Pre LPF
0...100
Sets the damping amount of the high range input to the ring modulator

OSC Mode
Fixed, Note (Key Follow)
Switching between specifying the oscillator frequency and using a note
number

MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009

x1...x16

Fixed Frequency [Hz]


0...12.00kHz
Sets the oscillator frequency when OSC Mode is set to Fixed
,
c

Fx:009

Phaser Manual
Sets the phaser frequency range

0...100

Resonance
Sets the phaser resonance amount

100...+100

Phaser Depth
Sets the phaser modulation depth

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the oscillator frequency when OSC Mode
is set to Fixed
Amt
12.00...+12.00kHz
Sets the modulation amount of the oscillator frequency when OSC Mode is
set to Fixed

0...100
d

Note Offset
48...+48
Sets the pitch difference from the original note when OSC Mode is set to
Note (Key Follow)

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the phaser modulation depth

Note Fine
Fine-adjusts the oscillator frequency

Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount for the phaser modulation depth

LFO Frequency [Hz]


0.02...20.00Hz
Sets the LFO speed of the oscillator frequency modulation
Fx:009,

Phaser Wet/Dry
Wet...2:99, Dry, 2:99...Wet
Sets the balance between the phaser effect and dry sounds

Tremolo Shape
Sets the degree of the tremolo LFO shaping

100...+100
Fx:020

Tremolo Depth
Sets the tremolo modulation depth

20.00...+20.00Hz

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330

MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009

x1...x16

Fx:009

LFO Depth
0...100
Sets the depth of LFO modulation for the oscillator frequency

100...+100

Select the type of phaser LFO and tremolo LFO for the Type
parameter. How the effect sound moves or rotates depends on
the type of LFO. Selecting LFO Phase enables you to offset the
timing of the phaser peak and control a subtle movement and
rotation of the sound.

Off...Tempo

 
 
 

Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
,

a: Type, a: LFO Phase [degree]

BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the tremolo modulation depth

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

0...100

Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the tremolo modulation depth

Sine Oscillator
OSC Mode Pitch

20.00...+20.00Hz

Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed

Fixed

LFO

Off...Tempo

 
 
 

Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009

Wet / Dry

Fixed Frequency

BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
c

Right

0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,

Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

Ring Modulator

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the depth of modulation
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the depth of modulation

Appendix

352

Effects
Mod./P.Shift

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

d: Input Level Dmod [%], d: Src


This parameter sets the dynamic modulation of the input level.
Input Level D-mod

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330

Input Level

Input Level

x1.0

x1.0

Amt= +50

Amt= 50

Amt= +100

Amt= 100

Louder

100...+100
Louder

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

x0.5

D-mod

Higher

a: Pre LPF

Zero

This parameter enables you to set the damping amount of the


high range sound input to the ring modulator. If the input sound
contains lots of harmonics, the effect may sound dirty. In this
case, cut a certain amount of high range.

b: OSC Mode
This parameter determines whether or not the oscillator frequency follows the note number.

x0.5

D-mod

Higher
Zero

Max

Max

038: Pitch Shifter


This effect changes the pitch of the input signal. You can select
from three types: Fast (quick response), Medium, and Slow (preserves tonal quality). You can also create an effect in which the
pitch is gradually raised (or dropped) using the delay with feedback.

c: Fixed Frequency [Hz]

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry

This parameter sets the oscillator frequency when OSC Mode is


set to Fixed.

Input Level
High Damp

d: Note Offset, d: Note Fine

Pitch Shifter

Delay
Pre

These parameters for the oscillator are used when OSC Mode is
set to Note (Key Follow). The Note Offset sets the pitch difference from the original note in semitone steps. The Note Fine
parameter fine-adjusts the pitch in cent steps. Matching the oscillator frequency with the note number produces a ring modulation effect in the correct key.

Input Level

Post

Feedback Position

Feedback

Right

037: Detune
b

Using this effect, you can obtain a detune effect that offsets the
pitch of the effect sound slightly from the pitch of the input signal. Compared to the chorus effect, a more natural sound thickness will be created.

Mode
Switches Pitch Shifter mode

Wet / Dry

Slow, Medium, Fast

Pitch Shift [1/2tone]


Sets the pitch shift amount by steps of a semitone

24...+24
,

Src
Selects the modulation source of pitch shift amount

Off...Tempo
24...+24

Fine [cent]
Sets the pitch shift amount by steps of a cent

100...+100cent
,

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of pitch shift amount

100...+100cent

c
Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Wet / Dry

Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time

Feedback Position
Switches the feedback connection.

Input Level
High Damp

Detune

Delay
Feedback

Input Level

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the pitch shift
b

Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount

0...1000msec
100...+100
0...100%

Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level

Off...Tempo

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100

100...+100

Fx:037,

Off...Tempo
Fx:037

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

100...+100cent

100...+100
,

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

0...100%

Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level

Off...Tempo

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Input Level Dmod [%]


Sets the modulation amount of the input level

100...+100cent

Input Level Dmod [%]


Sets the modulation amount of the input level
d

100...+100

High Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the high range

c
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range

Pre, Post

Wet / Dry

Src
Selects the modulation source of the pitch shift

0...1000msec

Feedback
Sets the feedback amount

Right

Pitch Shift [cent]


Sets the pitch difference from the input signal

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of pitch shift amount

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

a: Mode
This parameter switches the pitch shifter operating mode. With
Slow, tonal quality will not be changed too much. With Fast, the
effect becomes a Pitch Shifter that has a quick response, but may
change the tone. Medium is in between these two. If you do not
need to set too much pitch shift amount, set this parameter to
Slow. If you wish to change the pitch significantly, use Fast.

Effects
Mod./P.Shift

353

b: Pitch Shift [1/2tone], b: Src, b: Amt, c: Fine [cent], c: Amt

a: Pitch Shift [cent], e: Depth

The amount of pitch shift will use the value of the Pitch Shift
plus the Fine value. The amount of modulation will use the c:
Amt value plus d: Amt.
Modulation Source is used both for Pitch Shift and Fine.

These parameters set the amount of pitch shift and amount of


modulation by means of the LFO.
Pitch Shift Mod - Pitch Shift / Depth
Pitch
LFO Waveform=Triangle
Depth (+value)

Higher

e: Feedback Position, f: Feedback

Pitch Shift (+ value)

Original Pitch
Lower

When Feedback Position is set to Pre, the pitch shifter output is


again input to the pitch shifter. Therefore, if you specify a higher
value for the Feedback parameter, the pitch will be raised (or
lowered) more and more each time feedback is repeated.
If Feedback Position is set to Post, the feedback signal will not
pass through the pitch shifter again. Even if you specify a higher
value for the Feedback parameter, the pitch-shifted sound will be
repeated at the same pitch.

LFO Waveform=Square
Depth (value)

f: Pan, g: Wet/Dry
The Pan parameter pans the effect sound and dry sound to the
left and right. With L, the effect sound is panned left, and the dry
sound is panned right. With a Wet/Dry = Wet setting, the effect
and dry sound will be output in a proportion of 1:1.

039: Pitch Shift Mod.


(Pitch Shift Modulation)

040: Rotary Speaker

This effect modulates the detuned pitch shift amount using an


LFO, adding a clear spread and width to the sound by panning
the effect sound and dry sound to the left and right. This is especially effective when the effect sound and dry sound output from
stereo speakers are mixed.

This effect simulates a rotary speaker, and obtains a more realistic sound by simulating the rotor in the low range and the horn
in the high range separately. The effect also simulates the stereo
microphone settings.
Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Wet / Dry

Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Horn

Wet / Dry

+
+

Rotary Speaker

Pitch Shifter

Horn/Rotor
Balance

Mic Distance
Mic Spread

Rotor
Speaker Simulation
Right

Pan
Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri / Sqr

Pitch Shift [cent]


Sets the pitch difference from the input signal

100...+100cent

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Square

LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed

a
0.02...20.00Hz
Off...Tempo

Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed

Fx:009

Depth
Sets the LFO modulation depth for pitch shift amount

100...+100
,

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
,
g

100...+100

Horn Ratio
Stop, 0.50...2.00
Adjusts the (high-range side) horn rotation speed. Standard value is 1.00.
Selecting Stop will stop the rotation
Rotor Acceleration
0...100
Determines how quickly the rotor rotation speed in the low range is switched
e

Rotor Ratio
Stop, 0.50...2.00
Adjusts the (low-range side) rotor rotation speed. Standard value is 1.00.
Selecting Stop will stop the rotation
f

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

Manual Speed Ctrl (Manual Speed Control)


Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source in case the rotation speed is changed directly
,

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the depth of modulation

Pan
L, 1:99...99:1, R
Sets the panning effect sound and dry sound separately

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that toggles between slow and fast

Horn Acceleration
0...100
How quickly the horn rotation speed in the high range is switched

x1...x16

Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the depth of modulation
f

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that toggles between rotation and stop

Sw
Toggle, Moment
Selects switching mode of the modulation source that toggles between slow
and fast

MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009

 
 
 

Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009

Rotate, Stop

Speed Switch
Slow, Fast
Switches the speaker rotation speed between slow and fast

20.00...+20.00Hz

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

Manual Speed Control

Sw
Toggle, Moment
Selects switching mode of the modulation source that toggles between rotation and stop

Fx:009,

BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,

Speed Switch: Slow/Fast

Mode Switch
Switches between speaker rotation and stop

Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed

Mode Switch: Rotate/Stop

Appendix

Wet / Dry

D
D-mod
D-mod
-mod

Right

Horn/Rotor Balance
Rotor, 1...99, Horn
Sets the level balance between the high-range horn and low-range rotor
Mic Distance
0...100
Sets the distance between the microphone and rotary speaker

Mic Spread
Sets the angle of left and right microphones

0...100

354

Effects
ER/Delay

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

a: Sw
This parameter sets how the modulation source switches
between rotation and stop.
When Sw = Toggle, the speaker rotates or stops alternately
each time you press the pedal or operate the joystick.

ER/Delay
Early reflection and delay effects

041: Early Reflections


This effect is only the early reflection part of a reverberation
sound, and adds presence to the sound. You can select one of the
four decay curves.
Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Wet / Dry

Each time the value for the modulation source exceeds 64, the
speaker rotates or stops alternately.

EQ Trim
LEQ

When Sw = Moment, the speaker is rotating. It stops only


when you press the pedal or operate the joystick.

When Sw = Moment, the speed is usually slow. It becomes fast


only when you press the pedal or operate the joystick.

Wet / Dry

Type
Sharp, Loose, Modulated, Reverse
Selects the decay curve for the early reection

ER Time [msec]
Sets the time length of early reection

Pre Delay [msec]


0...200msec
Sets the time taken from the original sound to the rst early reection

EQ Trim
Sets the input level of EQ applied to the effect sound

10...800msec

0...100

Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

15.0...+15.0dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15.0...+15.0dB

When a value for the modulation source is less than 64, slow
speed is selected, and when the value is 64 or higher, fast is
selected.

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

c: Manual Speed Ctrl


If you wish to control the speaker rotation speed manually, not
switching between Slow and Fast, select the modulation source in
the Manual Speed Ctrl field. If manual control is not necessary,
set this field to Off.

Early Reflections

EQ Trim

b: Sw

Slow/fast will alternate each time the value of the modulation


source exceeds 64.

Pre Delay

Right

Rotation will occur when the value of the modulation source is


less than 64, and will stop when the value is 64 or greater.

This parameter sets how the rotation speed (slow and fast) is
switched via the modulation source.
When Sw = Toggle, the speed is switched between slow and
fast each time you press the pedal or operate the joystick.

HEQ

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

d: Horn Acceleration, e: Rotor Acceleration

a: Type

On a real rotary speaker, the rotation speed is accelerated or


decelerated gradually after you switch the speed. The Horn
Acceleration parameter sets the speed at which the rotation is
accelerated or decelerated.

This parameter selects the decay curve for the early reflection.
Early Reflections - Type

Sharp

g: Mic Distance, g: Mic Spread


This is a simulation of stereo microphone settings.

Loose

Rotary Speaker - Mic Placement


Mic Spread

Microphone

Microphone
Modulated

Mic Distance

Mic Distance

Reverse

Dry

Rotary Speaker (Top View)

Pre Delay

ER Time

Effects
ER/Delay

042: Auto Reverse


This effect records the input signal and automatically plays it in
reverse (the effect is similar to a tape reverse sound).
Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Wet / Dry

Direct
Mix

Auto Reverse

This multitap delay outputs three Tap signals to the left, right,
and center respectively. You can also adjust the left and right
spread of the delay sound.

Right

Wet / Dry

D-mod
Envelope Control

Input

When Envelope Select is set to D-mod, the input signal will be


recorded only when the value of the modulation source selected
by the Src parameter is 64 or higher.
When Envelope Select is set to Input, the input signal will be
recorded only when its level exceeds the Threshold level.
When recording is completed, reverse playback starts immediately.

043: L/C/R Delay

Rec/Reverse Play
Control

-mod

355

Envelope Select

Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In -Stereo Out


Left

a
b

Rec Mode
Sets the recording mode

Reverse Time [msec]


Sets the maximum duration of the reverse playback

Input Level D-mod

20...1320msec

Envelope Select
D-mod, Input
Selects whether the start and end of recording is controlled via the modulation source or the input signal level
,

Threshold
0...100
Sets the recording start level when Envelope Select is set to Input

Response
Sets the speed of the response to the end of recording

Direct Mix
Always On, Always Off, Cross Fade
Selects how a dry sound is mixed
Fx:031

High Damp Low Damp

L Delay
Level

C Delay

Spread
Level

Feedback
Input Level D-mod

R Delay
Level

Right
Wet / Dry

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that controls recording when Envelope Select
is set to D-mod

Wet / Dry

Single, Multi

L Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time of TapL

0...1360msec

a
Level
Sets the output level of TapL

0...100

Fx:031

0...50

C Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time of TapC

0...1360msec

b
Level
Sets the output level of TapC

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

0...50

R Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time of TapR

0...1360msec

c
g

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330

Level
Sets the output level of TapR

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

Feedback (C Delay)
Sets the feedback amountof TapC

100...+100
d

a: Rec Mode, b: Reverse Time

0...50
100...+100

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the TapC feedback amount
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the TapC feedback amount

When Rec Mode is set to Single, you can set up to 1320msec for
Reverse Time. If recording starts during the reverse playback,
the playback will be interrupted.
When Rec Mode is set to Multi, you can make another recording during the reverse playback. However, the maximum Reverse
Time is limited to 660msec.
If you wish to record a phrase or rhythm pattern, set Rec Mode
to Single. If you record only one note, set Rec Mode to Multi.
The Reverse Time parameter specifies the maximum duration
of the reverse playback. The part in excess of this limit will not be
played in reverse. If you wish to add short pieces of the reverse
playback of single notes, make the Reverse Time shorter.

High Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the high range

0...100%

Low Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the low range

0...100%

Input Level Dmod [%]


Sets the modulation amount of the input level
f

100...+100
Fx:037,

Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
g

Spread
Sets the width of the stereo image of the effect sound

Off...Tempo
Fx:037
0...50

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Rec Mode/Reverse Time


Rec

Reverse Rec

Reverse Envelope Select = Input

Input
Time

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Rec Mode = Single

These parameters set the damping amount of high range and


low range. The tone of the delayed sound becomes darker and
lighter as it feeds back.

Rec Mode = Multi

Reverse Time

Reverse Time

c: Envelope Select, c: Src, d: Threshold


These parameters select the source to control the start and end of
recording.

g: Spread
This parameter sets the pan width of the effect sound. The stereo
image is widest with a value of 50, and the effect sound of both
channels is output from the center with a value of 0.

Appendix

e: High Damp [%], e: Low Damp [%]

356

Effects
ER/Delay

044: Cross Delay

045: Multitap Delay

This is a stereo delay, and can by used as a cross-feedback delay


effect in which the delay sounds cross over between the left and
right by changing the feedback routing.

The left and right Multitap Delays have two taps respectively.
Changing the routing of feedback and tap output allows you to
create various patterns of complex effect sounds.
Stereo In - Stereo Out

Stereo In - Stereo Out

Left

Left

Wet / Dry

Wet / Dry
High Damp Low Damp
Input Level D-mod

Feedback

Delay

Delay
Input Level D-mod

Stereo/Cross

Feedback

Spread
Input Level D-mod

High Damp Low Damp

Input Level D-mod

Delay

High Damp Low Damp (1)


Mode
Tap1 Level
High Damp Low Damp

(2)
Mode

(1)

Delay

Tap1=(1)
Tap2=(2)

Spread

(2)

Stereo/Cross
Feedback

Right

Right

Wet / Dry

Wet / Dry

Mode: Normal

Stereo/Cross
Stereo, Cross
Switches between stereo delay and cross-feedback delay

L Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time for the left channel

0.0...680.0msec

R Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time for the right channel

0.0...680.0msec

L Feedback
Sets the feedback amount for the left channel
d

100...+100

Src
Selects the modulation source of feedback amount

Off...Tempo

Amt L
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the left channel feedback
R Feedback
Sets the feedback amount for the right channel

Amt R
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the right channel feedback
f

High Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the high range

0...100%
Fx:043

Low Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the low range

0...100%
Fx:043

Input Level Dmod [%]


Sets the modulation amount of the input level
h

100...+100
Fx:037,

Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
i

Spread
Sets the width of the stereo image of the effect sound

Off...Tempo
Fx:037

Tap1 Time [msec]


Sets the Tap1 delay time

0.0...680.0msec

Tap2 Time [msec]


Sets the Tap2 delay time

0.0...680.0msec

Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level

0...100

Feedback (Tap2)
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount
e

100...+100

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the Tap2 feedback amount
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the Tap2 feedback amount

High Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the high range

Fx:043

Low Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the low range

Fx:043

Input Level Dmod [%]


Sets the modulation amount of the input level
h

0...100%

0...100%

100...+100

Fx:037,

Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level

50...+50
Fx:043

Off...Tempo
Fx:037

Spread
100...+100
Sets the width of the stereo image of the effect sound
Fx:043,
i

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

Mode: Cross Pan2

Mode
Normal, Cross Feedback, Cross Pan1, Cross Pan2
Switches the left and right delay routing

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Mode: Cross Pan1

100...+100

Mode: Cross Feedback

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the effect sounds stereo image width
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the effect sounds stereo image width

100...+100

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

a: Mode
You can change how the left and right delay signals are panned
by modifying the routing of the left and right delay as shown in
the figure above. You need to input different sounds to each
channel in order for this parameter to be effective.

d: Tap1 Level
This parameter sets the output level of Tap1. Setting a different
level from Tap2 will add a unique touch to a monotonous delay
and feedback.

Effects
ER/Delay

046: Modulation Delay

e: LFO Sync, e: Src,


f: L LFO Phase [degree], f: R LFO Phase [degree]

This stereo delay uses an LFO to sweep the delay time. The pitch
also varies. You will obtain a delay sound with swell and shimmering. You can also control the delay time using a modulation
source.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Wet / Dry

Delay

The LFO can be reset via a modulation source.


The Src parameter sets the modulation source that resets the
LFO. For example, you can assign Gate as a modulation source so
that the sweep always starts from the specified point.
L LFO Phase and R LFO Phase set the phase obtained when
the left and right LFOs are reset. In this way, you can create
changes in pitch sweep for the left and right channels individually.

Feedback

The effect is off when a value of the modulation source specified in the Src parameter is 63 or smaller, and the effect is on
when the value is 64 or higher. The LFO is triggered and reset to
the L LFO Phase and R LFO Phase settings when the value
changes from 63 or smaller to 64 or higher.

Delay
Right

LFO Sync

Wet / Dry
Response
LFO: Tri / Sine

D-mod

L/R: +/+ +/
LFO Shape

LFO

047: Dynamic Delay

LFO Phase Modulation Mode

Modulation Mode
LFO, D-mod
Switches between LFO modulation control and modulation source control
D-mod Modulation
Reversed L/R control by modulation source

Src
Selects the modulation source that controls delay time
Response
Sets the rate of response to the modulation source
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

L/R:+/+, L/R:+/
,

This stereo delay controls the level of delay according to the


input signal level. You can use this as a ducking delay that applies
delay to the sound only when you play keys at a high velocity or
only when the volume level is low.

Off...Tempo

Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry
High Damp Low Damp

0...30

Delay

Triangle, Sine

Feedback

c
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed

Delay

100...+100
Fx:020

Right
FB

LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed
LFO Sync
Switches LFO reset off/on

0.02...20.00Hz

Wet / Dry

Out
Attack, Release

Envelope

Control Target

Threshold

Off, On
Control Target
Selects from no control, output, and feedback

None, Out, FB

Src
Selects the modulation source that resets the LFO

Off...Tempo

L LFO Phase [degree]


Sets the phase obtained when the left LFO is reset

180...+180

Polarity
Reverses level control

R LFO Phase [degree]


Sets the phase obtained when the right LFO is reset

180...+180

Threshold
Sets the level to which the effect is applied

0...100

+,

L Depth
Sets the depth of the left LFO modulation

0...200

Offset
Sets the offset of level control

0...100

R Depth
Sets the depth of the right LFO modulation

0...200

Attack
Sets the attack time of level control

1...100

Release
Sets the release time of level control

1...100
0.0...680.0msec
0.0...680.0msec

L Delay Time [msec]


Sets the left delay time

0.0...500.0

R Delay Time [msec]


Sets the right delay time

0.0...500.0

L Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time for the left channel

L Feedback
Sets the feedback amount of left delay

100...+100

R Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time for the right channel

R Feedback
Sets the feedback amount of right delay

100...+100

Feedback
Sets the feedback amount

Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010,
j

Spread

High Damp Low Damp

i
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

b: D-mod Modulation
When the modulation source is used for control, this parameter
reverses the left and right modulation direction.

100...+100

High Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the high range

Fx:043

Low Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the low range

Fx:043

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330

Spread
Sets the width of the stereo image of the effect sound

0...100%
0...100%

100...+100
Fx:043

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

a: Control Target
This parameter selects no level control, delay output control
(effect balance), or feedback amount control.

Appendix

D-mod

357

358

Effects
ER/Delay

a: Polarity, b: Threshold, b: Offset, c: Attack, d: Release


The Offset parameter specifies the value for the Control Target parameter (that is set to None), expressed as the ratio relative to the parameter value (the Wet/Dry value with Control
Target=Out, or the Feedback value with Control Target=FB).
When Polarity is positive, the Control Target value is
obtained by multiplying the parameter value by the Offset
value (if the input level is below the threshold), or equals the
parameter value if the input level exceeds the threshold.
When Polarity is negative, Control Target value equals the
parameter value if the input level is below the threshold, or is
obtained by multiplying the parameter value by the Offset
value if the level exceeds the threshold.
The Attack and Release parameters specify attack time and
release time of delay level control.
Dynamic Delay

Level

Dry
Threshold

L Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time for the left channel
L Feedback
Sets the feedback amount for the left channel
R Delay Time [msec]
Sets the delay time for the right channel
R Feedback
Sets the feedback amount for the right channel

0.0...680.0msec
100...+100

High Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the high range

Fx:043

Low Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the low range

Fx:043

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

0...100%
0...100%

Triangle, Sine

d
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed

100...+100
Fx:020

LFO Phase [degree]


180...+180
Sets the LFO phase difference between the left and right Fx:034

Panning Frequency [Hz]


Sets the panning speed

0.02...20.00Hz

Panning Depth
Sets the panning width

Attack

g
(Ducking Delay)

Wet

100...+100

Release

Envelope

0.0...680.0msec

Src
Selects the modulation source for the panning width
Amt
Set the modulation amount of the panning width

Control Target=Out
Polarity= ()
Delay Time
Wet

0...100
Off...Tempo
100...+100

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Control Target=Out
Polarity= (+)
Time

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

048: Autopan Delay


This stereo delay effect pans the delay sound left and right using
the LFO.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Wet / Dry
High Damp Low Damp

Pan

Delay

Depth

Feedback

Pan

Delay
High Damp Low Damp
Right

Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
LFO: Tri / Sin

LFO Shape

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100

Effects
ER/Delay

049: L/C/R BPM Delay


The L/C/R delay enables you to match the delay time with the
song tempo. You can also synchronize the delay time with the
arpeggiator or sequencer. If you program the tempo before performance, you can achieve a delay effect that synchronizes with
the song in real-time. Delay time is set by notes.

359

a: BPM, b: L Delay Base Note, b: Times, c: C Delay Base


Note,
c: Times, d: R Delay Base Note, d: Times
The delay time is the length of the note obtained by multiplying
the Base Note parameter by the Times value, in relation to the
tempo specified by the BPM parameter (or the MIDI Clock
tempo if BPM is set to MIDI).

Note: With extreme values, the sync may be lost.

050: BPM Delay

Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In -Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry
Input Level D-mod

This stereo delay enables you to set the delay time to match the
song tempo.

L Delay
Level

High Damp Low Damp

C Delay

Spread

Note: With extreme values, the sync may be lost.

Level
Feedback

Input Level D-mod

R Delay
Stereo In - Stereo Out

Level

Left

Right

Wet / Dry

Wet / Dry

High Damp Low Damp

Tempo

BPM
BPM

Delay
Input Level D-mod

Base Note x Times


Base Note x Times

Feedback

Base Note x Times


High Damp Low Damp

Input Level D-mod

Delay

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

Right

MIDI, 40...240
,

BPM

 
 
 

L Delay Base Note
Selects the type of notes to specify the delay time for TapL
,
b

BPM

Times
x1...x16

Sets the number of notes to specify the delay time for TapL
Level
Sets the output level of TapL

0...50

0...50

R Delay Base Note


 
 
 

Selects the type of notes to specify the delay time for TapR
,
d

Off...Tempo

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the TapC feedback

100...+100
0...100%
Fx:043

Low Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the low range

0...100%
Fx:043

100...+100
Fx:037,

Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
h

Spread
Sets the width of the stereo image of the effect sound

R>
----, OVER!!
Display the error message if the right channel delay time exceeds the upper

limit

Times
x1...x16
Sets the number of notes to specify the left channel delay time
Fx:049

Off...Tempo
Fx:037
0...50
Fx:043

Times
x1...x16
Sets the number of notes to specify the right channel delay time
Fx:049
2.50...+2.50%

L Feedback
Sets the feedback amount for the left channel

100...+100

Src
Selects the modulation source of feedback amount

Off...Tempo

Amt L
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the left channel feedback
R Feedback
Sets the feedback amount for the right channel

100...+100

e
Amt R
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the right channel feedback
f

High Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the high range

Fx:043

Low Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the low range

Fx:043

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Input Level Dmod [%]


Sets the modulation amount of the input level
h

2.50...+2.50%

Adjust [%]
Fine-adjust the right channel delay time

High Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the high range

Input Level Dmod [%]


Sets the modulation amount of the input level

100...+100

Src
Selects the modulation source for the TapC feedback

MIDI, 40...240

Fx:049,

 
 
 

R Delay Base Note
Selects the type of notes to specify the right channel delay time
Fx:049,
0...50

Feedback (C Delay)
Sets the feedback amount of TapC

Adjust [%]

Adjust [%]
Fine-adjust the left channel delay time

Times
x1...x16
Sets the number of notes to specify the delay time for TapR

Level
Sets the output level of TapR

Adjust [%]

Base Note x Times

L Delay Base Note


 
 
 

Selects the type of notes to specify the left channel delay time
Fx:049,

Times
x1...x16
Sets the number of notes to specify the delay time for TapC

Level
Sets the output level of TapC

Base Note x Times

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

C Delay Base Note


 
 
 

Selects the type of notes to specify the delay time for TapC
,
c

Wet / Dry

Tempo

0...100%
0...100%

100...+100

Fx:037,

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330

Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

100...+100

Off...Tempo
Fx:037

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Appendix

360

Effects
Reverb

051: Sequence Delay


This four-tap delay enables you to select a tempo and rhythm
pattern to set up each tap.

Reverb effects

Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In -Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry

Pan
Input Level D-mod

Reverb
These effects simulate the ambience of reverberation in concert
halls.

052: Reverb Hall

Delay
High Damp Low Damp

This hall-type reverb simulates the reverberation of mid-size


concert halls or ensemble halls.

Feedback
Input Level D-mod
Right

Wet / Dry

Tempo

BPM
BPM

053: Reverb Smooth Hall

Rythm Pattern

This hall-type reverb simulates the reverberation of larger halls


and stadiums, and creates a smooth release.
a

BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo

MIDI, 44...240
,

Rhythm Pattern
Selects a rhythm pattern

 ...    3

Tap1 Pan
Sets the panning of Tap1

L, 1...99, R

Tap2 Pan
Sets the panning of Tap2

L, 1...99, R

055: Reverb Dry Plate

Tap3 Pan
Sets the panning of Tap3

L, 1...99, R

This plate reverb simulates dry (light) reverberation.

Tap4 Pan
Sets the panning of Tap4

L, 1...99, R

Feedback
Sets the feedback amount

100...+100

054: Reverb Wet Plate


This plate reverb simulates warm (dense) reverberation.

Left

HEQ
Pre Delay

Reverb

EQ Trim

100...+100
Right

Wet / Dry

High Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the high range

0...100%
Fx:043

Low Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the low range

Fx:043

0...100%

100...+100

Reverb Time [sec]


Sets the reverberation time
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range

Off...Tempo
Fx:037

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

Pre Delay [msec]


Sets the delay time from the dry sound
b
Pre Delay Thru [%]
Sets the mix ratio of non-delay sound
c

100...+100

EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

0...100%
0...200msec

0...100%

0...100

Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

a: BPM, b: Rhythm Pattern


With the tempo specified by the BPM parameter (or the MIDI
Clock tempo if BPM is set to MIDI), the length of one beat
equals the feedback delay time, and the interval between taps
becomes equal. Selecting a rhythm pattern will automatically
turn the tap outputs on and off. When BPM is set to MIDI, the
lower limit of the BPM is 44.

0.1...10.0sec

Fx:037,

Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level

Off...Tempo

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the feedback

Wet / Dry
Pre Delay Thru

EQ Trim
LEQ

Src
Selects the modulation source of feedback amount

Input Level Dmod [%]


Sets the modulation amount of the input level

Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

361

Effects
Reverb

b: Pre Delay [msec], b: Pre Delay Thru [%]

057: Reverb Bright Room

The Pre Delay sets the delay time to the reverb input, allowing
you to control spaciousness.
Using the Pre Delay Thru parameter, you can mix the dry sound
without delay, emphasizing the attack of the sound.

This room-type reverb emphasizes the early reflections that


make the sound brighter. See 056: Reverb Room.
Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Reverb - Hall / Plate Type


Level

Wet / Dry
ER Level

Dry

ERs

EQ Trim

Louder

LEQ

Pre Delay Thru

HEQ

Reverb

Pre Delay

Reverb Level

Reverb
Pre Delay Thru

ERs
Time

EQ Trim

ER Level

Right
Wet / Dry

Reverb Time

This room-type reverb emphasizes the early reflections that


make the sound tighter. Changing the balance between the early
reflections and reverb sound allows you to simulate nuances,
such as the type of walls of a room.

Reverb Time [sec]


Sets the reverberation time

0.1...3.0sec

a
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range

0...100%

Pre Delay [msec]


Sets the delay time from the dry sound

0...200msec
Fx:052

b
Pre Delay Thru [%]
Sets the mix ratio of non-delay sound

0...100%

Fx:052

ER Level
Sets the level of early reections

0...100

Reverb Level
Sets the reverberation level

0...100

EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

0...100

Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

c: ER Level, d: Reverb Level


These parameters set the early reflection level and reverb level.
Changing these parameter values allows you to simulate the type
of walls in the room. That is, a larger ER Level simulates a hard
wall, and a larger Reverb Level simulates a soft wall.
Reverb - Room Type
Level

Dry

ER
(Early Reflections)

Reverb
Time

Pre Delay Thru


Pre Delay

Reverb Time

Appendix

056: Reverb Room

Louder

Pre Delay

362

Effects
Mono Mono Chain

059: Par4Eq-Wah

Mono Mono Chain

(Parametric 4-Band EQ Wah/Auto Wah)

Effects that combine two mono effects connected in series

This effect combines a mono-type four-band parametric equalizer and a wah. You can change the order of the connection.
Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

058: P4EQ - Exciter

Left

Wet / Dry

Routing

(Parametric 4-Band EQ Exciter)

Parametric 4Band EQ

Wah/Auto Wah

This effect combines a mono-type four-band parametric equalizer and an exciter.

Wah
Trim

Right

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Sweep Mode
Envelope

Left

Wet / Dry

Parametric 4Band EQ

-mod

Exciter

Wet / Dry

Auto
D-mod
LFO
LFO

Exciter
Trim

[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level

0...100

Right
Wet / Dry

[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
[E] Band1 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency of Band 1

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1

[E] Band2 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency of Band 2

50...5.00kHz

[E] Band3 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency for Band 3
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
[E] Band4 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency for Band 4
e

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

18...+18dB

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4

20...1.00kHz

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2

0...100

[E] Band1 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency of Band 1

50...5.00kHz

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3

[E] Band4 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency for Band 4

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4

500...20.00kHz
0.5...10.0

Fx:006

[E] Band2 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency of Band 2

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3

300...10.00kHz

18...+18dB

18...+18dB

[E] Band3 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency for Band 3

0.5...10.0

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2

Fx:006

18...+18dB

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1

20...1.00kHz

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

18...+18dB
300...10.00kHz
0.5...10.0

Fx:006

18...+18dB
500...20.00kHz
0.5...10.0

Fx:006

18...+18dB

[W] Frequency Bottom


Sets the lower limit of the wah center frequency

Fx:009
Fx:009

0...100

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4

18...+18dB

Frequency Top
Sets the upper limit of the wah center frequency

[X] Exciter Blend


Sets the intensity (depth) of the Exciter effect

100...+100
Fx:011

[W] Sweep Mode


Auto, D-mod, LFO
Selects the control from auto-wah, modulation source, and LFO
Fx:009,

[X] Emphatic Point


Sets the frequency range to be emphasized

0...70
Fx:011

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the wah when Sweep Mode=D-mod

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

0...100

[W] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed
h

100...+100
i

0.02...20.00Hz

Resonance
Sets the resonance amount

0...100

LPF
Switches the wah low pass lter on and off

Off, On

Routing
PEQ WAH, WAH PEQ
Changes the order of the parametric equalizer and wah connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Effects
Mono Mono Chain

363

060: P4EQ - Cho/Flng

061: P4EQ - Phaser

This effect combines a mono-type four-band parametric equalizer and a chorus/flanger.

This effect combines a mono-type four-band parametric equalizer and a phaser.

Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Parametric 4Band EQ

Parametric 4Band EQ

Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Cho/Flng Wet / Dry

Right

[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level

a
20...1.00kHz

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1

18...+18dB

[E] Band2 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency of Band 2

50...5.00kHz

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2

18...+18dB

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3

18...+18dB

[E] Band4 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency for Band 4

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4

18...+18dB

[F] Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time

0.0...50.0msec

[F] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

0.02...20.00Hz

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Sine
g
0...100

h
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount

100...+100
Fx:020

Normal, Wet Invert

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

i: Output Mode
When Wet Invert is selected, the right channel phase of the chorus/flanger effect sound is inverted. This creates pseudo-stereo
effects and adds spread.
However, if a mono-input type effect is connected after this
effect, the left and right sounds may cancel each other, eliminating the chorus/flanger effects.

[E] Band2 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency of Band 2

50...5.00kHz

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

18...+18dB
300...10.00kHz

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

18...+18dB
500...20.00kHz

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4

18...+18dB

[P] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

0.02...20.00Hz

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Sine

[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied

0...100

[P] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

0...100

[P] Phaser Wet/Dry


Sets the phaser effect balance
i
Output Mode
Selects the phaser output mode

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330

18...+18dB

Resonance
Sets the resonance amount

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1

[F] Cho/Flng Wet/Dry


Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Sets the effect balance of the chorus/anger
Fx:010, 020
Output Mode
Selects the output mode for the chorus/anger

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

[F] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1

[E] Band4 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency for Band 4

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

20...1.00kHz

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3

500...20.00kHz

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4

0...100

[E] Band3 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency for Band 3

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2

300...10.00kHz

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

[E] Band3 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency for Band 3

Wet / Dry

[E] Band1 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency of Band 1

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert

Phaser Wet / Dry

0...100

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2

Resonance

LFO: Tri / Sine

[E] Band1 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency of Band 1

Right

Wet / Dry

LFO: Tri / Sine

Phaser
Trim

Feedback

Phaser

Chorus/Flanger
Trim

Wet / Dry

Chorus/Flanger

Left

Wet / Dry

100...+100
Fx:023
Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Fx:010, 023
Normal, Wet Invert
Fx:060

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Appendix

Left

364

Effects
Mono Mono Chain

062: P4EQ - Mt. Delay

063: Comp - Wah

(Parametric 4-Band EQ Multitap Delay)

(Compressor Wah/Auto Wah)

This effect combines a mono-type four-band parametric equalizer and a multitap delay.

This effect combines a mono-type compressor and a wah. You


can change the order of the connection.
Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Left

Left
Wet / Dry

Parametric 4Band EQ

Compressor

Delay
Trim

High Damp (1)

Wah/Auto Wah

EQ Trim LEQ HEQ

Feedback

Wet / Dry

Routing

Multitap Delay

Comp

(2)

Wah

Output Level

Mt.Dly Wet / Dry

Right

Right
Wet / Dry

Envelope - Control

Sweep Mode
Envelope
Auto
D-mod
-mod

Wet / Dry

LFO
LFO

[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
[E] Band1 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency of Band 1

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1

0.5...10.0

[E] Band2 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency of Band 2

50...5.00kHz

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
[E] Band4 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency for Band 4
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4

Fx:006

18...+18dB

[E] Band3 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency for Band 3

20...1.00kHz

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2

0...100

0.5...10.0

18...+18dB

0.5...10.0
Fx:006

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4

18...+18dB

[D] Tap1 Time [msec]


Sets the Tap1 delay time

0...680msec

0...100
Fx:045

[D] Tap2 Time [msec]


Sets the Tap2 delay time

0...680msec

Feedback
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount

100...+100

High Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the high range

0...100%

Fx:043

Wet/DryDry, 1:99...99:1, Wet


Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on
page 330
i

SrcOff...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on
page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the
effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Fx:002

0...100

[C] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

0...100

[C] Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

[W] Frequency Bottom


Sets the lower limit of the wah center frequency

Fx:009

0...100

Frequency Top
Sets the upper limit of the wah center frequency

Fx:009

0...100

[W] Sweep Mode


Auto, D-mod, LFO
Selects the control from auto-wah, modulation source, and LFO
Fx:009,

[W] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

0.02...20.00Hz

[W] Resonance
Sets the resonance amount

0...100

Low Pass Filter


Switches the wah low pass lter on and off

Off, On

Routing
CMP WAH, WAH CMP
Switches the order of the compressor and wah connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Output Level
Sets the compressor output level

1...100

[D] Mt.Delay Wet/DryDry, 2:98...98:2, Wet


Sets the multitap delay effect balance

Fx:002

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the wah when Sweep Mode=D-mod

f
Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level

[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330

Fx:006

500...20.00kHz

1...100

300...10.00kHz
0.5...10.0

Fx:002

Fx:006

18...+18dB

[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Effects
Mono Mono Chain

365

064: Comp - Amp Sim

065: Comp - OD/HiGain

(Compressor Amp Simulation)

(Compressor Overdrive/Hi.Gain)

This effect combines a mono-type compressor and an amp simulation. You can change the order of the effect connection.

This effect combines a mono-type compressor and an overdrive/


high-gain distortion. You can change the order of the effect connection.

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left
Routing

Compressor

Wet / Dry

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Amp Simulation

Left

Wet / Dry

Routing
EQ Trim LEQ

Compressor

HEQ

Comp

Overdrive / Hi-Gain

Amp Simulation Filter


3 Band PEQ

Output Level

Comp

Driver
Output Level

Output Level
Right
Envelope - Control

Mode: Overdrive / Hi-Gain


Drive

Wet / Dry
Right

Wet / Dry

Envelope - Control

[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity

Fx:002

[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330

1...100
Fx:002

Output Level
Sets the compressor output level

0...100
Fx:002

[C] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

1...100
a

15...+15dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

Solid State, British


(EL84), American
(6L6)

1...100

[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330

Fx:002

Output Level
Sets the compressor output level

Fx:002

1...100
0...100

[O] Drive Mode


Overdrive, Hi-Gain
Switches between overdrive and high-gain distortion
c
Drive
Sets the degree of distortion

[A] Amplier Type


Selects the type of guitar amplier

Fx:002

0...100

[C] Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity

[O] Output Level


Sets the overdrive output level
d

Routing
CMP AMP, AMP CMP
Switches the order of the compressor and amp simulation connection

1...100

Fx:006
Fx:006,

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the overdrive output level
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the overdrive output level

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

0...50

[O] Low Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency for Low EQ (shelving type)

50...+50

20...1.00kHz

e
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330

Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

[O] Mid1 Cutoff [Hz]


300...10.00kHz
Sets the center frequency for Mid/High EQ 1 (peaking type)

100...+100
f

Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 1
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1

18...+18dB

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

18...+18dB

[O] Mid2 Cutoff [Hz]


500...20.00kHz
Sets the center frequency for Mid/High EQ 2 (peaking type)
g

Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

18...+18dB

Routing
CMP OD, OD CMP
Switches the order of the compressor and overdrive connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Appendix

366

Effects
Mono Mono Chain

066: Comp - P4EQ

067: Comp - ChoFlng

(Compressor Parametric 4-Band EQ)

(Compressor Chorus/Flanger)

This effect combines a mono-type compressor and a four-band


parametric equalizer. You can change the order of the effect connection.

This effect combines a mono-type compressor and a chorus/


flanger. You can change the order of the effect connection.
Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left
Routing

Compressor

Parametric 4Band EQ

Comp

Chorus/Flanger
+

Output Level

Comp
Output Level

Chorus/Flanger

EQ Trim LEQ HEQ

+
+

Wet / Dry

Routing

Compressor

Wet / Dry

Feedback

Trim
Right
Envelope - Control

Right
Envelope - Control

[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity

1...100
Fx:002

[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330

1...100
Fx:002

Output Level
Sets the compressor output level

0...100
Fx:002

[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
[E] Band1 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency of Band 1

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1

[E] Band2 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency of Band 2

50...5.00kHz

[E] Band3 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency for Band 3
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
[E] Band4 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency for Band 4
g

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4

0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2

20...1.00kHz

0.5...10.0
Fx:006

Fx:002

Output Level
Sets the compressor output level

Fx:002

1...100
0...100

[C] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

0...100

[C] Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

[F] Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time

0.0...50.0msec

[F] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

0.02...20.00Hz

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Sine
0...100

g
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount

100...+100
Fx:020

[F] Cho/Flng Wet/Dry


Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Sets the effect balance of the chorus/anger
Fx:010, 020
Output Mode
Selects the output mode for the chorus/anger

Normal, Wet Invert

Routing
CMP FLNG, FLNG CMP
Switches the order of the compressor and chorus/anger connection

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

18...+18dB
j

100...+100

[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330

[F] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

0.5...10.0

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330

1...100

Fx:006

Routing
CMP PEQ, PEQ CMP
Switches the order of the compressor and parametric EQ connection

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

18...+18dB
500...20.00kHz

Fx:002

300...10.00kHz

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB

[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity

0...100

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2

Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri / Sine

Wet / Dry

a
a

Normal
Output Mode

Wet Invert
Cho/Flng Wet / Dry

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

h: Output Mode, i: Routing


When Wet Invert is selected, the right channel phase of the chorus/flanger effect sound is inverted. This creates pseudo-stereo
effects and adds spread.
However, if a mono-input type effect is connected after this
effect, the left and right sounds may cancel each other, eliminating the chorus/flanger effects.
When Routing is set to FLNGCMP, Output Mode will be set
to Normal.

Effects
Mono Mono Chain

367

068: Comp - Phaser

069: Comp - Mt. Delay

(Compressor Phaser)

(Compressor Multitap Delay)

This effect combines a mono-type compressor and a phaser. You


can change the order of the effect connection.

This effect combines a mono-type compressor and a multitap


delay. You can change the order of the effect connection.

Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Compressor
EQ Trim LEQ

Phaser

Envelope - Control

[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330

Fx:002

1...100

Right

Output Level
Sets the compressor output level

Fx:002

1...100

0...100

[C] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

0...100

[C] Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

[P] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

0.02...20.00Hz

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Sine

[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied

0...100

[P] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

0...100

Resonance
Sets the resonance amount

100...+100
Fx:023

[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity

Fx:002

1...100

[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330

Fx:002

Output Level
Sets the compressor output level

Fx:002

1...100

0...100

[C] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

0...100

[C] Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

[D] Tap1 Time [msec]


Sets the Tap1 delay time

0...680msec

e
Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level

0...100

Fx:045

[D] Tap2 Time [msec]


Sets the Tap2 delay time

0...680msec

Feedback
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount

100...+100

[D] High Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the high range

Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet


Fx:010, 023

[D] Mt.Delay Wet/Dry


Sets the multitap delay effect balance

Normal, Wet Invert


Fx:067

Routing
CMPDLY, DLYCMP
Switches the order of the compressor and multitap delay connection

Routing
CMPPHS, PHSCMP
Switches the order of the compressor and phaser connection
Fx:067
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Wet / Dry

Output Mode
Selects the phaser output mode

(2)
Mt.Dly Wet / Dry

Envelope - Control

Fx:002

Delay

High Damp (1)


Output Level

Wet / Dry

LFO: Tri / Sine

[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity

[P] Phaser Wet/Dry


Sets the phaser effect balance

Feedback

Comp

Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Resonance
Phaser Wet / Dry
+

Right

Multitap Delay

EQ Trim LEQ HEQ

Comp
Output Level

Wet / Dry

Routing

Compressor

Phaser

HEQ

Left

Wet / Dry

Routing

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

0...100%

Fx:043
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

100...+100

Appendix

Left

368

Effects
Mono Mono Chain

070: Limiter - P4EQ

071: Limiter - Cho/Flang

(Limiter Parametric 4-Band EQ)

(Limiter Chorus/Flanger)

This effect combines a mono-type limiter and a four-band parametric equalizer. You can change the order of the effect connection.

This effect combines a mono-type limiter and a chorus/flanger.


You can change the order of the effect connection.
Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Chorus/Flanger

Limiter

Wet / Dry

Routing

Limiter

Wet / Dry

Routing

Left

Parametric 4Band EQ

Chorus/Flanger

Limiter
EQ Trim LEQ HEQ

Limiter

Gain Adjust
Feedback

Trim
Gain Adjust

Right
Envelope - Control
Right

Release
Sets the release time

1...100
Fx:003

[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
[E] Band1 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency of Band 1
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1

50...5.00kHz

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
[E] Band4 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency for Band 4

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4

0.5...10.0
Fx:006

18...+18dB
j

100...+100

1...100

[L] Gain Adjust [dB]


Sets the limiter output gain

Inf, 38...+24dB
Fx:003

[F] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

0.02...20.00Hz

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Sine

[F] Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time

0.0...50.0msec

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

0...100
100...+100
Fx:020

[F] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

0...100

[F] Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

[F] Cho/Flng Wet/Dry


Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Sets the effect balance of the chorus/anger
Fx:010, 020
Normal, Wet Invert
Fx:067

Routing
LMTFLNG, FLNGLMT
Switches the order of the limiter and chorus/anger connection
Fx:067
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

0.5...10.0

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330

Fx:003

Output Mode
Selects the output mode for the chorus/anger

Fx:006

Routing
LMTPEQ, PEQLMT
Switches the order of the limiter and parametric EQ connection

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

18...+18dB
500...20.00kHz

Release
Sets the release time

300...10.00kHz
0.5...10.0
Fx:006

1...100

Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
f

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB

Fx:003

20...1.00kHz

[E] Band2 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency of Band 2

[E] Band3 Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency for Band 3
g

0...100

18...+18dB

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2

40...0dB

Fx:003

[L] Attack
Sets the attack time
b

Inf, 38...+24dB
Fx:003

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1

Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2

1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003

Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied

40...0dB
Fx:003
1...100
Fx:003

[L] Attack
Sets the attack time
b

[L] Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio

1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003

Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied

[L] Gain Adjust [dB]


Sets the limiter output gain

Wet / Dry

LFO: Tri / Sine

Wet / Dry

Envelope - Control

[L] Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio

Normal
Output Mode

Wet Invert
Cho/Flng Wet / Dry

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Effects
Mono Mono Chain

072: Limiter - Phaser


This effect combines a mono-type limiter and a phaser. You can
change the order of the effect connection.

c
Left

Fx:003

1...100

Release
Sets the release time

Fx:003

1...100

[L] Gain Adjust [dB]


Sets the limiter output gain

Inf, 38...+24dB
Fx:003

[D] Tap1 Time [msec]


Sets the Tap1 delay time

Wet / Dry

Routing

Limiter

[L] Attack
Sets the attack time
b

Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Phaser

369

0...680msec

d
+

Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level

Phaser

Limiter
Gain Adjust

Resonance

Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert

Phaser Wet / Dry

0...100

Fx:045

[D] Tap2 Time [msec]


Sets the Tap2 delay time

0...680msec

Feedback (Tap2)
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount

100...+100

Right

Wet / Dry

LFO: Tri / Sine

Envelope - Control

[D] Mt.Delay Wet/Dry


Sets the multitap delay effect balance
[L] Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio

1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003

Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied

High Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the high range

40...0dB

Fx:003

[L] Attack
Sets the attack time

Fx:003

1...100

Release
Sets the release time

Fx:003

Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet

f
0...100%

Fx:043

Routing
LMTDLY, DLYLMT
Switches the order of the limiter and multitap delay connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

1...100

[L] Gain Adjust [dB]


Sets the limiter output gain

Inf, 38...+24dB
Fx:003

[P] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

0.02...20.00Hz

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Sine

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

074: Exciter - Comp

[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied

0...100

(Exciter Compressor)

[P] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

0...100

This effect combines a mono-type exciter and a compressor. You


can change the order of the effect connection.

f
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount

100...+100
Fx:023

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

[P] Phaser Wet/Dry


Sets the phaser effect balance

Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet


Fx:010, 023

g
Output Mode
Selects the phaser output mode

Normal, Wet Invert


Fx:067

Compressor

EQ Trim LEQ HEQ

Comp

Exciter

Routing
LMTPHS, PHSLMT
Switches the order of the limiter and phaser connection Fx:067

Output Level

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Wet / Dry

Routing

Exciter

Right
Envelope - Control

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

073: Limiter - Mt. Delay

[X] Exciter Blend


Sets the intensity (depth) of the Exciter effect

[X] Emphatic Point


Sets the frequency range to be emphasized

[X] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

(Limiter Multitap Delay)


This effect combines a mono-type limiter and a multitap delay.
You can change the order of the effect connection.

e
Left

Wet / Dry

Routing

Multitap Delay

Limiter

Feedback

Limiter

Delay

Gain Adjust High Damp (1)

(2)
Mt.Dly Wet / Dry

Right

h
[L] Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio

1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003

Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied

40...0dB
Fx:003

0...100
15...+15dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity

Fx:002

1...100

[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330

Fx:002

Output Level
Sets the compressor output level

Fx:002

1...100
0...100

Routing
XCTCMP, CMPXCT
Switches the order of the exciter and compressor connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Wet / Dry

Envelope - Control

0...70

Fx:011

[X] Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

f
+

100...+100
Fx:011

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Wet / Dry

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Appendix

Left

370

Effects
Mono Mono Chain

075: Exciter - Limiter

076: Exciter - Cho/Flng

(Exciter Limiter)

(Exciter Chorus/Flanger)

This effect combines a mono-type exciter and a limiter. You can


change the order of the effect connection.

This effect combines a mono-type limiter and a chorus/flanger.


Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry

Limiter

Exciter

Chorus/Flanger

Exciter

Wet / Dry

Routing

EQ Trim LEQ

HEQ

Chorus/Flanger

Exciter

EQ Trim LEQ HEQ

Limiter

Exciter

Feedback

Gain Adjust

Right

Wet / Dry

LFO: Tri / Sine


Right

Wet / Dry

Envelope - Control

[X] Exciter Blend


Sets the intensity (depth) of the Exciter effect

[X] Emphatic Point


Sets the frequency range to be emphasized

[X] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

100...+100
Fx:011
0...70
Fx:011

[X] Exciter Blend


Sets the intensity (depth) of the Exciter effect

[X] Emphatic Point


Sets the frequency range to be emphasized

[X] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

0...100

[X] Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB
e

[L] Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio

[L] Threshold [dB]


Sets the level above which the compressor is applied

1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003
40...0dB
Fx:003

[L] Attack
Sets the attack time

1...100
Fx:003

Release
Sets the release time

1...100
Fx:003

[L] Gain Adjust [dB]


Sets the limiter output gain

Routin
XCTLMT, LMTXCT
Switches the order of the exciter and limiter connection

100...+100

0...100

[X] Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

[F] Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time

0.0...50.0msec

[F] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

0.02...20.00Hz

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Sine

[F] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

0...100

g
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount

100...+100
Fx:020

[F] Cho/Flng Wet/Dry


Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Sets the effect balance of the chorus/anger
Fx:010, 020
Output Mode
Selects the output mode for the chorus/anger

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

0...70

Fx:011

Inf, 38...+24dB
Fx:003

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100
Fx:011

Normal
Output Mode

Wet Invert
Cho/Flng Wet / Dry

Normal, Wet Invert


Fx:060

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Effects
Mono Mono Chain

371

077: Exciter - Phaser

078: Exciter - Mt. Delay

(Exciter Phaser)

(Exciter Multitap Delay)

This effect combines a mono-type limiter and a phaser.

This effect combines a mono-type exciter and a multitap delay.


Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Left

Left

Wet / Dry

Wet / Dry

Exciter
EQ Trim LEQ

EQ Trim LEQ HEQ

HEQ

Multitap Delay

Exciter

Phaser

Phaser

Exciter

Resonance

Feedback

Delay

Exciter

Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert

High Damp (1)

(2)
Mt.Dly Wet / Dry

Phaser Wet / Dry


Right

Right

Wet / Dry

Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri / Sine

[X] Exciter Blend


Sets the intensity (depth) of the Exciter effect

[X] Emphatic Point


Sets the frequency range to be emphasized

[X] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

100...+100
Fx:011
0...70
Fx:011
0...100

[X] Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

[X] Exciter Blend


Sets the intensity (depth) of the Exciter effect

[X] Emphatic Point


Sets the frequency range to be emphasized

[X] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

0.02...20.00Hz

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Sine

[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied

0...100

[P] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

0...100

g
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
[P] Phaser Wet/Dry
Sets the phaser effect balance
h
Output Mode
Selects the phaser output mode

100...+100
Fx:023
Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Fx:010, 023

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

[X] Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

[D] Tap1 Time [msec]


Sets the Tap1 delay time

0...680msec

Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level

0...100

Fx:045

[D] Tap2 Time [msec]


Sets the Tap2 delay time

0...680msec

Feedback (Tap2)
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount

100...+100

[D] High Damp [%]


Sets the damping amount in the high range

[D] Mt.Delay Wet/Dry


Sets the multitap delay effect balance

0...100%

Fx:043
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Normal, Wet Invert


Fx:060

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

0...100

0...70

Fx:011

[P] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

100...+100
Fx:011

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

100...+100

Appendix

372

Effects
Mono Mono Chain

079: OD/HG - Amp Sim

080: OD/HG - Cho/Flng

(Overdrive/Hi.Gain Amp Simulation)

(Overdrive/Hi.Gain Chorus/Flanger)

This effect combines a mono-type overdrive/high-gain distortion and an amp simulation. You can change the order of the
effect connection.

This effect combines a mono-type overdrive/high-gain distortion and a chorus/flanger. You can change the order of the effect
connection.

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Left

Overdrive / Hi-Gain

Left

Wet / Dry

Routing

Overdrive / Hi-Gain

3 Band PEQ

Chorus/Flanger

3 Band PEQ

Amp Simulation Filter

Driver

Wet / Dry

Routing

Amp Simulation

Output Level

Driver

Chorus/Flanger

Output Level

Mode: Overdrive / Hi-Gain


Drive

Mode: Overdrive / Hi-Gain


Drive

Right

Normal
Output Mode

Feedback

Wet Invert
Cho/Flng Wet / Dry

Right

Wet / Dry

Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri / Sine

[O] Drive Mode


Overdrive, Hi-Gain
Switches between overdrive and high-gain distortion

[O] Drive Mode


Overdrive, Hi-Gain
Switches between overdrive and high-gain distortion

a
Drive
Sets the degree of distortion
[O] Output Level
Sets the overdrive output level
b

1...100
Fx:006

Fx:006,

[O] Low Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency for Low EQ (shelving type)

Drive
Sets the degree of distortion

0...50

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the overdrive output level
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the overdrive output level

[O] Output Level


Sets the overdrive output level
b

50...+50

18...+18dB

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1

0.5...10.0
Fx:006

Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2
f

[A] Amplier Type


Selects the type of guitar amplier

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

18...+18dB

Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2

Solid State, British


(EL84), American
(6L6)

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330

Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 1

[O] Mid2 Cutoff [Hz]


500...20.00kHz
Sets the center frequency for Mid/High EQ 2 (peaking type)

18...+18dB

[F] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

0.02...20.00Hz

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Sine

[F] Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time

0.0...50.0msec

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

18...+18dB

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1

18...+18dB

Routing
ODAMP, AMPOD
Switches the order of the overdrive and amp simulation connection

20...1.00kHz

[O] Mid1 Cutoff [Hz]


300...10.00kHz
Sets the center frequency for Mid/High EQ 1 (peaking type)

18...+18dB

0.5...10.0
Fx:006

50...+50

[O] Mid2 Cutoff [Hz]


500...20.00kHz
Sets the center frequency for Mid/High EQ 2 (peaking type)
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2

0...50

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the overdrive output level

[O] Low Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency for Low EQ (shelving type)

[O] Mid1 Cutoff [Hz]


300...10.00kHz
Sets the center frequency for Mid/High EQ 1 (peaking type)
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 1

Fx:006,

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the overdrive output level

20...1.00kHz

c
Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

1...100

Fx:006

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

0...100

Feedback
Sets the feedback amount

100...+100

[F] Cho/Flng Wet/Dry


Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Fx:010, 020
Sets the effect balance of the chorus/anger
Output Mode
Selects the output mode for the chorus/anger

100...+100
Fx:020

Normal, Wet Invert


Fx:067

Routing
OD FLNG, FLNG OD
Switches the order of the overdrive and chorus/anger connection
Fx:067
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Effects
Mono Mono Chain

373

081: OD/HG - Phaser

082: OD/HG - Mt. Delay

(Overdrive/Hi.Gain Phaser)

(Overdrive/Hi.Gain Multitap Delay)

This effect combines a mono-type overdrive/high-gain distortion and a phaser. You can change the order of the effect connection.

This effect combines a mono-type overdrive/high-gain distortion and a multitap delay.


Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Wet / Dry

Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out


Wet / Dry

Routing

Overdrive / Hi-Gain

3 Band PEQ

Phaser

+
3 Band PEQ

Multitap Delay

Overdrive / Hi-Gain

Left

Feedback

Delay

Driver
Output Level

High Damp (1)

Output Level

Resonance

Mode: Overdrive / Hi-Gain


Drive

(2)
Mt.Dly Wet / Dry

Phaser

Driver

Mode: Overdrive / Hi-Gain


Drive

Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert

Right

Wet / Dry

Phaser Wet / Dry

Right

Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri / Sine

[O] Drive Mode


Overdrive, Hi-Gain
Switches between overdrive and high-gain distortion
a

[O] Drive Mode


Overdrive, Hi-Gain
Switches between overdrive and high-gain distortion

Drive
Sets the degree of distortion

a
1...100

[O] Output Level


Sets the overdrive output level
b

[O] Output Level


Sets the overdrive output level

Fx:006
Fx:006,

0...50

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the overdrive output level

Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the overdrive output level

[O] Low Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency for Low EQ (shelving type)

50...+50

Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

18...+18dB

[O] Mid1 Cutoff [Hz]


300...10.00kHz
Sets the center frequency for Mid/High EQ 1 (peaking type)
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 1

0.5...10.0

Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2

0.5...10.0

18...+18dB

[P] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

0.02...20.00Hz

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Sine

0...100

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

0...100

Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
[P] Phaser Wet/Dry
Sets the phaser effect balance
h
Output Mode
Selects the phaser output mode
i

100...+100
Fx:023

Routing
OD PHS, PHS OD
Switches the order of the overdrive and phaser connection
Fx:067
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

18...+18dB

Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2

18...+18dB

[D] Tap1 Time [msec]


Sets the Tap1 delay time

0...680msec

Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level

0...100

Fx:045

[D] Tap2 Time [msec]


Sets the Tap2 delay time

0...680msec

Feedback
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount

100...+100

[D] Mt.Delay Wet/Dry


Sets the multitap delay effect balance

Dry, 2:98...98:2, Wet

h
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range

Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet


Fx:010, 023
Normal, Wet Invert
Fx:067

0.5...10.0

Fx:006

[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied

Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 1

[O] Mid2 Cutoff [Hz]


500...20.00kHz
Sets the center frequency for Mid/High EQ 2 (peaking type)

Fx:006

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2

18...+18dB

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1

18...+18dB

[O] Mid2 Cutoff [Hz]


500...20.00kHz
Sets the center frequency for Mid/High EQ 2 (peaking type)
e

20...1.00kHz

[O] Mid1 Cutoff [Hz]


300...10.00kHz
Sets the center frequency for Mid/High EQ 1 (peaking type)

Fx:006

Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1

50...+50

20...1.00kHz

c
Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

0...50

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the overdrive output level

Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the overdrive output level

[O] Low Cutoff [Hz]


Sets the center frequency for Low EQ (shelving type)

Fx:006,

0...100%

Fx:043

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Appendix

Drive
Sets the degree of distortion

1...100

Fx:006

374

Effects
Mono Mono Chain

083: Wah - Amp Sim

084: Decimator - Amp

(Wah/Auto Wah Amp Simulation)

(Decimator Amp Simulation)

This effect combines a mono-type wah and an amp simulation.


You can change the order of the effect connection.

This effect combines a mono-type decimator and an amp simulation. You can change the order of the effect connection.

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry

Routing

Wah/Auto Wah

Amp Simulation

a
+

Wah

[D] Pre LPFOff, On


Turn the harmonic noise caused by lowered sampling on and off
Fx:014
High Damp [%]
Sets the ratio of high-range damping

Amp Simulation Filter

0...100%

[D] Sampling Freq [Hz] (Sampling Frequency)


Sets the sampling frequency
Right

Sweep Mode
Envelope
Auto
-mod D-mod

Wet / Dry

[W] Frequency Bottom


Sets the lower limit of the wah center frequency

0...100
Fx:009

Frequency Top
Sets the upper limit of the wah center frequency

Fx:009

0...100

Resolution
Sets the data bit length

Fx:014

4...24

[D] Output Level


Sets the decimator output level

Fx:014

[W] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

0...100

[A] Amplier Type


Selects the type of guitar amplier

Solid State, British (EL84),


American (6L6)

RoutingDECIAMP, AMPDECI
Switches the order of the wah and amp simulation connection
Wet/DryDry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on
page 330

[W] Sweep Mode


Auto, D-mod, LFO
Selects the control from auto-wah, modulation source, and LFO
Fx:009,
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the wah when Sweep Mode=D-mod

LFO
LFO

1.00k...48.00kH
z

0.02...20.00Hz

[W] Resonance
Sets the resonance amount

0...100

Low Pass Filter


Switches the wah low pass lter on and off

Off, On

SrcOff...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on
page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the
effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

[A] Amplier Type


Selects the type of guitar amplier

Solid State, British


(EL84), American
(6L6)

Routing
WAH AMP, AMP WAH
Switches the order of the wah and amp simulation connection

085: Decimator - Comp


(Decimator Compressor)
This effect combines a mono-type decimator and a compressor.
You can change the order of the effect connection.

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry

Routing

Compressor

Decimator

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

Output Level

Resolution

100...+100

Comp

Decimator
Pre LPF

High Damp

Output Level

Right

Wet / Dry
Envelope - Control

[D] Pre LPF


Off, On
Turn the harmonic noise caused by lowered sampling on and off

Fx:014

a
High Damp [%]
Sets the ratio of high-range damping
[D] Sampling Freq [Hz] (Sampling Frequency)
Sets the sampling frequency

0...100%
1.00k...48.00kHz

b
Resolution
Sets the data bit length

Fx:014

[D] Output Level


Sets the decimator output level

Fx:014

[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity

Fx:002

[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330

Fx:002

Output Level
Sets the compressor output level

Fx:002

4...24

0...100
1...100
1...100

Routing
DECICMP, CMPDECI
Switches the order of the decimator and compressor connection

0...100

Effects
Mono Mono Chain

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

375

087: Cho/Flng - Mt.Dly


(Chorus/Flanger Multitap Delay)
This effect combines a mono-type chorus/flanger and a multitap
delay.
Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left

Wet / Dry

Multitap Delay

Chorus/Flanger

086: AmpSim - Tremolo

Feedback

(Amp Simulation Tremolo)

Chorus/Flanger
EQ LEQ HEQ
Trim

Delay (2)

(1)
Cho/Flng
Wet / Dry High Damp

Mt.Dly
Wet / Dry

Feedback

This effect combines a mono-type amp simulation and a tremolo.

Right

Wet / Dry

LFO: Tri / Sine

Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Wet / Dry

Amp Simulation

Tremolo

Amp Simulation Filter

Tremolo

[F] Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time

0.0...50.0msec

[F] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

0.02...20.00Hz

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Sine

b
Right

Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri/Sin/Vintage/Up/Down

LFO Shape

[F] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

0...100

[T] LFO Waveform


Selects LFO Waveform
b

Solid State, British


(EL84), American
(6L6)

[T] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

[T] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

0.02...20.00Hz
f
0...100

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100
Fx:020

[F] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

0...100

[F] Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

100...+100
Fx:020

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Triangle, Sine, Vintage, Up, Down


Fx:032

LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
c

Feedback
Sets the feedback amount

[F] Cho/Flng Wet/Dry


Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Sets the effect balance of the chorus/anger
Fx:010, 020
[D] Tap1 Time [msec]
Sets the Tap1 delay time

0...680msec

g
Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level

0...100

Fx:045

[D] Tap2 Time [msec]


Sets the Tap2 delay time

0...680msec

Feedback (Tap2)
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount

100...+100

100...+100

[D] Mt.Delay Wet/Dry


Sets the multitap delay effect balance

Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet

i
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range

0...100%

Fx:043

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

Appendix

[A] Amplier Type


Selects the type of guitar amplier

376

Effects
Mono Mono Chain

088: Phaser - Cho/Flng

089: Reverb - Gate

(Phaser Chorus/Flanger)

(Reverb Gate)

This effect combines a mono-type phaser and a chorus/flanger.

This effect combines a mono-type reverb and a gate.


Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out

Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out


Left

Left

Wet / Dry

Phaser

Wet / Dry

Reverb

Chorus/Flanger
EQ Trim

Phaser
Resonance

Chorus/Flanger
EQ LEQ HEQ
Trim
Phaser
Feedback
Wet / Dry

[P] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

0.02...20.00Hz

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Sine

[R] Reverb Time [sec]


Sets the reverberation time
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range

0...100%

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

0...100

[R] Pre Delay [msec]


0...200msec
Sets the delay time of the reverb sound and gate control signal

100...+100
Fx:023

[R] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

[P] Phaser Wet/Dry


Sets the phaser effect balance

Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet


Fx:010, 023
0.02...20.00Hz

LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform

Triangle, Sine

[F] Delay Time [msec]


Sets the delay time

0.0...50.0msec

Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation

0...100

15...+15dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

15...+15dB

Pre HEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 330

15...+15dB

100...+100

[G] Input Reverb Mix


Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Sets the balance between the dry and reverb sounds of the gate control signal.

0...100

[G] Polarity
+,
Switches between non-invert and invert of the gate on/off state

Fx:005

[G] Attack
Sets the attack time

Fx:005

Release
Sets the release time

Fx:005

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330

Threshold
Sets the gate threshold level

[F] Cho/Flng Wet/Dry


Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Sets the effect balance of the chorus/anger
Fx:010, 020
Normal, Wet Invert
Fx:060

Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet

Src
Off...Gate2+Dmpr
Selects the modulation source that controls the gate when Envelope Select
is set to D-mod

[F] Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

[R] Reverb Balance


Sets the reverb effect balance

0...100

Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

[R] Pre LEQ Gain [dB]


Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330

[G] Envelope Select


D-mod, Input
Switches between modulation source control and input signal control

100...+100
Fx:020

[F] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330

0...100

[F] LFO Frequency [Hz]


Sets the LFO speed

Output Mode
Selects the output mode for the chorus/anger

0.1...10.0sec

0...100

Gate

[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied

Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
f

Wet / Dry

Reverb
Balance

Input Reverb Mix


Input
Envelope - Control
Gate+Dmpr
D-mod Envelope Select

LFO: Tri / Sine

Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
c

Gate

Right

Wet / Dry

Reverb
LEQ HEQ

Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Cho/Flng
Wet / Dry
+

Right
LFO: Tri / Sine

Pre Delay

1...100
1...100

Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330

Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330

100...+100

f: Envelope Select, f: Src, g: Input Reverb Mix, g:


Threshold
The Envelope Select parameter enables you to select whether
turning the gate on and off is triggered by the input signal level
or controlled directly by the modulation source. You can select
from Off to Gate2+Dmpr for the Src parameter to specify the
modulation source.
When Envelope Select is set to Input, the gate is controlled by
the level of signals that are the combination of the dry sound and
the reverb sound. When the signal level exceeds the threshold,
the gate opens and the reverb sound is output.
Normally, set Input Reverb Mix to Dry (the gate is controlled
only by the dry sound). If you wish to extend the gate time, set
the Input Reverb Mix value higher and adjust the Threshold
value.

Effects
Mono Mono Chain

377

090: Vocoder

c: Formant Shift

This effect can be assigned only to the D FX processor (usually,


the modulating effect for the Keyboard tracks). When this effect
is selected, the microphone input no longer goes to the Voice
Processor, but is routed to the D FX processor.

By offsetting the Carrier filter, you can adjust the height of the
frequency range to which the vocoder effect is applied. The tonal
quality will change significantly.

When programming the Vocoder, you can use one of the specially programmed Vocoder Performances (in the SFX bank)
as templates.

This parameter sets the high-range output level of the right


channel sound (Modulator). If the modulator is a human voice, it
will make the words more clear.
The Vocoder/Carrier parameter sets the balance between the
vocoder sound and the left channel sound (Carrier). The Wet/
Dry parameter sets the balance between the effect and dry
sound.
If you wish to change the intensity of the vocoder effect, select
Wet for Wet/Dry, and adjust the balance using the Vocoder/
Carrier parameter.

Before using the Vocoder, you must connect a microphone and,


set the 1/MIC selector to the MIC position.
This effect applies the character of the microphone signal (Modulator) to the tracks oscillator signal input (Carrier). Therefore,
the voice can modulate one of the sounds of the Pa1X. A common use of this effect is to produce the sound of various instruments by inputting a voice to the Modulator via a microphone.
A special effect is also achieved by using rhythm or effect sounds.
Strings or distortion guitar sounds with a lot of harmonics are
suitable as a Carrier.
Wet: Stereo In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Osc

Carrier
Wet / Dry

Osc (Carrier)
Trim

Mic (Modulator)
Trim

Band Pass Filter

Modulator

Wet / Dry

Osc (Carrier) Trim


Sets the input level of the oscillator (Carrier)

0...100

Mic (Modulator) Trim


Sets the input level of the microphone (Modulator)

0...100

Formant Shift
Sets the height of the frequency for the vocoder effect

2...+2

Response
Sets the speed of the response to the modulator input

0...100

Low Gain [dB]


Sets the low-range output level of the vocoder

12...+12

High Gain [dB]


Sets the high-range output level of the vocoder

12...+12

Modulator Mix
Sets the high-range output level of the modulator

Note: When you assign the Vocoder effect to the D FX processor, the
direct input can no longer be heard. The input signal goes entirely
to the FX processor. To listen to the direct signal, you can still use
the Wet/Dry parameter to increase the level of the direct signal
(Dry).
Please remember to set the tracks Pan value to Off, and the Send
value to 127.
You can add reverb to the Vocoder, by way of the D to C parameter.

Vocoder /
Carrier

Envelope

Modulator High Mix


Mic

f: Modulator Mix

Hint: To create a new Song making use of the Vocoder, enter the
Sequencer-Backing Sequence mode with a Performance that
includes the Vocoder effect.

0...100

Vocoder/Carrier
Carrier, 1:99...99:1, Vocoder
Sets the balance between the vocoder output and the Carrier
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds
Src
Selects the modulation source of the effect balance
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance

Off...Tempo
100...+100

Appendix

378

Assignable parameters
List of Footswitch and EC5 functions

Assignable parameters
List of Footswitch and EC5 functions
The following functions can be assigned to a footswitch or Korg
EC5s switch pedal.

Function

Meaning

Style Change

Style number

Sound Up

Selects the next Sound

Sound Down

Selects the previous Sound

Transpose Down
Transpose Up

Function

Meaning

Off

No function assigned

Style Start/Stop

FX B Mute

Pause Seq1
Same functions of the control panel buttons with the same name

Synchro Start

FX C Mute
FX D Mute
FX All Mute

Synchro Stop

Style-Upper1 Mute

Tap Tempo/Reset

Style-Upper2 Mute

Tempo Lock

Style-Upper3 Mute

Ritardando

Progressively increases the Tempo value

Accelerando

Progressively decreases the Tempo value

Tempo Up

Increases the Tempo value

Tempo Down

Decreases the Tempo value

Intro 1

Style-Lower Mute
Style-Drum Mute
Style-Percussion Mute
Style-Bass Mute
Style-Acc1 Mute

Intro 2

Style-Acc2 Mute

Intro 3 / Count In

Style-Acc3 Mute

Ending 1

Style-Acc4 Mute

Ending 2

Fill 2

Style-Acc5 Mute
Same functions of the control panel buttons with the same name

Style-Acc1-5 Mute
Song-Melody Mute

Mute of Song track 4 (usually, the Melody track)

Song-Drum&Bass Mode

Mute of all tracks, apart for track 2 (usually Bass) and 10 (usually Drum)

Fill 3 / Break
Variation 1
Variation 2
Solo Selected Track

Variation 3

Damper Pedal

Variation 4
Variation Up

Selects the next Variation

Variation Down

Selects the previous Variation

Bass Inversion

Soft Pedal
Sostenuto Pedal
Bass&Lower Backing

Fade In/Out
Memory

Turns Punch Recording on/off

FX A Mute

Play Stop Seq2

Fill 1

Same functions of the control panel buttons with the same name

Upper Octave Down


Punch In/Out

Play Stop Seq1

Pause Seq2

Upper Octave Up

Same functions of the control panel buttons with the same name

Manual Bass

Mutes all tracks, except for Bass and


Lower

Ensemble On/Off
QuarterTone

Turns Quarter Tone on/off

Chord Latch

Holds the recognized chord until the


pedal is released

Style Up

Selects the next Style

Style Down

Selects the previous Style

Chord Latch + Damper

Holds the recognized chord until the


pedal is released, and sustains the tracks
where the Damper has been turned on

Same functions of the control panel buttons with the same name

Glide

When the pedal is pressed, affected


notes on Upper tracks are bent down,
according to settings for the Pitch Bend
on the same tracks. When the pedal is
released, notes return to the normal
pitch, at the speed defined by the
Time parameter (see Glide on
page 230).

Single Touch
STS1
STS2
STS3
STS4
STS Up

Selects the next STS

STS Down

Selects the previous STS

Perform. Up

Selects the next Performance

Perform. Down

Selects the previous Performance

Audio In Mute

Assignable parameters
List of Assignable Pedal and Assignable Sliders functions

Meaning

Microphone Talkback

Turns all Voice Processor effects down, to


let you address the audience. See Voice
Processor Setup: Talk on page 244.

Voice Proc. Sw. A Tgl

Toggle-style switch controls assigned to


the Voice Processor. Press once to activate , a second time to deactivate. See
Voice Processor Preset: Controls on
page 252, for information on the
assigned Voice Processor parameters.

Voice Proc. Sw. B Tgl


Voice Proc. Sw. C Tgl
Voice Proc. Sw. D Tgl
Voice Proc. Sw. A Mom
Voice Proc. Sw. B Mom
Voice Proc. Sw. C Mom
Voice Proc. Sw. D Mom
FX CC12 Switch
FX CC13 Switch

Momentary switch controls assigned to


the Voice Processor. Press to activated,
release to deactivate. See Voice Processor Preset: Controls on page 252, for
information on the assigned Voice Processor parameters.
Standard FX controllers

Rotary Spkr On/Off


Rotary Spkr Fast/Slow
Drawbar Perc On/Off
Drawbar Noise On/Off
Text Page Up
Text Page Down

SongBook Next

These options let you move to the previous or next page, when reading a text
file loaded with a Song (see Text files
loaded with Standard MIDI Files and MP3
files on page 146) or Song Book entry
(see Lyrics as text files associated to a
SongBook entry on page 163).
Moves to the next SongBook entry in the
selected Custom List.

Pad 1

Pad 4
Pad Stop

The following functions can be assigned to a continuous pedal


or to the Assignable Sliders.
Function

Meaning

Off

No function assigned

Master Volume
Acc. Volume

Same functions of the control panel buttons with the same name

Accopaniment Volume

Keyboard Expression
Joystick +X

Joystick right

Joystick -X

Joystick left

Joystick +Y

Joystick forward

Joystick -Y

Joystick backward

Upper VDF Cutoff

Filter cutoff (for Sounds assigned to the


Upper tracks)

Upper VDF Resonance

Filter resonance (for Sounds assigned to


the Upper tracks)

Voice Proc. Cnt.Ctl A

Continuous controls assigned to the


Voice Processor. See Voice Processor Preset: Controls on page 221, for information on the assigned Voice Processor
parameters.

Voice Proc. Cnt.Ctl B


Voice Proc. Cnt.Ctl C
Voice Proc. Cnt.Ctl D
Mic In Volume
FX CC12 Ctl
FX CC13 Ctl

Pad 2
Pad 3

List of Assignable Pedal and Assignable


Sliders functions

Standard FX controllers

Max CD Volume [%]


Max MP3 Volume [%]
Pad Volume

With this function assigned, you can control the proportional volume of all four
Pads at the same time. Please note that
the status of the Pads volume, after having been modified with a pedal or slider,
is made current, and will be saved in a
Performance or STS by using the relevant
Write procedure.

Appendix

Function

379

380

Assignable parameters
List of Assignable Switches functions

List of Assignable Switches functions

Function

Meaning

Rotary Spkr Fast/Slow


Drawbar Perc On/Off

The following functions can be assigned to the Assignable


Switches.

Drawbar Noise On/Off


Text Page Up
Text Page Down

Function

Meaning

Off

No function assigned

Ritardando

Progressively increases the Tempo value

Accelerando

Progressively decreases the Tempo value

Style Up

Selects the next Style

Style Down

Selects the previous Style

Perform. Up

Selects the next Performance

Perform. Down

Selects the previous Performance

FX A Mute
FX B Mute
FX C Mute
FX D Mute
FX All Mute
Style-Upper1 Mute
Style-Upper2 Mute
Style-Upper3 Mute
Style-Lower Mute
Style-Drum Mute
Style-Percussion Mute
Style-Bass Mute
Style-Acc1 Mute
Style-Acc2 Mute
Style-Acc3 Mute
Style-Acc4 Mute
Style-Acc5 Mute
Style-Acc1-5 Mute
Song-Melody Mute

Mute of Song track 4 (usually, the Melody track)

Song-Drum&Bass Mode

Mute of all tracks, apart for track 2 (usually Bass) and 10 (usually Drum)

Solo Selected Track


Bass&Lower Backing

Mutes all tracks, except for the Bass and


Lower tracks

QuarterTone

Turns Quarter Tone on/off

Audio In Mute
Microphone Talkback

Turns all Voice Processor effects down, to


let you address the audience. See Voice
Processor Setup: Talk on page 244.

Voice Proc. Sw. A Tgl

Toggle-style switch controls assigned to


the Voice Processor. Press once to activate , a second time to deactivate. See
Voice Processor Preset: Controls on
page 252, for information on the
assigned Voice Processor parameters.

Voice Proc. Sw. B Tgl


Voice Proc. Sw. C Tgl
Voice Proc. Sw. D Tgl
Voice Proc. Sw. A Mom
Voice Proc. Sw. B Mom
Voice Proc. Sw. C Mom
Voice Proc. Sw. D Mom
FX CC12 Switch
FX CC13 Switch
Rotary Spkr On/Off

Momentary switch controls assigned to


the Voice Processor. Press to activated,
release to deactivate. See Voice Processor Preset: Controls on page 252, for
information on the assigned Voice Processor parameters.
Standard FX controllers

SongBook Next

These options let you move to the previous or next page, when reading a text
file loaded with a Song (see Text files
loaded with Standard MIDI Files and MP3
files on page 146) or Song Book entry
(see Lyrics as text files associated to a
SongBook entry on page 163).
Moves to the next SongBook entry in the
selected Custom List.

Assignable parameters
List of functions assignable to Voice Processors Continuous Controls

381

List of functions assignable to Voice Processors Continuous Controls


The following Voice Processor functions can be assigned to a continuous pedal or to the Assignable Slider, by using one of the four corresponding <Cnt> meta-functions available on the Voice Processor Preset: Controls page of the Global mode (see Voice Processor
Preset: Controls).
Lead Voice Level

Voice 3 Level

Thicken Level

Lead to Delay

Harmony Output Level

Voice 3 Gender

Thicken Detune

Harmony to Delay

Voice 1 Level

Voice 4 Level

Thicken Spread

Delay to Reverb

Voice 1 Gender

Voice 4 Gender

Vibrato Depth

Reverb/Delay Balance

Voice 2 Level

Harmony Smooth

Lead to Reverb

Effect Level

Voice 2 Gender

Human Style Amount

Harmony to Reverb

Voice Modeling Level

List of functions assignable to Voice Processors Switch Controls

Lead On/Off

Thicken On/Off

Voice 1 On/Off

Voice 4 On/Off

Harm/Model On/Off

Latch On/Off

Voice 2 On/Off

Harmony/Modeling Switch

Effect On/Off

Harmony Hold

Voice 3 On/Off

Pitch Correction On/Off

Appendix

The following Voice Processor functions can be assigned to a footswitch, to an Assignable Switch, or to and EC5 swtich pedal, by using
one of the four corresponding <Sw> meta-functions available on the Voice Processor Preset: Controls page of the Global mode (see
Voice Processor Preset: Controls).

382

Assignable parameters
Scales

Scales
The following is a list of scales (or tunings) you can select in various operating modes.
Equal

Equal tuning, the standard scale for modern


Western music. It is made of 12 identical semitones.

Pure Major

Major chords in the selected key are perfectly


tuned.

Pure Minor

Minor chords in the selected key are perfected


tuned.

Arabic

An arabic scale, using quarters of tone. Set the


Key parameter as follow:
C - for the rast C/bayati D scale
D - for the rast D/bayati E scale
F - for the rast F/bayati G scale
G - for the rast G/bayati A scale
A# - for the rast Bb/bayati C scale

Pythagorean Pythagorean scale, based on the music theories of


the great Greek philosopher and matematician. It
is most suitable for melodies.
Werckmeister
Late Baroque/Classic Age scale. Very suitable for
XVIII Century music.
Kirnberger

Harpsichord scale, very common during the


XVIII Century.

Slendro

Scale of the Indonesian Gamelan. The octave is


divided in 5 notes (C, D, F, G, A). The remaining
notes are tuned as in the Equal tuning.

Pelog

Scale of the Indonesian Gamelan. The octave is


divided in 7 notes (all white keys, when Key is =
C). The black keys are tuned as in the Equal tuning.

Stretch

Simulates the stretched tuning of an acoustic


piano. Basically an equal tuning, the lowest notes
are slightly lower, while the highest notes are
slightly higher than the standard.

User

User scale, i.e. scale programmed by the user for


the Style Play, Backing Sequence and Song Play
modes. The user scale can be saved to a Performance, Style Performance, STS or Song. You cant
select a User scale in Global mode.

MIDI Data
MIDI Controllers

383

MIDI Data
CC#

MIDI Controllers
The following is a table including all Control Change messages,
and their effect on various Pa1X functions.
CC Name

Pa1X Function

Bank Select

Program selection

Mod1 (Y+)

Joystick forward

Mod2 (Y-)

Joystick backward

Undef. ctl

Foot ctl

Port.time

Data ent.

Volume

Balance

Undef. ctl

10

Pan Pot

11

Expression

12

Fx Ctl 1

13

Fx Ctl 2

14-15

Undef. ctl

16

Gen.pc.1

17

Gen.pc.2

18

Slider

19

Gen.pc.4

20-31

Undef. ctl

Pa1X Function

91

Fx A/C

A/C (reverb) send level

92

Fx 2 ctl

93

Fx B/D

94

Fx 4 ctl

95

Fx 5 ctl

96

Data Inc

97

Data Dec

98

NRPN Lsb

See table below(*)

99

NRPN Msb*

See table below(*)

100

RPN Lsb

101
102-119
Track volume

Track panning
Expression

B/D (modul.) send level

RPN Msb
Undefined ctl

120

AllSOff

121

Res Ctl

122

LocalCt

123

NoteOff

124

OmniOff

125

Omni On

126

Mono On

127

Poly On

Reset All Controllers

(*) The following NRPN messages are recognized by the Pa1X:


CC#99
(MSB)

CC#98
(LSB)

CC#06
(Data Entry)

Vibrato Rate

0127(a)

Vibrato Depth

0127(a)

Vibrato Decay

10

0127(a)

Filter Cutoff

32

0127(a)

Resonance

33

0127(a)

EG Attack Time

99

0127(a)

EG Decay Time

100

0127(a)

EG Release Time

102

0127(a)

Drum Filter Cutoff

20

dd(b)

0127(a)

Filter resonance

Drum Filter Resonance

21

dd(b)

0127(a)

Drum EG Attack Time

22

dd(b)

0127(a)

Drum EG Decay Time

23

dd(b)

0127(a)

Drum Coarse Tune

24

dd(b)

0127(a)

Drum Fine Tune

25

dd(b)

0127(a)

NRPN

Control Change #32-63 are the LSB (Least Significant Bytet) of Control Change #0-31, i.e. the MSB (Most Significant Byte), and are
changed according to their MSB counterparts.
64

Damper

65

Portamento

Damper pedal

66

Sostenuto

Sostenuto pedal

67

Soft pedal

Soft pedal

68

Legato

69

Hold 2

70

Sustin level

71

F.Res.Hp

72

Release

Release time

73

Attack

Attack time

74

F.CutOff

Filter cutoff (Brilliance)

75

Decay T.

Decay time

76

Lfo1 Sp.

Vibrato speed

77

Lfo1 Dpt

Vibrato depth

Drum Volume

26

dd(b)

0127

Vibrato initial delay

Drum Panpot

28

dd(b)

0127(a)

78

Lfo1 Dly

79

FilterEg

Drum Rev Send (FX 1)

29

dd(b)

0127(a)

80

Gen.pc.5

Drum Mod Send (FX 2)

30

dd(b)

0127(a)

81

Gen.pc.6

82

Gen.pc.7

83

Gen.pc.8

84

Port.ctl

85-90

Undef. ctl

(a). 64 = No change to the original parameters value


(b). dd = Drum Instrument No. 0127 (C0C8)

Note: These controls are reset when stopping the Song, or choosing
a new Song.

Appendix

CC#

CC Name

384

MIDI Data
Program Change messages used as remote commands

Program Change messages used as remote commands


The following is a table including all Program Change messages, used as remote Style and Sequencer controls. These messages are to be
sent on the Control channel (see MIDI: MIDI In Channels on page 238).
PC

Function

PC

Function

PC

Function

PC

Function

PC

Function

91

Fade In/Out

92

Memory

93

Bass Inversion

94

96

Single Touch

97

Style Change

98

Intro 3/Count In

99

Manual Bass

95

Tempo Lock

Start/Stop (Style)

100

101

Play/Stop (Seq 2)

Play/Stop (Seq 1)

Note: The above Program Change numbers are given according to the 0-127 numbering system.

MIDI Data
MIDI Implementation Chart

385

MIDI Implementation Chart


KORG Pa1X
OS Version 2.5 - May. 15, 2005

Function

Recognized

Default

116

116

Changed

116

116

Default
Mode

Note
Number:

X
****************
0127

0127

True Voice

****************

0127

9n, V=1127
X

Poly (Key)
Aftertouch

Mono (Channel)

System
Real Time

Aux
Messages

Notes

Mode 1:OMNI ON, POLY


Mode 3:OMNI OFF, POLY

V=64

X
O

Sequencer data only

*A
*A

Bank Select (MSB, LSB)

*A

1, 2

Modulations

*A

Data Entry MSB

*A

38

Data Entry LSB

*A

7, 11

Volume, Expression

*A

10, 91, 93

Panpot, A/C FX Send, B/D FX Send

*A

64, 66, 67

Damper, Sostenuto, Soft

*A

65, 5

Portamento On/Off, Portamento Time

*A

71, 72, 73

Harmonic Content, EG time (Release, Attack)

*A

74, 75

Brightness, Decay Time

*A

76, 77, 78

Vibrato Rate, Depth, Delay

*A

98, 99

NRPN (LSB, MSB)

*A, 1

100, 101

RPN (LSB, MSB)

*A, 2

All sounds off, Reset all controllers

X
O

True #

0127

****************
X

System Exclusive

System
Common

9n, V=1127

0, 32

120, 121
Program
Change

Pitch Bend

Control
Change

Altered

Note Off

Memorized

Messages

Note On
Velocity

Remarks

0127

*A
*A

0127
X

*3

Song Position

Song Select

Tune

Clock

*4

Commands

*4

Local On/Off

All Notes Off

O (123127)

Active Sense

Reset

*A: Sent and received when MIDI Filters In and Out are set to Off in Global mode.
*1: Drawbars settings, Sound parameters, Selection of SongBook entries.
*2: LSB, MSB = 00,00: Pitch Bend range, =01,00: Fine Tune, =02,00: Course Tune.
*3: Includes Inquiry and Master Volume messages, FX settings, Quarter Tone settings.
*4: Transmitted only when the Clock Send parameter (Global mode) is set to on.
Mode 2:OMNI ON, MONO
Mode 4:OMNI OFF, MONO

O: Yes
X: No

Appendix

Basic Channel

Transmitted

386

Parameters
Control panel and operating mode parameters

Parameters
Control panel and operating mode parameters
The following table shows the parameters you can save to memory when selecting one of the Write commands from the Style Play,
Song Play, Sequencer, Global and Disk mode page menu, as well as when pressing the Write button in the SongBook > Book Edit 1
page.
Legend: Perf (Performance), STS (Styles STS), Sty Perf (Style Performance), STS SB (SongBooks STS), SB (SongBook Entry), Sty Stp (Style
Play Setup), Sng Stp (Song Play Setup), Glb Stp (Global Setup), Mid Stp (MIDI Setup), VP Stp (Voice Processor Setup), VP Tlk (Voice Processor Talk Setup), VP Pst (Voice Processor Preset), Dsk Stp (Disk Setup).
Page

Parameter

Perf STS Sty Perf STS SB SB

Global
Sty Stp Sng Stp Seq Stp Glb Stp Mid Stp VP Stp VP Tlk VP Pst Dsk Stp

Note

Control Panel

Master Volume (Slider)


Acc./Seq Volume (Slider)
Assign. Slider Functions
Slider Mode

Drawbar Settings

Selected Operating Mode


Memory
Bass Inversion

Manual Bass

Fade In/Out
Selected Style Number

Single Touch
Tap Tempo / Reset
Synchro Start/Stop
Start/Stop
Style Element (Intro 1-3,
Ending 1/2, Var 1-4,

Fill 1-3)
Sequencer 1/2 Transport
Balance (Slider)
Selected STS
Tempo

Tempo Lock
Display Hold
Chord Scanning

Keyboard Mode

Style Change
Perf./Sound Select
Selected Performance
Selected Sound
K/St K
SongBook
Ensemble On/Off

Assign. Switch Functions

Pads

Master Transpose

Upper Octave Transpose


U
U

Analog control
St/Sg

L5

Style Play selected at startup

L7
L10

Set to On at startup

Set to Off at startup

STS#1 selected when selecting a Style (with SINGLE TOUCH = On)

Set to Off at startup


Set to Off at startup

G
Set to Off at startup

Performance 1-1 selected at startup

St

St

L4
L3
L1

Style Play Mode

Main (Kbd Trk)

Main (Sty Trk)


Main Volume
Main STS Name

Main Mic

Selected Style

Meter
Tempo

Selected Perf/STS
Selected Songs
Keyboard Sounds
K
K
Upper Trk Octave Transp. U
U
Master Transpose

Original Style Sounds

Style Trk Octave Transp.


St
Style Trk Sounds
St
Track Volume
K/St K
Play/Mute
K/St K
Selected STS
Harmony/Modeling
Lead
V1-V4
Pitch
Thicken
Effects
Talk
Play/Mute
VP Preset

VP Lock

Saved in the Style pattern

K
U

St
St
St
St

K
K

St
St
Selected when Original Style Sounds is set to Off
St
St
STS#1 selected when selecting a Style (with SINGLE TOUCH = On)

L1

T
L8

L2

G
SG

Parameters
Control panel and operating mode parameters

Main Sub-Scale

Main Pad

Main Split

Mix/Tun Volume/Pan

Mix/Tun FX Send

Mix/Tun Tuning

Mix/Tun Sub-Scale

Effects FX Select

Effects FX A-D

Trk Ctrl Mode


Trk Ctrl Drum Volume
Trk Ctrl Easy Edit

Kbd Ens Kbd Control

Kbd Ens Key/Vel Range

Kbd Ens Ensemble

Style Ctrl Drum/Fill

Style Ctrl Kbd Rng/Wrap

Pad/Switch Pad

Pad/Switch Assign. Sw.

Pref Style Pref

Parameter
Scale
Key
Quarter Tone
Detuned Notes
Scale Lock
Pad Assignment
Pad lock
Split Point
Chord Recogn. Mode
Split Point Lock
Style Preferences Lock
Upper Volume Link
Pan
Volume
Play/Mute
Send Level
Play/Mute
PB Sensitivity
Trk Octave Transpose
Detune
Play/Mute
Scale
Key
Quarter Tone
Detuned Notes
Scale Lock
FX (A-B)
FX (C-D)
Wet/Dry (A-B)
Wet/Dry (C-D)
B to A
D to C
Mod. Track (A-B)
Mod. Track (C-D)
Selected FX (A-B)
Selected FX (C-D)
FX Parameters (A-B)
FX Parameters (C-D)
Int/Ext
Type
Play/Mute
Drum Family Volume
Play/Mute
Sound Parameters
Play/Mute
Damper
Joystick X
Joystick Y
Expression
Play/Mute
Top/Btm Key
Top/Btm Velocity
Play/Mute
Ensemble
Note Velocity
Tempo
Feedback
Ens Track Assign
Play/Mute
Drum Mapping Var 1-4
Kick and Snare Design.
Fill Mode 1-3
Fill Mode Lock
Play/Mute
Keyboard Range On/Off
Wrap Around
Play/Mute
Pad 1-4
Volume
Pan
C Send
D Send
Pad Lock
Switch 1-4
Assign. Sw. Lock
Chord Recogn. Mode
Velocity Control
Scale Mode
Memory Mode
Style Pref Lock

Perf STS Sty Perf STS SB SB

Global
Sty Stp Sng Stp Seq Stp Glb Stp Mid Stp VP Stp VP Tlk VP Pst Dsk Stp

Note
L14
L14
L14
L14

L3

L6
L11

K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St

K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K

St
St
St
St
St
St
St
St
St

K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K

G
G

St
St
St
St
St
St
St
St
St

T
L8
T
L8
T
L8
L14
L14
L14

K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K
K
K
K
K
U
U
K

U
K

K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
U
U
K

U
K

St
St
St
St
St
St
St

K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
U
U
K

U
K

St
St
St
St
St
St
St

T
L8
T
L8
T
L8

L13

P
P
P
P
P

P
P
P
P
P

P
P
P
P
P

L8
T
L8
L3
L3
L3
L3
L3

L4

L11
L11
L11
L11

Appendix

Page

387

388

Parameters
Control panel and operating mode parameters

Page

Parameter

Pref Global Setup

Midi Setup
Perf/Sound Default
Velocity Control Value
Upper Volume Link
Bass & Lower Backing

Perf STS Sty Perf STS SB SB

Global
Sty Stp Sng Stp Seq Stp Glb Stp Mid Stp VP Stp VP Tlk VP Pst Dsk Stp

Note

Song Play Mode


Selected Songs
Meter
Saved in the Song
Tempo
Saved in the Song
Selected Perf/STS

Main (Kbd Trk)


Selected Style
Keyboard Sounds
K
K
Upper Trk Octave Transp. U
U
Master Transpose

Song Trk Octave Transp.


Main (Sng Trk 1-8, 9-16)
Song Trk Sounds
Track Volume
K
K
Main Volume
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg
Main Jukebox
Selected Song
Characters

Link int/Ext Video

Main Lyrics-Options
Show Chords

Text Follow

Main STS Name


Selected STS
STS#1 selected when selecting a Style (with SINGLE TOUCH = On)
Harmony/Modeling

Lead

V1-V4

Pitch

Thicken

Main Mic
Effects

Talk

Play/Mute
VP Preset

VP Lock

Scale

Key

Main Sub-Scale
Quarter Tone
Detuned Notes

Scale Lock

Pad Assignment

Main Pad
Pad lock

Split Point

Chord Recogn. Mode

Main Split
Split Point Lock

Style Preferences Lock

Upper Volume Link

Pan
K
K
Mix/Tun Volume/Pan
Volume
K
K
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg
Send Level
K
K
Mix/Tun FX Send
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg
PB Sensitivity
K
K
Trk Octave Transpose
K
K
Mix/Tun Tuning
Detune
K
K
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg
FX (A-B)

FX (C-D)
(*)
(**)
(*)
Wet/Dry (A-B)

Wet/Dry (C-D)
(*)
(**)
(*)
Effects FX Select
B to A

D to C
(*)
(*)
(**)
Mod. Track (A-B)

Mod. Track (C-D)


(*)
(*)
(**)
Selected FX (A-B)

Selected FX (C-D)
(*)
(*)
(**)
Effects FX A-D
FX Parameters (A-B)

FX Parameters (C-D)
(*)
(*)
(**)
(*) Depends on the Perf. Recalls FX CD parameter (**) Depends on the Seq.2 FX Mode parameter
Int/Ext
K
K
Sg
Trk Ctrl Mode
Type
K
K
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg
Drum Family Volume
K
K
Trk Ctrl Drum Volume
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg
Sound Parameters
K
K
Trk Ctrl Easy Edit
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg
Damper
K
K
Joystick X
K
K
Kbd Ens Kbd Control Joystick Y
K
K
Expression
K
K
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg
Top/Btm Key
U
U
Kbd Ens Key/Vel Range Top/Btm Velocity
U
U
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg

L1

G
T
T

L2
L14
L14
L14
L14
L3
L6
L11

G
G

T
T
T

Parameters
Control panel and operating mode parameters

Parameter

Perf STS Sty Perf STS SB SB

Ensemble

Note Velocity

Tempo

Kbd Ens Ensemble


Feedback

Ens Track Assign


U
Play/Mute
K
Pad 1-4
P
Volume
P
Pan
P
Pad/Switch Pad
C Send
P
D Send
P
Pad Lock
Switch 1-4

Pad/Switch Assign. Sw.


Assign. Sw. Lock
Jukebox Editor
Groove Quantize
Various Parameters
Melody
Drum
Pref Track Settings
Bass
Harmony Track
Midi Setup
Perf recalls FX CD
Lyrics/Marker Balance Link
Seq.1/2 Best GM Sound
Pref General Control
Fast Play
Link Mode
Seq.2 FX Mode
HD Path
SongBook Mode
SongBook List
Genre, Artist, Key info,
Tempo, Meter Info, Master Transpose
Book Edit 1
Style/Song Reference
STS Data
Synchro Start, Synchro
Stop, Memory
TXT File Reference
Book Edit 2
Song Selection Number
Harmony Track
SongBook Custom List
Sequencer Mode
Song Data
Main
Play/Mute
Midi Setup
Pref Global Setup
Harmony Track
Sound Mode
Sound Data
Global Mode
Velocity Curve
A.Touch Curve
Master Tuning
Reverb Offset
Gen Ctrl Basic
Fade In Time
Fade Out Time
Acc/Rit Step
Acc/Rit Curve
Glide Time
Transp applies to Sty/Kbd
Transp applies to Seq 1/2
Gen Ctrl Transp Ctrl
Transp applies to Midi In
Scale and Transp Position
Main Scale
Gen Ctrl Scale
Key
Gen Ctrl Lock
Locks
Language
Show PC Number
Gen Ctrl Interface
Show Track Activity
Auto Style Select
Auto Perf/Sound Select
Pedal/Footswitch
Ctrl Pedal/Switch
Damper Polarity
Pedal/Switch Polarity
Ctrl Assignable Sliders Assign. Sliders A1-8, B1-8
Ctrl EC5
EC A-E
Midi Setup
Note to RX Noise Enable
Clock Send
MIDI Midi Stp/GenCtrl Clock Source
Local Control On
MIDI A Out/Thru Mode
MIDI B Out/Thru Mode

Global
Sty Stp Sng Stp Seq Stp Glb Stp Mid Stp VP Stp VP Tlk VP Pst Dsk Stp

U
K
P
P
P
P
P

Note

Sg

T
L3
L3
L3
L3
L3

L4

Saved as a .JBX file

Saved into an .SBD file

Saved into an .SBL file


See table Style, Pad and Song parameter on page 392
Sg

T
G

Saved into a Sound

G
G

G
G
G

Set to Int at startup


Set to On at startup

Appendix

Page

389

390

Parameters
Control panel and operating mode parameters

Page

MIDI Midi In Control

MIDI Midi In Ch.


MIDI Midi Out Ch.
MIDI Filters
Audio Out Sty/Kbd
Audio Out Seq 1
Audio Out Seq 2
Audio Out Drums
Audio Out Audio In

Audio Out Metro/SP

Audio Out MP3/CD

VP Setup Setup

VP Setup Lead Voice

VP Setup Dyn/EQ

VP Setup Talk

VP Preset Preset

VP Preset Thick/Pitch

Parameter
Midi In Oct Transp
Midi In Mute/Unmute
Chord 1 Midi Channel
Chord 2 Midi Channel
Upper Octave Transp
Lower Octave Transp
Midi In Velocity Value
VP Midi In Channel
VP Oct Transp In
VP In Note Range H/L
Channels
Channels
Midi In Filters
Midi Out Filters
Tracks
Tracks
Tracks
Drum Output
Drum Category
VP Out
Metronome Mode
Metronome Volume
Click Out
SPDIF On/Off
Speaker On/Off
MP3 Max Volume
CD Max Volume
VP Setup
Vibrato Mode
Vibrato RX Enable
Octave Transpose
Pitch Bend Range
Damper Mode
Mic In Low Cut
Delay Compensation
Pan
Level
Dyn Assign
EQ Assign
Dyn-Threshold
Dyn-Ratio
Dyn-Gate
EQ-Low Gain
EQ-Low Freq
EQ-Mid Gain
EQ-Mid Freq
EQ-Mid Q
EQ-High Gain
EQ-High Freq
Talk On/Off
Auto Talk
Ld to Rev
FX Lev
Master Vol. Attenuation
Rev-Type
Rev-PreDelay
Rev-Decay
Rev-Low Color
Rev-High Color
Thicken On/Off
Thicken-Detune
Thicken-Spread
Level
VP Preset
Harmony/Modeling Sw.
Lead On/Off
V1-V4 On/Off
Pitch On/Off
Thicken On/Off
Harm./Model. On/Off
Effects On/Off
VP Preset Lock
Thk-On/Off
Thk-Detune
Thk-Spread
Thk-Level
Ptch-On/Off
Ptch-Root
Ptch-Scale Type
Ptch-Attack
Ptch-Amount
Ptch-Window
Ptch-Custom Scale

Perf STS Sty Perf STS SB SB

Global
Sty Stp Sng Stp Seq Stp Glb Stp Mid Stp VP Stp VP Tlk VP Pst Dsk Stp

Note

T
G
T
T
T
G
G

Parameters
Control panel and operating mode parameters

Parameter

Perf STS Sty Perf STS SB SB

Resonance / Amount
Spectral / Amount
Growl / Amount
VP Preset V. Modeling Inflection / Amount
Vibrato / Amount
Level
Pan
On/Off
Latch On/Off
Harmony Mode
Root
Type
Human. Style
Amount
VP Preset Harmony
Tuning
Portamento
PB Assign
Smooth
Harm Note Input Source
Attack
Release
Level
Voice On/Off
Gender
Voicing
Vibrato Style
VP Preset Harm. Voices Vibrato Amount
Level
Pan
CV Map-Note In
CV Map-Note Out
Lead to Rev
Harm/Model to Rev
Harm/Model to Dly
Lead to Dly
Dly to Rev
Rev/Dly Balance
FX Level
Rev-Type
Rev-PreDelay
VP Preset Effects
Rev-Decay
Rev-Low Color
Rev-High Color
Dly-Type
Dly-Delay
Dly-Feedback
Dly-Source
Dly-R(atio)
Dly-Hi Freq Damp
Cnt.Ctl A-D
VP Preset Controls
Sw.Ctl A-D
System
Characters
Video Interface
Colors
Position X/Y
Touch Screen Calib
Calibration
Disk Mode
Global Protect
Hard Disk Protect
Factory Styles/Pad Protect
Preferences
PCM Autoload
Hide Unknown Files
HD Sleep Time

List of abbreviations used in the above table


G = General parameters
SG = Style tracks, globally
T = Selected tracks
U = Upper tracks only
K = Keyboard tracks only
Rt = Realtime tracks only
St = Style tracks only
Sg = Song tracks only
P = Pad tracks only
L[n] = Subject to the corresponding Lock (see diagram)

Global
Sty Stp Sng Stp Seq Stp Glb Stp Mid Stp VP Stp VP Tlk VP Pst Dsk Stp

Reserved memory area

Note

Set to On at startup

L1

L9

L3

L11

L5

L13

L7

L15

L2

L10

L4

L12

L6
L8

L14
L16

Appendix

Page

391

392

Parameters
Style, Pad and Song parameter

Style, Pad and Song parameter


The following table shows the parameters you can save into the Style when selecting the Write Style command from the Style Record
mode page menu; into the Pad when selecting the Write Pad command from the Pad Record mode page menu; and into the Song
when selecting the Save Song command from the Sequencer mode page menu.
Parameter

Header

Style
Tracks

Pad
Master Track

Header

Track

Volume (GM Master Volume)(a)

Tempo
Meter (Time Signature)
Sounds(b)
Note On/Off
Pitch Bend
After Touch

Control Change(c)
Quarter Tone(a)
Quarter Tone Reset(a)
Pad Sync
Pad Type
Chord Variation Length
Original Key/Chord
NTT
Wrap Around
Expression
Keyboard Range
Chord Variation Table
Track Type (Drum/Perc/Bass/Acc)
Trigger Mode
Tension
Play/Mute status(a)
Master Transpose(a)
Volume
Pan
FX Block(a)
FX Send
Detune
Scale(a)
Key
Note
Detune

Uses Arranger/Sequencers
Tempo

Header

Master Track

FX Select (A, B, C, D)(a)

Modulation Track(a)

FX Feedback Send (B>A or D>C)(a)


FX Parameters (A, B, C, D)

Scale Yes/No(a)
Pitch Bend Range

Song
Tracks

(a). Saved as SysEx data.


(b). For these Sounds to be used in a Style, the Original Style Sounds parameter must be checked in the Style Play mode. See Original
Style Sounds on page 80.
(c). Not all Control Change messages are allowed in Styles/Pads. Please see List of recorded events on page 104 for more information.

Recognized chords

393

Recognized chords
The following pages show the most important chords recognized by the Pa1X, when the selected Chord Recognition mode is Fingered 2
(see Chord Recognition Mode on page 95). Recognized chords may vary with a different Chord Recognition mode.

Major 6th

Major
3-note
T

2-note

2-note

4-note
T

Major 7th
4-note

3-note

2-note

T
T

Sus 2

Sus 4
3-note

2-note

3-note

3-note

2-note

T
T

Dominant 7th
4-note
T

T
T

T
T

Dominant 7th Sus 4


4-note

4-note

4-note
T

Major 7th 5

Dominant 7th 5
3-note

T
T

Major 7th Sus 4


4-note

= constituent notes of the chord

T = can be used as tension

Appendix

394

Recognized chords

Minor

Minor 6th

3-note

2-note

4-note

Minor 7th

Minor-Major 7th

4-note

3-note

Diminished

3-note

4-note

Diminished Major 7th

3-note

4-note

T
T

Minor 7th 5
4-note

Augmented
3-note
T
T

No 3rd
2-note

Augmented 7th
4-note
T

Augmented Major 7th


4-note

No 3rd, no 5th
1-note

= constituent notes of the chord

T = can be used as tension

Installing the hard disk (Pa1X only)

395

Installing the hard disk (Pa1X only)


mounting brackets and the M3x6 screws should have been
supplied with your Pa1X).

You can install a 2.5 ATA hard disk drive into your Pa1X, for
quick and easy data storage and retrieval. Please contact your
Korg dealer for more information. Before you begin, turn the
instrument off, and disconnect the power cable.

Warning: Installation of the hard disk drive is done as the users


own risk. Korg will assume no responsibility for any damage or
injury resulting from its improper installation or use.

Note: To install the hard disk, you will need a cross-point screwdriver.
1.

C
D

Turn the instrument upside down, and remove the eight


screws (a), to open the cover (A) and gain access to the
option compartment.

Note: Block any possible access to the inside of the instrument


during installation to prevent any items from falling inside. In
the event something does fall into the instrument, please
immediately contact your nearest Service Center.

b
4.

A
a

Place the assembled hard disk unit over the four spacers in
the option compartment, as shown in the diagram. Secure
the hard disk unit to the spacers using the remaining four
M3x6 screws (b). Be sure to fix the clip (c), previously
removed, to the original spacer, as shown in the diagram.
Connect the data cable (B) to the hard disk (C), then secure
the cable (B) with the clip (c).

b
C

a
b

2.

As you face the option compartment opening, locate the


area dedicated to the hard disk, i.e., the one with the four
small vertical spacers and the cable (B). Unscrew the screw
(b) and remove the clip (c), securing the cable (B) to one of
the spacers. Save the screw and the clip, you will need them
to complete the hard disk installation.
5.

b
B
b+c

Close and secure the compartment cover by reversing the


procedure described in step 1.

b+c

3.

Connect the two mounting brackets (D) to the hard disk


(C), by using four of the M3x6 screws (b). (Both the

Appendix

396

Installing the hard disk (Pa1X only)

Formatting the hard disk


When the installation is finished, reconnect the power cable and
turn the instrument on. You must format the hard disk before it
can be used.
1.

Press DISK to access the Disk edit mode.

2.

Select the Format page.

Device selector

3.

Use the Device selector to select the hard disk (HD).

4.

Press the
(Text Edit) button in the display to assign a
label (name) to the hard disk.

5.

Select the Full Format option, then press the Execute button, and follow the instructions that appear in the display.

Installing the Korg CDRW-1 Drive

397

Installing the Korg CDRW-1 Drive


Please note: Follow these instructions if your Pa1X (a) does not
include a small screw under the CD-RW slot (shown in the diagram),
and (b) does not include a mounting tray inside the slot itself.

If the above is not true, please follow the instructions you can download from our website (www.korgpa.com).

A Korg CDRW-1 CD player/writer can be installed into your Pa1X. Installation will require a + (cross-point) screwdriver. Please contact your Korg dealer for more information on how to obtain this option.
Warning: Installation of the CD drive is done at the users own risk. Korg will assume no responsibility for any damage or injury resulting
from improper installation or use.
Pa1X Pro

Pa1X

1) Before you begin, turn the instrument off, and disconnect the power cable.
2) Push the small unlock button with the tip of a pen, to open the CD drives (A) cover, and remove the paper protection.

push

push

A
3) With the help of a cross-point screwdriver, remove the two screws
(a) securing the floppy disk drive cover (B), and remove the cover itself.

3) With the help of a cross-point screwdriver, remove the two screws


(a) securing the CD slot cover (B), and remove the cover itself.

B
a

Appendix

398

Installing the Korg CDRW-1 Drive

Pa1X Pro

Pa1X

4) Slide the CD drive (A) into the instrument. Push it all the way in, to make sure that the CD drive mounts to the connector inside the Pa1X (two
clicks should be felt on your fingers when the connector on the CD drive is correctly inserted).

5) Turn the instrument on. Go to the Disk mode, and select the CD device by using the Device pop-up on the lower left corner of the Load, Save,
Copy, and Erase pages. If it works, go on with the next step to complete installation.
6) Screw screw (b) to secure the CD drive in place. Apply the cover (C) supplied with the Pa1X, and secure it with the two previously extracted
screws (a).

a
a

We suggest saving all removed components in a safe place for future use.

399

Installing additional RAM

Installing additional RAM


Pa1X comes equipped with 16MB of RAM already installed, which can be used for storing samples and Song editing. You can install an
additional 16MB of RAM in the form of a single 72-pin SIMM module (for a list of tested SIMMs, see www.korgpa.com). Please contact
your Korg dealer for more information.
1.

Before you begin, turn the instrument off, and disconnect the power cable.

2.

Turn the instrument upside down, and remove the screws (a), to
open the cover (A) and gain access to the option compartment.
Note: Block any possible access to the inside of the instrument during installation to prevent any items from falling inside. In the
event something does fall into the instrument, please immediately
contact your nearest Service Center.

Pa1X Pro

a
a

Pa1X

3.

As you face the option compartment opening, locate the two


RAM slots. A 16MB SIMM module is already present in one of
the slots.

4.

Lightly push out on the two securing clamps (one on each end).

A
a

Appendix

400
5.

Installing additional RAM

Remove the existing module (B), by gently rotating it forward as


shown in the diagram.

6.

Insert the new SIMM module (C) into the slot that was originally empty, as shown in the diagram. Line up the lower side of
the module with the slot base, then rotate the module up, and
delicately push until it is firmly seated in place. Be sure the module is correctly inserted. If not, extract it and repeat the operation.

7.

Now re-insert the SIMM module (B) that you removed in step
5, using the same method as used with the new module (C).

8.

Close and secure the compartment cover by reversing the operations seen on step 2.

401

Installing ROM expansions

Installing ROM expansions


Pa1X can be fitted with up to two dedicated Sound expansion boards. Please, check on www.korgpa.com, or contact your Korg dealer
for more information on the available options.
1.

Before you begin, turn the instrument off, and disconnect the power cable.

2.

Turn the instrument upside down, and remove the screws (a), to
open the cover (A) and gain access to the option compartment.
Note: Block any possible access to the inside of the instrument during installation to prevent any items from falling inside. In the
event something does fall into the instrument, please immediately
contact your nearest Service Center.

Pa1X Pro

a
a

Pa1X

A
a

As you face the option compartment opening, locate the two


ROM slots.

Appendix

3.

402
4.

Installing ROM expansions

Insert the first ROM expansion module (B) the only one, if it
is the only one you purchased in the slot farther from you, as
shown in the diagram. Line up the lower side of the module
with the slot base, then rotate the module up, and delicately
push until it is firmly seated in place. Be sure the module is correctly inserted. If not, extract it and repeat the operation.
Note: You could also install the module in the other slot, but this
way installing a second module later will be easier.

5.

If you purchased a second ROM sound module (C), install it by


following the same procedure seen for the first module (B).

6.

Close and secure the compartment cover by reversing the operations seen on step 2.

403

Installing the Video Interface (VIF3)


NTSC, PAL, SECAM

Installing the Video Interface (VIF3)


You can install a Korg VIF3 Video Interface into your Pa1X or
Pa1X Pro. This interface will let you connect a video monitor or
video projector, to read lyrics on an external device. The card
can be installed by the user. Korg is not responsible for any
damage or injury caused by incorrect installation of this card
by unauthorized personnel.

NTSC, PAL, SECAM

Part listing
Before beginning with the installation, please be sure all the following parts are included with your kit. Some parts are needed
only when installing the board on a particular model, but not on
others. In addition, you will need a cross-point screwdriver and
a pair of pliers (not supplied).

A
The following instruction refer both to the VIF3-PAL and VIF3NTSC versions of the board. When connecting the VIF3-PAL to
a SECAM-compliant TV, the image will be shown in black and
white.

C
B
E

Precautions
Installation of the card is done at the users own risk. Korg will
assume no responsibility for any damage or injury resulting
from its improper installation or use.

H
F

Be sure to disconnect the instrument from the AC plug, before


opening it.
Part name

Pa1X Pro

Pa1X

Video card

Plastic spacers

Cable holder clip

Ground cable

(not needed)

Video card cable

(not needed)

Video cable

(not needed)

Nuts

2.9 x 9.5 self-threading screw

(not needed)

1
2

Note: The checkmark means the part is needed for the corresponding instrument. Some components are only for the Pa80 and Pa60,
therefore are not needed on the Pa1X or Pa1X Pro.

Appendix

To prevent your bodys static electricity from damaging the


boards components, touch an unpainted metallic component
before proceeding with the installation.

404

Installing the Video Interface (VIF3)


Installation on the Pa1X Pro

support (g) for the installation on the Pa1X Pro, nevertheless we suggest to save them for any future use.

Installation on the Pa1X Pro


1.

Turn the instrument upside down, and remove the seven


screws (d), to open the cover (c) and gain access to the
option compartment.

Note: Block any possible access to the inside of the instrument


during installation to prevent any items from falling inside. In
the event something does fall into the instrument, please
immediately contact your nearest Service Center.

b
b

g
b

d
d

2.

d d

b
4.

As you face the option compartment opening, locate the


area reserved for the video interface, i.e., the one with the
two small vertical spacers and the cable (e), secured by two
clips. Unfasten the cable (e) from the clip (C), and rewire
the clip around the unfastened cable.

Insert the two plastic spacers (B) into the corresponding


screws on the option compartment cover, as shown in the
diagram. Secure the IC board (f) to the two spacers (B),
using the two self-locking nuts (G). Connect the terminal
lug of the cable (e) and the terminal lug without a ring (F)
to the corresponding connectors on the IC board. Unscrew
the screw (b) from the connector board in the option compartment, then re-insert it after securing to it the clip (C)
included with the accessory kit. Use the clip to lock the ring
of the free cable terminal lug (F). Connect this terminal to
the RCA connector on the connector board, as shown in
the diagram.

B
B
e

f
e

GF
G

b+C

5.
3.

Examine the video interface (A) included with the kit. Note
how the IC board (f) is joined to the support (g) by means
of the two screws (b). Unscrew the two screws (b) to separate them. You will not need the removed screws (b) and

Close and secure the compartment cover by reversing the


procedure described in step 1.

Installing the Video Interface (VIF3)


Installation on the Pa1X

save them for any future use. On the contrary, the removed
screws will be needed in the following step.

Installation on the Pa1X


1.

405

Turn the instrument upside down, and remove the eight


screws (d), to open the cover (c) and gain access to the
option compartment.

Note: Block any possible access to the inside of the instrument


during installation to prevent any items from falling inside. In
the event something does fall into the instrument, please
immediately contact your nearest Service Center.

b
b

g
b

d
d

2.

c
d

4.

As you face the option compartment opening, locate the


area reserved for the video interface, i.e., the one with the
two small vertical spacers, the cable (e), secured by two
clips, and the cable (F), secured by the clip (C). Note how
the clip (C) is secured to one of the two vertical spacers by
means of the screw (b). Unscrew the screw (b) and remove
the clip (C). Then unfasten the cable (e) from the clip (C),
as shown in the diagram. Save the screw and the clip, you
will need them to complete the video interface installation.

Secure the IC board (f) to the two vertical spacers using the
two screws (b), previously removed. Please remember to
re-insert the clip (C) at its original position. Connect the
terminal lug of the cable (F) to the corresponding connector on the IC board. Secure the cable to the clip (C). Finally,
connect the cable (e) to the IC board, and secure it using
the previously loosened clip (C).

b+C

f
e

F
b
C

5.

b+C

Close and secure the compartment cover by reversing the


procedure described in step 1.

3.

Note how the IC board (f) is joined to the support (g) by


means of the two screws (b). Unscrew the two screws (b) to
separate them. You will not need the removed support (g)
for the installation on the Pa1X, nevertheless we suggest to

Appendix

406

Installing the Video Interface (VIF3)


Connections and setup

Connections and setup


1.

Connect the instruments video output to the video input


of the television set. Depending on the type of television
set, you can use a cable of the type RCA-to-RCA (if the
television set is equipped with a Video Composite input),
or RCA-to-SCART (if the television set is equipped with
a SCART connector). You can buy the needed cables at a
store that sells television equipment.

RCA

RCA

SCART
2.

Turn the instrument on, and press the GLOBAL button to


gain access to the Global edit mode. Go to the Video Interface: Video Out page, and select the video standard (PAL
or NTSC) depending to the installed video board (VIF3PAL or VIF3-NTSC).

3.

Select the Write Global-Global Setup command from the


page menu to save the settings in memory. The Write Global-Global Setup dialog box will appear. Press OK to confirm.

4.

Turn the television set on, and tune it on the AV1 or AV2
input.

5.

In the same page of the Global, use the Colors parameter to


choose the preferred set of colors for the lyrics and the
background.

Installing the MP3 Board (EXBP-MP3)


Precautions

407

Installing the MP3 Board (EXBP-MP3)

Please note Korg is not responsible for any damage or injury caused by
incorrect installation of this card by unauthorized personnel.

Part listing
Before beginning with the installation, please be sure all the following parts
are included with your kit. Some parts are needed only when installing the
board on a particular model, but not on others. In addition, you will need a
cross-point screwdriver (Pa1X/Pa1X Pro) and a 5.5mm hexagon wrench or a
pair of pliers (Pa1X Pro) (not supplied).

Precautions

Installation of the card is done at the users own risk. Korg will assume no
responsibility for any damage or injury resulting from its improper installation or use.

Be sure to disconnect the instrument from the AC plug, before opening it.

To prevent your bodys static electricity from damaging the boards components, touch an unpainted metallic component before proceeding with the
installation.

Part name

Pa1X Pro

Pa1X

Self-locking nuts

Plastic spacers

MP3 card

M36 screws

Note: The checkmark means the part is needed for the corresponding instrument.

Appendix

You can install a Korg EXBP-MP3 board into your Pa1X or Pa1X
Pro. This user-installable card will let your Pa1X and Pa1X Pro
play and record MP3 files, allowing for easy music data exchange
with any personal computer or stand-alone MP3 player.

408

Installing the MP3 Board (EXBP-MP3)


Installation

Installation
Pa1X Pro
1.

Turn the instrument upside down, and remove the seven


screws (a), to open the cover (b) and gain access to the option
compartment.
Note: Block any possible access to the inside of the instrument
during installation to prevent any items from falling inside. In
the event something does fall into the instrument, please
immediately contact your nearest Service Center.

2.

As you face the option compartment opening, locate the area


reserved for the MP3 board, i.e., the one with the four small
vertical columns, the MP3 audio cable (c) and the video cable
(d). Please note how the video cable (d) is fastened by two
clamps (f) to two columns, by means of two self-locking nuts
(A). Remove both nuts (A), taking care not to remove the two
clamps from their position, and unfasten the audio cable (c)
from the clamp (e).

3.

Insert the four plastic spacers (B) into the corresponding columns on the option compartment cover, as shown in the diagram. Please be sure to lay the flat size of the spacers onto the
option compartment cover, and to keep both clamps (f) under
the spacers (B), as shown in the following diagram.

4.

Insert the MP3 board (C) over the four spacers, with the components on the upper side (as shown in the diagram). Secure it to
the spacers by using the four self-locking nuts (A). Connect the
terminal lug of the cable (c) to the corresponding connector on
the MP3 board, by folding the cable as shown in the diagram.

5.

Close and secure the compartment cover by reversing the


procedure described in step 1.

a
a

A+f
e A+f
d
c

B B
B B
f
f

A
c

C
A

A
A

Installing the MP3 Board (EXBP-MP3)


Installation

409

Pa1X
Turn the instrument upside down, and remove the eight
screws (a), to open the cover (b) and gain access to the option
compartment.
Note: Block any possible access to the inside of the instrument (for example, the openings of the nearby RAM expansion slots) during installation to prevent any items from
falling inside. In the event something does fall into the instrument, please immediately contact your nearest Service Center.

a
a

2.

b
a

As you face the option compartment opening, locate the area


reserved for the MP3 board, i.e., the one with the four small
vertical spacers, the MP3 audio cable (c) and the video cable
(d). Please note how the video cable (d) is fastened by two
clamps (f) to two of the spacers, by means of two M3 screws
(D). Remove both screws (D), taking care not to remove the
two clamps from their position, and unfasten the audio cable
(c) from the clamp (e).

d
D+f

3.

Insert the MP3 board (C) over the four spacers, with the components on the upper side (as shown in the diagram). Secure it to
the spacers by using the four M3 screws (D). Connect the terminal lug of the cable (c) to the corresponding connector on the
MP3 board, by folding the cable as shown in the diagram.

4.

Close and secure the compartment cover by reversing the


procedure described in step 1.

D+f

D
C
D

c
D

Appendix

1.

410

Installing the MP3 Board (EXBP-MP3)


Recording an MP3

Recording an MP3
If your Pa1X is fitted with the optional MP3 Board (EXBP-MP3)
and a hard disk (optional on the Pa1X with speakers), you can
record your performance as an MP3 file.
Note: You cannot enter MP3 Record mode while in Sequencer or
Disk mode.
All you play on the keyboard, the Styles and the Standard MIDI
Files performed by the sequencer will be recorded. Audio entering the Audio Input 1 (microphone input, or mono line-level
input), and harmony voices generated by the Voice Processor
will be recorded as well.
Playback of MP3 files and Audio CD tracks will not be
recorded.
To enter recording, keep the SHIFT button pressed, and press
the REC button. The following dialog box will appear.

After saving, you can listen to the MP3 file in Song Play mode, as
you did with any other Song.
The MP3 file can also be moved to a personal computer for further editing, via the USB interface.

Notes
Operating system version

To use the EXBP-MP3, your Pa1X must be fitted with Operating System 1.51 or higher.

Audio outputs

After installing the EXBP-MP3 board, the audio output level (both on
the OUTPUT connectors and the internal speakers) is increased of
about 3dB. Readjust the master volume accordingly.

Audio generated by the MP3 board is only output on the Left+Right


analog outputs. It cannot be routed to the digital output.

Playback

MP3 files recorded with lower sampling rates may not sound very
good. This is an unavoidable problem with MP3 files.

You can assign an MP3 file to both sequencers, but starting one stops
the other (if it is playing).

When reading MP3 files from a data CD, and the CD has been automatically paused for having been inactive for some time, starting playback may require some seconds, because the CD has to start spinning
again.

Select the preferred MP3 audio quality option, by means of the


Quality pop-up menu. The higher the sound quality, the larger
the MP3 file that will be generated.
When done, press the Rec button in the display to start
recording. The Rec button changes to Stop, and can be
pressed again to stop recording. During recording, a big
red R will flash in the display.

If you like, you can press the EXIT button to exit this dialog box.
To enter it again, and see the file length or stop recording, press
SHIFT+REC again.
During recording, you can use this dialog box to see the Recording time, file length, and the remaining space on disk. Maximum
recording time depends on the available space on the hard disk.
After pressing Stop, recording will stop, and the following dialog
box will appear:

Press the
(Text Edit) button to assign a name to the MP3
File. Press the Browse button to select a device and directory
where to save the file. Press the Save button to save the file.

Recording

You can record as an MP3 file everything you play with the Pa1X,
including your vocals (in other words, you can record your whole performance). However, you cannot record MP3 files or convert Audio
CD Tracks.

You can listen to Audio CD tracks during MP3 recording, but they will
not be recorded.

Hard disk

To record MP3 files, your Pa1X must be fitted with a hard disk.

It is not advisable to fill the hard disk too much during recording. Filling the hard disk may cause troubles with the recorded file.

Regular care is recommended with your hard disk. Defragmenting and


repairing can be made with any PC utility, while the Pa1X is connected
via USB.

Shortcuts

411

Shortcuts

Shift +

Functions

Any operating modes


Dial

Tempo Change

Scroll Arrows, or
Up/Down

When a list of Songs or SongBook entries is


shown: Next/Previous alphabetical section.
It also works in Disk mode, when the Name
sorting is selected.

Sound

Sends the Sound assigned to the selected


track to the Sound mode

Global

Selects the Setup/General Controls page, MIDI


section, of the Global mode. This is a quick
way to jump to MIDI editing pages.

Disk

Selects the Preferences page of the Disk mode

Start/Stop

Panic

Slider Mode

Selects the Assignable Sliders page, Controllers section, of the Global mode

Fade In/Out

Selects the Fade In/Out parameter in the Basic


page, Preferences section, of the Global
mode

Synchro (either)

Selects the MIDI Setup parameter in the


Setup/General Controls page, MIDI section, of
the Global mode

Tempo Lock

Selects the Lock page, General Controls section, of the Global mode

Display Hold

Selects the Interface page, General Controls


section, of the Global mode

SongBook

Selects the Custom List page of the SongBook


mode

Transpose (either)

Selects the Transpose Control page, General


Controls section, of the Global mode

Style Play mode


Style Play

Selects the Style Setup page (Preferences section)

Memory

Selects the Style Preferences page (Preferences section)

Var or Fill

Selects the corresponding Style Element in


the Drum/Fill page (Style Controls section)

Chord Scanning
(either)

Selects the Chord Recognition parameter in


the Split panel, Main Page

Keyboard Mode
(either)

Selects the Key Velocity page (Keyboard/


Ensemble section)

Shift +

Functions

Ensemble

Selects the Ensemble Type parameter in the


Ensemble page, (Keyboard/Ensemble section)

Pad (any)

Selects the Pad page (Pad/Assignable Switches


section)

Assignable Switch
(any)

Selects the Switch page (Pad/Assignable


Switches section)

Upper Octave
(either)

Selects the Tuning page (Mixer/Tuning section)

Song Play mode


Song Play

Selects the General Control page (Preferences


section)

Play/StopSeq 1
or 2

Sync Start of either sequencers

>>

Play the next Audio CD track

<<

Play the previous Audio CD track

Upper Octave
(either)

Selects the Tuning page (Mixer/Tuning section)

Keyboard Mode
(either)

Selects the Key Velocity page (Keyboard/


Ensemble section)

Pad (any)

Selects the Pad page (Pad/Assignable Switches


section)

Assignable Switch
(any)

Selects the Switch page (Pad/Assignable


Switches section)

JukeBox mode
>>

Play the next Song in the JukeBox list

<<

Play the previous Song in the JukeBox list

Sequencer mode
Sequencer

Selects the Sequencer Setup page (Preferences section)

Upper Octave
(either)

Selects the Tuning page (Mixer/Tuning section)

Another available shortcut is the following one, not requiring


the SHIFT button being pressed.
Style Play mode
Up/Down
(together)

Original Tempo

Appendix

You can keep the SHIFT button pressed, and press another button on the control panel to directly jump to an edit page. Here is
the list of shortcuts.

412

Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting
Problem

Solution

Page

General problems
Power does not turn on

Make sure that (1) the power cable is plugged into the outlet, (2) the cable is plugged into the
connector on the back of the instrument, (3) and is not damaged, (4) there are no problems
with the mains.
Is the power switch turned ON?
If the power still does not turn on, contact your dealer or the nearest KORG Service Center.

No sound

Is a jack connected to the HEADPHONES connector? This would disable the internal speakers.

18

Check the connections to your amp or mixer.

18

Make sure that all the components of the amplifying system are turned on.
Is the MASTER VOLUME slider of the Pa1X set to a position other than 0?

18

Is the Local parameter set to Off? Turn it On.

237

Is the Speaker parameter set to Off? Turn it On.

241

Is the Attack parameter value too high? Set it to a lower value, to let the sound start faster. Is
the Volume parameter too low? Set it to a higher value.

84, 90

Lowest note are not played

When the SPLIT button is lit up, the keyboard will be divided into the Lower part (low notes,
below the split point) and the Upper part (high notes, above the split point). Is the Lower track
muted? Unmute it.

27

Wrong sounds

Do the USER banks contain modified data? Load the appropriate data for the Song or the Style
you wish to playback.

262

Has one of the USER Drum Kits been modified? Load the appropriate Drum Kits.

262

Have the Styles or Performances been modified? Load the appropriate data (Styles or Performances).

262

Sound does not stop

Make sure that the damper switch polarity parameter is set correctly.

235

The selected Style or Song cannot


start

Make sure that the Clock parameter is set to Internal. If you are using the MIDI Clock of
another device, you must set the MIDI Clock parameter to MIDI A or MIDI B (depending on the
port the Pa1X is hooked to the other device through) and make sure that the external device
transmits MIDI Clock data.

236

Does not respond to MIDI messages

Make sure that all MIDI cables are connected correctly.

280

Make sure that the external device is transmitting through MIDI channels enabled to receive in
the Pa1X.

238

Make sure that the MIDI IN Filters of the Pa1X do not prevent the reception of messages.

239

Percussive instruments are not


played correctly

Make sure that the Drum track is set to Drum Mode and the external device has not transposition applied.

Some clicks can be heard when


playing a percussive instrument

This is part of the sound, and not a problem.

A background noise can be heard


after selecting a Performance,
Style or STS

The selected Performance, Style or STS recalled the effect 15 Analog Record, simulating the
noise of a old vinyl recording.

The Voice Processor cannot be


heard

The Vocoder effect has been assigned to the D FX processor. This deactivates the Voice processor.
Voice processor effects an only be applied to the microphone (MIC) input

88, 181

377

Troubleshooting

Problem

Solution

413

Page

Disk related problems

Cannot save data to a floppy disk

Cannot load data from a floppy


disk

Are you using a 3.5 inch 2DD or 2HD floppy disk? You must use one of these types.
Is the disk inserted correctly?

278

Is the write protect tab of the disk in the protect position?

278

Is the disk formatted?

270

Is the disk inserted correctly?

278

Is the write protect tab of the disk in the protect position?

278

Is the disk inserted correctly?

278

Does the disk contain data compatible with the Pa1X?

259

Appendix

Cannot format a floppy disk

414

Technical specifications

Technical specifications
Model

Pa1X Pro

Pa1X

Keyboard

76 keys, semi-weighted, with velocity and mono aftertouch.

61 keys, semi-weighted, with velocity and mono aftertouch.

Operating System

KORG OPOS (Objective Portable Operating System) and RX (Real eXperience) Technology. Multitasking, Load-While-Play feature. SSD
(Solid State Disk)-resident. Upgradable from floppy disk.

Display

320 240 pixels, Color TouchView graphic touch screen

Help

Hypertextual, context-sensitive help system. Multilingual starting from OS Rel. 1.5.

Data storage

1.44MB Floppy Disk Drive (MS-DOS compatible), Optional CDRW (KORG CDRW-1), Standard 2.5" ATA Hard Disk Drive

Sound generation system

KORG HI - Hyper Integrated.

Polyphony

62 voices, 62 oscillators. Filters with resonance.

1.44MB Floppy Disk Drive (MS-DOS compatible), Optional CDRW (KORG CDRW-1), Optional 2.5" ATA Hard Disk Drive

Multitimbricity

40 tracks (2 x 16 Sequencer, 4 Keyboard, 4 Pads)

Sounds

Factory: >870, including a Stereo Piano and GM Level 2-compatible Programs, 48 Drum Kits
User: 256 Sounds, 64 Drum Kits.

Digital Drawbars

8 Footages. Realtime control, using the Assignable Sliders

Sound Edit

Onboard full editing for Sounds and Drum Kits

Sampling

Record, Edit, Time Slice (compatible with Korg, Wav, Aiff and Akai files)

PCM RAM Memory

16MB standard, expandable up to 32MB with an optional 16MB SIMM module

PCM ROM Expansion

2 slots available, for up to 32MB of additional samples (up to 512 extra Sounds and 128 Drum Kits)

Effects

4 stereo digital multi-effect processors (with 89 effect types each, plus Vocoder). Voice Processor by TCHelicon.

Voice Processor

Voice technology by TCHelicon. Four-parts harmonizer, Reverb, Delay, Compressor, EQ. Pitch Correction and Voice Modeling available as options.

Realtime Tracks

Four Keyboard tracks (Upper 1, 2, 3, Lower), 4 Pad tracks

Performances

320 Realtime Performance locations.

Single Touch Settings (STS)

Memorize Realtime tracks and Voice Processor settings. Up to 4 608 Styles. Up to 4 each SongBook entry.

Styles

More than 450 preloaded Styles, SSD-resident, freely reconfigurable. Up to 608 available Style locations. Eight Style tracks, 4 Single
Touch Settings and one Style Performance per-Style.
Direct Disk (up to 96 Styles) and Direct Hard Disk (up to 288 Styles) functions. Compatible with old i-Series and Pa80/60-series Styles.
Style Record with Edit functions, Step Edit, Event Edit. Up to 96 User Style locations.

Style controls

4 Variations, 2 Fills, 2 Intros, 2 Endings, Intro 3/Count In, Fill 3/Break, Synchro Start/Stop, Tap Tempo/Reset, Fade In/Out, Bass Inversion,
Manual Bass, Tempo Lock, Memory, Accompaniment Volume, Accompaniment Mute, Drum Mapping, Snare & Kick Designation, Single
Touch.

General controls

Master Volume, Ensemble, Octave Transpose, Master Transpose, Split Point, Style Change, Tracks Volume, Quarter Tone (pedal function), Assignable Sliders, Assignable Switches, Joystick, Dial.

Pads

4 Assignable Pads + Stop button

Song Play

Patented XDS Crossfade Dual Sequencer player - 2 Sequencers with separate Select, Start/Stop, Pause, << (Rewind) and >> (Fast Forward) controls. Balance control.
Lyrics data can be displayed on-screen, or on an external video monitor. Jukebox function. SMF Direct Player (formats 0 and 1). Reads
Audio CDs and MP3 files (both optional).

Sequencer

Quick, Multitrack and Step Record functions. Full-featured sequencer. 16 tracks. Up to 200,000 events. SMF native format.

MP3 Player/Recorder

MP3 Player/Recorder (optional). Requires a KORG EXBP-MP3 expansion board.

CD Audio Player/Writer

Optional. Requires a KORG CDRW-1 drive. Reads audio and data, writes data (ISO 9660 disks).

SongBook

Fully programmable music database, with automatic selection of Style Play and Song Play modes. Different custom lists can be created.

Pedals

Damper, Assignable (continuous, footswitch), EC5

Realtime controllers

Joystick (pitch + modulation), Assignable Sliders, Assignable Switches, Pads

MIDI

2 IN, 2 OUT (toggle as THRU ports). Individual track assignment. Auto-setup functions (MIDI Setup)

USB

USB 1.1 connector (Type B/Slave)

Audio Inputs

2 Line In, 1 Mic In with Gain control

Audio Outputs

2 Main (Left/Mono, Right), 2 Sub (1, 2), 1 48kHz S/PDIF digital coaxial (mirroring Main Outputs)

Headphone

Front 6.3 mm 1/4" jack connection

Amplification

Bi-amped 2 35 Watt (Woofer) + 2 12 Watt

Speakers

4 Speakers (13 cm Woofer + Dome Tweeter), 2-way, Bass Reflex


Box

Power Supply

Universal 100 ~ 240V AC power supply

Power Consumption

35 W

Dimensions

W: 1330 mm / 52.36", D: 366 mm / 14.40", H: 136 mm / 5.35" (with- W: 1123 mm / 44.21, D: 428 mm / 16.85, H: 189 mm / 7.44 (without music stand)
out music stand)

Weight

19.5 kg / 44.99 lbs

Accessories

Users Manual, AC Power Cable, Music Stand, CDRW installation kit

65 W

22 kg / 48.5 lbs

Technical specifications

Model

Pa1X Pro

Options

EC5 Multiswitch Controller


EXP-2 Expression/Volume Pedal
XVP-10 Expression/Volume Pedal
PS-1 Footswitch
DS-1H Damper Pedal

415

Pa1X

SUG-TC1 Pitch Correction/Voice Modeling Software Upgrade (by TCHelicon)


CDRW-1 CD Player/Writer (user installable)
EXBP-MP3 MP3 Player/Recorder Board (user installable)
VIF3 NTSC/PAL Video Interface (user installable)
1 16MB, 72-pin SIMM module (user installable)
2 EXBP-series ROM expansions (user installable)
2.5" ATA Hard disk (user installable)

Appendix

416

Index

Index
A
Acc/Seq Volume 8, 18
Aftertouch Curve 230
AIFF file format 225
Akai 215, 225
Amp EG 207
AMS(Alternate Modulation Source)
Amp EG 207
Filter Cutoff 202
Filter EG 202
Filter LFO 203
Pan 205
Pitch 198
Pitch EG 200
Resonance 201
Arabic Scale 83, 86
Assignable Sliders 8, 235
Attack Level
Amp EG 207
Attack Time
Filter EG 205
Audio Inputs 11, 15, 19, 240
Audio Outputs 15, 18, 239241
Auto Style/Perf/Sound Select 234
Write 257

B
Backup 17, 271
Balance 11, 18
Bank Select 283
Bank123.SET, Bank456.SET, Bank789.SET (Direct HD) 99
Bass & Lower Backing 96
BPM
MIDI/Tempo Sync., LFO 209

C
CD 48, 55, 139, 140, 156
Installing 397
Selecting 259
Volume 242
Writing 274276
Chord Scanning 11
Lock 233
Cutoff Frequency 201

D
Damper 19, 91
Polarity 235
Decay Time
Filter EG 205
Delay
LFO 209

Demo 19
Digital Drawbars 192
Direct FD 100
Direct HD 99
Disk 259279
Backup 271
Format 270
Write protection 278
Display Hold 11
Double Sequencer 10, 147
Drum tracks 89, 93, 240

E
EC5 236
Effects
Copy 97, 155, 187
Sequencer mode 179, 180
Song Play mode 148, 149, 150
Style Play mode 85, 87, 180
Ending 10
Ensemble 92

F
Fade (Sound parameter)
LFO 209
Fade In/Out 230
Fill 10
Filter
Cutoff Frequency 201
Filter Type 200
Filter Cutoff 202
Filter EG 202
Filter LFO 203
Footswitch 235
Polarity 235
Format 270

G
General MIDI 281
Global 229258
Write
Global Setup 257
MIDI Setup 257
Sequencer Setup 188
Song Play Setup 156
Style Play Setup 99
Talk Configuration 258
Voice Processor Preset 258
Voice Processor Setup 258
Global channel 281
Groove Quantize 152

Index

H
Harmony track (Voice Processor) 153, 186
in SongBook entries 161
MIDI channel 237
Note Input Source 249

I
Inputs 11, 15, 19, 240
Intro 9

J
Jukebox 143, 151

K
Keyboard Mode 12
Lock 233
KMP file format 225
KSF file format 225

L
Level (Sound parameter)
Trim 200
LFO
Waveform, LFO waveform 208
Local Off 237, 283
Lower Lock 233
Lyrics 144, 163

M
Markers 145
Master Transpose 12, 231
Master Tune 230
Master Volume 8, 18
Menu 11
MIDI
Clock 137, 236
General MIDI 281
Global channel 281
IN channels 238
Interface 15, 283
OUT channels 238
Setup 96, 153, 186, 236, 281
Standard MIDI File 137, 166
MIDI interface 15, 283
MIDI Setup 96, 153, 186, 236, 281
Write 257
Midifile 137, 166, 280
Mode
Pad Record 126136
Sampling 215228
Sequencer 166189
Song Play 137156
SongBook 157165
Sound 190214
Style Play 78101
Style Record 102125
MP3 48, 56, 137, 139, 140, 144, 151, 156, 157, 163
Installation 407
Recording 410

Volume 241

O
Octave Transpose 13, 86
Auto Octave 232
Midi In 237
Offset
Offset, LFO 209
Operating Modes 8
OS (Operating System)
Backup 17, 271
Update 17
Outputs 15, 18, 239241

P
Pads 12, 94
Pan
Pads 94
Song tracks 148, 179
Sound 197, 205
Style tracks 84
PANIC (SHIFT+START/STOP) 10
PCG file format 225
PCM Autoload 226, 273
Pedals 235
Performance 12, 78
Selecting 12, 74
Selecting (Auto) 234
Writing 98
Pitch 198
Pitch Bend 86, 180
Pitch EG 200
Portamento
AMS 213
Program Change 283

Q
Quarter Tone 83, 86

R
Resonance 201

S
Sampling 215228
Sampling mode 215228
Scale
Main scale 231
Sequencer
Link mode 154
Sequencer 2 FX mode 154
Transport controls 10, 11
Sequencer mode 166189
Shift 10
Single Touch 9, 10
Single Touch Setting (STS) 10
Selecting 10, 75
Writing 98
Song
Markers 145

417

418

Index

Play from disk 76, 188


Recording 169178
Selecting 76, 188
Standard MIDI File 280
Song Play mode 137156
SongBook 157165
Sound
Editing 90, 150, 181
Selecting 12, 74
Selecting (Auto) 234
Writing 211
Sound mode 190214
Split Point 83, 281
Standard MIDI File 137, 166, 280
STS, See Single Touch Setting
Style
Ending 10
Fill 10
Intro 9
Recording 102125
Selecting 9, 75
Selecting (Auto) 234
Style Performance 78
Variation 10
Style Performance
Selecting, see Style
Writing 99
Style Play mode 78101
Style Record mode 102125
Sync.
Key Sync., LFO 209
MIDI/Tempo, LFO 209
Synchro Start/Stop 10

T
Talk
Auto On/Off 244
On/Off 82
Settings 244
Write settings 258
Tap Tempo 10
Tempo/Value section 11
Touch Panel
Calibration 256
Reset 256
Track Select 10
Tracks
Drum/Percussion 89, 93, 240
Keyboard tracks 12, 78, 138
Octave Transpose 13

Sounds 12
Volume 84, 147, 179
Transpose 12, 13, 86
Auto Octave 232
Midi In 237
Trinity 215, 225
Triton 215, 225
Tune
Tune (Sound parameter) 195

U
Upper Volume Link 84, 96
USB 273

V
VALUE slider
AMS 213
Variation 10
Velocity
AMS 213
Velocity Intensity, Amp Mod. 206
Velocity, Filter EG 202
Velocity Curve 230
Video Interface 15, 256, 403
Vocoder 377
Voice Processor
Harmony Track 153, 161, 186
MIDI channel 237
Note Input Source 249
Voice Processor Preset
Editing 245
Lock 233
Writing 258
Voice Processor Setup
Editing 242
Writing 258
Volume
Acc/Seq 8, 18, 137
Balance 18
Individual tracks
Sequencer 179
Song Play 147
Style Play 84
Master 8, 18, 137

W
WAVE file format 225

Address
KORG ITALY Spa
Via Cagiata, 85
I-60027 Osimo (An)
Italy
Web servers
www.korgpa.com
www.korg.co.jp
www.korg.com
www.korg.co.uk
www.korgcanada.com
www.korgfr.net
www.korg.de
www.korg.it
www.letusa.es

PART NUMBER: MAN0001093

KORG Italy 2005. All rights reserved

You might also like